summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 02:46:02 -0700
committerRoger Frank <rfrank@pglaf.org>2025-10-15 02:46:02 -0700
commit12bfa56c7787433201cc9a4c6e4e52b6cc52dcc1 (patch)
tree5248c1212867fbbd89b09cd3ca283bedda88e11e
initial commit of ebook 28958HEADmain
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--28958-8.txt10065
-rw-r--r--28958-8.zipbin0 -> 168117 bytes
-rw-r--r--28958-h.zipbin0 -> 431847 bytes
-rw-r--r--28958-h/28958-h.htm11773
-rw-r--r--28958-h/images/illus-036.jpgbin0 -> 56600 bytes
-rw-r--r--28958-h/images/illus-064.jpgbin0 -> 57101 bytes
-rw-r--r--28958-h/images/illus-256.jpgbin0 -> 58097 bytes
-rw-r--r--28958-h/images/illus-emb.pngbin0 -> 2618 bytes
-rw-r--r--28958-h/images/illus-fpc.jpgbin0 -> 58195 bytes
-rw-r--r--28958-h/images/illus-map.pngbin0 -> 9788 bytes
-rw-r--r--28958.txt10065
-rw-r--r--28958.zipbin0 -> 168090 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
15 files changed, 31919 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/28958-8.txt b/28958-8.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1619615
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958-8.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,10065 @@
+The Project Gutenberg eBook, The Road to Frontenac, by Samuel Merwin
+
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+
+
+
+Title: The Road to Frontenac
+
+
+Author: Samuel Merwin
+
+
+
+Release Date: May 24, 2009 [eBook #28958]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+
+***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC***
+
+
+E-text prepared by Roger Frank and the Project Gutenberg Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team (http://www.pgdp.net)
+
+
+
+Note: Project Gutenberg also has an HTML version of this
+ file which includes the original illustrations.
+ See 28958-h.htm or 28958-h.zip:
+ (http://www.gutenberg.org/files/28958/28958-h/28958-h.htm)
+ or
+ (http://www.gutenberg.org/files/28958/28958-h.zip)
+
+
+
+
+
+THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC
+
+
+[Illustration: "Half way down the steps was a double file of Indians
+chained two and two."]
+
+
+THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC
+
+by
+
+SAMUEL MERWIN
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+New York
+Doubleday, Page & Co.
+1901
+
+Copyright, 1901, by Frank Leslie Publishing House.
+Copyright, 1901, by Doubleday, Page & Company.
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+ CHAPTER PAGE
+ I. Captain Menard Has a Lazy Day. 1
+ II. The Maid. 19
+ III. Mademoiselle Eats Her Breakfast. 38
+ IV. The Long Arrow. 61
+ V. Danton Breaks Out. 83
+ VI. The Fight at La Gallette. 103
+ VII. A Compliment for Menard. 127
+ VIII. The Maid Makes New Friends. 147
+ IX. The Word of an Onondaga. 169
+ X. A Night Council. 191
+ XI. The Big Throat Speaks. 212
+ XII. The Long House. 235
+ XIII. The Voice of the Great Mountain. 254
+ XIV. Where the Dead Sit. 272
+ XV. The Bad Doctor. 293
+ XVI. At the Long Lake. 314
+ XVII. Northward. 337
+ XVIII. The Only Way. 359
+ XIX. Frontenac. 383
+
+
+
+
+LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
+
+ PAGE
+
+ "Half way down the steps was a double file of Indians
+ chained two and two." _Frontispiece_
+
+ "Sitting on a bundle was, a girl, perhaps eighteen or
+ nineteen years old." 36
+
+ "The Indians walked silently to the fire." 64
+
+ "Menard stood ... smiling with the same look of scorn
+ he had worn ... when they led him to the torture." 256
+
+
+
+
+THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC.
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+CAPTAIN MENARD HAS A LAZY DAY.
+
+
+Captain Daniel Menard leaned against the parapet at the outer edge of
+the citadel balcony. The sun was high, the air clear and still.
+Beneath him, at the foot of the cliff, nestled the Lower Town, a strip
+of shops and houses, hemmed in by the palisades and the lower battery.
+The St. Lawrence flowed by, hardly stirred by the light breeze. Out in
+the channel, beyond the merchantmen, lay three ships of war, _Le
+Fourgon_, _Le Profond_, and _La Perle_, each with a cluster of supply
+boats at her side; and the stir and rattle of tackle and chain coming
+faintly over the water from _Le Fourgon_ told that she would sail for
+France on the morrow, if God should choose to send the wind.
+
+Looking almost straight down, Menard could see the long flight of
+steps that climbed from the settlement on the water front to the
+nobler city on the heights. Halfway down the steps was a double file
+of Indians, chained two and two, and guarded by a dozen regulars from
+his own company. He watched them until they reached the bottom and
+disappeared behind the row of buildings that ended on the wharf in
+Patron's trading store. In a moment they reappeared, and marched
+across the wharf, toward the two boats from _Le Fourgon_ that awaited
+them. Even from the height, Menard could see that the soldiers had a
+stiff task to control their prisoners. After one of the boats, laden
+deep, had shoved off, there was a struggle, and the crowd of idlers
+that had gathered scattered suddenly. Two Indians had broken away, and
+were running across the wharf, with a little knot of soldiers close on
+their heels. One of the soldiers, leaping forward, brought the stock
+of his musket down on the head of the nearer Indian. The fugitive went
+down, dragging with him his companion, who tugged desperately at the
+chain. A soldier drew his knife, and cut off the dead Indian's arm
+close to the iron wristlet, breaking the bone with his foot. Then they
+led back the captive and tumbled him into the boat, with the hand of
+his comrade dangling at the end of the chain. The incident had excited
+the soldiers, and they kicked and pounded the prisoners. A crowd
+gathered about the body on the wharf, the bolder ones snatching at his
+beads and wampum belt.
+
+Menard raised his eyes to the lands across the river and to the white
+cloud-puffs above. After months of camp and canoe, sleeping in snow
+and rain, and by day paddling, poling, and wading,--never a new face
+among the grumbling soldiers or the stolid prisoners,--after this,
+Quebec stood for luxury and the pleasant demoralization of good
+living. He liked the noise of passing feet, the hail of goodwill from
+door to door, the plodding shopkeepers and artisans, the comfortable
+priests in brown and gray.
+
+The sound of oars brought his eyes again to the river. The two boats
+with their loads of redskins were passing the merchantmen that lay
+between the men-of-war and the city. On the wharf, awaiting a second
+trip, was a huddled group of prisoners. Menard's face clouded as he
+watched them. Men of his experience were wondering what effect this
+new plan of the Governor's would have upon the Iroquois. Capturing a
+hunting party by treachery and shipping them off to the King's galleys
+was a bold stroke,--too bold, perhaps. Governor Frontenac would never
+have done this; he knew the Iroquois temper too well. Governor la
+Barre, for all his bluster, would not have dared. It was certain that
+this new governor, Denonville, was not a coward; but as Menard
+reflected, going back over his own fifteen years of frontier life, he
+knew that this policy of brute force would be sorely tested by the
+tact and intrigue of the Five Nations. His own part in the capture
+little disturbed him. He had obeyed orders. He had brought the band to
+the citadel at Quebec without losing a man (saving the poor devil who
+had strangled himself with his own thongs at La Gallette).
+
+To such men as Menard, whose lives were woven closely into the fabric
+of New France, the present condition was clear. Many an evening he had
+spent with Major d'Orvilliers, at Fort Frontenac, in talking over the
+recent years of history into which their two names and their two lives
+had gone so deeply. Until his recall to France in 1682, Governor
+Frontenac had been for ten years building up in the Iroquois heart a
+fear and awe of Onontio, the Great Father, at Quebec. D'Orvilliers
+knew that period the better, for Menard had not come over (from the
+little town of his birth, in Picardy) until Frontenac's policy was
+well established. But Menard had lived hard and rapidly during his
+first years in the province, and he was a stern-faced young soldier
+when he stood on the wharf, hat in hand and sword to chin, watching
+New France's greatest governor sitting erect in the boat that bore him
+away from his own. Menard had been initiated by a long captivity among
+the Onondagas, and had won his first commission by gallant action
+under the Governor's eye.
+
+In those days no insult went unpunished; no tribe failed twice in its
+obligations. The circle of French influence was firmly extended around
+the haunts of the Iroquois in New York and along the Ohio. From
+Frontenac, on Lake Ontario, north to Hudson's Bay, was French land. To
+the westward, along the Ottawa River, and skirting the north shore of
+Lake Huron to Michillimackinac and Green Bay, were the strong French
+allies, the Hurons, Ottawas, Nipissings, Kiskagons, Sacs, Foxes, and
+Mascoutins. Down at the lower end of Lake Michigan, at the Chicagou
+and St. Joseph portages, were the Miamis; and farther still, the
+Illinois, whom the Sieur de la Salle and Henri de Tonty had drawn
+close under the arm of New France.
+
+This chain of allies, with Du Luth's fort at Detroit and a partial
+control over Niagara, had given New France nearly all the fur trade of
+the Great Lakes. The English Governor Dongan, of New York, dared not
+to fight openly for it, but he armed the Iroquois and set them against
+the French. Menard had laughed when the word came, in 1684, from
+Father de Lamberville, whose influence worked so far toward keeping
+the Iroquois quiet, that Dongan had pompously set up the arms of his
+king in each Iroquois village, even dating them back a year to make
+his claim the more secure. Every old soldier knew that more than
+decrees and coats of arms were needed to win the Five Nations.
+
+When La Barre succeeded Frontenac, lacking the tact and firmness which
+had established Frontenac's name among foes and allies alike, he fell
+back upon bluster (to say nothing of the common talk in Quebec that he
+had set out to build up his private fortune by the fur trade).
+Learning that, by his grant of Fort Frontenac, La Salle was entitled
+to a third of the trade that passed through it, he seized the fort. He
+weakened La Salle's communications so greatly that La Salle and Tonty
+could not make good their promises of French protection to the
+Illinois. This made it possible for the Iroquois, unhindered, to lay
+waste the Illinois country. By equally shortsighted methods, La Barre
+so weakened the ties that bound the northern allies, and so increased
+the arrogance of the Iroquois, that when Governor Denonville took up
+the task, most of the allies, always looking to the stronger party,
+were on the point of going over to the Iroquois. This would give the
+fur trade to the English, and ruin New France. Governor Dongan seized
+the moment to promise better bargains for the peltry than the French
+could offer. It remained for the new governor to make a demonstration
+which would establish firmly the drooping prestige of New France.
+
+Now the spring of 1687 was just ending. Since February it had been
+spread abroad, from the gulf seignories to Fort Frontenac, that
+preparations were making for a great campaign against the Iroquois.
+Champigny, the new Intendant, had scoured the country for supplies,
+and now was building bateaux and buying canoes. Regulars and militia
+were drilling into the semblance of an army, and palisades and
+defences were everywhere built or strengthened, that the home guard
+might keep the province secure during the long absence of the troops.
+Menard wondered, as he snapped bits of stone off the parapet, and
+watched the last boatload of galley slaves embarking at the wharf,
+whether the Governor's plans would carry. He would undoubtedly act
+with precision, he would follow every detail of campaigning to the
+delight of the tacticians, he would make a great splash,--and then?
+How about the wily chiefs of the Senecas and Onondagas and Mohawks?
+They had hoodwinked La Barre into signing the meanest treaty that ever
+disgraced New France. Would Denonville, too, blind himself to the
+truth that shrewd minds may work behind painted faces?
+
+But above all else, Menard was a soldier. He snapped another bit of
+stone, and gave up the problem. He would fight at the Governor's
+orders, retreat at the Governor's command,--to the Governor would
+belong the credit or the blame. Of only one thing was he sure,--his
+own half hundred men should fight as they had always fought, and
+should hold their posts to the end. There ended his responsibility.
+And did not the good Fathers say that God was watching over New
+France?
+
+Meantime the breath of summer was in the air. The spring campaign was
+over for Menard. So he rested both elbows on the parapet, and wondered
+how long the leaves had been out in Picardy. Over beyond the ships and
+the river were waves of the newest green, instead of the deep, rich
+colour and the bloom of full life he had left behind at Fort Frontenac
+but two weeks back. The long journey down the St. Lawrence had seemed
+almost a descent into winter. On the way to Quebec every day and every
+league had brought fewer blossoms. Even Montreal, sixty leagues to the
+south, had her summer before Quebec.
+
+On the wharf below him the crowd were still plucking the dead Indian.
+Menard could hear their laughter and shouts. Their figures were small
+in the distance, their actions grotesque. One man was dancing,
+brandishing some part of the Indian's costume. Menard could not
+distinguish the object in his hand. A priest crossed the wharf and
+elbowed into the crowd. For the moment he was lost in the rabble, but
+shortly the shouting quieted and the lightheaded fellows crowded into
+a close group. Probably the priest was addressing them. Soon the
+fringe of the crowd thinned, then the others walked quietly away. When
+at last the priest was left alone by the mutilated Indian, he knelt,
+and for a space was motionless.
+
+The idleness of reaction was on Menard. He leaned on the parapet,
+hardly stirring, while the priest went on his way across the square
+and began toiling up the steps. When he was halfway up, Menard
+recognized him for Claude de Casson, an old Jesuit of the Iroquois
+mission at Sault St. Francis Xavier, near Montreal. Menard strolled
+through the citadel to the square, and, meeting the Father, walked
+with him.
+
+"Well, Father Claude, you are a long way from your flock."
+
+"Yes, Captain Menard, I came with the relations. I have been"--Father
+Claude was blown from his climb, and he paused, wiping the sweat from
+his lean face--"I have been grieved by a spectacle in the Lower Town.
+Some wretches had killed an Onondaga with the brutality of his own
+tribe, and were robbing him. Are such acts permitted to-day in Quebec,
+M'sieu?"
+
+"He was a prisoner escaping from the soldiers. It must be a full year
+since I last saw you, Father. I hope you bring a good record to the
+College."
+
+"The best since our founding, M'sieu."
+
+"Is there no word in the relations from the New York missions?"
+
+"Yes, M'sieu. Brother de Lamberville brings glorious word from the
+Mohawks. Twenty-three complete conversions."
+
+"You say he brings this word?" Menard's brows came together. "Then he
+has come up to Montreal?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"It is true, then, that the Iroquois have word of our plans?"
+
+"It would seem so. He said that a war party which started weeks ago
+for the Illinois country had been recalled. A messenger was sent out
+but a few days before he came away."
+
+Menard slowly shook his head.
+
+"This word should go to the Commandant," he said. "How about your
+Indians at the Mission, Father Claude? They have not French hearts."
+
+"Ah, but I am certain, M'sieu, they would not break faith with us."
+
+"You can trust them?"
+
+"They are Christians, M'sieu."
+
+"Yes, but they are Iroquois. Have none of them gone away since this
+news reached Quebec?"
+
+"None, save one poor wretch whose drunkenness long ago caused us to
+give up hope, though I--"
+
+"What became of him? Where did he go?"
+
+"He wandered away in a drunken fit."
+
+"And you have not heard from him since?"
+
+"No, M'sieu. He was Teganouan, an Onondaga."
+
+"You would do well, Father, if I may suggest, to take what news you
+may have to the Commandant. You and I know the importance of trifles
+at such a time as this. How long do you remain in Quebec?"
+
+"A few days only, unless there should be work for me here."
+
+"Do you return then to Montreal?"
+
+"I cannot say until I have made my report and delivered the relations.
+Brother de Lamberville thinks it important that word should go to all
+those who are now labouring in the Iroquois villages. If they remain
+after the campaign is fairly started, their lives may be in danger."
+
+"You think it necessary to go yourself?"
+
+"What else, M'sieu? This is not the time to trust too freely an Indian
+runner. And a layman might never get through alive. My habit would be
+the best safeguard."
+
+"I suppose you are right. If I should not see you again, I must ask
+you to convey my respect to your colleagues at the Mission. I shall
+probably be here until the campaign is fairly started; perhaps longer.
+Already I am tasting the luxury of idleness."
+
+"A dangerous luxury, M'sieu. If I might be permitted to advise--"
+
+"Yes, yes, Father,--I know, I know. But what is the use? You are a
+priest, I am a soldier. Yours is penance, mine is fighting; yours is
+praying, mine is singing,--every man to his own. And when you priests
+have got your pagans converted, we soldiers will clean up the mess
+with our muskets. And now, Father, good day, and may God be with
+you."
+
+The priest's face was unmoved as he looked after the retreating
+figure. He had watched Menard grow from a roistering lieutenant into a
+rigid captain, and he knew his temper too well to mind the flicks of
+banter. But before the soldier had passed from earshot, he called
+after him.
+
+Menard turned back. "What now, good Father? A mass for my soul, or a
+last absolution before I plunge into my term of dissolute idleness?"
+
+"Neither, my son," replied the priest, smiling. "Is any of your
+idleness to be shared with another?"
+
+"Certainly, Father."
+
+"I am bringing a picture to the College."
+
+"I have no money, Father. I should be a sorry patron."
+
+"No, no, M'sieu; it is not a patron I seek. It is the advice of one
+who has seen and judged the master work of Paris. The painting has
+been shown to none as yet."
+
+"But you have seen it?"
+
+"Yes, yes, I have seen it. Come with me, M'sieu; it is at my room."
+
+They walked together to the cell, six feet long by five wide, where
+Father Claude slept when in Quebec. It was bare of all save a hard
+cot. A bale, packed in rough cloth and tied with rope, lay on the bed.
+Father Claude opened the bundle, while Menard leaned against the wall,
+and drew out his few personal belongings and his portable altar before
+he reached the flat, square package at the bottom. There was a touch
+of colour in his cheeks and a nervousness in the movement of his hands
+as he untied the flaxen strings, stripped off the cloth, and held the
+picture up to Menard's view.
+
+It was a full-length portrait in oil of a young Indian woman, holding
+a small cross in her right hand, and gazing at it with bent head. Her
+left hand was spread upon her breast. She wore a calico chemise
+reaching below her knees, and leggings, and moccasins. A heavy robe
+was thrown over the top of her head, falling on the sides and back to
+within a foot of the ground. In the middle background was a stream,
+with four Indians in a canoe. A tiny stone chapel stood on the bank at
+the extreme right.
+
+Father Claude's hand trembled as he supported the canvas upon the cot,
+and his eyes wavered from Menard to the picture, and back again.
+
+"It is not altogether completed," he said, nervously. "Of course the
+detail will be worked out more fully, and the cross should be given a
+warmer radiance. Perhaps a light showing through the windows of the
+chapel--"
+
+"Who is it?" asked Menard.
+
+"It is Catherine Outasoren, the Lily of the Onondagas," replied the
+priest; "the noblest woman that ever rose from the depths of Indian
+superstition."
+
+Menard's eyes rested on an obscure signature in a lower corner, "C. de
+C."
+
+"You certainly have reason to be proud of the work. But may I ask
+about the perspective? Should the maiden appear larger than the
+chapel?"
+
+The priest gazed at the painting with an unsettled expression.
+
+"Yes," he said, "perhaps you are right, M'sieu. At any rate I will
+give the matter thought and prayer."
+
+"And the Indians," Menard questioned, "in the canoe; are they coming
+toward the chapel or going away from it? It seems to me that any doubt
+on that point should be removed."
+
+"Ah," said the priest; "that very doubt is allegorical. It typifies
+the workings of the human mind when first confronted by the truth.
+When the seeker first beholds the light, as shown through the devotion
+of such a woman as Catherine Outasoren, there arises in his mind--"
+
+"Very true, very true! But I never yet have seen a canoe-load of
+Indians in doubt whether they were moving forward or backward."
+
+Father Claude held the canvas at arm's length and gazed long at it.
+
+"Tell me, M'sieu," he said at last, "do you think it deserving of a
+place in the College?"
+
+"I do not see why not."
+
+"And you think I would be justified in laying a request before the
+Superior?"
+
+Menard shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"That is your decision, Father."
+
+"I never can fully thank you, my son, for your kindness in looking on
+my humble work. I will not decide to-day. First I must add foliage in
+the foreground. And I will give it my earnest prayer."
+
+Menard said farewell and went out, leaving the priest gazing at the
+picture. He strolled back toward the citadel, stopping now and then to
+greet an old friend or a chance acquaintance. When he arrived at the
+headquarters in the citadel he found Danton, a brown-haired young
+lieutenant of engineers, gazing at a heap of plans and other papers on
+the table.
+
+"Well, Captain Menard," was his greeting, "I'd give half of last
+year's pay, if I ever get it, to feel as lazy as you look."
+
+"You are lazy enough," growled Menard.
+
+"That begs the question. It is not how lazy a man is, but how lazy he
+gets a chance to be."
+
+"If you'd been through what I have this spring, you'd deserve a
+rest."
+
+"You must have had a stirring time," said the Lieutenant. "Major
+Provost has promised to let me go out with the line when the campaign
+starts. I've not had a brush since I came over."
+
+Menard gave him a quizzical smile before he replied, "You'll get
+brushes enough."
+
+"By the way, the Major wants to see you."
+
+"Does he?" said Menard.
+
+He lighted his short pipe with a coal from the fire and walked out.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II.
+
+THE MAID.
+
+
+Menard did not go at once to see Major Provost, the Commandant. He had
+already handed in his report at the citadel. It was probable that this
+was some new work for him. He had just settled his mind to the
+prospect of a rest, the first since that mad holiday, seven years
+before, when word had come that his lieutenant's commission was on the
+way. That was at Three Rivers. He wanted to idle, to waste a few weeks
+for the sheer delight of extravagance, but his blood did not flow more
+quickly at the wish. He was an older man by a score of years--or was
+it only seven?
+
+He lingered on the square. The black-eyed children, mostly dirty and
+ragged (for the maids whom the King had sent over by shiploads to his
+colonists had not developed into the most diligent and neat
+housewives) tumbled about his feet. He allowed himself to be drawn
+into their play. They had no awe of his uniform, for it was worn and
+frayed. He had not yet taken the trouble to get out his fresher coat
+and breeches and boots. He thought of this, and was again amused. It
+was another sign of age. The time had been when his first care after
+arriving in Quebec was to don his rich house uniform and polished
+scabbard, and step gaily to the Major's house to sun himself in the
+welcome of the Major's pretty wife, who had known his uncle, the Sieur
+de Vauban, at La Rochelle. Now he was back in Quebec from months on
+the frontier, he was summoned to the Major's house, and yet he stayed
+and laughed at the children. For the Major's wife was older, too, and
+the vivacity of her youth was thinning out and uncovering the
+needle-like tongue beneath. A slim little urchin was squirming between
+his boots, with a pursuing rabble close behind, and the Captain had to
+take hold of a young tree to keep his feet. He turned and started in
+pursuit of the children, but caught sight of two Ursuline sisters
+entering the square, and straightened himself. After all, a captain is
+a captain, even though the intoxication of spring be in him, and his
+heart struggling to clamber back into the land of youth. He walked on
+across the square and down the street to the Major's house.
+
+Major Provost welcomed Menard heartily, and led him to his office.
+"We'll have our business first," he said, "and get it done with."
+
+Menard settled back in the carved oak chair which had for generations
+been a member of the Major's family. The light mood had left him. Now
+he was the soldier, brusque in manner, with lines about his mouth
+which, to certain men, gave his face a hard expression.
+
+"First let me ask you, Menard, what are your plans?"
+
+"For the present?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"I have none."
+
+"Your personal affairs, I mean. Have you any matters to hold your
+attention here for the next few weeks?"
+
+"None."
+
+Major Provost fingered his quill.
+
+"I don't know, of course, how your own feelings stand, Menard. You've
+been worked hard for three years, and I suppose you want rest. But
+somebody must go to Fort Frontenac, and the Governor thinks you are
+the man."
+
+Menard made a gesture of impatience.
+
+"There are a dozen men here with little to do."
+
+"I know it. But this matter is of some importance, and it may call for
+delicate work before you are through with it. It isn't much in
+itself,--merely to bear orders to d'Orvilliers,--but the Governor
+thinks that the right man may be able to do strong work before the
+campaign opens. You probably know that we are to move against the
+Senecas alone, and that we must treat with the other nations to keep
+them from aiding the Senecas. No one can say just how this can be
+done. Even Father de Lamberville has come back, you know, from the
+Mohawks; but the Governor thinks that if we send a good man, he may be
+able to see a way, once he gets on the ground, and can advise with
+d'Orvilliers. Now, you are a good man, Menard; and you can influence
+the Indians if anyone can."
+
+"You are a little vague, Major."
+
+"You will go to Frontenac in advance of the army to prepare the way.
+La Durantaye and Du Luth are already at Detroit, awaiting orders, with
+close to two hundred Frenchmen and four hundred Indians. And Tonty
+should have joined them before now with several hundred Illinois."
+
+"I don't believe he'll bring many Illinois. They must have known of
+the Iroquois war party that started toward their villages. They will
+stay to defend their own country. They may not know that the Iroquois
+party was recalled."
+
+"Recalled?" said the Major.
+
+"Yes. Father de Casson has the news from Father de Lamberville. You
+see what that means. The Iroquois have been warned."
+
+"I was afraid of it. These new governors, Menard--each has to learn
+his lesson from the beginning of the book. Why will they not take
+counsel from the men who know the Indians? This campaign has been
+heralded as broadly as a trading fair."
+
+"When should I start?" asked Menard, abruptly.
+
+"At once--within a few days." Major Provost looked at the other's set
+face. "I am sorry about this, Menard. But you understand, I am sure.
+Perhaps I had better give you an idea of our plans. You know, of
+course, that we have three ships fitting out at Frontenac. Already our
+force is being got together at St. Helen's Island, by Montreal.
+Champigny is engaging canoemen and working out a transport and supply
+system between Montreal and Frontenac. The force will proceed to
+Frontenac, and embark from there in the ships, bateaux, and canoes."
+
+"Is the rendezvous at Niagara?"
+
+"No, at La Famine, on the southern shore of Lake Ontario."
+
+Menard nodded. He knew the place; for by nearly starving there, years
+before, with the others of Governor la Barre's ill-starred expedition,
+he had contributed to giving the spot a name.
+
+"La Durantaye and Du Luth, with Tonty, are to meet us there. You will
+instruct them to move on to Niagara, and there await further orders.
+We shall sail around the east end of the lake and along the south
+shore."
+
+"The Iroquois will follow your movements."
+
+"We intend that they shall. They will not know where our final landing
+place will be, and will have to keep their forces well in hand. And it
+will prevent them from uniting to attack Niagara."
+
+"What then?"
+
+"We will leave a strong guard at La Famine with the stores, and strike
+inland for the Seneca villages."
+
+"And now what part am I to play in this?"
+
+Major Provost leaned back in his chair.
+
+"You, Menard, are to represent the Governor. You will move in advance
+of the troops. At Frontenac it will be your duty to see first that the
+way is clear to getting the two divisions to the meeting place at La
+Famine, and to see that d'Orvilliers has the fort ready for the
+troops, with extra cabins and stockades. Then the Governor wishes you
+and d'Orvilliers to go over all the information the scouts bring in.
+If you can decide upon any course which will hold back the other
+tribes from aiding the Senecas, act upon it at once, without orders.
+In other words, you have full liberty to follow your judgment. That
+ought to be responsibility enough."
+
+Menard stretched his arms. "All right, Major. But when my day comes to
+taste the delights of Quebec, I hope I may not be too old to enjoy
+it."
+
+"The Governor honours you, Menard, with this undertaking."
+
+"He honoured De Sévigné with a majority and turned him loose in
+Quebec."
+
+"Too bad, Menard, too bad," the Major laughed. "Now I, who ask nothing
+better than a brisk campaign, must rot here in Quebec until I die."
+
+"Are you not to go?"
+
+"No. I am to stay behind and brighten my lonely moments drilling the
+rabble of a home guard. Do you think you will need an escort?"
+
+"No; the river from here to Frontenac is in use every day. I shall
+want canoemen. Two will be enough."
+
+"Very well. Let me know what supplies you need. You mistake, man, in
+grumbling at the work. You are building up a reputation that never
+could live at short range. Stay away long enough and you will be a
+more popular man than the Governor. I envy you, on my honour, I do."
+
+"One thing more, Major. This galley affair; what do you think of it?"
+
+"You mean the capture at Frontenac? You should know better than I,
+Menard. You brought the prisoners down."
+
+"There is no doubt in my mind, Major, nor in d'Orvilliers's! We obeyed
+orders." Menard looked up expressively. "You know the Iroquois. You
+know how they will take it. The worst fault was La Grange's. He
+captured the party--and it was not a war party--by deliberate
+treachery. D'Orvilliers had intrusted to him the Governor's orders
+that Indians must be got for the King's galleys. As you know,
+d'Orvilliers and I both protested. I did not bring them here until the
+Governor commanded it."
+
+"Well, we can't help that now, Menard."
+
+"That is not the question. You ask me to keep the Onondagas out of
+this fight, after we have taken a hundred of their warriors in this
+way."
+
+"I know it, Menard; I know it. But the Governor's orders--Well, I have
+nothing to say. You can only do your best."
+
+They went to the reception room, where Madame de Provost awaited them.
+Menard was made to stay and dine, in order that Madame could draw from
+him a long account of his latest adventures on the frontier. Madame de
+Provost, though she had lived a dozen years in the province, had never
+been farther from Quebec than the Seignory of the Marquis de St.
+Denis, half a dozen leagues below the city. The stories that came to
+her ears of massacres and battles, of settlers butchered in the
+fields, and of the dashing adventures of La Salle and Du Luth, were to
+her no more than wild tales from a far-away land. So she chattered
+through the long dinner; and for the first time since he had reached
+the city, Menard wished himself back on Lake Ontario, where there were
+no women.
+
+Menard returned to the citadel early in the evening. Lieutenant Danton
+was drawing plans for a redoubt, but he leaned back as Menard
+entered.
+
+"I began to think you were not coming back, Captain," he said. "I'm
+told the Major says that you are the only man in New France who could
+have got that trading agreement from the Onondagas last year. How did
+you do it?"
+
+"How does a man usually do what he is told to do?" Menard sat on a
+corner of the long table and looked lazily at the boy.
+
+"That wasn't the kind of treaty our Governors make; you know it
+wasn't."
+
+"You were not here under Frontenac."
+
+"No. I wish I had been. He must have been a great orator. My father
+has told me about the long council at Montreal. He said that Frontenac
+out-talked the greatest of the Mohawk orators. Did you learn it from
+him?"
+
+"My boy, when you are through with your pretty pictures," Menard
+motioned toward the plans, "and have got out into the real work; when
+you've spent months in Iroquois lodges; when you've been burned and
+shot and starved,--then it will be a pity if you haven't learned to be
+a soldier. What is this little thing you are drawing?"
+
+Danton flushed. "You may laugh at the engineers," he said, "but where
+would King Louis be now if--"
+
+"Tut, my boy, tut!"
+
+"That is very well--"
+
+Menard laughed. "How old are you, Danton?" he asked.
+
+"Twenty-two."
+
+"Very good. You have got on well. I dare say you've learned a deal out
+of your books. Now we have you out here in the provinces, where the
+hard work is done. Well send you back in a few years a real man. And
+then you'll step smartly among the pretty officers of the King, and
+when one speaks of New France you'll lift your brows and say: 'New
+France? Ah, yes. That is in America. I was there once. Rather a
+primitive life--no court, no army.' Ah, ha, my boy--no, never mind.
+Come up to my quarters and have a sip of real old Burgundy."
+
+"Are you ever serious, Menard?" asked Danton, sitting on the Captain's
+cot and smacking his lips over the liquor.
+
+Menard smiled. "I'm afraid I shall have to play at composure for an
+hour," he said. "I must see Father Claude. Settle yourself here, if
+you like."
+
+Menard hurried away, for it was growing late. He found the Jesuit
+meditating in his cell.
+
+"Ah, Captain Menard, I am glad to see you so soon again."
+
+Menard sat on the narrow bed and stretched out his legs as far as he
+could in the cramped space.
+
+"How soon will your duties be over here, Father?"
+
+"There seems to be no reason for me to stay. I have delivered the
+relations, and no further work has come to hand."
+
+"Then it may be that you can help me, Father."
+
+"You know, my son, that I will."
+
+"Very well. I have been ordered to Fort Frontenac in advance of the
+troops. I am to bear orders to d'Orvilliers and to Du Luth and La
+Durantaye. It is possible that there may be some delicate work to be
+done among the Indians. You know the Iroquois, Father, and our two
+heads together should be stronger than mine alone. I want you to go
+with me."
+
+The priest's eyes lighted.
+
+"It may be that I can get permission at Montreal."
+
+"You will go, then?"
+
+"Gladly. It is to be no one else--we two--"
+
+"We shall have canoemen. To my mind, the fewer the better."
+
+"Still, Captain, you cannot depend on the canoemen. Would it not be
+well to have one other man? You might need a messenger."
+
+Menard thought for a moment.
+
+"True, Father. And if I am to have a man, he had best be an officer;
+yes, a man who could execute orders. I'll take Danton. You will be
+ready for a start, Father, probably to-morrow?"
+
+"At any time, my son."
+
+"Good night."
+
+There was little work to be done in preparing for the journey (Major
+Provost would attend to the supplies and to engaging the canoemen),
+and Menard still was in the lazy mood. He stood for a while at the
+edge of the cliff and looked down at the wharf. It was dark, and he
+could not see whether the body of the Indian had been removed. The
+incident of the afternoon had been gathering importance to his mind
+the longer he thought of it. Five years earlier Menard had been
+captured by the Onondagas during a fight near Fort Frontenac. They had
+taken him to one of their villages, south of Lake Ontario, and for
+days had tortured him and starved him. They had drawn out cords from
+his arms and legs and thrust sticks between them and the flesh. His
+back was still covered with scars from the burning slivers which they
+had stuck through the skin. They had torn the nails from his left hand
+with their teeth. Then Otreouati, the Big Throat, the chief who had
+led his followers to believe in Frontenac, came back from a parley
+with another tribe, and taking a liking to the tall young soldier who
+bore the torture without flinching, he adopted him into his own
+family. Menard had lived with the Indians, a captive only in name, and
+had earned the name of the Big Buffalo by his skill in the hunt. At
+last, when they had released him, it was under a compact of
+friendship, that had never since been broken. It had stood many tests.
+Even during open campaigns they had singled him out from the other
+Frenchmen as their brother. He wondered whether they knew of his part
+in stocking the King's galleys. Probably they did.
+
+It was late when Menard took a last sweeping look at the river and
+walked up to the citadel. His day of idleness was over. After all, it
+had not been altogether a wasted day. But it was the longest holiday
+he was likely to have for months to come. Having made up his mind to
+accept the facts, he stretched out on his bed and went to sleep.
+
+Danton took the news that he was to be a member of the party with
+enthusiasm. Menard had hardly finished telling him when he swept the
+tiresome plans and specifications into a heap at the end of the table,
+and rushed out to get a musket (for a sword would have no place in the
+work before them). The start was to be made at noon, but Danton was on
+the ground so early as almost to lower his dignity in the eyes of the
+bronzed canoemen. He wore his bravest uniform, with polished belt and
+buttons and new lace at the neck. His broad hat had a long curling
+feather. He wore the new musket slung rakishly over his shoulder.
+
+About the middle of the forenoon, as Menard was looking over his
+orders, memorizing them in case of accident to the papers, he was
+found by Major Provost's orderly, who said that the Commandant wished
+to see him at once.
+
+The Major was busy with the engineers in another room, but he left
+them.
+
+"Menard," he said abruptly, "I've got to ask you to do me a favour. If
+I could see any way out of it--"
+
+"I will do anything I can."
+
+"Thank you. I suppose you know the Marquis de St. Denis?"
+
+"Slightly."
+
+"Well, I shan't take time to give you the whole story. St. Denis has
+the seignory six leagues to the east. You may know that he went into
+debt to invest in La Salle's colonizing scheme in Louisiana. St. Denis
+was in France at the time, and had great faith in La Salle. Of course,
+now that La Salle has not been heard from, and the debts are all past
+due without even a rumour of success to make them good--you can
+imagine the rest. The seignory has been seized. St. Denis has
+nothing."
+
+"Has he a family?" asked Menard.
+
+"A daughter. His wife is dead. He came here after you left last night,
+and again this morning. We are old friends, and I have been trying to
+help him. He is going to sail to-day on _Le Fourgon_ for Paris to see
+what he can save from the wreck. My house is crowded with the officers
+who are here planning the campaign; but St. Denis has a cousin living
+at Frontenac, Captain la Grange, and we've got to get Valerie there
+somehow. Do you think it will be safe?"
+
+"It's a hard trip, you know; but it's safe enough."
+
+"I shan't forget your kindness, Menard. The girl is a spirited little
+thing, and she takes it hard. Madame has set her heart on getting her
+to La Grange. I don't know all the details myself."
+
+"I think we can arrange it, Major. We start in an hour."
+
+"She will be there. You are a splendid fellow, Menard. Good-bye."
+
+Menard's face was less amiable once he was away from the house. He
+knew from experience the disagreeable task that lay before him. But
+there was nothing to be said, so he went to his quarters and took a
+last look at the orders. Then taking off his coat and his rough shirt,
+he placed the papers carefully in a buckskin bag, which he hung about
+his neck.
+
+Everything was ready at the wharf. The long canoe lay waiting, a
+_voyageur_ at each end. The bales were stowed carefully in the centre.
+Father de Casson met Menard at the upper end of the dock. He had come
+down by way of the winding road, for his bundle was heavy, and he knew
+no way but to carry it himself. Menard good-naturedly gave him a hand
+as they crossed the dock. When they had set it down, and Menard
+straightened up, his eyes twinkled, for young Danton, in his finery,
+was nervously walking back and forth at the edge of the dock, looking
+fixedly into the canoe, apparently inspecting the bales. His shoulders
+were unused to the musket, and by a quick turn he had brought the
+muzzle under the rim of his hat, setting it on the side of his head.
+His face was red.
+
+Sitting on a bundle, a rod away, was a girl, perhaps eighteen or
+nineteen years old, wearing a simple travelling dress. Her hands were
+clasped tightly in her lap, and she gazed steadily out over the water
+with an air that would have been haughty save for the slight upward
+tip of her nose.
+
+[Illustration: "Sitting on a bundle was, a girl, perhaps eighteen or
+nineteen years old."]
+
+Menard's eyes sobered, and he handed his musket to one of the
+canoemen. Then he crossed over to where the maiden was sitting.
+
+"Mademoiselle St. Denis?"
+
+The girl looked up at him. Her eyes seemed to take in the dinginess of
+his uniform. She inclined her head.
+
+"I am Captain Menard. Major Provost tells me that I am to have the
+honour of escorting you to Fort Frontenac. With your permission we
+will start. Father Claude de Casson is to go with us, and Lieutenant
+Danton."
+
+The bundle was placed in the canoe. Menard helped the girl to a seat
+near the middle: from the way she stepped in and took her seat he saw
+that she had been on the river before. Danton, with his Parisian airs,
+had to be helped in carefully. Then they were off, each of the four
+men swinging a paddle, though Danton managed his awkwardly at first.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+MADEMOISELLE EATS HER BREAKFAST.
+
+
+The sun hung low over the western woods when Menard, at the close of
+the second day, headed the canoe shoreward. The great river swept by
+with hardly a surface motion, dimpling and rippling under the last
+touch of the day breeze. Menard's eyes rested on Father Claude, as the
+canoe drew into the shadow of the trees. The priest, stiff from the
+hours of sitting and kneeling, had taken up a paddle and was handling
+it deftly. He had rolled his sleeves up to the elbow, showing a thin
+forearm with wire-like muscles. The two _voyageurs_, at bow and stern,
+were proving to be quiet enough fellows. Guerin, the younger, wore a
+boyish, half-confiding look. His fellow, Perrot, was an older man.
+
+Menard felt, when he thought of Danton, a sense of pride in his own
+right judgment. The boy was taking hold with a strong, if unguided,
+hand. Already the feather was gone from his hat, the lace from his
+throat. Two days in the canoe and a night on the ground had stained
+and wrinkled his uniform,--a condition of which, with his quick
+adaptability, he was already beginning to feel proud. He had flushed
+often, during the first day, under the shrewd glances of the
+_voyageurs_, who read the inexperience in his bright clothes and white
+hands. Menard knew, from the way his shoulders followed the swing of
+his arms, that the steady paddling was laming him sadly. He would
+allow Danton five days more; at the week's end he must be a man, else
+the experiment had failed.
+
+The canoe scraped bottom under a wild growth of brush and outreaching
+trees. The forest was stirring with the rustle and call of birds, with
+the breath of the leaves and the far-away crackle and plunge of larger
+animals through the undergrowth. A chipmunk, with inquisitive eyes,
+sat on the root of a knotted oak, but he whisked away when Menard and
+the canoemen stepped into the shallow water. Overhead, showing little
+fear of the canoe and of the strangely clad animals within it,
+scampered a family of red squirrels, now nibbling a nut from the
+winter's store, now running and jumping from tree to tree, until only
+by the shaking of the twigs and the leaf-clusters could one follow
+their movements.
+
+The maid leaned an elbow on the bale which Danton had placed at her
+back, and rested her cheek on her hand. They were under the drooping
+branches of an elm that stood holding to the edge of the bank. Well
+out over the water sat one of the squirrels, his tail sweeping above
+his head, nibbling an acorn, and looking with hasty little glances at
+the canoe. She watched him, and memories came into her eyes. There had
+been squirrels on her father's seignory who would take nuts from her
+hand, burying them slyly under the bushes, and hurrying back for
+more.
+
+Danton came wading to the side of the canoe to help her to the bank,
+but she took his hand only to steady herself while rising. Stepping
+over the bracing-strips between the gunwales, she caught a swaying
+branch, and swung herself lightly ashore. Back from the water the
+ground rose into a low hill, covered with oak and elm and ragged
+hickory trees. Here, for a space, there was little undergrowth, and
+save under the heaviest of the trees the ground was green with short,
+coarse grass. Danton took a hatchet from the canoe, and trimmed a fir
+tree, heaping armfuls of green boughs at the foot of an oak near the
+top of the slope. Over these he threw a blanket. The maid came slowly
+up the hill, in response to his call, and with a weary little smile of
+thanks she sank upon the fragrant couch. She rested against the tree
+trunk, gazing through the nearer foliage at the rushing river.
+
+For the two days she had been like this,--silent, shy, with sad eyes.
+And Danton,--who could no more have avoided the company of such a maid
+than he could have left off eating or breathing or laughing,--Danton,
+for all his short Paris life (which should, Heaven knows, have given
+him a front with the maids), could do nothing but hang about, eager
+for a smile or a word, yet too young to know that he could better
+serve his case by leaving her with her thoughts, and with the
+boundless woods and the great lonely spaces of the river. Menard saw
+the comedy--as indeed, who of the party did not--and was amused. A few
+moments later he glanced again toward the oak. He was sharpening a
+knife, and could seem not to be observing. Danton was sitting a few
+yards from the maid, with the awkward air of a youth who doubts his
+welcome. She still looked out over the water. Menard saw that her face
+was white and drooping. He knew that she had not slept; for twice
+during the preceding night, as he lay in his blanket, he had heard
+from under the overturned canoe, where she lay, the low sound of her
+sobbing.
+
+Menard walked slowly down the slope, testing the knife-edge with his
+thumb, his short pipe between his teeth. He sheathed his knife,
+lowered his pipe, and called:--
+
+"Guerin." The two men, who were bringing wood to the fire, looked up.
+"Where has the Father gone?"
+
+Guerin pointed around the base of the hill. "He went to the woods,
+M'sieu."
+
+"With a bundle," added Perrot.
+
+Menard walked around the hill, and after a little searching found the
+priest, kneeling, in a clearing, before the portrait of Catharine
+Outasoren, which he had set against a tree. His brushes and paints
+were spread on the ground before him. He did not hear Menard
+approach.
+
+"Oh," said the captain, "you brought the picture!"
+
+The priest looked up over his shoulder, with a startled manner.
+
+"I myself have stripped down to the lightest necessaries," said
+Menard, with a significant glance at the portrait.
+
+The priest lowered his brush, and sat looking at the picture
+with troubled eyes. "I had no place for it," he said at last,
+hesitatingly.
+
+"They didn't take it at the College, eh?"
+
+Father Claude flushed.
+
+"They were very kind. They felt that perhaps it was not entirely
+completed, and that--"
+
+"You will leave it at Montreal, then, at the Mission?"
+
+"Yes,--I suppose so. Yes, I shall plan to leave it there."
+
+Menard leaned against a tree, and pressed the tobacco down in his
+pipe.
+
+"I have been doing some thinking in the last few minutes, Father. I've
+decided to make my first call on you for assistance."
+
+"Very well, Captain."
+
+"It is about the maid. Have you noticed?"
+
+"She seems of a sober mind."
+
+"Don't you see why? It is her father's losses, and this journey. She
+is taking it very hard. She is afraid, Father, all the time; and she
+neither sleeps nor eats."
+
+"It is naturally hard for such a child as she is to take this journey.
+She has had no experience,--she does not comprehend the easy customs
+and the hard travelling of the frontier. I think that in time--"
+
+Menard was puffing impatiently.
+
+"Father," he said, "do you remember when Major Gordeau was killed, and
+I was detailed to bring his wife and daughter down to Three Rivers? It
+was much like this. They fretted and could not sleep, and the coarse
+fare of the road was beneath their appetites. Do you remember? And
+when it came to taking the rapids, with the same days of hard work
+that lie before us now, they were too weak, and they sickened, the
+mother first, then the daughter. When I think of that, Father, of the
+last week of that journey, and of how I swore never again to take a
+woman in my care on the river, I--well, there is no use in going over
+it. If this goes on, we shall not get to Frontenac in time, that is
+all. And I cannot afford to take such a chance."
+
+The priest looked grave. The long struggle against the rapids from
+Montreal to La Gallette had tried the hardihood of more than one
+strong man.
+
+"It is probable, my son, that the sense of your responsibility makes
+you a little over-cautious. She is a strong enough child, I should
+say. Still, perhaps the food is not what she has been accustomed to. I
+have noticed that she eats little."
+
+"Perrot is too fond of grease," Menard said. "I must tell him to use
+less grease."
+
+"If she should be taken sick, we could leave her with someone at
+Montreal."
+
+"Leave her at Montreal!" exclaimed Menard. "When she breaks down, it
+will be in the rapids. And then I must either go on alone, or wait
+with you until she is strong enough to be carried. In any case it
+means confusion and delay. And I must not be delayed."
+
+"What have you in mind to do?"
+
+"We must find a way to brighten her spirits. It is homesickness that
+worries her, and sorrow for her father, and dread of what is before
+and around her. I'll warrant she has never been away from her home
+before. We must get her confidence,--devise ways to cheer her,
+brighten her."
+
+"I can reason with her, and--"
+
+"This is not the time for reasoning, Father. What we must do is to
+make her stop thinking, stop looking backward and forward. And there
+is Danton; he can help. He is of an age with her, and should succeed
+where you and I might fail."
+
+"He has not awaited the suggestion, Captain."
+
+"Yes, I know. But he must,--well, Father, it has all been said. The
+maid is on our hands, and must be got to Frontenac. That is all. And
+there is nothing for it but to rely on Danton to help."
+
+The priest looked at his brushes, and hesitated. "I am not certain,"
+he said, "she is very young. And Lieutenant Danton,--I have heard,
+while at Quebec,--"
+
+Menard laughed.
+
+"He is a boy, Father. These tales may be true enough. Why not? They
+would fit as well any idle lieutenant in Quebec, who is lucky
+enough to have an eye, and a pair of shoulders, and a bit of the
+King's gold in his purse. This maid is the daughter of a gentleman,
+Father; she is none of your Lower Town jades. And Danton may be young
+and foolish,--as may we all have been,--but he is a gentleman born."
+
+"Very well," replied the priest, looking with regret at the failing
+light, and beginning to gather his brushes. "I will counsel her, but I
+fear it will do little good. If the maid is sick at heart, and we
+attempt to guide her thoughts, we may but drive the trouble deeper in.
+It is the same with some of the Indian maidens, when they have left
+the tribe for the Mission. Now and again there comes a time, even with
+piety to strengthen them,--and this maid has little,--when the
+yearning seems to grow too strong to be cured. Sometimes they go back.
+One died. It was at Sault St. Francis in the year of the--"
+
+"Yes, yes," Menard broke in. "We have only one fact to remember; there
+must be no delay in carrying out the Governor's orders. We cannot
+change our plans because of this maid."
+
+"We must not let her understand, M'sieu."
+
+Menard had been standing, with a shoulder against the tree,
+alternately puffing at his pipe and lowering it, scowling meanwhile at
+the ground. Now he suddenly raised his head and chuckled.
+
+"It will be many a year since I have played the beau, Father. It may
+be that I have forgotten the rôle." He spread out his hands and looked
+at the twisted fingers. "But I can try, like a soldier. And there are
+three of us, Father Claude, there are three of us."
+
+He turned to go back to the camp, but the priest touched him.
+
+"My son,--perhaps, before you return, you would look again at my
+unworthy portrait. I--about the matter of the canoe--"
+
+"Oh," said Menard, "you've taken it out."
+
+"Yes; it seemed best, considering the danger that others might feel
+the same doubts which troubled you."
+
+"I wouldn't do that. The canoe was all right, once the direction were
+decided on."
+
+"Above all else, the true portrait should convey to the mind of the
+observer the impression that a single, an unmistakable purpose
+underlies the work. When one considers--"
+
+"Very true, Father, very true," said Menard abruptly, looking about at
+the beginning of the twilight. "And now we had better get back. The
+supper will be ready."
+
+Menard strode away toward the camp. Father Claude watched him for a
+time through the trees, then turned again to the picture. Finally he
+got together his materials, and carrying them in a fold of his gown,
+with the picture in his left hand, he followed Menard.
+
+The maid was leaning back against the tree, looking up at the sky,
+where the first red of the afterglow was spreading. She did not hear
+Menard; and he paused, a few yards away, to look at the clear
+whiteness of her skin and the full curve of her throat. Her figure and
+air, her habits of gesture and step, and carriage of the head, were
+those of the free-hearted maid of the seignory. They told of an
+outdoor life, of a good horse, and a light canoe, and the inbred love
+of trees and sky and running water. Here was none of the stiffness,
+the more than Parisian manner, of the maidens of Quebec. To stand
+there and look at her, unconscious as she was, pleased Menard.
+
+"Mademoiselle," he said, coming nearer, "will you join us at supper?"
+
+The maid looked at him with a slow blush (she was not yet accustomed
+to the right of these men to enter into the routine of her life).
+Menard reached to help her, but she rose easily.
+
+"Lieutenant Danton is not here?"
+
+"No, M'sieu, he walked away."
+
+They sat about a log. Danton had not strayed far, for he joined them
+shortly, wearing a sulky expression. Menard looked about the group.
+The maid was silent. Father Claude was beginning at once on the food
+before him. The twilight was growing deeper, and Guerin dragged a log
+to the fire, throwing it on the pile with a shower of sparks, and half
+a hundred shooting tongues of flame. The Captain looked again at
+Danton, and saw that the boy's glance shifted uneasily about the
+group. Altogether it was an unfortunate start for his plan. But it was
+clear that no other would break the ice, so he drew a long breath, and
+plunged doggedly into the story of his first fight on the St.
+Lawrence.
+
+It was a brave story of ambuscade and battle; and it was full of the
+dark of night and the red flash of muskets and the stealth and
+treachery of the Iroquois soul. When he reached the tale of the
+captured Mohawk, who sat against a tree with a ball in his lungs, to
+the last refusing the sacrament, and dying like a chief with the death
+song on his lips, Danton was leaning forward, breathless and eager,
+hanging on his words. The maid's eyes, too, were moist. Then they
+talked on, Danton asking boyish questions, and Father Claude starting
+over and again on a narrative of the wonderful conversion of the Huron
+drunkard, Heroukiki, who, in his zeal,--and here Menard always swept
+in with a new story, which left the priest adrift in the eddies of the
+conversation. At last, when they rose, and the dusk was settling over
+the trees, the maid was laughing with gentle good fellowship.
+
+While they were eating, the _voyageurs_ had brought the canoe a short
+way up the bank, resting it, bottom up, on large stones brought from
+the shore. Underneath was a soft cot of balsam; over the canoe were
+blankets, hanging on both sides to the ground. Then Mademoiselle said
+good-night, with a moment's lingering on the word, and a wistful note
+in her voice that brought perhaps more sympathy than had the sad eyes
+of the morning. For after all she was only a girl, and hers was a
+brave little heart.
+
+The three men lay on the slope with hardly a word, looking at the
+river, now shining like silver through the trees. This new turn in the
+life of the party was not as yet to be taken familiarly. Father Claude
+withdrew early to his meditations. Menard stretched out on his back,
+his hands behind his head, gazing lazily at the leaves overhead, now
+hanging motionless from the twigs.
+
+Danton was sitting up, looking about, and running the young reeds
+through his fingers.
+
+"Danton," Menard said, after a long silence, "I suppose you know that
+we have something of a problem on our hands."
+
+Danton looked over the river.
+
+"What have you thought about Mademoiselle?"
+
+"I don't understand."
+
+"Father Claude and I have been talking this evening about her. I have
+thought that she does not look any too strong for a hard journey of a
+hundred and more leagues."
+
+"She has little colour," said Danton, cautiously.
+
+"It seems to me, Danton, that you can help us."
+
+"How?"
+
+"What seems to you the cause of the trouble?"
+
+"With Mademoiselle? She takes little impression from the kindness of
+those about her."
+
+"Oh, come, Danton. You know better. Even a boy of your age should see
+deeper than that. You think she slights you; very likely she does.
+What of that? You are not here to be drawn into a boy-and-girl quarrel
+with a maid who chances to share our canoe. You are here as my aid, to
+make the shortest time possible between Quebec and Frontenac. If she
+were to fall sick, we should be delayed. Therefore she must not fall
+sick."
+
+Danton had plucked a weed, and now was pulling it to pieces, bit by
+bit.
+
+"What do you want me to do?"
+
+"Stop this moping, this hanging about. Take hold of the matter. Devise
+talks, diversions; fill her idle moments; I care not what you
+do,--within limits, my boy, within limits."
+
+"Oh," said Danton, "then you really want me to?"
+
+"Certainly. I am too old myself."
+
+Danton rose, and walked a few steps away and back.
+
+"But she will have none of me, Menard. It is, 'No, with thanks,' or,
+worse, a shake of the head. If I offer to help, if I try to talk, if
+I--oh, it is always the same. I am tired of it."
+
+Menard smiled in the dark.
+
+"Is that your reply to an order from your superior officer, Danton?"
+
+The boy stood silent for a moment, then he said, "I beg your pardon,
+Captain." And with a curious effort at stiffness he wandered off among
+the trees, and was soon out of Menard's sight.
+
+Menard walked slowly down to the fire, opened his pack, and spreading
+out his blanket, rolled himself in it with his feet close to the red
+embers. For a long time he lay awake. This episode took him back
+nearly a decade, to a time when he, like Danton, would have lost his
+poise at a glance from the nearest pair of eyes. That the maid should
+so interest him was in itself amusing. Had she been older or younger,
+had she been any but the timid, honest little woman that she was, he
+would have left her, without a second thought, in the care of the
+Commandant at Montreal, to be escorted through the rapids by some
+later party. But he had fixed his mind on getting her to Frontenac,
+and the question was settled. His last thought that night was of her
+quiet laughter and her friendly, hesitating "good-night."
+
+He was awakened in the half light before the sunrise by a step on the
+twigs. At a little distance through the trees was the maid, walking
+down toward the water. She slipped easily between the briers, holding
+her skirt close. From a spring, not a hundred yards up the hillside, a
+brook came tumbling to the river, picking its way under and over the
+stones and the fallen trees, and trickling over the bank with a low
+murmur. The maid stopped by a pool, and kneeling on a flat rock,
+dipped her hands.
+
+The others were asleep. A rod away lay Danton, a sprawling heap in his
+blanket. Menard rose, tossed his blanket upon his bundle, and walked
+slowly down toward the maid.
+
+"Mademoiselle, you rise with the birds."
+
+She looked around, and laughed gently. He saw that she had frankly
+accepted the first little change in their relations.
+
+"I like to be with the birds, M'sieu."
+
+Menard had no small talk. He was thinking of her evident lack of
+sleep.
+
+"It is the best hour for the river, Mademoiselle." The colours of the
+dawn were beginning to creep up beyond the eastern bank, sending a
+lance of red and gold into a low cloud bank, and a spread of soft
+crimson close after. "Perhaps you are fond of the fish?"
+
+The maid was kneeling to pick a cluster of yellow flower cups. She
+looked up and nodded, with a smile.
+
+"We fished at home, M'sieu."
+
+"We will go," said Menard, abruptly. "I will bring down the canoe."
+
+He threw the blankets to one side, and stooping under the long canoe,
+carried it on his shoulders to the water. A line and hook were in his
+bundle; the bait was ready at a turn of the grass and weeds.
+
+"We are two adventurers," he said lightly, as he tossed the line into
+the canoe, and held out one of the paddles. "You should do your share
+of the morning's work, Mademoiselle."
+
+She laughed again, and took the paddle. They pushed off; the maid
+kneeling at the bow, Menard in the stern. He guided the canoe against
+the current. The water lay flat under the still air, reflecting the
+gloomy trees on the banks, and the deepening colours of the sky. He
+fell into a lazy, swinging stroke, watching the maid. Her arms and
+shoulders moved easily, with the grace of one who had tumbled about a
+canoe from early childhood.
+
+"Ready, Mademoiselle?" He was heading for a deep pool near a line of
+rushes. The maid, laying down her paddle, reached back for the line,
+and put on the bait with her own fingers.
+
+Menard held the canoe steady against the current, which was there but
+a slow movement, while she lowered the hook over the bow. They sat
+without a word for some minutes. Once he spoke, in a bantering voice,
+and she motioned to him to be quiet. Her brows were drawn down close
+together.
+
+It was but a short time before she felt a jerk at the line. Her arms
+straightened out, and she pressed her lips tightly together. "Quick!"
+she said. "Go ahead!"
+
+"Can you hold it?" he asked, as he dipped his paddle.
+
+She nodded. "I wish the line were longer. It will be hard to give him
+any room." She wound the cord around her wrist. "Will the line hold,
+M'sieu?"
+
+"I think so. See if you can pull in."
+
+She leaned back, and pulled steadily, then shook her head. "Not very
+much. Perhaps, if you can get into the shallow water--"
+
+Menard slowly worked the canoe through an opening in the rushes. There
+was a thrashing about and plunging not two rods away. Once the fish
+leaped clear of the water in a curve of clashing silver.
+
+"It's a salmon," he said. "A small one."
+
+The maid held hard, but the colour had gone from her face. The canoe
+drew nearer to the shore.
+
+"Hold fast," said Menard. He gave a last sweep of the paddle, and
+crept forward to the bow. Kneeling behind the maid, he reached over
+her shoulder, and took the line below her hand.
+
+"Careful, M'sieu; it may break."
+
+"We must risk it." He pulled slowly in until the fish was close under
+the gunwale. "Now can you hold?"
+
+"Yes." She shook a straying lock of hair from her eyes, and took
+another turn of the cord around her wrist.
+
+"Steady," he said. He drew his knife, leaned over the gunwale, and
+stabbed at the fighting fish until his blade sank in just below the
+gills, and he could lift it aboard.
+
+The maid laughed nervously, and rested her hands upon the two
+gunwales. Her breath was gone, and there was a red mark around her
+wrist where the cord had been. The canoe had drifted into the rushes,
+and Menard went back to his paddle, and worked out again into the
+channel.
+
+"And now, Mademoiselle," he said, "we shall have a breakfast of our
+own. You need not paddle. I will take her down."
+
+Her breath was coming back. She laughed, and sat comfortably in the
+bow, facing Menard, and letting her eyes follow the steady swing and
+catch of his paddle. When they reached the camp, the _voyageurs_ were
+astir, but Danton and the priest still slept. The first red glare of
+the sun was levelled at them over the eastern trees.
+
+Menard made a fire under an arch of flat stones, and trimming a strip
+of oak wood with his hatchet, he laid the cleaned fish upon it and
+kept it on the fire until it was brown and crisp. The maid sat by, her
+eyes alert and her cheeks flushed.
+
+Danton was awake before the fish was cooked, and he stood about with a
+pretence of not observing them. The maid was fairly aroused. She drew
+him into the talk, and laughed and bantered with the two men as
+prettily as they could have wished from a Quebec belle.
+
+All during the morning Danton was silent. At noon, when the halt was
+made for the midday lunch, he was still puzzling over the apparent
+understanding between Mademoiselle and the Captain. Before the journey
+was taken up, he stood for a moment near Menard, on the river bank.
+
+"Captain," he said, "you asked me last night to--"
+
+"Well?"
+
+"It may be that I have misunderstood you. Of course, if Mademoiselle--if
+you--" He caught himself.
+
+Menard smiled; then he read the earnestness beneath the boy's
+confusion, and sobered.
+
+"Mademoiselle and I went fishing, Danton. Result,--Mademoiselle eats
+her first meal. If you can do as much you shall have my thanks. And
+now remember that you are a lieutenant in the King's service."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+THE LONG ARROW.
+
+
+Menard allowed a halt of but a few hours at Three Rivers. The
+settlement held little of interest, for all the resident troops and
+most of the farmers and _engagés_ had gone up the river to join the
+army which was assembling at Montreal. The close of the first week out
+of Quebec saw the party well on the second half of the journey to
+Montreal. As they went on, Menard's thoughts were drawn more deeply
+into the work that lay ahead, and in spite of his efforts at
+lightness, the work of keeping up the maid's spirits fell mostly to
+Danton (though Father Claude did what he could). As matters gradually
+became adjusted, Danton's cheery, hearty manner began to tell; and now
+that there was little choice of company, the maid turned to him for
+her diversion.
+
+On the morning of the second day after leaving Three Rivers, the two
+_voyageurs_ were carrying the canoe to the water when Guerin slipped
+on a wet log, throwing the canoe to the ground, and tearing a wide
+rent in the bark. Menard was impatient at this carelessness. The
+knowledge that the Three Rivers detachment had already gone on to
+Montreal had decided him to move more rapidly, and he had given orders
+that they should start each day in the first light of the dawn. This
+was a chill morning. A low, heavy fog lay on the river, thinning, at a
+yard above the water, into a light mist which veiled what colour may
+have been in the east.
+
+While Guerin and Perrot were patching the canoe under Menard's eye,
+Danton found some dry logs under the brush, and built up the dying
+fire, which was in a rocky hollow, not visible from the river. Then he
+and the maid sat on the rocks above it, where they could get the
+warmth, and yet could see the river. Menard and his men, though only a
+few rods away, were but blurred forms as they moved about the canoe,
+gumming the new seams.
+
+The maid, save for an occasional heavy hour in the late evenings, had
+settled into a cheerful frame of mind. The novelty, and the many
+exciting moments of the journey, as well as the kindness of the three
+men, kept her thoughts occupied. Danton, once he had shaken off his
+sulky fits, was good company. They sat side by side on the rock,
+looking down at the struggling fire, or at the figures moving about
+the canoe, or out into the white mystery of the river, talking easily
+in low tones of themselves and their lives and hopes.
+
+The mist, instead of rising, seemed to settle closer to the water, as
+the broad daylight came across the upper air. The maid and Danton fell
+into silence as the picture brightened. Danton was less sensitive than
+she to the whims of nature, and tiring of the scene, he was gazing
+down into the fire when the maid, without a word, touched his arm. He
+looked up at her; then, seeing that her eyes were fixed on the river,
+followed her gaze. Not more than a score of yards from the shore,
+moving silently through the mist, were the heads of three Indians.
+Their profiles stood out clearly against the white background; their
+shoulders seemed to dissolve into the fog. They passed slowly on up
+the stream, looking straight ahead, without a twitch of the eyelids,
+like a vision from the happy hunting-ground.
+
+Danton slipped down from the rock, and stepped lightly to Menard,
+pointing out the three heads just as they were fading into the
+whiteness about them. Menard motioned to Guerin and Perrot to get the
+newly patched canoe into the water, took three muskets, and in a
+moment pushed off, leaving Danton with the maid and the priest, who
+had retired a short distance for his morning prayers. For a minute the
+heads of the three white men were in sight above the fog, then they
+too were swallowed up.
+
+"I wonder what Menard thinks about them?" said Danton, going back
+toward the maid.
+
+She was still looking at the mist, and did not hear him, so he took a
+seat at the foot of the rock and rubbed the hammer of his musket,
+which had been rusted by the damp. After a time the maid looked toward
+him.
+
+"What does it mean?" she asked.
+
+"I don't know," Danton replied. "They were going up-stream in a canoe,
+I suppose. Probably he thinks they can give us some information."
+
+In a few minutes, during which the mist was clearing under the rays of
+the sun, the two canoes together came around a wooded point and
+beached. The Indians walked silently to the fire. They appeared not to
+see Danton and the maid. Menard paused to look over his canoe. It was
+leaking badly, and before joining the group at the fire, he set the
+canoemen at work making a new patch.
+
+[Illustration: "The Indians walked silently to the fire."]
+
+"Danton," he said, in a low tone, when he reached the fire, "find the
+Father."
+
+Danton hurried away, and Menard turned to the largest of the three
+Indians, who wore the brightest blanket, and had a peculiar wampum
+collar, decorated in mosaic-like beadwork.
+
+"You are travellers, like ourselves," he said, in the Iroquois tongue.
+"We cannot let you pass without a word of greeting. I see that you are
+of the Onondagas, my brothers. It may be that you are from the Mission
+at the Sault St. Francis Xavier?"
+
+The Indian bowed. "We go from Three Rivers to Montreal."
+
+"I, too, am taking my party to Montreal." Menard thought it wise to
+withhold the further facts of his journey. "Have you brothers at Three
+Rivers?"
+
+"No," replied the Indian. "We have been sent with a paper from the
+Superior at Sault St. Francis Xavier to the good fathers at Three
+Rivers. Now we are on our return to the Mission."
+
+"Have my brothers eaten?" Menard motioned toward the fire. "It is
+still early in the day."
+
+The three bowed. "We are travelling fast," said the spokesman, "for
+the Superior awaits our return. We ate before the light. It will soon
+be time for us to go on our journey."
+
+Menard saw Father Claude and Danton approaching, and waited for them.
+The face of the large Indian seemed like some other face that had had
+a place in his memory. It was not unlikely that he had known this
+warrior during his captivity, when half a thousand braves had been to
+him as brothers. The Indian was apparently of middle age, and had
+lines of dignity and authority in his face that made it hard to accept
+him as a subdued resident at the Mission. But Menard knew that no sign
+of doubt or suspicion must appear in his face, so he waited for the
+priest. The Indians sat with their knees drawn up and their blankets
+wrapped about them, looking stolidly at the fire.
+
+Father Claude came quietly into the group, and with a smile extended
+his hand to the smallest of the three, an older man, with a wrinkled
+face. "I did not look for you here, Teganouan. Have you gone back to
+the Mission?"
+
+Teganouan returned the smile, and bowed.
+
+"My brother has told the white man of our errand?"
+
+"Yes," said Menard, "they have been sent to Three Rivers by the
+Superior, and are now returning. I have told them that we, too, are
+going to Montreal."
+
+The priest took the hint. "We shall meet you and your brothers again,
+Teganouan. They are newcomers at the Mission, I believe. They had not
+come when I left."
+
+"No, Father. They have but last week become Christians. The Long
+Arrow" (inclining his head toward the large Indian) "has lost a son,
+and through his suffering was led to take the faith."
+
+The Long Arrow, who had seemed to lose interest in the conversation as
+soon as he had finished speaking, here rose.
+
+"My brothers and the good Father will give us their blessing? The end
+of the journey is yet three days away. I had hoped that we might be
+permitted to accept the protection of the son of Onontio,"--he looked
+at Menard,--"but I see that his canoe will not be ready for the
+journey before the sun is high." He looked gravely from Menard to the
+priest, then walked to the shore, followed by the others. They pushed
+off, and shortly disappeared around the point of land.
+
+Menard gave them no attention, but as soon as they were gone from
+sight, he turned to the priest.
+
+"Well, Father, what do you make of that?"
+
+Father Claude shook his head.
+
+"Nothing, as yet, M'sieu. Do you know who the large man is?"
+
+"No; but I seem to remember him. And what is more to the point, he
+certainly remembers me."
+
+"Are you sure?"
+
+"He recognized me on the river. He came back with me so willingly
+because he wanted to know more about us. That was plain. It would be
+well, Father, to enquire at the Mission. We should know more of them
+and their errand at Three Rivers."
+
+Menard called Danton, and walked with him a little way into the wood.
+
+"Danton," he said, "you are going through this journey with us, and I
+intend that you shall know about such matters as this meeting with the
+Onondagas."
+
+"Oh, they were Onondagas?"
+
+"Yes. They claim to be Mission Indians, but neither the Father nor I
+altogether believe them." In a few sentences Menard outlined the
+conversation. "Now, Danton, this may or may not be an important
+incident. I want you to know the necessity for keeping our own counsel
+in all such matters, dropping no careless words, and letting no
+emotions show. I wish you would make a point of learning the Iroquois
+language. Father Claude will help you. You are to act as my right-hand
+man, and you may as well begin now to learn to draw your own
+conclusions from an Indian's words."
+
+Danton took eagerly to the lessons with Father Claude, for they seemed
+another definite step toward the excitement that surely, to his mind,
+lay in wait ahead. The studying began on that afternoon, while they
+were toiling up against the stream.
+
+In the evening, when the dusk was coming down, and the little camp was
+ready for the night, Menard came up from the heap of stores, where the
+_voyageurs_ had already stretched out, and found the maid sitting
+alone by the fire. Danton, in his rush of interest in the new study,
+had drawn Father Claude aside for another lesson.
+
+"Mademoiselle is lonely?" asked Menard, sitting beside her.
+
+"No, no, M'sieu. I have too many thoughts for that."
+
+"What interesting thoughts they must be."
+
+"They are, M'sieu. They are all about the Indians this morning. Tell
+me, M'sieu,--they called you Onontio. What does it mean?"
+
+"They called me the son of Onontio, because of my uniform. Onontio,
+the Great Mountain, is their name for the Governor; and the Governor's
+soldiers are to them his sons."
+
+"They speak a strange language. It is not the same as that of the
+Ottawas, who once worked for my father."
+
+"Did you know their tongue?"
+
+"A few words, and some of the signs. This,"--raising her hand, with
+the first finger extended, and slowly moving her arm in a half circle
+from horizon to horizon,--"this meant a sun,--one day."
+
+Menard looked at her for a moment in silence. He enjoyed her
+enthusiasm.
+
+"Why don't you learn Iroquois? You would enjoy it. It is a beautiful
+tongue,--the language of metaphor and poetry."
+
+"I should like to," she replied, looking with a faint smile at Danton
+and the priest, who were sitting under a beech tree, mumbling in low
+tones.
+
+"You shall join the class, Mademoiselle. You shall begin to-morrow. It
+was thoughtless of Danton to take the Father's instruction to himself
+alone."
+
+"And then, M'sieu, I will know what the Indians say when they sit up
+stiffly in their blankets, and talk down in their throats. They have
+such dignity. It is hard not to believe them when they look straight
+at one."
+
+"Don't you believe them?"
+
+"The three this morning,--they did not tell the truth."
+
+"Didn't they?"
+
+"Why, I understood that you did not believe them."
+
+"And where did Mademoiselle learn that? Did she follow the conversation?"
+
+"No; but Lieutenant Danton--"
+
+"He told you?"
+
+She nodded. Menard frowned.
+
+"He shouldn't have done that."
+
+The maid looked surprised at his remark, and the smile left her face.
+"Of course, M'sieu," she said, a little stiffly, "whatever is not
+meant for my ears--"
+
+Menard was still frowning, and he failed to notice her change in
+manner. He abruptly gave the conversation a new turn, but seeing after
+a short time that the maid had lost interest in his sallies, he rose,
+and called to the priest.
+
+"Father, you are to have a new pupil. Mademoiselle also will study the
+language of the Iroquois. If you are quick enough with your pupils, we
+shall soon be able to hold a conversation each night about the fire.
+Perhaps, if you would forego your exclusive air, Mademoiselle would
+begin at once."
+
+Danton, without waiting for the priest to start, came hurriedly over
+and sat by the maid.
+
+"You must pardon me," he said, "I did not think,--I did not know that
+you would be interested. It is so dry."
+
+The maid smiled at the fire.
+
+"You did not ask," she replied, "and I could not offer myself to the
+class."
+
+"It will be splendid," said Danton. "We shall learn the language of
+the trees and the grass and the rivers and the birds. And the message
+of the wampum belt, too, we shall know. You see,"--looking up at
+Menard,--"already I am catching the meanings."
+
+Menard smiled, and then went down the bank, leaving the three to bend
+their heads together over the mysteries of the Iroquois rules of
+gender, written out by Father Claude on a strip of bark. It was nearly
+an hour later, after the maid had crept to her couch beneath the
+canoe, and Perrot and Guerin had sprawled upon the bales and were
+snoring in rival keys, that Danton came lightly down the slope humming
+a drinking song. He saw Menard, and dropped to the ground beside him,
+with a low laugh.
+
+"Mademoiselle will lead my wits a chase, Menard. Already she is deep
+in the spirit of the new work."
+
+"Be careful, my boy, that she leads no more than your wits a chase."
+
+Danton laughed again.
+
+"I don't believe there is great danger. What a voice she has! I did
+not know it at first, when she was frightened and spoke only in the
+lower tones. Now when she speaks or laughs it is like--"
+
+"Like what?"
+
+"There is no fit simile in our tongue, light as it is. It may be that
+in the Iroquois I shall find the words. It should be something about
+the singing brooks or the voice of the leaves at night."
+
+The lad was in such buoyant spirits that Menard had to harden himself
+for the rebuke which he must give. With the Indian tribes Menard had
+the tact, the control of a situation, that would have graced a council
+of great chiefs; but in matters of discipline, the blunter faculties
+and language of the white men seemed to give his wit no play. Now, as
+nearly always, he spoke abruptly.
+
+"Have you forgotten our talk of this morning, Danton?"
+
+"No," replied the boy, looking up in surprise.
+
+The night had none of the dampness that had left a white veil over the
+morning just gone. The moon was half hidden behind the western trees.
+The sky, for all the dark, was blue and deep, set with thousands of
+stars, each looking down at its mate in the shining water.
+
+"I spoke of the importance of keeping our own counsel."
+
+Danton began to feel what was coming. He looked down at the ground
+without replying.
+
+"To-night Mademoiselle has repeated a part of our conversation."
+
+"Mademoiselle,--why, she is one of our party. She knows about us,--who
+we are, what we are going for--"
+
+"Then you have told her, Danton?"
+
+"How could she help knowing? We are taking her to Frontenac."
+
+"Father Claude has not told her why we go to Frontenac--nor have I."
+
+"But Major Provost is her friend--"
+
+"He would never have told her."
+
+"But she seemed to know about it."
+
+"Then you have talked it over with her?"
+
+"Why, no,--that is, in speaking of our journey we said something of
+the meaning of the expedition. It could hardly be expected that we,--I
+fail to see, Captain, what it is you are accusing me of."
+
+"You have not been accused yet, Danton. Let me ask you a question. Why
+did you enter the King's army?"
+
+Danton hesitated, and started once or twice to frame answer, but made
+no reply.
+
+"Did you wish a gay uniform, to please the maids, to--"
+
+"You are unfair, M'sieu."
+
+"No, I wish to know. We will say, if you like, that you have hoped to
+be a soldier,--a soldier of whom the King may one day have cause to be
+proud."
+
+Danton flushed, and bowed his head.
+
+"I offered you the chance to go on this mission, Danton, because I
+believed in you. I believed that you had the making of a soldier. This
+is not a child's errand, this of ours. It is the work of strong men.
+This morning I told you of my talk with the three Onondagas because I
+have planned to take you into my confidence, and to give you the
+chance to make a name for yourself. I made a point of the importance
+of keeping such things to yourself."
+
+"But Mademoiselle, M'sieu, she is different--"
+
+"Look at the facts, Danton. I told you this morning: within twelve
+hours you have passed on your information. How do I know that you
+would not have let it slip to others if you had had the chance? You
+forget that Mademoiselle is a woman, and the first and last duty of a
+soldier is to tell no secrets to a woman."
+
+"You speak wrongly of Mademoiselle. It is cowardly to talk thus."
+
+Menard paused to get control of his temper.
+
+"Cowardly, Danton? Is that the word you apply to your commander?"
+
+"Your pardon, M'sieu! A thousand pardons! It escaped me--"
+
+"We will pass it by. I want you to understand this matter. Mademoiselle
+will spend a night in Montreal. We shall leave her with other women. A
+stray word, which to her might mean nothing, might be enough to give
+the wrong persons a hint of the meaning of our journey. A moment's
+nervousness might slip the bridle from her tongue. All New France is
+not so loyal that we can afford to drop a chance secret here and
+there. As to this maid, she is only a child, and by giving her our
+secrets, you are forcing her to bear a burden which we should bear
+alone. These Indians this morning were spies, I am inclined to
+believe, scouting along the river for information of the coming
+campaign. The only way that we can feel secure is by letting no word
+escape our lips, no matter how trivial. I tell you this, not so much
+for this occasion as for a suggestion for the future."
+
+"Very well, M'sieu. You will please accept my complete apologies."
+
+"I shall have to add, Danton, that if any further mistake of this kind
+occurs I shall be forced to dismiss you from my service. Now that I
+have said this, I want you to understand that I don't expect it to
+happen. I have believed in you, Danton, and I stand ready to be a
+friend to you."
+
+Menard held out his hand. Danton clasped it nervously, mumbling a
+second apology. For a few moments longer they sat there, Menard trying
+to set Danton at ease, but the boy was flushed, and he spoke only half
+coherently. He soon excused himself and wandered off among the trees
+and the thick bushes.
+
+During the next day Danton was in one of his sullen moods. He worked
+feverishly, and, with the maid, kept Father Claude occupied for the
+greater part of the time, as they paddled on, with conversation, and
+with discussion of the Iroquois words. The maid felt the change from
+the easy relations in the party, and seemed a little depressed, but
+she threw herself into the studying. Often during the day she would
+take up a paddle, and join in the stroke. At first Menard protested,
+but she laughed, and said that it was a "rest" after sitting so long.
+
+They were delayed on the following day by a second accident to the
+canoe, so that they were a full day late in reaching Montreal. They
+moved slowly up the channel, past the islands and the green banks with
+their little log-houses or, occasionally, larger dwellings built after
+the French manner. St. Helen's Island, nearly opposite the city, had a
+straggling cluster of hastily built bark houses, and a larger group of
+tents where the regulars were encamped, awaiting the arrival of
+Governor Denonville with the troops from Quebec.
+
+Menard stopped at the island, guiding the canoe to the bank where a
+long row of canoes and bateaux lay close to the water.
+
+"You might get out and walk around," he said to the others. "I shall
+be gone only a few moments."
+
+Father Claude sat on the bank, lost in meditation. Danton and the maid
+walked together slowly up and down, beyond earshot from the priest.
+Since Menard's rebuke, both the lad and the maid had shown a slight
+trace of resentment. It did not come out in their conversation, but
+rather in their silences, and in the occasions which they took to sit
+and walk apart from the others. It was as if a certain common ground
+of interest had come to them. The maid, for all her shyness and even
+temper, was not accustomed to such cool authority as Menard was
+developing. The priest was keeping an eye on the fast-growing
+acquaintanceship, and already had it vaguely in mind to call it to the
+attention of Menard, who was getting too deeply into the spirit and
+the details of his work to give much heed.
+
+Menard was soon back.
+
+"Push off," he said. "The Major is not here. We shall have to look for
+him in the city."
+
+They headed across the stream. The city lay before them, on its gentle
+slope, with the mountain rising behind like an untiring sentry. It was
+early in the afternoon, and on the river were many canoes and small
+boats, filled with soldiers, friendly Indians, or _voyageurs_, moving
+back and forth between the island and the city. They passed close to
+many of the bateaux, heaped high with provision and ammunition bales,
+and more than once the lounging soldiers rose and saluted Menard.
+
+At the city wharf he turned to Danton.
+
+"We shall have to get a larger canoe, Danton, and a stronger. Will you
+see to it, please? We shall have two more in our party from now on.
+Make sure that the canoe is in the best of condition. Also I wish you
+would see to getting the rope and the other things we may need in
+working through the rapids. Then spend your time as you like. We shall
+start early in the morning."
+
+Menard and Father Claude together went with the maid to the Superior,
+who arranged for her to pass the night with the sisters. Then Menard
+left the priest to make his final arrangements at the Mission, and
+went himself to see the Commandant, to whom he outlined the bare facts
+of his journey to Frontenac.
+
+"The thing that most concerns you," he said finally, "is a meeting I
+had a few days ago with three Indians down the river. One called
+himself the Long Arrow, and another was Teganouan, who, Father de
+Casson tells me, recently left the Mission at the Sault St. Francis
+Xavier. They claim to be Mission Indians. It will be well to watch
+out for them, and to have an eye on the Richelieu, and the other
+routes, to make sure that they don't slip away to the south with
+information."
+
+"Very well," replied the Commandant. "I imagine that we can stop them.
+Do you feel safe about taking this maid up the river just now?"
+
+"Oh, yes. Our men are scattered along the route, are they not?" Menard
+asked.
+
+"Quite a number are out establishing Champigny's transport system."
+
+"I don't look for any trouble. But I should like authority for one or
+two extra men."
+
+"Take anything you wish, Menard. I will get word over to the island at
+once, giving you all the authority you need."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V.
+
+DANTON BREAKS OUT.
+
+
+When Menard reached the wharf, early on the following morning, he
+found Father Claude waiting for him. The new canoe lay on the wharf,
+and beside it was a heap of stores. Perrot and the two new _engagés_
+sat on the edge of the wharf. The sun had just risen over the trees on
+St. Helen's Island, and the air was clear and cool.
+
+"Well, Perrot," said Menard, as he unslung his musket and horn, "is
+everything ready?"
+
+"Everything, M'sieu."
+
+"Where is Guerin?"
+
+"I have not seen him, M'sieu."
+
+Menard turned to the priest.
+
+"Good-morning, Father. You are on time, I see; and that is more than
+we can say for Danton. Where is the boy?"
+
+"He has gone for Mademoiselle St. Denis, Captain. He was here before
+the sunrise, checking up the stores."
+
+"Learning to work, is he? That is a good sign. And how about yourself?
+Did you pick up anything yesterday?"
+
+"Yes," replied the priest. "I enquired at the Mission about Teganouan
+and his companions."
+
+"Well?"
+
+"Nothing is known of them. Teganouan had been one of the worst
+drunkards among the Onondagas, and his conversion, a year ago, was
+thought to be one of our greatest victories for the faith. His
+penances were among the most complete and purging ever--"
+
+"And the others?"
+
+"Just before I left the Mission for Quebec, Teganouan went on an
+errand to the city and fell among some of our fellow-countrymen who
+were having a drinking bout. For a few days after that he wavered, and
+fell again. Once afterward he was seen in company with two low
+fellows, _coureurs de bois_, who have since been confined under
+suspicion of communicating with the enemy."
+
+"He has returned to the Mission, then?"
+
+"No, he disappeared some time ago. They do not know the Long Arrow. I
+described him to Brother de Lamberville--"
+
+"Oh, he is here now?"
+
+"Yes. It seems, further, that all the other workers among the Iroquois
+have had word and are returning. That much of my labour is removed."
+
+"How do they get this word?" said Menard, impatiently. "That is the
+old question. It is enough to make one wonder if there are any secrets
+kept from the enemy's country."
+
+"No one seems to know, M'sieu. The Superior told me last night that
+they had not been sent for, so it would seem that the information must
+have reached them through the Indians."
+
+"The folly of these new governors!" Menard strode back and forth. "Oh,
+it makes one sigh for old Frontenac. He never walked blindfolded into
+such a trap as this. But go on. You were speaking of Father de
+Lamberville."
+
+"It was only that I described the Long Arrow to Brother de Lamberville.
+He seemed to remember such a wampum collar as the Long Arrow wore. He
+could not recall exactly."
+
+"Then we may as well forget the incident. It seems that we are to know
+nothing of it. Here is Danton."
+
+The lieutenant and the maid were walking rapidly down to the wharf.
+Mademoiselle was in a gay mood after her few hours of enjoyment among
+the comforts of a city.
+
+"Good-morning," she called, waving her hand.
+
+"Good-morning," said Menard, shortly. He did not look a second time,
+to see her smile fade, for Guerin had not appeared, and he was rapidly
+losing patience. He walked up and down the wharf for a few moments,
+while Danton found a seat for the maid and the two talked together.
+
+"Perrot," he said, "do you know where Guerin was last evening?"
+
+"Yes, M'sieu. He was at the inn."
+
+"What was he doing? Drinking?"
+
+"A little, M'sieu."
+
+"Go up there, on the run. If you don't find him there, come right
+back, for we can't wait much longer for anyone."
+
+Perrot ran up the street and disappeared. In a few moments he came in
+sight, striding down between the row of houses, holding Guerin firmly
+by one arm. The young fellow was hanging back, and stumbling in limp
+fashion. He was evidently drunk. Danton, who had joined Menard when
+the two men appeared, said, "Heavens, he must have started early!"
+
+Some distance behind Perrot and Guerin came a ragged crowd of
+woodsmen, singing, jeering, and shouting, and bearing broad traces of
+a sleepless night.
+
+Menard stood waiting with a look of disgust. When they came upon the
+wharf Guerin laughed, and tried to get out a flippant apology for his
+tardiness; but Menard seized him before the words were off his lips,
+and dragging him across the wharf threw him into the water. Then he
+turned to Perrot, and said, "Pull him out."
+
+The two new men stood uneasily near, with startled faces. Behind them
+the maid was sitting, a frightened look in her eyes. Danton had
+risen.
+
+"Clear away from here!" Menard called to the drunken rabble, who had
+collected a few rods away, and were now hesitating between laughter
+and fright. They stood looking at each other and at Menard, then they
+slunk away.
+
+In all an hour had gone before they were ready to start. Guerin was
+weak and shivering from his plunge, but Menard ordered him into the
+canoe. The incident drew a cloud over the maid's spirits, and
+altogether depressed the party, so that not until afternoon did they
+get into conversation. By that time they were past the Lachine Rapids
+and the Sault St. Louis, where the men made a portage, and Danton led
+the maid along the bank through the tangled brush and briers. When at
+last they were ready to push on across Lake St. Louis the maid's skirt
+was torn in a dozen places, and a thorn had got into her hand, which
+Danton carefully removed with the point of his knife, wincing and
+flushing with her at each twinge of pain. During the rest of the day,
+they had an Iroquois lesson, and by the end of the afternoon when the
+sun was low, and Menard headed for the shore of Isle Perrot, the maid
+was bright again, laughing over Danton's blunders in the new
+language.
+
+They spent the next day on the island, for what with wind and rain
+the lake was impassable for their canoe. The men built a hut of brush
+and bark which sheltered the party from the driving rain. Menard's
+mood lightened at the prospect of a rest, and he started a long
+conversation in Iroquois which soon had even Father Claude laughing
+in his silent way. The rain lessened in the afternoon, but the wind
+was still running high. Menard and the _engagés_ went out early in
+the afternoon and repacked all the supplies, in order that the
+weight might be distributed more evenly in the canoe. With this and
+other work he was occupied until late in the afternoon. Father Claude
+took the occasion for a solitary walk, and for meditation. When Menard
+entered the hut he found the maid sitting with her head resting
+against one of the supporting trees. She wore a disturbed, unsettled
+expression. Danton evidently had been sitting or standing near her,
+for when Menard entered, stooping, he was moving across the hut in a
+hesitating, conscious manner. The Captain looked at them curiously.
+
+"I'm afraid we'll have to take away a part of your house to pay for
+your supper," he said. "Everything is wet outside that might do for
+firewood. Lend a hand, Danton." He gathered logs and sticks from the
+floor and walls, and carried them out. Danton, after a quick look
+toward the maid (which, of course, Menard saw), did the same.
+
+The Captain was the first to reenter the hut. The maid had not moved,
+and her eyes were puzzled and wearied, but she tried to smile.
+
+"Has it stopped raining?" she asked.
+
+Menard gave her an amused glance, and pointed to a sparkling beam of
+sunlight that came slanting in through an opening in the wall, and
+buried itself in a little pool of light on the trampled ground. She
+looked at it, flushed, and turned her eyes away. He stood for a
+moment, half minded to ask the question that was on his tongue, but
+finally held it back. In a moment Danton came back, looking
+suspiciously at each of them as he stooped to gather another armful of
+wood.
+
+Menard was thoughtful during the evening meal. Afterward he slipped
+his arm through Father Claude's, and led him for a short walk, giving
+him an account of the incident. "I didn't say anything at the time,"
+he concluded, "partly because I thought I might be mistaken, and
+partly because it would have been the worst thing I could do. I begin
+to see--I should have foreseen it before I spoke to him about the
+girl--that we have trouble ahead, Father, with these precious
+children. I confess I don't know just what to do about it. We must
+think it over. Anyway, you had better talk to her. She would tell you
+what she wouldn't tell me. If he's annoying her, we must know it."
+
+Father Claude was troubled.
+
+"The maid is in our care," he said, "and also in that of Lieutenant
+Danton. It would seem that he--"
+
+"There's no use in expecting him to take any responsibility, Father."
+
+"Yes, I suppose you are right. He is a child."
+
+"Will you go to the maid, Father, and get straight at the truth? You
+see that I cannot meddle with her thoughts without danger of being
+misinterpreted. It is you who must be her adviser."
+
+The priest acquiesced, and they returned to the camp, to find the maid
+still sitting alone, with a troubled face, and Danton puttering about
+the fire with a show of keeping himself occupied. They ate in silence,
+in spite of Menard's efforts to arouse them. After the meal they hung
+about, each hesitating to wander away, and yet seeing no pleasure in
+gathering about the fire. Menard saw that Father Claude had it in mind
+to speak to the maid, so he got Danton away on a pretext of looking
+over the stores. But he said nothing of the episode that was in all
+their minds, preferring to await the priest's report.
+
+After the maid had gone to her couch beneath the canoe, and Danton had
+wandered into the wilderness that was all about them, Father Claude
+joined Menard at the fire.
+
+"Well, Father, what word?"
+
+"Softly, M'sieu. It is not likely that she sleeps as yet."
+
+"Well?"
+
+"I have talked long with her, but she is of a stubborn mind."
+
+"How is that?"
+
+"She was angry at first. She spoke hastily, and asked me in short
+terms to leave her in solitude. And then, after a time, when she began
+to see that it was her welfare and our duty which I had in mind, and
+not an idle curiosity, she was moved."
+
+"Did she speak then?"
+
+"No, M'sieu, she wept, and insisted that there was no trouble on her
+mind,--it was merely the thought of her home and her father that had
+cast her down."
+
+"And so she has pride," mused Menard. "Could you gather any new
+opinions, Father? Do you think that they may already have come to some
+understanding?"
+
+"I hardly think so, M'sieu. But may I suggest that it would be well to
+be firm with Lieutenant Danton? He is young, and the maid is in our
+trust,"
+
+"True, Father. I will account for him."
+
+There seemed to be nothing further to do at the moment, so the priest
+went to his blanket, and Menard drew a bundle under his head and went
+to sleep, after a glance about the camp to see that the sentry was on
+watch. Now that Montreal lay behind, and the unsettled forest before,
+with only a thin line of Frenchmen stretched along the river between
+them and Fort Frontenac, he had divided the night into watches, and
+each of the four _engagés_ stood his turn.
+
+The following day was all but half gone before the wind had dropped to
+a rate that made the passage of the lake advisable. Menard ordered the
+noon meal for an hour earlier than usual, and shortly afterward they
+set out across the upper end of Lake St. Louis to the foot of the
+cascades. Before the last bundle had been carried up the portage to
+Buisson Pointe, the dusk was settling over the woods across the river,
+and over the rising ground on Isle Perrot at the mouth of the Ottawa.
+
+During the next day they passed on up the stream to the Coteau des
+Cedres. Menard and Father Claude were both accustomed to take the
+rapid without carrying, or even unloading, but Danton looked at the
+swirling water with doubt in his eyes. When the maid, leaning back in
+the canoe while the men halted at the bank to make fast for the
+passage, saw the torrent that tumbled and pitched merrily down toward
+them, she laughed. To hold a sober mood for long was not in her
+buoyant nature, and she welcomed a dash of excitement as a relief from
+the strained relations of the two days just gone.
+
+"M'sieu," she called to Menard, with a sparkle in her eyes. "Oh,
+M'sieu, may I stay in the canoe?"
+
+Danton turned quickly at the sound of her voice, and a look, half of
+pain, half of surprise, came over his face as he saw her eagerness.
+Menard looked at her in doubt.
+
+"It may be a wet passage, Mademoiselle."
+
+"And why not, M'sieu? Have I not been wet before? See, I will protect
+myself." She drew the bundles closely about her feet, and threw a
+blanket across her knees. "Now I can brave the stream, Captain.
+Or,"--her gay tone dropped, and she looked demurely at him,--"perhaps
+it is that I am too heavy, that I should carry myself up the bank. I
+will obey my orders, Captain." But as she spoke she tucked the blanket
+closer about her, and stole another glance at Menard.
+
+He smiled. He was thinking of Madame Gordeau and her fragile daughter,
+who had shuddered with fear at a mere glimpse of the first rapid.
+"Very well," he said, "Mademoiselle shall stay in the canoe."
+
+"But it is not safe"--broke in Danton, stepping forward. Then,
+conscious of the blunder, he turned away, and took up the rope.
+
+"Lay hold, boys," said Menard.
+
+Perrot and one of the new men waded into the water, and laid hold of
+the gunwales on each side of the bow. Menard himself took the stern.
+He called to Danton, who stood awkwardly upon the bank, "Take the rope
+with the men."
+
+Guerin made the rope fast and set out ahead, with the other men and
+Danton close behind. Father Claude rolled up his robe and joined
+them.
+
+"Wait," called Menard, as the rope straightened. "Mademoiselle, I am
+sorry to disturb you, but if you will sit farther back you will have
+less trouble from the spray." He waded along the side, and helped her
+to move nearer the stern, placing the bundles and the blanket about
+her as before. Then he shouted, "All right," and they started into the
+foaming water.
+
+They toiled slowly up the incline, catching at rocks to steady their
+course, and often struggling for a foothold. Once Menard ordered a
+halt at a large rock, and all rested for a moment.
+
+When they started again, the men at the bow of the canoe had some
+trouble in holding it steady, for their feet were on a stretch of
+smooth rock, and Menard called Danton back to help them. The boy
+worked his way along the rope, and reached the bow.
+
+"Come around behind Perrot," said Menard.
+
+Danton reached around Perrot's body, and caught hold of the gunwale.
+At that moment his foot slipped, and he fell, dragging the side of the
+canoe down with him. The men at the bow did their best to prevent a
+capsize, but succeeded only in keeping half the bundles in the canoe.
+The others, the muskets, and the maid went into the river.
+
+Menard moved forward as rapidly as he could against the current. The
+maid was unable at once to get her feet, used as she was to the water,
+and was swept down against him. He caught her, and, steadying himself
+with one hand, by the water-logged canoe, raised her head and held her
+while she struggled for a footing and shook the water from her eyes.
+Before she was wholly herself, Danton came plunging toward them.
+
+"Give her to me!" he said huskily. "I've drowned her! My God, let me
+have her!"
+
+"Stop," said Menard, sternly. "Take the men, and go after those
+bales--quick!"
+
+Danton looked stupidly at him and at the maid, who was wiping the
+water from her face with one hand, and holding tightly to the Captain.
+Then he followed Perrot, who had already, with the two new men and
+Father Claude, commenced to get together the bales, most of which had
+sunk, and were moving slowly along the bottom. Menard still had his
+arm about the girl's shoulders. He helped her to the shore.
+
+"Keep moving, Mademoiselle,--don't sit down. In a moment we shall have
+a fire. Father Claude," he called, "bring the canoe ashore." Then to
+the maid, "There are yet some dry blankets, thank God."
+
+Mademoiselle was herself now, and she protested. "But it is only
+water, M'sieu. Let me go on with you, beyond the rapids."
+
+Menard merely shook his head. The canoe was soon on the bank, and
+emptied of water. The other men were beginning to come in with soaked
+bundles and dripping muskets. Each bale was opened, and the contents
+spread out to dry, while Guerin was set to work at drying the muskets
+with a cloth. Perrot and Danton built a rough shelter for the maid,
+enclosing a small fire, and gave her some dry blankets. Then each man
+dried himself as best he could.
+
+This accident threw Danton into a fit of gloominess from which nothing
+seemed to arouse him. He was careless of his duty, and equally
+careless to the reprimands that followed. This went on for two days,
+during which the maid seemed at one moment to avoid him, and at
+another to watch for his coming. In the evening of the second day
+following, the party camped at Pointe ŕ Baudet, on Lake St. Francis.
+The supper was eaten in a silence more oppressive than usual, for
+neither Menard nor Father Claude could overcome the influence of
+Danton's heavy face and the maid's troubled eyes. After the supper the
+two strolled away, and sat just out of earshot on a mossy knoll. For
+hours they talked there, their voices low, save once or twice when
+Danton's rose. They seemed to have lost all count of time, all heed of
+appearances. Menard and the priest made an effort at first to appear
+unobservant, but later, seeing that their movements were beyond the
+sight of those unheeding eyes, they took to watching and speculating
+on the course of the conversation. The night came on, and the dark
+closed over them. Still the murmur of those low voices floated across
+the camp.
+
+Father Claude, with a troubled mind, went down to the water, and
+walked slowly up and down. Menard saw to the final preparations for
+the night, and posted the first sentry. Then he joined the priest.
+
+"Father?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"I think it is time to speak."
+
+"I fear it is, M'sieu."
+
+"I must leave it in your hands."
+
+"Shall I go now?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+Without further words, Father Claude walked up the bank, crackling
+through the bushes. From this spot the voices were inaudible, and for
+a few moments there was no sound. Then Menard could hear some one
+moving heavily through the undergrowth, going farther and farther into
+the stillness, and he knew that it was Danton. He sat on the bank with
+his back against a tree, and waited for a long hour. At last he
+dropped asleep.
+
+He was awakened by Father Claude. The priest dropped to the ground
+beside him. His training had given Menard the faculty of awaking
+instantly into full grasp of a situation.
+
+"Well," he said. "Where is the maid?"
+
+"She has gone to her couch, but not to sleep, I fear. It has come,
+M'sieu."
+
+"What has come?"
+
+"Danton has lost his senses. He asks her to marry him, to flee with
+him. It is a difficult case. She has had no such experience before,
+and knows not how to receive him. She seems to have no love for him,
+beyond the pleasure his flattery has given her. She believes all he
+says. One thing I know, aside from all questions of expediency, of
+care for our trust, this must not go on."
+
+"Not for the present, at least. She may do what she will, once we have
+taken her safely to Frontenac."
+
+"No, M'sieu; not even then. We must stop it at once."
+
+"Oh, of course," said Menard; "so far as we are concerned, we have no
+choice. You need not bother longer to-night. I will wait for the boy.
+I am sorry for him."
+
+"I should have more pity, if I knew less of his past."
+
+"Tush, Father! He is not a bad fellow, as they go. To be sure he does
+not rise any too well to new responsibilities, but he will grow into
+it. It is better an honest infatuation with the daughter of a
+gentleman than a dishonest one with an Indian maid. And you know our
+officers, Father. God knows, they are all bad enough; and yet they are
+loyal fellows."
+
+"Ah, M'sieu, I fear you will be too lenient with him. Believe me, we
+have not a minute to waste in stopping the affair."
+
+"Have no fear, Father. Good-night."
+
+"Good-night."
+
+Menard lay on the bank, gazing at the sparkling water, and listening
+to the slow step of the sentry and to the deeper sounds of the forest.
+Another hour crept by, and still Danton had not returned. Menard
+walked about the camp to make sure that he was not already rolled in
+his blanket; then he went to the sentry, who was leaning against a
+tree a few rods away.
+
+"Colin," he said, "have you seen Lieutenant Danton?"
+
+"Yes, M'sieu. He is up there." Colin pointed through the trees that
+fringed the river. "I heard a noise some time ago, and went up to see.
+He is lying under a beech tree, if he has not moved,--and I should
+have heard him if he had. It may be that he is asleep."
+
+Menard nodded, and walked slowly along the bank, bending aside the
+briers that caught at his clothes and his hands.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI.
+
+THE FIGHT AT LA GALLETTE.
+
+
+Danton was lying on the ground, but he was not asleep. He looked up,
+at the sound of Menard's footsteps, and then, recognizing him, lowered
+his eyes again. The Captain hesitated, standing over the prostrate
+figure.
+
+"Danton," he said finally, "I want you to tell me the truth."
+
+The boy made no reply, and Menard, after waiting for a moment, sat
+upon a log.
+
+"I have decided to do rather an unusual thing, Danton," he said
+slowly, "in offering to talk it over with you as a friend, and not as
+an officer. In one thing you must understand me: Mademoiselle St.
+Denis has been intrusted to my care, and until she has safely reached
+those who have a right to share the direction of her actions, I can
+allow nothing of this sort to go on. You must understand that. If you
+will talk with me frankly, and try to control yourself for the
+present, it may be that I can be of service to you later on."
+
+There was a long silence. Finally, Danton spoke, without raising his
+head.
+
+"Is there need of this, M'sieu? Is it not enough that she--that
+Mademoiselle dismisses me?"
+
+"Oh," said Menard, "that is it?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"You are sure of yourself, Danton? sure that you have not made a
+mistake?"
+
+"A mistake?" The boy looked up wildly. "I was--shall I tell you,
+M'sieu?--I left the camp to-night with the thought that I should never
+go back."
+
+Menard looked at him curiously.
+
+"What did you plan to do?"
+
+"I didn't know,--I don't know now. Back to Montreal, perhaps to the
+Iroquois. I don't care where."
+
+"You did not bring your musket. It would hardly be safe."
+
+"Safe!" There was weary contempt in the boy's voice. He sat up, and
+made an effort to steady himself, leaning back upon his hands. "I
+should not say this. It was what I thought at first. I am past it now;
+I can think better. It was only your coming,--when I first saw you, it
+came rushing back, and I wanted to--oh, what is the use? You do not
+know. You cannot understand."
+
+"And now?"
+
+"Now, Captain, I ask for a release. Let me go back to Montreal."
+
+"How would you go? You have no canoe."
+
+"I will walk."
+
+Menard shook his head.
+
+"I am sorry," he said, "but it is too late. In the first place, you
+would never reach the city. There are scouting bands of Iroquois all
+along the river."
+
+"So much the better, M'sieu, so--"
+
+"Wait. That is only one reason. I cannot spare you. I have realized
+within the last day that I should have brought more men. The Iroquois
+know of our campaign; they are watching us. A small party like this is
+to their liking. I will tell you, Danton, we may have a close rub
+before we get to Frontenac. I wish I could help you, but I cannot.
+What reason could I give for sending you alone down the river to
+Montreal? You forget, boy, that we are not on our own pleasure; we are
+on the King's errand. For you to go now would be to take away one of
+our six fighting men,--to imperil Mademoiselle. And that, I think," he
+looked keenly at Danton, "is not what you would wish to do."
+
+The boy's face was by turns set and working. He looked at Menard as if
+to speak, but got nothing out. At last he sprang to his feet, and
+paced back and forth between the trees.
+
+"What can I do?" he said half to himself. "I can't stay! I can't see
+her every day, and hear her voice, and sit with her at every meal. Why
+do you call yourself my friend, Menard? Why don't you help? Why don't
+you say something--?"
+
+"There are some things, Danton, that a man must fight out alone."
+
+Danton turned away, and stood looking over the river. Menard sat on
+the log and waited. The moments slipped by, and still they said
+nothing. They could hear the stirring of Colin, back at the camp, and
+the rustle of the low night breeze. They could almost hear the great
+silent rush of the river.
+
+"Danton."
+
+The boy half turned his head.
+
+"You will stay here and play the man. You will go on with your duties;
+though, if the old arrangement be too hard, I will be your master in
+the Iroquois study, leaving Mademoiselle to Father Claude. And now you
+must return to the camp and get what sleep you can. Heaven knows we
+may have little enough between here and Frontenac. Come."
+
+He got up, and walked to the camp, without looking around. Danton
+lingered until the Captain's tall figure was blending with the shadows
+of the forest, then he went after.
+
+During the following day they got as far as the group of islands at
+the head of Lake St. Francis. Wherever possible Menard was now
+selecting islands or narrow points for the camp, where, in case of a
+night attack, defence would be a simple problem for his few men. Also,
+each night, he had the men spread a circle of cut boughs around the
+camp at a little distance, so that none could approach without some
+slight noise. Another night saw the party at the foot of Petit
+Chesneaux, just above Pointe Maligne.
+
+While Perrot was preparing the supper, and Danton, with the
+_voyageurs_, was unpacking the bales, Menard took his musket and
+strode off into the forest. There was seldom a morning now that the
+maid did not have for her breakfast a morsel of game which the
+Captain's musket had brought down.
+
+In half an hour he returned, and sought Father Claude; and after a few
+low words the two set off. Menard led the way through thicket and
+timber growth, over a low hill, and down into a hollow, where a
+well-defined Indian trail crossed a brook. Here was a large sugar
+maple tree standing in a narrow opening in the thicket. Menard struck
+a light, and held up a torch so that the priest could make out a
+blaze-mark on the tree.
+
+"See," said Menard. "It is on the old trail. I saw it by the merest
+chance."
+
+Father Claude bent forward, with his eyes close to the inscription
+that had been painted on the white inner bark, with charcoal and
+bear's grease.
+
+"Can you read it?" asked Menard, holding the torch high.
+
+The priest nodded. Both of these men knew the Indian writing nearly as
+well as their own French.
+
+ [Transcriber's Note: An illustration of picture-writing appears
+ here in the text with the following caption:
+
+ NOTE.--By this picture-writing the Long Arrow (of the clan of the
+ Beaver) tells the Beaver (of the same clan) that he has taken up
+ the hatchet against the party in the canoe, and he asks the Beaver
+ to assist him. The parallel zigzag lines under the long arrow tell
+ that he is travelling by the river, and the two straight lines
+ under these that he has two warriors with him. The attack is to be
+ made in either three or four sleeps, or days, as indicated by the
+ three finished huts and one unfinished.
+
+ The Beaver has seen this sign, as shown by his signature at the
+ bottom. The seventeen slanting lines under the foot mean that he
+ has seventeen warriors and they are travelling on foot, southward,
+ as shown by the fact that the lines slope toward the sun.
+
+ That the figures in the canoe are French is shown by their hats.
+ The priest has no paddle, the maid is represented with long
+ hair.]
+
+"He does not know of the two men you got at Montreal, M'sieu. He tells
+of only six in our canoe."
+
+"No? But that matters little. The Beaver has hurried after him with
+nearly a score. They can give us trouble enough. What do you make of
+the huts? Do they mean three days or four?"
+
+"It looks to me," said the priest slowly, "that he was interrupted in
+drawing the fourth."
+
+"Well,"--Menard threw his torch into the brook, and turned away into
+the dusk of the thicket,--"we know enough. The fight will be somewhere
+near the head of the rapids. Perhaps they will wait until we get on
+into the islands."
+
+"And meantime," said the priest, as they crackled through the
+undergrowth, "we shall say nothing of this to Lieutenant Danton or the
+maid?"
+
+"Nothing," Menard replied.
+
+In three days more they had passed Rapide Flat, after toiling
+laboriously by the Long Sault. They were a sober enough party now,
+oppressed with Danton's dogged attention to duty and with the maid's
+listless manner.
+
+They were passing a small island the next morning, when Perrot gave a
+shout and stopped paddling.
+
+"What is it?" asked Menard, sharply.
+
+Perrot pointed across a spit of land. In the other channel they could
+see a bateau just disappearing behind a clump of trees. It was headed
+down-stream. Menard swung the canoe about, and they skirted the foot
+of the island. Instead of a single bateau there were some half dozen,
+drifting light down the river, with a score of _coureurs de bois_ and
+_voyageurs_ under the command of a bronzed lieutenant, Du Peron, a
+sergeant, and a corporal. The lieutenant recognized Menard, and both
+parties landed while the two officers exchanged news.
+
+"Can you spare me a few men?" Menard asked, when they had drawn apart
+from the others.
+
+The lieutenant's eye roamed over the group on the beach, where the men
+of both parties were mingling.
+
+"How many do you want? I'm running shorthanded. We have all we can
+manage with these bateaux."
+
+"There's a war party of twenty on my trail," said Menard. "If I had my
+own men with me I should feel safe, but I have my doubts about these
+fellows. I haven't room for more than two."
+
+"What's the trouble?--that La Grange affair?"
+
+Menard nodded.
+
+"I heard that they had a price on your head. There's been a good deal
+of talk about it at Frontenac. A converted Mohawk has been scouting
+for us, and he says that the Onondagas blame you for that whole galley
+business."
+
+"I know," said Menard, grimly. "You could hardly expect them to get
+the truth of it."
+
+"It was bad work, Menard, bad work. The worst thing La Grange did was
+to butcher the women and children. He was drunk at the time, and the
+worst of it was over before d'Orvilliers got wind of it. Do you know
+who is leading this war party?"
+
+"The Long Arrow."
+
+"Oh, yes. A big fellow, with a rather noticeable wampum collar. He
+came to Frontenac as a Mission Indian, but got away before we
+suspected anything. Our scout told me that his son was in the party
+that was taken to the galleys. He's been scouting along the river ever
+since. Likely as not he followed you down to Quebec. How many men have
+you now?"
+
+"Five, and Father Claude."
+
+"He could shoot at a pinch, I suppose. I'll let you have the best two
+I have, but--" Du Peron shrugged his shoulders--"you know the sort
+that are assigned for this transport work. They're a bad lot at best.
+But they can shoot, and they hate the Iroquois, so you're all right if
+you can keep them sober. That will make nine, with yourself,--it
+should be enough."
+
+"It will be enough. How is the transport moving?"
+
+"Splendidly. Whatever we may say about the new Governor, our Intendant
+knows his business. I judge from the way he is stocking up Frontenac,
+that we are to use it as the base for a big campaign."
+
+"I suppose so. You will report, will you, at Montreal, that we were
+safe at Rapide Flat? And if you find a _coureur_ going down to Quebec,
+I wish you would send word to Provost that Mademoiselle St. Denis is
+well and in good spirits."
+
+The lieutenant looked curiously at the maid, who was walking with
+Father Claude near the canoe. Then the two officers shook hands, and
+in a few moments were going their ways, Menard with two villainous
+_voyageurs_ added to his crew. That afternoon he passed the last
+rapid, and beached the canoe at La Gallette, thankful that nothing
+intervened between them and Fort Frontenac but a reach of still water
+and the twining channels of the Thousand Islands, where it would call
+for the sharpest eyes ever set in an Iroquois head to follow his
+movements.
+
+They ate an early supper, and immediately afterward Father Claude
+slipped away. The maid looked after him a little wistfully, then she
+wandered to the bank, and found a mossy seat where she could watch the
+long rapid, with its driving, foaming current that dashed over the
+ledges and leaped madly around the jagged rocks. Menard set his men at
+work preparing the camp against attack. When this was well under way
+he called Danton, who was lying by the fire, and spent an hour with
+him conversing in Iroquois. By that time the twilight was creeping
+down the river. Menard left the boy to form a speech in accord with
+Iroquois tradition, and went on a tour of inspection about the camp.
+The new men had swung thoroughly into the spirit of their work; one of
+them was already on guard a short way back in the woods. The other men
+were grouped in a cleared place, telling stories and singing.
+
+Father Claude came hurriedly toward the fire, looking for Menard. His
+eyes glowed with enthusiasm.
+
+"M'sieu," he said, in an eager voice, "come. I have found it."
+
+"What?"
+
+"It has come to me,--about the canoe."
+
+Menard looked puzzled, but the priest caught his arm, and led him
+away.
+
+"It came while we ate supper. The whole truth, the secret of the
+allegory, flashed upon me. I have worked hard, and now it is done.
+Instead of leaving out the canoe, I have put it back, and have placed
+in it six warriors, three paddling toward the chapel, and three away
+from it. Over them hovers an angel,--a mere suggestion, a faint,
+shining face, a diaphanous form, and outspread hands. Thus we
+symbolize the conflict in the savage mind at the first entrance of the
+Holy Word into their lives, with the blessed assurance over all that
+the Faith must triumph in the end."
+
+At the last words, he stopped and drew Menard around to face the
+portrait of the Lily of the Onondagas, which was leaning against a
+stump.
+
+"Is it too dark, M'sieu? See, I will bring it closer." He lifted the
+picture, and held it close to Menard's eyes. He was trembling with the
+excitement of his inspiration.
+
+The Captain stepped back.
+
+"I should like to know, Father, where you have had this picture."
+
+"It was in my bundle. I have"--for the first time he saw the sternness
+in Menard's face, and his voice faltered.
+
+"You did not leave it at Montreal?"
+
+Father Claude slowly lowered the canvas to the ground. The light had
+gone out of his eyes, and his face was white. Then suddenly his thin
+form straightened. "I had forgotten. It was M'sieu's order. See,"--he
+suddenly lifted the picture over his head and whirled to the
+stump,--"it shall go no farther. We will leave it here for the wolves
+and the crows and the pagan redmen."
+
+He dashed it down with all his strength, but Menard sprang forward,
+and caught it on his outstretched arm. "No, Father," he said; "we will
+take it with us."
+
+The priest smiled wearily, and lowered the picture to the ground; but
+when Menard said, "You have broken it," he raised it hastily, and
+examined it. One corner of the wooden frame was loosened, but the
+canvas was not injured.
+
+"I can mend it," he said.
+
+Then they walked to the camp together, without talking; and Menard
+helped him repair the frame, and pack the picture carefully.
+
+"How is it that it was not ruined in the capsize at Coteau des
+Cedres?" Menard asked.
+
+"It was preserved by a miracle, M'sieu. This bundle did not leave the
+canoe."
+
+The _voyageurs_, still lounging in the clearing, were laughing and
+talking noisily. The Captain, after he had prepared the maid's couch,
+and bade her good-night, called to them to be quiet. For a time the
+noise ceased, but a little later, as he was spreading his blanket on
+the ground, it began again, and one of the transport men sang the
+opening strain of a ribald song. Menard strode over to the group so
+quickly that he took them by surprise. Colin was slipping something
+behind him, but he could not escape Menard's eye. In a moment he was
+sprawling on his face, and a brandy flask was brought to light. Menard
+dashed it against a tree, and turned to the frightened men.
+
+"Go to your blankets, every man of you. There are Iroquois on this
+river. You have already made enough noise to draw them from half a
+league away. The next man that is caught drinking will be flogged." He
+thought of the maid lying under her frail shelter, for whose life he
+was responsible. "If it occurs twice, he will be shot. Perrot, I want
+you to join the sentry. From now on we shall have two men on guard all
+night. See that there is no mistake about this. At the slightest
+noise, you will call me."
+
+The men slunk to their blankets, and soon the camp was still.
+
+The river sang as it rushed down its zigzag channel through the
+rocks,--a song that seemed a part of the night, and yet was distinct
+from the creeping, rustling, dropping, all-pervading life and stir of
+the forest. Every leaf, every twig and root, every lump of sod and
+rock-held pool of stagnant water, had its own miniature world, where
+living things were fighting the battle of life. In the far distance,
+perhaps, an owl hooted; or near at hand a flying squirrel alighted on
+a bending elm-twig. Deer and moose followed their beaten tracks to the
+streams that had been theirs before ever Frenchman pierced the forest;
+beaver dove into their huts above the dams their own sharp teeth had
+made; moles nosed under the rich soil, and left a winding track
+behind; frogs croaked and bellowed from some backset of the
+river,--and all blended, not, perhaps, so much into a sound, as into a
+sense of movement,--an even murmur in a low key, to which the lighter
+note of the water was apart and distinct.
+
+To a man trained as Menard had been, this was companionship. He was
+never alone in the forest, never without his millions of friends, who,
+though they seldom came into his thoughts, were yet a part of him, of
+his sense of life and strength. And through all these noises, even to
+the roar of Niagara itself, he could sleep like a child, when the
+slightest sound of a moccasined foot on a dry leaf would have aroused
+him at the instant to full activity. To-night he lay awake for a long
+time. With every day that he drew nearer the frontier came graver
+doubts of the feasibility of the plan which had been intrusted to him.
+The wretched business of La Grange's treachery and the stocking of the
+King's galleys had probably alienated the Onondagas for all time.
+Their presence on the St. Lawrence pointed to this. He felt safe
+enough, personally, for the very imprudence of the Governor's
+campaign, which had made it known so early to all the Iroquois, was an
+element in his favour. The Iroquois, unlike many of the roaming
+western tribes, had their settled villages, with lodges and fields of
+grain to defend from invasion. One secret of the campaign had been
+well kept; no one save the Governor's staff and Menard knew that the
+blow was to fall on the Senecas alone. And Menard was certain enough
+in his knowledge of Iroquois character to believe that each tribe,
+from the Mohawks on the east to the Senecas on the west, would call in
+its warriors, and concentrate to defend its villages. Therefore there
+could be no strong force on the St. Lawrence, where the French could
+so easily cut it off. As for the Long Arrow and his band, eight good
+fighting men and a stout-hearted priest could attend to them.
+
+No, the danger would begin after the maid was safe at Frontenac, and
+he and Danton and Father Claude must set out to win the confidence of
+the Onondagas. The Oneidas and Mohawks must not be slighted; but the
+Onondagas and Cayugas, being the nearest to the Senecas, and between
+them and the other nations, would likely prove to be the key to the
+situation.
+
+The night was black when he awoke. Clouds had spread over the sky,
+hiding all but a strip in the west where a low line of stars peeped
+out. This strip was widening rapidly as the night breeze carried the
+clouds eastward. At a little distance some of the men were whispering
+together and laughing softly. A hand was feeling his arm, and a voice
+whispered,--
+
+"Quick, M'sieu; something has happened!"
+
+"Is that you, Colin?"
+
+"Yes. Guerin was on guard with me, and he fell. I thought I heard an
+arrow, but could not be sure. I looked for him after I heard him fall,
+but could not find him in the dark."
+
+Menard sprang to his feet, with his musket, which had lain at his side
+every night since leaving Montreal.
+
+"Where was Guerin, Colin?"
+
+"Straight back from the river, a few rods. He had spoken but a moment
+before. It must have told them where to shoot."
+
+"Call the men, and draw them close in a circle." Menard felt his way
+toward the fire, where a few red embers showed dimly, and roused
+Danton with a light touch and a whispered caution to be silent.
+Already he could hear the low stir of the _engagés_ as they slipped
+nearer the fire. He walked slowly toward the river, with one hand
+stretched out in front, to find the canoe. It was closer than he
+supposed, and he stumbled over it, knocking one end off its support.
+The maid awoke with a gasp.
+
+"Mademoiselle, silence!" he whispered, kneeling beside her. "I fear we
+are attacked. You must come with me." He had to say it twice before
+she could fully understand, and just then an arrow sang over them, and
+struck a tree with a low _thut_. He suddenly rose and shouted,
+"Together, boys! They will be on us in a moment. Close in at the bank,
+and save your powder. Perrot, come here and help me with the canoe."
+
+There was a burst of yells from the dark in answer to his call, and a
+few shots flashed. Danton was rallying the men, and calling to them to
+fall back, where they could take cover among the rocks and trees of
+the bank.
+
+The maid was silent, but she reached out her hand, and Menard,
+catching her wrist, helped her to her feet, and fairly carried her
+down the slope of the bank, laying her behind the tangled roots of a
+great oak. Already the sky was clearer, and the trees and men were
+beginning to take dim shape. The river rushed by, a deeper black than
+sky and woods, with a few ghostly bits of white where the foam of the
+rapids began.
+
+"Stay here," he whispered. "Don't move or speak. I shall not be far."
+
+She clung to his hand in a dazed manner, but he gently drew his away,
+and left her crouching on the ground.
+
+The men were calling to one another as they dodged back from tree to
+tree toward the river, shooting only when a flash from the woods
+showed the position of an Indian. Some of them were laughing, and as
+Menard reached the canoe Perrot broke into a jeering song. It was
+clear that the attacking party was not strong. Probably they had not
+taken into account the double guard, relying on the death of the
+sentry to clear the way for a surprise.
+
+"Perrot!" called the Captain. "Why don't you come here?"
+
+The song stopped. There was a heavy noise as the _voyageur_ came
+plunging through the bushes, drawing a shower of arrows and musket
+balls.
+
+"Careful, Perrot, careful."
+
+"They can't hit me," said Perrot, laughing. He stumbled against the
+Captain, stepped back, and fell over the canoe, rolling and kicking.
+Menard sprang toward him and jerked him up. He smelled strongly of
+brandy.
+
+Menard swore under his breath.
+
+"Pick up your musket. Take hold of that canoe,--quick!"
+
+Perrot was frightened by his stern words, and he succeeded in holding
+up an end of the canoe, while Menard pushed him down the slope to
+the water's edge. They rushed back, and in a few trips got down
+most of the stores. By this time Perrot was sobering somewhat, and
+with the Captain he took his place in the line. The men were
+shooting more frequently now, and by their loose talk showed
+increasing recklessness. Calling to Danton, Menard finally made
+them understand his order to fall back. Before they reached the
+bank, Colin dropped, with a ball through the head, and was dragged
+back by Danton.
+
+They dropped behind logs and trees at the top of the slope. It began
+to look as if the redmen were to get no closer, in spite of the
+drunken condition of all but one or two of the men. Though the night
+was now much brighter, they were in the shadow, and neither the
+Captain nor Danton observed that the brandy which the transport men
+had supplied was passing steadily from hand to hand. They could not
+know that the boy Guerin lay on his back amid the attacking Onondagas,
+an arrow sticking upright in his breast, one hand lying across his
+musket, the other clasping a flask.
+
+The maid had not moved. She could be easily seen now in the clearer
+light, and Menard went to her, feeling the need of giving her some
+work to occupy her mind during the strain of the fight.
+
+"Mademoiselle," he whispered.
+
+She looked up. He could see that she was shivering.
+
+"I must ask you to help me. We must get the canoe into the water. They
+will soon tire of the assault and withdraw; then it will be safe to
+take to the canoe. They cannot hurt you. We are protected by the
+bank."
+
+He helped her to rise, and she bravely threw her weight on the canoe,
+which Menard could so easily have lifted alone, and stood at the edge
+of the beach, passing him the bundles, which he, wading out, placed
+aboard. But suddenly he stopped, with an exclamation, peering into the
+canoe.
+
+The maid, dreading each moment some new danger, asked in a dry voice,
+"What is it, M'sieu?"
+
+For reply he seized the bundles, one at a time, and tossed them
+ashore, hauling the canoe after, and running his hand along the bark.
+
+The maid stepped to his side. There was a gaping hole in the side of
+the canoe. She drew her breath in quickly, and looked up at him.
+
+"It was Perrot," he muttered, "that fool Perrot." He stood looking at
+it, as if in doubt what to do. Up on the bank the men, Danton and
+Father Claude among them, were popping away at the rustling bushes.
+Suddenly he turned and gazed down at the maid's upturned face.
+"Mademoiselle," he said, "I do not think there is danger, but whatever
+happens you must keep close to me, or to Danton and Father Claude. It
+may be that there will be moments when we cannot stop and explain to
+you as I am doing now, but you must trust us, and believe that all
+will come out well. The other men are not themselves to-night--"
+
+He stopped. It was odd that he should so talk to a maid while his men
+were fighting for their lives; but the Menard who had the safety of
+this slender girl in his hands was not the Menard of a hundred battles
+gone by. So he lingered, not knowing why, save that he hoped for some
+word from her lips of confidence in those who wished to protect her.
+And, as he waited, she smiled with trembling lips, and said:--
+
+"It will come out well, M'sieu. I--I am not afraid."
+
+Then Menard went up the bank with a bound, and finding one man already
+in a stupor, and another struggling for a flask, which Father Claude
+was trying to take away from him, he laid about him with his hard
+fists, and shortly had the drunkards as near to their senses as they
+were destined to be during the short space they had yet to live.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII.
+
+A COMPLIMENT FOR MENARD.
+
+
+Colin and Guerin were dead, and one of the transport men lay in a
+drunken sleep, so that including Menard, Danton, and Father Claude
+there were six men in the little half circle that clung to the edge of
+the bank, shooting into the brush wherever a twig stirred or a musket
+flashed. "There are not many of them," said Menard to Danton, as they
+lay on their sides reloading. He listened to the whoops and barks in
+an interval between shots. "Not a score, all told."
+
+"Will they come closer?"
+
+"No. You won't catch an Iroquois risking his neck in an assault.
+They'll try to pick us off; but if we continue as strong as we are
+now, they are likely to draw off and try some other devilment, or wait
+for a better chance."
+
+Danton crept back to his log for another shot. Now that the sky was
+nearly free of clouds, and the river was sparkling in the starlight,
+the Frenchmen could not raise their heads to shoot without exposing a
+dim silhouette to the aim of an Indian musket. Father Claude, who was
+loading and firing a long _arquebuse ŕ croc_, had risen above this
+difficulty by heaping a pile of stones. Kneeling on the slope, a pace
+below the others, and resting the crutch of his piece in a hollow
+close to the stones, he could shoot through a crevice with little
+chance of harm, beyond a bruised shoulder.
+
+The maid came timidly up the bank, and touched Menard's arm.
+
+"What is it, Mademoiselle? You must not come here. It is not safe."
+
+"I want to speak to you, M'sieu. If I could have your knife--for one
+moment--"
+
+"What do you want of a knife, child? It is best that you--" There was
+a fusillade from the brush, and his voice was lost in the uproar. "You
+must wait below, on the beach. They cannot get to you."
+
+"It is the canoe, M'sieu. The cloth about the bales is stout,--I can
+sew it over the hole."
+
+Menard looked at her as she crouched by his side; her hair fallen
+about her face and shoulders; her hands, grimy with the clay of the
+bank, clinging to a wandering root. She was still trembling with
+excitement, but her eyes were bright and eager. Without a word he drew
+his knife from its sheath, and held it out. She took it, and was down
+the slope with a light spring, while the Captain poked the muzzle of
+his musket through the leaves. As he drew it back, after firing, he
+caught a glimpse of Danton's face, turned toward him with a curious
+expression. The boy laughed nervously, and wiped the sweat from his
+blackened forehead. "They don't give us much rest, Captain, do they?"
+Menard's reply was jerked out with the strokes of his ramrod: "They
+will--before long--and we can--take to the canoe. We're letting them
+have all they want." He peered through the leaves, and fired quickly.
+A long shriek came from the darkness. Menard laughed. "There's one
+more gone, Danton."
+
+The fight went on slowly, wretchedly, shot for shot, Danton himself
+dragging up a bale of ammunition and serving it to the men. The maid,
+unaided, had overturned the canoe where it lay, and with quickened
+breath was pressing her needle through the tough bark. Danton lost the
+flint from his musket, and crept down the bank to set a new one.
+Suddenly he exclaimed, "There goes Perrot!"
+
+The old _voyageur_ had, in a fit of recklessness, raised his head for
+a long look about the woods. Now he was rolling slowly down the slope
+toward the canoe and the maid, clutching weakly at roots and bushes as
+he passed. There was a dark spot on his forehead. Menard sprang after,
+and felt of his wrists; the pulse was fluttering out. He looked up, to
+see the maid dipping up water with her hollowed hands, and waved her
+back.
+
+"It is no use, Mademoiselle. Is the canoe ready? We may need it
+soon."
+
+She stood motionless, slowly shaking her head, and letting the water
+spill from her hands a drop at a time.
+
+"Go back there. Do what you can with it." He hurried up the bank and
+fell into his place.
+
+"Do you see what they are doing?" asked Danton.
+
+"Playing the devil. Anything else?"
+
+The lieutenant pointed to an arrow that was sticking in a tree beside
+him, slanting downward. "They are climbing trees. Listen. You can hear
+them talking, and calling down. I've fired, but I don't get them."
+
+Menard listened closely, and shot for the sound, but with no result.
+
+"We've got to stop this, Danton. I don't understand it. It isn't like
+the Iroquois to keep at it after a repulse. Tell Father Claude; he is
+shooting too low." Menard glanced along the line at his men. The
+drunken transport man lay silent at his post; beyond him were his mate
+and one of the Montreal men, both of them reckless and frightened by
+turns, shooting aimlessly into the dark. The arrows were rattling down
+about them now. One grazed Father Claude's back as he stooped to take
+aim, and straightened him up with a jerk. A moment later a bullet sang
+close past Menard's head. He looked for the maid; she was sitting by
+the canoe, sewing, giving no heed to the arrows.
+
+The Montreal man groaned softly, and flattened out, with an arrow
+slanting into the small of his back; which so unmanned the only other
+conscious _engagé_ that he sank by him, sobbing, and trying to pull
+out the arrow with his hands. Menard sprang up.
+
+"My God, Danton! Father Claude! This is massacre. Run for the canoe.
+My turn, eh?"
+
+"What is it?" asked Danton. "Did they get you?"
+
+For reply, Menard tore an arrow from the flesh of his forearm and
+dashed down the bank, musket in hand. The maid was tugging at the
+canoe, struggling to move it toward the water. She did not look up to
+see the yellow, crimson, and green painted figures rise from the reeds
+that fringed the water but a few yards away; she did not hear the rush
+of moccasined feet on the gravel. Before she could turn, she was
+seized and thrown to the ground, surrounded by the Indians, who were
+facing about hastily to meet Menard. The Captain came among them with
+a whirl of his musket that sent one warrior to the ground and dropped
+another, half stunned, across the canoe. Danton was at his heels, and
+Father Claude, fighting like demons with muskets and knives.
+
+"Quick, Mademoiselle!" Menard lifted her as he spoke, and swung her
+behind him; and then the three were facing the group of howling,
+jumping figures, which was increased rapidly by those who had followed
+the Frenchmen down the bank. "Come back here, Father. Protect the
+maid! They dare not attack you, if you drop your musket! Loose your
+hold, Mademoiselle." He caught roughly at the slender arms that held
+about his waist, parrying a knife stroke with his other hand. "They
+will kill you if you cling to me. Now, Danton! Never mind your arm. I
+have one in the hand. Fight for the maid and France!" Menard was
+shouting for sheer lust and frenzy of battle, "What is the matter with
+the devils? Why don't they shoot? God, Danton, they're coming at us
+with clubs!" He called out in the Iroquois tongue: "Come at us,
+cowards! Make an end of it! Where are your bows? your muskets? Where
+is the valour of the Onondagas--of my brothers?"
+
+The last words brought forth a chorus of jeers and yells. The two
+officers stood side by side at the water's edge. Behind them,
+knee-deep in the water, was Father Claude, holding the maid in his
+arms. The Indians seemed to draw together, still with that evident
+effort to take their game alive, for two tall chiefs were rushing
+about, cautioning the warriors. Then, of a sudden, the whole body came
+forward with a rush, and Menard, Danton, Father Claude, and the maid
+went down; the three men fighting and splashing until they lay, bound
+with thongs, on the beach.
+
+Menard turned his head and saw that Danton lay close to him.
+
+"Mademoiselle?" he said. "What have they done with her?"
+
+"She is here." The reply was in Father Claude's voice. It came from
+the farther side of Danton.
+
+"Is she hurt?"
+
+"No. But they have bound her and me."
+
+"Bound you!" The Captain tried to sit up, but could not. "They would
+not do that, Father. It is a mistake."
+
+A warrior, carrying a musket under his arm, walked slowly around the
+prisoners, making signs to them to be silent. The others had withdrawn
+to the shadow of the bank; the sound of their voices came indistinctly
+across the strip of shore. Indifferent to the pain in his arm, Menard
+struggled at his thongs, and called to them in Iroquois: "Who of my
+brothers has bound the holy Father? What new fear strikes the breasts
+of the sons of the night-wind that they must subdue with force the
+gentle spirit of their Father, who has given his years for his
+children? Is it not enough that you have broken the faith with your
+brother, the child of your own village, the son of your bravest chief?
+Need you other prey than myself?"
+
+The guard stood over Menard, and lifted his musket. Menard laughed.
+
+"Strike me, brave warrior. Show that your heart is still as fond as on
+the day I carried your torn body on my shoulder to the safety of your
+lodge. Ah, you remember? You have not forgotten the Big Buffalo? Then,
+why do you hesitate? The man who has courage to seize a Father of the
+Church, surely can strike his brother. This is not the brave Tegakwita
+I have known."
+
+Father Claude broke in on Menard, whose voice was savage in its
+defiance.
+
+"Have patience, M'sieu. I will speak." He lifted his voice.
+"Teganouan! Father Claude awaits you." There was no reply from the
+knot of warriors at the bank, and the priest called again. Finally a
+chief came across and looked stolidly at the prisoners.
+
+"My Father called?" he said.
+
+"Your Father is grieved, Long Arrow, that you would bind him like a
+soldier taken in war." The priest's voice was gentle. "Is this the
+custom of the Onondagas? It was not so when I served you with Father
+de Lamberville."
+
+"My Father fought against his children."
+
+"You would have slain me, Long Arrow, had I not."
+
+The Indian walked slowly back to his braves, and for some moments
+there was a consultation. Then the other chief came to them, and,
+without a word, himself cut the thongs that bound the priest's wrists
+and ankles. There was no look of recognition in his eyes as he passed
+Menard, though they had been together on many a long hunt. He was the
+Beaver.
+
+As the Captain lay on his back, looking first at the kneeling Indian,
+then at the sky overhead, he was thinking of the Long Arrow, again
+with a half-memory of some other occasion when they had met. Then,
+slowly, it came to him. It was at the last council to decide on his
+release from captivity, five years before. The Long Arrow had come
+from a distant village to urge the death of the prisoner. He had
+argued eloquently that to release Menard would be to send forth an
+ungrateful son who would one day strike at the hand that had
+befriended him.
+
+Father Claude was on his feet, chafing his wrists and talking with the
+Beaver. The Long Arrow joined them, and for a few moments the chiefs
+reasoned together in low, dignified tones. Then, at a word from the
+Beaver, and a grunt of disgust from the Long Arrow, Father Claude,
+with quick fingers, set the maid free, and took her head upon his
+knee.
+
+"Have they hurt her, Father?" asked Menard, in French.
+
+"No, M'sieu, I think not. It is the excitement. The child sadly needs
+rest."
+
+"Will they release you? It is not far to Frontenac. It may be that you
+can reach there with Mademoiselle."
+
+"No, my son." The priest paused to dip up some water, and to stroke
+the maid's forehead and wrists. "They have some design which has not
+been made clear to me. They have promised not to bind me or to injure
+what belongs to me among the supplies. But the Beaver threatens to
+kill us if we try to escape, Mademoiselle and I."
+
+"Why do they hold you?"
+
+"To let no word go out concerning your capture. I fear, M'sieu--"
+
+"Well?"
+
+The priest lowered his eyes to the maid, who still lay fainting, and
+said no more. A long hour went by, with only a commonplace word now
+and then between the prisoners. The maid revived, and sat against the
+canoe, gazing over the water that swept softly by. Danton lay silent,
+saying nothing. Once a groan slipped past the Captain's lips at a
+twitch of his wounded arm, and Father Claude, immediately cheered by
+the prospect of a moment's occupation, cleaned the wound with cool
+water, and bandaged it with a strip from his robe.
+
+Preparations were making for a start. A half-dozen braves set out,
+running down the beach; and shortly returned by way of the river with
+two canoes. The others had opened the bales of supplies (excepting
+Father Claude's bundle, which he kept by him), and divided the food
+and ammunition among themselves. The two chiefs came to the prisoners,
+and seated themselves on the gravel. The Long Arrow began talking.
+
+"My brother, the Big Buffalo, is surprised that he should be taken a
+prisoner to the villages of the Onondagas. He thinks of the days when
+he shared with us our hunts, our lodges, our food, our trophies; when
+he lived a free life with his brothers, and parted from them with
+sadness in his voice. He had a grateful heart for the Onondagas then.
+When he left our lodges he placed his hand upon the hearts of our
+chiefs, he swore by his strange gods to keep the pledge of friendship
+to his brothers of the forest. Moons have come and gone many times
+since he left our villages. The snow has fallen for five seasons
+between him and us, to chill his heart against those who have
+befriended him. Twice has he been in battle when we might have taken
+him a prisoner, but the hearts of our braves were warm toward him, and
+they could not lift their arms. When there have been those who have
+urged that the hatchet be taken up against him, many others have come
+forward to say, 'No; he will yet prove our friend and our brother.'"
+
+Menard lay without moving, looking up at the stars. Danton, by his
+side, and the maid, sitting beyond, were watching him anxiously.
+Father Claude stood erect, with folded arms.
+
+"And now," continued the chief, "now that Onontio, the greatest of war
+chiefs, thinks that he is strong, and can with a blow destroy our
+villages and drive us from the lands our gods and your gods have said
+to be ours by right, as it was our fathers',--now there is no longer
+need for the friendship of the Onondagas, whose whole nation is fewer
+than the fighting braves of the great Onontio. The war-song is sung in
+every white village. The great canoes take food and powder up our
+river, for those who would destroy us."
+
+Menard was still looking upward. "My brother," he said, speaking
+slowly, "was once a young brave. When he was called before his great
+chief, and commanded to go out and fight to save his village and his
+brothers and sisters, did he say to his chief: 'No, my father, I will
+no longer obey your commands. I will no longer strive to become a
+famous warrior of your nation. I will go away into the deep
+forest,--alone, without a lodge, without a nation, to be despised
+alike by my brothers and my foes?' Or did he go as he was bid,
+obeying, like a brave warrior, the commands of those who have a right
+to command? Does not the Long Arrow know that Onontio is the greatest
+of chiefs, second only to the Great-Chief-Across-the-Water, the father
+of red men and white men? If Onontio's red sons are disobedient, and
+he commands me to chastise them, shall I say to my father, 'I cannot
+obey your will, I will become an outcast, without a village or a
+nation?' The Long Arrow is a wise man. He knows that the duty of all
+is to obey the father at Quebec."
+
+"The Big Buffalo speaks with wisdom. But it may be he forgets that our
+braves have passed him by in the battles of every season since he left
+our villages. He forgets that he met a band of peaceful hunters from
+our nation, who went into his great stone house because they believed
+that his white brothers, if not himself, would keep the word of
+friendship. He forgets that they were made to drink of the white man's
+fire water, and were chained together to become slaves of the great
+kind Chief-Across-the-Water, who loves his children, and would make
+them mighty in his land. Is this the father he would have us obey?
+Truly, he speaks with an idle tongue."
+
+Menard lay silent. His part in La Grange's treachery, and in carrying
+out later the Governor's orders, would be hard to explain. To lay the
+blame on La Grange would not help his case, at least until he could
+consult with Father Claude, and be prepared to speak deliberately.
+
+"My brother does not reply?"
+
+"He will ask a question," replied Menard. "What is the will of the
+chiefs to do with the sons of Onontio?"
+
+"The Big Buffalo has seen the punishment given by the Onondagas to
+those who have broken their faith."
+
+"I understand. And of course we shall be taken to your villages before
+this death shall come?"
+
+The Long Arrow bowed.
+
+"Very well," said Menard, in his slow voice. "As the Long Arrow, brave
+as he is, is but a messenger, obeying the will of the nation, I will
+withhold my word until I shall be brought before your chiefs in
+council. I shall have much to say to them; it need be said only once.
+I shall be pleased to tell my truths to the Big Throat, whose eyes can
+see beyond the limits of his lodge; who knows that the hand of Onontio
+is a firm and strong hand. He shall know from my lips how kind Onontio
+wishes to be to his ungrateful children--" He paused. The Indians must
+not know yet that the Governor's campaign was to be directed only
+against the Senecas. The mention of the Big Throat would, he knew, be
+a shaft tipped with jealousy in the breast of the Long Arrow. The Big
+Throat, Otreouati, was the widest famed orator and chief of the
+Onondagas; and it was he who had adopted Menard as his son. Above all,
+the Long Arrow would not dare to do away with so important a prisoner
+before he could be brought before the council.
+
+The maid was leaning forward, following their words intently. "Oh,
+M'sieu," she said, "I cannot understand it all. What will they do with
+you?"
+
+Menard hesitated, and replied in French without turning his head:
+"They will take us to their villages below Lake Ontario. They will not
+harm you, under Father Claude's protection. And then it is likely that
+we may be rescued before they can get off the river."
+
+"But yourself, M'sieu? They are angry with you. What will they do?"
+
+"Lieutenant Danton and I must look out for ourselves. I shall hope
+that we may find a way out."
+
+The Long Arrow was looking closely at them, evidently resenting a
+woman's voice in the talk. At the silence, he spoke in the same low
+voice, but Menard and Father Claude read the emotion underneath.
+
+"It may be that the Big Buffalo has never had a son to brighten his
+days as his life reaches the downward years. It may be that he has not
+watched the papoose become a fleet youth, and the youth a tireless
+hunter. He may not have waited for the day when the young hunter
+should take his seat at the council and speak with those who will hear
+none but wise men. I had such a son. He went on the hunt with a band
+that never returned to the village." His voice rose above the pitch
+customary to a chief. It was almost cold in its intensity. "I found
+his body, my brother, the body of my son, at this place, killed by the
+white men, who talked to us of the love of their gods and their
+Chief-Across-the-Water. Here it was I found him, who died before he
+would become the slave of a white man; and here I have captured the
+man who killed him. It is well that we have not killed my brother
+to-night. It is better that we should take him alive before the
+council of the Onondagas, who once were proud in their hearts that he
+was of their own nation."
+
+The maid's eyes, shining with tears, were fixed on the Indian's face.
+She had caught up with her hand the flying masses of her hair and
+braided them hastily; but still there were locks astray, touched by
+the light of the starlit sky. Menard turned his head, and watched her
+during the long silence. Danton was watching her too. He had not
+understood the chief's story, but it was clear from her face that she
+had caught it all. It was Father Claude who finally spoke. His voice
+was gentle, but it had the air of authority which his long experience
+had taught him was necessary in dealing with the Indians.
+
+"The Big Buffalo has said wisely. He will speak only to the great
+chiefs of the nation, who will understand what may be beyond the minds
+of others. The heart of the Long Arrow is sad, his spirit cast down,
+and he does not see now what to-morrow he may,--that the hand of the
+Big Buffalo is not stained with the blood of his son. We will go to
+your village, and tell your chiefs many things they cannot yet know.
+For the Big Buffalo and his young brother, I shall ask only the
+justice which the Onondagas know best how to give. For myself and my
+sister, I am not afraid. We will follow your course, to come back when
+the chiefs shall order it."
+
+The two Indians exchanged a few signs, rose, and went to the scattered
+group of braves, who were feasting on the white men's stores. In a
+moment these had thrown the bundles together, and were getting the
+canoes into the water. Two warriors cut Danton's thongs and raised him
+to his feet. He rubbed his wrists, where the thongs had broken the
+skin, and stepped about to get the stiffness from his ankles. Then he
+bent down to set Menard loose, but was thrown roughly back.
+
+"What's this? What's the matter? Do you understand this, Menard?"
+
+"I think so," replied the Captain, quietly.
+
+"What is it?"
+
+"A little compliment to me, that is all."
+
+Danton stood looking at him in surprise, until he was hustled to
+the nearest canoe and ordered to take a paddle. He looked back and
+saw four warriors lift Menard, still bound hand and foot, and
+carry him to the other canoe, laying him in the bottom beneath the
+bracing-strips. Father Claude, too, was given a paddle. Then they
+glided away over the still water, into a mysterious channel that
+wound from one shadow-bound stretch to another, past islands that
+developed faintly from the blackness ahead and faded into the
+blackness behind. The lean arms of the Indians swung with a
+tireless rhythm, and their paddles slipped to and fro in the water
+with never a sound, save now and then a low splash.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII.
+
+THE MAID MAKES NEW FRIENDS.
+
+
+The prisoners were allowed some freedom in the Onondaga village. They
+were not bound, and they could wander about within call of the low hut
+which had been assigned to them. This laxity misled Danton into
+supposing that escape was practicable.
+
+"See," he said to Menard, "no one is watching. Once the dark has come
+we can slip away, all of us."
+
+Menard shook his head.
+
+"Do you see the two warriors sitting by the hut yonder,--and the group
+playing platter among the trees behind us? Did you suppose they were
+idling?"
+
+"They seem to sleep often."
+
+"You could not do it. We shall hope to get away safely; but it will
+not be like that."
+
+Danton was not convinced. He said nothing further, but late on that
+first night he made the attempt alone. The others were asleep, and
+suspected nothing until the morning. Then Father Claude, who came and
+went freely among the Indians, brought word that he had been caught a
+league to the north. The Indians bound him, and tied him to stakes in
+a strongly guarded hut. This much the priest learned from Tegakwita,
+the warrior who had guarded them on the night of their capture. After
+Menard's appeal to his gratitude he had shown a willingness to be
+friendly, and, though he dared do little openly, he had given the
+captives many a comfort on the hard journey southward.
+
+Later in the morning Menard and Mademoiselle St. Denis were sitting at
+the door of their hut. The irregular street was quiet, excepting for
+here and there a group of naked children playing, or a squaw passing
+with a load of firewood on her back. An Indian girl came in from the
+woods toward them. She was of light, strong figure, with a full face
+and long hair, which was held back from her face by bright ribbons.
+Her dress showed more than one sign of Mission life. She was cleaner
+than most of the Indians, and was not unattractive. She came to them
+without hesitation.
+
+"I am Tegakwita's sister. My name is Mary; the Fathers at the Mission
+gave it to me."
+
+Menard hardly gave her a glance, but Mademoiselle was interested.
+
+"That is not your Indian name?" she asked.
+
+"Yes,--Mary."
+
+"Did you never have another?"
+
+"My other name is forgotten."
+
+"These Mission girls like to ape our ways," said Menard, in French.
+
+The girl looked curiously at them, then she untied a fold of her
+skirt, and showed a heap of strawberries. "For the white man's squaw,"
+she said.
+
+Mademoiselle blushed and laughed. "Thank you," she replied, holding
+out her hands. The girl gave her the berries, and turned away. Menard
+looked up as a thought came to him.
+
+"Wait, Mary. Do you know where the young white chief is?"
+
+"Yes. He tried to run away. He cannot run away from our warriors."
+
+"Are you afraid to go to him?"
+
+"My brother, Tegakwita, is guarding him. I am not afraid."
+
+Menard went to a young birch tree that stood near the hut, peeled off
+a strip of bark, and wrote on it:--
+
+"If you try to escape again you will endanger my plans. Keep your
+patience, and I can save you."
+
+"Will you take him some berries, and give him this charm with them?"
+
+She took the note, rolled it up with a nod, and went away. Menard saw
+the question in Mademoiselle's eyes, and said: "It was a warning to be
+cool. Our hope is in getting the good-will of the chiefs."
+
+"Will they--will they hurt him, M'sieu?"
+
+"I hope not. At least we are still alive and safe; and years ago,
+Mademoiselle, I learned how much that means."
+
+The maid looked into the trees without replying. Her face had lost
+much of its fulness, and only the heavy tan concealed the worn
+outlines. But her eyes were still bright, and her spirit, now that the
+first shock had passed, was firm.
+
+Father Claude returned, after a time, with a heavy face. He drew
+Menard into the hut, and told him what he had gathered: that the Long
+Arrow and his followers were planning a final vengeance against
+Captain Menard. All the braves knew of it; everywhere they were
+talking of it, and preparing for the feasting and dancing.
+
+"They will wait until after the fighting, won't they?"
+
+"No, M'sieu. It is planned to begin soon, within a day or two."
+
+"Have you inquired for the Big Throat?"
+
+"He is five leagues away, at the next village. We can hardly hope for
+help from him, I fear. All the tribes are preparing to join in
+fighting our troops."
+
+Menard paused to think.
+
+"It looks bad, Father." He walked up and down the hut. "The Governor's
+column must have followed up the river within a few days of us. Then
+much time was lost in getting us down here." He turned almost fiercely
+to the priest. "Why, the campaign may have opened already. Word may
+come to-morrow from the Senecas calling out the Onondagas and Cayugas.
+Do you know what that means? It means that I have failed,--for the
+first time in my life, Father,--miserably failed. There must be some
+way out. If I could only get word to the Big Throat. I'm certain I
+could talk him over. I have done it before."
+
+Father Claude had never before seen despair in Menard's eyes.
+
+"You speak well, M'sieu. There must be some way. God is with us."
+
+The Captain was again pacing the beaten floor. Finally he came to the
+priest, and took his arm. "I don't know what it is that gives me
+courage, Father, but at my age a man isn't ready to give up. They may
+kill me, if they like, but not before I've carried out my orders. The
+Onondagas must not join the Senecas."
+
+"How"--began the priest.
+
+Menard shook his head. "I don't know yet,--but we can do it." He went
+out of doors, as if the sunlight could help him, and during the rest
+of the day and evening he roamed about or lay motionless under the
+trees. The maid watched him until dark, but kept silent; for Father
+Claude had told her, and she, too, believed that he would find a way.
+
+Late in the evening Father Claude began to feel disturbed. Menard was
+still somewhere off among the trees. He had come in for his handful of
+grain, at the supper hour, but with hardly a word. The Father had
+never succeeded, save on that one occasion when Danton was the
+subject, in carrying on a long conversation with the maid; and now
+after a few sorry attempts he went out of doors. He thought of going
+to the Captain, to cheer his soul and prepare his mind for whatever
+fate awaited him, but his better judgment held him back.
+
+The village had no surface excitement to suggest coming butchery and
+war. The children were either asleep or playing in the open. Warriors
+walked slowly about, wrapped closely in blankets, though the night was
+warm. The gnats and mosquitoes were humming lazily, the trees barely
+stirring, and the voices of gossiping squaws or merry youths blended
+into a low drone. There was the smell in the air of wood and leaves
+burning, from a hundred smouldering fires. Father Claude stood for a
+long time gazing at the row of huts, and wondering that such an air of
+peace and happiness could hover over a den of brute savages, who were
+even at the moment planning to torture to his death one of the bravest
+sons of New France.
+
+While he meditated, he was half conscious of voices near at hand. He
+gave it no attention until his quick ear caught a French word. He
+started, and hurried to the hut, pausing in the door. By the dim light
+of the fire, that burned each night in the centre of the floor, he
+could see Mademoiselle standing against the wall, with hands clasped
+and lips parted. Nearer, with his back to the door, stood an Indian.
+
+The maid saw the Father, but did not speak. He came forward into the
+hut, and gently touched the Indian's arm.
+
+"What is it?" he asked in Iroquois.
+
+The Indian stood, without a reply, until the silence grew heavy.
+Mademoiselle had straightened up, and was watching with fascinated
+eyes. Then, slowly, the warrior turned, and beneath buckskin and
+feathers, dirt and smeared colours, the priest recognized Danton. He
+turned sadly to the maid.
+
+"I do not understand," he said.
+
+She put her hands before her eyes. "I cannot talk to him," she said,
+in a broken voice. "Why does he come? Why must I--" Then she collected
+herself, and came forward. Pity and dignity were in her voice. "I am
+sorry, Lieutenant Danton. I am very sorry."
+
+The boy choked, and Father Claude drew him, unresisting, outside the
+hut.
+
+"How did you come here, Danton? Tell me."
+
+Danton looked at him defiantly.
+
+"What does this mean? Where did you get these clothes?"
+
+"It matters not where I got them. It is my affair."
+
+"Who gave you these clothes?"
+
+"It is enough that I have friends, if those whom I thought friends
+will not aid me."
+
+The priest was pained by the boy's rough words.
+
+"I am sorry for this, my son,--for this strange disorder. Did you not
+receive a message from your Captain?"
+
+Danton hesitated. "Yes," he said at last. "I received a message,--an
+order to lie quiet, and let these red beasts burn me to death. Menard
+is a fool. Does he not know that they will kill him? Does he not know
+that this is his only chance to escape? He is a fool, I say."
+
+"You forget, my son."
+
+"Well, if I do? Must I stay here for the torture because my Captain
+commands? Why do you hold me here? Let me go. They will be after me."
+
+"Wait, Danton. What have you said to Mademoiselle?"
+
+The boy looked at him, and for a moment could not speak.
+
+"Do you, too, throw that at me, Father? It was all I could do. I
+thought she cared for her life more than for--for Menard. No, let me
+go on. I have risked everything to come for her, and she--she--I did
+not know it would be like this."
+
+"But what do you plan?" The priest's voice was more gentle. "Where are
+you going? You cannot get to Frontenac alone."
+
+"I don't know," replied Danton wearily, turning away. "I don't care
+now. I may as well go to the devil."
+
+Without a word of farewell he walked boldly off through the trees,
+drawing his blanket about his shoulders. Father Claude stood watching
+him, half in mind to call Menard, then hesitating. Already the boy was
+committed: he had broken his bonds, and to make any effort to hold him
+meant certain death for him. Perhaps it was better that he should take
+the only chance left to him. The hut was silent. He looked within, and
+saw the maid still standing by the wall. Her eyes were on him, but she
+said nothing, and he turned away. He walked slowly up and down under
+the great elms that arched far up over his head. At last he looked
+about for the Captain, and finding him some little way back in the
+woods, told him the story.
+
+Menard's face had aged during the day. His eyes had a dull firmness in
+place of the old flash. He heard the account without a word, and, at
+the close, when the priest looked at him questioningly for a reply, he
+shook his head sadly. His experiment with Danton had failed.
+
+"He didn't tell you who had helped him?"
+
+"No, M'sieu. It is very strange."
+
+"Yes," said Menard, "it is."
+
+The night passed without further incident. Early in the morning,
+Father Claude went out to find Tegakwita, and learn what news had come
+in during the night of the French column. Runners were employed in
+passing daily between the different villages, keeping each tribe fully
+informed.
+
+Menard sat before the hut. The clearing showed more life than on the
+preceding day. Bands of warriors, hunting and scouting parties, were
+coming in at short intervals, scattering to their shelters or hurrying
+to the long building in the centre of the village. The growing boys
+and younger warriors ran about, calling to one another in eager,
+excited voices. As the morning wore along, grave chiefs and braves,
+wrapped in their blankets, walked by on their way to the council
+house.
+
+The maid, after Father Claude had gone, watched the Captain for a long
+time through the open door. The conversation with the Long Arrow, on
+the night of their capture, had been burned into her memory; and now,
+as she looked at Menard's drawn face and weary eyes, the picture came
+to her again of the Long Arrow sitting by the river in the dim light
+of the stars,--and of the white man who had fought for her, lying
+before him, gazing upward and speaking with a calm voice to the stern
+chief who wished to kill him. Then, in spite of the excitement, the
+danger, and exhaustion of the fight, it had seemed that the Captain
+could not long be held by this savage. His stern manner, his command,
+had given her a confidence which had, until this moment, strengthened
+her. But now, of a sudden, she saw in his eyes the look of a man who
+sees no way ahead. This quarrel with the Long Arrow was no matter of
+open warfare, even of race against race; it was an eye for an eye, the
+demand of a crazed father for the life of the slayer of his son. That
+she could do nothing, that she must sit feebly while he went to his
+death, came to her with a dead sense of pain.
+
+With a restless spirit she went out of doors, passing him with a
+little smile; but he did not look up. A group of passing youths
+stopped and jeered at him, but he did not give them a glance. She
+shrank back against the building until they had gone on.
+
+"Do not mind them, Mademoiselle," said Menard, quietly. "They will not
+harm you."
+
+She hesitated by his side, half in mind to speak to him, to tell him
+that she knew his trouble, and had faith in him, but his bowed head
+was forbidding in its solitude. All about the hut, under the spreading
+trees, was a stretch of coarse green sod, dotted with tiny yellow
+flowers and black-centred daisies. She wandered over the grass,
+gathering them until her hands were full. Two red boys came by, and
+paused to cry at her, taunting her as if she, too, were to meet the
+fate of a war captive. The thought made her shudder, but then, on an
+impulse, she called to them in their own language. They looked at each
+other in surprise. She walked toward them, laying down the flowers,
+and holding out her hand. A little later, when Menard looked up, he
+saw her sitting beneath a gnarled oak, a boy on either side eagerly
+watching her. She was talking and laughing with them, and teaching
+them to make a screeching pipe with grass-blades held between the
+thumbs. He envied her her elastic spirits.
+
+"You have made two friends," he called in French.
+
+She looked up and nodded, laughing. "They are learning to make the
+music of the white brothers."
+
+The boys' faces had sobered at the sound of his voice. They looked at
+him doubtfully, and then at each other. He got up and walked slowly
+toward them.
+
+"I will make friends, too, Mademoiselle," he said, smiling. "We have
+none too many here."
+
+Before he had taken a dozen steps, the boys arose. He held out his
+hands, saying, "Your father would be friends with his children." But
+they began to retreat, a step at a time.
+
+"Come, my children," said the maid, smiling at the words as she
+uttered them. "The white father is good. He will not hurt you."
+
+They kept stepping backward until he had reached the maid's side;
+then, with a shout of defiance, they scampered away. In the distance
+they stopped, and soon were the centre of a group of children whom
+they taught to blow on the grass-blades, with many a half-frightened
+glance toward Menard and the maid.
+
+"There," he said, at length, "you may see the advantage of a
+reputation."
+
+She looked at him, and, moved by the pathos underlying the words,
+could not, for the moment, reply.
+
+"I once had a home in this village," he added. "It stood over there,
+in the bare spot near the beech tree." His eyes rested on the spot for
+a moment, then he turned back to the hut.
+
+"M'sieu," she said shyly.
+
+The little heap of flowers lay where she had dropped them; and, taking
+them up, she arranged them hastily and held them out. "Won't you take
+them?"
+
+He looked at her, a little surprised, then held out his hand.
+
+"Why,--thank you. I don't know what I can do with them."
+
+They walked back together.
+
+"You must wear some of the daisies, Mademoiselle. They will look
+well."
+
+She looked down at her torn, stained dress, and laughed softly; but
+took the white cluster he gave her, and thrust the stems through a
+tattered bit of lace on her breast.
+
+Menard was plainly relieved by the incident. He had been worn near to
+despair, facing a difficulty which seemed every moment farther from a
+solution; and now he turned to her fresh, light mood as to a refuge.
+
+"We must put these in water, Mademoiselle, or they will soon lose
+their bloom."
+
+"If we had a cup--?"
+
+"A cup? A woodsman would laugh at your question. There is the spring,
+here is the birch; what more could you have?"
+
+"You mean--?"
+
+"We will make a cup,--if you will hold the flowers. They are
+beautiful, Mademoiselle. No nation has such hills and lakes and
+flowers as the Iroquois. The Hurons boast of their lake country,--and
+the Sacs and Foxes, too, though they have a duller eye for the
+picturesque. See--the valley yonder--" He pointed through a rift in
+the foliage to the league-long glimpse of green, bound in by the
+gentle hills that rose beyond--"even to the tired old soldier there is
+nothing more beautiful, more peaceful."
+
+He peeled a long strip of bark from the birch tree, and rolled it into
+a cup. "Your needle and thread, Mademoiselle,--if they have not taken
+them."
+
+"No; I have everything here."
+
+She got her needle, and under his direction stitched the edges of the
+bark.
+
+"But it will leak, M'sieu."
+
+He laughed. "The tree is the Indian's friend, Mademoiselle. Now it is
+a pine tree that we need. The guards will tell me of one."
+
+He walked over to the little group of warriors still at their game of
+platter,--the one never-ceasing recreation of the Onondagas, at which
+they would one day gamble away blankets, furs, homes, even squaws,
+only to win them back on the next. They looked at him suspiciously
+when he questioned them; but he was now as light of heart as on the
+day, a few weeks earlier, when he had leaned on the balcony of the
+citadel at Quebec, idly watching the river. He smiled at them, and
+after a parley the maid saw one tall brave point to a tree a few yards
+farther in the wood. They followed him closely with their eyes until
+he was back within the space allowed him.
+
+"Now, Mademoiselle, we can gum the seams,--see? It is so easy. The
+cold water will harden it."
+
+They went together to the spring and filled the cup, first drinking
+each a draught. He rolled a large stone to the hut door, and set the
+cup on it.
+
+"Oh, Mademoiselle, it will not stand. I am not a good workman, I fear.
+But then, it is not often in a woodsman's life that he keeps flowers
+at his door. We must have some smaller stones to prop it up."
+
+"I will get them, M'sieu." In spite of his protests she ran out to the
+path and brought some pebbles. "Now we have decorated our home." She
+sat upon the ground, leaning against the log wall, and smiling up at
+him. "Sit down, M'sieu. I am tired of being solemn, we have been
+solemn so long."
+
+Already the heaviness was coming back on the Captain. He wondered, as
+he looked at her, if she knew how serious their situation was. It
+hardly seemed that she could understand it, her gay mood was so
+genuine. She glanced up again, and at the sight of the settling lines
+about his mouth and the fading sparkle in his eyes, her own eyes,
+while the smile still hovered, grew moist.
+
+"I am sorry," she said softly,--"very, very sorry."
+
+He sat near by, and fingered the flowers in the birch cup. They were
+both silent. Finally she spoke.
+
+"M'sieu."
+
+He looked down.
+
+"It may be that you think that--that I do not understand. It is not
+that, M'sieu. But when I think about it, and the sadness comes, I
+know, some way, that it is going to come out all right. We are
+prisoners, but other people have been prisoners, too. I have heard of
+many of them from Father Dumont. He himself has suffered among the
+Oneidas. I--I cannot believe it, even when it seems the darkest."
+
+"I hope you are right, Mademoiselle. I, too, have felt that there must
+be a way. And at the worst, they will not dare to hurt Father Claude
+and--you." And under his breath he added, "Thank God."
+
+"They will not dare to hurt you, M'sieu. They must not do it." She
+rose and stood before him. "When I think of that,--that you, who have
+done so much that I might be safe, are in danger, I feel that it would
+be cowardly for me to go away without you. You would not have left me,
+on the river. I know you would have died without a thought. And I--if
+anything should happen, M'sieu; if Father Claude and I should be set
+free, and--without you--I could never put it from my thoughts. I
+should always feel that I--that you--no no, M'sieu. They cannot do
+it."
+
+She shook away a tear, and looked at him with an honest, fearless
+gaze. It was the outpouring of a grateful heart, true because she
+herself was true, because she could not accept his care and sacrifice
+without a thought of what she owed him.
+
+"You forget," he said gently, "that it was not your fault. They could
+have caught me as easily if you had not been there. It is a soldier's
+chance, Mademoiselle. He must take what life brings, with no
+complaint. It is the young man's mistake to be restless, impatient.
+For the rest of us, why, it is our life."
+
+"But, M'sieu, you are not discouraged? You have not given up?"
+
+"No, I have not given up." He rose and looked into her eyes. "I have
+come through before; I may again. If I am not to get through, I shall
+fight them till I drop. And then, I pray God, I may die like a
+soldier."
+
+He turned away and went into the hut. He was in the hardest moment of
+his trial. It was the inability to fight, the lack of freedom, of
+weapons, the sense of helplessness, that had come nearer to
+demoralizing Menard than a hundred battles. He had been trusted with
+the life of a maid, and, more important still, with the Governor's
+orders. He was, it seemed, to fail.
+
+The maid stood looking after him. She heard him drop to the ground
+within. Then she roamed aimlessly about, near the building.
+
+Father Claude came up the path, walking slowly and wearily, and
+entered the hut. A moment later Menard appeared in the doorway and
+called:--
+
+"Mademoiselle." As she approached, he said gravely, "I should like it
+if you will come in with us. It is right that you should have a voice
+in our councils."
+
+She followed him in, wondering.
+
+"Father Claude has news," Menard said.
+
+The priest told them all that he had been able to learn. Runners had
+been coming in during the night at intervals of a few hours. They
+brought word of the landing of the French column at La Famine. The
+troops had started inland toward the Seneca villages. The Senecas were
+planning an ambush, and meanwhile had sent frantic messages to the
+other tribes for aid. The Cayuga chiefs were already on the way to
+meet in council with the Onondagas. The chance that the attack might
+be aimed only at the Senecas, to punish them for their depredations of
+the year before, had given rise to a peace sentiment among the more
+prudent Onondagas and Cayugas, who feared the destruction of their
+fields and villages. Up to the present, none had known where the
+French would strike. But, nevertheless, said the priest, the general
+opinion was favourable to taking up the quarrel with the Senecas.
+
+Further, the French were leaving a rearguard of four hundred men in a
+hastily built stockade at La Famine, and the more loose-tongued
+warriors were already talking of an attack on this force, cutting the
+Governor's communications, and then turning on him from the rear,
+leaving it to the Senecas to engage him in front.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX.
+
+THE WORD OF AN ONONDAGA.
+
+
+For a long time after Father Claude had finished speaking, the three
+sat talking over the situation. Even the maid had suggestions. But
+when all had been said, when the chances of a rescue by the French, or
+of getting a hearing before the council, even of a wild dash for
+liberty, had been gone over and over, their voices died away, and the
+silence was eloquent. D'Orvilliers would know that only capture could
+have prevented them from reaching the fort; but even supposing him to
+believe that they were held by the Onondagas, he had neither the men
+nor the authority to fight through the Cayuga lakes and hills to reach
+them. As for the Governor's column, it would have its hands full
+before marching ten leagues from La Famine. Had Menard been alone, he
+would have made the attempt to escape, knowing from the start that the
+chance was near to nothing, but glad of the opportunity at least to
+die fighting. But with Mademoiselle to delay their progress, and to
+suffer his fate if captured, it was different. As matters stood, she
+was likely to be released with Father Claude, as soon as he should be
+disposed of. And so his mind had settled on staying, and dying, if he
+must, alone.
+
+"I have not known whether to tell all," said Father Claude, after the
+silence. "And yet it would seem that Mademoiselle may as well know the
+truth now as later."
+
+"You have not told me?" she said, with reproach in her voice. "Must I
+always be a child to you, Father? If God has seen it best to place me
+here, am I not to help bear the burden?"
+
+"Mademoiselle is right, Father. Hold nothing back. Three stout hearts
+are better than two."
+
+The priest looked gravely at the fire.
+
+"The word has gone out," he said. "The Long Arrow, by his energy and
+his eloquence, but most of all because he had the courage to capture
+the Big Buffalo in the enemy's country with but a score of braves, now
+controls the village. To-morrow night the great council will begin.
+The war chiefs of all the Cayuga and Onondaga and Oneida and Mohawk
+villages will meet here and decide whether to take up the hatchet
+against the white men. The Long Arrow well knows that his power will
+last only until the greater chiefs come, and he will have his revenge
+before his day wanes."
+
+"When?" asked the Captain.
+
+"To-morrow morning, M'sieu. The feasting and dancing will begin
+to-night."
+
+The maid was looking at the priest. "I do not understand," she said.
+"What will he do?"
+
+"He means me, Mademoiselle," said the Captain, quietly.
+
+"Not--" she said, "not--"
+
+"Yes," he replied. "They will bring us no food to-night. In the
+morning they will come for me."
+
+"Oh, M'sieu, they cannot! They--" She gazed at him, not heeding the
+tears that suddenly came to her eyes and fell down upon her cheeks;
+and, as she looked, she understood what was in his mind. "Why do you
+not escape, M'sieu? There is yet time,--to-night! You are thinking of
+me, and I--I--Oh, I have been selfish--I did not know! We will stay
+here, Father Claude and I. You need not think of us; they will not
+harm us--you told me that yourself, M'sieu. I should be in your way,
+but alone--it is so easy." She would have gone on, but Menard held up
+his hand.
+
+"No," he said, shaking his head, "no."
+
+Her lips moved, but she saw the expression in his eyes, and the words
+died. She turned to Father Claude, but he did not look up.
+
+"I do not know," said Menard, slowly, "whether the heart of the Big
+Throat is still warm toward me. He was once as my father."
+
+"He will not be here in time," Father Claude said. "He does not start
+from his village until the sun is dropping on the morrow."
+
+The maid could not take her eyes from Menard's face. Now that the
+final word had come, now that all the doubts of the unsettled day, now
+only half gone, had settled into a fact to be faced, he was himself
+again, the quiet, resolute soldier. Only the set, almost hard lines
+about the mouth told of his suffering.
+
+"If we had a friend here," he was saying, quietly enough, "it may be
+that Tegakwita--But no, of course not. I had forgotten about
+Danton--"
+
+"Tegakwita has lost standing in the tribe for allowing Lieutenant
+Danton to escape. He is very bitter, We can ask nothing from him."
+
+"No, I suppose not."
+
+The cool air of these two men, the manner in which they could face the
+prospect, coupled with her own sense of weakness, weighed hard upon
+the maid's heart. She felt that she must cry out, must in some manner
+give way to her feelings. She rose and hurried into the open air. The
+broad sunlight was still sifting down through the leaves and lying
+upon the green earth in bright patches. The robins were singing, and
+many strange birds, whose calls she did not know, but who piped
+gently, musically, so in harmony with the soft landscape that their
+notes seemed a part of it. It was all unreal, this quiet, sunlit
+world, where the birds were free as the air which bore their songs,
+while the brave Captain--she could not face the thought.
+
+The birch cup was still on the stone by the door. She lifted out the
+flowers with their dripping stems, and rearranged them carefully,
+placing a large yellow daisy in the centre.
+
+An Indian was approaching up the path. He had thrown aside his
+blanket, and he strode rapidly, clad in close-fitting jacket and
+leggings of deerskin, with knife and hatchet slung at his waist. He
+came straight to the hut and entered, brushing by her without a
+glance. Just as he passed she recognized him. He was Tegakwita. Her
+fear of these stern warriors had suddenly gone, and she followed him
+into the doorway to hear his errand. Menard greeted him with a nod;
+Father Claude, too, was silent.
+
+"The White Chief, the Big Buffalo, has a grateful heart," said the
+Indian, in cutting tones. She was glad that she could understand him.
+She took a flower from the bunch at her breast, and stood motionless
+in the low doorway, pulling the petals apart, one by one and watching
+the little group within. The priest and the Captain were sitting on
+the ground, Menard with his hands clasped easily about his knees.
+Tegakwita stood erect, with his back to the door. "He feels the love
+of a brother for those who would make sacrifices for him," he went on.
+"It was many years ago that he saved Tegakwita from the perils of the
+hunt. Tegakwita has not forgotten. When the White Chief became a
+captive, he had not forgotten. He has lost his brave name as a warrior
+because he believed in the White Chief. He has lost--" his voice grew
+tremulous with the emotion that lay underneath the words--"He has lost
+his sister, whom he sent to be a sister to the white man and his
+squaw."
+
+"My brother speaks strangely," said Menard, looking up at him half
+suspiciously.
+
+"Yes, it is strange." His voice was louder, and in his excitement he
+dropped the indirect form of speech that, in the case of an older
+warrior, would have concealed his feelings. "It is strange that you
+should send my sister, who came to you in trust, to release the white
+brave. It is strange you should rob me of her whom my father placed by
+my side."
+
+Menard and Father Claude looked at each other. The Indian watched them
+narrowly.
+
+"My son is mistaken," said Father Claude, quietly. "His sister has
+wandered away. It may be that she has even now returned."
+
+"No, my Father. The white brave has stolen her."
+
+Menard got up, and spoke with feeling.
+
+"Tegakwita does not understand. The white brave was foolish. He is a
+young warrior. He does not know the use of patience. He first escaped
+against my orders. The word I sent by your sister was a command to be
+patient. He went alone, my brother. He has gone forever from my camp.
+It cannot be that she--"
+
+"The Big Buffalo speaks lies. Who came to cut the white brave's bonds?
+Who stole the hunting coat, the leggings of Tegakwita, that her lover
+might go free? Who has dishonoured herself, her brother, the father
+that--" Words failed him, and he stood facing them with blazing eyes.
+
+Menard glanced at the maid, but she had passed the point where a shock
+could sway her, and now stood quietly at the door, waiting to hear
+what more the warrior would say. But he stood motionless. Father
+Claude touched his arm.
+
+"If this is true, Tegakwita, the Big Buffalo must not be held to
+blame. He has spoken truly. To talk in these words to the man who has
+been your brother, is the act of a dog. You have forgotten that the
+Big Buffalo never speaks lies."
+
+The Indian gave no heed to his words. He took a step forward, and
+raised his hand to his knife. Menard smiled contemptuously, and spread
+out his hands; he had no weapon. But Tegakwita had a second thought,
+and dropped his hand.
+
+"Tegakwita, too, never speaks lies," he said. "He will come back
+before the sun has come again."
+
+He walked rapidly out, crowding roughly past the maid.
+
+Menajd leaned against the wall. "Poor boy!" he said, "poor boy!"
+
+The maid came slowly in, and sat on the rude bench which leaned
+against the logs near the door. The strain of the day was drawing out
+all the strength, the womanhood, that lay behind her buoyant youth.
+Already the tan was fading from her face, here in the hut and under
+the protecting elms; and the whiteness of her skin gave her, instead
+of a worn appearance, the look of an older woman,--firmer, with
+greater dignity. Her eyes had a deeper, fuller understanding.
+
+"I suppose that there is nothing, M'sieu--nothing that we can do?"
+
+Menard shook his head. "No; nothing."
+
+"And the Indian,--he says that he will come back?"
+
+"Yes. I don't know what he means. It doesn't matter."
+
+"No, I suppose it doesn't."
+
+They were silent for a moment. The maid leaned forward. "What was
+that, M'sieu?"
+
+"Loungers, on the path."
+
+"No, they are coming here."
+
+Menard rose, but she stepped to the door. "Let me go, M'sieu. Ah, I
+see them. It is my little friends." She went out, and they could hear
+her laughing with the two children, and trying to coax them toward the
+door.
+
+"Danton will never get away," said the Captain, in a low tone to the
+priest.
+
+"I fear not, M'sieu."
+
+"He has lost his head, poor boy. I thought him of better stuff. And
+the girl--Ah, if he had only gone alone! I could forgive his rashness,
+Father, his disobedience, if only he could go down with a clear
+name."
+
+"There is still doubt," said the priest, cautiously. "We know only
+what Tegakwita said."
+
+"I'm afraid," Menard replied, shaking his head, "I'm afraid it's true.
+You said he wore the hunting clothes. Some one freed him. And the girl
+is gone. I wish--Well, there is no use. I hoped for something better,
+that is all."
+
+Just outside the door the maid was talking gaily with the two
+children, who now and then raised their piping voices. Then it was
+evident that they were going away, for she was calling after them. She
+came into the hut, smiling, and carrying a small willow basket full of
+corn.
+
+"See," she said, "even now it is something to have made a friend. We
+shall not go hungry to-day, after all. Will you partake, Father? And
+M'sieu?"
+
+She paused before the Captain. He had stepped forward, and was staring
+at her.
+
+"Where are they?" he asked.
+
+"The children? They are wandering along the path."
+
+"Quick, Mademoiselle! Call them back."
+
+She hesitated, in surprise; then set the basket on the ground and
+obeyed. Menard paced the floor until she returned.
+
+"They are outside, M'sieu, too frightened to come near."
+
+"Give me that birch cup, outside the door." He was speaking in quick,
+low tones. "They must not see me. It would frighten them."
+
+She brought him the cup, and he emptied the flowers on the floor,
+tearing open the seams, and drying the wet white bark on his sleeve.
+He snatched a charred coal from the heap of ashes in the centre of the
+floor, and wrote rapidly in a strange mixture of words and signs, "A
+piece of thread, Mademoiselle. And look again--see that they have not
+gone."
+
+"They are waiting, M'sieu."
+
+He rolled the bark tightly, and tied it with the thread which she
+brought from her bundle.
+
+"We must have a present. Father Claude, you have your bale.
+Find something quickly,--something that will please them. No,
+wait--Mademoiselle, have you a mirror? They would run fifty
+leagues for a mirror."
+
+She nodded, rummaged through her bundle, and brought out a small
+glass.
+
+"Take this, Mademoiselle. Tell them to give this letter to the Big
+Throat, at the next village. They will know the way. He must have it
+before the day is over. No harm can come to them. If anyone would
+punish them, the Big Throat will protect them. You must make them do
+it. They cannot fail."
+
+Her face flushed, and her eyes snapped as she caught his nervous
+eagerness. Even Father Claude had risen, and was watching him with
+kindling eyes. She took the roll and the mirror, and ran out the door.
+In a moment, Menard, pacing the floor, could hear her merry laugh, and
+the shrill-voiced delight of the children over their new toy. He
+caught the priest's hand.
+
+"Father, we shall yet be free. Who could fail with such a lieutenant
+as that maid. How she laughs. One would think she had never a care."
+
+At last she came back, and sank, with a nervous, irresponsible little
+laugh, on the bench. And then, for the moment, they all three laughed
+together.
+
+In the silence that followed, Father Claude moved toward the door.
+
+"I must go out again, M'sieu. It may be that there is further word."
+
+"Very well, Father. And open your ears for news of the poor boy."
+
+The priest bowed, and went out. Menard stood in the door watching him,
+as he walked boldly along the path. After a little he turned. The maid
+was looking at him, still flushed and smiling.
+
+"Well, Mademoiselle, we can take hope again."
+
+"You are so brave, M'sieu."
+
+He smiled at her impulsiveness, and looked at her, hardly conscious
+that he was causing her to blush and lower her eyes.
+
+"And so I am brave, Mademoiselle? It may be that Major Provost and
+Major d'Orvilliers will not feel so."
+
+"But they must, M'sieu."
+
+"Do you know what they will say? They will speak with sorrow of
+Captain Menard, the trusted, in whose hands Governor Denonville placed
+the most important commission ever given to a captain in New France.
+They will regret that their old friend was not equal to the test; that
+he--ah, do not interrupt, Mademoiselle; it is true--that his failure
+lost a campaign for New France. You heard Father Claude; you know what
+these Indians plan to do."
+
+"You must not speak so, M'sieu. It is wicked. He would be a coward who
+could blame you. It was not your fault that you were captured. When I
+return I shall go to them and tell them how you fought, and how you
+faced them like--like a hero. When I return--" She stopped, as if the
+word were strange.
+
+"Aye, Mademoiselle, and God grant that you may return soon. But your
+good heart leads you wrong. It was my fault that I did not bring a
+force strong enough to protect myself,--and you. To fight is not a
+soldier's first duty. It is to be discreet; he must know when not to
+fight as well as when to draw his sword; he must know how many men are
+needed to defend his cause. No; I was overconfident, and I lost. And
+there we must leave it. Nothing more can be said."
+
+He stood moodily over the heap of ashes. When he looked at her again,
+she had risen.
+
+"The flowers, M'sieu," she said, "you--you threw them away."
+
+He glanced down. They lay at his feet. Silently he knelt and gathered
+them.
+
+"Will you help me, Mademoiselle? We will make another cup. And these
+two large daisies,--did you see how they rested side by side on the
+ground when I would have trampled on them? You will take one and I the
+other; and when this day shall be far in the past, it may be that you
+will remember it, and how we two were here together, waiting for the
+stroke that should change life for us."
+
+He held it out, and she, with lowered eyes, reached to take it from
+his hand, but suddenly checked the motion and turned to the door.
+
+"Will you take it, Mademoiselle?"
+
+She did not move; and he stood, the soldier, helpless, waiting for a
+word. He had forgotten everything,--the low, smoke-blackened hut, the
+responsibility that lay on his shoulders, the danger of the
+moment,--everything but the slender maid who stood before him, who
+would not take the flower from his hand. Then he stepped to her side,
+and, taking away the other flowers from the lace beneath her throat,
+he placed the single daisy in their stead. Her eyes were nearly
+closed, and she seemed hardly to know that he was there.
+
+"And it may be," he whispered softly, "that we, like the flowers,
+shall be spared."
+
+She turned slowly away, and sank upon the bench. Menard, with a
+strange, new lightness in his heart, went out into the sunlight.
+
+The day wore on. The warm sunbeams, that slipped down through the
+foliage, lengthened and reached farther and farther to the east. The
+bright spots of light crept across the grass, climbed the side of the
+hut and the tree-trunks, lingered on the upreaching twigs, and died
+away in the blue sky. The evening star shot out its white spears,
+glowing and radiant, long before the light had gone, or the purple and
+golden afterglow had faded into twilight. Menard's mind went back to
+another day, just such a glorious, shining June day as this had been,
+when he had sat not a hundred yards from this spot, waiting, as now,
+for the end. He looked at his fingers. They were scarred and knotted;
+one drunken, frenzied squaw had mangled them with her teeth. He had
+wondered then how a man could endure such torture as had come to him,
+and still could live and think, could even struggle back to health.
+The depression had gone from him now; his mind was more alert than
+since the night of the capture. Whether it was the bare chance of help
+from the Big Throat, or the gentle sadness in the face of the maid as
+she bowed her head to the single daisy on her breast,--something had
+entered into his nerves and heart, something hopeful and strong, He
+wondered, as Father Claude came up the path, slowly, laboriously, why
+the priest should be so saddened. After all, the world was green and
+bright, and life, even a few hours of it, was sweet.
+
+"What news, Father?"
+
+The priest shook his head. "Little, M'sieu."
+
+"Has the feast begun?"
+
+"Not yet. They are assembling before the Long House."
+
+"Are they drinking?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+There was no need for talk, and so the two men sat before the hut,
+with only an idle word now and then, until the dark came down. The
+quiet of the village was broken now by the shouts of drinking
+warriors, with a chanting undertone that rose and swelled slowly into
+the song that would continue, both men knew, until the break of day,
+or until none was left with sober tongue to carry the wavering air. A
+great fire had been lighted, and they could see the glare and the
+sparks beyond a cluster of trees and huts. Later, straggling braves
+appeared, wandering about, bottle or flask in hand, crazed by the raw
+brandy with which the English and Dutch of New York and Orange and the
+French of the province alike saw fit to keep the Indians supplied.
+
+A group of the warriors came from the dance, and staggered toward the
+hut of the captives. They were armed with knives and hatchets. One had
+an arquebuse, which he fired at the trees as often as the uncertain
+hands of all of them could load it. He caught sight of the white men
+sitting in the shadow, and came toward them, his fellows at his
+heels.
+
+"Move nearer the door," whispered Menard. "They must not get in."
+
+The two edged along the ground without rising, until they sat with
+their backs in the open doorway. The Indians hung about, a few yards
+away, jeering and shouting. The one with the arquebuse evidently
+wished to shoot, but the others were holding his arms, and reasoning
+in thick voices. No construction of the Iroquois traditions could make
+it right to kill a prisoner who was held for the torture.
+
+The white men watched them quietly. Menard heard a rustle, and the
+sound of a quick breath behind him, and he said, without taking his
+eyes from the Indians:--
+
+"Step back, Mademoiselle, behind the wall. You must not stand here."
+
+The warrior broke away from the hands that held him, staggering a rod
+across the grass before he could recover his balance. The others went
+after him, but he quickly rested the piece and fired. The ball went
+over their heads through the doorway, striking with a low noise
+against the rear wall. Menard rose, jerking away from the priest's
+restraining hand.
+
+"Mademoiselle," he said, "you are not hurt?"
+
+"No, M'sieu."
+
+"Thank God!" He stood glaring at the huddled band of warriors, who
+were trying to reload the arquebuse; then he bounded forward, broke
+into the group with a force that sent two to the ground, snatched the
+weapon, and, with a quick motion, drew out the flint. He threw the gun
+on the ground, and walked back to his seat.
+
+Two of the guards came running forward. They had not been drinking,
+and one of them ordered the loafers away. This did not strike them
+amiss. They started off, trying to reload as they walked, evidently
+not missing the flint.
+
+The maid came again to the doorway, and asked timidly:--
+
+"Is there danger for you, M'sieu? Will they come back?"
+
+"No. It is merely a lot of drunken youths. They have probably
+forgotten by now. Can you sleep, Mademoiselle?--have you tried?"
+
+"No, I--I fear that I could not."
+
+"It would be well to make the effort," he said gently, looking over
+his shoulder at her as she leaned against the doorpost. "We do not
+know what may happen. At any rate, even if you escape, you will need
+all your strength on the morrow. A fallen captain may not command,
+Mademoiselle, but--"
+
+"If it is your command, M'sieu, I will try. Good night."
+
+There was a long stillness, broken only by the distant noises of the
+dance.
+
+"You, too, will sleep, M'sieu?" said Father Claude. "I will watch."
+
+"No, no, Father."
+
+"I beg it of you. At the least you will let me divide the night with
+you?"
+
+"We shall see, we shall see. There is much to be said before either of
+us closes his eyes. Hello, here is a runner."
+
+An Indian was loping up the path. He turned in toward the hut.
+
+"Quiet," said the priest. "It is Tegakwita."
+
+The warrior had run a long way. He was breathing deeply, and the sweat
+stood out on his face and caught the shine of the firelight.
+
+"My brother has been far," said Menard, rising.
+
+"The White Chief is not surprised? He heard the word of Tegakwita,
+that he would return before another sun. He has indeed been far. He
+has followed the track of the forest wolf that stole the child of the
+Onondagas. He has found the bold, the brave white warrior, who stole
+away in the night, robbing Tegakwita of what is dearer to him than the
+beating of his heart."
+
+The maid stood again in the doorway, resting a hand on the post, and
+leaning forward with startled eyes.
+
+"He has found--he has found him--" she faltered.
+
+The Indian did not look at her. He drew something from the breast of
+his shirt, and threw it on the ground at Menard's feet. Then, with
+broken-hearted dignity, he strode away and disappeared in the night.
+
+Father Claude stooped, and picked up the object. Dimly in the
+firelight they could see it,--two warm human scalps, the one of brown
+hair knotted to the other of black. Menard took them in his hand.
+
+"Poor boy!" he said, over and over. "Poor boy!"
+
+He looked toward the door, but the maid had gone inside.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X.
+
+A NIGHT COUNCIL.
+
+
+The night crept by, as had the day, wearily.
+
+The two men sat in the doorway or walked slowly back and forth across
+the front of the hut, saying little. The Captain was calling to mind
+every incident of their capture, and of the original trouble between
+La Grange and the hunting party. He went over the conversation with
+Major Provost at Quebec word by word, until he felt sure in his
+authority as the Governor's representative; although the written
+orders in the leather bag that hung from his neck were concerned only
+with his duties in preparing Fort Frontenac for the advancing
+column,--duties that he had not fulfilled.
+
+A plan was forming in his mind which would make strong demands on the
+good faith of Major Provost and the Governor. He knew, as every old
+soldier knows, that governments and rulers are thankless, that even
+written authority is none too binding, if to make it good should
+inconvenience those who so easily give it. He knew further that if he
+should succeed now in staying the Onondagas and Cayugas by pledges
+which, perchance, it might not please Governor Denonville to observe,
+the last frail ties that held the Iroquois to the French would be
+broken, and England would reign from the Hudson to the river of the
+Illinois. And he sighed, as he had sighed many times before, for the
+old days under Frontenac, under the only Governor of New France who
+could hold these slippery redskins to their obligations.
+
+"Father," he said finally, "I begin to see a way."
+
+"The Big Throat?"
+
+"He must help, though to tell the truth I fear that he will be of
+little service. He may come in time to give us a stay; but, chief
+though he is, he will hardly dare overrule the Long Arrow on a matter
+so personal as this."
+
+"What is the Long Arrow's family--the Beaver?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"But, M'sieu, that is the least of the eight families. If it were the
+Tortoise or the Bear against us, we should have greater cause for
+fear."
+
+"True, Father, but to each family belongs its own quarrels, its own
+revenge. If the Big Throat should interfere too deeply, it would anger
+the other small families, who might fear the same treatment at some
+other time. And with Beaver, Snipe, Deer, and Potato united against
+us,--well, it is a simple enough problem."
+
+They were walking by the door, and Menard, as he spoke, sat on the
+stone which he had rolled there in the afternoon. The priest stood
+before him.
+
+"I hope we may succeed, my son. I have seen this anger before, and it
+has always ended in the one way."
+
+"Of course," the Captain replied, "it does depend on the Big Throat.
+He must reach here in time."
+
+"God grant that he may!"
+
+"In that case, Father, I look for a delay. Unless his heart has
+hardened rapidly, he still thinks of me. Together we will go to him,
+and ask a hearing in the war council."
+
+"Oratory will not release us, I fear, M'sieu."
+
+"We shall not ask to be released, Father. Don't you understand? It is
+more than that we shall demand,--it is peace with New France, the
+safety of the column--"
+
+The priest's eyes lighted. "Do you think, M'sieu--"
+
+"We can do it. They have not heard all the truth. They do not want a
+long war which will kill their braves and destroy their homes and
+their corn. It is this attack on the Senecas that has drawn them
+out."
+
+"You will tell them that the Governor fights only the Senecas?"
+
+"More than that. The La Grange affair has stirred them up. It has
+weakened their faith in the Governor,--it has as good as undone all
+the work of twenty years past. Our only hope is to reestablish that
+faith."
+
+"I hope that we may," said the priest, slowly. "But they have reached
+a state now where words alone will hardly suffice. I have tried it,
+M'sieu. Since we came, I have talked and reasoned with them."
+
+"Well, Father, I am going to try it. The question is, will the
+Governor make good what I shall have to promise? It may be that he
+will. If not,--then my life will not be worth a box of tinder if I
+stray a league from Quebec without a guard." He looked down at the
+daisy on his coat. "But the maid will be safe, Father. She will be
+safe."
+
+"I do not believe that they would harm her, even as it is."
+
+"No, I trust not--I trust not. But we are here, and she is here; and
+not until I know that her journey is over will my eyes close easily at
+night."
+
+"But your plan, M'sieu,--you have not told me."
+
+"Ah, I thought you understood. Did you know about the capture at
+Frontenac when it happened? No? It was like this. The Governor sent
+word, with the orders that came up to the fort in May, that at the
+first sign of trouble or disturbance with the Indians there,
+d'Orvilliers should seize a few score of them and send them down
+the river in chains. It would be an example, he said. I was
+awaiting orders,--I had just returned from the Huron Country and
+Michillimackinac,--and d'Orvilliers called me to his rooms and
+showed me the order. 'Now,' he said, 'who in the devil is meddling
+at Quebec?' I did not know; I do not know yet. But there was the
+order. He turned it over to La Grange, with instructions to wait until
+some offence should give him an excuse."
+
+"I know the rest, M'sieu."
+
+"Yes, yes. You have heard a dozen times,--how La Grange was drinking,
+and how he lied to a peaceful hunting party, and drugged them, and
+brained one poor devil with his own sword. And what could we do,
+Father? Right or wrong, the capture was made. It was too late to
+release them, for the harm was done. If d'Orvilliers had refused to
+carry out his orders and send them to Quebec, it would have cost him
+his commission."
+
+"And you, M'sieu?"
+
+"I was the only officer on detached service at the Fort. D'Orvilliers
+could not look me in the face when he ordered me to take them."
+
+"You will tell them this?"
+
+"This? Yes, and more. I will pledge the honour of New France that La
+Grange shall suffer. The man who has betrayed the Onondagas must be
+punished before we can have their good faith. Don't you understand?"
+
+Father Claude walked away a few steps, and then back, his hands
+clasped before him.
+
+"Don't you understand, Father? If a wrong has been done an Iroquois,
+it is revenge that will appease him. Very well. Captain la Grange has
+wronged them; let them have their revenge."
+
+"Is that the right view, M'sieu?"
+
+"Not for us, Father,--for you and me. To us it is simple justice. But
+justice,--that is not the word with which to reach an Indian."
+
+"But it may be that Captain la Grange is in favour at Quebec. What
+then?"
+
+"You do not seem to understand me yet, Father." Menard spoke slowly
+and calmly. "This is not my quarrel. I can take what my life brings,
+and thank your God, the while, that I have life at all. But if by one
+foolish act the Iroquois are to be lost to France, while I have the
+word on my tongue that will set all right, am I,--well, would you have
+me such a soldier?"
+
+The priest was looking through the leaves at the firelight. For once
+he seemed to have nothing to offer.
+
+"It will not be easy, Father; but when was a soldier's work easy?
+First I must make these Indians believe me,--and you know how hard
+that will be. Then I must convince Governor Denonville that this is
+his only course; and that will be still harder. Or, if they will not
+release me, you will be my messenger, Father, and take the word. I
+will stay here until La Grange has got his dues."
+
+"Let us suppose," said the priest,--"let us suppose that you did not
+do this, that you did not take this course against Captain la Grange
+which will leave him a marked man to the Iroquois, even if the
+Governor should do nothing."
+
+"Then," said Menard, "the rear-guard at La Famine will be butchered,
+and the army of New France will be cut to pieces. That is all."
+
+"You are sure of this?"
+
+"It points that way, Father."
+
+"Then let us take another case. Suppose that you succeed at the
+council, that you are released. Then if the Governor should disclaim
+responsibility, should--"
+
+"Then, Father, I will go to La Grange and make him fight me. I mean to
+pledge my word to these chiefs. You know what that means."
+
+"Yes," replied the priest, "yes." He seemed puzzled and unsettled by
+some thought that held his mind. He walked slowly about, looking at
+the ground. Menard, too, was restless. He rose from the stone and
+tossed away the pebbles that had supported the cup, one at a time.
+
+"They are singing again," he said, listening to the droning chant that
+came indistinctly through the dark. "One would think they would long
+ago have been too drunk to stand. How some of these recruits the King
+sends over to us would envy them their stomachs."
+
+The priest made no reply. He did not understand the impulse that led
+the Captain to speak irrelevantly at such a moment.
+
+"I suppose the doctors are dancing now," Menard continued. "It may be
+that they will come here. If they do, we shall have a night of it."
+
+"We will hope not, M'sieu."
+
+"If they should, Father,--well, it is hard to know just what to do."
+
+"You were thinking--?"
+
+"Oh, I was wondering. If they come here, and let their wild talk run
+away with them, it might be well to fight them off until morning.
+Maybe we could do it."
+
+"Yes, it might seem best."
+
+"But if--if the Big Throat should not come, or should have changed,
+then it would have been better that I had submitted."
+
+"You are thinking of me, my son. You must not. I will not leave you to
+go without a struggle. I can fight, if needs be, as well as you. I
+will do my part."
+
+"It is not that, Father. But if we fight, and the Big Throat does not
+come,--there is the maid. They would not spare her then."
+
+The priest looked at the Captain, and in the dim, uncertain light he
+saw something of the thought that lay behind those wearied eyes.
+
+"True," he said; "true."
+
+Menard walked up and down, a half-dozen steps forward, a half-dozen
+back, without a glance at the priest, who watched him closely.
+Suddenly he turned, and the words that were in his mind slipped
+unguarded from his tongue, low and stern:--
+
+"If they come, Father,--if they harm her,--God! if they even wake her,
+I will kill them."
+
+Father Claude looked at him, but said nothing. They walked together up
+and down; then, as if weary, they sat again by the door.
+
+"There are some things which I could not talk over with you," said the
+priest, finally. "It was best that I should not. And now I hardly know
+what is the right thing for me to do, or to say."
+
+"What troubles you?"
+
+"When you are cooler, it will come to you. For to-night,--until our
+last moment of choice,--I must ask one favour, M'sieu. You will not
+decide on this course until it comes to the end. You will think of
+other ways; you will--"
+
+"What else have I been doing, Father? There is no other way."
+
+"But you will not decide yet?"
+
+"No. We need not, to-night."
+
+The priest seemed relieved.
+
+"M'sieu," came in a low voice from the darkness within the hut, "may I
+not sit with you?"
+
+"You are awake, Mademoiselle? You have not been sleeping?"
+
+"No, I could not. I--I have not heard you, M'sieu,--I have not
+listened. But I wanted to very much. I have only my thoughts, and they
+are not the best of company to-night."
+
+"Come." Menard rose and got one of the priest's blankets, folding it
+and laying it on the ground against the wall. "I fear that we may be
+no better than the thoughts; but such as we are, we are at the service
+of Mademoiselle."
+
+She sat by them, and leaned back, letting her hands fall into her lap.
+Menard was half in the shadow, and he could let his eyes linger on her
+face. It was a sad face now, worn by the haunting fears that the night
+had brought,--fears that had not held their substance in the sunlight;
+but the eyes were still bright. Even at this moment she had not
+forgotten to catch up the masses of hair that were struggling to be
+free; and there was a touch of neatness about her torn dress that the
+hardships of the journey and the dirt and discomforts of an Indian
+shelter had not been able to take away. They all three sat without
+talking, watching the sparks from the fire and the tips of flame that
+now and then reached above the huts.
+
+"How strange their song is, M'sieu."
+
+"Yes. They will keep it up all night. If we were nearer, you would see
+that as soon as a brave is exhausted with the dancing and singing,
+another will rush in to take his place. Sometimes they fall fainting,
+and do not recover for hours."
+
+"I saw a dance once, at home. The Ottawas--there were but a few of
+them--had a war-dance. It seemed to be just for amusement."
+
+"They enjoy it. It is not uncommon for them to dance for a day when
+there is no hunt to occupy them."
+
+Father Claude had been silent. Now he rose and walked slowly away,
+leaving them to talk together. They could see him moving about with
+bowed head.
+
+"The Father is sad, M'sieu."
+
+"Yes. But it is not for himself."
+
+"Does he fear now? Does he not think that the Big Throat will come?"
+
+"I think he will come."
+
+The maid looked down at her clasped hands. Menard watched her,--the
+firelight was dancing on her face and hair,--and again the danger
+seemed to slip away, the chant and the fire to be a part of some
+mad dream that had carried him in a second from Quebec to this
+deep-shadowed spot, and had set this maid before him.
+
+"You are wearing the daisy, Mademoiselle."
+
+She looked up, half-startled at the change in his voice. Then her eyes
+dropped again.
+
+"See," he continued, "so am I. Is it not strange that we should be
+here, you and I. And yet, when I first saw you, I thought--"
+
+"You thought, M'sieu?"
+
+Menard laughed gently. "I could not tell you, without telling you what
+I think now, and that would--be--"
+
+He spoke half playfully, and waited; but she did not reply.
+
+"I do not know what it is that has come to me. It is not like me. Or
+it may be that the soldier, all these years, has not been me. Would it
+not be strange if I were but now to find myself,--or if you were to
+find me, Mademoiselle? If it is true, if this is what I have waited so
+long to find, it would be many years before I could repay you for
+bringing it to me,--it would be a long lifetime."
+
+Again he waited, and still she was silent. Then he talked on, as madly
+now as on the night of their capture, when he had fought, shouting,
+musket and knife in hand, at the water's edge. But this was another
+madness.
+
+"It is such a simple thing. Until you came out here under the trees my
+mind was racked with the troubles about us. But now you are here, and
+I do not care,--no, not if this were to be my last night, if to-morrow
+they should--" She made a nervous gesture, but he went on.
+
+"You see it is you, Mademoiselle, who come into my life, and then all
+the rest goes out."
+
+"Don't," she said brokenly. "Don't."
+
+Father Claude came slowly toward them.
+
+"My child," he said, "if you are not too wearied, I wish to talk with
+you."
+
+She rose with an air of relief and joined him. Menard watched them,
+puzzled. He could hear the priest speaking in low, even tones; and
+then the maid's voice, deep with emotion. Finally they came back, and
+she went hurriedly into the hut without a glance at the soldier, who
+had risen and stood by the door.
+
+"Come, M'sieu, let us walk."
+
+Menard looked at him in surprise, but walked with him.
+
+"It is about the speech to the council--and Captain la Grange. It may
+be that you are right, M'sieu."
+
+"Right? I do not understand."
+
+"It was but a moment ago that we talked of it."
+
+"Yes, I have not forgotten. But what do you mean now?"
+
+"You promised me to wait before deciding. It may be that I was wrong.
+If you are to make the speech, you will need to prepare it carefully.
+There is none too much time."
+
+"Yes," said Menard. Then suddenly he stopped and took the priest's
+arm. "I did not think, Father; I did not understand. What a fool I
+am!"
+
+"No, no, M'sieu."
+
+"You have talked with her. He is her cousin, and yet it did not come
+to me. It will pain her."
+
+"Yes," said Father Claude, slowly, "it will pain her. But I have been
+thinking. I fear that you are right. It has passed beyond the simple
+matter of our own lives; now it is New France that must be thought of.
+You have said that it was Captain la Grange's treachery that first
+angered the Onondagas. We must lay this before them. If his punishment
+will satisfy them, will save the rear-guard, why then, my son, it is
+our duty."
+
+They paced back and forth in silence. Menard's heavy breathing and his
+quick glances toward the hut told the priest something of the struggle
+that was going on in his mind. Suddenly he said:--
+
+"I will go to her, Father. I will tell her. I cannot pledge myself to
+this act if--if she--"
+
+"No, M'sieu, you must not; I have told her. She understands. And she
+has begged me to ask you not to speak with her. She has a brave heart,
+but she cannot see you now."
+
+"She asked you,--" said the Captain, slowly. "She asked you--I cannot
+think. I do not know what to say."
+
+The priest quietly walked back to the stone by the door, and left the
+soldier to fight out the battle alone. It was half an hour before he
+came back and stood before Father Claude.
+
+"Well, M'sieu?"
+
+Menard spoke shortly, "Yes, Father, you are right."
+
+That was all, but it told the priest that the matter had been finally
+settled. He had seen the look in the Captain's eyes when the truth had
+come to him; and he knew now what he had not dreamed before, that the
+soldier's heart had gone out to this maid, and now he must set his
+hand against one of her own blood. The Father knew that he would do
+it, would fight La Grange to the end. A word was trembling on his
+tongue, but as he looked at the seamed face before him, he could not
+bring himself to add a deeper sorrow to that already stamped there.
+
+"You must help me with the speech, Father. My wits are not at their
+best, I fear."
+
+"Willingly, M'sieu. And the presents,--we must think of that."
+
+"True. We have not the wampum collars. It must be something of great
+value that will take their place. You know how much tradition means to
+these people. Of course I have nothing. But you--you have your bale.
+And Mademoiselle--together you should find something."
+
+"I fear that I have little. My blankets and my altar they would not
+value. One moment--" He stepped to the door, and spoke softly,
+"Mademoiselle."
+
+"Yes, Father." She stood in the doorway, wearily. It was plain that
+she had been weeping, but she was not ashamed.
+
+"We shall need your help, Mademoiselle. Anything in your bale that
+would please the chiefs must be used."
+
+She was puzzled.
+
+"It is the custom," continued the priest, "at every council. To the
+Indians a promise is not given, a statement is not true, a treaty is
+not binding, unless there is a present for each clause. We have much
+at stake, and we must give what we have."
+
+"Certainly, Father."
+
+She stepped back into the darkness, and they could hear her dragging
+the bundle. Menard sprang to help.
+
+"Mademoiselle, where are you?"
+
+"Here, M'sieu."
+
+He walked toward the sound with his hands spread before him. One hand
+rested on her shoulder, where she stooped over the bale. She did not
+shrink from his touch. For a moment he stood, struggling with a mad
+impulse to take her slender figure in his arms, to hold her where a
+thousand Indians could not harm her save by taking his own strong
+life; to tell her what made this moment more to him than all the stern
+years of the past. It may be that she understood, for she was
+motionless, almost breathless. But in a moment he was himself.
+
+"I will take it," he said.
+
+He stooped, took up the bundle, and carried it outside. She followed
+to the doorway.
+
+"You will look, Mademoiselle."
+
+She nodded, and knelt by the bundle, while the two men waited.
+
+"There is little here, M'sieu. I brought only what was necessary. Here
+is a comb. Would that please them?"
+
+She reached back to them, holding out a high tortoise-shell comb. They
+took it and examined it.
+
+"It is beautiful," said Menard.
+
+"Yes; my mother gave it to me."
+
+"Perhaps, Mademoiselle,--perhaps there is something else, something
+that would do as well."
+
+"How many should you have, M'sieu?"
+
+"Five, I had planned. There will be five words in the speech."
+
+"Words?" she repeated.
+
+"To the Iroquois each argument is a 'word.'"
+
+"I have almost nothing else, not even clothing of value. Wait--here is
+a small coat of seal."
+
+"And you, Father?" asked Menard.
+
+"I have a book with highly coloured pictures, M'sieu,--'The Ceremonies
+of the Mass applied to the Passion of Our Lord.'"
+
+"Splendid! Have you nothing else?"
+
+"I fear not."
+
+Menard turned to the maid, who was still on her knees by the open
+bundle, looking up at them.
+
+"I am afraid that we must take your coat and the comb," he said. "I am
+sorry."
+
+She answered in a low tone, but firmly: "You know, M'sieu, that it
+would hurt me to do nothing. It hurts me to do so little."
+
+"Thank you, Mademoiselle. Well, Father, we must use our wits. It may
+be that four words will be enough, but I cannot use fewer. We have but
+three presents."
+
+"Yes," replied the priest, "yes." He walked slowly by them, and about
+in a circle, repeating the word. The maid leaned back and watched him,
+wondering. He paused before the Captain and seemed about to speak.
+Then abruptly he went into the hut, and they could hear him moving
+within. Menard and the maid looked at each other, the soldier smiling
+quietly. He understood.
+
+Father Claude came out holding the portrait of Catharine, the Lily of
+the Onondagas, in his hands.
+
+"It may be that this could be used for the fourth present," he said.
+
+Menard took it without a word, and laid it on the ground by the fur
+coat. The maid looked at it curiously.
+
+"Oh, it is a picture," she said.
+
+"Yes, Mademoiselle," the Captain replied. "It is the portrait of an
+Onondaga maiden who is to them, and to the French, almost a saint.
+They will prize this above all else."
+
+The maid raised it, and looked at the strangely clad figure. Father
+Claude quietly walked away, but Menard went after and gripped his
+hand.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI.
+
+THE BIG THROAT SPEAKS.
+
+
+The light of the rising sun struggled through the mist that lay on the
+Onondaga Valley. The trees came slowly out of the gray air, like ships
+approaching through a fog. As the sun rose higher, each leaf glistened
+with dew. The grass was wet and shining.
+
+Menard had seized a few hours of sleep. He awoke with the first beam
+of yellow light, and rose from his bed on the packed, beaten ground
+before the door. Father Claude was sitting on a log, at a short
+distance, with bowed head. The Captain stretched his stiff limbs, and
+walked slowly about until the priest looked up.
+
+"Good morning, Father."
+
+"Good morning, M'sieu."
+
+"It was a selfish thought that led me to choose the earlier watch.
+These last hours are the best for sleeping."
+
+"No, I have rested well."
+
+"And Mademoiselle?"
+
+"I have heard no sound. I think that she still sleeps."
+
+"Softly, then. There has been no disturbance?"
+
+"None. The singing has died down during the last hour. There, you can
+hear it, M'sieu."
+
+"Yes. But it is only a few voices. It must be that the others are
+sleeping off the liquor. They will soon awaken."
+
+"Listen."
+
+A musket was fired, and another.
+
+"That is the signal."
+
+The song, which one group after another had taken up all through the
+night, rose again and grew in volume as one at a time the sleepers
+aroused and joined the dance. The only sign of the fire was a pillar
+of thin smoke that rolled straight upward in the still air.
+
+"Father," said Menard, "are the guards about?"
+
+"I have not seen them. I suppose they are wandering within call."
+
+"Then, quickly, before we are seen, help me with this log."
+
+"I do not understand, M'sieu."
+
+"Into the hut with it, and the others, there. If a chance does
+come,--well, it may be that we shall yet be reduced to holding the
+hut. These will serve to barricade the door."
+
+They were not disturbed while they rolled the short logs within and
+piled them at one side of the door, where they could not be seen from
+the path.
+
+"Quietly, Father," whispered the Captain. He knew that the maid lay
+sleeping, back among the shadows. "And the presents,--you have packed
+them away?"
+
+"In my bundle, M'sieu. They will not be harmed."
+
+They returned to the open air, and looked about anxiously for signs of
+a movement toward the hut; but the irregular street was silent. Here
+and there, from the opening in the roof of some low building of bark
+and logs, rose a light smoke.
+
+"They are all at the dance," said Menard. His memory supplied the
+picture: the great fire, now sunk to heaps of gray ashes, spread over
+the ground by the feet of those younger braves who had wished to show
+their hardihood by treading barefoot on the embers; the circle of
+grunting figures, leaning forward, hatchet and musket in hand, moving
+slowly around the fire with a shuffling, hopping step; the outer
+circle of sitting or lying figures, men, women, and children, drunken,
+wanton, quarrelsome, dreaming of the blood that should be let before
+the sun had gone; and at one side the little group of old men, beating
+their drums of wood and skin with a rhythm that never slackened.
+
+The song grew louder, and broke at short intervals into shouts and
+cries, punctuated with musket-shots.
+
+"They are coming, M'sieu."
+
+The head of the line, still stepping in the slow movement of the
+dance, appeared at some distance up the path. The Long Arrow was in
+front, in full war-paint, and wearing the collar of wampum beads.
+Beside him was the Beaver. The line advanced, two and two, steadily
+toward the lodge of the white men.
+
+Menard leaned against the door-post and watched them. His figure was
+relaxed, his face composed.
+
+"Here are the doctors, Father."
+
+A group of medicine men, wildly clad in skins of beasts and reptiles,
+with the heads of animals on their shoulders, came running along
+beside the line, leaping high in the air, and howling.
+
+Menard turned to the priest. "Father, which shall it be,--shall we
+fight?"
+
+"I do not know, M'sieu. We have no weapons, and it may be, yet, that
+the Big Throat--"
+
+"Yes, I know."
+
+"And there is the maid, M'sieu."
+
+For the first time since the sunrise the quiet expression left the
+Captain's face. He was silent for a moment. Then he said:--
+
+"I will go, Father. You must protect her. If anything--if they should
+dare to touch her, you will--?"
+
+"I will fight them, M'sieu."
+
+"Thank you." Menard held out his hand. They gripped in silence, and
+turned again toward the Indians, who were now but a hundred yards
+away.
+
+"They will stop in a moment," said Menard, "and form for the gantlet.
+Yes,--see, the Long Arrow holds up his hands." He stood irresolute,
+looking at the fantastic picture; then he stepped back into the hut.
+
+The maid lay in her blanket on the bench. He stood over her, looking
+at the peaceful face that rested on her outstretched arm. He took her
+hand, and said gently:--
+
+"Mademoiselle."
+
+She stirred, and slowly opened her eyes; she did not seem surprised
+that he should be there clasping tightly her slender hand. He wondered
+if he had been in her dreams.
+
+"Good-bye, Mademoiselle."
+
+"You--you are going, M'sieu?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+She looked up at him with half-dazed eyes. She was not yet fully
+awake.
+
+"You must not fear," he said. "They cannot hurt you. You will soon be
+safe at--at Frontenac."
+
+She was beginning to understand. Then all at once the light came into
+her eyes, and she clung to his arm, which was still wet with the dew.
+
+"You are not going? They will not take you? Oh, M'sieu, I cannot--you
+must not!"
+
+She would have said more, but he bent down and kissed her forehead.
+Then, with his free hand he unclasped her fingers and went away. At
+the door he turned. She was sitting on the bench, gazing after him
+with a look that he never forgot. For all of the unhappiness, the
+agony, that came to him from those eyes, it was with a lighter heart
+that he faced the warriors who rushed to seize him.
+
+Every brave, woman, and child that the village could supply was in the
+double line that stretched away from a point on the path not a hundred
+yards distant to the long council house, which stood on a slight rise
+of ground. They were armed with muskets, clubs, knives,--with any
+instrument which could bruise or, mutilate the soldier as he passed,
+and yet leave life in him for the harder trials to follow. Five
+warriors, muskets in hand, had come to the hut. They sprang at Menard
+as he stepped out through the doorway, striking him roughly and
+holding his elbows behind his back.
+
+A shout went up from the waiting lines, and muskets and clubs were
+waved in the air. The Captain stepped forward briskly with head erect,
+scorning to glance at the braves who walked on either side. He knew
+that they would not kill him in the gantlet; they would save him for
+the fire. He had passed through this once, he could do it again,
+conscious that every moment brought nearer the chance of a rescue by
+the Big Throat. Perhaps twenty paces had been covered, and his
+guardians were prodding him and trying to force him into a run, when
+he heard a shout from the priest, and then the sounds of a struggle at
+the hut. He turned his head, but a rude hand knocked it back. Again he
+heard the priest's voice, and this time, with it, a woman's scream.
+
+The Captain hesitated for a second. The warriors prodded him again,
+and before they could raise their arms he had jerked loose, snatched a
+musket from one, and swinging it around his head, sent the two to the
+ground, one with a cracked skull. Before those in the lines could
+fairly see what had happened, he was running toward the hut with two
+captured muskets and a knife. In front of the hut the three other
+Indians were struggling with Father Claude, who was fighting in a
+frenzy, and the maid. She was hanging back, and one redskin had
+crushed her two wrists together in his hand and was dragging her.
+
+Menard was on them with a leap. They did not see him until a musket
+whirled about their ears, and one man fell, rolling, at the maid's
+feet.
+
+"Back into the hut!" he said roughly, and she obeyed. As he turned to
+aid the priest he called after her, "Pile up the logs, quick!"
+
+She understood, and with the strength that came with the moment, she
+dragged the logs to the door.
+
+Menard crushed down the two remaining Indians as he would have crushed
+wild beasts, without a glance toward the mob that was running at him,
+without a thought for the gash in his arm, made first by an arrow at
+La Gallette and now reopened by a knife thrust. The Father, too, was
+wounded, but still he could fight. There was but a second more. The
+Captain threw the four muskets into the hut, and after them the
+powder-horns and bullet-pouches which he had barely time to strip from
+the dead men. Then he crowded the priest through the opening above the
+logs, and came tumbling after. Another second saw the logs piled close
+against the door, while a shower of bullets and arrows rattled against
+them.
+
+"Take a musket, Father. Now, fire together! Quick, the others! Can you
+load these, Mademoiselle?"
+
+"Yes." She reached for them, and poured the powder down the barrels.
+
+"Not too much, Mademoiselle. We may run short."
+
+"Yes, M'sieu."
+
+To miss a mark in that solid mob would have been difficult. The first
+four shots brought down three men, and sent another limping away with
+a bleeding foot.
+
+"Keep it up, Father! Don't wait an instant. Fast, Mademoiselle, fast!
+Ah, there's one more. See, they are falling back. Take the other wall,
+Father. See that they do not come from the rear."
+
+The priest ran about the hut, peering through the chinks.
+
+"I see nothing," he called.
+
+"You had better stay there, then. Keep a close watch."
+
+The maid laid two loaded muskets at the Captain's side.
+
+"Can we hold them off, M'sieu?"
+
+His eye was pressed to an opening, and he did not turn.
+
+"I fear not, Mademoiselle. A few minutes more may settle it. But we
+can give them a fight."
+
+"If they come again, will you let me shoot, M'sieu?"
+
+He turned in surprise, and looked at her slight figure.
+
+"You, Mademoiselle?"
+
+"Yes; I can help. I have shot before."
+
+He laughed, with the excitement of the moment, and nodded. Then they
+were silent. She knelt by his side and looked through another opening.
+The women and children had retreated well up the path. The warriors
+were crowded together, just out of range, talking and shouting
+excitedly. A moment later a number of these slipped to the rear and
+ran off between the huts.
+
+"What does that mean, M'sieu? Will they come around behind?"
+
+"Yes. Watch out, Father. You will hear from them soon."
+
+"Very well, M'sieu. It will be hard. There are trees and bushes here
+for cover."
+
+Menard shrugged his shoulders, and made no reply. Time was all he
+wished.
+
+"If the Big Throat started with the first light, he should be here
+before another hour," he said to the maid, who was watching the
+Indians.
+
+"Yes," she replied.
+
+"Is there any corn in the basket, Mademoiselle?"
+
+"I think so. I had forgotten."
+
+"We shall need it. Wait; I will look."
+
+He got the basket, and brought it to her.
+
+"There is no time for cooking, but you had better eat what you can.
+And keep a close watch."
+
+"Here, M'sieu." She spread her skirt, and he poured out half of the
+corn.
+
+"You give me too much. You must not."
+
+He laughed, and crossed to the priest, saying over his shoulder:--
+
+"Mademoiselle is our new recruit. And the recruit must not complain of
+her food. I cannot allow it."
+
+The moments passed with no sign of action along the line of redskins
+on the path. They were quieter since the flanking party had started.
+To Menard it was evident that a plan had been settled upon. In a like
+position, a dozen Frenchmen would have stormed the hut, knowing that
+only two or three could fall before they were under the shelter of the
+walls; but even a large force of Indians was unwilling to take the
+chance.
+
+"Father," called the Captain, "it may be better for you to take the
+doorway. Mademoiselle and I will watch the forest."
+
+"Very well, M'sieu."
+
+The exchange was made rapidly.
+
+"Will you look out at the sides, as well?" Menard said to her. "Keep
+moving about, and using all the openings. There are too many chances
+for approach here."
+
+"If I see one, shall I shoot, M'sieu?"
+
+He smiled. "You had better tell me first."
+
+She stepped briskly about, peering through the chinks with an alert
+eye. Menard found it hard to keep his own watch, so eager were his
+eyes to watch her. But he turned resolutely toward the woods.
+
+"M'sieu!" she whispered. They had been silent for a long time. "To the
+left in the bushes! It looks like a head."
+
+"Can you make sure?"
+
+"Yes. It is a head. May I shoot?"
+
+Menard nodded without looking. She rested her musket in the opening
+between two logs, and fired quickly.
+
+"Did you hit him?"
+
+"Yes, I think so."
+
+She was breathless with excitement, but she reloaded at once. A moment
+later Menard fired, and then the priest.
+
+"On all sides, eh?" the Captain muttered. He called to the others:
+"Waste no powder. Shoot only when you are sure of hitting. They will
+fall back again. Two dead Indians will discourage the wildest
+charge."
+
+The firing went on at intervals, but still the warriors kept at it,
+creeping up from bush to bush and tree to tree. Menard's face grew
+more serious as the time went by. He began to realize that the Long
+Arrow was desperate, that he was determined on vengeance before the
+other chiefs could come. It had been a typical savage thought that had
+led him to bring Menard to this village, where he had once lived,
+rather than to the one in which the chief held greater permanent
+authority; the scheme was too complete and too near its end for delay
+or failure to be considered. Still the attacking party drew nearer,
+swelled every moment by a new group. Then Menard saw their object.
+They would soon be near enough to dash in close to the wall, where
+their very nearness would disable the white men's muskets.
+
+"Work fast!" he said suddenly. "They must not get nearer!"
+
+"Yes," panted the maid. Her shoulder was bruised by the heavy musket,
+her arms ached with the quick ramming and lifting, but she loaded and
+fired as rapidly as she could.
+
+"Father," called the Captain. "Quick! come here. They are too many for
+me!"
+
+The priest ran across the floor, half blinded by the smoke, cocking
+his musket as he came. "Where, M'sieu?"
+
+"There--at the oak! They are preparing for a rush!"
+
+He fired, at the last word, and one warrior sprawled on his face. The
+priest followed.
+
+"That will check them. Now back to the door!"
+
+Father Claude turned. The light was dim and the smoke heavy. His eyes
+smarted and blurred, so that he heard, rather than saw, the logs come
+crashing back into the hut. Menard heard it also; and together the two
+men dashed forward. They met the rush of Indians with blows that could
+not be stayed, but there was a score pushing behind the few who had
+entered. Slowly, the two backed across the hut. The stock of Menard's
+musket broke short off against the head of the Beaver. His foot struck
+another, and he snatched it up and fought on.
+
+"Mademoiselle," he called, "where are you?"
+
+"Here, M'sieu!"
+
+The voice was behind him. Then he felt a weight on his shoulder. The
+wearied maid, for want of another rest for her musket, fired past his
+face straight into the dark mass of Indians. She tried to reload, but
+Menard was swept back against her. With one arm he caught and held her
+tight against him, swinging the musket with his free hand. She clung
+to him, hardly breathing. They reached the rear wall. One tall warrior
+bounded forward and struck the musket from his hand. That was the end
+of the struggle. They were torn apart, and dragged roughly out into
+the blinding sunlight.
+
+Among the Iroquois, the torture was a religious rite, which nothing,
+once it was begun, could hasten. It may have been that the younger
+warriors would have rushed upon the captives to kill them; but if so,
+their elders held them back. The long lines formed again, and the
+doctors ran about the little group before the hut door, leaping and
+singing. Menard lay on his face, held down by three warriors. He tried
+to turn his head to see what had been done with the maid, but could
+not. He would have called to her, but to make a sound now would be to
+his captors an admission of weakness.
+
+A great clamour came from the lines. Menard wondered at the delay. He
+heard a movement a few yards away. Warriors were grunting, and feet
+shuffled on the ground. He heard the priest say, in a calm voice,
+"Courage, Mademoiselle"; and for a moment he struggled desperately.
+Then, realizing his mistake, he lay quiet. When at last he was jerked
+to his feet, he saw that the priest and the maid had been forced to
+take the two first places in the line. The maid was struggling in the
+grasp of two braves, one of whom made her hold a war club by closing
+his own hand over hers. Menard understood; his friends were to strike
+the first blows.
+
+The guards tried to drag him forward, but he went firmly with them,
+smiling scornfully. There was a delay, as the line was reached, for
+the maid could not be made to hold the club. Another man dropped out
+of the line to aid the two who held her.
+
+"Strike me, Mademoiselle," said Menard. "It is best."
+
+She shook her head. Father Claude spoke:--
+
+"M'sieu is right."
+
+It was then that she first looked at the Captain. When she saw the
+straight figure and the set face, a sense of her own weakness came to
+her, and she, too, straightened. Menard stepped forward; and raising
+the club she let it fall lightly on his shoulders. A shout went up.
+
+"Hard, Mademoiselle, hard," he said. "You must."
+
+She pressed her lips together, closed her eyes, and swung the club
+with all her strength. Then her muscles gave way, and she sank to the
+ground, not daring to look after the Captain as he passed on between
+the two rows of savages. She heard the shouts and the wild cries, but
+dimly, as if they came from far away. The confusion grew worse, and
+then died down. From screaming the voices dropped into excited
+argument. She did not know what it meant,--not until Father Claude
+bent over her and spoke gently.
+
+"What is it?" she whispered, not looking up. "What have they done?"
+
+"Nothing. The Big Throat has come."
+
+She raised her eyes helplessly.
+
+"He has come?"
+
+"Yes. I must go back. Take heart, Mademoiselle."
+
+He hurried away and slipped through the crowd that had gathered about
+Menard and the chief. She sat in a little heap on the ground, not
+daring to feel relieved, wondering what would come next. She could not
+see the Captain, but as the other voices dropped lower and lower, she
+could catch now and then a note of his voice. In a few moments, the
+warriors who were pressing close on the outskirts of the crowd were
+pushed aside, and he came out. She looked at him, then at the ground,
+shuddering, for there was blood on his forehead. Even when he stood
+over her she could not look up or speak.
+
+"There is hope now, Mademoiselle. He is here."
+
+"Yes--Father Claude told me. Is--are you to be released?"
+
+"Hardly that, but we shall at least have a little time. And I hope to
+get a hearing at the council."
+
+"He will let you?"
+
+"I have not asked him yet." He sat beside her, wearily. "There will be
+time for that. He is talking now with the Long Arrow and the old
+warriors. He is not fond of the Long Arrow." In the excitement he had
+not seen that she was limp and exhausted, but now he spoke quickly,
+"They have hurt you, Mademoiselle?"
+
+"No, I am not hurt. But you--your head--"
+
+"Only a bruise." He drew his sleeve across his forehead. "I had rather
+a bad one in the arm."
+
+He rolled up his sleeve in a matter-of-fact way. Her eyes filled.
+
+"Oh, M'sieu, you did not tell me. I can help you. Wait, I will be
+back."
+
+She rose, and started toward the spring, but he sprang to her side.
+
+"You must not trouble. It is not bad. There will be time for this."
+
+"No. Come with me if you will."
+
+She ran with nervous steps; and he strode after. At the side of the
+bubbling pool she knelt, and looked up impatiently.
+
+"It will not do to let this go, M'sieu. Can you roll your sleeve
+higher?"
+
+He tried, but the heavy cloth was stiff.
+
+"If you will take off the coat--"
+
+He unlaced it at the breast, and drew it off. She took his wrist, and
+plunged his arm into the pool, washing it with quick, gentle fingers,
+drying it on his coat. Then she leaned back, half perplexed, and
+looked around.
+
+"What is it?"
+
+"A cloth. No,"--as he reached for his coat;--"that is too rough. Here,
+M'sieu,--" she tore a strip from her skirt, and wrapped it around the
+forearm. "Hold it with your other hand, just a moment."
+
+She hurried to the hut, and returning with needle and thread, stitched
+the bandage. Then she helped him on with his coat, and they walked
+slowly to the hut.
+
+"Where is Father Claude?" she asked.
+
+He pointed to a thicket beyond the hut. There, kneeling by the body of
+a dying Indian, was the priest, praying silently. He had baptized the
+warrior with dew from the leaves at his side, and now was claiming his
+soul for the greater King in whose service his own life had been
+spent.
+
+The Captain sat beside the maid, their backs to the logs, and watched
+the shifting groups of warriors. He told her of the arrival of the Big
+Throat, and of the confusion that resulted. Then for a time they were
+silent, waiting for the impromptu council to reach a conclusion. The
+warriors finally began to drift away, though the younger and more
+curious ones still hung about. A group of braves came slowly toward
+the hut.
+
+"That is the Big Throat in front," said Menard. "The broad-shouldered
+warrior beside him is the Talking Eagle, the best-known chief of the
+clan of the Bear. They are almost here. We had better stand. Are you
+too tired?"
+
+"No, indeed."
+
+Father Claude had seen the group approaching, and he joined Menard.
+The Big Throat stood motionless and looked at the Captain.
+
+"My brother, the Big Buffalo, has asked to speak with the Big Throat,"
+he said at length.
+
+Menard bowed, but did not reply.
+
+"He asks for his release,--and for the holy man and the squaw?"
+
+"The Big Buffalo asks nothing save what the chiefs of the Onondagas
+would give to a chief taken in battle. The Long Arrow has lied to the
+Big Buffalo. He has soiled his hands with the blood of women and holy
+Fathers. The Big Buffalo was told by Onontio, whom all must obey, to
+come to the Onondagas and give them his word. The Long Arrow was
+impatient. He would not let him journey in peace. He wished to injure
+him; to let his blood. Now the Big Buffalo is here. He asks that he
+may be heard at the council, to give the chief the word of Onontio.
+That is all."
+
+The Big Throat's face was inscrutable. He looked at Menard without a
+word until the silence grew tense, and the maid caught her breath.
+Then he said, with the cool, diplomatic tone that concealed whatever
+kindness or justice may have prompted the words:--
+
+"The Big Buffalo shall be heard at the council to-night. The chiefs of
+the Onondagas never are deaf to the words of Onontio."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII.
+
+THE LONG HOUSE.
+
+
+The council-house was a hundred paces or more in length. The frame was
+of tall hickory saplings planted in the ground in two rows, with the
+tops bent over and lashed together in the form of an arch. The
+building was not more than fifteen yards wide. The lower part of the
+outer wall was of logs, the upper part and the roof of bark. Instead
+of a chimney there was a narrow opening in the roof, extending the
+length of the building.
+
+A row of smouldering fires reached nearly from end to end of the
+house. The smoke struggled upward, but failing, for the greater part,
+to find the outlet overhead, remained inside to clog the air and dim
+the eyes. The chiefs sat in a long ellipse in the central part of the
+house, some sitting erect with legs crossed, others half reclining,
+while a few lay sprawling, their chins resting on their hands. The Big
+Throat sat with the powerful chiefs of the nation at one end. The
+lesser sachems, including the Long Arrow, sat each before his own band
+of followers. The second circle was made up of the older and
+better-known warriors. Behind these, pressing close to catch every
+word of the argument, were braves, youths, women, and children, mixed
+together indiscriminately. A low platform extended the length of the
+building against the wall on each side, and this held another
+crowding, elbowing, whispering mass of redskins. Every chief and
+warrior, as well as most of the women, held each a pipe between his
+teeth, and puffed out clouds of smoke into the thick air.
+
+The maid's eyes smarted and blurred in the smoke. It reached her
+throat, and she coughed.
+
+"Lie down, Mademoiselle," said Menard. "Breathe close to the ground
+and it will not be so bad."
+
+She hesitated, looking at the Big Throat, who sat with arms folded,
+proud and dignified. Then she smiled, and lay almost flat on the
+ground, breathing in the current of less impure air that passed
+beneath the smoke. They had been placed in the inner circle, next to
+the chiefs of the nations, where Menard's words would have the weight
+that, to the mind of the Big Throat, was due to a representative of
+the French Governor, even in time of war. Father Claude, sitting on
+the left of the maid, was looking quietly into the fire. He had
+committed the case into the hands of Providence, and he was certain
+that the right words would be given to the Captain.
+
+It was nearing the close of the afternoon. A beam of sunlight slipped
+in at one end of the roof-opening, and slanted downward, clearing a
+shining way through the smoke. A Cayuga chief was speaking.
+
+"The corn is ripening in the fields about the Onondaga village. As I
+came down the hills of the west to-day I saw the green tops waving in
+the wind, and I was glad, for I knew that my brothers would feast in
+plenty, that their Manitous have been kind. The Cayugas, too, have
+great fields of corn, and the Senecas. Their women have worked
+faithfully that the land might be plentiful.
+
+"But a storm is breaking over the cornfields of the Senecas. It is a
+great cloud that has come down from the north, with the flash of fire
+and the roar of thunder, and with hailstones of lead that will leave
+no stalk standing. My brothers know the strength of the north wind.
+They have not forgotten other storms that would have laid waste the
+villages of the Senecas and the Mohawks. And they have not forgotten
+their Manitous, who have whispered to them when the clouds appeared in
+the northern sky, 'Rise up, Mohawks and Oneidas and Onondagas and
+Cayugas and Senecas, and stand firmly against this storm, and your
+homes and your fields shall not be destroyed.'"
+
+The house was silent with interest. The maid raised her head and
+watched the stolid faces of the chiefs in the inner circle. Not an
+expression changed from beginning to end of the speech. Beyond, she
+could see other, younger faces, some eager, some bitter, some defiant,
+some smiling, and all showing the flush of excitement,--but these grim
+old chiefs had long schooled their faces to hide their thoughts. They
+held their blankets close, and puffed deliberately at their pipes with
+hardly a movement of the lips.
+
+The Cayuga went on:--
+
+"Messengers have come to the Cayugas from their brothers, the Senecas,
+telling of the storm that is rushing on them. The Cayugas know the
+hearts of the Five Nations. When the Mohawks have risen to defend
+their homes, the hearts of the Cayugas have been warm, and they have
+taken up the hatchet with their brothers. When the Onondagas have gone
+on the war-path, Senecas and Cayugas have gone with them, and the
+trouble of one has been the trouble of all."
+
+"The good White Father is no longer the war chief of the white men.
+The Great Mountain, who knew the voice of the forest, who spoke
+with the tongue of the redman, has been called back to his
+Great-Chief-Across-the-Water. His word was the word of kindness, and
+when he spoke our hearts were warm. But another mountain is now the
+war chief, a mountain that spits fire and lead, that speaks with a
+double tongue. The Five Nations have never turned from a foe. The
+enemy of the Senecas has been the enemy of the Mohawks. If the storm
+strikes the fields of the Senecas, their brothers will not turn
+away and stop their ears and say they do not hear the thunder, for
+they remember the storms of other seasons, and they know that the
+hail that destroys one field will destroy other fields. And so this is
+the word of the Cayugas:--Let all the warriors of the Five Nations
+take up the hatchet; let them go on the war-path to tell this
+white chief with the double tongue that the Five Nations are one
+nation; that they are bolder than thunder, swifter than fire,
+stronger than lead."
+
+The maid found it hard, with her imperfect knowledge of the language,
+to follow his metaphors. She had partly risen, heedless of the smoke,
+and was leaning forward with her eyes fixed on the stern face of the
+speaker. Menard bent down, and half smiled at her excitement.
+
+"What is it?" she whispered. "He is for war?"
+
+"Yes; he naturally would be." There was a stir about the house, as the
+speech ended, and they could speak softly without drawing notice. "The
+Cayugas are nearer to the Senecas than the other nations, and they
+fear that they too may suffer."
+
+"Then you do not think they all feel with him?"
+
+"No; the Oneidas and Mohawks, and even the Onondagas, are too far to
+the east to feel in danger. They know how hard it would be for the
+Governor to move far from his base in this country. It may be that the
+younger warriors will be for fighting, but the older heads will think
+of the corn."
+
+"Will the Big Throat speak?"
+
+"Yes; but not like these others. He talks simply and forcibly. That is
+the way when a chief's reputation is made. The Big Throat won his
+name, as a younger brave, by his wonderful oratory."
+
+"And you, M'sieu,--you will be heard?"
+
+"Yes; I think so. We must not talk any more now. They will not like
+it."
+
+The Cayuga was followed by a wrinkled old chief of the Oneidas, called
+the Hundred Skins. He stepped forward and stood near the fire, his
+blanket drawn close about his shoulders, where the red light could
+play on his face. A whisper ran around the outer circle, for it was
+known that he stood for peace.
+
+"My Cayuga brother has spoken wisely," he began, in a low but distinct
+voice. He looked slowly about the house to command attention. "The
+Oneidas have not forgotten the storms of other seasons; they have not
+forgotten the times of starving, when neither the Manitous of the
+redman nor the God of the white man came to help. The grain stood
+brown in the fields; the leaves hung dead from the trees; there was no
+wind to cool the fever that carried away old men and young men, squaws
+and children. And when the wind came, and the cold and snow of the
+winter, there was no food in the lodges of the Five Nations. My
+brothers have heard that the corn is rising to a man's height--they
+have seen it to-day in the fields of the Onondagas. They know that
+this corn must be cared for like the children of their lodges, if they
+wish food to eat when the winter comes and the fields are dead. They
+know what it will cost them to take the war-path.
+
+"Twelve moons have not gone since the chiefs of the Senecas rose in
+this house and called on the warriors of the Five Nations to take up
+the hatchet against the white men of the north. The skins of the
+beaver were talking in their ears. They saw great canoes on the white
+man's rivers loaded with skins, and their hands itched and their
+hearts turned inward. Then the wise chiefs of the Oneidas and Cayugas
+and Onondagas and Mohawks spoke well. They were not on the war-path;
+the hatchet was deep in the ground, and young trees were growing over
+it. Then the Oneidas said that the White Chief would not forget if the
+Senecas heeded their itching hands and listened to the bad medicine of
+the beaver skins in their ears. But the Senecas were not wise, and
+they took up the hatchet.
+
+"This is the word of the Oneidas to the chiefs of the Long House:--The
+Seneca has put his foot in the trap. Then shall the Oneida and
+Onondaga and Cayuga and Mohawk rush after, that they too may put in
+their feet where they can get away only by gnawing off the bone? Shall
+the wise chiefs of the Long House run into fight like the dogs of
+their village? The Oneidas say no! The Senecas took up the hatchet;
+let them bury it where they can. And when the winter comes, the
+Oneidas will send them corn that they may not have another time of
+starving."
+
+Menard was watching the Oneida with eyes that fairly snapped. The low
+voice stopped, and another murmur ran around the outer circles. The
+Hundred Skins had spoken boldly, and the Cayuga young men looked
+stern. The chief stepped slowly back and resumed his seat, and then,
+not before, did Menard's face relax. He looked about cautiously to see
+if he was observed, then settled back and gazed stolidly into the
+fire. The old Oneida had played directly into his hand; by letting
+slip the motive for the Seneca raid of the winter before, he had
+strengthened the one weak point in the speech Menard meant to make.
+
+The next speaker was one of the younger war chiefs of the Onondagas.
+He made an effort to speak with the calmness of the older men, but
+there was now and then a flash in his eye and an ill-controlled vigour
+in his voice that told Menard and the priest how strong was the war
+party of this village. The Onondaga plunged into his speech without
+the customary deliberation.
+
+"Our brothers, the Senecas, have sent to us for aid. We have been
+called to the Long House to hear the voice of the Senecas,--not from
+the lips of their chiefs, for they have fields and villages to guard
+against the white man, and they are not here to stand before the
+council and ask what an Iroquois never refuses. The Cayuga has spoken
+with the voice of the Seneca. Shall the chiefs and warriors of the
+Long House say to the Cayuga, 'Go back to your village and send
+messengers to the Senecas to tell them that their brothers of the Long
+House have corn and squaws and children that are more to them than the
+battles of their brothers--tell the Senecas that the Oneidas must eat
+and cannot fight'? There is corn in the fields of the Oneidas. But
+there is food for all the Five Nations in the great house on the
+Lake."
+
+The speaker paused to let his words sink in. Menard whispered to the
+maid, in reply to an inquiring look. "He means the Governor's base of
+supplies at La Famine."
+
+The Onondaga's voice began to rise.
+
+"When the Oneida thinks of his corn, is he afraid to leave it to his
+squaws? Does he hesitate because he thinks the white warriors are
+strong enough to turn on him and drive him from his villages? This is
+not the speech that young warriors are taught to expect from the Long
+House. When has the Long House been guided by fear? No. If the Oneida
+is hungry, let him eat from the stores of the white man, at the house
+on the Lake. The Cayugas and Onondagas will draw their belts tighter,
+that the Oneida may be filled."
+
+The young chief looked defiantly around. There was a murmur from the
+outer circle, but the chiefs were grave and silent. The Hundred Skins
+gazed meditatively into the fire as if he had not heard, slowly
+puffing at his pipe. The taunt of cowardice had sprung out in the heat
+of youth; his dignity demanded that he ignore it. The speech had its
+effect on the Cayugas and the young men, but the older heads were
+steady.
+
+Other chiefs rose, talked, and resumed their places, giving all views
+of the situation and of the relations between the Iroquois and the
+French,--but still little expression showed on the inner circle of
+faces. The maid after a time grew more accustomed to the smoke, and
+sat up. She was puzzled by the conflicting arguments and the lack of
+enthusiasm. Fully two hours had passed, and there was no sign of an
+agreement. The eager spectators, in the outer rows, gradually settled
+down.
+
+During a lull between two speeches, Menard spoke to the maid, who was
+beginning to show traces of weariness.
+
+"It may be a long sitting, Mademoiselle. We must make the best of
+it."
+
+"Yes." She smiled. "I am a little tired. It has been a hard day."
+
+"Too hard, poor child. But I hope to see you safe very soon now. I am
+relying on the Big Throat. He, with a few of the older chiefs, sees
+farther than these hot-heads. He knows that France must conquer in the
+end, and is wise enough to make terms whenever he can."
+
+"But can he, M'sieu? Will they obey him?"
+
+"Not obey, exactly; he will not command them. Indians have no
+discipline such as ours. The chiefs rely on their judgment and
+influence. But they have followed the guidance of the Big Throat for
+too many years to leave it now."
+
+Another chief rose to speak. The sun had gone, and the long building
+was growing dark rapidly. A number of squaws came through the circle,
+throwing wood on the fires. The new flames shot up, and threw a
+flickering light on the copper faces, many of which still wore the
+paint of the morning. The smoke lay over them in wavering films, now
+and again half hiding some sullen face until it seemed to fade away
+into the darkness.
+
+At last the whole situation lay clear before the council. Some
+speakers were for war, some for peace, others for aiding the Senecas
+as a matter of principle. The house was divided.
+
+There was a silence, and the pipes glowed in the dusk; then the Long
+Arrow rose. The listless spectators stirred and leaned forward. The
+maid, too, was moved, feeling that at last the moment of decision was
+near. She was surprised to see that he had none of the savage
+excitement of the morning. He was as quiet and tactful in speech as
+the Big Throat himself.
+
+Slowly the Long Arrow drew his blanket close about him and began to
+speak. The house grew very still, for the whole tribe knew that he
+had, in his anger of the morning, disputed the authority of the Big
+Throat. There had been hot words, and the great chief had rebuked him
+contemptuously within the hearing of half a hundred warriors. Now he
+was to stand before the council, and not a man in that wide circle but
+wondered how much he would dare to say.
+
+He seemed not to observe the curious glances. Simply and quietly he
+began the narrative of the capture of the hunting party at Fort
+Frontenac. At the first words Menard turned to Father Claude with a
+meaning look. The maid saw it, and her lips framed a question.
+
+"It is better than I hoped," Menard whispered. "He is bringing it up
+himself."
+
+"Not two moons have waned," the Long Arrow was saying, "since five
+score brave young warriors left our village for the hunt. They left
+the hatchet buried under the trees. They took no war-paint. The Great
+Mountain had said that there was peace between the redman and the
+white man; he had asked the Onondagas to hunt on the banks of the
+Great River; he had told them that his white sons at the Stone House
+would take them as brothers into their lodges. When the Great Mountain
+said this, through the mouths of the holy Fathers, he lied."
+
+The words came out in the same low, even tone in which he had begun
+speaking, but they sank deep. The house was hushed; even the stirring
+of the children on the benches died away.
+
+"The Great Mountain has lied to his children,"--Menard's keen ears
+caught the bitter, if covered, sarcasm in the last two words; they
+had been Governor Frontenac's favourite term in addressing the
+Iroquois--"and his children know his voice no longer. There is corn
+in the fields? Let it grow or rot. There are squaws and children
+in our lodges? Let them live or die. It is not the Senecas who ask
+our aid; it is the voice of a hundred sons and brothers and youths
+and squaws calling from far beyond the great water,--calling from
+chains, calling from fever, calling from the Happy Hunting Ground,
+where they have gone without guns or corn or blankets, where they
+lie with nothing to comfort them." The Long Arrow stood erect, with
+head thrown back and eyes fixed on the opposite wall. "Our sons and
+brothers went like children to the Stone House of the white man.
+Their hands were stretched before them, their muskets hung empty
+from their shoulders, their bowstrings were loosened; the calumet was
+in their hands. But the sons of Onontio lied as their fathers had
+taught them. They took the calumet; they called the Onondagas into
+their great lodge; and in the sleep of the white man's fire-water
+they chained them. Five score Onondagas have gone to be slaves to
+the Great-Chief-Across-the-Water, who loves his children and is kind
+to them, and would take them all under his arm where no storm can
+harm them. My brothers of the Long House have heard the promises of
+Onontio, and they have seen the fork in his tongue. And so they
+choose this time to speak of corn and squaws and children." The
+keen, closely set eyes slowly lowered and swept around the circle.
+"Is this the time to speak of corn? Our Manitou has sent this
+Great Mountain into our country. He has placed him in our hands so
+that we may strike, so that we may tell the white man with our
+muskets that our Manitou is stern and just, and that no Iroquois
+will listen to the idle words of a double tongue."
+
+He paused, readjusted his blanket, and then stood motionless, that all
+might digest his words. Then, after a long wait, he went on:--
+
+"There are children to-day in our lodges who can remember the Big
+Buffalo, who can remember our adopted son who shared our fires and
+food, who shared our hunts, who lived with us as freely as an
+Onondaga. We saw him every day, and we forgot that his heart was as
+white as his skin, for his tongue was the tongue of an Onondaga. We
+forgot that the white man has two tongues. It has not been long, my
+brothers,--not long enough for an Onondaga to forget. But the Big
+Buffalo is a mangy dog. He forgot the brothers of his lodge. He it was
+who took the Onondaga hunters and carried them away to be slaves. But
+the Manitou did not forget. He has put this Big Buffalo into our
+hands, that we may give him what should be given to the dog who
+forgets his master."
+
+Again the Long Arrow paused.
+
+"No; this is not the time to speak of corn. It is not the Senecas who
+call us, it is our brothers and their squaws and children. The
+Iroquois have been the greatest warriors of the world. They have
+driven the Hurons to the far northern forests; the Illinois to the
+Father of Waters, two moons' travel to the west; the Delawares to the
+waters of the south. They have told the white man to stay within his
+boundaries, and he has stayed. They have been kind to the white man;
+they have welcomed the holy Fathers into their villages. But now the
+Great Mountain makes slaves of the Onondagas. He brings his warriors
+across the Great Lake to punish the Senecas and destroy their lodges.
+Shall the Long House of the Five Nations turn a white face to this
+Great Mountain? Shall the Long House call out in a shaking voice,
+'See, Onontio, there are no heads on our arrows, no flints in our
+muskets! our hatchets are dull, our knives nicked and rusted! come,
+Onontio, and strike us, that we may know you are our master and our
+father'?"
+
+The Long Arrow's voice had risen only slightly, but now it dropped; he
+went on, in a tone that was keen as a knife, but so low that those at
+the farther end of the house leaned forward and sat motionless.
+
+"It has been said to-day to the Long House that we shall close our
+ears to the thunder of the Great Mountain, that we should think of our
+corn and our squaws, and leave the Senecas to fight their own battles.
+But the Long House will not do this. The Long House will not give up
+the liberty that has been the pride of the Iroquois since first the
+rivers ran to the lake, and the moss grew on the trees, and the wind
+waved the tops of the long grass. The Great Mountain has come to take
+this liberty. He shall not have it. No; he shall lose his own--we will
+leave his bones to dry where the Seneca dogs run loose. The Big
+Buffalo shall die to tell the white man that the Iroquois never
+forgets; the Great Mountain shall die to tell the white man that the
+Iroquois is free."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII.
+
+THE VOICE OF THE GREAT MOUNTAIN.
+
+
+There was no lack of interest now in the council. The weariness left
+the maid's eyes as she followed the speeches that came in rapid
+succession. There was still the disagreement, the confusion of a dozen
+different views and demands; but the speech of the Long Arrow had
+pointed the discussion, it had set up an opinion to be either defended
+or attacked.
+
+"Will the Big Throat speak now?" asked Mademoiselle, leaning close to
+Menard.
+
+"I hardly think so. I don't know what will come next."
+
+"When will you speak, M'sieu?"
+
+"Not until word from the Big Throat. It would be a breach of
+courtesy."
+
+One warrior, a member of the Beaver family, and probably a blood
+relative of the Beaver who had been killed in the fight of the
+morning, took advantage of the pause to speak savagely for war and
+vengeance. He counted those who had fallen since the sun rose, and
+appealed to their families to destroy the man who had killed them. He
+was not a chief, but his fiery speech aroused a murmur of approval
+from scattered groups of the spectators. This sympathy from those
+about him, with the anger which was steadily fed by his own hot words,
+gradually drove from his mind the observance of etiquette which was so
+large a part of an important council. Still speaking, he left his
+place, and walking slowly between two of the fires and across the
+circle, paused before Menard.
+
+"The dog whom we fed and grew has turned against its masters, as the
+dogs of your own lodges, my brothers, will bite the hand that pats
+their heads. It has hung about outside of the Great Lodge to kill the
+hunter who sees no danger ahead. And now, when this dog is caught, and
+tied at your door, would not my brothers bring him to the end of all
+evil beasts?" As he finished, he made a gesture of bitter contempt and
+kicked Menard.
+
+A shout went up, and voices clamoured, protesting, denouncing,
+exulting. The Captain's eyes flashed fire. It was not for a second
+that he hesitated. Weakness, to an Indian, is the last, the greatest
+fault. If he should take this insult, it would end forever not only
+his own chance of escape, with the maid and the priest, but all hope
+of safety for the Governor's column. He sprang to his feet before the
+Indian, whose arm was still stretched out in the gesture, and with two
+quick blows knocked him clear of his feet, and then kicked him into
+the fire.
+
+A dozen hands dragged the warrior from the fire and stamped out a
+blaze that had started in the fringe of one legging. Every man in the
+house was on his feet, shouting and screaming. Menard stood with his
+hands at his side, smiling, with the same look of scorn he had worn in
+the morning when they led him to the torture. Father Claude drew
+closer to the maid, and the two sat without moving. Then above the
+uproar rose the voice of the Big Throat; and slowly the noise died
+away. The chief stepped to the centre of the circle, but before he
+could speak Menard had reached his side, and motioned to him to be
+silent.
+
+"My brothers," he said, looking straight at the fallen warrior, who
+was scrambling to his feet,--"my brothers, the Big Buffalo is sorry
+that the Onondagas have among them a fool who thinks himself a
+warrior. The Big Buffalo is not here to fight fools. He is here to
+talk to chiefs. He is glad that the fool speaks only for himself and
+not for the brave men of the Long House." He walked deliberately back
+and resumed his seat by the maid.
+
+[Illustration: "Menard stood ... smiling with the same look of scorn he
+had worn ... when they led him to the torture."]
+
+"Courage, Mademoiselle," he said close to her ear. "It is all right."
+
+"What will they do, M'sieu?"
+
+"Nothing. I have won. Wait--the Big Throat is speaking."
+
+One by one the warriors fell back to their seats. Some were muttering,
+some were smiling; but all were subdued. The Big Throat's voice was
+calm and firm.
+
+"The Big Buffalo has spoken well. The word of a fool is not the word
+of the Long House. The White Chief comes to give us the voice of
+Onontio, and we will listen."
+
+He turned toward Menard, and then resumed his seat.
+
+The Captain rose, and looked about the circle. The chiefs were
+motionless. Even the Long Arrow, now that his outburst was past,
+closed his lips over the stem of his pipe and gazed at the smoke.
+Father Claude drew forward the bundle and opened it, the maid helping.
+Some of the boys behind them crowded closer to see the presents.
+
+Menard spoke slowly and quietly. The rustling and whispering in the
+outer circle died away, so that every word was distinct.
+
+"When the Five Nations have given their word to another nation, it has
+not been necessary to sign a paper; it has not been necessary to keep
+a record. The Long Arrow has said that the Iroquois do not forget. He
+is right. The words that have gone out from the councils have never
+been forgotten. I see here, in this council, the faces of warriors who
+have grown old in serving their people, of chiefs who are bent and
+wrinkled with the cares of many generations. I see in the eyes of my
+brothers that they have not forgotten the Onontio, who went away to
+his greater chief only five seasons ago. They have seen this Onontio
+in war and peace. They have listened to his silver tongue in the
+council. They have called themselves his children, and have known that
+he was a wise and kind father. They remember the promises they made
+him. But the Senecas did not remember. The Seneca has no ears; he has
+a hole in his head, and the words of his father have passed through.
+The Senecas promised Onontio that they would not take the white man's
+beaver. But when the English came to their lodges and whispered in
+their ears, the hole was stopped. The English whispered of brandy and
+guns and powder and hatchets and knives. They told the Senecas that
+these things should be given to them if they would steal the beaver.
+The English are cowards--they sent the Senecas to do what they were
+afraid to do. And then the hole in the Seneca's head was stopped--the
+Seneca who had forgotten the words of Onontio remembered the words of
+the English.
+
+"My brothers of the Long House had not forgotten the promises they had
+given Onontio. When the Seneca chiefs called for aid in stealing the
+beaver, my brothers were wise and said no. The Onondagas and Cayugas
+and Oneidas and Mohawks were loyal--they kept their promise, and
+Onontio has not forgotten; he will not forget.
+
+"This is what the Great Mountain would say to you, my brothers: You
+have been faithful to your word, and he is pleased. He knows that the
+Onondagas are his children. And he knows why the Senecas left their
+villages and fields to plunder his white children. It was for the
+skins of the beaver, which the white braves had taken from their own
+forests and would bring in their canoes down the Ottawa to trade at
+the white man's villages. He knows, my brothers, that the Senecas had
+tired of their promises, and now would steal the beaver and sell it to
+the English. What comes to the boy when he climbs the tree to steal
+the honey which the bees have gathered and taken to their home? Is he
+not stung and bitten until he cries that he will not disturb the bees
+again? The Senecas have tried to take that which is to the white man
+as the honey is to the bee; and they too must be stung and bitten
+until they have learned that the Great Mountain will always protect
+those who deserve his aid. He has sent you a comb from the shell of
+the great sea-tortoise, more precious than a thousand wampum shells,
+to tell you that as the sea-monster pursues its enemies, so will he
+pursue those who cannot keep their promises--who lie to him."
+
+Father Claude handed him the comb, and he laid it before the Big
+Throat. It was evident that he had been closely followed, and he
+started on his second word with more vigour.
+
+"Your chiefs have spoken to-day of the storm cloud that has swept down
+from the north; your runners have told you that it is not a cloud, but
+an army, that has come up the great river and across the lake of
+Frontenac to the country of the Senecas. Do my brothers know what a
+great army follows their White Father when he sets out to punish his
+children? More than twenty score of trained warriors are in this war
+party, and every warrior carries a musket; to-night they are marching
+on the Seneca villages. They will destroy those villages as a brave
+would destroy a nest of hornets in his lodge. Not one lodge will be
+left standing, not one stalk of corn.
+
+"The Oneidas and Onondagas and Cayugas talk of their cornfields. But
+even the Cayugas need have no fear. For Onontio is a wise and just
+father; he punishes only those that offend him. The Senecas have
+broken their promises, and the Senecas must be punished, but the other
+nations are still the children of the Great Mountain, and his hand is
+over them. The Big Buffalo has come from the Great Mountain to tell
+you that he will not harm the Cayugas; their fields and lodges are
+safe."
+
+There was a stir at this, and then quiet, as the spectators settled
+back to hear the rest of Menard's speech. Here was a captive who spoke
+as boldly as their own chiefs, who commanded their attention as a
+present bearer from the White Chief. And they knew, all of them, from
+the way in which he was choosing his words, coolly ignoring the more
+important subjects until he should be ready to deal with them, that he
+spoke with authority. He knew his auditors, and he let them see that
+he knew them.
+
+"The Senecas have listened to the English. What do they expect from
+them? Do they think that the English wish to help them? Do they look
+for wealth and support from the English? My brothers of the Long House
+know better. They have seen the English hide from the anger of the
+Great Mountain. They have seen the iron hand of New France reach out
+across the northern country, and along the shores of the great lakes,
+and down the Father of Waters in the far west, while the English were
+clinging to their little strip of land on the edge of the sea. My
+brothers know who is strong and who is weak. Never have the fields of
+the Five Nations been so rich and so large. No wars have disturbed
+them. They have grown and prospered. Do the Senecas think it is the
+English who have made them great? No--the Senecas are not fools. They
+know that the Great Mountain has driven away their enemies and given
+them peace and plenty. My brothers of the Long House remembered this
+when the Senecas came to them and asked for aid in stealing the
+beaver. They stopped their ears; they knew that Onontio was their
+father, and that they must be faithful to him if they wished to have
+plenty in their lodges.
+
+"Onontio is a patient father. Let the Senecas repent, and he will
+forgive them. Let them bury the hatchet, and he will forgive them. Let
+them be satisfied with peace and honest trade, and he will buy their
+furs, and give them fair payment. And then their cornfields shall grow
+so large that a fleet runner cannot pass around them in half a moon.
+They shall have no more famine. Their pouches shall be full of powder,
+their muskets new and bright. Their women shall have warm clothing and
+many beads. Nowhere shall there be such prosperous nations as here
+among the Iroquois. If the Senecas have broken their pledges and have
+not repented, they must be punished. But the Cayugas and Onondagas and
+Oneidas and Mohawks have not broken their pledges. The Great Mountain
+has sent the Big Buffalo to tell them that he has seen that they are
+loyal, and he is pleased. He knows that they are wise. If the
+Onondagas have a grievance, he will not forget it, and if they ask for
+vengeance he will hear them. The Great Mountain knows that the
+Onondagas are his children, that they will not make war upon their
+father. He sends this coat of seal fur that the hearts of the Cayugas
+and Onondagas and Oneidas and Mohawks may be kept warm, and to tell
+them that he loves them and will protect them."
+
+The maid's eyes sparkled with excitement.
+
+"I wish they would speak, or laugh, or do something," she whispered to
+Father Claude, "Are they not interested? They hardly seem to hear
+him."
+
+The priest looked at her gravely.
+
+"Yes," he replied, "they are listening."
+
+The time had come to speak of La Grange. The Captain had been steadily
+leading up to this moment. He had tried to show the Indians that they
+had no complaint, no cause for war, unless it was the one incident at
+Fort Frontenac. He knew that the chiefs not only understood his
+argument, but that they were quietly waiting for him to approach this
+real cause of trouble, and were probably curious to see how he would
+meet it. The mind of the Iroquois, when in the council, separated from
+the heat and emotion of the dance, the hunt, the war-path, was
+remarkably keen. Menard felt sure that if he could present his case
+logically and firmly, it would appeal to most of the chief and older
+warriors. Then the maid came into his thoughts, and he knew, though he
+did not look down, that she was gazing up at him and waiting. He
+hesitated for a moment longer. The chiefs, too, were waiting. The Long
+House was hushed:--three hundred faces were looking at him through the
+twisting, curling smoke that blurred the scene into an unreal picture.
+Yes, the time had come to speak of La Grange; and he spoke the first
+words hurriedly, stepping half-unconsciously farther from the maid.
+
+There was a part of the true story of the capture which he did not
+tell,--the Governor's part. For the rest, it was all there, every word
+about La Grange and his treacherous act coming out almost brutally.
+
+"Your speakers have told you of the hunting party that was taken into
+the stone house, and put into chains, and sent away to be slaves to
+the Chief-Across-the-Water. There is a chief at the stone house whom
+you have seen fighting bravely in many a battle. He is a bold warrior;
+none is so quick or so tireless as Captain la Grange. But he has a
+devil in his heart. The bad medicine of white man and redman, the
+fire-water, is always close to him, ready to whisper to him and guide
+him. It was not the father at Quebec that broke the faith with the
+Onondagas. It was not the Big Buffalo. If the Big Buffalo could so
+forget his brothers of the Onondaga lodges, he would not have come
+back to the Long House to tell them of the sorrow of the Great
+Mountain. My brothers have seen the Big Buffalo in war and peace--they
+know that he would not do this.
+
+"The devil was in Captain la Grange's heart. He captured my brothers.
+He told the Great Mountain that it was a war party, that he had taken
+them prisoners fairly. He lied to the Great Mountain. When the Great
+Mountain asked the Big Buffalo to bring the prisoners to his great
+village on the river, the Big Buffalo could not say, 'No, I am no
+longer your son!' When the Great Mountain commands, the Big Buffalo
+obeys. With sorrow in his heart he did as his father told him."
+
+Menard was struggling to put the maid out of his thoughts, to keep in
+view only the safety of the column and the welfare of New France. And
+as the words came rapidly to his lips and fell upon the ears of that
+silent audience, he began to feel that they believed him.
+
+"My brothers," he said, with more feeling than they knew, "it is five
+seasons since I left your village for the land of the white man. In
+that time you have had no thought that I was not indeed your brother,
+the son of your chief. You have known other Frenchmen. Father Claude,
+who sits by my side; Father Jean de Lamberville, who has given his
+many years to save you for the great white man's Manitou; Major
+d'Orvilliers, who has never failed to give food and shelter to the
+starving hunter at his great stone house,--I could name a hundred
+others. You know that these are honest, that what they promise will be
+done. But in every village is a fool, in every family is one who is
+weak and cannot earn a name on the hunt. You have a warrior in this
+house who to-day raised his hand against a visitor in the great
+council. My brothers,--it is with sadness that I say it,--not all the
+white men are true warriors. You are wise chiefs and brave warriors;
+you know that because one man is a dog, it is not so with all his
+nation. The Great Mountain sends me to you, and I speak in his voice.
+I tell you that Captain la Grange is a dog, that he has broken the
+faith of the white man and the redman, that the father at Quebec and
+the Great-Chief-Across-the-Water, who are so quick to punish their red
+children, will also punish the white. The white men are good. They
+love the Onondagas. And if any white man breaks the faith, he shall be
+punished."
+
+His voice had risen, and he was speaking in a glow that seemed to drop
+a spark into each listening heart. He knew now that they believed. He
+turned abruptly for the present. Father Claude was so absorbed in
+following the speech, and in watching the maid, who sat with flushed
+cheeks and lowered eyes, that he was not ready, and Menard stooped and
+took the book. He could not avoid seeing the maid, when he looked
+down; and the priest felt a sudden pain in his own heart to see the
+look of utter weariness that came into the Captain's eyes.
+
+Menard turned the leaves of the book for a moment, as if to collect
+himself, and then held it open so that the Indians could see the
+bright pictures. There was a craning of necks in the outer circles.
+
+"In these picture writings is told the story of the 'Ceremonies of the
+Mass applied to the Passion of Our Lord,'" he said slowly. "And our
+Lord is your Great Spirit. It brings you a message; it tells you that
+the white man is a good man, who punishes his own son as sternly as
+his red child."
+
+The present pleased the Big Throat. He would not let his curiosity
+appear in the council, but he dropped the book so that it fell open,
+seemingly by accident, and his eyes strayed to it now and then during
+the last word of the speech. Menard did not hesitate again.
+
+"I have told my Onondaga brothers that this white dog shall be
+punished," he said. "When this word is given in your council in the
+voice of Onontio, it is a word that cannot be broken. Wind is not
+strong enough, thunder is not loud enough, waves are not fierce
+enough, snows are not cold enough, powder is not swift enough to break
+it." The words came swiftly from his lips. Calm old chiefs leaned
+forward that they might catch every syllable. Eyes were brighter with
+interest. The Long Arrow, thinking of his son and fearing lest the man
+who killed him should slip from his grasp, grew troubled and more
+stern. At last Menard turned, and taking the portrait from the
+priest's hands held it up, slowly turning it so that all could see it
+in the uncertain firelight. At first they were puzzled and surprised;
+then a murmur of recognition ran from lip to lip.
+
+"You know this maid," Menard was saying, "this maid who to all who
+love the Iroquois, to all who love the church, the Great Spirit, is a
+saint. Her spirit has been for many moons in the happy hunting ground.
+The snow has lain cold and heavy on her grave. The night bird has sung
+her beauty in the empty forest. Catherine Outasoren has come back from
+the land where the corn is always growing, where the snows can never
+fall; she has come back to bear you the word of the Great Mountain.
+She has come to tell you that the dog who broke the oath of the white
+man to the Onondagas must suffer. This is the pledge of the Great
+Mountain."
+
+He stopped abruptly, and stood looking with flashing eyes at the
+circle of chiefs. There was silence for a moment, then a murmur that
+rapidly rose and swelled into the loud chatter of many voices. Menard
+laid the portrait at the feet of the Big Throat, and took his seat at
+the side of the maid,--but he did not look at her nor she at him.
+Father Claude sat patiently waiting.
+
+There was low talk among the chiefs. Then a warrior came and led the
+captives out of doors, through a long passage that opened between two
+rows of crowding Indians. The night was clear, and the air was sweet
+to their nostrils. They walked slowly down the path. A group of young
+braves kept within a few rods.
+
+"It must be late," said Menard, in a weak effort to break the
+silence.
+
+"Yes," replied Father Claude.
+
+"I suppose we had better go back to our hut?"
+
+"Yes," said the priest again. But the maid was silent.
+
+They sat on the grass plot before the door, none of them having any
+words that fitted the moment. Menard brought out a blanket and spread
+it on the ground, that the maid need not touch the dew-laden grass.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV.
+
+WHERE THE DEAD SIT.
+
+
+"They need not starve us," said Menard, trying to speak lightly. "I am
+hungry."
+
+The others made no reply.
+
+"I will see what chance we have for a supper."
+
+He got up and walked along the path looking for the guards. In a short
+time he returned.
+
+"They will bring us something. The sentiment is not so strong against
+us now, I think."
+
+"They change quickly," said Father Claude.
+
+"Yes. It is the Big Throat."
+
+"And yourself, M'sieu," the maid said impulsively. "You have done it,
+too."
+
+"I cannot tell. We do not know what the council may decide. It may be
+morning before they will come to an agreement. The Long Arrow will
+fight to the last."
+
+"And the other, M'sieu,--the one who attacked you,--he too will
+fight?"
+
+"He is nothing. When an Iroquois shows himself a coward his influence
+is gone forever. It may be even that they will give him a new name
+because of this."
+
+"There are times when a small accident or a careless word will change
+the mind of a nation," said Father Claude. "When we left the council
+they were not unfriendly to us. But in an hour it may be that they
+will renew the torture. Until their hearts have been touched by the
+Faith there are but two motives behind the most of their actions,
+expediency and revenge. But I think we may hope. Brother de
+Lamberville has told of many cases of torture where the right appeal
+has brought a complete change."
+
+So they talked on, none having anything to say, and yet each dreading
+the silences that came so easily and hung over them so heavily. They
+could see the council-house some distance up the path. Its outlines
+were lost in the shadows of the trees, but through the crevices in the
+bark and logs came thin lines of light, and a glow shone through the
+long roof opening upon the smoke that hung in the still air above it.
+Sometimes they could hear indistinctly the voice of a speaker; but the
+words could not be distinguished. At other times there was a low buzz
+of voices. The children and women who had not been able to get into
+the building could be seen moving about outside shutting off a strip
+of light here and there.
+
+Two braves came with some corn and smoked meat. Menard set it down on
+a corner of the blanket.
+
+"You will eat, Mademoiselle?"
+
+She shook her head. "I am not hungry. Thank you, M'sieu."
+
+"If I may ask it,--if I may insist,--it is really necessary,
+Mademoiselle."
+
+She reached out, with a weary little gesture, and took some of the
+corn.
+
+"And you too, Father."
+
+They ate in silence, and later went together to the spring for a cool
+drink.
+
+"We ought to make an effort to sleep," Menard said; and added, "if we
+can. Father, you had better lie down. In a few hours, if there is no
+word, I will wake you."
+
+"You will not forget, M'sieu? You will not let me sleep too long."
+
+"No." The Captain smiled. "No, Father; you shall take your turn at
+guard duty."
+
+The priest said good-night, and went to a knoll not far from the door.
+The maid had settled back against the logs of the hut, and was gazing
+at the trees. Menard sat in silence for a few moments.
+
+"Mademoiselle," he said at length, "I know that it will be hard for
+you to rest until we have heard; but--" he hesitated, but she did not
+help him, and he had to go on,--"I wish you would try."
+
+"It would be of no use, M'sieu."
+
+"I know,--I know. But we have much to keep in mind. It has been very
+hard. Any one of us is likely to break. And you have not been so used
+to this life as the Father and I."
+
+"I know it," she said, still looking at the elm branches that bent
+almost to the ground before them, "but when I lie down, and close my
+eyes, and let my mind go, it seems as if I could not stand it. It is
+not bad now; I can be very cool now. You see, M'sieu?" She turned
+toward him with the trace of a smile. "But when I let go--perhaps you
+do not know how it is; the thoughts that come, and the dreams,--when I
+am awake and yet not awake,--and the feeling that it is not worth
+while, this struggle, even to what it may bring if we succeed. It
+makes the night a torture, and the dread of another day is even worse.
+It is better to stay awake; it is better even to break. Anything is
+better."
+
+Menard looked down between his knees at the ground. He did not
+understand what it was that lay behind her words. He started to speak,
+then stopped. After a little he found himself saying words that came
+to his lips with no effort; in fact, he did not seem able to check
+them.
+
+"It is not right that I should be here near you. I gave up that right
+to-night. I gave it up yesterday. I have been proud, during these
+years of fighting, that I was a soldier. I had thought, too, that I
+was a man. It was hardly a week ago that I rebuked that poor boy for
+what I have since done myself. I promised Major Provost that I would
+take you safely to Frontenac. That I have failed is only a little
+thing. I have said to you--no, you must not stop me. We have gone
+already beyond that point. We understand now. I have tried to be to
+you more than--than I had a right to be while you were in my care.
+Danton did not know; Father Claude does not know. You know, because I
+have told you. I have shown you in a hundred ways."
+
+"No," she said, in a choking voice. "It is my fault. I allowed you."
+
+He shook his head.
+
+"That is nothing. It is not what you have done. It is not even what
+you think. It is what I shall think and know all my life,--that I have
+done the wrong thing. There are some of us, Mademoiselle, who have no
+home, no ties of family, no love, except for the work in which we are
+slowly building up a good name and a firm place. That is what I was.
+Do you know what it is that makes up the life of such a man? It is the
+little things, the acts of every day and every week; and they must be
+honest and loyal, or he will fail. I might have stayed in Paris, I
+might even have found a place in Quebec where I could wear a bright
+uniform, and be close in the Governor's favour. I chose the other
+course. I have given a dozen years to the harder work, only to fall
+within the week from all that I had hoped,--had thought myself to be.
+And now, as I speak to you, I know that I have lost; that if you
+should smile at me, should put your hand in mine, everything that I
+have been working for would be nothing to me. You would be the only
+thing in the world."
+
+She sat motionless. He did not go on, and yet each moment seemed to
+bring them closer in understanding. After a little while she said
+huskily:--
+
+"You cared--you cared like that?"
+
+She was not looking toward him, and she could not see him slowly bow
+his head; but there was an answer in his silence.
+
+"You cared--when you made the speech--"
+
+"Yes."
+
+She looked at the stalwart, bowed figure. She was beginning to
+understand what he had done, that in his pledge to the chiefs he had
+triumphed over a love greater than she had supposed a man could bear
+for a woman.
+
+"A soldier cannot always choose his way," he was saying. "I have never
+chosen mine. It was the orders of my superior that brought us here,
+that brought this suffering to you. If it were not for these orders,
+the Onondagas would be my friends, and because of that, your friends.
+It has always been like this; I have built up that others might tear
+down. I thought for a few hours that something else was to come to me.
+I should have known better. It was when you took the daisy--" she
+raised her hand and touched the withered flower. "I did not reason. I
+knew I was breaking my trust, and I did not care. After all, perhaps
+even that was the best thing. It gave me strength and hope to carry on
+the fight. It was you, then,--not New France. Now the dream is over,
+and again it is New France. It must be that."
+
+"Yes," she said, "it must be."
+
+"I have had wild thoughts. I have meant to ask you to let me hope,
+once this is over and you safe at Frontenac. I could not believe that
+what comes so easily to other men is never to come to me. I cannot ask
+that now."
+
+She looked at him, and a sudden glow came into her eyes.
+
+"Why not?" she whispered, as if frightened.
+
+"Why not," he repeated, for an instant meeting her gaze. Then he rose
+and stood before her. "Because I have given an oath to bring Captain
+la Grange to punishment. You heard me. But you did not hear what I
+promised to Father Claude. I have sworn that what the Governor may
+refuse to do, I shall do myself. I have set my hand against your
+family."
+
+"You could not help it, M'sieu,--you could not help it," she said. But
+the light was going out of her eyes. It had been a moment of weakness
+for both of them. She looked up at him, standing erect in the faint
+light, and the sight of his square, broad shoulders seemed to give her
+strength. He was the strong one; he had always been the strong one.
+She rose and leaned back against the logs. She found that she could
+face him bravely.
+
+"He is your cousin," he had just said in a dry voice.
+
+"Yes, he is my cousin."
+
+Menard was steadily recovering himself.
+
+"We will not give all up. You know that I love you,--I hope that you
+love me." He hesitated for an instant, but she gave no sign. "We will
+keep the two flowers. We will always think of this day, and yesterday.
+I have no duty now but to get you safe to Frontenac; until you are
+there I must not speak again. As for the rest of it, we can only wait,
+and trust that some day there may be some light."
+
+She looked at him sadly.
+
+"You do not know? Father Claude has not told you?"
+
+Something in her voice brought him a step nearer.
+
+"You know that Captain la Grange is my cousin?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"You did not know that I am to be his wife?"
+
+They stood face to face, looking deep into each other's eyes, while a
+long minute dragged by, and the rustling night sounds and the call of
+the crickets came to their ears.
+
+"No," he said, "I did not know. May I keep the flower, Mademoiselle?"
+
+She bowed her head. She could not speak.
+
+"Good-night."
+
+"Good-night."
+
+He walked away. She saw him stop at the knoll where the priest lay
+asleep on a bed of boughs, and stand for a moment gazing down at him.
+Then he went into the shadows. From the crackling of the twigs she
+knew that he was walking about among the trees. She sank to the ground
+and listened to the crickets. A frog bellowed in the valley; perhaps
+he had been calling before--she did not know.
+
+She fell asleep, with her cheek resting against a mossy log. She did
+not know when Menard came back and stood for a long time looking at
+her. He did not awaken Father Claude until long after the time for
+changing the watch.
+
+When he did, he walked up and down on the path, holding the priest's
+arm, and trying to speak. They had rounded the large maple three times
+before he said:--
+
+"You did not tell me, Father."
+
+"What, my son?"
+
+The Captain stopped, and drawing the priest around, pointed toward the
+maid as she slept.
+
+"You did not tell me--why we are taking her to Frontenac."
+
+"No. She asked it. We spoke of it only once, that night on the river.
+She was confused, and she asked me not to speak. She does not know
+him. She has not seen him since she was a child."
+
+Menard said nothing. He was gripping the priest's arm, and gazing at
+the sleeping maid.
+
+"It was her father," added Father Claude.
+
+Menard's hand relaxed.
+
+"Good-night, Father." He walked slowly toward the bed on the knoll.
+And Father Claude called softly after him:--
+
+"Good-night, M'sieu. Good-night."
+
+Menard lay awake. He could see the priest sitting by the door. He
+wondered if the maid were sleeping. A late breeze came across the
+valley, arousing the leaves and carrying a soft whisper from tree to
+tree, until all the forest voices were joined. Lying on his side he
+could see indistinctly the council-house. There were still the lighted
+cracks; the Long House was still in session. Their decision did not
+now seem so vital a matter. The thought of the maid--that he was
+taking her to be the wife of another, and that other La Grange--had
+taken the place of all other thoughts.
+
+Later still came the buzz of many voices. Dark forms were moving about
+the council-house. Menard raised himself to his elbow, and waited
+until he saw a group approaching on the path, then he joined Father
+Claude.
+
+The Big Throat led the little band of chiefs to the hut. They stood,
+half a score of them, in a semicircle, their blankets drawn close,
+their faces, so far as could be seen in the dim light, stern and
+impassive. Menard and the priest stood erect and waited.
+
+"It has pleased the Great Mountain that his voice should be heard in
+the Long House of the Iroquois," said the Big Throat, in a low, calm
+voice. "His voice is gentle as the breeze and yet as strong as the
+wind. The Great Mountain has before promised many things to the
+Iroquois. Some of the promises he has broken, some he has kept. But
+the Onondagas know that there is no man who keeps all his promises.
+They once thought they knew such a man, but they were mistaken. White
+men, Indians,--all speak at night with a strong voice, in the morning
+with a weak voice. Each draws his words sometimes off the top of his
+mind, where the truth and the strong words do not lie. The Onondagas
+are not children. They know the friend from the enemy. And they know,
+though he may sometimes fail them, that the Great Mountain is their
+friend, their father."
+
+Menard bowed slowly, facing the chief with self-control as firm as his
+own.
+
+"They know," the Big Throat continued, "that the Indian has not always
+kept the faith with the white man. And then it is that the Great
+Mountain has been a kind father. If he thinks it right that our
+brothers, the Senecas, should meet with punishment for breaking the
+peace promised to the white man by the Long House, the Onondagas are
+not the children to say to their father, 'We care not if our brother
+has done wrong; we will cut off the hand that holds the whip of
+punishment.' The Onondagas are men. They say to the father, 'We care
+not who it is that has done wrong. Though he be our next of blood, let
+him be punished.' This is the word of the council to the Big Buffalo
+who speaks with his father's voice."
+
+Well as he knew the Iroquois temperament, Menard could not keep an
+expression of admiration from his eyes. He knew what this speech
+meant,--that the Big Throat alone saw far into the future, saw that in
+the conflict between red and white, the redman must inevitably lose
+unless he crept close under the arm that was raised to strike him. It
+was no sense of justice that prompted the Big Throat's words; it was
+the vision of one of the shrewdest statesmen, white or red, who had
+yet played a part in the struggles for possession of the New World.
+Greatest of all, only a master could have convinced that hot-blooded
+council that peace was the safest course. The chief went on:--
+
+"The Big Buffalo has spoken well to the council. He has told the
+chiefs that he has not been a traitor to the brothers who have for so
+long believed that his words were true words. The Big Buffalo is a
+pine tree that took root in the lands of the Onondagas many winters
+ago. From these lands and these waters, and the sun and winds that
+give life to the corn and the trees of the Onondagas, he drew his sap
+and his strength. Can we then believe that this pine tree which we
+planted and which has grown tall and mighty before our eyes, is not a
+pine tree at all? When a quick-tongued young brave, who has not known
+the young tree as we have, comes to the council and says that this Big
+Buffalo, this pine tree, is not a pine but an elm with slippery bark,
+are we to believe him? Are we to drop from our minds what our hearts
+and eyes have long known, to forget what we have believed? My brothers
+of the Long House say no. They know that the pine tree is a pine tree.
+It may be that in the haze of the distance pine and elm look alike to
+young eyes; but what a chief has seen, he has seen; what he has known,
+he has known. The Big Buffalo speaks the truth to his Onondaga
+brothers, and with another sun he shall be free to go to his white
+brothers."
+
+"The Big Throat has a faithful heart," said Menard, quietly. "He knows
+that the voice of Onontio is the voice of right and strength."
+
+"The chiefs of the Onondagas and Cayugas will sit quietly before their
+houses with their eyes turned toward the lands beyond the great lake,
+waiting for the whisper that shall come with the speed of the winds
+over forests and waters to tell them that the white man has kept his
+promise. When the dog who robbed our villages of a hundred brave
+warriors has been slain, then shall they know that the Big Buffalo is
+what they have believed him to be, their brother."
+
+"And the maid and the holy Father?"
+
+"They are free. The chiefs are sorry that a foolish brave has captured
+the white man's squaw."
+
+Menard and Father Claude bowed again, and the chiefs turned and strode
+away. The priest smiled gently after them.
+
+"And now, M'sieu, we may rest quietly."
+
+"Yes. You lie down, Father; it will not be necessary to watch now, and
+anyway I am not likely to sleep much." He walked back to the bed on
+the knoll, leaving the priest to stretch out across the doorway.
+
+The elder bushes and briers crowded close to the little clearing
+behind the hut, and Menard, lying on his side with his face close to
+the ground, watched the clusters of leaves as they gently rustled. He
+rolled half over and stared up at the bits of sky that showed through
+the trees. It seemed as if the great world were a new thing, as if
+these trees and bushes and reaches of tufted grass were a part of a
+new life. Before, they had played their part in his rugged life
+without asking for recognition; but to-night they came into his
+thoughts with their sympathy, and he wondered that all this great
+world of summer green and winter white, and of blue and green and
+lead-coloured water could for so long have influenced him without
+consciousness on his part. But his life had left little time for such
+thoughts; to-night he was unstrung.
+
+Over the noise of the leaves and the trickle of the spring sounded a
+rustle. It was not loud, but it was a new sound, and his eyes sought
+the bushes. The noise came, and stopped; came, and stopped. Evidently
+someone was creeping slowly toward the hut; but the sound was on the
+farther side of him, so that he could reach the maid's side before
+whoever was approaching could cross the clearing.
+
+For a time the noise died altogether. Then, after a space, his eyes,
+sweeping back and forth along the edge of the brush, rested on a
+bright bit of metal that for an instant caught the light of the sky,
+probably a weapon or a head ornament. Menard was motionless. Finally
+an Indian stepped softly out and stood beside a tree. When he began to
+move forward the Captain recognized Tegakwita, and he spoke his name.
+
+The Indian came rapidly over the grass with his finger at his lips.
+
+"Do not speak loud," he whispered. "Do not wake the holy Father."
+
+"Why do you come creeping upon my house at night, like a robber?"
+
+"Tegakwita is sad for his sister. His heart will not let him go among
+men about the village; it will not let his feet walk on the common
+path."
+
+"Why do you come?"
+
+"Tegakwita seeks the Big Buffalo."
+
+"It cannot be for an honest reason. You lay behind the bush. You saw
+me here and thought me asleep, but you did not approach honestly. You
+crept through the shadows like a Huron."
+
+"Tegakwita's night eyes are not his day eyes. He could not see who the
+sleeping man was. When he heard the voice, he came quickly."
+
+Menard looked at the musket that rested in the Indian's hand, at the
+hatchet and knife that hung from his belt.
+
+"You are heavily armed, Tegakwita. Is it for the war-path or the hunt?
+Do Onondaga warriors carry their weapons from house to house in their
+own village?"
+
+The Indian made a little gesture of impatience.
+
+"Tegakwita has no house. His house has been dishonoured. He lives
+under the trees, and carries his house with him. All that he has is in
+his hand or his belt. The Big Buffalo speaks strangely."
+
+Menard said nothing for a moment. He looked up, with a keen gaze, at
+the erect figure of the Indian. Finally he said:--
+
+"Sit down, Tegakwita. Tell me why you came."
+
+"No. Tegakwita cannot rest himself until his sister has reached the
+Happy Hunting-Ground."
+
+"Very well, do as you like. But waste no more time. What is it?"
+
+"The Big Buffalo has been an Onondaga. He knows the city in the valley
+where the dead sit in their graves. It is there that my sister lies,
+by an open grave, waiting for the farewell word of him who alone is
+left to say farewell to her. Tegakwita's Onondaga brothers will not
+gather at the grave of a girl who has given up her nation for a white
+dog. But he can ask the Big Buffalo, who brought the white dog to our
+village, to come to the side of the grave."
+
+"Your memory is bad, Tegakwita. It was not I who brought the white
+brave. It was you who brought him, his two hands tied with thongs."
+
+The Indian stood, without replying, looking down at him with
+brilliant, staring eyes.
+
+Menard spoke again.
+
+"You want me to go with you. You slip through the bushes like a snake,
+with your musket and your knife and your hatchet, to ask me to go with
+you to the grave of your sister. Do I speak rightly, Tegakwita?"
+
+"The Big Buffalo has understood."
+
+Menard slowly rose and looked into the Indian's eyes.
+
+"I have no weapons, Tegakwita. The chiefs who have set me free have
+not yet returned the musket which was taken from me. It is dangerous
+to go at night through the forest without a weapon. Give me your
+hatchet and I will go with you."
+
+Tegakwita's lip curled almost imperceptibly.
+
+"The White Chief is afraid of the night?"
+
+Menard, too, looked scornful. He coolly waited.
+
+"The Big Buffalo cannot face the dead without a hatchet in his hand?"
+said Tegakwita.
+
+Menard suddenly sprang forward and snatched the hatchet from the
+Indian's belt. It was a surprise, and the struggle was brief.
+Tegakwita was thrown a step backward. He hesitated between struggling
+for the hatchet and striking with the musket; before he had fully
+recovered and dropped the musket, Menard had leaped back and stood
+facing him with the hatchet in his right hand.
+
+"Now I will go with you to the city of the dead, Tegakwita."
+
+The Indian's breath was coming quickly, and he stood with clenched
+fists, taken aback by the Captain's quickness.
+
+"Come, I am ready. Pick up your musket."
+
+As Tegakwita stooped, Menard glanced toward the hut. The priest lay
+asleep before the door. It was better to get this madman away than to
+leave him free to prowl about the hut.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV.
+
+THE BAD DOCTOR.
+
+
+At the edge of the thicket they stopped and stood face to face, each
+waiting for the other to pass ahead. Tegakwita slightly bowed, with an
+unconscious imitation of the Frenchmen he had seen at Fort Frontenac
+and Montreal.
+
+"Pass on," said Menard, sternly. "You know the trail, Tegakwita; I do
+not. It is you who must lead the way."
+
+The Indian was sullen, but he yielded, plunging forward between the
+bushes, and now and then, in the shadow of some tree, glancing
+furtively over his shoulder. His manner, the suspicion that showed
+plainly in the nervous movements of his head, in every motion as he
+glided through thicket, glade, or strip of forest, told Menard that he
+had chosen well to take the second place. His fingers closed firmly
+about the handle of the hatchet. That he could throw at twenty paces
+to the centre of a sapling, no one knew better than Tegakwita.
+
+The city of the dead lay in a hollow at ten minutes' walk from the
+village. Generations ago the trees had been cleared, and no bush or
+sapling had been allowed a foothold on this ground. The elms and oaks
+and maples threw their shadows across the broad circle, and each
+breath of wind set them dancing over the mounds where many an hundred
+skeletons crouched side by side, under the grass-grown heaps of earth,
+their rusted knives and hatchets and their mouldy blankets by their
+sides. No man came here, save when a new heap of yellow earth lay
+fresh-turned in the sun, and a long line of dancing, wailing redmen,
+led by their howling doctors, followed some body that had come to
+claim its seat among the skeletons.
+
+Tegakwita paused at the edge of the clearing, and looked around with
+that furtive quickness. Menard came slowly to his side.
+
+"You will take your weapons to the grave?" asked Menard, very quietly,
+but with a suggestion that the other understood.
+
+"Yes. Tegakwita has no place for his weapons. He must carry them where
+he goes."
+
+"We can leave them here. The leaves will hide them. I will put the
+hatchet under this log." He made a motion of dropping the hatchet,
+closely watching the Indian; then he straightened, for Tegakwita's
+right hand held the musket, and his left rested lightly on his belt,
+not a span from his long knife.
+
+"The White Chief knows the danger of leaving weapons to tempt the
+young braves. He finds it easy to take the chance with Tegakwita's
+hatchet."
+
+"Very well," said Menard, sternly. "Lead the way."
+
+They walked slowly between the mounds. Menard looked carefully about,
+but in the uncertain light he could see no sign of a new opening in
+any of them. When they had passed the centre he stopped, and said
+quietly:--
+
+"Tegakwita."
+
+The Indian turned.
+
+"Where is the grave?"
+
+"It is beyond, close to the great oak."
+
+"Ah!"
+
+They went on. The great oak was in a dense, deep-shadowed place, at
+the edge of the circle. A little to one side, close to the crowding
+thicket, was a small, new mound. Looking now at Tegakwita, Menard
+could see that his front was stained with the soil. Probably he had
+spent the day working on the mound for his sister. While Menard stood
+at one side, he went to a bush that encroached a yard on the sacred
+ground and drew out a number of presents, with necessary articles and
+provisions to stay the soul on its long journey to the Happy
+Hunting-Ground. It was at the end of Menard's tongue to repeat
+Tegakwita's remark about hiding the weapons, but he held back and
+stood silently waiting.
+
+"Come," said the Indian.
+
+He parted the bushes, drew away a heavy covering of boughs, and there,
+wrapped in Tegakwita's finest blanket, lay the body of the Indian
+girl. Menard stood over it, looking down with a sense of pity he had
+never before felt for an Indian. He could not see her face, for it was
+pressed to the ground, but the clotted scalp showed indistinctly in
+the shadow. He suddenly raised, his eyes to Tegakwita, who stood
+opposite.
+
+"What have you done with the white brave?" he said in fierce, low
+tones. "What have you done with him?"
+
+Tegakwita raised one arm and swept it about in a quarter circle.
+
+"Ask the vultures that come when a man falls, ask the beasts that wait
+for everyone, ask the dogs of the village. They can tell you, not I."
+
+Menard's hands closed tightly, and a wild desire came to him to step
+across the body and choke the man who had killed Danton; but in a
+moment he was himself. He had nothing to gain by violence. And after
+all, the Indian had done no more than was, in his eyes, right. He bent
+down; and together they carried the body to the grave, close at hand.
+Tegakwita placed her sitting upright in the hole he had dug. By her
+side he placed the pots and dishes and knives which she had used in
+preparing the food they two had eaten. He set the provisions before
+her and in her lap; and drawing a twist of tobacco from his bosom, he
+laid it at her feet to win her the favour and kindness of his own
+Manitou on her journey. After each gift he stood erect, looking up at
+the sky with his arms stretched out above his head; and at these
+moments his simple dignity impressed Menard. But there were other
+moments, when, in stooping, Tegakwita would glance about with nervous,
+shifting eyes, as if fearing some interruption. His musket was always
+in his hand or by his side. Menard took it that he still feared the
+hatchet.
+
+Then at last the ceremony was done, and the Indian with his bare hands
+threw the earth over the hole in the mound. Still looking nervously
+from bush to bush, his hands began to move more slowly; then he
+paused, and sat by the mound, looking up with a hesitancy that
+recognized the need of an explanation for the delay.
+
+"Tegakwita's arms are weary."
+
+"Are they?" said Menard, dryly.
+
+"Tegakwita has not slept for many suns."
+
+"Neither have I."
+
+The Indian started as a rustle came from the forest. Menard watched
+him curiously. The whole proceeding was too unusual to be easily
+understood. Tegakwita's nervous manner, his request that the Captain
+accompany him to the mound, the weapons that never left his
+side,--these might be the signs of a mind driven to madness by his
+sister's act; but Menard did not recollect, from his own observation
+of the Iroquois character, that love for a sister was a marked trait
+among the able-bodied braves. Perhaps it was delay that he sought. At
+this thought Menard quietly moved farther from the undergrowth.
+Tegakwita's quick eyes followed the movement.
+
+"Come," said the Captain, "the night is nearly gone. I cannot wait
+longer."
+
+"Tegakwita has worked hard. His heart is sick, his body lame. Will the
+Big Buffalo help his Onondaga brother?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+The Indian rose with too prompt relief.
+
+"Your muscles need only the promise of help to give them back their
+spring, Tegakwita."
+
+"The White Chief speaks with a biting tongue."
+
+"You have been speaking with a lying tongue. You think I do not know
+why you have brought me here; you think I do not understand the evil
+thoughts that fill your mind. You are a coward, Tegakwita. But you
+will not succeed to-night."
+
+The ill-concealed fright that came into the Indian's face and manner
+told Menard that he was not wide of the mark. He began to understand.
+Tegakwita wished to get him at work and off his guard,--the rest would
+be simple. And as Menard well knew, more than one brave of the
+Onondagas, who had known him both as friend and enemy, would shrink
+when the moment came to attack the Big Buffalo single-handed, even
+though taking him at a disadvantage. Now Tegakwita was hesitating, and
+struggling to keep his eyes from the thicket.
+
+"Yes, I will help you. We will close this matter now, and go back to
+the village where your cowardly hands will be tied by fear of your
+chiefs. Drop your musket."
+
+"The Big Buffalo speaks in anger. Does he think to disarm Tegakwita
+that he may kill him?"
+
+"Lay your musket on the ground before us. Then I will drop the
+hatchet."
+
+Tegakwita stepped around the grave, and leaning the musket across a
+stone stood by it. Menard's voice was full of contempt.
+
+"You need not fear. The Big Buffalo keeps his word." He tossed the
+hatchet over the grave, and stood unarmed. "Drop your knife."
+
+Tegakwita hesitated. Menard took a step forward, and the knife fell to
+the ground.
+
+"Come. We will work side by side." He was surprised at Tegakwita's
+slinking manner. He wondered if this Indian could by some strange
+accident have been given a temperament so fine that sorrow could unman
+him. To the Iroquois, gifted as they were with reasoning power, life
+held little sentiment. Curiously enough, as Menard stood in the light
+of the young moon watching the warrior come slowly around the grave,
+which still showed above the earth the head and shoulders of the dead
+girl, he found himself calling up the rare instances he had known of a
+real affection between Indians.
+
+Tegakwita stood by him, and without a word they stooped and set to
+work, side by side, scraping the earth with their fingers over the
+body. Tegakwita found a dozen little ways to delay. Menard steadily
+lost patience.
+
+"Tegakwita has forgotten," said the Indian, standing up; "he has not
+offered the present to his sister's Oki."
+
+"Well?" said Menard, roughly.
+
+Tegakwita's voice trembled, as if he knew that he was pressing the
+white man too far.
+
+"The grave must be opened. It will not take long."
+
+It came to Menard in a flash. The many delays, the anxious glances
+toward the thicket,--these meant that others were coming. Something
+delayed them; Tegakwita must hold the Big Buffalo till they arrived.
+With never a word Menard sprang over the grave; but the Indian was
+quicker, and his hand was the first on the musket. Then they fought,
+each struggling to free his hands from the other's grasp, rolling over
+and over,--now half erect, tramping on the soft mound, now wrestling
+on the harder ground below. At last Menard, as they whirled and
+tumbled past the weapons, snatched the knife. Tegakwita caught his
+wrist, and then it was nigh to stabbing his own thigh as they fought
+for it. Once he twisted his hand and savagely buried the blade in the
+Indian's side. Tegakwita caught his breath and rallied, and the blood
+of the one was on them both. At last a quick wrench bent the Indian's
+wrist back until it almost snapped,--Menard thought that it had,--and
+the stained blade went home once, and again, and again, until the arms
+that had clung madly about the white man slipped off, and lay weakly
+on the ground.
+
+Menard was exhausted. The dirt and blood were in his hair and eyes and
+ears. He was rising stiffly to his knees when the rush of Indians came
+from the bushes. He could not see them clearly,--could hardly hear
+them,--though he fought until a musket-stock swung against his head
+and stretched him on the ground.
+
+When he recovered they were standing about him, half a score of them,
+waiting to see if he still had life. He raised a bruised arm to wipe
+his eyes, but a rough hand caught it and drew a thong tightly about
+his wrists. Slowly his senses awakened, and he could see indistinctly
+the silent forms,--some standing motionless, others walking slowly
+about. It was strange. His aching head had not the wit to meet with
+the situation. Then they jerked him to his feet, and with a stout
+brave at each elbow and others crowding about on every side, he was
+dragged off through the bushes.
+
+For a long time the silent party pushed forward. They were soon clear
+of the forest, passing through rich wild meadows that lifted the scent
+of clover, the fresher for the dew that lay wet underfoot. There were
+other thickets and other forests, and many a reach of meadow, all
+rolling up and down over the gentle hills. Menard tried to gather his
+wits, but his head reeled; and the struggle to keep his feet moving
+steadily onward was enough to hold his mind. He knew that he should
+watch the trail closely, to know where they were taking him, but he
+was not equal to the effort. At last the dawn came, gray and
+depressing, creeping with deadly slowness on the trail of the
+retreating night. The sky was dull and heavy, and a mist clung about
+the party, leaving little beads of moisture on deerskin coats and
+fringed leggings and long, brown musket barrels. The branches drooped
+from the trees, blurred by the mist and the half dark into strange
+shapes along the trail.
+
+The day was broad awake when Menard gave way. His muscles had been
+tried to the limit of his endurance during these many desperate days
+and sleepless nights that he had thought to be over. He fell loosely
+forward. For a space they dragged him, but the burden was heavy, and
+the chief ordered a rest. The band of warriors scattered about to
+sleep under the trees, leaving a young brave to watch the Big Buffalo,
+who slept motionless where they had dropped him in the long grass
+close at hand. On every side were hills, shielding them from the view
+of any chance straggler from the Onondaga villages, unless he should
+clamber down the short slopes and search for them in the mist. A
+stream tumbled by, not a dozen yards from Menard and his yawning
+guardian.
+
+When he awoke, the mist had thinned, but the sky showed no blue.
+Beneath the gray stretch that reached from hill crest to hill crest,
+light foaming clouds scudded across from east to west, though there
+was little wind near the ground. The Captain listened for a time to
+the noise of the stream before looking about. He changed his position,
+and rheumatic pains shot through his joints. For the second time in
+his life he realized that he was growing old; and with this thought
+came another. What sort of a soldier was he if he could not pass
+through such an experience without paying the old man's penalty. To be
+sure his head was battered and bruised, and scattered over his
+shoulders and arms and hips were a dozen small wounds to draw in the
+damp from the grass, but he did not think of these. In his weak,
+half-awake state, he was discouraged, with the feeling that the best
+of his life was past. And the thought that he, a worn old soldier,
+could have dreamed what he had dreamed of the maid and her love sank
+down on his heart like a weight. But this thought served another
+purpose: to think of the maid was to think of her danger; and this was
+to be the alert soldier again, with a plan for every difficulty as
+long as he had life in his body. And so, before the mood could drag
+him down, he was himself again.
+
+Most of the Indians were asleep, sprawling about under the trees near
+the water. The warrior guarding Menard appeared to be little more than
+a youth. He sat with his knees drawn up and his head bowed, his
+blanket pulled close around him, and his oily black hair tangled about
+his eyes. Menard lay on his back looking at the Indian through
+half-closed eyes.
+
+"Well," he said in a low, distinct voice, "you have me now, haven't
+you?"
+
+The Indian gave him a quick glance, but made no reply.
+
+"It is all right, my brother. Do not turn your eyes to me, and nothing
+will be seen. I can speak quietly. A nod of your head will tell me if
+anyone comes near. Do you understand?"
+
+Again the little eyes squinted through the hanging locks of hair.
+
+"You do understand? Very well. You know who I am? I am the Big
+Buffalo. I killed half a score of your bravest warriors in their own
+village. Do you think these thongs can hold the Big Buffalo, who never
+has been held by thongs, who is the hardest fighter and the boldest
+hunter of all the lands from the Mohawk to the Great River of the
+Illinois? Listen, I will tell you how many canoes of furs the Big
+Buffalo has in the north country; I will tell you--"
+
+The Indian's head nodded almost imperceptibly. A yawning brave was
+walking slowly along the bank of the stream, gathering wood for a
+fire. He passed to a point a few rods below the prisoner, then came
+back and disappeared among the trees.
+
+"I will tell you," said Menard, keeping his voice at such a low pitch
+that the guard had to bend his head slightly toward him, "of the great
+bales of beaver that are held safe in the stores of the Big Buffalo.
+Does my brother understand? Does he see that these bales are for him,
+that he will be as rich as the greatest chief among all the chiefs of
+the Long House? No brave shall have such a musket,--with a long,
+straight barrel that will send a ball to the shoulder of a buffalo
+farther than the flight of three arrows. His blanket shall be the
+brightest in Onondaga; his many clothes, his knives, his hatchets, his
+collars of wampum shall have no equal. He can buy the prettiest wives
+in the nation. Does my brother understand?"
+
+The fire had been lighted, and a row of wild hens turned slowly on
+wooden spits over the flames. One by one the warriors were rousing and
+stirring about among the trees. There were shouts and calls, and the
+grumbling talk of the cooks as they held the long spits and turned
+their faces away from the smoke, which rose but slowly in the damp,
+heavy air. Menard lay with his eyes closed, as if asleep; even his
+lips hardly moved as he talked.
+
+"My brother must think quickly, for the time is short. All that I
+promise he will have, if he will be a friend to the Big Buffalo. And
+every Onondaga knows that the word of the Big Buffalo is a word that
+has never been broken. My brother will be a friend. He will watch
+close, and to-night, when the dark has come, he will let his knife
+touch the thongs that hold the White Chief captive."
+
+The Indian's face was without expression. Menard watched him closely,
+but could not tell whether his offer was taking effect. What he had no
+means of knowing was that since the battle at the hut, and the short
+fight in the council-house, the younger braves had centred their
+superstitions on him. It was thought that his body was occupied by
+some bad spirit that gave him the strength of five men, and that he
+had been sent to their village by a devil to lure the warriors into
+the hands of the French. These were not the open views that would have
+been heard at a council; they were the fears of the untried warriors,
+who had not the vision to understand the diplomacy of the chiefs, nor
+the position in the village to give them a public hearing. They had
+talked together in low tones, feeding the common fear, until a few
+words from the Long Arrow had aroused them into action. And so this
+guard was between two emotions: the one a lust for wealth and position
+in the tribe, common to every Indian and in most cases a stronger
+motive than any of the nobler sentiments; the other an unreasoning
+fear of this "bad doctor," the fear that to aid him or to accept furs
+from him would poison the ears of his own Oki, and destroy his chance
+of a name and wealth during his life, and of a long, glorious hunt
+after death.
+
+"My brother shall come with me to the land of the white men, where
+there is no trouble,--where he shall have a great lodge like the white
+chiefs, with coloured pictures in gold frames, and slaves to prepare
+his food. He shall be a great chief among white men and redmen, and
+his stores shall be filled to the doors with furs of beaver and
+seal."
+
+Menard's voice was so low and deliberate that the Indian did not
+question his statements. He was tempted more strongly than he had ever
+been tempted before, but with the desire grew the fear of the
+consequences. As for the Captain, he was clutching desperately at this
+slender chance that lay to his hand.
+
+"I have given my brother his choice of greater power than was ever
+before offered to a youth who has yet to win his name. The stroke of a
+knife will do it. No one shall know, for the Big Buffalo can be
+trusted. My brother has it before him to be a red chief or a white
+chief, as he may wish. The warriors are near,--the day grows bright;
+he must speak quickly."
+
+There was a call from the group by the fire, and the young Indian gave
+a little start, and slowly rising, walked away, yielding his place as
+guard to an older man. Menard rolled over and pressed his face to the
+ground as if weary; he could then watch the youth through the grass as
+he moved to the fire, but in a moment he lost sight of him. The new
+guard was a stern-faced brave, and his appearance promised no help; so
+the Captain, having done all that could be done at the moment, tried
+to get another sleep, struggling to put thoughts of the maid from his
+mind. Perhaps, after all, she was safe at the village.
+
+Meantime the youth, after a long struggle with the temptings of the
+bad doctor, yielded to his superstition, and sought the Long Arrow,
+who lay on the green bank of the stream. In a few moments the story
+was told, and the chief, with a calm face but with twinkling eyes,
+came to the prisoner and stood looking down at him.
+
+"The White Chief is glad to be with his Onondaga brothers?" he said in
+his quiet voice.
+
+Menard slowly raised his eyes, and looked coolly at the chief without
+replying.
+
+"The tongue of the Big Buffalo is weary perhaps? It has moved so many
+times to tell the Onondaga what is not true, that now it asks for
+rest. The Long Arrow is kind. He will not seek to move it again. For
+another sleep it shall lie at rest; then it may be that our braves
+shall find a way to stir it."
+
+Menard rolled over, with an expression of contempt, and closed his
+eyes.
+
+"The Long Arrow was sorry that his white brother was disappointed at
+the torture. Perhaps he will have better fortune after he has slept
+again. Already have the fires been lighted that shall warm the heart
+of the White Chief. And he shall have friends to brighten him. His
+squaw, too, shall feel the glow of the roaring fire, and the gentle
+hands of the Onondaga warriors, who do not forget the deaths of their
+own blood."
+
+Menard lay still.
+
+"Another sleep, my brother, and the great White Chief who speaks with
+the voice of Onontio shall be with his friends. He shall hear the
+sweet voice of his young squaw through the smoke that shall be her
+garment. He shall hear the prayers of his holy Father by his side, and
+shall know that his spirit is safe with the Great Spirit who is not
+strong enough to give him his life when the Long Arrow takes it
+away."
+
+There was still a mad hope that the chief spoke lies, that the maid
+and Father Claude were safe. True or false, the Long Arrow would
+surely talk thus; for the Iroquois were as skilled in the torments of
+the mind as of the body. He was conscious that the keen voice was
+going on, but he did not follow what it said. Again he was going over
+and over in his mind all the chances of escape. It might be that the
+youth had been moved by his offer. But at that moment he heard the
+Long Arrow saying:--
+
+" ... Even before his death the Big Buffalo must lie as he has always
+lied. His tongue knows not the truth. He thinks to deceive our young
+braves with talk of his furs and his lodges and his power in the land
+of the white men. But our warriors know the truth. They know that the
+Big Buffalo has no store of furs, no great lodges,--that he lives in
+the woods with only a stolen musket, where he can by his lies capture
+the peaceful hunters of the Onondagas to make them the slaves of his
+Chief-Across-the-Water."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI.
+
+AT THE LONG LAKE.
+
+
+Menard again dropped to sleep. When the day had nearly reached its
+middle, he was aroused by two warriors, who pulled him roughly to his
+feet. The band had evidently been astir for some moments. A few braves
+were extinguishing the fire with clumps of sod, while the others
+packed in their blankets what had been left from the morning meal, or
+looked to the spots of rust which the damp had brought to knives and
+muskets. The Long Arrow came over to inspect the thongs that held
+Menard's wrists; he had not forgotten his attack on his guards on the
+morning of the torture. And with a precaution that brought a half
+smile to the prisoner's face, he posted a stout warrior on each side,
+in addition to those before and behind. Then they set out over the
+hills, wading through a great tumbling meadow where their feet sank
+deep into the green and yellow and white that June had spread over the
+open lands of the Iroquois. Overhead the sky, though still clouded,
+was breaking, giving little glimpses of clear blue.
+
+As they neared the crest of the first hill, the Captain looked back
+over his shoulder. The sun had at last broken through to the earth,
+and a great band of yellow light was moving swiftly across the valley.
+Before it, all the ground was sombre in its dark green and its heavy
+moisture; behind lay a stretch of golden sunshine, rounding over the
+farther hills in great billows of grass and flowers and clustering
+trees, glistening with dew and glowing with the young health of the
+summer. Up the hillside came the sunlight; and then in a moment it had
+passed them, and the air was warm and sweet.
+
+Menard looked at the sun and then back across the valley to get his
+direction. He saw that the party was moving a little to the south of
+west. This line of march should take them through the Cayuga
+country,--a natural move on the part of the Long Arrow, for the
+Cayugas were closer to the scene of the fighting than the Onondagas,
+and therefore would be less likely to interfere with the persecution
+of a Frenchman, particularly before their chiefs should return from
+the council.
+
+Late in the afternoon they came to a slow-moving stream, the outlet of
+an inland lake. By the basin-shape of the end of the lake, he
+recognized it as one that lay directly between Onondaga and the Long
+Lake of the Cayugas. On the bank of the little river, under the matted
+foliage, the chief signalled a halt, and the warriors threw themselves
+on the ground. Menard lay at the foot of a beech whose roots dipped in
+the water, and for the hundredth time since the sun had risen he cast
+about for some chance at escape. The thongs about his wrists were tied
+by skilful hands. He tried to reach the knot with his fingers, but
+could not. His guards were alert to every motion; they lay on either
+side, and he could not lift his eyes without meeting the sullen glance
+of one or the other. He was about ready to submit, trusting to his
+wits to seize the first opportunity that should come; for after all,
+to worry would strain his nerves, and now, if at any time, his nerves
+and his strength were needed. When at last he reached this point of
+view, he lay back on the weed-grown earth and went to sleep.
+
+An hour later he was aroused for another start. Night came while they
+were on the way, but they pushed steadily forward, and within a few
+hours they reached the Long Lake. Instead of stopping, however, the
+Long Arrow headed to the south along the bank of the lake. For a space
+it was hard going through the interwoven bushes and briers that tore
+even Menard's tough skin. The moon was in the sky, and here and there
+he caught glimpses of the lake lying still and bright. They saw no
+signs of life save for the flitting bats, and the owls that called
+weirdly through the reaches of the forest. After another hour they
+found a trail which led them down close to the water, and at last to a
+half-cleared space, rank and wild with weed and thistle, and with
+rotting heaps where lay the trunks of trees, felled a generation
+earlier. Scattered about the outer edge of the clearing, close to the
+circle of trees, were a few bark huts, with roofs sagging and doors
+agape. One or two were rivalled in height by the weeds that choked
+their windows. As Menard stood between his guards under the last tree
+on the trail, looking at the deserted village where the frightened
+bats rose and wheeled, and the moonlight streamed on broken roofs, he
+began to understand. The Long Arrow had found a place where he could
+carry out his vengeance undisturbed.
+
+Other forms had risen from the weeds to greet the party. Looking more
+closely, Menard saw that a group of Indians were dragging logs for a
+fire. Evidently this was a rendezvous for two or more bands. He tried
+to count the dim forms, and found them somewhat less than a score in
+all. Perhaps the Long Arrow had found it not easy to raise a large
+party to defy the will of the council concerning the White Chief; but
+he had enough, and already the brandy was beginning to flow,--the
+first stage of the orgie which should take up the rest of the night,
+and perhaps the day to follow. The Long Arrow and his party at once
+joined in the drinking. Confident that they would not this time be
+interrupted, they would probably use all deliberation in preparing for
+the torture.
+
+A rough meal was soon ready, and all fell to. Nothing was set apart
+for the prisoner; though had he been weak they would have fed him to
+stay him for the torture. One of his guardians, in mock pity, threw
+him a bone to which a little meat clung. He asked that his hands be
+loosed, or at least tied in front of his body, but his request brought
+jeers from the little group about him. Seeing that there was no hope
+of aid, he rolled over and gnawed the bone where it lay on the ground.
+The warriors laughed again, and one kicked it away; but Menard crawled
+after it, and this time was not disturbed. A little later, two other
+Indians came from the fire, and after a talk with his guards, ordered
+him to his feet and led him to one of the huts. The door was of rude
+boards, hung on wooden hinges, and now held in place by a short log.
+One brave kicked away the log, and Menard was thrown inside with such
+force that he fell headlong.
+
+Through an opening in the roof came a wide beam of moonlight. He
+looked up, and at first thought he was alone; then he saw two figures
+crouching against the rear wall. His own face and head were so covered
+with dust and blood that he could not have been recognized for a white
+man.
+
+"Who are you?" he said in Iroquois.
+
+"Captain!" came in a startled voice that he knew for Father Claude's;
+and a little gasp of relief from the other figure brought a thrill of
+joy. He tried to raise himself, but in an instant they had come to him
+and were laughing and sobbing and speaking his name. While Father
+Claude seized his shoulders to lift him, the maid fell on her knees,
+and with her teeth tried to cut the thongs.
+
+"Wait, Father," she said in a mumbled voice, without pausing in her
+work; "wait a moment."
+
+Menard could feel her warm tears dropping on his hands.
+
+"You must not, Mademoiselle," said the priest. "You must let me."
+
+She shook her head, and worked faster, until the thongs fell away and
+she could rub with her own torn hands the Captain's wrists.
+
+"Now he may arise, Father. See--see what they have done to him."
+
+Menard laughed. All the weight that had pressed on his heart had
+lifted at the sound of her voice and the touch of her hands. The laugh
+lingered until he was on his feet, and the three stood close together
+in the patch of moonlight and looked each into the other's eyes--not
+speaking, because there was no word so complete as the relief that had
+come to them all; a relief so great, and a bond so strong that during
+all the time they should live thereafter, through other days and other
+times, even across the seas in lands where much should be about them
+to draw a mist over the past, the moment would always be close in
+their memories,--it would stand out above all other deeds and other
+moments. Then the Captain held out his hands, and they each took one
+in a long clasp that told them all to hope, that stirred a new, daring
+thought in each heart. Father Claude at last turned away with shining
+eyes. The maid stood looking up at this soldier whom she trusted, and
+a little sigh passed her lips. Then she too turned, and to cover her
+thoughts she hummed a gay air that Menard had heard the trumpeters
+play at Quebec.
+
+"Tell us, M'sieu," she said abruptly, "what is it? How did it
+happen?"
+
+"It is the Long Arrow."
+
+"So we thought," said Father Claude; "but he was not with the party
+that brought us here, and we could not know. They came while we were
+sleeping, and bound our mouths so that we could not scream. I was at
+fault, I--"
+
+"No, Father. You cannot say that. I left you. I should have been at
+your side."
+
+"Will you tell us about it, M'sieu?" asked the maid. She was leaning
+against the bark wall, looking at the two men.
+
+Menard dropped to the ground, and in a quiet voice gave them the story
+of his capture. The priest rested near him on the broken-down bench
+that slanted against one wall. As the story grew, the maid came over
+and sat at the Captain's feet where she could watch his face as he
+talked. When he reached the account of the fight at the grave, he
+paused and looked at her upturned face. Then he went on, but he did
+not take up the tale where he had dropped it. He could not tell her of
+Tegakwita's end. As he went on to the fight with the Long Arrow's band
+and the flight through the hill country, he thought that she had
+missed nothing; but when he had finished she said:--
+
+"And Tegakwita, M'sieu? Did he come with them?"
+
+"No," Menard replied; "he did not come. I killed him."
+
+He had not meant to let the words come out so brutally. And now, as he
+saw the frightened look, almost of horror, come into her eyes, he
+suffered in a way that would not have been possible before he had
+known this maid. He read her thoughts,--that she herself was the cause
+of a double tragedy,--and it for the moment unmanned him. When he
+could look at her again, she was more nearly herself.
+
+"Go on, M'sieu. There is more?"
+
+"No. There is no more, except that I am here with you. But of
+yourselves? You have told me nothing."
+
+"We have told you all there is to tell," said Father Claude. "We were
+taken while we slept. They have come rapidly, but otherwise they have
+not been unkind."
+
+"You have had food?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"We must think now," Menard said abruptly; "we must put our wits
+together. It is late in the night, and we should be free before dawn.
+Have you thought of any way?"
+
+"Yes," replied the priest, slowly, "we have thought of one. Teganouan
+is with our party. At the first he tried to keep out of sight, but of
+course he could not, once we were on the way. He was a long time at
+the Mission of St. Francis, and I at one time hoped that he would
+prove a true believer. It was drink that led him away from us,--an old
+weakness with him. This morning, when he passed me, I knew that he was
+ashamed. I dared not speak to him; but since then, whenever my eyes
+have met his, I have seen that look of understanding."
+
+"I fear you will not see it to-night," said the Captain. "They are
+drinking."
+
+"Ah, but he is not. He is guarding the hut. Come, M'sieu, it may be
+that we can see him now."
+
+Menard rose, and with the priest peered through the cracks at the rear
+of the hut. After a moment they saw him, standing in the shadow of a
+tree.
+
+"You are sure it is he, Father?"
+
+"Ah, M'sieu, I should know him."
+
+Menard rested his hand on a strip of rotting bark in the wall. The
+priest saw the movement.
+
+"Yes," he said cautiously, "it would be very simple. But you will be
+cautious, M'sieu. Of course, I do not know--I cannot tell surely--and
+yet it must be that Teganouan still has a warm heart. It cannot be
+that he has forgotten the many months of my kindness."
+
+While they stood there, hesitating between a dozen hasty plans, a
+light step sounded, and in an instant their eyes were at the opening.
+A second Indian had joined the guard, and was talking with him in a
+low voice. Father Claude gripped the Captain's arm.
+
+"See, M'sieu,--the wampum collar,--it is the Long Arrow."
+
+Menard laid his finger on his lips. The two Indians were not a dozen
+yards away. The chief swayed unsteadily as he talked, and once his
+voice rose. He carried a bottle, and paused now and then to drink from
+it.
+
+"Teganouan is holding back," whispered Menard. "See, the Long Arrow
+has taken his arm--they are coming--is the door fast?"
+
+"We cannot make it fast, M'sieu. It opens outward."
+
+Menard sprang across to the door and ran his hands over it, but found
+no projection that could be used to hold it closed. He stood for a
+moment, puzzling; then his face hardened, and he fell back to where
+the priest and the maid stood side by side.
+
+"They will get in, M'sieu?"
+
+"Yes. It is better."
+
+They did not speak again. The moccasined feet made no noise on the
+cleared ground, and it seemed a long time before they could hear the
+log fall from the door. There were voices outside. At last the door
+swung open, and the Long Arrow, bottle in hand, came clumsily into the
+hut and stood unsteadily in the square of moonlight. He looked about
+as if he could not see them. Teganouan had come in behind him; and the
+door swung to, creaking.
+
+"The White Chief is the brother of the Long Arrow," said the chief,
+speaking slowly and with an effort to make his words distinct. "He
+loves the Onondagas. Deep in his mind are the thoughts of the young
+white brave who lived in our villages and hunted with our braves and
+called the mighty Big Throat his father. He never forgets what the
+Onondagas have done for him. He has a grateful heart." The effort of
+speaking was confusing to the chief. He paused, as if to collect his
+ideas, and looked stupidly at the three silent figures before him.
+"... grateful heart," he repeated. "The Long Arrow has a grateful
+heart, too. He remembers the kind words of the white men who come to
+his village and tell him of the love of the Great Mountain. He never
+forgets that the Big Buffalo is his brother--he never forgets. When
+the Big Buffalo took his son from the hunting party of the Onondagas
+he did not forget."
+
+Menard did not listen further. He was looking about the hut with
+quick, shifting eyes, now at the chief in the moonlight, now at
+Teganouan, who stood at one side in the shadow, now at the door. Could
+Teganouan be trusted to help them? He glanced sharply at the warrior,
+who was looking at his chief with an alert, cunning expression. His
+musket lay carelessly in the hollow of his arm, his knife and hatchet
+hung at his waist. The chief had only his knife; in his hand was the
+bottle, which he held loosely, now and then spilling a few drops of
+the liquor.
+
+"The Long Arrow nev'r f'rgets,"--the chief's tongue was getting the
+better of him. "His house is lonely, where the fire burns alone and
+the young warr'r who once laid 's blanket,--laid 's blanket by the
+fire, no long'r 's there to warm the heart of the Long Arrow. But now
+his loneliness is gone. Now when he comes from the hunt to 's house
+he'll find a new fire, a bright fire, and a new squaw to warm 's
+heart--warm 's heart." He swayed a little as he spoke, and Teganouan
+took a short step forward; but the chief drew himself up and came
+slowly across the patch of moonlight. His eyes were unnaturally
+bright, and they rolled uncertainly from one to another of the little
+group before him. His coarse black hair was matted and tangled, and
+the eagle feathers that at the council had stood erect from his head
+now drooped, straggling, to one side.
+
+The maid had understood. The two men drew close to her on each side,
+and her hand rested, trembling, on Menard's arm. All three were
+thinking fast. One scream, the sound of a struggle or even of loud
+voices, would bring upon them the whole drunken band. As the chief
+approached, the maid could feel the muscles harden on the Captain's
+arm.
+
+"Long Arrow's lonely--his fire's not bright when he comes from hunt--"
+Here and there in his talk a few words were distinguishable as he
+stood lurching before them. He reached out in a maudlin effort to
+touch the maid's white face. She drew in her breath quickly and
+stepped back; then Menard had sprung forward, and she covered her eyes
+with her hands.
+
+There was a light scuffle, but no other sound. A strong smell of
+brandy filled the hut. Slowly she lifted her head, and let her hands
+drop to her sides. The Long Arrow lay sprawling at her feet, his head
+gashed and bleeding, and covered with broken glass and dripping
+liquor. The priest had kneeled beside him, and over his bowed head she
+saw Teganouan, startled, defiant, his musket halfway to his shoulder,
+his eyes fixed on the door. Her eyes followed his gaze. There stood
+the Captain, his back to the door, the broken neck of the bottle
+firmly gripped in his hand.
+
+She stepped forward, too struck with horror to remain silent.
+
+"Oh, M'sieu!" she said brokenly, stretching out her hands.
+
+He motioned to her to be quiet, and she sank down on the bench.
+
+"Father," he said.
+
+The priest looked up questioningly. There was a long moment of
+silence, and the shouts and calls of the half-drunken revellers
+without sounded strangely loud. Then, as the priest gazed at the set,
+hard face of the Captain, and at the motionless Indian, he understood
+of a sudden all the wild plan that was forming in the Captain's mind.
+He rose slowly to his feet, and stood facing Teganouan, with the light
+streaming down upon his gentle face.
+
+"The sun has gone to sleep many times, Teganouan, since you left the
+great white house of the church at St. Francis. You have heard the
+counsel of evil men, who think only of the knife and the hatchet and
+the musket, who have no dream but to slay their brothers." He was
+speaking slowly and in a kindly voice, as a father might speak to a
+son who has wandered from the right. "Have you forgotten the talk of
+the holy Fathers, when they told you the words of the Book of the
+Great Spirit, who is to all your Manitous and Okis as the sun is to
+the stars. Have you forgotten the many moons that passed while you
+lived in the great white house,--when you gave your promise, the
+promise of an Onondaga, that you would be a friend to the white man,
+that you would believe the words of the Great Spirit and live a
+peaceful life? Have you forgotten, Teganouan, the evil days when your
+enemy, the fire-water, took possession of your heart and led you away
+from the white house into the lodges of them that do wrong,--how when
+the good spirit returned to you and you came back to the arms of the
+Faith, you were received as a son and a brother? The holy Fathers did
+not say, 'This warrior has done that which he should not do. Let him
+be punished. We have no place for the wrongdoer.' No; they did not say
+this. They said, 'The lost is found. He that wandered from the fold
+has returned.' And they welcomed the lost one, and bade him repent and
+lead a right life. Have you forgotten, Teganouan?"
+
+The Indian had slowly lowered his musket.
+
+"Teganouan has not forgotten," he replied. "He has a grateful heart
+toward the holy Fathers of the great white house. When he was sick,
+they brought him their good doctor and told him to live. He believed
+that the white men were his brothers, that they would do to him as the
+Fathers had promised. But when Teganouan came to the white men, and
+asked to be made like they were, he left behind in his village a
+brother and a sister and a father who said that he was a traitor, who
+said that he was false to the trust of his blood and his nation, that
+he was not of their blood."
+
+"And did he believe them? Did he not know, better than they could,
+that the faith of the white man is also the faith of the redman; that
+the love of the white man includes all who breathe and speak and hunt
+and trade and move upon the earth?"
+
+"Teganouan has not forgotten. He heard the words of the Fathers, and
+he believed that they were true; but when the white Captain took from
+the Onondagas five score of their bravest warriors and called them
+slaves, when he took the brother of Teganouan, borne by the same
+mother and fed by the same hand, to be a slave of the mighty
+Chief-Across-the-Water, could he remember what the holy Fathers had
+said,--that all men were brothers?"
+
+"Teganouan has heard what the White Chief, the Big Buffalo, has said,
+that the evil man who was treacherous to the Onondagas shall be
+punished?"
+
+"Teganouan understands. But the evil man is far from the vengeance of
+the white man. The White Chief is here in our lodges."
+
+Menard left the door and came to the priest's side. The jagged piece
+of glass, his only weapon, he threw to the ground.
+
+"Teganouan," he said slowly and firmly, looking into the Indian's
+eyes, "you heard the great council at the Long House of the Five
+Nations. You heard the decision of the chiefs and warriors, that they
+whom Onontio had sent to bring a message of peace should be set free.
+You have broken the pledge made by your council. You have attacked us
+and made us prisoners, and brought us here where we may be tortured
+and killed and none may know. But when the Great Mountain finds that
+the Big Buffalo has not come back, when he sends his white soldier to
+the villages of the Onondagas and asks what they have done to him who
+brought his voice, what will you say? When the chiefs say, 'We set him
+free,' and look about to find the warrior who has dared to disobey the
+Long House, what will you say? When the young boys and the drunkards
+with loose tongues have told the story of the death of the Long Arrow,
+what will you say? Then you will be glad to flee to the white house of
+the holy Fathers, knowing that they will protect you and save you when
+the braves of your own blood shall pursue you."
+
+Teganouan's eyelids had drooped, and now he was looking at the ground,
+where the chief lay.
+
+"You will come with me, Teganouan. You will fly with us over the Long
+Lake, and through the forests and down the mighty rivers and over the
+inland sea, and there you shall be safe; and you shall see with your
+own eyes the punishment that the Great Mountain will give to the evil
+man who has been false to the Onondagas."
+
+He held out his hand, and silently waited. The priest's head was
+raised, and his lips moved slowly in prayer. The maid sat rigid, her
+hands tightly gripping the edge of the bench. Though he knew that
+every moment brought nearer the chance of discovery, that the lives of
+them all hung on a thread as slender as a hair, the Captain stood
+without the twitching of a muscle, without a sign of fear or haste in
+his grave, worn face.
+
+The Indian's eyes wavered. He looked at the fallen chief, at the
+priest, at Menard; then he took the offered hand. No further word was
+needed. Menard did not know the thought that lay behind the cunning
+face; it was enough that the Indian had given his word.
+
+"Quick, we must hide him," said the Captain, looking swiftly about the
+hut. "We must disturb you, Mademoiselle--"
+
+In a moment the three men had lifted the body of the Long Arrow and
+laid it away under the low bench. Teganouan scraped a few handfuls of
+earth from a corner and spread it over the spot where the chief had
+been.
+
+"How far is it to the lake, Teganouan?"
+
+"But a few rods."
+
+"And the forest is thick?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"We must cross the lake. Is there a canoe here?"
+
+The Indian shook his head. Menard stood thinking for an instant.
+
+"If you are thinking of me, M'sieu, I think I can swim with you," said
+the maid, timidly.
+
+"There is no other way, Mademoiselle. I am sorry. But we will make it
+as easy as we can."
+
+He stepped to the rear wall, and with a blow of his fist would have
+broken an opening through the rotted bank, but the Indian caught his
+arm.
+
+"It is not necessary. See." He set rapidly to work, and in a few
+silent moments he had unlaced the thread-like root that held the sheet
+of bark in place, and lowered it to the ground. He raised himself by
+the cross-pole that marked the top of the wall, and slipped through
+the opening. A few quick glances through the trees, and he turned and
+beckoned. Menard followed, with the knife of the Long Arrow between
+his teeth; and with Father Claude's help the maid got through to where
+he could catch her and lower her to the ground.
+
+The Indian made a cautious gesture and crept slowly through the
+yielding bushes. One by one they followed, the Captain lingering until
+the maid was close to him and he could whisper to her to keep her
+courage. They paused at the bank of the lake. The water lay sparkling
+in the moonlight. Menard looked grimly out; this light added to the
+danger. He found a short log close at hand and carried it to the
+water.
+
+"Come, Mademoiselle," he whispered, "and Father Claude. This will
+support you. Teganouan and I will swim. Keep low in the water, and do
+not splash or speak. The slightest noise will travel far across the
+lake."
+
+Slowly they waded out, dropping into the water before it was waist
+deep. Teganouan's powder-horn and musket lay on the log, and the maid
+herself steadied it so that they should not be lost.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII.
+
+NORTHWARD.
+
+
+Weak and chilled from the long swim through the cold water they
+dragged themselves across the narrow beach to the bushes that hung
+over the bank. Menard and Father Claude supported the maid, who was
+trembling and clinging to them. At the bank she sank to the ground.
+
+"It is hard, Mademoiselle, but we must not stop. It is better to be
+weary than to rest in this condition. It would mean sickness."
+
+"Yes," she said; "I know. In a moment I can go on." She looked up and
+tried to smile. "It is so cold, M'sieu."
+
+Menard turned to Teganouan.
+
+"How far is it to the villages of the Cayugas?"
+
+"Not far. Half a sleep."
+
+"Is there a trail?"
+
+"The trail is far. It passes the end of the Long Lake." He raised his
+head and looked at the stars, then pointed to the southwest. "The
+nearest village lies there. If we go through the forest toward the
+setting sun, we shall meet the trail."
+
+"You think it will be wise to go to the Cayugas, M'sieu?" asked Father
+Claude.
+
+"I think so. The chiefs must have returned before this time, or at
+least by the morrow." He dropped into the Iroquois tongue. "Is not
+this so, Teganouan? Would the chiefs of the Cayugas linger among the
+Onondagas after the close of the council?"
+
+"The Cayuga warriors await the word of the Long House. They know that
+their chiefs would hasten to bring it back to them."
+
+"Yes. It must be so, Father. And we can trust them to aid us. Perhaps
+they will give us a canoe. Teganouan must tell them he is our guide,
+sent by the Big Throat and the chiefs of the Onondagas to take us
+safely to Frontenac."
+
+The maid was struggling to keep awake, but her lids were heavy. Menard
+came to her and stood, hesitating. She knew that he was there; she
+could hear the rustle of his wet clothes, and his heavy breathing, but
+she did not look up.
+
+"Come," he said, lightly touching her shoulder, "we cannot wait here.
+We must go."
+
+She did not reply, and he hesitated again. Then he stooped and lifted
+her in his arms.
+
+"You will go ahead, Teganouan," he said, "and you, too, if you will,
+Father Claude. Choose an easy trail if you can, and be careful that no
+twig flies back."
+
+They set out slowly through the forest. The priest and the Indian
+laboriously broke a way, and Menard followed, holding the maid
+tenderly, and now and then, in some lighter spot where a beam of
+moonlight fell through the foliage, looking down at her gentle, weary
+face. She was sleeping; and he prayed that no sad dreams might come to
+steal her rest. His arms ached and his knees gave under him, but he
+had hardly a thought for himself. At last, after a long, silent march,
+the priest stopped, and said, supporting himself with one thin hand
+against a tree:--
+
+"You are weary, M'sieu. You must let me take Mademoiselle."
+
+"No, Father, no. I have been thinking. I am afraid it is not right
+that she should sleep now. Even though she fail in the effort,
+exercise of her muscles is all that will prevent sickness. And yet I
+cannot,"--he looked again at her face as it rested against his
+shoulder,--"I cannot awaken her now."
+
+The Father saw the sorrow in the Captain's eyes, and understood.
+
+"I will take her, M'sieu."
+
+Carefully Menard placed her in Father Claude's arms and turned away.
+
+"Teganouan," he said, trying to recover his self-possession, "should
+we not be near the trail?"
+
+"Yes, more than half the way."
+
+"Can we reach it more quickly by heading a little to the north?"
+
+"We would reach the trail, yes; but the way would be longer."
+
+"Never mind; once on the trail it will be easier than in this forest.
+Turn to the north, Teganouan."
+
+He could hear the maid's voice, protesting sleepily, and Father Claude
+talking quietly to her. He looked around. The priest said in a low
+tone:--
+
+"Come, M'sieu, it is hard to awaken her."
+
+"We must frighten her, then."
+
+He caught her shoulders and shook her roughly. Slowly her eyes opened,
+and then the two men dragged her forward. At first she thought herself
+back among the Onondagas, and she begged them not to take her away,
+hanging back and forcing them almost to carry her. It cut Menard to
+the heart, but he pushed steadily forward. Later she yielded, and with
+a dazed expression obeyed. Once or twice she stumbled, and would have
+fallen but for the strong hands that held her. Father Claude rested
+his hand on her forehead as they walked, and Menard gave him an
+anxious, questioning glance. The priest shook his head.
+
+"No," he said, "there is no fever. I trust that it is nothing worse
+than exhaustion."
+
+Menard went on with relief in his eyes.
+
+In less than half an hour after reaching the trail, they came upon the
+outlying huts of the village. Over the hills to the east the dawn was
+breaking, and all the sleeping birds and beasts and creeping things of
+the forest were stirring into life and movement. Teganouan went ahead
+of the party and soon roused a member of the Cayuga branch of his
+clan, the family of the Bear. Through the yawning services of this
+warrior they were guided to an unused hut. Teganouan searched farther,
+and returned with a heap of blankets for the maid, who had dropped to
+the ground before the hut. Menard carried her within and made her as
+comfortable as possible, then withdrew and closed the door.
+
+"Have the chiefs returned from the council at the village of the
+Onondagas?" he asked of the warrior, who stood at one side watching
+them with curiosity in his gaze.
+
+The Cayuga bowed.
+
+"Will my brother carry a message from the White Chief, the Big
+Buffalo, to his chiefs? Will he tell them, as soon as the sun has
+risen, that the Big Buffalo has come to talk with them?"
+
+The warrior bowed and walked away.
+
+"We are safe now, I think, Father. We must get what little sleep we
+can between now and sunrise."
+
+"Should not one of us watch, M'sieu?"
+
+"We are not fit for it. We have hard work before us, and many a chance
+yet to run."
+
+"Teganouan will watch," said the Indian.
+
+Menard's face showed surprise, but Father Claude whispered, "He has
+learned at the mission to understand our language."
+
+They lay on the ground before the hut, in their wet clothes, and in a
+moment were asleep. Teganouan built a fire close at hand, and sat by
+it without a motion, excepting the alert shifting glances of his
+bead-like eyes, until, when the colours in the east had faded into
+blue and the sun was well above the trees, he saw the chiefs of the
+village coming slowly toward him between the huts, a crowd of young
+men following behind them, and a snarling pack of dogs running before.
+He aroused Menard and Father Claude.
+
+The chiefs sat in a circle about the fire, the two white men among
+them. The other Indians sat and stood in a wider circle, just within
+earshot, and waited inquisitively for the White Chief to state his
+errand.
+
+"My brothers, the white men, have asked to speak with the chiefs of
+the Cayugas," said the spokesman, a wrinkled old warrior, whom Menard
+recognized as one of the speakers at the Long House.
+
+"The Big Buffalo is on his way to the stone house of Onontio. He is
+far from the trail. His muskets and his knives and hatchets were taken
+from him by the Onondagas and were not returned to him. He asks that
+the chiefs of the Cayugas permit him to use one of their many canoes,
+that he may hasten to carry to Onontio the word of the Long House."
+
+"The White Chief comes to the Cayugas, who live two sleeps away from
+their brothers, the Onondagas, to ask for aid. Have the Onondagas then
+refused him? Why is my brother so far from the trail?"
+
+"The chiefs of the Cayugas sat in the Long House; they heard the words
+of the great council, that the Big Buffalo and the holy Father and the
+white maiden should be set free. They know that what is decided in the
+council is the law of the nation, that no warrior shall break it."
+
+The little circle was silent with attention, but none of the chiefs
+replied.
+
+"It was still in the dark of the night when the Big Throat came to the
+lodge of the Big Buffalo, and gave him the pledge of the council that
+he should be free with the next sun. The Big Buffalo once learned to
+believe the pledge of the Iroquois. When the mighty Big Throat said
+that he was free, he believed. He did not set a guard to sit with
+wakeful eyes through the night in fear that the pledge was not true.
+No, the Big Buffalo is a warrior and a chief; he is not a woman. He
+trusted his red brothers, and rested his head to sleep. Then in the
+dark came a chief, a dog of a traitor, and took away his white brother
+and his white sister while their eyes were still heavy with sleep, and
+carried them far over the hills to the lake of the Cayugas. Here they
+hid like serpents in the long grass, and thought that they would kill
+them. But the Big Buffalo is a warrior. Without a knife or a musket or
+a hatchet he killed the Long Arrow and came across the Long Lake. He
+knew that the Cayugas were his brothers, that they would not break the
+pledge of the Long House."
+
+The grave faces of the Indians showed no surprise, save for a slight
+movement of the eyes on the part of one or two of the younger men,
+when the Long Arrow was mentioned. Most of them had lighted their
+pipes before sitting down, and now they puffed in silence.
+
+"The White Chief speaks strangely," the spokesman said at last. "He
+tells the Cayugas that their brothers, the Onondagas, have broken the
+pledge of the council."
+
+"Yes."
+
+"He asks for aid?"
+
+"No," said Menard, "he does not ask for aid. He asks that the Iroquois
+nation restore to him what the dogs of the Long Arrow have taken away.
+He has spoken to the Long House in the voice of the Great Mountain. He
+has the right of a free man, of a chief honoured by the council, to go
+freely and in peace. What if those who do not respect the law of the
+council shall rob him of his rights? Must he go on his knees to the
+chiefs? Must he ask that he be allowed to live? Must he go far back on
+his trail to seek aid of the Onondagas, because the Cayugas will not
+hold to the law?"
+
+One of the great lessons learned during Menard's work under Governor
+Frontenac had been that the man who once permits himself to be lowered
+in the eyes of the Indians has forever lost his prestige. Now he sat
+before the chiefs of a great village, weak from the strain of the long
+days and nights of distress and wakefulness and hunger, his clothing
+still wet and bedraggled, with no weapon but a knife, no canoe, not to
+speak of presents,--with none of the equipment which to the Indian
+mind suggested authority,--and yet made his demands in the stern voice
+of a conqueror. He knew that these Indians cared not at all whether
+the word of the council to him had been broken or kept, unless he
+could so impress them with his authority that they would fear
+punishment for the offence.
+
+"The Big Buffalo is a mighty warrior," said the spokesman. "His hard
+hands are greater than the muskets and hatchets of the Cayugas. He
+fights with the strength of the winter wind; no man can stand where
+his hand falls. He speaks wisely to the Cayugas. They are sorry that
+their brothers, the Onondagas, have so soon forgotten the word of the
+great council, Let the Big Buffalo rest his arms. The warriors of the
+Cayugas shall be proud to offer him food."
+
+They all rose, and after a few grunted words of friendship, filed away
+to go over the matter in private council. Menard saw that they were
+puzzled; perhaps they did not believe that he had killed the Long
+Arrow. He turned to Teganouan, who had been sitting a few yards away.
+
+"Teganouan, will you go among the braves of the village and tell them
+that the Big Buffalo is a strong fighter, that he killed the Long
+Arrow with his hands? It may be that they have not believed."
+
+This was the kind of strategy Teganouan understood. He walked slowly
+away, puffing at his pipe, to mingle among the people of the village
+and boast in bold metaphors the prowess of his White Chief.
+
+"They will give us a canoe," said Father Claude.
+
+"Yes, they must. Now, let us sleep again."
+
+They dropped to the ground, and Menard looked warningly at the circle
+of young boys who came as close as they dared to see this strange
+white man, and to hear him talk in the unpronounceable language.
+Father Claude's eyes were first to close. The Captain was about to
+join him in slumber when a low voice came from the door.
+
+"M'sieu."
+
+He started up and saw the maid holding the door ajar and leaning
+against it, her pale face, framed in a tangle of soft hair, showing
+traces of the wearing troubles of the days just passed.
+
+"Ah, Mademoiselle, you must not waken. You must sleep long, and rest,
+and grow bright and young again."
+
+She smiled, and looked at him timidly.
+
+"I have been dreaming, M'sieu," she said, and her eyes dropped, "such
+an unpleasant dream. It was after we had crossed the lake--We did
+cross it, M'sieu, did we not? That, too, was not a dream? No--see, my
+hair is wet."
+
+"No," he said, "that was not a dream."
+
+"We were on the land, and I was so tired, and you talked to
+me--something good--I cannot remember what it was, but I know that you
+were good. And I thought that I--that I said words that hurt you,
+unkind words. And when I wished and tried to speak as I felt, only the
+other words would come. That was a dream, M'sieu, was it not? It has
+been troubling me. You have been so kind, and I could not sleep
+thinking that--that--"
+
+"Yes," he said, "that was a dream."
+
+She looked at him with relief, but as she looked she seemed to become
+more fully awake to what they were saying. Her eyes lowered again, and
+the red came over her face.
+
+"I am glad," she said, so low that he hardly heard.
+
+"And now you will rest, Mademoiselle?"
+
+She smiled softly, and drew back within the hut, closing the heavy
+door. And Menard turned away, unmindful of the wide-eyed boys who were
+staring from a safe distance at him and at the door where the strange
+woman had appeared. He sat with his back against the logs of the hut,
+and looked at the ants that hurried about over the trampled ground.
+
+The sun was high when he was aroused by Teganouan, who had spent the
+greater part of the morning among the people of the village.
+
+"Have you any word, Teganouan?"
+
+"Yes. The warriors have learned of the strength of the Big Buffalo,
+and his name frightens them. They bow to the great chief who has
+killed the Long Arrow without a hatchet. They say that the Onondagas
+should be punished for their treachery."
+
+"Good."
+
+"Teganouan has been talking long with a runner of the Seneca nation."
+
+"Ah, he brings word of the fight?"
+
+"Yes. The Senecas have suffered under the iron hand of the Great
+Mountain. A great army takes up the hatchet when he goes on the
+war-path, more than all the Senecas and Cayugas and Onondagas together
+when every brave who can hold in his hand a bow or a musket has come
+to fight with his brothers. There were white warriors so many that the
+runner could not have counted them with all the sticks in the Long
+House. There were men of the woods in the skins and beads of the
+redmen; there were Hurons and Ottawas and Nipissings, and even the
+cowardly Illinois and the Kaskaskias and the Miamis from the land
+where the Great River flows past the Rock Demons. The Senecas fought
+with the strength of the she-bear, but their warriors were killed,
+their corn was trampled and cut, their lodges were burned."
+
+"Did the Great Mountain pursue them?"
+
+"He has gone back to his stone house across the great lake, leaving
+the land black and smoking. The Senecas have come to the western
+villages of the Cayugas."
+
+"There are none in this village?"
+
+"No. But the chiefs have sent blankets to their brothers, and as much
+corn as a hundred braves could carry over the trail. They have taken
+from their own houses to give to the Senecas."
+
+A few moments later two young men came with baskets of sagamity and
+smoked meat. Menard received it, and rising, knocked gently at the
+door.
+
+"Yes, M'sieu,--I am not sleeping."
+
+He hesitated, and she came to the door and opened it.
+
+"Ah, you have food, M'sieu! I am glad. I have been so hungry."
+
+"Come, Father," said the Captain, and they entered and sat on the long
+bench, eating the smoky, greasy meat as eagerly as if it had been
+cooked for the Governor's table. Their spirits rose as the baskets
+emptied, and they found that they could laugh and joke about their
+ravenous hunger.
+
+The chiefs returned shortly after, and came stooping into the hut in
+the free Indian fashion. The old chief spoke:--
+
+"The Big Buffalo has honoured the lodges of the Cayugas; he has made
+the village proud to offer him their corn and meat. It would make
+their hearts glad if he would linger about their fires, with the holy
+Father and the squaw, that they might tell their brothers of the great
+warrior who dwelt in their village. But the White Chief bears the word
+of the Long House. He goes to the stone house to tell his white
+brothers, who fight with the thunder, that the Cayugas and the
+Onondagas are friends of the white men, that they have given a pledge
+which binds them as close as could the stoutest ropes of deerskin. And
+so with sad hearts they come to say farewell to the Big Buffalo, and
+to wish that no dog may howl while he sleeps, that no wind may blow
+against his canoe, that no rains may fall until he rests with his
+brothers at the great stone house beyond the lake."
+
+"The Big Buffalo thanks the mighty chiefs of the Cayugas," replied
+Menard. "He is glad that they are his friends. And when his mouth is
+close to the ear of the Great Mountain, he will tell him that his
+Cayuga sons are loyal to their Father."
+
+The chief had lighted a long pipe. After two deliberate puffs, the
+first upward toward the roof of the hut, the second toward the ground,
+he handed it to Menard, who followed his example, and passed it to the
+chief next in importance. As it went slowly from hand to hand about
+the circle, the Captain turned to the maid, who sat at his side.
+
+"Do they mean it, M'sieu?" she whispered.
+
+For an instant a twinkle came into his eye; she saw it, and smiled.
+
+"Careful," he whispered.
+
+Before she could check the smile, a bronze hand reached across to her
+with the pipe. She started back and looked down at it.
+
+"You must smoke it," Menard whispered. "It is a great honour. They
+have admitted you to their council."
+
+"Oh, M'sieu--I can't--" she took the pipe and held it awkwardly; then,
+with an effort, raised it to her mouth. It made her cough, and she
+gave it quickly to the Captain.
+
+The Indians rose gravely and filed out of the hut.
+
+"Come, Mademoiselle, we are to go."
+
+The smoke had brought tears to her eyes, and she was hesitating,
+laughing in spite of herself.
+
+"Oh, M'sieu, will--will it make me sick?"
+
+He smiled, with a touch of the old light humour.
+
+"I think not. We must go, or they will wonder."
+
+They found the chiefs waiting before the hut, Father Claude and
+Teganouan among them. As soon as they had appeared, the whole party
+set out through the village and over a trail through the woods to the
+eastward. The ill-kept dogs played about them, and plunged, barking,
+through the brush on either side. Behind, at a little distance, came
+the children and hangers-on of the village, jostling one another to
+keep at the head where they could see the white strangers.
+
+When they reached the bank of the lake, they found two canoes drawn up
+on the narrow strip of gravel, and a half-dozen well-armed braves
+waiting close at hand. The chief paused and pointed toward the
+canoes.
+
+"The Cayugas are proud that the White Chief will sail in their canoes
+to the land of the white men. The bravest warriors of a mighty village
+will go with them to see that no Onondaga arrow flies into their camp
+by night."
+
+He signalled to a brave, who brought forward a musket and laid it,
+with powder-horn and bullet-pouch, at the Captain's feet.
+
+"This musket is to tell the Big Buffalo that no wild beast shall
+disturb his feast, and that meat in plenty shall hang from the
+smoking-pole in his lodge."
+
+The canoes were carried into the water and they embarked,--Menard, the
+maid, and two braves in one, Father Claude and four braves in the
+other. They swung out into the lake, the wiry arms and shoulders of
+the canoemen knotting with each stroke of the paddles; and the crowd
+of Indians stood on the shore gazing after until they had passed from
+view beyond a wooded point.
+
+A few hours should take them to the head of the lake. They had reached
+perhaps half the distance, when Menard saw that two of his canoemen
+had exchanged glances and were looking toward the shore. He glanced
+along the fringe of trees and bushes, a few hundred yards distant,
+until his eyes rested on three empty canoes. He called to Father
+Claude's canoe, and both, at his order, headed for the shore. As they
+drew near, half a score of Indians came from the brush.
+
+"Why," said the maid, "there are some of the men who brought us to the
+lake."
+
+"Yes," replied Menard, "it is the Long Arrow's band."
+
+He leaped out of the canoe before it touched the beach, and walked
+sternly up to the group of warriors. He knew why they were there. It
+was what he had expected. When they had discovered the death of the
+Long Arrow there had been rage and consternation. Disputes had
+followed, the band had divided, and a part had crossed the lake to
+hunt the trail of the Big Buffalo. He folded his arms and gave them a
+long, contemptuous look.
+
+"Why do the Onondagas seek the trail of the Big Buffalo? Do they think
+to overtake him? Do they think that all their hands together are
+strong enough to hold him? Did they think that they could lie to the
+White Chief, could play the traitor, and go unpunished?"
+
+Only one or two of the Onondagas had their muskets in their hands.
+They all showed fright, and one was edging toward the wood. The
+Cayugas in the canoes, at a word from Father Claude, had raised their
+muskets. Menard saw the movement from the corner of his eye, and for
+the moment doubted the wisdom of the action. It was a question whether
+the Cayugas could actually be brought to fire on their Onondaga
+brothers. Still, this band had defied the law of the council, and
+might, in the eyes of the Indians, bring down another war upon the
+nation by their act. While he spoke, the Captain had been deciding on
+a course. He now walked boldly up to the man who was nearest the
+bushes, and snatched away his musket. There was a stir and a murmur,
+but without heeding, he took also the only other musket in the party,
+and stepped between the Indians and the forest.
+
+"Stand where you are, or I will kill you. One man"--he pointed to a
+youth--"will go into the forest and bring your muskets to the
+canoes."
+
+They hesitated, but Menard held his piece ready to fire, and the
+Cayugas did the same. At last the youth went sullenly into the bushes
+and brought out an armful of muskets.
+
+"Count them, Father," Menard called in French.
+
+The priest did so, and then ran his eye over the party on the beach.
+
+"There are two missing, M'sieu."
+
+Menard turned to the youth, who, though he had not understood the
+words, caught their spirit and hurried back for the missing weapons.
+Then the Captain walked coolly past them, and took his place in the
+canoe. For a long time, as they paddled up the lake, they could see
+the Onondagas moving about the beach, and could hear their angry
+voices.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII.
+
+THE ONLY WAY.
+
+
+When at last the canoe slipped from the confines of river and hills
+and forest out upon the great Lake Ontario, where the green water
+stretched flat, east and north and west to the horizon, the Cayuga
+warriors said farewell and turned again to their own lands. It was at
+noon of a bright day. The water lay close to the white beach, with
+hardly a ripple to mar the long black scallops of weed and drift which
+the last storm had left on the sand. The sky was fair and the air
+sweet.
+
+In the one canoe which the Cayugas had left to them, the little party
+headed to the east, now skimming close to the silent beach, now
+cutting a straight path across some bay from point to point, out over
+the depths where lay the sturgeon and the pickerel and trout and
+whitefish. The gulls swooped at them; then, frightened, soared away in
+wide, rushing circles, dropping here and there for an overbold minnow.
+The afternoon went by with hardly the passing of a word. Each of them,
+the Captain, the maid, the priest, looked over the burnished water,
+now a fair green or blue sheet, now a space of striped yellow and
+green and purple, newly marked by every phase of sun and cloud; and to
+each it meant that the journey was done. Here was solitude, with none
+of the stir of the forest to bring companionship; but as they looked
+out to the cloud-puffs that dipped behind the water at the world's
+end, they knew that far yonder were other men whose skins were white,
+for all of beard and tan, whose tongue was the tongue of Montreal, of
+Quebec, of Paris,--and neither tree nor rock nor mountain lay between.
+The water that bore them onward was the water that washed the beach at
+Frontenac. Days might pass and find them still on the road; but they
+would be glorious days, with the sun overhead and the breeze at their
+backs, and at evening the wonder of the western sky to make the water
+golden with promise. As they swung their paddles, the maid with them,
+their eyes were full of dreams,--all save Teganouan. His eyes were
+keen and cunning, and when they looked to the north it was not with
+thoughts of home. It may be that he was dreaming of the deed which
+might yet win back his lost name as an Onondaga warrior.
+
+The sun hung over the lake when at last the canoe touched the beach.
+They ate their simple meal almost in silence, and then sat near the
+fire watching the afterglow that did not fade from the west until the
+night was dark and the moon high over the dim line that marked the
+eastern end of the lake. The sense of relief that had come to them
+with the first sight of the lake was fading now. They were thinking of
+Frontenac, and of what might await them there,--the priest soberly,
+the maid bravely, the Captain grimly. Later, when the maid had said
+good-night, and Father Claude had wandered down the beach to the
+water's edge, Menard dragged a new log to the fire and threw it on,
+sending up the flame and sparks high above the willows of the bank. He
+stretched out and looked into the flames.
+
+Teganouan, who had been lying on the sand, heard a rustle far off in
+the forest and raised his head. He heard it again, and rose, standing
+motionless; then he took his musket and came toward the fire. The
+Captain lay at full length, his chin on his hands. He was awake, for
+his eyes were open, but he did not look up. The Indian hesitated, and
+stood a few yards away looking at the silent figure, as if uncertain
+whether to speak. Finally he stepped back and disappeared among the
+willows.
+
+Half an hour went by. Father Claude came up the beach, walking
+slowly.
+
+"It is growing late, M'sieu, for travellers."
+
+Menard glanced up, but did not reply. The priest was looking about the
+camp.
+
+"Where is Teganouan, M'sieu? Did you give him permission to go away?"
+
+"No; he is here,--he was here." Menard rose. "You are right, he has
+gone. Has he taken his musket?"
+
+"I think so. I do not see it."
+
+"He left it leaning against the log. No; it is not there. Wait,--do
+you hear?"
+
+They stood listening; and both caught the faint sound of a body moving
+between the bushes that grew on the higher ground, close to the line
+of willows. Menard took up his musket and held it ready, for they had
+not left the country of the Iroquois.
+
+"Here he comes," whispered Father Claude. "Yes, it is Teganouan."
+
+The Indian was running toward them. He dropped his musket, and began
+rapidly to throw great handfuls of sand upon the fire. The two white
+men sprang to aid him, without asking an explanation. In a moment the
+beach was lighted only by the moon. Then Menard said:--
+
+"What is it, Teganouan?"
+
+"Teganouan heard a step in the forest. He went nearer, and there were
+more. They are on the war-path, for they come cautiously and slowly."
+
+"Father, will you keep by the maid? We must not disturb her now. You
+had better heap up the sand about the canoe so that no stray ball can
+reach her."
+
+The priest hurried down the beach, and Menard and the Indian slipped
+into the willows, Menard toward the east, Teganouan toward the west,
+where they could watch the forest and the beach on all sides. The
+sound of an approaching party was now more distinct. There would be a
+long silence, then the crackle of a twig or the rustle of dead leaves;
+and Menard knew that the sound was made by moccasined feet. He was
+surprised that the invaders took so little caution; either they were
+confident of finding the camp asleep, or they were in such force as to
+have no fear. While he lay behind a scrub willow conjecturing, Father
+Claude came creeping up behind him.
+
+"I will watch with you, M'sieu. It will make our line longer."
+
+"Is she safe?"
+
+"Yes. I have heaped the sand high around the canoe, even on the side
+toward the water."
+
+"Good. You had better move off a little nearer the lake, and keep a
+sharp eye out. It may be that they are coming by water as well, though
+I doubt it. The lake is very light. I will take the centre. You have
+no musket?"
+
+"No; but my eyes are good."
+
+"If you need me, I shall be close to the bushes, a dozen yards farther
+inland."
+
+They separated, and Menard took up his new position. Apparently the
+movement had stopped. For a long time no sound came, and then, as
+Menard was on the point of moving forward, a branch cracked sharply
+not twenty rods away. He called in French:--
+
+"Who are you?"
+
+For a moment there was silence, then a rush of feet in his direction.
+He could hear a number of men bounding through the bushes. He cocked
+his gun and levelled it, shouting this time in Iroquois:--
+
+"Stand, or I will fire!"
+
+"I know that voice! Drop your musket!" came in a merry French voice,
+and in another moment a sturdy figure, half in uniform and half in
+buckskin, bearded beyond recognition, had come crashing down the
+slope, throwing his arms around the Captain's neck so wildly that the
+two went down and rolled on the sand. Before Menard could struggle to
+his feet, three soldiers had followed, and stood laughing, forgetting
+all discipline, and one was saying over and over to the other:--
+
+"It is Captain Menard! Don't you know him? It is Captain Menard!"
+
+"You don't know me, Menard, I can see that. I wish I could take the
+beard off, but I can't. What have you done with my men?"
+
+Now Menard knew; it was Du Peron.
+
+"I left them at La Gallette," he said.
+
+"I haven't seen them--oh, killed?"
+
+Menard nodded.
+
+"Come down the beach and tell me about it. What condition are you in?
+Have you anybody with you?" Before Menard could answer, he said to one
+of the soldiers:--
+
+"Go back and tell the sergeant to bring up the canoes."
+
+They walked down the beach, and the other soldiers set about building
+a new fire.
+
+"Perhaps I'd better begin on you," Menard said. "What are you doing
+here? And what in the devil do you mean by coming up through the woods
+like a Mohawk on the war-path?"
+
+The Lieutenant laughed.
+
+"My story isn't a long one. I'm cleaning up our base of supplies at La
+Famine. We've got a small guard there. The main part of the rear-guard
+is back at Frontenac."
+
+"Where is the column?"
+
+"Gone to Niagara, Denonville and all, to build a fort. They'll give it
+to De Troyes, I imagine. It's a sort of triumphal procession through
+the enemy's country, after rooting up the Seneca villages and fields
+and stockades until you can't find an able-bodied redskin this side of
+the Cayugas. Oh, I didn't answer your other question. What do you
+think of these?" He held out a foot, shod in a moccasin. "You'd never
+know the King's troops now, Menard. We're wearing anything we can pick
+up. I've got a dozen canoes a quarter of a league down the lake. I saw
+your fire, and thought it best to reconnoitre before bringing the
+canoes past." He read the question in Menard's glance. "We are not
+taking out much time for sleep, I can tell you. It's all day and all
+night until we get La Famine cleared up. There is only a handful of
+men there, and we're expecting every day that the Cayugas and
+Onondagas will sweep down on them."
+
+"They won't bother you," said Menard.
+
+"Maybe not, but we must be careful. For my part, I look for trouble.
+The nations stand pretty closely by each other, you know."
+
+"They won't bother you now."
+
+"How do you know?"
+
+"What did I come down here for?"
+
+"They didn't tell me. Oh, you had a mission to the other nations? But
+that can't be,--you were captured."
+
+Menard lay on his side, and watched the flames go roaring upward as
+the soldiers piled up the logs.
+
+"I could tell you some things, Du Peron," he said slowly. "I suppose
+you didn't know,--for that matter you couldn't know,--but when the
+column was marching on the Senecas, and our rear-guard of four hundred
+men--"
+
+"Four hundred and forty."
+
+"The same thing. You can't expect the Cayugas to count so sharply as
+that. At that time the Cayugas and Onondagas held a council to discuss
+the question of sending a thousand warriors to cut off the rear-guard
+and the Governor's communications."
+
+The Lieutenant slowly whistled.
+
+"How did they know so much about it, Menard?"
+
+"How could they help it? Our good Governor had posted his plans on
+every tree. You can see what would have happened."
+
+"Why, with the Senecas on his front it would have been--" He paused,
+and whistled again.
+
+"Well,--you see. But they didn't do it."
+
+"Why not?"
+
+"Because I spoke at that council."
+
+"You spoke--but you were a prisoner, weren't you?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+The Lieutenant sat staring into the fire. Slowly it came to him what
+it was that the Captain had accomplished.
+
+"Why, Menard," he said, "New France won't be able to hold you, when
+this gets out. How you must have gone at them. You'll be a major in a
+week. You're the luckiest man this side of Versailles."
+
+"No, I'm not. And I won't be a major. I'm not on the Governor's pocket
+list. But I don't care about that. That isn't the reason I did it."
+
+"Why did you do it then?"
+
+"I--That's the question I've been asking myself for several days, Du
+Peron."
+
+The Lieutenant was too thoroughly aroused to note the change in the
+Captain's tone.
+
+"You don't see it right now, Menard. Wait till you've reached the
+city, and got into some clothes and a good bed, and can shake hands
+with d'Orvilliers and Provost and the general staff,--maybe with the
+Governor himself. Then you'll feel different. You're down now. I know
+how it feels. You're all tired out, and you've got the Onondaga dirt
+rubbed on so thick that you're lost in it. You wait a few weeks."
+
+"Did the Governor have much trouble with the Senecas?"
+
+"Oh, he had to fight for it. He was--My God, Menard, what about the
+girl? I was so shaken up at meeting you like this that it got away
+from me. The column had hardly got to the fort on their way up from
+Montreal before everyone was asking for you. La Grange had a letter
+from her father saying that she was with you, and he's been in a bad
+way. He says that he was to have married her, and that you've got away
+with her. It serves him right, the beast. One night, at La Famine, he
+was drunk, and he came around to all of us reading that letter at the
+top of his voice and swearing to kill you the moment he sees you. He's
+been talking a good deal about that."
+
+"She is here, asleep."
+
+"Thank God."
+
+"Where is La Grange now?"
+
+"He's over at Frontenac. He got into trouble before we left La Famine.
+He's drinking hard now, you know. He had command of a company that was
+working on the stockades, and he made such a muss of it that his
+sergeant had to take hold and handle it to get the work done at all.
+You can imagine what bad feeling that made in his company. Played the
+devil with his discipline. Well, he took it like a child. But that
+night, when he got a little loose on his legs, he hunted up the
+sergeant and made him fight. The fellow wouldn't until La Grange came
+at him with his sword, but then he cracked his head with a musket."
+
+"Hurt him?"
+
+"Yes. They took him up to Frontenac. He's in the hospital now, but
+it's pretty generally understood that d'Orvilliers won't let him go
+out until the Governor gets back from Niagara. He's well enough
+already, they say. It's hard on the sergeant, too; no one blames
+him."
+
+Du Peron looked around and saw Teganouan lying near.
+
+"Who's this Indian?" he asked in a low tone.
+
+"He is with me. A mission Indian."
+
+"Does he know French? Has he understood us?"
+
+"I don't know. I suppose so. Here is Father Claude de Casson. You
+remember him, don't you?"
+
+"Yes, indeed."
+
+The Lieutenant rose to greet the priest, and then the three sat
+together.
+
+"You asked me about the fight, didn't you, Menard? I don't seem able
+to hold to a subject very long to-night. We struck out from La Famine
+on the morning of the twelfth of July. You know the trail that leads
+south from La Famine? We followed that."
+
+Menard smiled at the leaping fire.
+
+"Don't laugh, Menard; that was no worse than what we've done from the
+start. The Governor never thought but what we'd surprise them as
+much on that road as on another. And after all, we won, though it did
+look bad for a while. There was a time, at the beginning of the
+fight,--well, I'm getting ahead of myself again. We were in fairly
+good order. Calličres had the advance with the Montreal troops. He
+threw out La Durantaye, with Tonty and Du Luth,--the _coureurs de
+bois_, you know,--to feel the way. La Durantaye had the mission
+Indians, from Sault St. Louis and the Montreal Mountain, on his left,
+and the Ottawas and Mackinac tribes on his right."
+
+"How did the Ottawas behave?"
+
+"Wretchedly. They ran at the first fire. I'll come to that. The others
+weren't so bad, but there was no holding them. They spread through the
+forest, away out of reach. Perrot had the command, but he could only
+follow after and knock one down now and then."
+
+"The Governor took command of the main force?"
+
+"Yes. And he carried his bale like the worst of us; I'll say that for
+him. It was hot, and we all drooped a bit before night. And he made a
+good fight, too, if you can forgive him that bungling march. When we
+bivouacked, some of Du Luth's boys scouted ahead. They got in by
+sunrise. They'd been to the main village of the Senecas on the hill
+beyond the marsh,--you know it, don't you?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"And they saw nothing but a few women and a pack of dogs. The Governor
+was up early,--he's not used to sleeping out doors in the mosquito
+country,--sitting on a log at the side of the trail, talking with
+Granville and Berthier. I wasn't five yards behind them, trying to
+scrape the mud off my boots--you know how that mud sticks, Menard.
+Well, when the scouts came in with their story, the Governor stood up.
+'Take my order to La Durantaye,' he said, 'that he is to move on with
+all caution, that the surprise may be complete. He will push forward,
+following the trail. You,' he said, to a few aides who stood by, 'will
+see that the command is aroused as silently as possible.' Well, I
+didn't know whether to laugh at the Governor or pity myself and the
+boys. Any man but the crowd of seigniors that he had about him would
+have foreseen what was coming. I knew that the devils were waiting for
+us, probably at one of the ravines where the trail runs through that
+group of hills just this side of the marsh. You know the place,--every
+one of us knows it. But what could we say? I'd have given a month's
+pay to have been within ear-shot of La Durantaye when he got the
+order. La Valterie told me about it afterward. 'What's this?' he says,
+'follow the trail? I'll go to the devil first. There's a better place
+for my bones than this pest-ridden country.' He calls to Du Luth:
+'Hear this, Du Luth. We're to "push forward, following the trail."' I
+can fairly hear him say it, with his eyes looking right through the
+young aide. 'Not I,' says Du Luth, 'I'm going around the hills and
+come into the village over the long oak ridge!' 'You can't do it. I
+have the Governor's order.' And then Du Luth drew himself up, La
+Valterie says, and looked the aide (who wasn't used to this kind of a
+soldier, and wished himself back under the Governor's petticoats) up
+and down till the fellow got red as a Lower Town girl. 'Tell your
+commanding officer,' says Du Luth, in his big voice, 'that the advance
+will "push forward, following the trail,"--and may God have mercy on
+our poor souls!'
+
+"Well, Menard, they did it, nine hundred of them. And we came on, a
+quarter of a league after, with sixteen hundred more. We got into the
+first defile, and through it, with never a sound. Then I was sure of
+trouble in the second, but long after the advance had had time to get
+through, everything was still. There was still the third defile, just
+before you reach the marsh, and my head was spinning, waiting for the
+first shot and wondering where we were to catch it and how many of us
+were to get out alive. And then, all at once it came. You see the
+Senecas, three hundred of them at least, were in the brush up on the
+right slope of the third defile; and as many more were in the elder
+thickets and swamp grass ahead and to the left. They let the whole
+advance get through,--fooled every man of Du Luth's scouts,--and then
+came at them from all sides. We heard the noise--I never heard a
+worse--and started up on the run; and then there was the strangest
+mess I ever got into. They had surprised the advance, right
+enough,--we could see Du Luth and Tonty running about knocking men
+down and bellowing out orders to hold their force together,--but you
+see the Senecas never dreamed that a larger force was coming on
+behind, and we struck them like a whirlwind. Well, for nearly an hour
+we didn't know what was going on. Our Indians and the Senecas were so
+mixed together that we dared not shoot to kill. Our own boys, even the
+regulars, lost their heads and fell into the tangle. It was all
+yelling and whooping and banging and running around, with the smoke so
+thick that you couldn't find the trail or the hills or the swamp. I
+was crowded up to my arms in water and mud for the last part of the
+time. Once the smoke lifted a little, and I saw what I thought to be a
+mission Indian, not five yards away, in the same fix. I called to him
+to help me, and he turned out to be a Seneca chief. Our muskets were
+wet,--at least mine was, and I saw that he dropped his when he started
+for me,--so we had it out with knives."
+
+"Did he get at you?"
+
+"Once. A rib stopped it--no harm done. Well, I was tired, but I got
+out and dodged around through the smoke to find out where our boys
+were, but they were mixed up worse than ever. I was just in time to
+save a _coureur_ from killing one of our Indians with his own hatchet.
+Most of the regulars scattered as soon as they lost sight of their
+officers. And Berthier,--I found him lying under a log all gone to
+pieces with fright.
+
+"I didn't know how it was to come out until at last the firing eased a
+little, and the smoke thinned out. Then we found that the devils had
+slipped away, all but a few who had wandered so far into our lines--if
+you could call them lines--that they couldn't get out. They carried
+most of their killed, though we picked up a few on the edge of the
+marsh. It took all the rest of the day to pull things together and
+find out how we stood."
+
+"Heavy loss?"
+
+"No. I don't know how many, but beyond a hundred or so of cuts and
+flesh-wounds like mine we seemed to have a full force. We went on in
+the morning, after a puffed-out speech by the Governor, and before
+night reached the village. The Senecas had already burned a part of
+it, but we finished it, and spent close to ten days cutting their corn
+and destroying the fort on the big hill, a league or more to the east.
+Then we came back to La Famine, and the Governor took the whole column
+to Niagara,--to complete the parade, I suppose."
+
+The story told, they sat by the fire, silent at first, then talking as
+the mood prompted, until the flames had died and the red embers were
+fading to gray. Father Claude had stretched out and was sleeping.
+
+"I must look about my camp," Du Peron said at length. "Good-night."
+
+"Good-night," said Menard; and alone he sat there until the last spark
+had left the scattered heap of charred wood.
+
+The night was cold and clear. The lake stretched out to a misty
+somewhere, touching the edge of the sky. He rose and walked toward the
+water. A figure, muffled in a blanket stood on the dark, firm sand
+close to the breaking ripples. He thought it was one of Du Peron's
+sentries, but a doubt drew him nearer. Then the blanket was thrown
+aside, and he recognized, in the moonlight, the slender figure of the
+maid. She was gazing out toward the pole-star and the dim clouds that
+lay motionless beneath it. The splash of the lake and the call of the
+locusts and tree-toads on the bank behind them were the only sounds.
+He went slowly forward and stood by her side. She looked up into his
+eyes, then turned to the lake. She had dropped the blanket to the
+sand, and he placed it again about her shoulders.
+
+"I am not cold," she said.
+
+"I am afraid, Mademoiselle. The air is chill."
+
+They stood for a long time without speaking, while the northern clouds
+sank slowly beneath the horizon, their tops gleaming white in the
+moonlight. Once a sharp command rang through the night, and muskets
+rattled.
+
+"What is that?" she whispered, touching his arm.
+
+"They are changing the guard."
+
+"You will not need to watch to-night, M'sieu?"
+
+"No; not again. We shall have an escort to Frontenac." He paused; then
+added in uncertain voice, "but perhaps--if Mademoiselle--"
+
+She looked up at him. He went on:
+
+"I will watch to-night, and to-morrow night, and once again--then
+there will be no need: we shall be at Frontenac. Yes, I will watch; I
+will myself keep guard, that Mademoiselle may sleep safely and deep,
+as she slept at the Long Lake and in the forests of the Cayugas. And
+perhaps, while she is sleeping, and the lake lies still, I may dream
+again as I did then--I will carry on our story to the end, and
+then--"
+
+He could not say more; he could not look at her. Even at the rustle of
+her skirt, as she sank to the beach and sat gazing up at him, he did
+not turn. He was looking dully at the last bright cloud tip, sinking
+slowly from his sight.
+
+"Frontenac lies there," he said. "I told them I should bring you
+there. It has been a longer road than we thought,--it has been a
+harder road,--and they have said that I broke my trust. Perhaps they
+were not wrong--I would have broken it--once. But we shall be there in
+three days. I will keep my promise to the chiefs; and we--we shall not
+meet again. It will be better. But I shall keep watch, to-night and
+twice again. That will be all."
+
+He looked down, and at sight of the mute figure his face softened.
+
+"Forgive me--I should not have spoken. It has been a mad dream--the
+waking is hard. When I saw you standing here to-night, I knew that I
+had no right to come--and still I came. I have called myself a
+soldier"--his voice was weary--"see, this is what is done to soldiers
+such as I." One frayed strip of an epaulet yet hung from his shoulder.
+He tore it off and threw it out into the lake. A little splash, and it
+was gone. "Good-night, Mademoiselle,--good-night."
+
+He turned away. The maid leaned forward and called. Her voice would
+not come. She called again and again. Then he heard, for he stood
+motionless.
+
+"M'sieu!"
+
+He came back slowly, and stood waiting. She was leaning back on her
+hands. Her hair had fallen over her face, and she shook it back,
+gazing up and trying to speak.
+
+"You said--you said, the end--"
+
+He hesitated, as if he dared not meet his thoughts.
+
+"You said--See," she fumbled hastily at her bosom, "see, I have kept
+it."
+
+She was holding something up to him. In the dim light he could not
+make it out. He took it and held it up. It was the dried stem and the
+crumbling blossom of a daisy. For a moment he kept it there, then,
+while he looked, he reached into his pocket and drew out the other.
+
+"Yes," he said, "yes--" His voice trembled; his hand shook. Her hair
+had fallen again, and she was trying to fasten it back. He looked at
+her, almost fiercely, but now her eyes were hidden. "We will go to
+Frontenac;" he said; "we will go to Frontenac, you and I. But they
+shall not get you." He caught the hands that were braiding her hair,
+and held them in his rough grip. "It is too late. Let them break my
+sword, if they will, still they shall not get you."
+
+Her head dropped upon his hands, and for the second time since those
+days at Onondaga, he felt her tears. For a moment they were
+motionless; he erect, looking out to the pole-star and over the water
+that stretched far away to the stone fort, she sobbing and clinging to
+his scarred hands. Then a desperate look came into his eyes, and he
+dropped on one knee and caught her shoulders and held her tightly,
+close against him.
+
+"See," he said, with the old mad ring in his voice, "see what a
+soldier I am! See how I keep my trust! But now--but now it is too late
+for them all. I am still a soldier, and I can fight, Valerie. And God
+will be good to us. God grant that we are doing right. There is no
+other way."
+
+"No," she whispered after him; "there is no other way."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX.
+
+FRONTENAC.
+
+
+The sun was dropping behind the western forests. From the lodges and
+cabins of the friendly Indians about the fort rose a hundred thin
+columns of smoke. Long rows of bateaux and canoes lined the beach
+below the log palisade; and others drew near the shore, laden with
+fish. There was a stir and bustle about the square within the stone
+bastions; orderlies hurried from quarters to barracks, bugles sounded,
+and groups of ragged soldiers sat about, polishing muskets and belts,
+and setting new flints. Men of the commissary department were carrying
+boxes and bales from the fort to a cleared space on the beach.
+
+Menard walked across the square and knocked at the door of Major
+d'Orvilliers's little house. Many an eye had followed him as he
+hurried by, aroused to curiosity by his tattered uniform, rusted
+musket, and boot-tops rudely stitched to deerskin moccasins.
+
+"Major d'Orvilliers is busy," said the orderly at the door.
+
+"Tell him it is Captain Menard."
+
+In a moment the Major himself appeared in the doorway.
+
+"Come in, Menard. I am to start in an hour or so to meet Governor
+Denonville, but there is always time for you. I'll start a little
+late, if necessary."
+
+"The Governor comes from Niagara?"
+
+"Yes. He is two or three days' journey up the lake. I am to escort him
+back."
+
+They had reached the office in the rear of the house, and the Major
+brushed a heap of documents and drawings from a chair.
+
+"Sit down, Menard. You have a long story, I take it. You look as if
+you'd been to the Illinois and back."
+
+"You knew of my capture?"
+
+"Yes. We had about given you up. And the girl,--Mademoiselle St.
+Denis--"
+
+"She is here."
+
+"Here--at Frontenac?"
+
+"Yes; in Father de Casson's care."
+
+"Thank God! But how did you do it? How did you get her here, and
+yourself?"
+
+Menard rose and paced up and down the room. As he walked, he told the
+story of the capture at La Gallette, of the days in the Onondaga
+village, of the council and the escape. When he had finished, there
+was a long silence, while the Major sat with contracted brows.
+
+"You've done a big thing, Menard," he said at last, "one of the
+biggest things that has been done in New France. But have you thought
+of the Governor--of how he will take it?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"It may not be easy. Denonville doesn't know the Iroquois as you and I
+do. He is elated now about his victory,--he thinks he has settled the
+question of white supremacy. If I were to tell him to-morrow that he
+has only made a bitter enemy of the Senecas, and that they will not
+rest until they wipe out this defeat, do you suppose he would believe
+it? You have given a pledge to the Iroquois that is entirely outside
+of the Governor's view of military precedent. To tell the truth,
+Menard, I don't believe he will like it."
+
+"Why not?"
+
+"He doesn't know the strength of the Five Nations. He thinks they
+would all flee before our regulars just as the Senecas did. Worse than
+that, he doesn't know the Indian temperament. I'm afraid you can't
+make him understand that to satisfy their hunger for revenge will
+serve better than a score of orations and treaties."
+
+"You think he won't touch La Grange?"
+
+"I am almost certain of it."
+
+"Then it rests with me."
+
+"What do you mean?"
+
+"I gave another pledge, d'Orvilliers. If the Governor won't do this--I
+shall have to do it myself."
+
+Save for a moment's hesitation Menard's voice was cool and even; but
+he had stopped walking and was looking closely at the commandant.
+
+D'Orvilliers was gazing at the floor.
+
+"What do you mean by that?" he said slowly, and then suddenly he got
+up. "My God, Menard, you don't mean that you would--"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"That can't be! I can't allow it."
+
+"It may not be necessary. I hope you are mistaken about the
+Governor."
+
+"I hope I am--but no; he won't help you. He's not in the mood for
+paying debts to a weakened enemy. And--Menard, sit down. I must talk
+plainly to you. I can't go on covering things up now. I don't believe
+you see the matter clearly. If it were a plain question of your
+mission to the Onondagas--if it were--Well, I want you to tell me in
+what relation you stand to Mademoiselle St. Denis."
+
+The Captain was standing by the chair. He rested his arms on the high
+back, and looked over them at d'Orvilliers.
+
+"She is to be my wife," he said.
+
+D'Orvilliers leaned back and slowly shook his head.
+
+"My dear fellow," he said, "when your story goes to Quebec, when the
+Château learns that you have promised the punishment of La Grange in
+the name of France, and then of this,--of Mademoiselle and her
+relations to yourself and to La Grange,--do you know what they will
+do?"
+
+Menard was silent.
+
+"They will laugh--first, and then--"
+
+"I know," said the Captain, "I have thought of all that."
+
+"You have told all this in your report?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"So you would go on with it?"
+
+"Yes; I am going on with it. There is nothing else I can do. I
+couldn't have offered to give myself up; they already had me. The
+fault was La Grange's. What I did was the only thing that could have
+been done to save the column; if you will think it over, you will see
+that. I know what I did,--I know I was right; and if my superiors,
+when I have given my report, choose to see it in another way, I have
+nothing to say. If they give me my liberty, in the army or out of it,
+I will find La Grange. If not, I will wait."
+
+"Why not give that up, at least, Menard?"
+
+"If I give that up, we shall have a war with the Iroquois that will
+shake New France as she has never been shaken before."
+
+D'Orvilliers started to speak, but checked the words. Menard slung his
+musket behind his shoulders.
+
+"Wait, Menard. I don't know what to say. I must have time to think. If
+you wish, I will not give notice of your arrival to the Governor. I
+will leave the matter of reporting in your hands." He rose, and
+fingered the papers on the table. "You see how it will look--there is
+the maid--La Grange seeks your life, you seek his--"
+
+Menard drew himself up, his hat in his hand.
+
+"It shall be pushed to the end, Major. You know me; you know Captain
+la Grange. There will be excitement, perhaps,--you may find it hard to
+avoid taking one side or the other. I must ask which side is to be
+yours."
+
+D'Orvilliers winced, and for a moment stood biting his lip; then he
+stepped forward and took both Menard's hands.
+
+"You shouldn't have asked that," he said. "God bless you, Menard! God
+bless you!"
+
+Menard paused in the door, and turned.
+
+"Shall I need a pass to enter the hospital?"
+
+"Oh, you can't go there. La Grange is there."
+
+"Yes; I will report to him. He shall not say that I have left it to
+hearsay."
+
+"But he will attack you!"
+
+"No; I will not fight him until I have an answer from the Governor."
+
+"You can't get in now until morning."
+
+"Very well, good-night."
+
+"You will be careful, Menard?"
+
+The Captain nodded and left the room. Wishing to settle his thoughts,
+he passed through the palisade gate and walked down the beach. The
+commissary men were loading the canoes, threescore of them, that were
+to carry the garrison on its westward journey. Already the twilight
+was deepening, and the lanterns of the officers were dimmed by the
+glow from a hundred Indian camp-fires.
+
+From within the fort came a long bugle-call. There was a distant
+rattling of arms and shouting of commands, then the tramp of feet, and
+the indistinct line came swinging through the sally-port. They halted
+at the water's edge, broke ranks, and took to the canoes, paddling
+easily away along the shore until they had faded into shadows. A score
+of Indians stood watching them, stolidly smoking stone pipes and
+holding their blankets close around them.
+
+It was an hour later when the Captain returned to the fort and started
+across the enclosure toward the hut which had been assigned to him.
+Save for a few Indians and a sentry who paced before the barracks, the
+fort seemed deserted. It was nearly dark now, and the lanterns at the
+sally-port and in front of barrack and hospital glimmered faintly.
+Menard had reached his own door, when he heard a voice calling, and
+turned. A dim figure was running across the square toward the sentry.
+There was a moment of breathless talk,--Menard could not catch the
+words,--then the sentry shouted. It occurred to Menard that he was now
+the senior officer at the fort, and he waited. A corporal led up his
+guard, halted, and again there was hurried talking. Menard started
+back toward them, but before he reached the spot all were running
+toward the hospital, and a dozen others of the home guard had gathered
+before the barracks and were talking and asking excited questions.
+
+Menard crossed to the hospital. Two privates barred the door, and he
+was forced to wait until a young Lieutenant of the regulars appeared.
+The lanterns over the door threw a dim light on the Captain as he
+stood on the low step.
+
+"What is it?" asked the Lieutenant. "You wished to see me?"
+
+"I am Captain Menard. What is the trouble?"
+
+The Lieutenant looked doubtfully at the dingy, bearded figure, then he
+motioned the soldiers aside.
+
+"It is Captain la Grange," he said, when Menard had entered; "he has
+been killed."
+
+The Lieutenant spoke in a matter-of-fact tone, but his eyes were
+shining and he was breathing rapidly. Menard looked at him for a
+moment without a word, then he stepped to the door of a back room and
+looked in. Three flickering candles stood on a low table, and another
+on a chair at the head of the narrow bed. The light wavered over the
+log and plaster walls. A surgeon was bending over the bed, his
+assistant waiting at his elbow with instruments; the two shut off the
+upper part of the bed from Menard's view. The Lieutenant stood behind
+the Captain, looking over his shoulder; both were motionless. There
+was no sound save a low word at intervals between the two surgeons,
+and the creak of a bore-worm that sounded distinctly from a log in the
+wall.
+
+Menard turned away and walked back to the outer door, the Lieutenant
+with him. There they stood, silent, as men are who have been brought
+suddenly face to face with death. At last the Lieutenant began to
+speak in a subdued voice.
+
+"We only know that it was an Indian. He has been scalped."
+
+"Oh!" muttered Menard.
+
+"I think he is still breathing,--he was just before you came,--but
+there is no hope for him. He was stabbed in a dozen places. It was
+some time before we knew--the Indian came in by the window, and must
+have found him asleep. There was no struggle."
+
+They stood again without speaking, and again the Lieutenant broke the
+silence.
+
+"It is too bad. He was a good fellow." He paused, as if searching for
+a kind word for Captain la Grange. "He was the best shot at the fort
+when he--when--"
+
+"Yes," said Menard. He too wished to speak no harsh word. "Is there
+anything I can do?"
+
+"I think not. There is a strong guard about the fort, but I think the
+Indian had escaped before we learned of it. I will see you before we
+take further steps."
+
+"Very well. I shall be at my quarters. Good-night."
+
+"Good-night."
+
+Menard walked slowly back across the enclosure. At the door of his hut
+he paused, and for a long time he stood there, looking up at the quiet
+sky. His mind was scattered for the moment; he could not think
+clearly.
+
+He opened his door and stepped over the log threshold, letting the
+door close after him of its own weight. The hut was dark, with but a
+square of dim light at the window. He fumbled for the candle and
+struck a light.
+
+There was a low rustle from the corner. Menard whirled around and
+peered into the shadows. The candle was blowing; he caught it up and
+shielded it with his hand. A figure was crouching in the corner, half
+hidden behind a cloak that hung there. The Captain sprang forward
+holding the candle high, tore down the cloak, and discovered
+Teganouan, the Onondaga, bending over feeling for his hatchet which
+lay on the floor at his feet. Menard caught his shoulders, and
+dragging him out of reach of the hatchet, threw him full length on the
+floor. The candle dropped and rolled on the floor, but before it could
+go out, Menard snatched it up.
+
+Slowly Teganouan rose to his feet.
+
+"Teganouan comes in a strange manner to the lodge of the white
+warrior," said Menard, scornfully. "He steals in like a Huron thief,
+and hides in dark corners."
+
+The Indian looked at him defiantly, but did not answer.
+
+"My Onondaga brother does not wish to show himself in the light.
+Perhaps there is some trouble on his mind. Perhaps he is governed by
+an evil Oki who loves the darkness." While Menard was speaking he was
+moving quietly toward the door. The Indian saw, but beyond turning
+slowly so as always to face his captor, made no movement. His face,
+except for the blazing eyes, was inscrutable. In a moment Menard stood
+between him and the door. "Perhaps it is best that I should call for
+the warriors of the fort. They will be glad to find here the slayer of
+their brother." His hand was on the latch.
+
+"The Big Buffalo will not call to his brothers." The Indian's voice
+was calm. Menard looked closely at him. "He has not thought yet. When
+he has thought, he will understand."
+
+"Teganouan speaks like a child."
+
+"If Teganouan is a child, can the Big Buffalo tell why he came to the
+white man's lodge?"
+
+"Because he has slain a great white warrior, he must hide his face
+like the outcast dog." Menard pointed to the scalp that hung at his
+waist. "He has slain a great warrior while the hatchet lies buried in
+the ground. He has broken the law of the white man and the redman. And
+so he must hide his face."
+
+"Why did not Teganouan run to the woods? Why did he come to the lodge
+of the Big Buffalo?"
+
+Menard looked steadily at him. He began to understand. The shrewd old
+warrior had chosen the one hiding-place where no searching party would
+look. Perhaps he had hoped for aid from the Captain, remembering his
+pledge to bring punishment on La Grange. If so, he should learn his
+mistake.
+
+"Teganouan's words are idle." Menard moved the latch.
+
+"The Big Buffalo will not open the door. Teganouan has not delivered
+his message. He is not an enemy to the Big Buffalo. He is his friend.
+He has come to this lodge, caring nothing for the safety of his life,
+that he might give his message. The Big Buffalo will not open the
+door. He will wait to hear the words of Teganouan; and then he may
+call to his brother warriors if he still thinks it would be wise."
+
+Menard waited.
+
+"Speak quickly, Teganouan."
+
+"Teganouan's words are like the wind. He has brought them many
+leagues,--from the lodges of the Onondagas,--that he may speak them
+now. He has brought them from the Long House of the Five Nations,
+where the fires burn brightly by day and by night, where the greatest
+chiefs of many thousand warriors are met to hear the Voice of the
+Great Mountain, the father of white men and redmen. The Great Mountain
+has a strong voice. It is louder than cannon; it wounds deeper than
+the musket of the white brave. It tells the Onondagas and Cayugas and
+Oneidas and Mohawks that they must not give aid to their brothers, the
+Senecas, who have fallen, whose corn and forts and lodges are burned
+to ashes and scattered on the winds. It tells the Onondagas that the
+Great Mountain is a kind father, that he loves them like his own
+children, and will punish the man who wrongs them, let him be white or
+red. It tells the Onondagas that the white captain, who has robbed a
+hundred Onondaga lodges of their bravest hunters, shall be struck by
+the strong arm of the Great Mountain, shall be blown to pieces by the
+Voice that thunders from the great water where the seal are found to
+the farthest village of the Five Nations. And the chiefs hear the
+Voice; they listen with ears that are always open to the counsel of
+Onontio. They take his promises into their hearts and believe them.
+They know that he will strike down the dog of a white captain. They
+refuse aid to their dying brothers, the Senecas, because they know
+that the strong arm of Onontio is over them, that it will give them
+peace."
+
+He paused, gazing with bright eyes at Menard. There was no reply, and
+he continued:--
+
+"The Great Mountain has kept his word. The Onondagas shall know, in
+their council, that Onontio's promise has been kept, that the white
+brave, who lied to their hunters and sent them in chains across the
+big water, has gone to a hunting-ground where his musket will not help
+him, where the buffalo shall trample him and tear his flesh with their
+horns. Then the Onondagas shall know that the Big Buffalo spoke the
+truth to the Long House. And this word shall be carried to the
+Onondagas by Teganouan. He will go to the council with the scalp in
+his hand telling them that the white children of Onontio are their
+brothers. Teganouan sees the Big Buffalo stand with his strong hand at
+the door. He knows that the Big Buffalo could call his warriors to
+seize Teganouan, and bind him, and bid him stand before the white
+men's muskets. But Teganouan is not a child. He sees with the eye of
+the old warrior who has fought a battle for every sun in the year, who
+has known the white man as well as the redman. When the Big Buffalo
+stood in the Long House, Teganouan believed him; Teganouan knew that
+his words were true. And now the heart of Teganouan is warm with
+trust. He knows that the Big Buffalo is a wise warrior and that he has
+an honest heart."
+
+There was a pause, and Menard, his hand still on the latch, stood
+motionless. He knew what the Indian meant. He had done no more than
+Menard himself had promised the council, in the name of Governor
+Denonville, should be done. The lodges of the allies near the fort
+sheltered many an Iroquois spy; whatever might follow would be known
+in every Iroquois village before the week had passed. To hold
+Teganouan for trial would mean war.
+
+There was the tramp of feet on the beaten ground without, and a clear
+voice said:--
+
+"Wait a moment, I must report to Captain Menard."
+
+Menard raised the latch an inch, then looked sharply at Teganouan. The
+Indian stood quietly, leaning a little forward, waiting for the
+decision. The Captain was on the point of speaking, but no word came
+from his parted lips. The voices were now just outside the door. With
+a long breath Menard's fingers relaxed, and the latch slipped back
+into place. Then he motioned toward the wall ladder that reached up
+into the darkness of the loft.
+
+Teganouan turned, picked up the hatchet and thrust it into his belt,
+took one quick glance about the room to make sure that no telltale
+article remained, and slipped up the ladder. There was a loud knock on
+the door, and Menard opened it. The Lieutenant came in.
+
+"We have no word yet, Captain," he said. "Every building in the fort
+has been searched. I have so few men that I could not divide them
+until this was done, but I am just now sending out searching parties
+through the Indian village and the forest. None of the canoes are
+missing. Have I your approval?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"You--you have been here since you left the hospital?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"I think, then, that he must have had time to slip out before we knew
+of it. There are many Indians here who would help him; but a few of
+them can be trusted, I think, to join the search. Major d'Orvilliers
+left me with only a handful of men. It will be difficult to accomplish
+much until he returns. I will post a sentry at the sally-port; we
+shall have to leave the bastions without a guard. I think it will be
+safe, for the time."
+
+"Very well, Lieutenant."
+
+The Lieutenant saluted and hurried away. Menard closed the door, and
+turned to the table, where were scattered the sheets on which he had
+been writing his report. He collected them and read the report
+carefully. He removed one leaf, and rolling it up, lighted it at the
+candle, and held it until it was burned to a cinder. Then he read the
+other sheets again. The report now told of his capture, of a part of
+the council at the Long House, and of the escape; but no word was
+there concerning Captain la Grange. Another hand had disposed of that
+question. Menard sighed as he laid it down, but soon the lines on his
+face relaxed. It was not the first time in the history of New France
+that a report had told but half the truth; and, after all, the column
+had been saved.
+
+He sharpened a quill with his sheath-knife, and began to copy the
+report, making further corrections here and there. Something more than
+an hour had passed before the work was finished. He rolled up the
+document and tied it with a thong of deerskin.
+
+It was still early in the evening, but the fort was as silent as at
+midnight. Menard opened the door and walked out a little way. The
+lamps were all burning, but no soldiers were to be seen. The barrack
+windows were dark. He stepped back into the house, closed the door,
+and said in a low voice:--
+
+"Teganouan."
+
+There was a stir in the loft. In a moment the Indian came down the
+ladder and stood waiting.
+
+"Teganouan, you heard what the Lieutenant said?"
+
+"Teganouan has ears."
+
+"Very well. I am going to blow out the candle."
+
+The room was dark. The door creaked softly, and a breath of air blew
+in upon the Captain as he stood by the table. He felt over the table
+for his tinder-box and struck a light. The door was slowly closing;
+Teganouan had gone.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+Another sun was setting. A single drum was beating loudly as the
+little garrison drew up outside the sally-port and presented arms. The
+allies and the mission Indians were crowding down upon the beach,
+silent, inquisitive,--puffing at their short pipes. For half a
+league, from the flat, white beach out over the rose-tinted water
+stretched an irregular black line of canoes and bateaux, all
+bristling with muskets. The Governor had come. He could be seen
+kneeling, all sunburned and ragged but with erect head, in the first
+canoe. His canoemen checked their swing, for the beach was close at
+hand, and then backed water. The bow scraped, and a dozen hands were
+outstretched in aid, but Governor Denonville stepped briskly out into
+the ankle-deep water and carried his own pack ashore. A cheer went up
+from the little line at the sally-port. Du Luth's _voyageurs_ and
+_coureur de bois_ caught it up, and then it swept far out over the
+water and was echoed back from the forest.
+
+In the doorway of a hut near the Recollet Chapel stood Menard and
+Valérie. They watched canoe after canoe glide up and empty its load of
+soldiers, not speaking as they watched, but thinking each the same
+thought. At last, when the straggling line was pouring into the fort,
+and the bugles were screaming, and the drum rolling, Valérie slipped
+her hand through the Captain's arm and looked up into his face.
+
+"It was you who brought them here," she said; and then, after a pause,
+she laughed a breathless little laugh. "It was you," she repeated.
+
+
+
+***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC***
+
+
+******* This file should be named 28958-8.txt or 28958-8.zip *******
+
+
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/2/8/9/5/28958
+
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://www.gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit:
+http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
diff --git a/28958-8.zip b/28958-8.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5024628
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958-8.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/28958-h.zip b/28958-h.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..88b4fd5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958-h.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/28958-h/28958-h.htm b/28958-h/28958-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9a0ba34
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958-h/28958-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,11773 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
+ "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml">
+<head>
+<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1" />
+<title>The Project Gutenberg eBook of The Road to Frontenac, by Samuel Merwin</title>
+<style type="text/css">
+ p {margin-top: 0.5em; text-align: justify; margin-bottom: 0.5em;}
+ body {margin-left: 11%; margin-right: 10%;}
+ a {text-decoration: none;}
+ @media screen {
+ hr.pb {margin:30px 0; width:100%; border:none;border-top:thin dashed silver;}
+ .pagenum {display: inline; font-size: x-small; text-align: right; position: absolute; right: 2%; padding: 1px 3px; font-style: normal; font-variant:normal; font-weight:normal; text-decoration: none; background-color: inherit; border:1px solid #eee;}
+ .pncolor {color: silver;}
+ }
+ @media print {
+ hr.pb {border:none;page-break-after: always;}
+ .pagenum { display:none; }
+ }
+ .image-left {padding-bottom: .5em; padding-top: .5em; padding-left: .5em; padding-right: .5em; margin-right: 1em; float: left; clear: left; margin-top: 1em; text-align: center;font-size: smaller; color: black; background: white; border: none;}
+ h3 {font-size:1.0em;}
+ h1,h2,h3 {text-align:center; font-weight:normal;}
+ .figcenter {margin: 2em auto 2em auto; text-align: center;}
+ p.tp {font-size:1em; margin-top:0; margin-bottom:0; text-align:center;}
+ .image-caption {padding-bottom: .5em; padding-top: .1em; text-align: justify; font-size: smaller; width: 200px;}
+ .caption {font-size:smaller;}
+ hr.tb {border:none; margin-top: 2em;}
+ table {margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto; clear: both;}
+ h1 {font-size:1.4em;}
+ hr.major {width: 65%; margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 2em; border:none; border-bottom:1px solid silver; clear:both;}
+ h2 {font-size:1.2em;}
+
+ h1.pg {text-align:center; font-weight:bold; font-size: 190%; }
+ h3.pg {text-align:center; font-weight:bold; font-size: 110%; }
+ hr.full { width: 100%;
+ margin-top: 3em;
+ margin-bottom: 0em;
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+ height: 4px;
+ border-width: 4px 0 0 0; /* remove all borders except the top one */
+ border-style: solid;
+ border-color: #000000;
+ clear: both; }
+ pre {font-size: 85%;}
+</style>
+</head>
+<body>
+<h1 class="pg">The Project Gutenberg eBook, The Road to Frontenac, by Samuel Merwin</h1>
+<pre>
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at <a href = "http://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a></pre>
+<p>Title: The Road to Frontenac</p>
+<p>Author: Samuel Merwin</p>
+<p>Release Date: May 24, 2009 [eBook #28958]</p>
+<p>Language: English</p>
+<p>Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1</p>
+<p>***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC***</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<h3 class="pg">E-text prepared by Roger Frank<br />
+ and the Project Gutenberg Online Distributed Proofreading Team<br />
+ (http://www.pgdp.net)</h3>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<hr class="full" />
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<h1>THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC</h1>
+<hr class='pb' />
+<div class='figcenter'>
+<a name='linki_1' id='linki_1'></a>
+<img src='images/illus-fpc.jpg' alt='' title='' style='width: 369px; height: 567px;' /><br />
+<p class='caption' style='margin: 0 auto; text-align:center; width: 369px;'>
+&#8220;Half way down the steps was a double file of Indians chained two and two.&#8221;<br />
+</p>
+</div>
+<hr class='pb' />
+<p class='tp' style='letter-spacing:0.1em;font-size:2em;margin-bottom:50px;margin-top:50px;'>THE ROAD TO<br />FRONTENAC</p>
+<p class='tp' >BY</p>
+<p class='tp' style='font-size:1.2em;'>SAMUEL MERWIN</p>
+<div style='margin:40px auto; text-align:center;'>
+<img alt='emblem' src='images/illus-emb.png' />
+</div>
+<p class='tp' >NEW YORK</p>
+<p class='tp' style='font-size:1.2em;'>DOUBLEDAY, PAGE &amp; CO.</p>
+<p class='tp' style='margin-bottom:50px;'>1901</p>
+<hr class='pb' />
+<div style='font-size:smaller;'>
+<p class='tp' style='font-variant:small-caps;'>Copyright, 1901, by Frank Leslie Publishing House.<br />
+Copyright, 1901, by Doubleday, Page &amp; Company.</p>
+</div>
+<hr class='pb' />
+<h3>CONTENTS</h3>
+<table border='0' cellpadding='2' cellspacing='0' summary='Contents' style='margin:1em auto;'>
+<tr>
+ <td align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'><span style='font-size:small;'>CHAPTER</span></td>
+ <td></td>
+ <td align='right'><span style='font-size:small;'>PAGE</span></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>I.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>Captain Menard Has a Lazy Day.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_I_CAPTAIN_MENARD_HAS_A_LAZY_DAY'>1</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>II.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>The Maid.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_II_THE_MAID'>19</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>III.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>Mademoiselle Eats Her Breakfast.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_III_MADEMOISELLE_EATS_HER_BREAKFAST'>38</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>IV.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>The Long Arrow.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_IV_THE_LONG_ARROW'>61</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>V.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>Danton Breaks Out.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_V_DANTON_BREAKS_OUT'>83</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>VI.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>The Fight at La Gallette.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_VI_THE_FIGHT_AT_LA_GALLETTE'>103</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>VII.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>A Compliment for Menard.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_VII_A_COMPLIMENT_FOR_MENARD'>127</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>VIII.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>The Maid Makes New Friends.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_VIII_THE_MAID_MAKES_NEW_FRIENDS'>147</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>IX.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>The Word of an Onondaga.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_IX_THE_WORD_OF_AN_ONONDAGA'>169</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>X.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>A Night Council.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_X_A_NIGHT_COUNCIL'>191</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>XI.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>The Big Throat Speaks.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_XI_THE_BIG_THROAT_SPEAKS'>212</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>XII.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>The Long House.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_XII_THE_LONG_HOUSE'>235</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>XIII.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>The Voice of the Great Mountain.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_XIII_THE_VOICE_OF_THE_GREAT_MOUNTAIN'>254</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>XIV.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>Where the Dead Sit.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_XIV_WHERE_THE_DEAD_SIT'>272</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>XV.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>The Bad Doctor.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_XV_THE_BAD_DOCTOR'>293</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>XVI.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>At the Long Lake.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_XVI_AT_THE_LONG_LAKE'>314</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>XVII.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>Northward.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_XVII_NORTHWARD'>337</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>XVIII.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>The Only Way.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_XVIII_THE_ONLY_WAY'>359</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='right' style='padding-right:1em;'>XIX.</td>
+ <td valign='top' align='left' style='padding-right:4em;'>Frontenac.&nbsp;&nbsp;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#CHAPTER_XIX_FRONTENAC'>383</a></td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+<hr class='pb' />
+<h3>LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS</h3>
+<table border='0' cellpadding='2' cellspacing='0' summary='Illustrations' style='margin:1em auto;'>
+<col style='width:80%;' />
+<col style='width:20%;' />
+<tr>
+ <td></td>
+ <td align='right'><span style='font-size:small'>PAGE</span></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='left'>&#8220;Half way down the steps was a double file of Indians chained two and two.&#8221;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#linki_1'><i>Frontispiece</i></a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='left'>&#8220;Sitting on a bundle was, a girl, perhaps eighteen or nineteen years old.&#8221;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#linki_2'>36</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='left'>&#8220;The Indians walked silently to the fire.&#8221;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#linki_3'>64</a></td>
+</tr>
+<tr>
+ <td valign='top' align='left'>&#8220;Menard stood ... smiling with the same look of scorn he had worn ... when they led him to the torture.&#8221;</td>
+ <td valign='bottom' align='right'><a href='#linki_4'>256</a></td>
+</tr>
+</table>
+<hr class='pb' />
+<div><span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_1' name='page_1'></a>1</span></div>
+<p style='font-size:1.3em; text-align:center; margin-top:3em; margin-bottom:1em;'>The Road to Frontenac.</p>
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 0; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<a name='CHAPTER_I_CAPTAIN_MENARD_HAS_A_LAZY_DAY' id='CHAPTER_I_CAPTAIN_MENARD_HAS_A_LAZY_DAY'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER I</h2>
+<h3>CAPTAIN MENARD HAS A LAZY DAY.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>Captain Daniel Menard leaned
+against the parapet at the outer edge of
+the citadel balcony. The sun was high, the
+air clear and still. Beneath him, at the foot
+of the cliff, nestled the Lower Town, a strip
+of shops and houses, hemmed in by the palisades
+and the lower battery. The St. Lawrence
+flowed by, hardly stirred by the light
+breeze. Out in the channel, beyond the merchantmen,
+lay three ships of war, <i>Le Fourgon</i>,
+<i>Le Profond</i>, and <i>La Perle</i>, each with a cluster
+of supply boats at her side; and the stir and
+rattle of tackle and chain coming faintly over
+the water from <i>Le Fourgon</i> told that she would
+sail for France on the morrow, if God should
+choose to send the wind.</p>
+<p>Looking almost straight down, Menard could
+see the long flight of steps that climbed from
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_2' name='page_2'></a>2</span>
+the settlement on the water front to the nobler
+city on the heights. Halfway down the steps
+was a double file of Indians, chained two and
+two, and guarded by a dozen regulars from his
+own company. He watched them until they
+reached the bottom and disappeared behind
+the row of buildings that ended on the wharf
+in Patron&#8217;s trading store. In a moment they
+reappeared, and marched across the wharf,
+toward the two boats from <i>Le Fourgon</i> that
+awaited them. Even from the height, Menard
+could see that the soldiers had a stiff task to
+control their prisoners. After one of the boats,
+laden deep, had shoved off, there was a struggle,
+and the crowd of idlers that had gathered
+scattered suddenly. Two Indians had broken
+away, and were running across the wharf, with
+a little knot of soldiers close on their heels.
+One of the soldiers, leaping forward, brought
+the stock of his musket down on the head of
+the nearer Indian. The fugitive went down,
+dragging with him his companion, who tugged
+desperately at the chain. A soldier drew his
+knife, and cut off the dead Indian&#8217;s arm close
+to the iron wristlet, breaking the bone with
+his foot. Then they led back the captive and
+tumbled him into the boat, with the hand of
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_3' name='page_3'></a>3</span>
+his comrade dangling at the end of the chain.
+The incident had excited the soldiers, and they
+kicked and pounded the prisoners. A crowd
+gathered about the body on the wharf, the
+bolder ones snatching at his beads and wampum
+belt.</p>
+<p>Menard raised his eyes to the lands across
+the river and to the white cloud-puffs above.
+After months of camp and canoe, sleeping in
+snow and rain, and by day paddling, poling,
+and wading,&ndash;&ndash;never a new face among the
+grumbling soldiers or the stolid prisoners,&ndash;&ndash;after
+this, Quebec stood for luxury and the
+pleasant demoralization of good living. He
+liked the noise of passing feet, the hail of goodwill
+from door to door, the plodding shopkeepers
+and artisans, the comfortable priests in
+brown and gray.</p>
+<p>The sound of oars brought his eyes again
+to the river. The two boats with their loads
+of redskins were passing the merchantmen that
+lay between the men-of-war and the city. On
+the wharf, awaiting a second trip, was a huddled
+group of prisoners. Menard&#8217;s face clouded as
+he watched them. Men of his experience were
+wondering what effect this new plan of the
+Governor&#8217;s would have upon the Iroquois.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_4' name='page_4'></a>4</span>
+Capturing a hunting party by treachery and
+shipping them off to the King&#8217;s galleys was a
+bold stroke,&ndash;&ndash;too bold, perhaps. Governor
+Frontenac would never have done this; he
+knew the Iroquois temper too well. Governor
+la Barre, for all his bluster, would not have
+dared. It was certain that this new governor,
+Denonville, was not a coward; but as Menard
+reflected, going back over his own fifteen years
+of frontier life, he knew that this policy of
+brute force would be sorely tested by the tact
+and intrigue of the Five Nations. His own
+part in the capture little disturbed him. He
+had obeyed orders. He had brought the band
+to the citadel at Quebec without losing a man
+(saving the poor devil who had strangled himself
+with his own thongs at La Gallette).</p>
+<p>To such men as Menard, whose lives were
+woven closely into the fabric of New France,
+the present condition was clear. Many an
+evening he had spent with Major d&#8217;Orvilliers,
+at Fort Frontenac, in talking over the recent
+years of history into which their two names
+and their two lives had gone so deeply. Until
+his recall to France in 1682, Governor Frontenac
+had been for ten years building up in the
+Iroquois heart a fear and awe of Onontio, the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_5' name='page_5'></a>5</span>
+Great Father, at Quebec. D&#8217;Orvilliers knew
+that period the better, for Menard had not
+come over (from the little town of his birth,
+in Picardy) until Frontenac&#8217;s policy was well
+established. But Menard had lived hard and
+rapidly during his first years in the province,
+and he was a stern-faced young soldier when
+he stood on the wharf, hat in hand and sword
+to chin, watching New France&#8217;s greatest governor
+sitting erect in the boat that bore him
+away from his own. Menard had been initiated
+by a long captivity among the Onondagas, and
+had won his first commission by gallant action
+under the Governor&#8217;s eye.</p>
+<p>In those days no insult went unpunished;
+no tribe failed twice in its obligations. The
+circle of French influence was firmly extended
+around the haunts of the Iroquois in New York
+and along the Ohio. From Frontenac, on Lake
+Ontario, north to Hudson&#8217;s Bay, was French
+land. To the westward, along the Ottawa
+River, and skirting the north shore of Lake
+Huron to Michillimackinac and Green Bay,
+were the strong French allies, the Hurons,
+Ottawas, Nipissings, Kiskagons, Sacs, Foxes,
+and Mascoutins. Down at the lower end of
+Lake Michigan, at the Chicagou and St. Joseph
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_6' name='page_6'></a>6</span>
+portages, were the Miamis; and farther still,
+the Illinois, whom the Sieur de la Salle and
+Henri de Tonty had drawn close under the
+arm of New France.</p>
+<p>This chain of allies, with Du Luth&#8217;s fort at
+Detroit and a partial control over Niagara, had
+given New France nearly all the fur trade of the
+Great Lakes. The English Governor Dongan,
+of New York, dared not to fight openly for it,
+but he armed the Iroquois and set them against
+the French. Menard had laughed when the
+word came, in 1684, from Father de Lamberville,
+whose influence worked so far toward
+keeping the Iroquois quiet, that Dongan had
+pompously set up the arms of his king in each
+Iroquois village, even dating them back a year
+to make his claim the more secure. Every old
+soldier knew that more than decrees and coats
+of arms were needed to win the Five Nations.</p>
+<p>When La Barre succeeded Frontenac, lacking
+the tact and firmness which had established
+Frontenac&#8217;s name among foes and allies alike,
+he fell back upon bluster (to say nothing of the
+common talk in Quebec that he had set out to
+build up his private fortune by the fur trade).
+Learning that, by his grant of Fort Frontenac,
+La Salle was entitled to a third of the trade
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_7' name='page_7'></a>7</span>
+that passed through it, he seized the fort. He
+weakened La Salle&#8217;s communications so greatly
+that La Salle and Tonty could not make good
+their promises of French protection to the Illinois.
+This made it possible for the Iroquois,
+unhindered, to lay waste the Illinois country.
+By equally shortsighted methods, La Barre so
+weakened the ties that bound the northern
+allies, and so increased the arrogance of the
+Iroquois, that when Governor Denonville took
+up the task, most of the allies, always looking
+to the stronger party, were on the point of
+going over to the Iroquois. This would give
+the fur trade to the English, and ruin New
+France. Governor Dongan seized the moment
+to promise better bargains for the peltry than
+the French could offer. It remained for the
+new governor to make a demonstration which
+would establish firmly the drooping prestige of
+New France.</p>
+<p>Now the spring of 1687 was just ending.
+Since February it had been spread abroad,
+from the gulf seignories to Fort Frontenac,
+that preparations were making for a great
+campaign against the Iroquois. Champigny,
+the new Intendant, had scoured the country for
+supplies, and now was building bateaux and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_8' name='page_8'></a>8</span>
+buying canoes. Regulars and militia were
+drilling into the semblance of an army, and
+palisades and defences were everywhere built
+or strengthened, that the home guard might keep
+the province secure during the long absence of
+the troops. Menard wondered, as he snapped
+bits of stone off the parapet, and watched the
+last boatload of galley slaves embarking at the
+wharf, whether the Governor&#8217;s plans would carry.
+He would undoubtedly act with precision, he
+would follow every detail of campaigning to the
+delight of the tacticians, he would make a great
+splash,&ndash;&ndash;and then? How about the wily chiefs
+of the Senecas and Onondagas and Mohawks?
+They had hoodwinked La Barre into signing
+the meanest treaty that ever disgraced New
+France. Would Denonville, too, blind himself
+to the truth that shrewd minds may work behind
+painted faces?</p>
+<p>But above all else, Menard was a soldier.
+He snapped another bit of stone, and gave up
+the problem. He would fight at the Governor&#8217;s
+orders, retreat at the Governor&#8217;s command,&ndash;&ndash;to
+the Governor would belong the credit or the
+blame. Of only one thing was he sure,&ndash;&ndash;his
+own half hundred men should fight as they had
+always fought, and should hold their posts to
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_9' name='page_9'></a>9</span>
+the end. There ended his responsibility. And
+did not the good Fathers say that God was
+watching over New France?</p>
+<p>Meantime the breath of summer was in the
+air. The spring campaign was over for Menard.
+So he rested both elbows on the parapet, and
+wondered how long the leaves had been out in
+Picardy. Over beyond the ships and the river
+were waves of the newest green, instead of the
+deep, rich colour and the bloom of full life he
+had left behind at Fort Frontenac but two
+weeks back. The long journey down the St.
+Lawrence had seemed almost a descent into
+winter. On the way to Quebec every day and
+every league had brought fewer blossoms. Even
+Montreal, sixty leagues to the south, had her
+summer before Quebec.</p>
+<p>On the wharf below him the crowd were still
+plucking the dead Indian. Menard could hear
+their laughter and shouts. Their figures were
+small in the distance, their actions grotesque.
+One man was dancing, brandishing some part
+of the Indian&#8217;s costume. Menard could not
+distinguish the object in his hand. A priest
+crossed the wharf and elbowed into the crowd.
+For the moment he was lost in the rabble, but
+shortly the shouting quieted and the lightheaded
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_10' name='page_10'></a>10</span>
+fellows crowded into a close group.
+Probably the priest was addressing them. Soon
+the fringe of the crowd thinned, then the others
+walked quietly away. When at last the priest
+was left alone by the mutilated Indian, he knelt,
+and for a space was motionless.</p>
+<p>The idleness of reaction was on Menard.
+He leaned on the parapet, hardly stirring, while
+the priest went on his way across the square
+and began toiling up the steps. When he was
+halfway up, Menard recognized him for Claude
+de Casson, an old Jesuit of the Iroquois mission
+at Sault St. Francis Xavier, near Montreal.
+Menard strolled through the citadel to the
+square, and, meeting the Father, walked with
+him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, Father Claude, you are a long way
+from your flock.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, Captain Menard, I came with the relations.
+I have been&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;Father Claude was
+blown from his climb, and he paused, wiping
+the sweat from his lean face&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;I have been
+grieved by a spectacle in the Lower Town.
+Some wretches had killed an Onondaga with
+the brutality of his own tribe, and were robbing
+him. Are such acts permitted to-day in Quebec,
+M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_11' name='page_11'></a>11</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;He was a prisoner escaping from the soldiers.
+It must be a full year since I last saw
+you, Father. I hope you bring a good record
+to the College.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The best since our founding, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is there no word in the relations from the
+New York missions?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, M&#8217;sieu. Brother de Lamberville brings
+glorious word from the Mohawks. Twenty-three
+complete conversions.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You say he brings this word?&#8221; Menard&#8217;s
+brows came together. &#8220;Then he has come up
+to Montreal?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is true, then, that the Iroquois have word
+of our plans?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It would seem so. He said that a war
+party which started weeks ago for the Illinois
+country had been recalled. A messenger was
+sent out but a few days before he came away.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard slowly shook his head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;This word should go to the Commandant,&#8221;
+he said. &#8220;How about your Indians at the Mission,
+Father Claude? They have not French
+hearts.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah, but I am certain, M&#8217;sieu, they would
+not break faith with us.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_12' name='page_12'></a>12</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;You can trust them?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They are Christians, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, but they are Iroquois. Have none
+of them gone away since this news reached
+Quebec?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;None, save one poor wretch whose drunkenness
+long ago caused us to give up hope,
+though I&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What became of him? Where did he
+go?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He wandered away in a drunken fit.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And you have not heard from him since?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, M&#8217;sieu. He was Teganouan, an Onondaga.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You would do well, Father, if I may suggest,
+to take what news you may have to the Commandant.
+You and I know the importance of
+trifles at such a time as this. How long do
+you remain in Quebec?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;A few days only, unless there should be work
+for me here.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Do you return then to Montreal?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I cannot say until I have made my report
+and delivered the relations. Brother de Lamberville
+thinks it important that word should go
+to all those who are now labouring in the Iroquois
+villages. If they remain after the campaign
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_13' name='page_13'></a>13</span>
+is fairly started, their lives may be in
+danger.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You think it necessary to go yourself?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What else, M&#8217;sieu? This is not the time
+to trust too freely an Indian runner. And a
+layman might never get through alive. My
+habit would be the best safeguard.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I suppose you are right. If I should not
+see you again, I must ask you to convey my
+respect to your colleagues at the Mission. I
+shall probably be here until the campaign is
+fairly started; perhaps longer. Already I am
+tasting the luxury of idleness.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;A dangerous luxury, M&#8217;sieu. If I might
+be permitted to advise&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, yes, Father,&ndash;&ndash;I know, I know. But
+what is the use? You are a priest, I am a
+soldier. Yours is penance, mine is fighting;
+yours is praying, mine is singing,&ndash;&ndash;every man
+to his own. And when you priests have got
+your pagans converted, we soldiers will clean
+up the mess with our muskets. And now,
+Father, good day, and may God be with you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest&#8217;s face was unmoved as he looked
+after the retreating figure. He had watched
+Menard grow from a roistering lieutenant into a
+rigid captain, and he knew his temper too well
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_14' name='page_14'></a>14</span>
+to mind the flicks of banter. But before
+the soldier had passed from earshot, he called
+after him.</p>
+<p>Menard turned back. &#8220;What now, good
+Father? A mass for my soul, or a last absolution
+before I plunge into my term of dissolute
+idleness?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Neither, my son,&#8221; replied the priest, smiling.
+&#8220;Is any of your idleness to be shared with
+another?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Certainly, Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I am bringing a picture to the College.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have no money, Father. I should be a
+sorry patron.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, no, M&#8217;sieu; it is not a patron I seek.
+It is the advice of one who has seen and judged
+the master work of Paris. The painting has
+been shown to none as yet.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But you have seen it?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, yes, I have seen it. Come with me,
+M&#8217;sieu; it is at my room.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They walked together to the cell, six feet long
+by five wide, where Father Claude slept when in
+Quebec. It was bare of all save a hard cot. A
+bale, packed in rough cloth and tied with rope,
+lay on the bed. Father Claude opened the
+bundle, while Menard leaned against the wall,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_15' name='page_15'></a>15</span>
+and drew out his few personal belongings and
+his portable altar before he reached the flat,
+square package at the bottom. There was a
+touch of colour in his cheeks and a nervousness
+in the movement of his hands as he untied the
+flaxen strings, stripped off the cloth, and held
+the picture up to Menard&#8217;s view.</p>
+<p>It was a full-length portrait in oil of a young
+Indian woman, holding a small cross in her
+right hand, and gazing at it with bent head.
+Her left hand was spread upon her breast. She
+wore a calico chemise reaching below her knees,
+and leggings, and moccasins. A heavy robe
+was thrown over the top of her head, falling on
+the sides and back to within a foot of the ground.
+In the middle background was a stream, with
+four Indians in a canoe. A tiny stone chapel
+stood on the bank at the extreme right.</p>
+<p>Father Claude&#8217;s hand trembled as he supported
+the canvas upon the cot, and his eyes
+wavered from Menard to the picture, and back
+again.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is not altogether completed,&#8221; he said,
+nervously. &#8220;Of course the detail will be
+worked out more fully, and the cross should
+be given a warmer radiance. Perhaps a light
+showing through the windows of the chapel&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_16' name='page_16'></a>16</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Who is it?&#8221; asked Menard.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is Catherine Outasoren, the Lily of the
+Onondagas,&#8221; replied the priest; &#8220;the noblest
+woman that ever rose from the depths of Indian
+superstition.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard&#8217;s eyes rested on an obscure signature
+in a lower corner, &#8220;C. de C.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You certainly have reason to be proud of
+the work. But may I ask about the perspective?
+Should the maiden appear larger than
+the chapel?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest gazed at the painting with an
+unsettled expression.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; he said, &#8220;perhaps you are right,
+M&#8217;sieu. At any rate I will give the matter
+thought and prayer.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And the Indians,&#8221; Menard questioned, &#8220;in
+the canoe; are they coming toward the chapel
+or going away from it? It seems to me that
+any doubt on that point should be removed.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah,&#8221; said the priest; &#8220;that very doubt is
+allegorical. It typifies the workings of the
+human mind when first confronted by the
+truth. When the seeker first beholds the light,
+as shown through the devotion of such a
+woman as Catherine Outasoren, there arises
+in his mind&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_17' name='page_17'></a>17</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Very true, very true! But I never yet have
+seen a canoe-load of Indians in doubt whether
+they were moving forward or backward.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude held the canvas at arm&#8217;s length
+and gazed long at it.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tell me, M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; he said at last, &#8220;do you
+think it deserving of a place in the College?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I do not see why not.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And you think I would be justified in laying
+a request before the Superior?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard shrugged his shoulders.</p>
+<p>&#8220;That is your decision, Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I never can fully thank you, my son, for
+your kindness in looking on my humble work.
+I will not decide to-day. First I must add foliage
+in the foreground. And I will give it my
+earnest prayer.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard said farewell and went out, leaving
+the priest gazing at the picture. He strolled
+back toward the citadel, stopping now and
+then to greet an old friend or a chance acquaintance.
+When he arrived at the headquarters
+in the citadel he found Danton, a
+brown-haired young lieutenant of engineers,
+gazing at a heap of plans and other papers
+on the table.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, Captain Menard,&#8221; was his greeting,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_18' name='page_18'></a>18</span>
+&#8220;I&#8217;d give half of last year&#8217;s pay, if I ever get it,
+to feel as lazy as you look.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are lazy enough,&#8221; growled Menard.</p>
+<p>&#8220;That begs the question. It is not how lazy
+a man is, but how lazy he gets a chance to be.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If you&#8217;d been through what I have this
+spring, you&#8217;d deserve a rest.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You must have had a stirring time,&#8221; said
+the Lieutenant. &#8220;Major Provost has promised
+to let me go out with the line when the campaign
+starts. I&#8217;ve not had a brush since I
+came over.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard gave him a quizzical smile before he
+replied, &#8220;You&#8217;ll get brushes enough.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;By the way, the Major wants to see you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Does he?&#8221; said Menard.</p>
+<p>He lighted his short pipe with a coal from
+the fire and walked out.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_19' name='page_19'></a>19</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_II_THE_MAID' id='CHAPTER_II_THE_MAID'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER II.</h2>
+<h3>THE MAID.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>Menard did not go at once to see Major
+Provost, the Commandant. He had already
+handed in his report at the citadel. It
+was probable that this was some new work for
+him. He had just settled his mind to the prospect
+of a rest, the first since that mad holiday,
+seven years before, when word had come that
+his lieutenant&#8217;s commission was on the way.
+That was at Three Rivers. He wanted to idle,
+to waste a few weeks for the sheer delight of
+extravagance, but his blood did not flow more
+quickly at the wish. He was an older man by
+a score of years&ndash;&ndash;or was it only seven?</p>
+<p>He lingered on the square. The black-eyed
+children, mostly dirty and ragged (for the maids
+whom the King had sent over by shiploads to
+his colonists had not developed into the most
+diligent and neat housewives) tumbled about
+his feet. He allowed himself to be drawn into
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_20' name='page_20'></a>20</span>
+their play. They had no awe of his uniform,
+for it was worn and frayed. He had not yet
+taken the trouble to get out his fresher coat and
+breeches and boots. He thought of this, and
+was again amused. It was another sign of age.
+The time had been when his first care after
+arriving in Quebec was to don his rich house
+uniform and polished scabbard, and step gaily
+to the Major&#8217;s house to sun himself in the welcome
+of the Major&#8217;s pretty wife, who had known
+his uncle, the Sieur de Vauban, at La Rochelle.
+Now he was back in Quebec from months on
+the frontier, he was summoned to the Major&#8217;s
+house, and yet he stayed and laughed at the
+children. For the Major&#8217;s wife was older, too,
+and the vivacity of her youth was thinning out
+and uncovering the needle-like tongue beneath.
+A slim little urchin was squirming between
+his boots, with a pursuing rabble close behind,
+and the Captain had to take hold of a young
+tree to keep his feet. He turned and started in
+pursuit of the children, but caught sight of
+two Ursuline sisters entering the square, and
+straightened himself. After all, a captain is a
+captain, even though the intoxication of spring
+be in him, and his heart struggling to clamber
+back into the land of youth. He walked on
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_21' name='page_21'></a>21</span>
+across the square and down the street to the
+Major&#8217;s house.</p>
+<p>Major Provost welcomed Menard heartily,
+and led him to his office. &#8220;We&#8217;ll have our
+business first,&#8221; he said, &#8220;and get it done with.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard settled back in the carved oak chair
+which had for generations been a member of
+the Major&#8217;s family. The light mood had left
+him. Now he was the soldier, brusque in
+manner, with lines about his mouth which, to
+certain men, gave his face a hard expression.</p>
+<p>&#8220;First let me ask you, Menard, what are
+your plans?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;For the present?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have none.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Your personal affairs, I mean. Have you
+any matters to hold your attention here for the
+next few weeks?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;None.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Major Provost fingered his quill.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t know, of course, how your own
+feelings stand, Menard. You&#8217;ve been worked
+hard for three years, and I suppose you want
+rest. But somebody must go to Fort Frontenac,
+and the Governor thinks you are the
+man.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_22' name='page_22'></a>22</span></p>
+<p>Menard made a gesture of impatience.</p>
+<p>&#8220;There are a dozen men here with little
+to do.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I know it. But this matter is of some
+importance, and it may call for delicate work
+before you are through with it. It isn&#8217;t much
+in itself,&ndash;&ndash;merely to bear orders to d&#8217;Orvilliers,&ndash;&ndash;but
+the Governor thinks that the right man
+may be able to do strong work before the
+campaign opens. You probably know that we
+are to move against the Senecas alone, and
+that we must treat with the other nations to
+keep them from aiding the Senecas. No one
+can say just how this can be done. Even
+Father de Lamberville has come back, you
+know, from the Mohawks; but the Governor
+thinks that if we send a good man, he may be
+able to see a way, once he gets on the ground,
+and can advise with d&#8217;Orvilliers. Now, you
+are a good man, Menard; and you can influence
+the Indians if anyone can.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are a little vague, Major.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will go to Frontenac in advance of
+the army to prepare the way. La Durantaye
+and Du Luth are already at Detroit, awaiting
+orders, with close to two hundred Frenchmen
+and four hundred Indians. And Tonty should
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_23' name='page_23'></a>23</span>
+have joined them before now with several
+hundred Illinois.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t believe he&#8217;ll bring many Illinois.
+They must have known of the Iroquois war
+party that started toward their villages. They
+will stay to defend their own country. They
+may not know that the Iroquois party was
+recalled.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Recalled?&#8221; said the Major.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. Father de Casson has the news from
+Father de Lamberville. You see what that
+means. The Iroquois have been warned.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I was afraid of it. These new governors,
+Menard&ndash;&ndash;each has to learn his lesson from
+the beginning of the book. Why will they
+not take counsel from the men who know the
+Indians? This campaign has been heralded as
+broadly as a trading fair.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;When should I start?&#8221; asked Menard, abruptly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;At once&ndash;&ndash;within a few days.&#8221; Major
+Provost looked at the other&#8217;s set face. &#8220;I am
+sorry about this, Menard. But you understand,
+I am sure. Perhaps I had better give you an
+idea of our plans. You know, of course, that
+we have three ships fitting out at Frontenac.
+Already our force is being got together at St.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_24' name='page_24'></a>24</span>
+Helen&#8217;s Island, by Montreal. Champigny is
+engaging canoemen and working out a transport
+and supply system between Montreal and
+Frontenac. The force will proceed to Frontenac,
+and embark from there in the ships,
+bateaux, and canoes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is the rendezvous at Niagara?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, at La Famine, on the southern shore
+of Lake Ontario.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard nodded. He knew the place; for
+by nearly starving there, years before, with the
+others of Governor la Barre&#8217;s ill-starred expedition,
+he had contributed to giving the spot
+a name.</p>
+<p>&#8220;La Durantaye and Du Luth, with Tonty,
+are to meet us there. You will instruct them
+to move on to Niagara, and there await further
+orders. We shall sail around the east end of
+the lake and along the south shore.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Iroquois will follow your movements.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We intend that they shall. They will not
+know where our final landing place will be, and
+will have to keep their forces well in hand.
+And it will prevent them from uniting to attack
+Niagara.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What then?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We will leave a strong guard at La Famine
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_25' name='page_25'></a>25</span>
+with the stores, and strike inland for the Seneca
+villages.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And now what part am I to play in this?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Major Provost leaned back in his chair.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You, Menard, are to represent the Governor.
+You will move in advance of the troops.
+At Frontenac it will be your duty to see first
+that the way is clear to getting the two divisions
+to the meeting place at La Famine, and to
+see that d&#8217;Orvilliers has the fort ready for the
+troops, with extra cabins and stockades. Then
+the Governor wishes you and d&#8217;Orvilliers to go
+over all the information the scouts bring in. If
+you can decide upon any course which will hold
+back the other tribes from aiding the Senecas,
+act upon it at once, without orders. In other
+words, you have full liberty to follow your judgment.
+That ought to be responsibility enough.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard stretched his arms. &#8220;All right,
+Major. But when my day comes to taste the
+delights of Quebec, I hope I may not be too
+old to enjoy it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Governor honours you, Menard, with
+this undertaking.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He honoured De S&eacute;vign&eacute; with a majority
+and turned him loose in Quebec.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Too bad, Menard, too bad,&#8221; the Major
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_26' name='page_26'></a>26</span>
+laughed. &#8220;Now I, who ask nothing better than
+a brisk campaign, must rot here in Quebec until
+I die.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Are you not to go?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. I am to stay behind and brighten my
+lonely moments drilling the rabble of a home
+guard. Do you think you will need an escort?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No; the river from here to Frontenac is in
+use every day. I shall want canoemen. Two
+will be enough.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well. Let me know what supplies you
+need. You mistake, man, in grumbling at the
+work. You are building up a reputation that
+never could live at short range. Stay away
+long enough and you will be a more popular
+man than the Governor. I envy you, on my
+honour, I do.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;One thing more, Major. This galley affair;
+what do you think of it?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You mean the capture at Frontenac? You
+should know better than I, Menard. You
+brought the prisoners down.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There is no doubt in my mind, Major, nor
+in d&#8217;Orvilliers&#8217;s! We obeyed orders.&#8221; Menard
+looked up expressively. &#8220;You know the Iroquois.
+You know how they will take it. The
+worst fault was La Grange&#8217;s. He captured the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_27' name='page_27'></a>27</span>
+party&ndash;&ndash;and it was not a war party&ndash;&ndash;by deliberate
+treachery. D&#8217;Orvilliers had intrusted to
+him the Governor&#8217;s orders that Indians must be
+got for the King&#8217;s galleys. As you know, d&#8217;Orvilliers
+and I both protested. I did not bring
+them here until the Governor commanded it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, we can&#8217;t help that now, Menard.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;That is not the question. You ask me to
+keep the Onondagas out of this fight, after we
+have taken a hundred of their warriors in this
+way.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I know it, Menard; I know it. But the
+Governor&#8217;s orders&ndash;&ndash;Well, I have nothing to
+say. You can only do your best.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They went to the reception room, where Madame
+de Provost awaited them. Menard was
+made to stay and dine, in order that Madame
+could draw from him a long account of his
+latest adventures on the frontier. Madame de
+Provost, though she had lived a dozen years in
+the province, had never been farther from Quebec
+than the Seignory of the Marquis de St.
+Denis, half a dozen leagues below the city.
+The stories that came to her ears of massacres
+and battles, of settlers butchered in the fields,
+and of the dashing adventures of La Salle and
+Du Luth, were to her no more than wild tales
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_28' name='page_28'></a>28</span>
+from a far-away land. So she chattered through
+the long dinner; and for the first time since he
+had reached the city, Menard wished himself
+back on Lake Ontario, where there were no
+women.</p>
+<p>Menard returned to the citadel early in the
+evening. Lieutenant Danton was drawing
+plans for a redoubt, but he leaned back as
+Menard entered.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I began to think you were not coming back,
+Captain,&#8221; he said. &#8220;I&#8217;m told the Major says
+that you are the only man in New France who
+could have got that trading agreement from the
+Onondagas last year. How did you do it?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How does a man usually do what he is told
+to do?&#8221; Menard sat on a corner of the long
+table and looked lazily at the boy.</p>
+<p>&#8220;That wasn&#8217;t the kind of treaty our Governors
+make; you know it wasn&#8217;t.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You were not here under Frontenac.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. I wish I had been. He must have
+been a great orator. My father has told me
+about the long council at Montreal. He said
+that Frontenac out-talked the greatest of the
+Mohawk orators. Did you learn it from him?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;My boy, when you are through with your
+pretty pictures,&#8221; Menard motioned toward the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_29' name='page_29'></a>29</span>
+plans, &#8220;and have got out into the real work;
+when you&#8217;ve spent months in Iroquois lodges;
+when you&#8217;ve been burned and shot and starved,&ndash;&ndash;then
+it will be a pity if you haven&#8217;t learned
+to be a soldier. What is this little thing you
+are drawing?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton flushed. &#8220;You may laugh at the
+engineers,&#8221; he said, &#8220;but where would King
+Louis be now if&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tut, my boy, tut!&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;That is very well&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard laughed. &#8220;How old are you, Danton?&#8221;
+he asked.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Twenty-two.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very good. You have got on well. I dare
+say you&#8217;ve learned a deal out of your books.
+Now we have you out here in the provinces,
+where the hard work is done. Well send you
+back in a few years a real man. And then
+you&#8217;ll step smartly among the pretty officers of
+the King, and when one speaks of New France
+you&#8217;ll lift your brows and say: &#8216;New France?
+Ah, yes. That is in America. I was there
+once. Rather a primitive life&ndash;&ndash;no court, no
+army.&#8217; Ah, ha, my boy&ndash;&ndash;no, never mind.
+Come up to my quarters and have a sip of real
+old Burgundy.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_30' name='page_30'></a>30</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Are you ever serious, Menard?&#8221; asked
+Danton, sitting on the Captain&#8217;s cot and smacking
+his lips over the liquor.</p>
+<p>Menard smiled. &#8220;I&#8217;m afraid I shall have to
+play at composure for an hour,&#8221; he said. &#8220;I
+must see Father Claude. Settle yourself here,
+if you like.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard hurried away, for it was growing late.
+He found the Jesuit meditating in his cell.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah, Captain Menard, I am glad to see you
+so soon again.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard sat on the narrow bed and stretched
+out his legs as far as he could in the cramped
+space.</p>
+<p>&#8220;How soon will your duties be over here,
+Father?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There seems to be no reason for me to stay.
+I have delivered the relations, and no further
+work has come to hand.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Then it may be that you can help me,
+Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You know, my son, that I will.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well. I have been ordered to Fort
+Frontenac in advance of the troops. I am to
+bear orders to d&#8217;Orvilliers and to Du Luth and
+La Durantaye. It is possible that there may
+be some delicate work to be done among the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_31' name='page_31'></a>31</span>
+Indians. You know the Iroquois, Father, and
+our two heads together should be stronger than
+mine alone. I want you to go with me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest&#8217;s eyes lighted.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It may be that I can get permission at
+Montreal.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will go, then?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Gladly. It is to be no one else&ndash;&ndash;we
+two&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We shall have canoemen. To my mind,
+the fewer the better.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Still, Captain, you cannot depend on the
+canoemen. Would it not be well to have one
+other man? You might need a messenger.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard thought for a moment.</p>
+<p>&#8220;True, Father. And if I am to have a man,
+he had best be an officer; yes, a man who
+could execute orders. I&#8217;ll take Danton. You
+will be ready for a start, Father, probably
+to-morrow?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;At any time, my son.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There was little work to be done in preparing
+for the journey (Major Provost would attend to
+the supplies and to engaging the canoemen),
+and Menard still was in the lazy mood. He
+stood for a while at the edge of the cliff and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_32' name='page_32'></a>32</span>
+looked down at the wharf. It was dark, and he
+could not see whether the body of the Indian
+had been removed. The incident of the afternoon
+had been gathering importance to his mind
+the longer he thought of it. Five years earlier
+Menard had been captured by the Onondagas
+during a fight near Fort Frontenac. They
+had taken him to one of their villages, south
+of Lake Ontario, and for days had tortured
+him and starved him. They had drawn out
+cords from his arms and legs and thrust sticks
+between them and the flesh. His back was
+still covered with scars from the burning slivers
+which they had stuck through the skin. They
+had torn the nails from his left hand with their
+teeth. Then Otreouati, the Big Throat, the
+chief who had led his followers to believe in
+Frontenac, came back from a parley with
+another tribe, and taking a liking to the tall
+young soldier who bore the torture without
+flinching, he adopted him into his own family.
+Menard had lived with the Indians, a captive
+only in name, and had earned the name of the
+Big Buffalo by his skill in the hunt. At last,
+when they had released him, it was under a
+compact of friendship, that had never since been
+broken. It had stood many tests. Even during
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_33' name='page_33'></a>33</span>
+open campaigns they had singled him out
+from the other Frenchmen as their brother.
+He wondered whether they knew of his part in
+stocking the King&#8217;s galleys. Probably they did.</p>
+<p>It was late when Menard took a last sweeping
+look at the river and walked up to the citadel.
+His day of idleness was over. After all, it had
+not been altogether a wasted day. But it was
+the longest holiday he was likely to have for
+months to come. Having made up his mind to
+accept the facts, he stretched out on his bed and
+went to sleep.</p>
+<p>Danton took the news that he was to be a
+member of the party with enthusiasm. Menard
+had hardly finished telling him when he swept
+the tiresome plans and specifications into a
+heap at the end of the table, and rushed out
+to get a musket (for a sword would have no
+place in the work before them). The start was
+to be made at noon, but Danton was on the
+ground so early as almost to lower his dignity
+in the eyes of the bronzed canoemen. He
+wore his bravest uniform, with polished belt
+and buttons and new lace at the neck. His
+broad hat had a long curling feather. He
+wore the new musket slung rakishly over his
+shoulder.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_34' name='page_34'></a>34</span></p>
+<p>About the middle of the forenoon, as Menard
+was looking over his orders, memorizing
+them in case of accident to the papers, he
+was found by Major Provost&#8217;s orderly, who
+said that the Commandant wished to see him
+at once.</p>
+<p>The Major was busy with the engineers in
+another room, but he left them.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Menard,&#8221; he said abruptly, &#8220;I&#8217;ve got to ask
+you to do me a favour. If I could see any way
+out of it&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will do anything I can.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Thank you. I suppose you know the
+Marquis de St. Denis?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Slightly.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, I shan&#8217;t take time to give you the whole
+story. St. Denis has the seignory six leagues
+to the east. You may know that he went
+into debt to invest in La Salle&#8217;s colonizing
+scheme in Louisiana. St. Denis was in France
+at the time, and had great faith in La Salle.
+Of course, now that La Salle has not been
+heard from, and the debts are all past due
+without even a rumour of success to make
+them good&ndash;&ndash;you can imagine the rest. The
+seignory has been seized. St. Denis has
+nothing.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_35' name='page_35'></a>35</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Has he a family?&#8221; asked Menard.</p>
+<p>&#8220;A daughter. His wife is dead. He came
+here after you left last night, and again this
+morning. We are old friends, and I have been
+trying to help him. He is going to sail to-day
+on <i>Le Fourgon</i> for Paris to see what he can
+save from the wreck. My house is crowded
+with the officers who are here planning the
+campaign; but St. Denis has a cousin living at
+Frontenac, Captain la Grange, and we&#8217;ve got
+to get Valerie there somehow. Do you think
+it will be safe?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s a hard trip, you know; but it&#8217;s safe
+enough.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I shan&#8217;t forget your kindness, Menard.
+The girl is a spirited little thing, and she
+takes it hard. Madame has set her heart on
+getting her to La Grange. I don&#8217;t know all
+the details myself.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think we can arrange it, Major. We
+start in an hour.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;She will be there. You are a splendid
+fellow, Menard. Good-bye.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard&#8217;s face was less amiable once he was
+away from the house. He knew from experience
+the disagreeable task that lay before him.
+But there was nothing to be said, so he went
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_36' name='page_36'></a>36</span>
+to his quarters and took a last look at the
+orders. Then taking off his coat and his rough
+shirt, he placed the papers carefully in a buckskin
+bag, which he hung about his neck.</p>
+<p>Everything was ready at the wharf. The
+long canoe lay waiting, a <i>voyageur</i> at each
+end. The bales were stowed carefully in the
+centre. Father de Casson met Menard at the
+upper end of the dock. He had come down
+by way of the winding road, for his bundle was
+heavy, and he knew no way but to carry it himself.
+Menard good-naturedly gave him a hand
+as they crossed the dock. When they had set
+it down, and Menard straightened up, his eyes
+twinkled, for young Danton, in his finery, was
+nervously walking back and forth at the edge
+of the dock, looking fixedly into the canoe,
+apparently inspecting the bales. His shoulders
+were unused to the musket, and by a quick
+turn he had brought the muzzle under the rim
+of his hat, setting it on the side of his head.
+His face was red.</p>
+<p>Sitting on a bundle, a rod away, was a girl,
+perhaps eighteen or nineteen years old, wearing
+a simple travelling dress. Her hands were
+clasped tightly in her lap, and she gazed steadily
+out over the water with an air that would
+have been haughty save for the slight upward
+tip of her nose.</p>
+<div class='figcenter'>
+<a name='linki_2' id='linki_2'></a>
+<img src='images/illus-036.jpg' alt='' title='' style='width: 367px; height: 501px;' /><br />
+<p class='caption' style='margin: 0 auto; text-align:center; width: 367px;'>
+&#8220;Sitting on a bundle was, a girl, perhaps eighteen or nineteen years old.&#8221;<br />
+</p>
+</div>
+<div><span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_37' name='page_37'></a>37</span></div>
+<p>Menard&#8217;s eyes sobered, and he handed his
+musket to one of the canoemen. Then he
+crossed over to where the maiden was sitting.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle St. Denis?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The girl looked up at him. Her eyes seemed
+to take in the dinginess of his uniform. She
+inclined her head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I am Captain Menard. Major Provost tells
+me that I am to have the honour of escorting
+you to Fort Frontenac. With your permission
+we will start. Father Claude de Casson is to
+go with us, and Lieutenant Danton.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The bundle was placed in the canoe. Menard
+helped the girl to a seat near the middle:
+from the way she stepped in and took her seat
+he saw that she had been on the river before.
+Danton, with his Parisian airs, had to be helped
+in carefully. Then they were off, each of the
+four men swinging a paddle, though Danton
+managed his awkwardly at first.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_38' name='page_38'></a>38</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_III_MADEMOISELLE_EATS_HER_BREAKFAST' id='CHAPTER_III_MADEMOISELLE_EATS_HER_BREAKFAST'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER III.</h2>
+<h3>MADEMOISELLE EATS HER BREAKFAST.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>The sun hung low over the western woods
+when Menard, at the close of the second
+day, headed the canoe shoreward. The great
+river swept by with hardly a surface motion,
+dimpling and rippling under the last touch of
+the day breeze. Menard&#8217;s eyes rested on
+Father Claude, as the canoe drew into the
+shadow of the trees. The priest, stiff from the
+hours of sitting and kneeling, had taken up a
+paddle and was handling it deftly. He had
+rolled his sleeves up to the elbow, showing a
+thin forearm with wire-like muscles. The two
+<i>voyageurs</i>, at bow and stern, were proving to
+be quiet enough fellows. Guerin, the younger,
+wore a boyish, half-confiding look. His fellow,
+Perrot, was an older man.</p>
+<p>Menard felt, when he thought of Danton, a
+sense of pride in his own right judgment.
+The boy was taking hold with a strong, if unguided,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_39' name='page_39'></a>39</span>
+hand. Already the feather was gone
+from his hat, the lace from his throat. Two
+days in the canoe and a night on the ground
+had stained and wrinkled his uniform,&ndash;&ndash;a condition
+of which, with his quick adaptability, he
+was already beginning to feel proud. He had
+flushed often, during the first day, under the
+shrewd glances of the <i>voyageurs</i>, who read the
+inexperience in his bright clothes and white
+hands. Menard knew, from the way his shoulders
+followed the swing of his arms, that the
+steady paddling was laming him sadly. He
+would allow Danton five days more; at the
+week&#8217;s end he must be a man, else the experiment
+had failed.</p>
+<p>The canoe scraped bottom under a wild
+growth of brush and outreaching trees. The
+forest was stirring with the rustle and call of
+birds, with the breath of the leaves and the
+far-away crackle and plunge of larger animals
+through the undergrowth. A chipmunk, with
+inquisitive eyes, sat on the root of a knotted
+oak, but he whisked away when Menard and
+the canoemen stepped into the shallow water.
+Overhead, showing little fear of the canoe
+and of the strangely clad animals within it,
+scampered a family of red squirrels, now nibbling
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_40' name='page_40'></a>40</span>
+a nut from the winter&#8217;s store, now running
+and jumping from tree to tree, until only
+by the shaking of the twigs and the leaf-clusters
+could one follow their movements.</p>
+<p>The maid leaned an elbow on the bale which
+Danton had placed at her back, and rested her
+cheek on her hand. They were under the
+drooping branches of an elm that stood holding
+to the edge of the bank. Well out over
+the water sat one of the squirrels, his tail
+sweeping above his head, nibbling an acorn,
+and looking with hasty little glances at the
+canoe. She watched him, and memories came
+into her eyes. There had been squirrels on
+her father&#8217;s seignory who would take nuts
+from her hand, burying them slyly under the
+bushes, and hurrying back for more.</p>
+<p>Danton came wading to the side of the
+canoe to help her to the bank, but she took his
+hand only to steady herself while rising. Stepping
+over the bracing-strips between the gunwales,
+she caught a swaying branch, and swung
+herself lightly ashore. Back from the water
+the ground rose into a low hill, covered with
+oak and elm and ragged hickory trees. Here,
+for a space, there was little undergrowth, and
+save under the heaviest of the trees the ground
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_41' name='page_41'></a>41</span>
+was green with short, coarse grass. Danton
+took a hatchet from the canoe, and trimmed a
+fir tree, heaping armfuls of green boughs at the
+foot of an oak near the top of the slope. Over
+these he threw a blanket. The maid came
+slowly up the hill, in response to his call, and
+with a weary little smile of thanks she sank
+upon the fragrant couch. She rested against
+the tree trunk, gazing through the nearer foliage
+at the rushing river.</p>
+<p>For the two days she had been like this,&ndash;&ndash;silent,
+shy, with sad eyes. And Danton,&ndash;&ndash;who
+could no more have avoided the company of
+such a maid than he could have left off eating
+or breathing or laughing,&ndash;&ndash;Danton, for all his
+short Paris life (which should, Heaven knows,
+have given him a front with the maids), could
+do nothing but hang about, eager for a smile
+or a word, yet too young to know that he could
+better serve his case by leaving her with her
+thoughts, and with the boundless woods and
+the great lonely spaces of the river. Menard
+saw the comedy&ndash;&ndash;as indeed, who of the
+party did not&ndash;&ndash;and was amused. A few
+moments later he glanced again toward the
+oak. He was sharpening a knife, and could
+seem not to be observing. Danton was
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_42' name='page_42'></a>42</span>
+sitting a few yards from the maid, with the
+awkward air of a youth who doubts his welcome.
+She still looked out over the water.
+Menard saw that her face was white and drooping.
+He knew that she had not slept; for
+twice during the preceding night, as he lay in
+his blanket, he had heard from under the overturned
+canoe, where she lay, the low sound of
+her sobbing.</p>
+<p>Menard walked slowly down the slope, testing
+the knife-edge with his thumb, his short
+pipe between his teeth. He sheathed his knife,
+lowered his pipe, and called:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Guerin.&#8221; The two men, who were bringing
+wood to the fire, looked up. &#8220;Where has the
+Father gone?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Guerin pointed around the base of the hill.
+&#8220;He went to the woods, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;With a bundle,&#8221; added Perrot.</p>
+<p>Menard walked around the hill, and after a
+little searching found the priest, kneeling, in a
+clearing, before the portrait of Catharine Outasoren,
+which he had set against a tree. His
+brushes and paints were spread on the ground
+before him. He did not hear Menard approach.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh,&#8221; said the captain, &#8220;you brought the
+picture!&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_43' name='page_43'></a>43</span></p>
+<p>The priest looked up over his shoulder, with
+a startled manner.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I myself have stripped down to the lightest
+necessaries,&#8221; said Menard, with a significant
+glance at the portrait.</p>
+<p>The priest lowered his brush, and sat looking
+at the picture with troubled eyes. &#8220;I had no
+place for it,&#8221; he said at last, hesitatingly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They didn&#8217;t take it at the College, eh?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude flushed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They were very kind. They felt that
+perhaps it was not entirely completed, and
+that&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will leave it at Montreal, then, at the
+Mission?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&ndash;&ndash;I suppose so. Yes, I shall plan to
+leave it there.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard leaned against a tree, and pressed
+the tobacco down in his pipe.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have been doing some thinking in the
+last few minutes, Father. I&#8217;ve decided to make
+my first call on you for assistance.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well, Captain.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is about the maid. Have you noticed?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;She seems of a sober mind.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Don&#8217;t you see why? It is her father&#8217;s
+losses, and this journey. She is taking it very
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_44' name='page_44'></a>44</span>
+hard. She is afraid, Father, all the time; and
+she neither sleeps nor eats.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is naturally hard for such a child as she
+is to take this journey. She has had no experience,&ndash;&ndash;she
+does not comprehend the easy customs
+and the hard travelling of the frontier. I
+think that in time&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard was puffing impatiently.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father,&#8221; he said, &#8220;do you remember when
+Major Gordeau was killed, and I was detailed
+to bring his wife and daughter down to Three
+Rivers? It was much like this. They fretted
+and could not sleep, and the coarse fare of the
+road was beneath their appetites. Do you
+remember? And when it came to taking the
+rapids, with the same days of hard work that
+lie before us now, they were too weak, and
+they sickened, the mother first, then the daughter.
+When I think of that, Father, of the last
+week of that journey, and of how I swore
+never again to take a woman in my care on the
+river, I&ndash;&ndash;well, there is no use in going over
+it. If this goes on, we shall not get to Frontenac
+in time, that is all. And I cannot afford
+to take such a chance.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest looked grave. The long struggle
+against the rapids from Montreal to La Gallette
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_45' name='page_45'></a>45</span>
+had tried the hardihood of more than one strong
+man.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is probable, my son, that the sense of
+your responsibility makes you a little over-cautious.
+She is a strong enough child, I
+should say. Still, perhaps the food is not what
+she has been accustomed to. I have noticed
+that she eats little.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Perrot is too fond of grease,&#8221; Menard said.
+&#8220;I must tell him to use less grease.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If she should be taken sick, we could leave
+her with someone at Montreal.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Leave her at Montreal!&#8221; exclaimed Menard.
+&#8220;When she breaks down, it will be in the
+rapids. And then I must either go on alone,
+or wait with you until she is strong enough to
+be carried. In any case it means confusion
+and delay. And I must not be delayed.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What have you in mind to do?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We must find a way to brighten her spirits.
+It is homesickness that worries her, and sorrow
+for her father, and dread of what is before and
+around her. I&#8217;ll warrant she has never been
+away from her home before. We must get
+her confidence,&ndash;&ndash;devise ways to cheer her,
+brighten her.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I can reason with her, and&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_46' name='page_46'></a>46</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;This is not the time for reasoning, Father.
+What we must do is to make her stop thinking,
+stop looking backward and forward. And there
+is Danton; he can help. He is of an age with
+her, and should succeed where you and I might
+fail.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He has not awaited the suggestion, Captain.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, I know. But he must,&ndash;&ndash;well, Father,
+it has all been said. The maid is on our hands,
+and must be got to Frontenac. That is all.
+And there is nothing for it but to rely on
+Danton to help.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest looked at his brushes, and hesitated.
+&#8220;I am not certain,&#8221; he said, &#8220;she is
+very young. And Lieutenant Danton,&ndash;&ndash;I
+have heard, while at Quebec,&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard laughed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;He is a boy, Father. These tales may
+be true enough. Why not? They would fit
+as well any idle lieutenant in Quebec, who is
+lucky enough to have an eye, and a pair of
+shoulders, and a bit of the King&#8217;s gold in his
+purse. This maid is the daughter of a gentleman,
+Father; she is none of your Lower Town
+jades. And Danton may be young and foolish,&ndash;&ndash;as
+may we all have been,&ndash;&ndash;but he is a
+gentleman born.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_47' name='page_47'></a>47</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well,&#8221; replied the priest, looking with
+regret at the failing light, and beginning to
+gather his brushes. &#8220;I will counsel her, but I
+fear it will do little good. If the maid is sick
+at heart, and we attempt to guide her thoughts,
+we may but drive the trouble deeper in. It is
+the same with some of the Indian maidens,
+when they have left the tribe for the Mission.
+Now and again there comes a time, even with
+piety to strengthen them,&ndash;&ndash;and this maid has
+little,&ndash;&ndash;when the yearning seems to grow too
+strong to be cured. Sometimes they go back.
+One died. It was at Sault St. Francis in the
+year of the&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, yes,&#8221; Menard broke in. &#8220;We have
+only one fact to remember; there must be no
+delay in carrying out the Governor&#8217;s orders.
+We cannot change our plans because of this
+maid.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We must not let her understand, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard had been standing, with a shoulder
+against the tree, alternately puffing at his pipe
+and lowering it, scowling meanwhile at the
+ground. Now he suddenly raised his head
+and chuckled.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It will be many a year since I have played
+the beau, Father. It may be that I have forgotten
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_48' name='page_48'></a>48</span>
+the r&ocirc;le.&#8221; He spread out his hands
+and looked at the twisted fingers. &#8220;But I can
+try, like a soldier. And there are three of us,
+Father Claude, there are three of us.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He turned to go back to the camp, but the
+priest touched him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My son,&ndash;&ndash;perhaps, before you return, you
+would look again at my unworthy portrait.
+I&ndash;&ndash;about the matter of the canoe&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh,&#8221; said Menard, &#8220;you&#8217;ve taken it out.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes; it seemed best, considering the danger
+that others might feel the same doubts which
+troubled you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I wouldn&#8217;t do that. The canoe was all
+right, once the direction were decided on.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Above all else, the true portrait should
+convey to the mind of the observer the impression
+that a single, an unmistakable purpose
+underlies the work. When one considers&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very true, Father, very true,&#8221; said Menard
+abruptly, looking about at the beginning of the
+twilight. &#8220;And now we had better get back.
+The supper will be ready.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard strode away toward the camp. Father
+Claude watched him for a time through the trees,
+then turned again to the picture. Finally he got
+together his materials, and carrying them in a
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_49' name='page_49'></a>49</span>
+fold of his gown, with the picture in his left
+hand, he followed Menard.</p>
+<p>The maid was leaning back against the tree,
+looking up at the sky, where the first red of the
+afterglow was spreading. She did not hear
+Menard; and he paused, a few yards away, to
+look at the clear whiteness of her skin and the
+full curve of her throat. Her figure and air,
+her habits of gesture and step, and carriage of
+the head, were those of the free-hearted maid
+of the seignory. They told of an outdoor life,
+of a good horse, and a light canoe, and the
+inbred love of trees and sky and running water.
+Here was none of the stiffness, the more than
+Parisian manner, of the maidens of Quebec.
+To stand there and look at her, unconscious as
+she was, pleased Menard.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle,&#8221; he said, coming nearer, &#8220;will
+you join us at supper?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid looked at him with a slow blush
+(she was not yet accustomed to the right of
+these men to enter into the routine of her life).
+Menard reached to help her, but she rose
+easily.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Lieutenant Danton is not here?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, M&#8217;sieu, he walked away.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They sat about a log. Danton had not
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_50' name='page_50'></a>50</span>
+strayed far, for he joined them shortly, wearing
+a sulky expression. Menard looked about the
+group. The maid was silent. Father Claude
+was beginning at once on the food before him.
+The twilight was growing deeper, and Guerin
+dragged a log to the fire, throwing it on the
+pile with a shower of sparks, and half a hundred
+shooting tongues of flame. The Captain looked
+again at Danton, and saw that the boy&#8217;s glance
+shifted uneasily about the group. Altogether
+it was an unfortunate start for his plan. But it
+was clear that no other would break the ice,
+so he drew a long breath, and plunged doggedly
+into the story of his first fight on the St.
+Lawrence.</p>
+<p>It was a brave story of ambuscade and battle;
+and it was full of the dark of night and the red
+flash of muskets and the stealth and treachery
+of the Iroquois soul. When he reached the
+tale of the captured Mohawk, who sat against a
+tree with a ball in his lungs, to the last refusing
+the sacrament, and dying like a chief with the
+death song on his lips, Danton was leaning
+forward, breathless and eager, hanging on his
+words. The maid&#8217;s eyes, too, were moist.
+Then they talked on, Danton asking boyish
+questions, and Father Claude starting over and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_51' name='page_51'></a>51</span>
+again on a narrative of the wonderful conversion
+of the Huron drunkard, Heroukiki, who,
+in his zeal,&ndash;&ndash;and here Menard always swept in
+with a new story, which left the priest adrift in
+the eddies of the conversation. At last, when
+they rose, and the dusk was settling over the
+trees, the maid was laughing with gentle good
+fellowship.</p>
+<p>While they were eating, the <i>voyageurs</i> had
+brought the canoe a short way up the bank,
+resting it, bottom up, on large stones brought
+from the shore. Underneath was a soft cot of
+balsam; over the canoe were blankets, hanging
+on both sides to the ground. Then Mademoiselle
+said good-night, with a moment&#8217;s lingering
+on the word, and a wistful note in her voice
+that brought perhaps more sympathy than had
+the sad eyes of the morning. For after all she
+was only a girl, and hers was a brave little
+heart.</p>
+<p>The three men lay on the slope with hardly
+a word, looking at the river, now shining like
+silver through the trees. This new turn in
+the life of the party was not as yet to be taken
+familiarly. Father Claude withdrew early to
+his meditations. Menard stretched out on his
+back, his hands behind his head, gazing lazily
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_52' name='page_52'></a>52</span>
+at the leaves overhead, now hanging motionless
+from the twigs.</p>
+<p>Danton was sitting up, looking about, and
+running the young reeds through his fingers.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Danton,&#8221; Menard said, after a long silence,
+&#8220;I suppose you know that we have something
+of a problem on our hands.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton looked over the river.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What have you thought about Mademoiselle?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t understand.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father Claude and I have been talking this
+evening about her. I have thought that she
+does not look any too strong for a hard journey
+of a hundred and more leagues.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;She has little colour,&#8221; said Danton, cautiously.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It seems to me, Danton, that you can help
+us.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What seems to you the cause of the
+trouble?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;With Mademoiselle? She takes little impression
+from the kindness of those about her.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, come, Danton. You know better.
+Even a boy of your age should see deeper than
+that. You think she slights you; very likely
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_53' name='page_53'></a>53</span>
+she does. What of that? You are not here
+to be drawn into a boy-and-girl quarrel with a
+maid who chances to share our canoe. You
+are here as my aid, to make the shortest time
+possible between Quebec and Frontenac. If
+she were to fall sick, we should be delayed.
+Therefore she must not fall sick.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton had plucked a weed, and now was
+pulling it to pieces, bit by bit.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What do you want me to do?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Stop this moping, this hanging about.
+Take hold of the matter. Devise talks, diversions;
+fill her idle moments; I care not what
+you do,&ndash;&ndash;within limits, my boy, within limits.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh,&#8221; said Danton, &#8220;then you really want
+me to?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Certainly. I am too old myself.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton rose, and walked a few steps away
+and back.</p>
+<p>&#8220;But she will have none of me, Menard. It
+is, &#8216;No, with thanks,&#8217; or, worse, a shake of the
+head. If I offer to help, if I try to talk, if I&ndash;&ndash;oh,
+it is always the same. I am tired of it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard smiled in the dark.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is that your reply to an order from your
+superior officer, Danton?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The boy stood silent for a moment, then he
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_54' name='page_54'></a>54</span>
+said, &#8220;I beg your pardon, Captain.&#8221; And with
+a curious effort at stiffness he wandered off
+among the trees, and was soon out of Menard&#8217;s
+sight.</p>
+<p>Menard walked slowly down to the fire,
+opened his pack, and spreading out his blanket,
+rolled himself in it with his feet close to the
+red embers. For a long time he lay awake.
+This episode took him back nearly a decade,
+to a time when he, like Danton, would have lost
+his poise at a glance from the nearest pair of
+eyes. That the maid should so interest him
+was in itself amusing. Had she been older
+or younger, had she been any but the timid,
+honest little woman that she was, he would
+have left her, without a second thought, in the
+care of the Commandant at Montreal, to be
+escorted through the rapids by some later party.
+But he had fixed his mind on getting her to
+Frontenac, and the question was settled. His
+last thought that night was of her quiet laughter
+and her friendly, hesitating &#8220;good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He was awakened in the half light before
+the sunrise by a step on the twigs. At a little
+distance through the trees was the maid, walking
+down toward the water. She slipped easily
+between the briers, holding her skirt close.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_55' name='page_55'></a>55</span>
+From a spring, not a hundred yards up the
+hillside, a brook came tumbling to the river,
+picking its way under and over the stones and
+the fallen trees, and trickling over the bank
+with a low murmur. The maid stopped by a
+pool, and kneeling on a flat rock, dipped her
+hands.</p>
+<p>The others were asleep. A rod away lay
+Danton, a sprawling heap in his blanket. Menard
+rose, tossed his blanket upon his bundle,
+and walked slowly down toward the maid.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle, you rise with the birds.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She looked around, and laughed gently. He
+saw that she had frankly accepted the first little
+change in their relations.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I like to be with the birds, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard had no small talk. He was thinking
+of her evident lack of sleep.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is the best hour for the river, Mademoiselle.&#8221;
+The colours of the dawn were beginning
+to creep up beyond the eastern bank, sending
+a lance of red and gold into a low cloud bank,
+and a spread of soft crimson close after. &#8220;Perhaps
+you are fond of the fish?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid was kneeling to pick a cluster of
+yellow flower cups. She looked up and nodded,
+with a smile.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_56' name='page_56'></a>56</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;We fished at home, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We will go,&#8221; said Menard, abruptly. &#8220;I
+will bring down the canoe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He threw the blankets to one side, and stooping
+under the long canoe, carried it on his
+shoulders to the water. A line and hook were
+in his bundle; the bait was ready at a turn of
+the grass and weeds.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We are two adventurers,&#8221; he said lightly, as
+he tossed the line into the canoe, and held out
+one of the paddles. &#8220;You should do your
+share of the morning&#8217;s work, Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She laughed again, and took the paddle.
+They pushed off; the maid kneeling at the
+bow, Menard in the stern. He guided the
+canoe against the current. The water lay flat
+under the still air, reflecting the gloomy trees
+on the banks, and the deepening colours of the
+sky. He fell into a lazy, swinging stroke,
+watching the maid. Her arms and shoulders
+moved easily, with the grace of one who had
+tumbled about a canoe from early childhood.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ready, Mademoiselle?&#8221; He was heading
+for a deep pool near a line of rushes. The
+maid, laying down her paddle, reached back
+for the line, and put on the bait with her own
+fingers.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_57' name='page_57'></a>57</span></p>
+<p>Menard held the canoe steady against the
+current, which was there but a slow movement,
+while she lowered the hook over the bow.
+They sat without a word for some minutes.
+Once he spoke, in a bantering voice, and she
+motioned to him to be quiet. Her brows were
+drawn down close together.</p>
+<p>It was but a short time before she felt a jerk
+at the line. Her arms straightened out, and she
+pressed her lips tightly together. &#8220;Quick!&#8221;
+she said. &#8220;Go ahead!&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Can you hold it?&#8221; he asked, as he dipped
+his paddle.</p>
+<p>She nodded. &#8220;I wish the line were longer.
+It will be hard to give him any room.&#8221; She
+wound the cord around her wrist. &#8220;Will the
+line hold, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think so. See if you can pull in.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She leaned back, and pulled steadily, then
+shook her head. &#8220;Not very much. Perhaps,
+if you can get into the shallow water&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard slowly worked the canoe through an
+opening in the rushes. There was a thrashing
+about and plunging not two rods away. Once
+the fish leaped clear of the water in a curve of
+clashing silver.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It&#8217;s a salmon,&#8221; he said. &#8220;A small one.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_58' name='page_58'></a>58</span></p>
+<p>The maid held hard, but the colour had gone
+from her face. The canoe drew nearer to the
+shore.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Hold fast,&#8221; said Menard. He gave a last
+sweep of the paddle, and crept forward to the
+bow. Kneeling behind the maid, he reached
+over her shoulder, and took the line below
+her hand.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Careful, M&#8217;sieu; it may break.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We must risk it.&#8221; He pulled slowly in
+until the fish was close under the gunwale.
+&#8220;Now can you hold?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221; She shook a straying lock of hair
+from her eyes, and took another turn of the
+cord around her wrist.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Steady,&#8221; he said. He drew his knife, leaned
+over the gunwale, and stabbed at the fighting
+fish until his blade sank in just below the gills,
+and he could lift it aboard.</p>
+<p>The maid laughed nervously, and rested her
+hands upon the two gunwales. Her breath
+was gone, and there was a red mark around
+her wrist where the cord had been. The canoe
+had drifted into the rushes, and Menard went
+back to his paddle, and worked out again into
+the channel.</p>
+<p>&#8220;And now, Mademoiselle,&#8221; he said, &#8220;we shall
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_59' name='page_59'></a>59</span>
+have a breakfast of our own. You need not
+paddle. I will take her down.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Her breath was coming back. She laughed,
+and sat comfortably in the bow, facing Menard,
+and letting her eyes follow the steady swing
+and catch of his paddle. When they reached
+the camp, the <i>voyageurs</i> were astir, but Danton
+and the priest still slept. The first red glare
+of the sun was levelled at them over the eastern
+trees.</p>
+<p>Menard made a fire under an arch of flat
+stones, and trimming a strip of oak wood with
+his hatchet, he laid the cleaned fish upon it and
+kept it on the fire until it was brown and crisp.
+The maid sat by, her eyes alert and her cheeks
+flushed.</p>
+<p>Danton was awake before the fish was
+cooked, and he stood about with a pretence
+of not observing them. The maid was fairly
+aroused. She drew him into the talk, and
+laughed and bantered with the two men as
+prettily as they could have wished from a
+Quebec belle.</p>
+<p>All during the morning Danton was silent.
+At noon, when the halt was made for the midday
+lunch, he was still puzzling over the
+apparent understanding between Mademoiselle
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_60' name='page_60'></a>60</span>
+and the Captain. Before the journey was taken
+up, he stood for a moment near Menard, on the
+river bank.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Captain,&#8221; he said, &#8220;you asked me last night
+to&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It may be that I have misunderstood you.
+Of course, if Mademoiselle&ndash;&ndash;if you&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; He
+caught himself.</p>
+<p>Menard smiled; then he read the earnestness
+beneath the boy&#8217;s confusion, and sobered.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle and I went fishing, Danton.
+Result,&ndash;&ndash;Mademoiselle eats her first meal. If
+you can do as much you shall have my thanks.
+And now remember that you are a lieutenant
+in the King&#8217;s service.&#8221;</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_61' name='page_61'></a>61</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_IV_THE_LONG_ARROW' id='CHAPTER_IV_THE_LONG_ARROW'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER IV.</h2>
+<h3>THE LONG ARROW.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>Menard allowed a halt of but a few hours
+at Three Rivers. The settlement held little
+of interest, for all the resident troops and most
+of the farmers and <i>engag&eacute;s</i> had gone up the
+river to join the army which was assembling at
+Montreal. The close of the first week out of
+Quebec saw the party well on the second half
+of the journey to Montreal. As they went on,
+Menard&#8217;s thoughts were drawn more deeply
+into the work that lay ahead, and in spite of his
+efforts at lightness, the work of keeping up the
+maid&#8217;s spirits fell mostly to Danton (though
+Father Claude did what he could). As matters
+gradually became adjusted, Danton&#8217;s cheery,
+hearty manner began to tell; and now that
+there was little choice of company, the maid
+turned to him for her diversion.</p>
+<p>On the morning of the second day after
+leaving Three Rivers, the two <i>voyageurs</i> were
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_62' name='page_62'></a>62</span>
+carrying the canoe to the water when Guerin
+slipped on a wet log, throwing the canoe to the
+ground, and tearing a wide rent in the bark.
+Menard was impatient at this carelessness.
+The knowledge that the Three Rivers detachment
+had already gone on to Montreal had
+decided him to move more rapidly, and he had
+given orders that they should start each day in
+the first light of the dawn. This was a chill
+morning. A low, heavy fog lay on the river,
+thinning, at a yard above the water, into a light
+mist which veiled what colour may have been
+in the east.</p>
+<p>While Guerin and Perrot were patching the
+canoe under Menard&#8217;s eye, Danton found some
+dry logs under the brush, and built up the dying
+fire, which was in a rocky hollow, not visible
+from the river. Then he and the maid sat on
+the rocks above it, where they could get the
+warmth, and yet could see the river. Menard
+and his men, though only a few rods away,
+were but blurred forms as they moved about
+the canoe, gumming the new seams.</p>
+<p>The maid, save for an occasional heavy hour
+in the late evenings, had settled into a cheerful
+frame of mind. The novelty, and the many
+exciting moments of the journey, as well as the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_63' name='page_63'></a>63</span>
+kindness of the three men, kept her thoughts
+occupied. Danton, once he had shaken off his
+sulky fits, was good company. They sat side
+by side on the rock, looking down at the struggling
+fire, or at the figures moving about the
+canoe, or out into the white mystery of the
+river, talking easily in low tones of themselves
+and their lives and hopes.</p>
+<p>The mist, instead of rising, seemed to settle
+closer to the water, as the broad daylight came
+across the upper air. The maid and Danton
+fell into silence as the picture brightened. Danton
+was less sensitive than she to the whims of
+nature, and tiring of the scene, he was gazing
+down into the fire when the maid, without a
+word, touched his arm. He looked up at her;
+then, seeing that her eyes were fixed on the
+river, followed her gaze. Not more than a
+score of yards from the shore, moving silently
+through the mist, were the heads of three Indians.
+Their profiles stood out clearly against
+the white background; their shoulders seemed
+to dissolve into the fog. They passed slowly
+on up the stream, looking straight ahead, without
+a twitch of the eyelids, like a vision from
+the happy hunting-ground.</p>
+<p>Danton slipped down from the rock, and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_64' name='page_64'></a>64</span>
+stepped lightly to Menard, pointing out the
+three heads just as they were fading into the
+whiteness about them. Menard motioned to
+Guerin and Perrot to get the newly patched
+canoe into the water, took three muskets, and
+in a moment pushed off, leaving Danton with
+the maid and the priest, who had retired a short
+distance for his morning prayers. For a minute
+the heads of the three white men were in sight
+above the fog, then they too were swallowed up.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I wonder what Menard thinks about them?&#8221;
+said Danton, going back toward the maid.</p>
+<p>She was still looking at the mist, and did not
+hear him, so he took a seat at the foot of the
+rock and rubbed the hammer of his musket,
+which had been rusted by the damp. After a
+time the maid looked toward him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What does it mean?&#8221; she asked.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t know,&#8221; Danton replied. &#8220;They
+were going up-stream in a canoe, I suppose.
+Probably he thinks they can give us some
+information.&#8221;</p>
+<p>In a few minutes, during which the mist was
+clearing under the rays of the sun, the two
+canoes together came around a wooded point
+and beached. The Indians walked silently to
+the fire. They appeared not to see Danton and
+the maid. Menard paused to look over his
+canoe. It was leaking badly, and before joining
+the group at the fire, he set the canoemen
+at work making a new patch.</p>
+<div class='figcenter'>
+<a name='linki_3' id='linki_3'></a>
+<img src='images/illus-064.jpg' alt='' title='' style='width: 370px; height: 548px;' /><br />
+<p class='caption' style='margin: 0 auto; text-align:center; width: 370px;'>
+&#8220;The Indians walked silently to the fire.&#8221;<br />
+</p>
+</div>
+<div><span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_65' name='page_65'></a>65</span></div>
+<p>&#8220;Danton,&#8221; he said, in a low tone, when he
+reached the fire, &#8220;find the Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton hurried away, and Menard turned to
+the largest of the three Indians, who wore the
+brightest blanket, and had a peculiar wampum
+collar, decorated in mosaic-like beadwork.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are travellers, like ourselves,&#8221; he said,
+in the Iroquois tongue. &#8220;We cannot let you
+pass without a word of greeting. I see that
+you are of the Onondagas, my brothers. It
+may be that you are from the Mission at the
+Sault St. Francis Xavier?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian bowed. &#8220;We go from Three
+Rivers to Montreal.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I, too, am taking my party to Montreal.&#8221;
+Menard thought it wise to withhold the further
+facts of his journey. &#8220;Have you brothers at
+Three Rivers?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; replied the Indian. &#8220;We have been
+sent with a paper from the Superior at Sault
+St. Francis Xavier to the good fathers at Three
+Rivers. Now we are on our return to the
+Mission.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_66' name='page_66'></a>66</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Have my brothers eaten?&#8221; Menard motioned
+toward the fire. &#8220;It is still early in the
+day.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The three bowed. &#8220;We are travelling fast,&#8221;
+said the spokesman, &#8220;for the Superior awaits
+our return. We ate before the light. It will
+soon be time for us to go on our journey.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard saw Father Claude and Danton approaching,
+and waited for them. The face of
+the large Indian seemed like some other face
+that had had a place in his memory. It was not
+unlikely that he had known this warrior during
+his captivity, when half a thousand braves
+had been to him as brothers. The Indian was
+apparently of middle age, and had lines of dignity
+and authority in his face that made it hard
+to accept him as a subdued resident at the Mission.
+But Menard knew that no sign of doubt
+or suspicion must appear in his face, so he
+waited for the priest. The Indians sat with
+their knees drawn up and their blankets
+wrapped about them, looking stolidly at the
+fire.</p>
+<p>Father Claude came quietly into the group,
+and with a smile extended his hand to the
+smallest of the three, an older man, with a
+wrinkled face. &#8220;I did not look for you here,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_67' name='page_67'></a>67</span>
+Teganouan. Have you gone back to the
+Mission?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Teganouan returned the smile, and bowed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brother has told the white man of our
+errand?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; said Menard, &#8220;they have been sent
+to Three Rivers by the Superior, and are now
+returning. I have told them that we, too, are
+going to Montreal.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest took the hint. &#8220;We shall meet
+you and your brothers again, Teganouan.
+They are newcomers at the Mission, I believe.
+They had not come when I left.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, Father. They have but last week become
+Christians. The Long Arrow&#8221; (inclining his
+head toward the large Indian) &#8220;has lost a son, and
+through his suffering was led to take the faith.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Long Arrow, who had seemed to lose
+interest in the conversation as soon as he had
+finished speaking, here rose.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brothers and the good Father will give
+us their blessing? The end of the journey is
+yet three days away. I had hoped that we
+might be permitted to accept the protection of
+the son of Onontio,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;he looked at Menard,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;but
+I see that his canoe will not be ready
+for the journey before the sun is high.&#8221; He
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_68' name='page_68'></a>68</span>
+looked gravely from Menard to the priest, then
+walked to the shore, followed by the others.
+They pushed off, and shortly disappeared
+around the point of land.</p>
+<p>Menard gave them no attention, but as soon as
+they were gone from sight, he turned to the priest.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, Father, what do you make of that?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude shook his head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Nothing, as yet, M&#8217;sieu. Do you know
+who the large man is?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No; but I seem to remember him. And
+what is more to the point, he certainly remembers
+me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Are you sure?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He recognized me on the river. He came
+back with me so willingly because he wanted
+to know more about us. That was plain.
+It would be well, Father, to enquire at the
+Mission. We should know more of them
+and their errand at Three Rivers.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard called Danton, and walked with him
+a little way into the wood.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Danton,&#8221; he said, &#8220;you are going through
+this journey with us, and I intend that you
+shall know about such matters as this meeting
+with the Onondagas.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, they were Onondagas?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_69' name='page_69'></a>69</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. They claim to be Mission Indians,
+but neither the Father nor I altogether believe
+them.&#8221; In a few sentences Menard outlined the
+conversation. &#8220;Now, Danton, this may or may
+not be an important incident. I want you to
+know the necessity for keeping our own counsel
+in all such matters, dropping no careless words,
+and letting no emotions show. I wish you
+would make a point of learning the Iroquois
+language. Father Claude will help you. You
+are to act as my right-hand man, and you may
+as well begin now to learn to draw your own
+conclusions from an Indian&#8217;s words.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton took eagerly to the lessons with
+Father Claude, for they seemed another definite
+step toward the excitement that surely, to
+his mind, lay in wait ahead. The studying
+began on that afternoon, while they were toiling
+up against the stream.</p>
+<p>In the evening, when the dusk was coming
+down, and the little camp was ready for the
+night, Menard came up from the heap of stores,
+where the <i>voyageurs</i> had already stretched out,
+and found the maid sitting alone by the fire.
+Danton, in his rush of interest in the new study,
+had drawn Father Claude aside for another
+lesson.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_70' name='page_70'></a>70</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle is lonely?&#8221; asked Menard,
+sitting beside her.</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, no, M&#8217;sieu. I have too many thoughts
+for that.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What interesting thoughts they must be.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They are, M&#8217;sieu. They are all about the
+Indians this morning. Tell me, M&#8217;sieu,&ndash;&ndash;they
+called you Onontio. What does it
+mean?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They called me the son of Onontio, because
+of my uniform. Onontio, the Great Mountain,
+is their name for the Governor; and the Governor&#8217;s
+soldiers are to them his sons.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They speak a strange language. It is not
+the same as that of the Ottawas, who once
+worked for my father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Did you know their tongue?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;A few words, and some of the signs. This,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;raising
+her hand, with the first finger extended,
+and slowly moving her arm in a half
+circle from horizon to horizon,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;this meant a
+sun,&ndash;&ndash;one day.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard looked at her for a moment in silence.
+He enjoyed her enthusiasm.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why don&#8217;t you learn Iroquois? You would
+enjoy it. It is a beautiful tongue,&ndash;&ndash;the language
+of metaphor and poetry.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_71' name='page_71'></a>71</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;I should like to,&#8221; she replied, looking with
+a faint smile at Danton and the priest, who
+were sitting under a beech tree, mumbling in
+low tones.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You shall join the class, Mademoiselle.
+You shall begin to-morrow. It was thoughtless
+of Danton to take the Father&#8217;s instruction
+to himself alone.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And then, M&#8217;sieu, I will know what the
+Indians say when they sit up stiffly in their
+blankets, and talk down in their throats. They
+have such dignity. It is hard not to believe
+them when they look straight at one.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Don&#8217;t you believe them?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The three this morning,&ndash;&ndash;they did not
+tell the truth.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Didn&#8217;t they?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why, I understood that you did not believe
+them.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And where did Mademoiselle learn that?
+Did she follow the conversation?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No; but Lieutenant Danton&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He told you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>She nodded. Menard frowned.</p>
+<p>&#8220;He shouldn&#8217;t have done that.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid looked surprised at his remark,
+and the smile left her face. &#8220;Of course,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_72' name='page_72'></a>72</span>
+M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; she said, a little stiffly, &#8220;whatever is
+not meant for my ears&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard was still frowning, and he failed to
+notice her change in manner. He abruptly
+gave the conversation a new turn, but seeing
+after a short time that the maid had lost interest
+in his sallies, he rose, and called to the
+priest.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father, you are to have a new pupil.
+Mademoiselle also will study the language of
+the Iroquois. If you are quick enough with
+your pupils, we shall soon be able to hold a conversation
+each night about the fire. Perhaps,
+if you would forego your exclusive air, Mademoiselle
+would begin at once.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton, without waiting for the priest to
+start, came hurriedly over and sat by the maid.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You must pardon me,&#8221; he said, &#8220;I did not
+think,&ndash;&ndash;I did not know that you would be
+interested. It is so dry.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid smiled at the fire.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You did not ask,&#8221; she replied, &#8220;and I could
+not offer myself to the class.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It will be splendid,&#8221; said Danton. &#8220;We
+shall learn the language of the trees and the
+grass and the rivers and the birds. And the
+message of the wampum belt, too, we shall
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_73' name='page_73'></a>73</span>
+know. You see,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;looking up at Menard,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;already
+I am catching the meanings.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard smiled, and then went down the
+bank, leaving the three to bend their heads
+together over the mysteries of the Iroquois
+rules of gender, written out by Father Claude
+on a strip of bark. It was nearly an hour later,
+after the maid had crept to her couch beneath
+the canoe, and Perrot and Guerin had sprawled
+upon the bales and were snoring in rival keys,
+that Danton came lightly down the slope humming
+a drinking song. He saw Menard, and
+dropped to the ground beside him, with a low
+laugh.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle will lead my wits a chase,
+Menard. Already she is deep in the spirit of
+the new work.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Be careful, my boy, that she leads no more
+than your wits a chase.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton laughed again.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t believe there is great danger. What
+a voice she has! I did not know it at first,
+when she was frightened and spoke only in the
+lower tones. Now when she speaks or laughs
+it is like&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Like what?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There is no fit simile in our tongue, light
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_74' name='page_74'></a>74</span>
+as it is. It may be that in the Iroquois I shall
+find the words. It should be something about
+the singing brooks or the voice of the leaves at
+night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The lad was in such buoyant spirits that
+Menard had to harden himself for the rebuke
+which he must give. With the Indian tribes
+Menard had the tact, the control of a situation,
+that would have graced a council of great
+chiefs; but in matters of discipline, the blunter
+faculties and language of the white men seemed
+to give his wit no play. Now, as nearly always,
+he spoke abruptly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Have you forgotten our talk of this morning,
+Danton?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; replied the boy, looking up in surprise.</p>
+<p>The night had none of the dampness that
+had left a white veil over the morning just
+gone. The moon was half hidden behind the
+western trees. The sky, for all the dark, was
+blue and deep, set with thousands of stars,
+each looking down at its mate in the shining
+water.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I spoke of the importance of keeping our
+own counsel.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton began to feel what was coming. He
+looked down at the ground without replying.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_75' name='page_75'></a>75</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;To-night Mademoiselle has repeated a part
+of our conversation.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle,&ndash;&ndash;why, she is one of our
+party. She knows about us,&ndash;&ndash;who we are,
+what we are going for&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Then you have told her, Danton?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How could she help knowing? We are
+taking her to Frontenac.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father Claude has not told her why we go
+to Frontenac&ndash;&ndash;nor have I.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But Major Provost is her friend&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He would never have told her.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But she seemed to know about it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Then you have talked it over with her?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why, no,&ndash;&ndash;that is, in speaking of our
+journey we said something of the meaning of
+the expedition. It could hardly be expected
+that we,&ndash;&ndash;I fail to see, Captain, what it is you
+are accusing me of.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You have not been accused yet, Danton.
+Let me ask you a question. Why did you
+enter the King&#8217;s army?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton hesitated, and started once or twice
+to frame answer, but made no reply.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Did you wish a gay uniform, to please the
+maids, to&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are unfair, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_76' name='page_76'></a>76</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;No, I wish to know. We will say, if you
+like, that you have hoped to be a soldier,&ndash;&ndash;a
+soldier of whom the King may one day have
+cause to be proud.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton flushed, and bowed his head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I offered you the chance to go on this
+mission, Danton, because I believed in you.
+I believed that you had the making of a soldier.
+This is not a child&#8217;s errand, this of ours. It is
+the work of strong men. This morning I told
+you of my talk with the three Onondagas
+because I have planned to take you into my
+confidence, and to give you the chance to make
+a name for yourself. I made a point of the
+importance of keeping such things to yourself.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But Mademoiselle, M&#8217;sieu, she is different&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Look at the facts, Danton. I told you this
+morning: within twelve hours you have passed
+on your information. How do I know that you
+would not have let it slip to others if you had
+had the chance? You forget that Mademoiselle
+is a woman, and the first and last duty of a
+soldier is to tell no secrets to a woman.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You speak wrongly of Mademoiselle. It is
+cowardly to talk thus.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard paused to get control of his temper.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_77' name='page_77'></a>77</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Cowardly, Danton? Is that the word you
+apply to your commander?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Your pardon, M&#8217;sieu! A thousand pardons!
+It escaped me&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We will pass it by. I want you to understand
+this matter. Mademoiselle will spend a
+night in Montreal. We shall leave her with
+other women. A stray word, which to her
+might mean nothing, might be enough to give
+the wrong persons a hint of the meaning of our
+journey. A moment&#8217;s nervousness might slip
+the bridle from her tongue. All New France
+is not so loyal that we can afford to drop a
+chance secret here and there. As to this maid,
+she is only a child, and by giving her our
+secrets, you are forcing her to bear a burden
+which we should bear alone. These Indians
+this morning were spies, I am inclined to
+believe, scouting along the river for information
+of the coming campaign. The only way
+that we can feel secure is by letting no word
+escape our lips, no matter how trivial. I tell
+you this, not so much for this occasion as for a
+suggestion for the future.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well, M&#8217;sieu. You will please accept
+my complete apologies.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I shall have to add, Danton, that if any
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_78' name='page_78'></a>78</span>
+further mistake of this kind occurs I shall be
+forced to dismiss you from my service. Now
+that I have said this, I want you to understand
+that I don&#8217;t expect it to happen. I have believed
+in you, Danton, and I stand ready to be
+a friend to you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard held out his hand. Danton clasped
+it nervously, mumbling a second apology. For
+a few moments longer they sat there, Menard
+trying to set Danton at ease, but the boy was
+flushed, and he spoke only half coherently.
+He soon excused himself and wandered off
+among the trees and the thick bushes.</p>
+<p>During the next day Danton was in one of
+his sullen moods. He worked feverishly, and,
+with the maid, kept Father Claude occupied
+for the greater part of the time, as they paddled
+on, with conversation, and with discussion of
+the Iroquois words. The maid felt the change
+from the easy relations in the party, and
+seemed a little depressed, but she threw herself
+into the studying. Often during the day
+she would take up a paddle, and join in the
+stroke. At first Menard protested, but she
+laughed, and said that it was a &#8220;rest&#8221; after
+sitting so long.</p>
+<p>They were delayed on the following day by
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_79' name='page_79'></a>79</span>
+a second accident to the canoe, so that they
+were a full day late in reaching Montreal.
+They moved slowly up the channel, past the
+islands and the green banks with their little log-houses
+or, occasionally, larger dwellings built
+after the French manner. St. Helen&#8217;s Island,
+nearly opposite the city, had a straggling cluster
+of hastily built bark houses, and a larger group
+of tents where the regulars were encamped,
+awaiting the arrival of Governor Denonville
+with the troops from Quebec.</p>
+<p>Menard stopped at the island, guiding the
+canoe to the bank where a long row of canoes
+and bateaux lay close to the water.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You might get out and walk around,&#8221; he
+said to the others. &#8220;I shall be gone only a few
+moments.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude sat on the bank, lost in meditation.
+Danton and the maid walked together
+slowly up and down, beyond earshot from the
+priest. Since Menard&#8217;s rebuke, both the lad
+and the maid had shown a slight trace of resentment.
+It did not come out in their conversation,
+but rather in their silences, and in the
+occasions which they took to sit and walk apart
+from the others. It was as if a certain common
+ground of interest had come to them. The
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_80' name='page_80'></a>80</span>
+maid, for all her shyness and even temper, was
+not accustomed to such cool authority as Menard
+was developing. The priest was keeping
+an eye on the fast-growing acquaintanceship,
+and already had it vaguely in mind to call it
+to the attention of Menard, who was getting
+too deeply into the spirit and the details of his
+work to give much heed.</p>
+<p>Menard was soon back.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Push off,&#8221; he said. &#8220;The Major is not
+here. We shall have to look for him in the
+city.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They headed across the stream. The city
+lay before them, on its gentle slope, with the
+mountain rising behind like an untiring sentry.
+It was early in the afternoon, and on the river
+were many canoes and small boats, filled with
+soldiers, friendly Indians, or <i>voyageurs</i>, moving
+back and forth between the island and the city.
+They passed close to many of the bateaux,
+heaped high with provision and ammunition
+bales, and more than once the lounging soldiers
+rose and saluted Menard.</p>
+<p>At the city wharf he turned to Danton.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We shall have to get a larger canoe, Danton,
+and a stronger. Will you see to it, please?
+We shall have two more in our party from now
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_81' name='page_81'></a>81</span>
+on. Make sure that the canoe is in the best of
+condition. Also I wish you would see to getting
+the rope and the other things we may need
+in working through the rapids. Then spend
+your time as you like. We shall start early in
+the morning.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard and Father Claude together went
+with the maid to the Superior, who arranged
+for her to pass the night with the sisters.
+Then Menard left the priest to make his final
+arrangements at the Mission, and went himself
+to see the Commandant, to whom he outlined
+the bare facts of his journey to Frontenac.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The thing that most concerns you,&#8221; he said
+finally, &#8220;is a meeting I had a few days ago with
+three Indians down the river. One called himself
+the Long Arrow, and another was Teganouan,
+who, Father de Casson tells me, recently
+left the Mission at the Sault St. Francis Xavier.
+They claim to be Mission Indians. It will be
+well to watch out for them, and to have an eye
+on the Richelieu, and the other routes, to make
+sure that they don&#8217;t slip away to the south with
+information.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well,&#8221; replied the Commandant. &#8220;I imagine
+that we can stop them. Do you feel safe
+about taking this maid up the river just now?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_82' name='page_82'></a>82</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, yes. Our men are scattered along the
+route, are they not?&#8221; Menard asked.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Quite a number are out establishing Champigny&#8217;s
+transport system.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t look for any trouble. But I should
+like authority for one or two extra men.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Take anything you wish, Menard. I will
+get word over to the island at once, giving you
+all the authority you need.&#8221;</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_83' name='page_83'></a>83</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_V_DANTON_BREAKS_OUT' id='CHAPTER_V_DANTON_BREAKS_OUT'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER V.</h2>
+<h3>DANTON BREAKS OUT.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>When Menard reached the wharf, early on
+the following morning, he found Father
+Claude waiting for him. The new canoe lay
+on the wharf, and beside it was a heap of stores.
+Perrot and the two new <i>engag&eacute;s</i> sat on the
+edge of the wharf. The sun had just risen
+over the trees on St. Helen&#8217;s Island, and the
+air was clear and cool.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, Perrot,&#8221; said Menard, as he unslung
+his musket and horn, &#8220;is everything ready?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Everything, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Where is Guerin?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have not seen him, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard turned to the priest.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-morning, Father. You are on time,
+I see; and that is more than we can say for
+Danton. Where is the boy?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He has gone for Mademoiselle St. Denis,
+Captain. He was here before the sunrise,
+checking up the stores.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_84' name='page_84'></a>84</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Learning to work, is he? That is a good
+sign. And how about yourself? Did you
+pick up anything yesterday?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; replied the priest. &#8220;I enquired at the
+Mission about Teganouan and his companions.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Nothing is known of them. Teganouan
+had been one of the worst drunkards among
+the Onondagas, and his conversion, a year ago,
+was thought to be one of our greatest victories
+for the faith. His penances were among the
+most complete and purging ever&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And the others?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Just before I left the Mission for Quebec,
+Teganouan went on an errand to the city and
+fell among some of our fellow-countrymen who
+were having a drinking bout. For a few days
+after that he wavered, and fell again. Once
+afterward he was seen in company with two
+low fellows, <i>coureurs de bois</i>, who have since
+been confined under suspicion of communicating
+with the enemy.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He has returned to the Mission, then?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, he disappeared some time ago. They
+do not know the Long Arrow. I described
+him to Brother de Lamberville&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, he is here now?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_85' name='page_85'></a>85</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. It seems, further, that all the other
+workers among the Iroquois have had word and
+are returning. That much of my labour is removed.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How do they get this word?&#8221; said Menard,
+impatiently. &#8220;That is the old question. It is
+enough to make one wonder if there are any
+secrets kept from the enemy&#8217;s country.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No one seems to know, M&#8217;sieu. The
+Superior told me last night that they had not
+been sent for, so it would seem that the
+information must have reached them through
+the Indians.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The folly of these new governors!&#8221; Menard
+strode back and forth. &#8220;Oh, it makes
+one sigh for old Frontenac. He never walked
+blindfolded into such a trap as this. But go
+on. You were speaking of Father de Lamberville.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It was only that I described the Long
+Arrow to Brother de Lamberville. He seemed
+to remember such a wampum collar as the Long
+Arrow wore. He could not recall exactly.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Then we may as well forget the incident.
+It seems that we are to know nothing of it.
+Here is Danton.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The lieutenant and the maid were walking
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_86' name='page_86'></a>86</span>
+rapidly down to the wharf. Mademoiselle was
+in a gay mood after her few hours of enjoyment
+among the comforts of a city.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-morning,&#8221; she called, waving her hand.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-morning,&#8221; said Menard, shortly. He
+did not look a second time, to see her smile
+fade, for Guerin had not appeared, and he was
+rapidly losing patience. He walked up and
+down the wharf for a few moments, while
+Danton found a seat for the maid and the
+two talked together.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Perrot,&#8221; he said, &#8220;do you know where
+Guerin was last evening?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, M&#8217;sieu. He was at the inn.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What was he doing? Drinking?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;A little, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Go up there, on the run. If you don&#8217;t find
+him there, come right back, for we can&#8217;t wait
+much longer for anyone.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Perrot ran up the street and disappeared.
+In a few moments he came in sight, striding
+down between the row of houses, holding
+Guerin firmly by one arm. The young fellow
+was hanging back, and stumbling in limp fashion.
+He was evidently drunk. Danton, who
+had joined Menard when the two men appeared,
+said, &#8220;Heavens, he must have started early!&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_87' name='page_87'></a>87</span></p>
+<p>Some distance behind Perrot and Guerin
+came a ragged crowd of woodsmen, singing,
+jeering, and shouting, and bearing broad traces
+of a sleepless night.</p>
+<p>Menard stood waiting with a look of disgust.
+When they came upon the wharf Guerin
+laughed, and tried to get out a flippant apology
+for his tardiness; but Menard seized him
+before the words were off his lips, and dragging
+him across the wharf threw him into the
+water. Then he turned to Perrot, and said,
+&#8220;Pull him out.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The two new men stood uneasily near, with
+startled faces. Behind them the maid was sitting,
+a frightened look in her eyes. Danton
+had risen.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Clear away from here!&#8221; Menard called to
+the drunken rabble, who had collected a few
+rods away, and were now hesitating between
+laughter and fright. They stood looking at
+each other and at Menard, then they slunk
+away.</p>
+<p>In all an hour had gone before they were
+ready to start. Guerin was weak and shivering
+from his plunge, but Menard ordered him
+into the canoe. The incident drew a cloud
+over the maid&#8217;s spirits, and altogether depressed
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_88' name='page_88'></a>88</span>
+the party, so that not until afternoon did they
+get into conversation. By that time they were
+past the Lachine Rapids and the Sault St.
+Louis, where the men made a portage, and
+Danton led the maid along the bank through
+the tangled brush and briers. When at last
+they were ready to push on across Lake St.
+Louis the maid&#8217;s skirt was torn in a dozen places,
+and a thorn had got into her hand, which Danton
+carefully removed with the point of his knife,
+wincing and flushing with her at each twinge of
+pain. During the rest of the day, they had an
+Iroquois lesson, and by the end of the afternoon
+when the sun was low, and Menard headed for
+the shore of Isle Perrot, the maid was bright
+again, laughing over Danton&#8217;s blunders in the
+new language.</p>
+<p>They spent the next day on the island, for
+what with wind and rain the lake was impassable
+for their canoe. The men built a hut of
+brush and bark which sheltered the party from
+the driving rain. Menard&#8217;s mood lightened at
+the prospect of a rest, and he started a long
+conversation in Iroquois which soon had even
+Father Claude laughing in his silent way.
+The rain lessened in the afternoon, but the
+wind was still running high. Menard and the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_89' name='page_89'></a>89</span>
+<i>engag&eacute;s</i> went out early in the afternoon and
+repacked all the supplies, in order that the
+weight might be distributed more evenly in
+the canoe. With this and other work he was
+occupied until late in the afternoon. Father
+Claude took the occasion for a solitary walk,
+and for meditation. When Menard entered
+the hut he found the maid sitting with her head
+resting against one of the supporting trees.
+She wore a disturbed, unsettled expression.
+Danton evidently had been sitting or standing
+near her, for when Menard entered, stooping,
+he was moving across the hut in a hesitating,
+conscious manner. The Captain looked at
+them curiously.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I&#8217;m afraid we&#8217;ll have to take away a part of
+your house to pay for your supper,&#8221; he said.
+&#8220;Everything is wet outside that might do for
+firewood. Lend a hand, Danton.&#8221; He gathered
+logs and sticks from the floor and walls,
+and carried them out. Danton, after a quick
+look toward the maid (which, of course, Menard
+saw), did the same.</p>
+<p>The Captain was the first to reenter the hut.
+The maid had not moved, and her eyes were
+puzzled and wearied, but she tried to smile.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Has it stopped raining?&#8221; she asked.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_90' name='page_90'></a>90</span></p>
+<p>Menard gave her an amused glance, and
+pointed to a sparkling beam of sunlight that
+came slanting in through an opening in the
+wall, and buried itself in a little pool of light on
+the trampled ground. She looked at it, flushed,
+and turned her eyes away. He stood for a moment,
+half minded to ask the question that was
+on his tongue, but finally held it back. In a
+moment Danton came back, looking suspiciously
+at each of them as he stooped to gather
+another armful of wood.</p>
+<p>Menard was thoughtful during the evening
+meal. Afterward he slipped his arm through
+Father Claude&#8217;s, and led him for a short walk,
+giving him an account of the incident. &#8220;I
+didn&#8217;t say anything at the time,&#8221; he concluded,
+&#8220;partly because I thought I might be mistaken,
+and partly because it would have been the
+worst thing I could do. I begin to see&ndash;&ndash;I
+should have foreseen it before I spoke to him
+about the girl&ndash;&ndash;that we have trouble ahead,
+Father, with these precious children. I confess
+I don&#8217;t know just what to do about it. We
+must think it over. Anyway, you had better
+talk to her. She would tell you what she
+wouldn&#8217;t tell me. If he&#8217;s annoying her, we
+must know it.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_91' name='page_91'></a>91</span></p>
+<p>Father Claude was troubled.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The maid is in our care,&#8221; he said, &#8220;and
+also in that of Lieutenant Danton. It would
+seem that he&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There&#8217;s no use in expecting him to take
+any responsibility, Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, I suppose you are right. He is a
+child.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will you go to the maid, Father, and get
+straight at the truth? You see that I cannot
+meddle with her thoughts without danger of
+being misinterpreted. It is you who must be
+her adviser.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest acquiesced, and they returned to
+the camp, to find the maid still sitting alone,
+with a troubled face, and Danton puttering
+about the fire with a show of keeping himself
+occupied. They ate in silence, in spite of
+Menard&#8217;s efforts to arouse them. After the
+meal they hung about, each hesitating to wander
+away, and yet seeing no pleasure in gathering
+about the fire. Menard saw that Father
+Claude had it in mind to speak to the maid, so
+he got Danton away on a pretext of looking
+over the stores. But he said nothing of the
+episode that was in all their minds, preferring
+to await the priest&#8217;s report.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_92' name='page_92'></a>92</span></p>
+<p>After the maid had gone to her couch beneath
+the canoe, and Danton had wandered
+into the wilderness that was all about them,
+Father Claude joined Menard at the fire.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, Father, what word?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Softly, M&#8217;sieu. It is not likely that she
+sleeps as yet.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have talked long with her, but she is of a
+stubborn mind.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How is that?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;She was angry at first. She spoke hastily,
+and asked me in short terms to leave her in
+solitude. And then, after a time, when she
+began to see that it was her welfare and our
+duty which I had in mind, and not an idle curiosity,
+she was moved.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Did she speak then?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, M&#8217;sieu, she wept, and insisted that
+there was no trouble on her mind,&ndash;&ndash;it was
+merely the thought of her home and her father
+that had cast her down.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And so she has pride,&#8221; mused Menard.
+&#8220;Could you gather any new opinions, Father?
+Do you think that they may already have come
+to some understanding?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I hardly think so, M&#8217;sieu. But may I
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_93' name='page_93'></a>93</span>
+suggest that it would be well to be firm with
+Lieutenant Danton? He is young, and the
+maid is in our trust,&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;True, Father. I will account for him.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There seemed to be nothing further to do at
+the moment, so the priest went to his blanket,
+and Menard drew a bundle under his head and
+went to sleep, after a glance about the camp to
+see that the sentry was on watch. Now that
+Montreal lay behind, and the unsettled forest
+before, with only a thin line of Frenchmen
+stretched along the river between them and
+Fort Frontenac, he had divided the night into
+watches, and each of the four <i>engag&eacute;s</i> stood his
+turn.</p>
+<p>The following day was all but half gone
+before the wind had dropped to a rate that
+made the passage of the lake advisable.
+Menard ordered the noon meal for an hour
+earlier than usual, and shortly afterward they
+set out across the upper end of Lake St. Louis
+to the foot of the cascades. Before the last
+bundle had been carried up the portage to
+Buisson Pointe, the dusk was settling over the
+woods across the river, and over the rising ground
+on Isle Perrot at the mouth of the Ottawa.</p>
+<p>During the next day they passed on up the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_94' name='page_94'></a>94</span>
+stream to the Coteau des Cedres. Menard and
+Father Claude were both accustomed to take
+the rapid without carrying, or even unloading,
+but Danton looked at the swirling water with
+doubt in his eyes. When the maid, leaning
+back in the canoe while the men halted at the
+bank to make fast for the passage, saw the
+torrent that tumbled and pitched merrily down
+toward them, she laughed. To hold a sober
+mood for long was not in her buoyant nature,
+and she welcomed a dash of excitement as a
+relief from the strained relations of the two
+days just gone.</p>
+<p>&#8220;M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; she called to Menard, with a
+sparkle in her eyes. &#8220;Oh, M&#8217;sieu, may I stay
+in the canoe?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton turned quickly at the sound of her
+voice, and a look, half of pain, half of surprise,
+came over his face as he saw her eagerness.
+Menard looked at her in doubt.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It may be a wet passage, Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And why not, M&#8217;sieu? Have I not been
+wet before? See, I will protect myself.&#8221; She
+drew the bundles closely about her feet, and
+threw a blanket across her knees. &#8220;Now I
+can brave the stream, Captain. Or,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;her
+gay tone dropped, and she looked demurely at
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_95' name='page_95'></a>95</span>
+him,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;perhaps it is that I am too heavy, that
+I should carry myself up the bank. I will obey
+my orders, Captain.&#8221; But as she spoke she
+tucked the blanket closer about her, and stole
+another glance at Menard.</p>
+<p>He smiled. He was thinking of Madame
+Gordeau and her fragile daughter, who had
+shuddered with fear at a mere glimpse of the
+first rapid. &#8220;Very well,&#8221; he said, &#8220;Mademoiselle
+shall stay in the canoe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But it is not safe&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;broke in Danton,
+stepping forward. Then, conscious of the blunder,
+he turned away, and took up the rope.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Lay hold, boys,&#8221; said Menard.</p>
+<p>Perrot and one of the new men waded into
+the water, and laid hold of the gunwales on
+each side of the bow. Menard himself took
+the stern. He called to Danton, who stood
+awkwardly upon the bank, &#8220;Take the rope
+with the men.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Guerin made the rope fast and set out ahead,
+with the other men and Danton close behind.
+Father Claude rolled up his robe and joined
+them.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Wait,&#8221; called Menard, as the rope straightened.
+&#8220;Mademoiselle, I am sorry to disturb you,
+but if you will sit farther back you will have
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_96' name='page_96'></a>96</span>
+less trouble from the spray.&#8221; He waded along
+the side, and helped her to move nearer the
+stern, placing the bundles and the blanket
+about her as before. Then he shouted, &#8220;All
+right,&#8221; and they started into the foaming water.</p>
+<p>They toiled slowly up the incline, catching
+at rocks to steady their course, and often
+struggling for a foothold. Once Menard
+ordered a halt at a large rock, and all
+rested for a moment.</p>
+<p>When they started again, the men at the bow
+of the canoe had some trouble in holding it
+steady, for their feet were on a stretch of smooth
+rock, and Menard called Danton back to help
+them. The boy worked his way along the rope,
+and reached the bow.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come around behind Perrot,&#8221; said Menard.</p>
+<p>Danton reached around Perrot&#8217;s body, and
+caught hold of the gunwale. At that moment
+his foot slipped, and he fell, dragging the side
+of the canoe down with him. The men at the
+bow did their best to prevent a capsize, but succeeded
+only in keeping half the bundles in the
+canoe. The others, the muskets, and the maid
+went into the river.</p>
+<p>Menard moved forward as rapidly as he could
+against the current. The maid was unable at
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_97' name='page_97'></a>97</span>
+once to get her feet, used as she was to the
+water, and was swept down against him. He
+caught her, and, steadying himself with one
+hand, by the water-logged canoe, raised her
+head and held her while she struggled for a
+footing and shook the water from her eyes.
+Before she was wholly herself, Danton came
+plunging toward them.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Give her to me!&#8221; he said huskily. &#8220;I&#8217;ve
+drowned her! My God, let me have her!&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Stop,&#8221; said Menard, sternly. &#8220;Take the
+men, and go after those bales&ndash;&ndash;quick!&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton looked stupidly at him and at the
+maid, who was wiping the water from her face
+with one hand, and holding tightly to the Captain.
+Then he followed Perrot, who had already,
+with the two new men and Father Claude,
+commenced to get together the bales, most of
+which had sunk, and were moving slowly along
+the bottom. Menard still had his arm about
+the girl&#8217;s shoulders. He helped her to the
+shore.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Keep moving, Mademoiselle,&ndash;&ndash;don&#8217;t sit
+down. In a moment we shall have a fire.
+Father Claude,&#8221; he called, &#8220;bring the canoe
+ashore.&#8221; Then to the maid, &#8220;There are yet
+some dry blankets, thank God.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_98' name='page_98'></a>98</span></p>
+<p>Mademoiselle was herself now, and she protested.
+&#8220;But it is only water, M&#8217;sieu. Let me
+go on with you, beyond the rapids.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard merely shook his head. The canoe
+was soon on the bank, and emptied of water.
+The other men were beginning to come in with
+soaked bundles and dripping muskets. Each
+bale was opened, and the contents spread out to
+dry, while Guerin was set to work at drying the
+muskets with a cloth. Perrot and Danton
+built a rough shelter for the maid, enclosing a
+small fire, and gave her some dry blankets.
+Then each man dried himself as best he could.</p>
+<p>This accident threw Danton into a fit of
+gloominess from which nothing seemed to
+arouse him. He was careless of his duty, and
+equally careless to the reprimands that followed.
+This went on for two days, during which the
+maid seemed at one moment to avoid him, and
+at another to watch for his coming. In the
+evening of the second day following, the party
+camped at Pointe &agrave; Baudet, on Lake St. Francis.
+The supper was eaten in a silence more oppressive
+than usual, for neither Menard nor Father
+Claude could overcome the influence of Danton&#8217;s
+heavy face and the maid&#8217;s troubled eyes.
+After the supper the two strolled away, and sat
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_99' name='page_99'></a>99</span>
+just out of earshot on a mossy knoll. For hours
+they talked there, their voices low, save once
+or twice when Danton&#8217;s rose. They seemed to
+have lost all count of time, all heed of appearances.
+Menard and the priest made an effort
+at first to appear unobservant, but later, seeing
+that their movements were beyond the sight of
+those unheeding eyes, they took to watching
+and speculating on the course of the conversation.
+The night came on, and the dark closed
+over them. Still the murmur of those low voices
+floated across the camp.</p>
+<p>Father Claude, with a troubled mind, went
+down to the water, and walked slowly up and
+down. Menard saw to the final preparations for
+the night, and posted the first sentry. Then
+he joined the priest.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think it is time to speak.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I fear it is, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I must leave it in your hands.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Shall I go now?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Without further words, Father Claude walked
+up the bank, crackling through the bushes.
+From this spot the voices were inaudible, and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_100' name='page_100'></a>100</span>
+for a few moments there was no sound. Then
+Menard could hear some one moving heavily
+through the undergrowth, going farther and
+farther into the stillness, and he knew that it
+was Danton. He sat on the bank with his back
+against a tree, and waited for a long hour. At
+last he dropped asleep.</p>
+<p>He was awakened by Father Claude. The
+priest dropped to the ground beside him. His
+training had given Menard the faculty of awaking
+instantly into full grasp of a situation.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well,&#8221; he said. &#8220;Where is the maid?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;She has gone to her couch, but not to sleep,
+I fear. It has come, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What has come?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Danton has lost his senses. He asks her
+to marry him, to flee with him. It is a difficult
+case. She has had no such experience before,
+and knows not how to receive him. She seems
+to have no love for him, beyond the pleasure
+his flattery has given her. She believes all he
+says. One thing I know, aside from all questions
+of expediency, of care for our trust, this
+must not go on.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Not for the present, at least. She may do
+what she will, once we have taken her safely to
+Frontenac.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_101' name='page_101'></a>101</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;No, M&#8217;sieu; not even then. We must stop
+it at once.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, of course,&#8221; said Menard; &#8220;so far as we
+are concerned, we have no choice. You need
+not bother longer to-night. I will wait for the
+boy. I am sorry for him.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I should have more pity, if I knew less of
+his past.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tush, Father! He is not a bad fellow, as
+they go. To be sure he does not rise any too
+well to new responsibilities, but he will grow
+into it. It is better an honest infatuation with
+the daughter of a gentleman than a dishonest
+one with an Indian maid. And you know our
+officers, Father. God knows, they are all bad
+enough; and yet they are loyal fellows.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah, M&#8217;sieu, I fear you will be too lenient
+with him. Believe me, we have not a minute to
+waste in stopping the affair.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Have no fear, Father. Good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard lay on the bank, gazing at the sparkling
+water, and listening to the slow step of
+the sentry and to the deeper sounds of the forest.
+Another hour crept by, and still Danton
+had not returned. Menard walked about the
+camp to make sure that he was not already
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_102' name='page_102'></a>102</span>
+rolled in his blanket; then he went to the sentry,
+who was leaning against a tree a few rods
+away.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Colin,&#8221; he said, &#8220;have you seen Lieutenant
+Danton?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, M&#8217;sieu. He is up there.&#8221; Colin
+pointed through the trees that fringed the
+river. &#8220;I heard a noise some time ago, and
+went up to see. He is lying under a beech
+tree, if he has not moved,&ndash;&ndash;and I should
+have heard him if he had. It may be that he
+is asleep.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard nodded, and walked slowly along
+the bank, bending aside the briers that caught
+at his clothes and his hands.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_103' name='page_103'></a>103</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_VI_THE_FIGHT_AT_LA_GALLETTE' id='CHAPTER_VI_THE_FIGHT_AT_LA_GALLETTE'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER VI.</h2>
+<h3>THE FIGHT AT LA GALLETTE.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>Danton was lying on the ground, but he
+was not asleep. He looked up, at the sound
+of Menard&#8217;s footsteps, and then, recognizing
+him, lowered his eyes again. The Captain hesitated,
+standing over the prostrate figure.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Danton,&#8221; he said finally, &#8220;I want you to
+tell me the truth.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The boy made no reply, and Menard, after
+waiting for a moment, sat upon a log.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have decided to do rather an unusual
+thing, Danton,&#8221; he said slowly, &#8220;in offering to
+talk it over with you as a friend, and not as an
+officer. In one thing you must understand me:
+Mademoiselle St. Denis has been intrusted to
+my care, and until she has safely reached those
+who have a right to share the direction of her
+actions, I can allow nothing of this sort to go
+on. You must understand that. If you will
+talk with me frankly, and try to control yourself
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_104' name='page_104'></a>104</span>
+for the present, it may be that I can be of
+service to you later on.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There was a long silence. Finally, Danton
+spoke, without raising his head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is there need of this, M&#8217;sieu? Is it not
+enough that she&ndash;&ndash;that Mademoiselle dismisses
+me?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh,&#8221; said Menard, &#8220;that is it?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are sure of yourself, Danton? sure
+that you have not made a mistake?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;A mistake?&#8221; The boy looked up wildly.
+&#8220;I was&ndash;&ndash;shall I tell you, M&#8217;sieu?&ndash;&ndash;I left the
+camp to-night with the thought that I should
+never go back.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard looked at him curiously.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What did you plan to do?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I didn&#8217;t know,&ndash;&ndash;I don&#8217;t know now. Back
+to Montreal, perhaps to the Iroquois. I don&#8217;t
+care where.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You did not bring your musket. It would
+hardly be safe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Safe!&#8221; There was weary contempt in the
+boy&#8217;s voice. He sat up, and made an effort to
+steady himself, leaning back upon his hands.
+&#8220;I should not say this. It was what I thought
+at first. I am past it now; I can think better.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_105' name='page_105'></a>105</span>
+It was only your coming,&ndash;&ndash;when I first saw
+you, it came rushing back, and I wanted to&ndash;&ndash;oh,
+what is the use? You do not know. You
+cannot understand.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And now?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Now, Captain, I ask for a release. Let me
+go back to Montreal.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How would you go? You have no canoe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will walk.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard shook his head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I am sorry,&#8221; he said, &#8220;but it is too late. In
+the first place, you would never reach the city.
+There are scouting bands of Iroquois all along
+the river.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;So much the better, M&#8217;sieu, so&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Wait. That is only one reason. I cannot
+spare you. I have realized within the last day
+that I should have brought more men. The
+Iroquois know of our campaign; they are
+watching us. A small party like this is to
+their liking. I will tell you, Danton, we may
+have a close rub before we get to Frontenac.
+I wish I could help you, but I cannot. What
+reason could I give for sending you alone down
+the river to Montreal? You forget, boy, that
+we are not on our own pleasure; we are on the
+King&#8217;s errand. For you to go now would be
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_106' name='page_106'></a>106</span>
+to take away one of our six fighting men,&ndash;&ndash;to
+imperil Mademoiselle. And that, I think,&#8221;
+he looked keenly at Danton, &#8220;is not what you
+would wish to do.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The boy&#8217;s face was by turns set and working.
+He looked at Menard as if to speak, but got
+nothing out. At last he sprang to his feet, and
+paced back and forth between the trees.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What can I do?&#8221; he said half to himself.
+&#8220;I can&#8217;t stay! I can&#8217;t see her every day, and
+hear her voice, and sit with her at every meal.
+Why do you call yourself my friend, Menard?
+Why don&#8217;t you help? Why don&#8217;t you say
+something&ndash;&ndash;?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There are some things, Danton, that a man
+must fight out alone.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton turned away, and stood looking over
+the river. Menard sat on the log and waited.
+The moments slipped by, and still they said
+nothing. They could hear the stirring of Colin,
+back at the camp, and the rustle of the low night
+breeze. They could almost hear the great silent
+rush of the river.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Danton.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The boy half turned his head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will stay here and play the man. You
+will go on with your duties; though, if the old
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_107' name='page_107'></a>107</span>
+arrangement be too hard, I will be your master
+in the Iroquois study, leaving Mademoiselle to
+Father Claude. And now you must return to
+the camp and get what sleep you can. Heaven
+knows we may have little enough between here
+and Frontenac. Come.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He got up, and walked to the camp, without
+looking around. Danton lingered until the
+Captain&#8217;s tall figure was blending with the
+shadows of the forest, then he went after.</p>
+<p>During the following day they got as far as
+the group of islands at the head of Lake St.
+Francis. Wherever possible Menard was now
+selecting islands or narrow points for the camp,
+where, in case of a night attack, defence would
+be a simple problem for his few men. Also,
+each night, he had the men spread a circle of
+cut boughs around the camp at a little distance,
+so that none could approach without some slight
+noise. Another night saw the party at the foot
+of Petit Chesneaux, just above Pointe Maligne.</p>
+<p>While Perrot was preparing the supper, and
+Danton, with the <i>voyageurs</i>, was unpacking the
+bales, Menard took his musket and strode off
+into the forest. There was seldom a morning
+now that the maid did not have for her breakfast
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_108' name='page_108'></a>108</span>
+a morsel of game
+which the Captain&#8217;s musket
+had brought down.</p>
+<div class="image-left"> <img alt='map' src='images/illus-map.png' /><br />
+
+<p class='image-caption'>
+<span style='font-variant:small-caps'>Note.</span>&ndash;&ndash;By this picture-writing the Long Arrow (of the clan of the
+Beaver) tells the Beaver (of the same clan) that he has taken up the hatchet
+against the party in the canoe, and he asks the Beaver to assist him. The
+parallel zigzag lines under the long arrow tell that he is travelling by the
+river, and the two straight lines under these that he has two warriors with
+him. The attack is to be made in either three or four sleeps, or days, as
+indicated by the three finished huts and one unfinished.<br /><br />
+
+The Beaver has seen this sign, as shown by his signature at the bottom. The
+seventeen slanting lines under the foot mean that he has seventeen warriors
+and they are travelling on foot, southward, as shown by the fact that the
+lines slope toward the sun.<br /><br />
+
+That the figures in the canoe are French is shown by their hats. The priest
+has no paddle, the maid is represented with long hair.
+</p>
+
+</div>
+<p>In half an hour he returned,
+and sought Father
+Claude; and after a
+few low words the two
+set off. Menard led the
+way through thicket and
+timber growth, over a
+low hill, and down into a
+hollow, where a well-defined
+Indian trail crossed
+a brook. Here was a
+large sugar maple tree
+standing in a narrow
+opening in the thicket.
+Menard struck a light,
+and held up a torch so
+that the priest could
+make out a blaze-mark
+on the tree.</p>
+<p>&#8220;See,&#8221; said Menard.
+&#8220;It is on the old trail.
+I saw it by the merest
+chance.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude bent forward, with his eyes
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_109' name='page_109'></a>109</span>
+close to the inscription that had been painted
+on the white inner bark, with charcoal and
+bear&#8217;s grease.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Can you read it?&#8221; asked Menard, holding
+the torch high.</p>
+<p>The priest nodded. Both of these men knew
+the Indian writing nearly as well as their own
+French.</p>
+<p>&#8220;He does not know of the two men you got
+at Montreal, M&#8217;sieu. He tells of only six in
+our canoe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No? But that matters little. The Beaver
+has hurried after him with nearly a score.
+They can give us trouble enough. What do
+you make of the huts? Do they mean three
+days or four?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It looks to me,&#8221; said the priest slowly,
+&#8220;that he was interrupted in drawing the
+fourth.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;Menard threw his torch into the
+brook, and turned away into the dusk of the
+thicket,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;we know enough. The fight will
+be somewhere near the head of the rapids.
+Perhaps they will wait until we get on into the
+islands.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And meantime,&#8221; said the priest, as they
+crackled through the undergrowth, &#8220;we shall
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_110' name='page_110'></a>110</span>
+say nothing of this to Lieutenant Danton or
+the maid?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Nothing,&#8221; Menard replied.</p>
+<p>In three days more they had passed Rapide
+Flat, after toiling laboriously by the Long Sault.
+They were a sober enough party now, oppressed
+with Danton&#8217;s dogged attention to duty and
+with the maid&#8217;s listless manner.</p>
+<p>They were passing a small island the next
+morning, when Perrot gave a shout and stopped
+paddling.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is it?&#8221; asked Menard, sharply.</p>
+<p>Perrot pointed across a spit of land. In the
+other channel they could see a bateau just
+disappearing behind a clump of trees. It was
+headed down-stream. Menard swung the canoe
+about, and they skirted the foot of the island.
+Instead of a single bateau there were some
+half dozen, drifting light down the river, with
+a score of <i>coureurs de bois</i> and <i>voyageurs</i>
+under the command of a bronzed lieutenant,
+Du Peron, a sergeant, and a corporal. The
+lieutenant recognized Menard, and both parties
+landed while the two officers exchanged news.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Can you spare me a few men?&#8221; Menard
+asked, when they had drawn apart from the
+others.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_111' name='page_111'></a>111</span></p>
+<p>The lieutenant&#8217;s eye roamed over the group
+on the beach, where the men of both parties
+were mingling.</p>
+<p>&#8220;How many do you want? I&#8217;m running
+shorthanded. We have all we can manage
+with these bateaux.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There&#8217;s a war party of twenty on my trail,&#8221;
+said Menard. &#8220;If I had my own men with
+me I should feel safe, but I have my doubts
+about these fellows. I haven&#8217;t room for more
+than two.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What&#8217;s the trouble?&ndash;&ndash;that La Grange
+affair?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard nodded.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I heard that they had a price on your head.
+There&#8217;s been a good deal of talk about it at
+Frontenac. A converted Mohawk has been
+scouting for us, and he says that the Onondagas
+blame you for that whole galley business.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I know,&#8221; said Menard, grimly. &#8220;You could
+hardly expect them to get the truth of it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It was bad work, Menard, bad work. The
+worst thing La Grange did was to butcher
+the women and children. He was drunk at
+the time, and the worst of it was over before
+d&#8217;Orvilliers got wind of it. Do you know who
+is leading this war party?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_112' name='page_112'></a>112</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;The Long Arrow.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, yes. A big fellow, with a rather noticeable
+wampum collar. He came to Frontenac as
+a Mission Indian, but got away before we suspected
+anything. Our scout told me that his
+son was in the party that was taken to the galleys.
+He&#8217;s been scouting along the river ever
+since. Likely as not he followed you down to
+Quebec. How many men have you now?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Five, and Father Claude.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He could shoot at a pinch, I suppose. I&#8217;ll
+let you have the best two I have, but&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;
+Du Peron shrugged his shoulders&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;you
+know the sort that are assigned for this transport
+work. They&#8217;re a bad lot at best. But they
+can shoot, and they hate the Iroquois, so you&#8217;re
+all right if you can keep them sober. That
+will make nine, with yourself,&ndash;&ndash;it should be
+enough.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It will be enough. How is the transport
+moving?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Splendidly. Whatever we may say about
+the new Governor, our Intendant knows his
+business. I judge from the way he is stocking
+up Frontenac, that we are to use it as the base
+for a big campaign.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I suppose so. You will report, will you, at
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_113' name='page_113'></a>113</span>
+Montreal, that we were safe at Rapide Flat?
+And if you find a <i>coureur</i> going down to
+Quebec, I wish you would send word to Provost
+that Mademoiselle St. Denis is well and
+in good spirits.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The lieutenant looked curiously at the maid,
+who was walking with Father Claude near the
+canoe. Then the two officers shook hands, and
+in a few moments were going their ways, Menard
+with two villainous <i>voyageurs</i> added to his
+crew. That afternoon he passed the last rapid,
+and beached the canoe at La Gallette, thankful
+that nothing intervened between them and
+Fort Frontenac but a reach of still water and
+the twining channels of the Thousand Islands,
+where it would call for the sharpest eyes ever
+set in an Iroquois head to follow his movements.</p>
+<p>They ate an early supper, and immediately
+afterward Father Claude slipped away. The
+maid looked after him a little wistfully, then
+she wandered to the bank, and found a mossy
+seat where she could watch the long rapid, with
+its driving, foaming current that dashed over
+the ledges and leaped madly around the jagged
+rocks. Menard set his men at work preparing
+the camp against attack. When this was well
+under way he called Danton, who was lying by
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_114' name='page_114'></a>114</span>
+the fire, and spent an hour with him conversing
+in Iroquois. By that time the twilight was
+creeping down the river. Menard left the boy
+to form a speech in accord with Iroquois tradition,
+and went on a tour of inspection about
+the camp. The new men had swung thoroughly
+into the spirit of their work; one of them was
+already on guard a short way back in the
+woods. The other men were grouped in a
+cleared place, telling stories and singing.</p>
+<p>Father Claude came hurriedly toward the
+fire, looking for Menard. His eyes glowed
+with enthusiasm.</p>
+<p>&#8220;M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; he said, in an eager voice, &#8220;come.
+I have found it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It has come to me,&ndash;&ndash;about the canoe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard looked puzzled, but the priest caught
+his arm, and led him away.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It came while we ate supper. The whole
+truth, the secret of the allegory, flashed upon
+me. I have worked hard, and now it is done.
+Instead of leaving out the canoe, I have put it
+back, and have placed in it six warriors, three
+paddling toward the chapel, and three away
+from it. Over them hovers an angel,&ndash;&ndash;a mere
+suggestion, a faint, shining face, a diaphanous
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_115' name='page_115'></a>115</span>
+form, and outspread hands. Thus we symbolize
+the conflict in the savage mind at the first entrance
+of the Holy Word into their lives, with
+the blessed assurance over all that the Faith
+must triumph in the end.&#8221;</p>
+<p>At the last words, he stopped and drew
+Menard around to face the portrait of the
+Lily of the Onondagas, which was leaning
+against a stump.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is it too dark, M&#8217;sieu? See, I will bring it
+closer.&#8221; He lifted the picture, and held it close
+to Menard&#8217;s eyes. He was trembling with the
+excitement of his inspiration.</p>
+<p>The Captain stepped back.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I should like to know, Father, where you
+have had this picture.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It was in my bundle. I have&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;for the
+first time he saw the sternness in Menard&#8217;s
+face, and his voice faltered.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You did not leave it at Montreal?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude slowly lowered the canvas to
+the ground. The light had gone out of his
+eyes, and his face was white. Then suddenly
+his thin form straightened. &#8220;I had forgotten.
+It was M&#8217;sieu&#8217;s order. See,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;he suddenly
+lifted the picture over his head and whirled to
+the stump,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;it shall go no farther. We will
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_116' name='page_116'></a>116</span>
+leave it here for the wolves and the crows and
+the pagan redmen.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He dashed it down with all his strength, but
+Menard sprang forward, and caught it on his
+outstretched arm. &#8220;No, Father,&#8221; he said; &#8220;we
+will take it with us.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest smiled wearily, and lowered the
+picture to the ground; but when Menard said,
+&#8220;You have broken it,&#8221; he raised it hastily, and
+examined it. One corner of the wooden frame
+was loosened, but the canvas was not injured.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I can mend it,&#8221; he said.</p>
+<p>Then they walked to the camp together,
+without talking; and Menard helped him repair
+the frame, and pack the picture carefully.</p>
+<p>&#8220;How is it that it was not ruined in the
+capsize at Coteau des Cedres?&#8221; Menard asked.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It was preserved by a miracle, M&#8217;sieu. This
+bundle did not leave the canoe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The <i>voyageurs</i>, still lounging in the clearing,
+were laughing and talking noisily. The Captain,
+after he had prepared the maid&#8217;s couch,
+and bade her good-night, called to them to be
+quiet. For a time the noise ceased, but a little
+later, as he was spreading his blanket on the
+ground, it began again, and one of the transport
+men sang the opening strain of a ribald
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_117' name='page_117'></a>117</span>
+song. Menard strode over to the group so
+quickly that he took them by surprise. Colin
+was slipping something behind him, but he
+could not escape Menard&#8217;s eye. In a moment
+he was sprawling on his face, and a brandy flask
+was brought to light. Menard dashed it against
+a tree, and turned to the frightened men.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Go to your blankets, every man of you.
+There are Iroquois on this river. You have
+already made enough noise to draw them from
+half a league away. The next man that is
+caught drinking will be flogged.&#8221; He thought
+of the maid lying under her frail shelter, for
+whose life he was responsible. &#8220;If it occurs
+twice, he will be shot. Perrot, I want you to
+join the sentry. From now on we shall have
+two men on guard all night. See that there is
+no mistake about this. At the slightest noise,
+you will call me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The men slunk to their blankets, and soon
+the camp was still.</p>
+<p>The river sang as it rushed down its zigzag
+channel through the rocks,&ndash;&ndash;a song that
+seemed a part of the night, and yet was distinct
+from the creeping, rustling, dropping, all-pervading
+life and stir of the forest. Every
+leaf, every twig and root, every lump of sod
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_118' name='page_118'></a>118</span>
+and rock-held pool of stagnant water, had its
+own miniature world, where living things were
+fighting the battle of life. In the far distance,
+perhaps, an owl hooted; or near at hand a flying
+squirrel alighted on a bending elm-twig. Deer
+and moose followed their beaten tracks to the
+streams that had been theirs before ever Frenchman
+pierced the forest; beaver dove into their
+huts above the dams their own sharp teeth had
+made; moles nosed under the rich soil, and left
+a winding track behind; frogs croaked and
+bellowed from some backset of the river,&ndash;&ndash;and
+all blended, not, perhaps, so much into a sound,
+as into a sense of movement,&ndash;&ndash;an even murmur
+in a low key, to which the lighter note of
+the water was apart and distinct.</p>
+<p>To a man trained as Menard had been, this
+was companionship. He was never alone in
+the forest, never without his millions of friends,
+who, though they seldom came into his thoughts,
+were yet a part of him, of his sense of life and
+strength. And through all these noises, even
+to the roar of Niagara itself, he could sleep
+like a child, when the slightest sound of a
+moccasined foot on a dry leaf would have
+aroused him at the instant to full activity.
+To-night he lay awake for a long time. With
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_119' name='page_119'></a>119</span>
+every day that he drew nearer the frontier
+came graver doubts of the feasibility of the
+plan which had been intrusted to him. The
+wretched business of La Grange&#8217;s treachery
+and the stocking of the King&#8217;s galleys had
+probably alienated the Onondagas for all time.
+Their presence on the St. Lawrence pointed to
+this. He felt safe enough, personally, for the
+very imprudence of the Governor&#8217;s campaign,
+which had made it known so early to all the
+Iroquois, was an element in his favour. The
+Iroquois, unlike many of the roaming western
+tribes, had their settled villages, with lodges
+and fields of grain to defend from invasion.
+One secret of the campaign had been well
+kept; no one save the Governor&#8217;s staff and
+Menard knew that the blow was to fall on the
+Senecas alone. And Menard was certain
+enough in his knowledge of Iroquois character
+to believe that each tribe, from the Mohawks
+on the east to the Senecas on the west, would
+call in its warriors, and concentrate to defend
+its villages. Therefore there could be no strong
+force on the St. Lawrence, where the French
+could so easily cut it off. As for the Long
+Arrow and his band, eight good fighting men
+and a stout-hearted priest could attend to them.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_120' name='page_120'></a>120</span></p>
+<p>No, the danger would begin after the maid
+was safe at Frontenac, and he and Danton and
+Father Claude must set out to win the confidence
+of the Onondagas. The Oneidas and
+Mohawks must not be slighted; but the Onondagas
+and Cayugas, being the nearest to the
+Senecas, and between them and the other nations,
+would likely prove to be the key to the situation.</p>
+<p>The night was black when he awoke.
+Clouds had spread over the sky, hiding all but
+a strip in the west where a low line of stars
+peeped out. This strip was widening rapidly
+as the night breeze carried the clouds eastward.
+At a little distance some of the men were whispering
+together and laughing softly. A hand
+was feeling his arm, and a voice whispered,&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Quick, M&#8217;sieu; something has happened!&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is that you, Colin?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. Guerin was on guard with me, and
+he fell. I thought I heard an arrow, but could
+not be sure. I looked for him after I heard
+him fall, but could not find him in the dark.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard sprang to his feet, with his musket,
+which had lain at his side every night since
+leaving Montreal.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Where was Guerin, Colin?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Straight back from the river, a few rods.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_121' name='page_121'></a>121</span>
+He had spoken but a moment before. It must
+have told them where to shoot.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Call the men, and draw them close in a
+circle.&#8221; Menard felt his way toward the fire,
+where a few red embers showed dimly, and
+roused Danton with a light touch and a whispered
+caution to be silent. Already he could
+hear the low stir of the <i>engag&eacute;s</i> as they slipped
+nearer the fire. He walked slowly toward the
+river, with one hand stretched out in front, to
+find the canoe. It was closer than he supposed,
+and he stumbled over it, knocking one
+end off its support. The maid awoke with a
+gasp.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle, silence!&#8221; he whispered,
+kneeling beside her. &#8220;I fear we are attacked.
+You must come with me.&#8221; He had to say it
+twice before she could fully understand, and
+just then an arrow sang over them, and struck
+a tree with a low <i>thut</i>. He suddenly rose and
+shouted, &#8220;Together, boys! They will be on
+us in a moment. Close in at the bank, and
+save your powder. Perrot, come here and help
+me with the canoe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There was a burst of yells from the dark in
+answer to his call, and a few shots flashed.
+Danton was rallying the men, and calling to
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_122' name='page_122'></a>122</span>
+them to fall back, where they could take cover
+among the rocks and trees of the bank.</p>
+<p>The maid was silent, but she reached out
+her hand, and Menard, catching her wrist,
+helped her to her feet, and fairly carried her
+down the slope of the bank, laying her behind
+the tangled roots of a great oak. Already the
+sky was clearer, and the trees and men were
+beginning to take dim shape. The river rushed
+by, a deeper black than sky and woods, with a
+few ghostly bits of white where the foam of
+the rapids began.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Stay here,&#8221; he whispered. &#8220;Don&#8217;t move
+or speak. I shall not be far.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She clung to his hand in a dazed manner,
+but he gently drew his away, and left her crouching
+on the ground.</p>
+<p>The men were calling to one another as they
+dodged back from tree to tree toward the river,
+shooting only when a flash from the woods
+showed the position of an Indian. Some of
+them were laughing, and as Menard reached
+the canoe Perrot broke into a jeering song.
+It was clear that the attacking party was
+not strong. Probably they had not taken into
+account the double guard, relying on the death
+of the sentry to clear the way for a surprise.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_123' name='page_123'></a>123</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Perrot!&#8221; called the Captain. &#8220;Why don&#8217;t
+you come here?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The song stopped. There was a heavy noise
+as the <i>voyageur</i> came plunging through the
+bushes, drawing a shower of arrows and musket
+balls.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Careful, Perrot, careful.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They can&#8217;t hit me,&#8221; said Perrot, laughing.
+He stumbled against the Captain, stepped back,
+and fell over the canoe, rolling and kicking.
+Menard sprang toward him and jerked him up.
+He smelled strongly of brandy.</p>
+<p>Menard swore under his breath.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Pick up your musket. Take hold of that
+canoe,&ndash;&ndash;quick!&#8221;</p>
+<p>Perrot was frightened by his stern words,
+and he succeeded in holding up an end of the
+canoe, while Menard pushed him down the
+slope to the water&#8217;s edge. They rushed back,
+and in a few trips got down most of the stores.
+By this time Perrot was sobering somewhat,
+and with the Captain he took his place in the
+line. The men were shooting more frequently
+now, and by their loose talk showed increasing
+recklessness. Calling to Danton, Menard finally
+made them understand his order to fall back.
+Before they reached the bank, Colin dropped,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_124' name='page_124'></a>124</span>
+with a ball through the head, and was dragged
+back by Danton.</p>
+<p>They dropped behind logs and trees at the
+top of the slope. It began to look as if the
+redmen were to get no closer, in spite of
+the drunken condition of all but one or two of
+the men. Though the night was now much
+brighter, they were in the shadow, and neither
+the Captain nor Danton observed that the
+brandy which the transport men had supplied
+was passing steadily from hand to hand. They
+could not know that the boy Guerin lay on
+his back amid the attacking Onondagas, an
+arrow sticking upright in his breast, one hand
+lying across his musket, the other clasping a
+flask.</p>
+<p>The maid had not moved. She could be
+easily seen now in the clearer light, and Menard
+went to her, feeling the need of giving her
+some work to occupy her mind during the strain
+of the fight.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle,&#8221; he whispered.</p>
+<p>She looked up. He could see that she was
+shivering.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I must ask you to help me. We must get
+the canoe into the water. They will soon tire
+of the assault and withdraw; then it will be
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_125' name='page_125'></a>125</span>
+safe to take to the canoe. They cannot hurt
+you. We are protected by the bank.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He helped her to rise, and she bravely threw
+her weight on the canoe, which Menard could
+so easily have lifted alone, and stood at the
+edge of the beach, passing him the bundles,
+which he, wading out, placed aboard. But
+suddenly he stopped, with an exclamation, peering
+into the canoe.</p>
+<p>The maid, dreading each moment some new
+danger, asked in a dry voice, &#8220;What is it,
+M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>For reply he seized the bundles, one at a
+time, and tossed them ashore, hauling the canoe
+after, and running his hand along the bark.</p>
+<p>The maid stepped to his side. There was a
+gaping hole in the side of the canoe. She
+drew her breath in quickly, and looked up at
+him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It was Perrot,&#8221; he muttered, &#8220;that fool
+Perrot.&#8221; He stood looking at it, as if in doubt
+what to do. Up on the bank the men, Danton
+and Father Claude among them, were popping
+away at the rustling bushes. Suddenly he
+turned and gazed down at the maid&#8217;s upturned
+face. &#8220;Mademoiselle,&#8221; he said, &#8220;I do not think
+there is danger, but whatever happens you
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_126' name='page_126'></a>126</span>
+must keep close to me, or to Danton and Father
+Claude. It may be that there will be moments
+when we cannot stop and explain to you as I
+am doing now, but you must trust us, and believe
+that all will come out well. The other
+men are not themselves to-night&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>He stopped. It was odd that he should so
+talk to a maid while his men were fighting for
+their lives; but the Menard who had the safety
+of this slender girl in his hands was not the
+Menard of a hundred battles gone by. So he
+lingered, not knowing why, save that he hoped
+for some word from her lips of confidence in
+those who wished to protect her. And, as he
+waited, she smiled with trembling lips, and
+said:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It will come out well, M&#8217;sieu. I&ndash;&ndash;I am
+not afraid.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Then Menard went up the bank with a
+bound, and finding one man already in a stupor,
+and another struggling for a flask, which Father
+Claude was trying to take away from him, he
+laid about him with his hard fists, and shortly
+had the drunkards as near to their senses as
+they were destined to be during the short space
+they had yet to live.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_127' name='page_127'></a>127</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_VII_A_COMPLIMENT_FOR_MENARD' id='CHAPTER_VII_A_COMPLIMENT_FOR_MENARD'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER VII.</h2>
+<h3>A COMPLIMENT FOR MENARD.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>Colin and Guerin were dead, and one of
+the transport men lay in a drunken sleep,
+so that including Menard, Danton, and Father
+Claude there were six men in the little half
+circle that clung to the edge of the bank, shooting
+into the brush wherever a twig stirred or
+a musket flashed. &#8220;There are not many of
+them,&#8221; said Menard to Danton, as they lay
+on their sides reloading. He listened to the
+whoops and barks in an interval between shots.
+&#8220;Not a score, all told.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will they come closer?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. You won&#8217;t catch an Iroquois risking
+his neck in an assault. They&#8217;ll try to pick us
+off; but if we continue as strong as we are now,
+they are likely to draw off and try some other
+devilment, or wait for a better chance.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton crept back to his log for another
+shot. Now that the sky was nearly free of
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_128' name='page_128'></a>128</span>
+clouds, and the river was sparkling in the starlight,
+the Frenchmen could not raise their heads
+to shoot without exposing a dim silhouette to
+the aim of an Indian musket. Father Claude,
+who was loading and firing a long <i>arquebuse &agrave;
+croc</i>, had risen above this difficulty by heaping
+a pile of stones. Kneeling on the slope, a pace
+below the others, and resting the crutch of his
+piece in a hollow close to the stones, he could
+shoot through a crevice with little chance of
+harm, beyond a bruised shoulder.</p>
+<p>The maid came timidly up the bank, and
+touched Menard&#8217;s arm.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is it, Mademoiselle? You must not
+come here. It is not safe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I want to speak to you, M&#8217;sieu. If I could
+have your knife&ndash;&ndash;for one moment&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What do you want of a knife, child? It is
+best that you&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; There was a fusillade from
+the brush, and his voice was lost in the uproar.
+&#8220;You must wait below, on the beach. They
+cannot get to you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is the canoe, M&#8217;sieu. The cloth about
+the bales is stout,&ndash;&ndash;I can sew it over the hole.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard looked at her as she crouched by his
+side; her hair fallen about her face and shoulders;
+her hands, grimy with the clay of the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_129' name='page_129'></a>129</span>
+bank, clinging to a wandering root. She was
+still trembling with excitement, but her eyes
+were bright and eager. Without a word he
+drew his knife from its sheath, and held it out.
+She took it, and was down the slope with a
+light spring, while the Captain poked the muzzle
+of his musket through the leaves. As he
+drew it back, after firing, he caught a glimpse
+of Danton&#8217;s face, turned toward him with a
+curious expression. The boy laughed nervously,
+and wiped the sweat from his blackened forehead.
+&#8220;They don&#8217;t give us much rest, Captain,
+do they?&#8221; Menard&#8217;s reply was jerked out
+with the strokes of his ramrod: &#8220;They will&ndash;&ndash;before
+long&ndash;&ndash;and we can&ndash;&ndash;take to the
+canoe. We&#8217;re letting them have all they want.&#8221;
+He peered through the leaves, and fired quickly.
+A long shriek came from the darkness. Menard
+laughed. &#8220;There&#8217;s one more gone,
+Danton.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The fight went on slowly, wretchedly, shot
+for shot, Danton himself dragging up a bale of
+ammunition and serving it to the men. The
+maid, unaided, had overturned the canoe where
+it lay, and with quickened breath was pressing
+her needle through the tough bark. Danton
+lost the flint from his musket, and crept down
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_130' name='page_130'></a>130</span>
+the bank to set a new one. Suddenly he exclaimed,
+&#8220;There goes Perrot!&#8221;</p>
+<p>The old <i>voyageur</i> had, in a fit of recklessness,
+raised his head for a long look about the
+woods. Now he was rolling slowly down the
+slope toward the canoe and the maid, clutching
+weakly at roots and bushes as he passed. There
+was a dark spot on his forehead. Menard
+sprang after, and felt of his wrists; the pulse
+was fluttering out. He looked up, to see the
+maid dipping up water with her hollowed hands,
+and waved her back.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is no use, Mademoiselle. Is the canoe
+ready? We may need it soon.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She stood motionless, slowly shaking her
+head, and letting the water spill from her hands
+a drop at a time.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Go back there. Do what you can with it.&#8221;
+He hurried up the bank and fell into his place.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Do you see what they are doing?&#8221; asked
+Danton.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Playing the devil. Anything else?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The lieutenant pointed to an arrow that
+was sticking in a tree beside him, slanting
+downward. &#8220;They are climbing trees. Listen.
+You can hear them talking, and calling down.
+I&#8217;ve fired, but I don&#8217;t get them.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_131' name='page_131'></a>131</span></p>
+<p>Menard listened closely, and shot for the
+sound, but with no result.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We&#8217;ve got to stop this, Danton. I don&#8217;t
+understand it. It isn&#8217;t like the Iroquois to
+keep at it after a repulse. Tell Father Claude;
+he is shooting too low.&#8221; Menard glanced along
+the line at his men. The drunken transport
+man lay silent at his post; beyond him were
+his mate and one of the Montreal men, both of
+them reckless and frightened by turns, shooting
+aimlessly into the dark. The arrows were
+rattling down about them now. One grazed
+Father Claude&#8217;s back as he stooped to take
+aim, and straightened him up with a jerk. A
+moment later a bullet sang close past Menard&#8217;s
+head. He looked for the maid; she was sitting
+by the canoe, sewing, giving no heed to the
+arrows.</p>
+<p>The Montreal man groaned softly, and flattened
+out, with an arrow slanting into the small
+of his back; which so unmanned the only other
+conscious <i>engag&eacute;</i> that he sank by him, sobbing,
+and trying to pull out the arrow with his hands.
+Menard sprang up.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My God, Danton! Father Claude! This
+is massacre. Run for the canoe. My turn,
+eh?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_132' name='page_132'></a>132</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;What is it?&#8221; asked Danton. &#8220;Did they
+get you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>For reply, Menard tore an arrow from the
+flesh of his forearm and dashed down the bank,
+musket in hand. The maid was tugging at
+the canoe, struggling to move it toward the
+water. She did not look up to see the yellow,
+crimson, and green painted figures rise from
+the reeds that fringed the water but a few yards
+away; she did not hear the rush of moccasined
+feet on the gravel. Before she could turn, she
+was seized and thrown to the ground, surrounded
+by the Indians, who were facing about
+hastily to meet Menard. The Captain came
+among them with a whirl of his musket that
+sent one warrior to the ground and dropped
+another, half stunned, across the canoe. Danton
+was at his heels, and Father Claude, fighting
+like demons with muskets and knives.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Quick, Mademoiselle!&#8221; Menard lifted her
+as he spoke, and swung her behind him; and
+then the three were facing the group of howling,
+jumping figures, which was increased rapidly
+by those who had followed the Frenchmen
+down the bank. &#8220;Come back here, Father.
+Protect the maid! They dare not attack you,
+if you drop your musket! Loose your hold,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_133' name='page_133'></a>133</span>
+Mademoiselle.&#8221; He caught roughly at the
+slender arms that held about his waist, parrying
+a knife stroke with his other hand. &#8220;They
+will kill you if you cling to me. Now, Danton!
+Never mind your arm. I have one in the hand.
+Fight for the maid and France!&#8221; Menard was
+shouting for sheer lust and frenzy of battle,
+&#8220;What is the matter with the devils? Why
+don&#8217;t they shoot? God, Danton, they&#8217;re coming
+at us with clubs!&#8221; He called out in the
+Iroquois tongue: &#8220;Come at us, cowards!
+Make an end of it! Where are your bows?
+your muskets? Where is the valour of the
+Onondagas&ndash;&ndash;of my brothers?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The last words brought forth a chorus of
+jeers and yells. The two officers stood side by
+side at the water&#8217;s edge. Behind them, knee-deep
+in the water, was Father Claude, holding
+the maid in his arms. The Indians seemed to
+draw together, still with that evident effort to
+take their game alive, for two tall chiefs were
+rushing about, cautioning the warriors. Then,
+of a sudden, the whole body came forward with
+a rush, and Menard, Danton, Father Claude,
+and the maid went down; the three men fighting
+and splashing until they lay, bound with
+thongs, on the beach.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_134' name='page_134'></a>134</span></p>
+<p>Menard turned his head and saw that Danton
+lay close to him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle?&#8221; he said. &#8220;What have they
+done with her?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;She is here.&#8221; The reply was in Father
+Claude&#8217;s voice. It came from the farther side
+of Danton.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is she hurt?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. But they have bound her and me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Bound you!&#8221; The Captain tried to sit up,
+but could not. &#8220;They would not do that,
+Father. It is a mistake.&#8221;</p>
+<p>A warrior, carrying a musket under his arm,
+walked slowly around the prisoners, making
+signs to them to be silent. The others had
+withdrawn to the shadow of the bank; the
+sound of their voices came indistinctly across
+the strip of shore. Indifferent to the pain in
+his arm, Menard struggled at his thongs, and
+called to them in Iroquois: &#8220;Who of my
+brothers has bound the holy Father? What
+new fear strikes the breasts of the sons of the
+night-wind that they must subdue with force
+the gentle spirit of their Father, who has given
+his years for his children? Is it not enough
+that you have broken the faith with your
+brother, the child of your own village, the son
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_135' name='page_135'></a>135</span>
+of your bravest chief? Need you other prey
+than myself?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The guard stood over Menard, and lifted his
+musket. Menard laughed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Strike me, brave warrior. Show that your
+heart is still as fond as on the day I carried
+your torn body on my shoulder to the safety of
+your lodge. Ah, you remember? You have
+not forgotten the Big Buffalo? Then, why do
+you hesitate? The man who has courage to
+seize a Father of the Church, surely can strike
+his brother. This is not the brave Tegakwita
+I have known.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude broke in on Menard, whose
+voice was savage in its defiance.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Have patience, M&#8217;sieu. I will speak.&#8221; He
+lifted his voice. &#8220;Teganouan! Father
+Claude awaits you.&#8221; There was no reply from
+the knot of warriors at the bank, and the priest
+called again. Finally a chief came across and
+looked stolidly at the prisoners.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My Father called?&#8221; he said.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Your Father is grieved, Long Arrow, that
+you would bind him like a soldier taken in war.&#8221;
+The priest&#8217;s voice was gentle. &#8220;Is this the
+custom of the Onondagas? It was not so when
+I served you with Father de Lamberville.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_136' name='page_136'></a>136</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;My Father fought against his children.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You would have slain me, Long Arrow,
+had I not.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian walked slowly back to his braves,
+and for some moments there was a consultation.
+Then the other chief came to them, and, without
+a word, himself cut the thongs that bound
+the priest&#8217;s wrists and ankles. There was no
+look of recognition in his eyes as he passed
+Menard, though they had been together on
+many a long hunt. He was the Beaver.</p>
+<p>As the Captain lay on his back, looking first
+at the kneeling Indian, then at the sky overhead,
+he was thinking of the Long Arrow,
+again with a half-memory of some other occasion
+when they had met. Then, slowly, it
+came to him. It was at the last council to decide
+on his release from captivity, five years
+before. The Long Arrow had come from a
+distant village to urge the death of the prisoner.
+He had argued eloquently that to release Menard
+would be to send forth an ungrateful son
+who would one day strike at the hand that
+had befriended him.</p>
+<p>Father Claude was on his feet, chafing his
+wrists and talking with the Beaver. The Long
+Arrow joined them, and for a few moments the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_137' name='page_137'></a>137</span>
+chiefs reasoned together in low, dignified tones.
+Then, at a word from the Beaver, and a grunt
+of disgust from the Long Arrow, Father Claude,
+with quick fingers, set the maid free, and took
+her head upon his knee.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Have they hurt her, Father?&#8221; asked Menard,
+in French.</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, M&#8217;sieu, I think not. It is the excitement.
+The child sadly needs rest.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will they release you? It is not far to
+Frontenac. It may be that you can reach
+there with Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, my son.&#8221; The priest paused to dip up
+some water, and to stroke the maid&#8217;s forehead
+and wrists. &#8220;They have some design which
+has not been made clear to me. They have
+promised not to bind me or to injure what
+belongs to me among the supplies. But the
+Beaver threatens to kill us if we try to escape,
+Mademoiselle and I.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why do they hold you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;To let no word go out concerning your
+capture. I fear, M&#8217;sieu&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest lowered his eyes to the maid, who
+still lay fainting, and said no more. A long
+hour went by, with only a commonplace word
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_138' name='page_138'></a>138</span>
+now and then between the prisoners. The
+maid revived, and sat against the canoe, gazing
+over the water that swept softly by. Danton
+lay silent, saying nothing. Once a groan
+slipped past the Captain&#8217;s lips at a twitch of
+his wounded arm, and Father Claude, immediately
+cheered by the prospect of a moment&#8217;s
+occupation, cleaned the wound with cool water,
+and bandaged it with a strip from his robe.</p>
+<p>Preparations were making for a start. A
+half-dozen braves set out, running down the
+beach; and shortly returned by way of the river
+with two canoes. The others had opened the
+bales of supplies (excepting Father Claude&#8217;s
+bundle, which he kept by him), and divided
+the food and ammunition among themselves.
+The two chiefs came to the prisoners, and
+seated themselves on the gravel. The Long
+Arrow began talking.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brother, the Big Buffalo, is surprised
+that he should be taken a prisoner to the villages
+of the Onondagas. He thinks of the
+days when he shared with us our hunts, our
+lodges, our food, our trophies; when he lived a
+free life with his brothers, and parted from
+them with sadness in his voice. He had a
+grateful heart for the Onondagas then. When
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_139' name='page_139'></a>139</span>
+he left our lodges he placed his hand upon the
+hearts of our chiefs, he swore by his strange
+gods to keep the pledge of friendship to his
+brothers of the forest. Moons have come and
+gone many times since he left our villages.
+The snow has fallen for five seasons between
+him and us, to chill his heart against those
+who have befriended him. Twice has he been
+in battle when we might have taken him a
+prisoner, but the hearts of our braves were
+warm toward him, and they could not lift their
+arms. When there have been those who have
+urged that the hatchet be taken up against
+him, many others have come forward to say,
+&#8216;No; he will yet prove our friend and our
+brother.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard lay without moving, looking up at
+the stars. Danton, by his side, and the maid,
+sitting beyond, were watching him anxiously.
+Father Claude stood erect, with folded arms.</p>
+<p>&#8220;And now,&#8221; continued the chief, &#8220;now that
+Onontio, the greatest of war chiefs, thinks
+that he is strong, and can with a blow destroy
+our villages and drive us from the lands our
+gods and your gods have said to be ours by
+right, as it was our fathers&#8217;,&ndash;&ndash;now there is no
+longer need for the friendship of the Onondagas,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_140' name='page_140'></a>140</span>
+whose whole nation is fewer than the fighting
+braves of the great Onontio. The war-song
+is sung in every white village. The great
+canoes take food and powder up our river,
+for those who would destroy us.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard was still looking upward. &#8220;My
+brother,&#8221; he said, speaking slowly, &#8220;was once
+a young brave. When he was called before
+his great chief, and commanded to go out and
+fight to save his village and his brothers and
+sisters, did he say to his chief: &#8216;No, my father,
+I will no longer obey your commands. I will
+no longer strive to become a famous warrior of
+your nation. I will go away into the deep
+forest,&ndash;&ndash;alone, without a lodge, without a
+nation, to be despised alike by my brothers
+and my foes?&#8217; Or did he go as he was bid,
+obeying, like a brave warrior, the commands of
+those who have a right to command? Does
+not the Long Arrow know that Onontio is the
+greatest of chiefs, second only to the Great-Chief-Across-the-Water,
+the father of red men
+and white men? If Onontio&#8217;s red sons are disobedient,
+and he commands me to chastise
+them, shall I say to my father, &#8216;I cannot obey
+your will, I will become an outcast, without
+a village or a nation?&#8217; The Long Arrow is a
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_141' name='page_141'></a>141</span>
+wise man. He knows that the duty of all is to
+obey the father at Quebec.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo speaks with wisdom. But
+it may be he forgets that our braves have
+passed him by in the battles of every season
+since he left our villages. He forgets that he
+met a band of peaceful hunters from our nation,
+who went into his great stone house because
+they believed that his white brothers, if not
+himself, would keep the word of friendship.
+He forgets that they were made to drink of
+the white man&#8217;s fire water, and were chained
+together to become slaves of the great kind
+Chief-Across-the-Water, who loves his children,
+and would make them mighty in his land. Is
+this the father he would have us obey? Truly,
+he speaks with an idle tongue.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard lay silent. His part in La Grange&#8217;s
+treachery, and in carrying out later the Governor&#8217;s
+orders, would be hard to explain. To lay
+the blame on La Grange would not help his
+case, at least until he could consult with Father
+Claude, and be prepared to speak deliberately.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brother does not reply?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He will ask a question,&#8221; replied Menard.
+&#8220;What is the will of the chiefs to do with the
+sons of Onontio?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_142' name='page_142'></a>142</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo has seen the punishment
+given by the Onondagas to those who have
+broken their faith.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I understand. And of course we shall be
+taken to your villages before this death shall
+come?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Long Arrow bowed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well,&#8221; said Menard, in his slow voice.
+&#8220;As the Long Arrow, brave as he is, is but a
+messenger, obeying the will of the nation, I will
+withhold my word until I shall be brought
+before your chiefs in council. I shall have
+much to say to them; it need be said only
+once. I shall be pleased to tell my truths to
+the Big Throat, whose eyes can see beyond the
+limits of his lodge; who knows that the hand
+of Onontio is a firm and strong hand. He
+shall know from my lips how kind Onontio
+wishes to be to his ungrateful children&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;
+He paused. The Indians must not know yet
+that the Governor&#8217;s campaign was to be directed
+only against the Senecas. The mention of the
+Big Throat would, he knew, be a shaft tipped
+with jealousy in the breast of the Long Arrow.
+The Big Throat, Otreouati, was the widest
+famed orator and chief of the Onondagas; and
+it was he who had adopted Menard as his son.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_143' name='page_143'></a>143</span>
+Above all, the Long Arrow would not dare
+to do away with so important a prisoner before
+he could be brought before the council.</p>
+<p>The maid was leaning forward, following
+their words intently. &#8220;Oh, M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; she said,
+&#8220;I cannot understand it all. What will they
+do with you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard hesitated, and replied in French without
+turning his head: &#8220;They will take us to
+their villages below Lake Ontario. They will
+not harm you, under Father Claude&#8217;s protection.
+And then it is likely that we may be
+rescued before they can get off the river.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But yourself, M&#8217;sieu? They are angry
+with you. What will they do?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Lieutenant Danton and I must look out
+for ourselves. I shall hope that we may find
+a way out.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Long Arrow was looking closely at
+them, evidently resenting a woman&#8217;s voice in
+the talk. At the silence, he spoke in the same
+low voice, but Menard and Father Claude read
+the emotion underneath.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It may be that the Big Buffalo has never
+had a son to brighten his days as his life
+reaches the downward years. It may be that
+he has not watched the papoose become a fleet
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_144' name='page_144'></a>144</span>
+youth, and the youth a tireless hunter. He
+may not have waited for the day when the
+young hunter should take his seat at the council
+and speak with those who will hear none but
+wise men. I had such a son. He went on the
+hunt with a band that never returned to the
+village.&#8221; His voice rose above the pitch customary
+to a chief. It was almost cold in its
+intensity. &#8220;I found his body, my brother, the
+body of my son, at this place, killed by the
+white men, who talked to us of the love of their
+gods and their Chief-Across-the-Water. Here
+it was I found him, who died before he would
+become the slave of a white man; and here I
+have captured the man who killed him. It is
+well that we have not killed my brother to-night.
+It is better that we should take him alive before
+the council of the Onondagas, who once were
+proud in their hearts that he was of their own
+nation.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid&#8217;s eyes, shining with tears, were
+fixed on the Indian&#8217;s face. She had caught up
+with her hand the flying masses of her hair and
+braided them hastily; but still there were locks
+astray, touched by the light of the starlit sky.
+Menard turned his head, and watched her during
+the long silence. Danton was watching
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_145' name='page_145'></a>145</span>
+her too. He had not understood the chief&#8217;s
+story, but it was clear from her face that she
+had caught it all. It was Father Claude who
+finally spoke. His voice was gentle, but it had
+the air of authority which his long experience
+had taught him was necessary in dealing with
+the Indians.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo has said wisely. He will
+speak only to the great chiefs of the nation, who
+will understand what may be beyond the minds
+of others. The heart of the Long Arrow is
+sad, his spirit cast down, and he does not see
+now what to-morrow he may,&ndash;&ndash;that the hand
+of the Big Buffalo is not stained with the blood
+of his son. We will go to your village, and
+tell your chiefs many things they cannot yet
+know. For the Big Buffalo and his young
+brother, I shall ask only the justice which the
+Onondagas know best how to give. For myself
+and my sister, I am not afraid. We will
+follow your course, to come back when the
+chiefs shall order it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The two Indians exchanged a few signs, rose,
+and went to the scattered group of braves, who
+were feasting on the white men&#8217;s stores. In a
+moment these had thrown the bundles together,
+and were getting the canoes into the water.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_146' name='page_146'></a>146</span>
+Two warriors cut Danton&#8217;s thongs and raised
+him to his feet. He rubbed his wrists, where
+the thongs had broken the skin, and stepped
+about to get the stiffness from his ankles.
+Then he bent down to set Menard loose,
+but was thrown roughly back.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What&#8217;s this? What&#8217;s the matter? Do
+you understand this, Menard?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think so,&#8221; replied the Captain, quietly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is it?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;A little compliment to me, that is all.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton stood looking at him in surprise,
+until he was hustled to the nearest canoe and
+ordered to take a paddle. He looked back and
+saw four warriors lift Menard, still bound hand
+and foot, and carry him to the other canoe, laying
+him in the bottom beneath the bracing-strips.
+Father Claude, too, was given a paddle.
+Then they glided away over the still water, into
+a mysterious channel that wound from one
+shadow-bound stretch to another, past islands
+that developed faintly from the blackness ahead
+and faded into the blackness behind. The
+lean arms of the Indians swung with a tireless
+rhythm, and their paddles slipped to and fro
+in the water with never a sound, save now and
+then a low splash.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_147' name='page_147'></a>147</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_VIII_THE_MAID_MAKES_NEW_FRIENDS' id='CHAPTER_VIII_THE_MAID_MAKES_NEW_FRIENDS'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER VIII.</h2>
+<h3>THE MAID MAKES NEW FRIENDS.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>The prisoners were allowed some freedom
+in the Onondaga village. They were not
+bound, and they could wander about within call
+of the low hut which had been assigned to them.
+This laxity misled Danton into supposing that
+escape was practicable.</p>
+<p>&#8220;See,&#8221; he said to Menard, &#8220;no one is watching.
+Once the dark has come we can slip
+away, all of us.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard shook his head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Do you see the two warriors sitting by the
+hut yonder,&ndash;&ndash;and the group playing platter
+among the trees behind us? Did you suppose
+they were idling?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They seem to sleep often.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You could not do it. We shall hope to
+get away safely; but it will not be like that.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton was not convinced. He said nothing
+further, but late on that first night he made
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_148' name='page_148'></a>148</span>
+the attempt alone. The others were asleep,
+and suspected nothing until the morning.
+Then Father Claude, who came and went freely
+among the Indians, brought word that he had
+been caught a league to the north. The Indians
+bound him, and tied him to stakes in a strongly
+guarded hut. This much the priest learned
+from Tegakwita, the warrior who had guarded
+them on the night of their capture. After Menard&#8217;s
+appeal to his gratitude he had shown a
+willingness to be friendly, and, though he
+dared do little openly, he had given the captives
+many a comfort on the hard journey
+southward.</p>
+<p>Later in the morning Menard and Mademoiselle
+St. Denis were sitting at the door of their
+hut. The irregular street was quiet, excepting
+for here and there a group of naked children
+playing, or a squaw passing with a load of firewood
+on her back. An Indian girl came in
+from the woods toward them. She was of
+light, strong figure, with a full face and long
+hair, which was held back from her face by
+bright ribbons. Her dress showed more than
+one sign of Mission life. She was cleaner than
+most of the Indians, and was not unattractive.
+She came to them without hesitation.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_149' name='page_149'></a>149</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;I am Tegakwita&#8217;s sister. My name is
+Mary; the Fathers at the Mission gave it to
+me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard hardly gave her a glance, but Mademoiselle
+was interested.</p>
+<p>&#8220;That is not your Indian name?&#8221; she asked.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&ndash;&ndash;Mary.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Did you never have another?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;My other name is forgotten.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;These Mission girls like to ape our ways,&#8221;
+said Menard, in French.</p>
+<p>The girl looked curiously at them, then she
+untied a fold of her skirt, and showed a heap of
+strawberries. &#8220;For the white man&#8217;s squaw,&#8221;
+she said.</p>
+<p>Mademoiselle blushed and laughed. &#8220;Thank
+you,&#8221; she replied, holding out her hands. The
+girl gave her the berries, and turned away.
+Menard looked up as a thought came to him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Wait, Mary. Do you know where the
+young white chief is?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. He tried to run away. He cannot
+run away from our warriors.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Are you afraid to go to him?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brother, Tegakwita, is guarding him.
+I am not afraid.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard went to a young birch tree that stood
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_150' name='page_150'></a>150</span>
+near the hut, peeled off a strip of bark, and
+wrote on it:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If you try to escape again you will endanger
+my plans. Keep your patience, and I can
+save you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will you take him some berries, and give
+him this charm with them?&#8221;</p>
+<p>She took the note, rolled it up with a nod,
+and went away. Menard saw the question in
+Mademoiselle&#8217;s eyes, and said: &#8220;It was a warning
+to be cool. Our hope is in getting the
+good-will of the chiefs.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will they&ndash;&ndash;will they hurt him, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I hope not. At least we are still alive and
+safe; and years ago, Mademoiselle, I learned
+how much that means.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid looked into the trees without replying.
+Her face had lost much of its fulness,
+and only the heavy tan concealed the worn outlines.
+But her eyes were still bright, and her
+spirit, now that the first shock had passed, was
+firm.</p>
+<p>Father Claude returned, after a time, with a
+heavy face. He drew Menard into the hut, and
+told him what he had gathered: that the Long
+Arrow and his followers were planning a final
+vengeance against Captain Menard. All the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_151' name='page_151'></a>151</span>
+braves knew of it; everywhere they were talking
+of it, and preparing for the feasting and
+dancing.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They will wait until after the fighting, won&#8217;t
+they?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, M&#8217;sieu. It is planned to begin soon,
+within a day or two.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Have you inquired for the Big Throat?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He is five leagues away, at the next village.
+We can hardly hope for help from him, I fear.
+All the tribes are preparing to join in fighting
+our troops.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard paused to think.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It looks bad, Father.&#8221; He walked up and
+down the hut. &#8220;The Governor&#8217;s column must
+have followed up the river within a few days of
+us. Then much time was lost in getting us
+down here.&#8221; He turned almost fiercely to the
+priest. &#8220;Why, the campaign may have opened
+already. Word may come to-morrow from the
+Senecas calling out the Onondagas and Cayugas.
+Do you know what that means? It
+means that I have failed,&ndash;&ndash;for the first time in
+my life, Father,&ndash;&ndash;miserably failed. There must
+be some way out. If I could only get word to
+the Big Throat. I&#8217;m certain I could talk him
+over. I have done it before.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_152' name='page_152'></a>152</span></p>
+<p>Father Claude had never before seen despair
+in Menard&#8217;s eyes.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You speak well, M&#8217;sieu. There must be
+some way. God is with us.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Captain was again pacing the beaten
+floor. Finally he came to the priest, and took
+his arm. &#8220;I don&#8217;t know what it is that gives
+me courage, Father, but at my age a man isn&#8217;t
+ready to give up. They may kill me, if they
+like, but not before I&#8217;ve carried out my orders.
+The Onondagas must not join the Senecas.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;began the priest.</p>
+<p>Menard shook his head. &#8220;I don&#8217;t know yet,&ndash;&ndash;but
+we can do it.&#8221; He went out of doors,
+as if the sunlight could help him, and during
+the rest of the day and evening he roamed
+about or lay motionless under the trees. The
+maid watched him until dark, but kept silent;
+for Father Claude had told her, and she, too,
+believed that he would find a way.</p>
+<p>Late in the evening Father Claude began to
+feel disturbed. Menard was still somewhere
+off among the trees. He had come in for his
+handful of grain, at the supper hour, but with
+hardly a word. The Father had never succeeded,
+save on that one occasion when Danton
+was the subject, in carrying on a long
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_153' name='page_153'></a>153</span>
+conversation with the maid; and now after a
+few sorry attempts he went out of doors. He
+thought of going to the Captain, to cheer his
+soul and prepare his mind for whatever fate
+awaited him, but his better judgment held
+him back.</p>
+<p>The village had no surface excitement to
+suggest coming butchery and war. The children
+were either asleep or playing in the open.
+Warriors walked slowly about, wrapped closely
+in blankets, though the night was warm. The
+gnats and mosquitoes were humming lazily, the
+trees barely stirring, and the voices of gossiping
+squaws or merry youths blended into a low
+drone. There was the smell in the air of wood
+and leaves burning, from a hundred smouldering
+fires. Father Claude stood for a long time
+gazing at the row of huts, and wondering that
+such an air of peace and happiness could hover
+over a den of brute savages, who were even at
+the moment planning to torture to his death
+one of the bravest sons of New France.</p>
+<p>While he meditated, he was half conscious of
+voices near at hand. He gave it no attention
+until his quick ear caught a French word. He
+started, and hurried to the hut, pausing in the
+door. By the dim light of the fire, that burned
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_154' name='page_154'></a>154</span>
+each night in the centre of the floor, he could
+see Mademoiselle standing against the wall,
+with hands clasped and lips parted. Nearer,
+with his back to the door, stood an Indian.</p>
+<p>The maid saw the Father, but did not speak.
+He came forward into the hut, and gently
+touched the Indian&#8217;s arm.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is it?&#8221; he asked in Iroquois.</p>
+<p>The Indian stood, without a reply, until the
+silence grew heavy. Mademoiselle had straightened
+up, and was watching with fascinated eyes.
+Then, slowly, the warrior turned, and beneath
+buckskin and feathers, dirt and smeared colours,
+the priest recognized Danton. He turned sadly
+to the maid.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I do not understand,&#8221; he said.</p>
+<p>She put her hands before her eyes. &#8220;I cannot
+talk to him,&#8221; she said, in a broken voice.
+&#8220;Why does he come? Why must I&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; Then
+she collected herself, and came forward. Pity
+and dignity were in her voice. &#8220;I am sorry,
+Lieutenant Danton. I am very sorry.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The boy choked, and Father Claude drew
+him, unresisting, outside the hut.</p>
+<p>&#8220;How did you come here, Danton? Tell
+me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton looked at him defiantly.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_155' name='page_155'></a>155</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;What does this mean? Where did you get
+these clothes?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It matters not where I got them. It is my
+affair.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Who gave you these clothes?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is enough that I have friends, if those
+whom I thought friends will not aid me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest was pained by the boy&#8217;s rough
+words.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I am sorry for this, my son,&ndash;&ndash;for this
+strange disorder. Did you not receive a message
+from your Captain?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Danton hesitated. &#8220;Yes,&#8221; he said at last.
+&#8220;I received a message,&ndash;&ndash;an order to lie quiet,
+and let these red beasts burn me to death.
+Menard is a fool. Does he not know that they
+will kill him? Does he not know that this is
+his only chance to escape? He is a fool, I say.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You forget, my son.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, if I do? Must I stay here for the
+torture because my Captain commands? Why
+do you hold me here? Let me go. They will
+be after me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Wait, Danton. What have you said to
+Mademoiselle?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The boy looked at him, and for a moment
+could not speak.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_156' name='page_156'></a>156</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Do you, too, throw that at me, Father? It
+was all I could do. I thought she cared for
+her life more than for&ndash;&ndash;for Menard. No, let
+me go on. I have risked everything to come
+for her, and she&ndash;&ndash;she&ndash;&ndash;I did not know it
+would be like this.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But what do you plan?&#8221; The priest&#8217;s voice
+was more gentle. &#8220;Where are you going?
+You cannot get to Frontenac alone.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t know,&#8221; replied Danton wearily,
+turning away. &#8220;I don&#8217;t care now. I may as
+well go to the devil.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Without a word of farewell he walked boldly
+off through the trees, drawing his blanket
+about his shoulders. Father Claude stood
+watching him, half in mind to call Menard,
+then hesitating. Already the boy was committed:
+he had broken his bonds, and to make
+any effort to hold him meant certain death for
+him. Perhaps it was better that he should take
+the only chance left to him. The hut was
+silent. He looked within, and saw the maid
+still standing by the wall. Her eyes were on
+him, but she said nothing, and he turned away.
+He walked slowly up and down under the
+great elms that arched far up over his head.
+At last he looked about for the Captain, and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_157' name='page_157'></a>157</span>
+finding him some little way back in the woods,
+told him the story.</p>
+<p>Menard&#8217;s face had aged during the day.
+His eyes had a dull firmness in place of the old
+flash. He heard the account without a word,
+and, at the close, when the priest looked at
+him questioningly for a reply, he shook his
+head sadly. His experiment with Danton had
+failed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;He didn&#8217;t tell you who had helped him?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, M&#8217;sieu. It is very strange.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; said Menard, &#8220;it is.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The night passed without further incident.
+Early in the morning, Father Claude went out
+to find Tegakwita, and learn what news had
+come in during the night of the French
+column. Runners were employed in passing
+daily between the different villages, keeping
+each tribe fully informed.</p>
+<p>Menard sat before the hut. The clearing
+showed more life than on the preceding day.
+Bands of warriors, hunting and scouting parties,
+were coming in at short intervals, scattering to
+their shelters or hurrying to the long building
+in the centre of the village. The growing
+boys and younger warriors ran about, calling to
+one another in eager, excited voices. As the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_158' name='page_158'></a>158</span>
+morning wore along, grave chiefs and braves,
+wrapped in their blankets, walked by on their
+way to the council house.</p>
+<p>The maid, after Father Claude had gone,
+watched the Captain for a long time through
+the open door. The conversation with the
+Long Arrow, on the night of their capture, had
+been burned into her memory; and now, as
+she looked at Menard&#8217;s drawn face and weary
+eyes, the picture came to her again of the Long
+Arrow sitting by the river in the dim light of
+the stars,&ndash;&ndash;and of the white man who had
+fought for her, lying before him, gazing upward
+and speaking with a calm voice to the stern
+chief who wished to kill him. Then, in spite
+of the excitement, the danger, and exhaustion
+of the fight, it had seemed that the Captain
+could not long be held by this savage. His
+stern manner, his command, had given her a
+confidence which had, until this moment,
+strengthened her. But now, of a sudden, she
+saw in his eyes the look of a man who sees
+no way ahead. This quarrel with the Long
+Arrow was no matter of open warfare, even of
+race against race; it was an eye for an eye, the
+demand of a crazed father for the life of the
+slayer of his son. That she could do nothing,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_159' name='page_159'></a>159</span>
+that she must sit feebly while he went to his
+death, came to her with a dead sense of pain.</p>
+<p>With a restless spirit she went out of doors,
+passing him with a little smile; but he did not
+look up. A group of passing youths stopped
+and jeered at him, but he did not give them a
+glance. She shrank back against the building
+until they had gone on.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Do not mind them, Mademoiselle,&#8221; said
+Menard, quietly. &#8220;They will not harm you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She hesitated by his side, half in mind to
+speak to him, to tell him that she knew his
+trouble, and had faith in him, but his bowed
+head was forbidding in its solitude. All about
+the hut, under the spreading trees, was a stretch
+of coarse green sod, dotted with tiny yellow
+flowers and black-centred daisies. She wandered
+over the grass, gathering them until her
+hands were full. Two red boys came by, and
+paused to cry at her, taunting her as if she, too,
+were to meet the fate of a war captive. The
+thought made her shudder, but then, on an
+impulse, she called to them in their own language.
+They looked at each other in surprise.
+She walked toward them, laying down the
+flowers, and holding out her hand. A little
+later, when Menard looked up, he saw her
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_160' name='page_160'></a>160</span>
+sitting beneath a gnarled oak, a boy on either
+side eagerly watching her. She was talking
+and laughing with them, and teaching them to
+make a screeching pipe with grass-blades held
+between the thumbs. He envied her her elastic
+spirits.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You have made two friends,&#8221; he called in
+French.</p>
+<p>She looked up and nodded, laughing. &#8220;They
+are learning to make the music of the white
+brothers.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The boys&#8217; faces had sobered at the sound of
+his voice. They looked at him doubtfully, and
+then at each other. He got up and walked
+slowly toward them.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will make friends, too, Mademoiselle,&#8221; he
+said, smiling. &#8220;We have none too many here.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Before he had taken a dozen steps, the boys
+arose. He held out his hands, saying, &#8220;Your
+father would be friends with his children.&#8221; But
+they began to retreat, a step at a time.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come, my children,&#8221; said the maid, smiling
+at the words as she uttered them. &#8220;The white
+father is good. He will not hurt you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They kept stepping backward until he had
+reached the maid&#8217;s side; then, with a shout of
+defiance, they scampered away. In the distance
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_161' name='page_161'></a>161</span>
+they stopped, and soon were the centre of
+a group of children whom they taught to blow
+on the grass-blades, with many a half-frightened
+glance toward Menard and the maid.</p>
+<p>&#8220;There,&#8221; he said, at length, &#8220;you may see
+the advantage of a reputation.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She looked at him, and, moved by the pathos
+underlying the words, could not, for the moment,
+reply.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I once had a home in this village,&#8221; he
+added. &#8220;It stood over there, in the bare spot
+near the beech tree.&#8221; His eyes rested on the
+spot for a moment, then he turned back to the
+hut.</p>
+<p>&#8220;M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; she said shyly.</p>
+<p>The little heap of flowers lay where she had
+dropped them; and, taking them up, she arranged
+them hastily and held them out. &#8220;Won&#8217;t you
+take them?&#8221;</p>
+<p>He looked at her, a little surprised, then held
+out his hand.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why,&ndash;&ndash;thank you. I don&#8217;t know what I
+can do with them.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They walked back together.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You must wear some of the daisies, Mademoiselle.
+They will look well.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She looked down at her torn, stained dress,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_162' name='page_162'></a>162</span>
+and laughed softly; but took the white cluster
+he gave her, and thrust the stems through a
+tattered bit of lace on her breast.</p>
+<p>Menard was plainly relieved by the incident.
+He had been worn near to despair, facing a
+difficulty which seemed every moment farther
+from a solution; and now he turned to her
+fresh, light mood as to a refuge.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We must put these in water, Mademoiselle,
+or they will soon lose their bloom.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If we had a cup&ndash;&ndash;?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;A cup? A woodsman would laugh at your
+question. There is the spring, here is the
+birch; what more could you have?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You mean&ndash;&ndash;?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We will make a cup,&ndash;&ndash;if you will hold the
+flowers. They are beautiful, Mademoiselle.
+No nation has such hills and lakes and flowers
+as the Iroquois. The Hurons boast of their
+lake country,&ndash;&ndash;and the Sacs and Foxes, too,
+though they have a duller eye for the picturesque.
+See&ndash;&ndash;the valley yonder&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; He pointed
+through a rift in the foliage to the league-long
+glimpse of green, bound in by the gentle hills
+that rose beyond&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;even to the tired old
+soldier there is nothing more beautiful, more
+peaceful.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_163' name='page_163'></a>163</span></p>
+<p>He peeled a long strip of bark from the birch
+tree, and rolled it into a cup. &#8220;Your needle
+and thread, Mademoiselle,&ndash;&ndash;if they have not
+taken them.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No; I have everything here.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She got her needle, and under his direction
+stitched the edges of the bark.</p>
+<p>&#8220;But it will leak, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He laughed. &#8220;The tree is the Indian&#8217;s
+friend, Mademoiselle. Now it is a pine tree
+that we need. The guards will tell me of one.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He walked over to the little group of warriors
+still at their game of platter,&ndash;&ndash;the one
+never-ceasing recreation of the Onondagas, at
+which they would one day gamble away
+blankets, furs, homes, even squaws, only to
+win them back on the next. They looked at
+him suspiciously when he questioned them;
+but he was now as light of heart as on the day,
+a few weeks earlier, when he had leaned on the
+balcony of the citadel at Quebec, idly watching
+the river. He smiled at them, and after a
+parley the maid saw one tall brave point to a
+tree a few yards farther in the wood. They
+followed him closely with their eyes until he
+was back within the space allowed him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Now, Mademoiselle, we can gum the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_164' name='page_164'></a>164</span>
+seams,&ndash;&ndash;see? It is so easy. The cold water will
+harden it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They went together to the spring and filled
+the cup, first drinking each a draught. He
+rolled a large stone to the hut door, and set
+the cup on it.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, Mademoiselle, it will not stand. I am
+not a good workman, I fear. But then, it is
+not often in a woodsman&#8217;s life that he keeps
+flowers at his door. We must have some
+smaller stones to prop it up.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will get them, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221; In spite of his
+protests she ran out to the path and brought
+some pebbles. &#8220;Now we have decorated our
+home.&#8221; She sat upon the ground, leaning
+against the log wall, and smiling up at him.
+&#8220;Sit down, M&#8217;sieu. I am tired of being solemn,
+we have been solemn so long.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Already the heaviness was coming back on
+the Captain. He wondered, as he looked at
+her, if she knew how serious their situation was.
+It hardly seemed that she could understand it,
+her gay mood was so genuine. She glanced up
+again, and at the sight of the settling lines
+about his mouth and the fading sparkle in his
+eyes, her own eyes, while the smile still hovered,
+grew moist.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_165' name='page_165'></a>165</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;I am sorry,&#8221; she said softly,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;very, very
+sorry.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He sat near by, and fingered the flowers in
+the birch cup. They were both silent. Finally
+she spoke.</p>
+<p>&#8220;M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He looked down.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It may be that you think that&ndash;&ndash;that I do
+not understand. It is not that, M&#8217;sieu. But
+when I think about it, and the sadness comes,
+I know, some way, that it is going to come out
+all right. We are prisoners, but other people
+have been prisoners, too. I have heard of many
+of them from Father Dumont. He himself
+has suffered among the Oneidas. I&ndash;&ndash;I cannot
+believe it, even when it seems the darkest.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I hope you are right, Mademoiselle. I, too,
+have felt that there must be a way. And at the
+worst, they will not dare to hurt Father Claude
+and&ndash;&ndash;you.&#8221; And under his breath he added,
+&#8220;Thank God.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They will not dare to hurt you, M&#8217;sieu.
+They must not do it.&#8221; She rose and stood
+before him. &#8220;When I think of that,&ndash;&ndash;that you,
+who have done so much that I might be safe,
+are in danger, I feel that it would be cowardly
+for me to go away without you. You would
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_166' name='page_166'></a>166</span>
+not have left me, on the river. I know you
+would have died without a thought. And I&ndash;&ndash;if
+anything should happen, M&#8217;sieu; if Father
+Claude and I should be set free, and&ndash;&ndash;without
+you&ndash;&ndash;I could never put it from my thoughts.
+I should always feel that I&ndash;&ndash;that you&ndash;&ndash;no no,
+M&#8217;sieu. They cannot do it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She shook away a tear, and looked at him
+with an honest, fearless gaze. It was the outpouring
+of a grateful heart, true because she
+herself was true, because she could not accept
+his care and sacrifice without a thought of what
+she owed him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You forget,&#8221; he said gently, &#8220;that it was
+not your fault. They could have caught me as
+easily if you had not been there. It is a soldier&#8217;s
+chance, Mademoiselle. He must take
+what life brings, with no complaint. It is the
+young man&#8217;s mistake to be restless, impatient.
+For the rest of us, why, it is our life.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But, M&#8217;sieu, you are not discouraged?
+You have not given up?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, I have not given up.&#8221; He rose and
+looked into her eyes. &#8220;I have come through
+before; I may again. If I am not to get through,
+I shall fight them till I drop. And then, I pray
+God, I may die like a soldier.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_167' name='page_167'></a>167</span></p>
+<p>He turned away and went into the hut.
+He was in the hardest moment of his trial. It
+was the inability to fight, the lack of freedom,
+of weapons, the sense of helplessness, that had
+come nearer to demoralizing Menard than a
+hundred battles. He had been trusted with
+the life of a maid, and, more important still,
+with the Governor&#8217;s orders. He was, it seemed,
+to fail.</p>
+<p>The maid stood looking after him. She
+heard him drop to the ground within. Then
+she roamed aimlessly about, near the building.</p>
+<p>Father Claude came up the path, walking
+slowly and wearily, and entered the hut. A
+moment later Menard appeared in the doorway
+and called:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle.&#8221; As she approached, he
+said gravely, &#8220;I should like it if you will
+come in with us. It is right that you should
+have a voice in our councils.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She followed him in, wondering.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father Claude has news,&#8221; Menard said.</p>
+<p>The priest told them all that he had been
+able to learn. Runners had been coming in
+during the night at intervals of a few hours.
+They brought word of the landing of the French
+column at La Famine. The troops had started
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_168' name='page_168'></a>168</span>
+inland toward the Seneca villages. The Senecas
+were planning an ambush, and meanwhile
+had sent frantic messages to the other tribes
+for aid. The Cayuga chiefs were already on
+the way to meet in council with the Onondagas.
+The chance that the attack might be aimed
+only at the Senecas, to punish them for
+their depredations of the year before, had given
+rise to a peace sentiment among the more prudent
+Onondagas and Cayugas, who feared the
+destruction of their fields and villages. Up to
+the present, none had known where the French
+would strike. But, nevertheless, said the
+priest, the general opinion was favourable to
+taking up the quarrel with the Senecas.</p>
+<p>Further, the French were leaving a rearguard
+of four hundred men in a hastily built
+stockade at La Famine, and the more loose-tongued
+warriors were already talking of an
+attack on this force, cutting the Governor&#8217;s
+communications, and then turning on him from
+the rear, leaving it to the Senecas to engage
+him in front.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_169' name='page_169'></a>169</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_IX_THE_WORD_OF_AN_ONONDAGA' id='CHAPTER_IX_THE_WORD_OF_AN_ONONDAGA'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER IX.</h2>
+<h3>THE WORD OF AN ONONDAGA.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>For a long time after Father Claude had
+finished speaking, the three sat talking over
+the situation. Even the maid had suggestions.
+But when all had been said, when the chances
+of a rescue by the French, or of getting a hearing
+before the council, even of a wild dash for
+liberty, had been gone over and over, their
+voices died away, and the silence was eloquent.
+D&#8217;Orvilliers would know that only capture
+could have prevented them from reaching the
+fort; but even supposing him to believe that
+they were held by the Onondagas, he had
+neither the men nor the authority to fight
+through the Cayuga lakes and hills to reach
+them. As for the Governor&#8217;s column, it would
+have its hands full before marching ten leagues
+from La Famine. Had Menard been alone, he
+would have made the attempt to escape, knowing
+from the start that the chance was near to
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_170' name='page_170'></a>170</span>
+nothing, but glad of the opportunity at least to
+die fighting. But with Mademoiselle to delay
+their progress, and to suffer his fate if captured,
+it was different. As matters stood, she was
+likely to be released with Father Claude, as soon
+as he should be disposed of. And so his mind
+had settled on staying, and dying, if he must,
+alone.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have not known whether to tell all,&#8221; said
+Father Claude, after the silence. &#8220;And yet
+it would seem that Mademoiselle may as well
+know the truth now as later.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You have not told me?&#8221; she said, with reproach
+in her voice. &#8220;Must I always be a
+child to you, Father? If God has seen it best
+to place me here, am I not to help bear the
+burden?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle is right, Father. Hold nothing
+back. Three stout hearts are better than
+two.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest looked gravely at the fire.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The word has gone out,&#8221; he said. &#8220;The
+Long Arrow, by his energy and his eloquence,
+but most of all because he had the courage to
+capture the Big Buffalo in the enemy&#8217;s country
+with but a score of braves, now controls the
+village. To-morrow night the great council will
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_171' name='page_171'></a>171</span>
+begin. The war chiefs of all the Cayuga and
+Onondaga and Oneida and Mohawk villages
+will meet here and decide whether to take up
+the hatchet against the white men. The Long
+Arrow well knows that his power will last only
+until the greater chiefs come, and he will have
+his revenge before his day wanes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;When?&#8221; asked the Captain.</p>
+<p>&#8220;To-morrow morning, M&#8217;sieu. The feasting
+and dancing will begin to-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid was looking at the priest. &#8220;I do
+not understand,&#8221; she said. &#8220;What will he
+do?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He means me, Mademoiselle,&#8221; said the Captain,
+quietly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Not&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; she said, &#8220;not&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; he replied. &#8220;They will bring us no
+food to-night. In the morning they will come
+for me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, M&#8217;sieu, they cannot! They&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; She
+gazed at him, not heeding the tears that suddenly
+came to her eyes and fell down upon her
+cheeks; and, as she looked, she understood what
+was in his mind. &#8220;Why do you not escape,
+M&#8217;sieu? There is yet time,&ndash;&ndash;to-night! You
+are thinking of me, and I&ndash;&ndash;I&ndash;&ndash;Oh, I have
+been selfish&ndash;&ndash;I did not know! We will stay
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_172' name='page_172'></a>172</span>
+here, Father Claude and I. You need not
+think of us; they will not harm us&ndash;&ndash;you told
+me that yourself, M&#8217;sieu. I should be in your
+way, but alone&ndash;&ndash;it is so easy.&#8221; She would
+have gone on, but Menard held up his hand.</p>
+<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; he said, shaking his head, &#8220;no.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Her lips moved, but she saw the expression
+in his eyes, and the words died. She turned to
+Father Claude, but he did not look up.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I do not know,&#8221; said Menard, slowly,
+&#8220;whether the heart of the Big Throat is still
+warm toward me. He was once as my father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He will not be here in time,&#8221; Father
+Claude said. &#8220;He does not start from his village
+until the sun is dropping on the morrow.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid could not take her eyes from
+Menard&#8217;s face. Now that the final word had
+come, now that all the doubts of the unsettled
+day, now only half gone, had settled into a fact
+to be faced, he was himself again, the quiet,
+resolute soldier. Only the set, almost hard
+lines about the mouth told of his suffering.</p>
+<p>&#8220;If we had a friend here,&#8221; he was saying,
+quietly enough, &#8220;it may be that Tegakwita&ndash;&ndash;But
+no, of course not. I had forgotten about
+Danton&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita has lost standing in the tribe for
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_173' name='page_173'></a>173</span>
+allowing Lieutenant Danton to escape. He is
+very bitter, We can ask nothing from him.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, I suppose not.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The cool air of these two men, the manner
+in which they could face the prospect, coupled
+with her own sense of weakness, weighed hard
+upon the maid&#8217;s heart. She felt that she must
+cry out, must in some manner give way to her
+feelings. She rose and hurried into the open
+air. The broad sunlight was still sifting down
+through the leaves and lying upon the green
+earth in bright patches. The robins were singing,
+and many strange birds, whose calls she did
+not know, but who piped gently, musically, so
+in harmony with the soft landscape that their
+notes seemed a part of it. It was all unreal,
+this quiet, sunlit world, where the birds were
+free as the air which bore their songs, while the
+brave Captain&ndash;&ndash;she could not face the thought.</p>
+<p>The birch cup was still on the stone by the
+door. She lifted out the flowers with their
+dripping stems, and rearranged them carefully,
+placing a large yellow daisy in the centre.</p>
+<p>An Indian was approaching up the path. He
+had thrown aside his blanket, and he strode
+rapidly, clad in close-fitting jacket and leggings
+of deerskin, with knife and hatchet slung at his
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_174' name='page_174'></a>174</span>
+waist. He came straight to the hut and entered,
+brushing by her without a glance. Just
+as he passed she recognized him. He was
+Tegakwita. Her fear of these stern warriors
+had suddenly gone, and she followed him into
+the doorway to hear his errand. Menard
+greeted him with a nod; Father Claude, too,
+was silent.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The White Chief, the Big Buffalo, has a
+grateful heart,&#8221; said the Indian, in cutting
+tones. She was glad that she could understand
+him. She took a flower from the bunch
+at her breast, and stood motionless in the low
+doorway, pulling the petals apart, one by one
+and watching the little group within. The
+priest and the Captain were sitting on the
+ground, Menard with his hands clasped easily
+about his knees. Tegakwita stood erect, with
+his back to the door. &#8220;He feels the love of a
+brother for those who would make sacrifices
+for him,&#8221; he went on. &#8220;It was many years
+ago that he saved Tegakwita from the perils of
+the hunt. Tegakwita has not forgotten. When
+the White Chief became a captive, he had not
+forgotten. He has lost his brave name as a
+warrior because he believed in the White Chief.
+He has lost&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; his voice grew tremulous with
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_175' name='page_175'></a>175</span>
+the emotion that lay underneath the words&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;He
+has lost his sister, whom he sent to be a
+sister to the white man and his squaw.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brother speaks strangely,&#8221; said Menard,
+looking up at him half suspiciously.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, it is strange.&#8221; His voice was louder,
+and in his excitement he dropped the indirect
+form of speech that, in the case of an older
+warrior, would have concealed his feelings. &#8220;It
+is strange that you should send my sister, who
+came to you in trust, to release the white brave.
+It is strange you should rob me of her whom
+my father placed by my side.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard and Father Claude looked at each
+other. The Indian watched them narrowly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My son is mistaken,&#8221; said Father Claude,
+quietly. &#8220;His sister has wandered away. It
+may be that she has even now returned.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, my Father. The white brave has stolen
+her.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard got up, and spoke with feeling.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita does not understand. The
+white brave was foolish. He is a young warrior.
+He does not know the use of patience.
+He first escaped against my orders. The word
+I sent by your sister was a command to be
+patient. He went alone, my brother. He has
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_176' name='page_176'></a>176</span>
+gone forever from my camp. It cannot be that
+she&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo speaks lies. Who came
+to cut the white brave&#8217;s bonds? Who stole the
+hunting coat, the leggings of Tegakwita, that
+her lover might go free? Who has dishonoured
+herself, her brother, the father that&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;
+Words failed him, and he stood facing them
+with blazing eyes.</p>
+<p>Menard glanced at the maid, but she had
+passed the point where a shock could sway her,
+and now stood quietly at the door, waiting to
+hear what more the warrior would say. But he
+stood motionless. Father Claude touched his
+arm.</p>
+<p>&#8220;If this is true, Tegakwita, the Big Buffalo
+must not be held to blame. He has spoken
+truly. To talk in these words to the man who
+has been your brother, is the act of a dog. You
+have forgotten that the Big Buffalo never
+speaks lies.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian gave no heed to his words. He
+took a step forward, and raised his hand to his
+knife. Menard smiled contemptuously, and
+spread out his hands; he had no weapon. But
+Tegakwita had a second thought, and dropped
+his hand.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_177' name='page_177'></a>177</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita, too, never speaks lies,&#8221; he said.
+&#8220;He will come back before the sun has come
+again.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He walked rapidly out, crowding roughly
+past the maid.</p>
+<p>Menajd leaned against the wall. &#8220;Poor
+boy!&#8221; he said, &#8220;poor boy!&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid came slowly in, and sat on the
+rude bench which leaned against the logs near
+the door. The strain of the day was drawing
+out all the strength, the womanhood, that lay
+behind her buoyant youth. Already the tan
+was fading from her face, here in the hut and
+under the protecting elms; and the whiteness
+of her skin gave her, instead of a worn appearance,
+the look of an older woman,&ndash;&ndash;firmer, with
+greater dignity. Her eyes had a deeper, fuller
+understanding.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I suppose that there is nothing, M&#8217;sieu&ndash;&ndash;nothing
+that we can do?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard shook his head. &#8220;No; nothing.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And the Indian,&ndash;&ndash;he says that he will come
+back?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. I don&#8217;t know what he means. It
+doesn&#8217;t matter.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, I suppose it doesn&#8217;t.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They were silent for a moment. The
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_178' name='page_178'></a>178</span>
+maid leaned forward. &#8220;What was that,
+M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Loungers, on the path.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, they are coming here.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard rose, but she stepped to the door.
+&#8220;Let me go, M&#8217;sieu. Ah, I see them. It is
+my little friends.&#8221; She went out, and they
+could hear her laughing with the two children,
+and trying to coax them toward the door.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Danton will never get away,&#8221; said the Captain,
+in a low tone to the priest.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I fear not, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He has lost his head, poor boy. I thought
+him of better stuff. And the girl&ndash;&ndash;Ah, if he
+had only gone alone! I could forgive his rashness,
+Father, his disobedience, if only he could
+go down with a clear name.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There is still doubt,&#8221; said the priest, cautiously.
+&#8220;We know only what Tegakwita
+said.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I&#8217;m afraid,&#8221; Menard replied, shaking his
+head, &#8220;I&#8217;m afraid it&#8217;s true. You said he wore
+the hunting clothes. Some one freed him.
+And the girl is gone. I wish&ndash;&ndash;Well, there is
+no use. I hoped for something better, that is
+all.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Just outside the door the maid was talking
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_179' name='page_179'></a>179</span>
+gaily with the two children, who now and then
+raised their piping voices. Then it was evident
+that they were going away, for she was calling
+after them. She came into the hut, smiling,
+and carrying a small willow basket full of
+corn.</p>
+<p>&#8220;See,&#8221; she said, &#8220;even now it is something
+to have made a friend. We shall not go
+hungry to-day, after all. Will you partake,
+Father? And M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>She paused before the Captain. He had
+stepped forward, and was staring at her.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Where are they?&#8221; he asked.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The children? They are wandering along
+the path.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Quick, Mademoiselle! Call them back.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She hesitated, in surprise; then set the basket
+on the ground and obeyed. Menard paced the
+floor until she returned.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They are outside, M&#8217;sieu, too frightened to
+come near.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Give me that birch cup, outside the door.&#8221;
+He was speaking in quick, low tones. &#8220;They
+must not see me. It would frighten them.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She brought him the cup, and he emptied
+the flowers on the floor, tearing open the
+seams, and drying the wet white bark on his
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_180' name='page_180'></a>180</span>
+sleeve. He snatched a charred coal from the
+heap of ashes in the centre of the floor, and
+wrote rapidly in a strange mixture of words
+and signs, &#8220;A piece of thread, Mademoiselle.
+And look again&ndash;&ndash;see that they have not
+gone.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They are waiting, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He rolled the bark tightly, and tied it with
+the thread which she brought from her bundle.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We must have a present. Father Claude,
+you have your bale. Find something quickly,&ndash;&ndash;something
+that will please them. No, wait&ndash;&ndash;Mademoiselle,
+have you a mirror? They
+would run fifty leagues for a mirror.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She nodded, rummaged through her bundle,
+and brought out a small glass.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Take this, Mademoiselle. Tell them to
+give this letter to the Big Throat, at the next
+village. They will know the way. He must
+have it before the day is over. No harm can
+come to them. If anyone would punish them,
+the Big Throat will protect them. You must
+make them do it. They cannot fail.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Her face flushed, and her eyes snapped as
+she caught his nervous eagerness. Even Father
+Claude had risen, and was watching him with
+kindling eyes. She took the roll and the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_181' name='page_181'></a>181</span>
+mirror, and ran out the door. In a moment,
+Menard, pacing the floor, could hear her merry
+laugh, and the shrill-voiced delight of the
+children over their new toy. He caught the
+priest&#8217;s hand.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father, we shall yet be free. Who could
+fail with such a lieutenant as that maid. How
+she laughs. One would think she had never a
+care.&#8221;</p>
+<p>At last she came back, and sank, with a
+nervous, irresponsible little laugh, on the bench.
+And then, for the moment, they all three
+laughed together.</p>
+<p>In the silence that followed, Father Claude
+moved toward the door.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I must go out again, M&#8217;sieu. It may be
+that there is further word.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well, Father. And open your ears
+for news of the poor boy.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest bowed, and went out. Menard
+stood in the door watching him, as he walked
+boldly along the path. After a little he turned.
+The maid was looking at him, still flushed and
+smiling.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, Mademoiselle, we can take hope
+again.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are so brave, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_182' name='page_182'></a>182</span></p>
+<p>He smiled at her impulsiveness, and looked
+at her, hardly conscious that he was causing
+her to blush and lower her eyes.</p>
+<p>&#8220;And so I am brave, Mademoiselle? It may
+be that Major Provost and Major d&#8217;Orvilliers
+will not feel so.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But they must, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Do you know what they will say? They
+will speak with sorrow of Captain Menard, the
+trusted, in whose hands Governor Denonville
+placed the most important commission ever
+given to a captain in New France. They will
+regret that their old friend was not equal to the
+test; that he&ndash;&ndash;ah, do not interrupt, Mademoiselle;
+it is true&ndash;&ndash;that his failure lost a
+campaign for New France. You heard Father
+Claude; you know what these Indians plan to do.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You must not speak so, M&#8217;sieu. It is
+wicked. He would be a coward who could
+blame you. It was not your fault that you were
+captured. When I return I shall go to them
+and tell them how you fought, and how you
+faced them like&ndash;&ndash;like a hero. When I
+return&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; She stopped, as if the word were
+strange.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Aye, Mademoiselle, and God grant that you
+may return soon. But your good heart leads
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_183' name='page_183'></a>183</span>
+you wrong. It was my fault that I did not bring
+a force strong enough to protect myself,&ndash;&ndash;and
+you. To fight is not a soldier&#8217;s first duty. It
+is to be discreet; he must know when not to
+fight as well as when to draw his sword; he
+must know how many men are needed to defend
+his cause. No; I was overconfident, and
+I lost. And there we must leave it. Nothing
+more can be said.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He stood moodily over the heap of ashes.
+When he looked at her again, she had risen.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The flowers, M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; she said, &#8220;you&ndash;&ndash;you
+threw them away.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He glanced down. They lay at his feet.
+Silently he knelt and gathered them.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will you help me, Mademoiselle? We will
+make another cup. And these two large daisies,&ndash;&ndash;did
+you see how they rested side by side
+on the ground when I would have trampled on
+them? You will take one and I the other; and
+when this day shall be far in the past, it may be
+that you will remember it, and how we two
+were here together, waiting for the stroke that
+should change life for us.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He held it out, and she, with lowered eyes,
+reached to take it from his hand, but suddenly
+checked the motion and turned to the door.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_184' name='page_184'></a>184</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Will you take it, Mademoiselle?&#8221;</p>
+<p>She did not move; and he stood, the soldier,
+helpless, waiting for a word. He had forgotten
+everything,&ndash;&ndash;the low, smoke-blackened hut,
+the responsibility that lay on his shoulders, the
+danger of the moment,&ndash;&ndash;everything but the
+slender maid who stood before him, who would
+not take the flower from his hand. Then he
+stepped to her side, and, taking away the other
+flowers from the lace beneath her throat, he
+placed the single daisy in their stead. Her
+eyes were nearly closed, and she seemed hardly
+to know that he was there.</p>
+<p>&#8220;And it may be,&#8221; he whispered softly, &#8220;that
+we, like the flowers, shall be spared.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She turned slowly away, and sank upon the
+bench. Menard, with a strange, new lightness
+in his heart, went out into the sunlight.</p>
+<p>The day wore on. The warm sunbeams,
+that slipped down through the foliage, lengthened
+and reached farther and farther to the
+east. The bright spots of light crept across
+the grass, climbed the side of the hut and the
+tree-trunks, lingered on the upreaching twigs,
+and died away in the blue sky. The evening
+star shot out its white spears, glowing and radiant,
+long before the light had gone, or the purple
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_185' name='page_185'></a>185</span>
+and golden afterglow had faded into twilight.
+Menard&#8217;s mind went back to another day, just
+such a glorious, shining June day as this had
+been, when he had sat not a hundred yards
+from this spot, waiting, as now, for the end.
+He looked at his fingers. They were scarred
+and knotted; one drunken, frenzied squaw had
+mangled them with her teeth. He had wondered
+then how a man could endure such torture
+as had come to him, and still could live
+and think, could even struggle back to health.
+The depression had gone from him now; his
+mind was more alert than since the night of
+the capture. Whether it was the bare chance
+of help from the Big Throat, or the gentle sadness
+in the face of the maid as she bowed her
+head to the single daisy on her breast,&ndash;&ndash;something
+had entered into his nerves and heart,
+something hopeful and strong, He wondered,
+as Father Claude came up the path, slowly,
+laboriously, why the priest should be so saddened.
+After all, the world was green and
+bright, and life, even a few hours of it, was
+sweet.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What news, Father?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest shook his head. &#8220;Little, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Has the feast begun?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_186' name='page_186'></a>186</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Not yet. They are assembling before the
+Long House.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Are they drinking?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There was no need for talk, and so the two
+men sat before the hut, with only an idle word
+now and then, until the dark came down. The
+quiet of the village was broken now by the
+shouts of drinking warriors, with a chanting
+undertone that rose and swelled slowly into
+the song that would continue, both men knew,
+until the break of day, or until none was left
+with sober tongue to carry the wavering air.
+A great fire had been lighted, and they could
+see the glare and the sparks beyond a cluster
+of trees and huts. Later, straggling braves
+appeared, wandering about, bottle or flask in
+hand, crazed by the raw brandy with which the
+English and Dutch of New York and Orange
+and the French of the province alike saw fit to
+keep the Indians supplied.</p>
+<p>A group of the warriors came from the dance,
+and staggered toward the hut of the captives.
+They were armed with knives and hatchets.
+One had an arquebuse, which he fired at the
+trees as often as the uncertain hands of all
+of them could load it. He caught sight of the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_187' name='page_187'></a>187</span>
+white men sitting in the shadow, and came
+toward them, his fellows at his heels.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Move nearer the door,&#8221; whispered Menard.
+&#8220;They must not get in.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The two edged along the ground without
+rising, until they sat with their backs in the
+open doorway. The Indians hung about, a few
+yards away, jeering and shouting. The one
+with the arquebuse evidently wished to shoot,
+but the others were holding his arms, and
+reasoning in thick voices. No construction of
+the Iroquois traditions could make it right to
+kill a prisoner who was held for the torture.</p>
+<p>The white men watched them quietly. Menard
+heard a rustle, and the sound of a quick
+breath behind him, and he said, without taking
+his eyes from the Indians:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Step back, Mademoiselle, behind the wall.
+You must not stand here.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The warrior broke away from the hands that
+held him, staggering a rod across the grass
+before he could recover his balance. The
+others went after him, but he quickly rested the
+piece and fired. The ball went over their
+heads through the doorway, striking with a low
+noise against the rear wall. Menard rose,
+jerking away from the priest&#8217;s restraining hand.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_188' name='page_188'></a>188</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle,&#8221; he said, &#8220;you are not hurt?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Thank God!&#8221; He stood glaring at the
+huddled band of warriors, who were trying to
+reload the arquebuse; then he bounded forward,
+broke into the group with a force that sent two
+to the ground, snatched the weapon, and, with
+a quick motion, drew out the flint. He threw
+the gun on the ground, and walked back to his
+seat.</p>
+<p>Two of the guards came running forward.
+They had not been drinking, and one of them
+ordered the loafers away. This did not strike
+them amiss. They started off, trying to reload
+as they walked, evidently not missing the flint.</p>
+<p>The maid came again to the doorway, and
+asked timidly:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is there danger for you, M&#8217;sieu? Will
+they come back?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. It is merely a lot of drunken youths.
+They have probably forgotten by now. Can
+you sleep, Mademoiselle?&ndash;&ndash;have you tried?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, I&ndash;&ndash;I fear that I could not.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It would be well to make the effort,&#8221; he
+said gently, looking over his shoulder at her as
+she leaned against the doorpost. &#8220;We do not
+know what may happen. At any rate, even if
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_189' name='page_189'></a>189</span>
+you escape, you will need all your strength on
+the morrow. A fallen captain may not command,
+Mademoiselle, but&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If it is your command, M&#8217;sieu, I will try.
+Good night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There was a long stillness, broken only by
+the distant noises of the dance.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You, too, will sleep, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221; said Father
+Claude. &#8220;I will watch.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, no, Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I beg it of you. At the least you will let
+me divide the night with you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We shall see, we shall see. There is much to
+be said before either of us closes his eyes.
+Hello, here is a runner.&#8221;</p>
+<p>An Indian was loping up the path. He
+turned in toward the hut.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Quiet,&#8221; said the priest. &#8220;It is Tegakwita.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The warrior had run a long way. He was
+breathing deeply, and the sweat stood out on
+his face and caught the shine of the firelight.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brother has been far,&#8221; said Menard,
+rising.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The White Chief is not surprised? He
+heard the word of Tegakwita, that he would
+return before another sun. He has indeed
+been far. He has followed the track of the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_190' name='page_190'></a>190</span>
+forest wolf that stole the child of the Onondagas.
+He has found the bold, the brave white
+warrior, who stole away in the night, robbing
+Tegakwita of what is dearer to him than the
+beating of his heart.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid stood again in the doorway, resting
+a hand on the post, and leaning forward with
+startled eyes.</p>
+<p>&#8220;He has found&ndash;&ndash;he has found him&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; she
+faltered.</p>
+<p>The Indian did not look at her. He drew
+something from the breast of his shirt, and
+threw it on the ground at Menard&#8217;s feet. Then,
+with broken-hearted dignity, he strode away
+and disappeared in the night.</p>
+<p>Father Claude stooped, and picked up the
+object. Dimly in the firelight they could see
+it,&ndash;&ndash;two warm human scalps, the one of brown
+hair knotted to the other of black. Menard
+took them in his hand.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Poor boy!&#8221; he said, over and over. &#8220;Poor
+boy!&#8221;</p>
+<p>He looked toward the door, but the maid
+had gone inside.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_191' name='page_191'></a>191</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_X_A_NIGHT_COUNCIL' id='CHAPTER_X_A_NIGHT_COUNCIL'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER X.</h2>
+<h3>A NIGHT COUNCIL.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>The night crept by, as had the day, wearily.</p>
+<p>The two men sat in the doorway or
+walked slowly back and forth across the front
+of the hut, saying little. The Captain was calling
+to mind every incident of their capture, and
+of the original trouble between La Grange and
+the hunting party. He went over the conversation
+with Major Provost at Quebec word by
+word, until he felt sure in his authority as the
+Governor&#8217;s representative; although the written
+orders in the leather bag that hung from
+his neck were concerned only with his duties
+in preparing Fort Frontenac for the advancing
+column,&ndash;&ndash;duties that he had not fulfilled.</p>
+<p>A plan was forming in his mind which would
+make strong demands on the good faith of
+Major Provost and the Governor. He knew,
+as every old soldier knows, that governments
+and rulers are thankless, that even written authority
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_192' name='page_192'></a>192</span>
+is none too binding, if to make it good
+should inconvenience those who so easily give
+it. He knew further that if he should succeed
+now in staying the Onondagas and Cayugas by
+pledges which, perchance, it might not please
+Governor Denonville to observe, the last frail
+ties that held the Iroquois to the French would
+be broken, and England would reign from the
+Hudson to the river of the Illinois. And he
+sighed, as he had sighed many times before, for
+the old days under Frontenac, under the only
+Governor of New France who could hold these
+slippery redskins to their obligations.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father,&#8221; he said finally, &#8220;I begin to see a
+way.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Throat?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He must help, though to tell the truth I
+fear that he will be of little service. He may
+come in time to give us a stay; but, chief
+though he is, he will hardly dare overrule
+the Long Arrow on a matter so personal as
+this.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is the Long Arrow&#8217;s family&ndash;&ndash;the
+Beaver?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But, M&#8217;sieu, that is the least of the eight
+families. If it were the Tortoise or the Bear
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_193' name='page_193'></a>193</span>
+against us, we should have greater cause for
+fear.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;True, Father, but to each family belongs
+its own quarrels, its own revenge. If the Big
+Throat should interfere too deeply, it would
+anger the other small families, who might fear
+the same treatment at some other time. And
+with Beaver, Snipe, Deer, and Potato united
+against us,&ndash;&ndash;well, it is a simple enough problem.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They were walking by the door, and Menard,
+as he spoke, sat on the stone which he had
+rolled there in the afternoon. The priest stood
+before him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I hope we may succeed, my son. I have
+seen this anger before, and it has always ended
+in the one way.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Of course,&#8221; the Captain replied, &#8220;it does depend
+on the Big Throat. He must reach here
+in time.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;God grant that he may!&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;In that case, Father, I look for a delay.
+Unless his heart has hardened rapidly, he still
+thinks of me. Together we will go to him,
+and ask a hearing in the war council.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oratory will not release us, I fear, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We shall not ask to be released, Father.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_194' name='page_194'></a>194</span>
+Don&#8217;t you understand? It is more than that
+we shall demand,&ndash;&ndash;it is peace with New
+France, the safety of the column&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest&#8217;s eyes lighted. &#8220;Do you think,
+M&#8217;sieu&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We can do it. They have not heard all
+the truth. They do not want a long war which
+will kill their braves and destroy their homes
+and their corn. It is this attack on the Senecas
+that has drawn them out.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will tell them that the Governor fights
+only the Senecas?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;More than that. The La Grange affair has
+stirred them up. It has weakened their faith
+in the Governor,&ndash;&ndash;it has as good as undone
+all the work of twenty years past. Our only
+hope is to reestablish that faith.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I hope that we may,&#8221; said the priest, slowly.
+&#8220;But they have reached a state now where
+words alone will hardly suffice. I have tried
+it, M&#8217;sieu. Since we came, I have talked and
+reasoned with them.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, Father, I am going to try it. The
+question is, will the Governor make good what
+I shall have to promise? It may be that he
+will. If not,&ndash;&ndash;then my life will not be worth
+a box of tinder if I stray a league from Quebec
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_195' name='page_195'></a>195</span>
+without a guard.&#8221; He looked down at the
+daisy on his coat. &#8220;But the maid will be safe,
+Father. She will be safe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I do not believe that they would harm her,
+even as it is.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, I trust not&ndash;&ndash;I trust not. But we are
+here, and she is here; and not until I know
+that her journey is over will my eyes close
+easily at night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But your plan, M&#8217;sieu,&ndash;&ndash;you have not
+told me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah, I thought you understood. Did you
+know about the capture at Frontenac when it
+happened? No? It was like this. The Governor
+sent word, with the orders that came up
+to the fort in May, that at the first sign of
+trouble or disturbance with the Indians there,
+d&#8217;Orvilliers should seize a few score of them
+and send them down the river in chains. It
+would be an example, he said. I was awaiting
+orders,&ndash;&ndash;I had just returned from the Huron
+Country and Michillimackinac,&ndash;&ndash;and d&#8217;Orvilliers
+called me to his rooms and showed me the
+order. &#8216;Now,&#8217; he said, &#8216;who in the devil is
+meddling at Quebec?&#8217; I did not know; I do
+not know yet. But there was the order. He
+turned it over to La Grange, with instructions
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_196' name='page_196'></a>196</span>
+to wait until some offence should give him an
+excuse.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I know the rest, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, yes. You have heard a dozen times,&ndash;&ndash;how
+La Grange was drinking, and how he
+lied to a peaceful hunting party, and drugged
+them, and brained one poor devil with his own
+sword. And what could we do, Father? Right
+or wrong, the capture was made. It was too
+late to release them, for the harm was done.
+If d&#8217;Orvilliers had refused to carry out his
+orders and send them to Quebec, it would have
+cost him his commission.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And you, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I was the only officer on detached service
+at the Fort. D&#8217;Orvilliers could not look me
+in the face when he ordered me to take them.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will tell them this?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;This? Yes, and more. I will pledge the
+honour of New France that La Grange shall
+suffer. The man who has betrayed the Onondagas
+must be punished before we can have
+their good faith. Don&#8217;t you understand?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude walked away a few steps, and
+then back, his hands clasped before him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Don&#8217;t you understand, Father? If a wrong
+has been done an Iroquois, it is revenge that
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_197' name='page_197'></a>197</span>
+will appease him. Very well. Captain la
+Grange has wronged them; let them have
+their revenge.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is that the right view, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Not for us, Father,&ndash;&ndash;for you and me. To
+us it is simple justice. But justice,&ndash;&ndash;that is
+not the word with which to reach an Indian.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But it may be that Captain la Grange is
+in favour at Quebec. What then?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You do not seem to understand me yet,
+Father.&#8221; Menard spoke slowly and calmly.
+&#8220;This is not my quarrel. I can take what my
+life brings, and thank your God, the while,
+that I have life at all. But if by one foolish
+act the Iroquois are to be lost to France, while
+I have the word on my tongue that will set
+all right, am I,&ndash;&ndash;well, would you have me such
+a soldier?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest was looking through the leaves
+at the firelight. For once he seemed to have
+nothing to offer.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It will not be easy, Father; but when was
+a soldier&#8217;s work easy? First I must make
+these Indians believe me,&ndash;&ndash;and you know
+how hard that will be. Then I must convince
+Governor Denonville that this is his only
+course; and that will be still harder. Or, if
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_198' name='page_198'></a>198</span>
+they will not release me, you will be my messenger,
+Father, and take the word. I will
+stay here until La Grange has got his dues.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Let us suppose,&#8221; said the priest,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;let us
+suppose that you did not do this, that you did
+not take this course against Captain la Grange
+which will leave him a marked man to the Iroquois,
+even if the Governor should do nothing.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Then,&#8221; said Menard, &#8220;the rear-guard at La
+Famine will be butchered, and the army of
+New France will be cut to pieces. That is
+all.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are sure of this?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It points that way, Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Then let us take another case. Suppose
+that you succeed at the council, that you are
+released. Then if the Governor should disclaim
+responsibility, should&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Then, Father, I will go to La Grange and
+make him fight me. I mean to pledge my
+word to these chiefs. You know what that
+means.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; replied the priest, &#8220;yes.&#8221; He seemed
+puzzled and unsettled by some thought that
+held his mind. He walked slowly about, looking
+at the ground. Menard, too, was restless.
+He rose from the stone and tossed away the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_199' name='page_199'></a>199</span>
+pebbles that had supported the cup, one at a
+time.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They are singing again,&#8221; he said, listening
+to the droning chant that came indistinctly
+through the dark. &#8220;One would think they
+would long ago have been too drunk to stand.
+How some of these recruits the King sends over
+to us would envy them their stomachs.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest made no reply. He did not understand
+the impulse that led the Captain to speak
+irrelevantly at such a moment.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I suppose the doctors are dancing now,&#8221;
+Menard continued. &#8220;It may be that they will
+come here. If they do, we shall have a night
+of it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We will hope not, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If they should, Father,&ndash;&ndash;well, it is hard to
+know just what to do.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You were thinking&ndash;&ndash;?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, I was wondering. If they come here,
+and let their wild talk run away with them, it
+might be well to fight them off until morning.
+Maybe we could do it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, it might seem best.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But if&ndash;&ndash;if the Big Throat should not come,
+or should have changed, then it would have been
+better that I had submitted.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_200' name='page_200'></a>200</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;You are thinking of me, my son. You
+must not. I will not leave you to go without
+a struggle. I can fight, if needs be, as well as
+you. I will do my part.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is not that, Father. But if we fight, and
+the Big Throat does not come,&ndash;&ndash;there is the
+maid. They would not spare her then.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest looked at the Captain, and in the
+dim, uncertain light he saw something of the
+thought that lay behind those wearied eyes.</p>
+<p>&#8220;True,&#8221; he said; &#8220;true.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard walked up and down, a half-dozen
+steps forward, a half-dozen back, without a
+glance at the priest, who watched him closely.
+Suddenly he turned, and the words that were
+in his mind slipped unguarded from his tongue,
+low and stern:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If they come, Father,&ndash;&ndash;if they harm her,&ndash;&ndash;God!
+if they even wake her, I will kill them.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude looked at him, but said nothing.
+They walked together up and down; then,
+as if weary, they sat again by the door.</p>
+<p>&#8220;There are some things which I could not
+talk over with you,&#8221; said the priest, finally. &#8220;It
+was best that I should not. And now I hardly
+know what is the right thing for me to do, or
+to say.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_201' name='page_201'></a>201</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;What troubles you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;When you are cooler, it will come to you.
+For to-night,&ndash;&ndash;until our last moment of choice,&ndash;&ndash;I
+must ask one favour, M&#8217;sieu. You will not
+decide on this course until it comes to the end.
+You will think of other ways; you will&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What else have I been doing, Father?
+There is no other way.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But you will not decide yet?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. We need not, to-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest seemed relieved.</p>
+<p>&#8220;M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; came in a low voice from the darkness
+within the hut, &#8220;may I not sit with
+you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are awake, Mademoiselle? You have
+not been sleeping?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, I could not. I&ndash;&ndash;I have not heard you,
+M&#8217;sieu,&ndash;&ndash;I have not listened. But I wanted
+to very much. I have only my thoughts, and
+they are not the best of company to-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come.&#8221; Menard rose and got one of the
+priest&#8217;s blankets, folding it and laying it on the
+ground against the wall. &#8220;I fear that we may
+be no better than the thoughts; but such as we
+are, we are at the service of Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She sat by them, and leaned back, letting her
+hands fall into her lap. Menard was half in the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_202' name='page_202'></a>202</span>
+shadow, and he could let his eyes linger on her
+face. It was a sad face now, worn by the haunting
+fears that the night had brought,&ndash;&ndash;fears that
+had not held their substance in the sunlight;
+but the eyes were still bright. Even at this
+moment she had not forgotten to catch up
+the masses of hair that were struggling to be
+free; and there was a touch of neatness about
+her torn dress that the hardships of the journey
+and the dirt and discomforts of an Indian shelter
+had not been able to take away. They all three
+sat without talking, watching the sparks from
+the fire and the tips of flame that now and then
+reached above the huts.</p>
+<p>&#8220;How strange their song is, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. They will keep it up all night. If we
+were nearer, you would see that as soon as a
+brave is exhausted with the dancing and singing,
+another will rush in to take his place.
+Sometimes they fall fainting, and do not recover
+for hours.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I saw a dance once, at home. The Ottawas&ndash;&ndash;there
+were but a few of them&ndash;&ndash;had a war-dance.
+It seemed to be just for amusement.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They enjoy it. It is not uncommon for
+them to dance for a day when there is no hunt
+to occupy them.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_203' name='page_203'></a>203</span></p>
+<p>Father Claude had been silent. Now he rose
+and walked slowly away, leaving them to talk
+together. They could see him moving about
+with bowed head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Father is sad, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. But it is not for himself.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Does he fear now? Does he not think
+that the Big Throat will come?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think he will come.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid looked down at her clasped hands.
+Menard watched her,&ndash;&ndash;the firelight was dancing
+on her face and hair,&ndash;&ndash;and again the danger
+seemed to slip away, the chant and the fire
+to be a part of some mad dream that had carried
+him in a second from Quebec to this deep-shadowed
+spot, and had set this maid before
+him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are wearing the daisy, Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She looked up, half-startled at the change in
+his voice. Then her eyes dropped again.</p>
+<p>&#8220;See,&#8221; he continued, &#8220;so am I. Is it not
+strange that we should be here, you and I.
+And yet, when I first saw you, I thought&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You thought, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard laughed gently. &#8220;I could not tell
+you, without telling you what I think now, and
+that would&ndash;&ndash;be&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_204' name='page_204'></a>204</span></p>
+<p>He spoke half playfully, and waited; but she
+did not reply.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I do not know what it is that has come to
+me. It is not like me. Or it may be that the
+soldier, all these years, has not been me. Would
+it not be strange if I were but now to find myself,&ndash;&ndash;or
+if you were to find me, Mademoiselle?
+If it is true, if this is what I have waited so
+long to find, it would be many years before I
+could repay you for bringing it to me,&ndash;&ndash;it
+would be a long lifetime.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Again he waited, and still she was silent.
+Then he talked on, as madly now as on the
+night of their capture, when he had fought,
+shouting, musket and knife in hand, at the
+water&#8217;s edge. But this was another madness.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is such a simple thing. Until you came
+out here under the trees my mind was racked
+with the troubles about us. But now you are
+here, and I do not care,&ndash;&ndash;no, not if this
+were to be my last night, if to-morrow they
+should&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; She made a nervous gesture, but
+he went on.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You see it is you, Mademoiselle, who come
+into my life, and then all the rest goes out.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Don&#8217;t,&#8221; she said brokenly. &#8220;Don&#8217;t.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude came slowly toward them.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_205' name='page_205'></a>205</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;My child,&#8221; he said, &#8220;if you are not too
+wearied, I wish to talk with you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She rose with an air of relief and joined him.
+Menard watched them, puzzled. He could
+hear the priest speaking in low, even tones;
+and then the maid&#8217;s voice, deep with emotion.
+Finally they came back, and she went
+hurriedly into the hut without a glance at
+the soldier, who had risen and stood by the
+door.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come, M&#8217;sieu, let us walk.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard looked at him in surprise, but
+walked with him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is about the speech to the council&ndash;&ndash;and
+Captain la Grange. It may be that you are
+right, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Right? I do not understand.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It was but a moment ago that we talked
+of it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, I have not forgotten. But what do
+you mean now?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You promised me to wait before deciding.
+It may be that I was wrong. If you are to
+make the speech, you will need to prepare it
+carefully. There is none too much time.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; said Menard. Then suddenly he
+stopped and took the priest&#8217;s arm. &#8220;I did
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_206' name='page_206'></a>206</span>
+not think, Father; I did not understand.
+What a fool I am!&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, no, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You have talked with her. He is her
+cousin, and yet it did not come to me. It
+will pain her.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; said Father Claude, slowly, &#8220;it will
+pain her. But I have been thinking. I fear
+that you are right. It has passed beyond the
+simple matter of our own lives; now it is New
+France that must be thought of. You have
+said that it was Captain la Grange&#8217;s treachery
+that first angered the Onondagas. We must
+lay this before them. If his punishment will
+satisfy them, will save the rear-guard, why then,
+my son, it is our duty.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They paced back and forth in silence.
+Menard&#8217;s heavy breathing and his quick
+glances toward the hut told the priest something
+of the struggle that was going on in his
+mind. Suddenly he said:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will go to her, Father. I will tell her. I
+cannot pledge myself to this act if&ndash;&ndash;if she&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, M&#8217;sieu, you must not; I have told her.
+She understands. And she has begged me
+to ask you not to speak with her. She has a
+brave heart, but she cannot see you now.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_207' name='page_207'></a>207</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;She asked you,&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; said the Captain, slowly.
+&#8220;She asked you&ndash;&ndash;I cannot think. I do not
+know what to say.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest quietly walked back to the stone
+by the door, and left the soldier to fight out the
+battle alone. It was half an hour before he
+came back and stood before Father Claude.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard spoke shortly, &#8220;Yes, Father, you are
+right.&#8221;</p>
+<p>That was all, but it told the priest that the
+matter had been finally settled. He had seen
+the look in the Captain&#8217;s eyes when the truth
+had come to him; and he knew now what he had
+not dreamed before, that the soldier&#8217;s heart
+had gone out to this maid, and now he must
+set his hand against one of her own blood.
+The Father knew that he would do it, would
+fight La Grange to the end. A word was trembling
+on his tongue, but as he looked at the
+seamed face before him, he could not bring
+himself to add a deeper sorrow to that already
+stamped there.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You must help me with the speech, Father.
+My wits are not at their best, I fear.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Willingly, M&#8217;sieu. And the presents,&ndash;&ndash;we
+must think of that.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_208' name='page_208'></a>208</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;True. We have not the wampum collars.
+It must be something of great value that will take
+their place. You know how much tradition
+means to these people. Of course I have nothing.
+But you&ndash;&ndash;you have your bale. And Mademoiselle&ndash;&ndash;together
+you should find something.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I fear that I have little. My blankets and
+my altar they would not value. One moment&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; He
+stepped to the door, and spoke softly, &#8220;Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, Father.&#8221; She stood in the doorway,
+wearily. It was plain that she had been weeping,
+but she was not ashamed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We shall need your help, Mademoiselle.
+Anything in your bale that would please the
+chiefs must be used.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She was puzzled.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is the custom,&#8221; continued the priest, &#8220;at
+every council. To the Indians a promise is not
+given, a statement is not true, a treaty is not
+binding, unless there is a present for each clause.
+We have much at stake, and we must give what
+we have.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Certainly, Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She stepped back into the darkness, and they
+could hear her dragging the bundle. Menard
+sprang to help.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_209' name='page_209'></a>209</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle, where are you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Here, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He walked toward the sound with his hands
+spread before him. One hand rested on her
+shoulder, where she stooped over the bale. She
+did not shrink from his touch. For a moment
+he stood, struggling with a mad impulse to take
+her slender figure in his arms, to hold her where
+a thousand Indians could not harm her save by
+taking his own strong life; to tell her what made
+this moment more to him than all the stern
+years of the past. It may be that she understood,
+for she was motionless, almost breathless.
+But in a moment he was himself.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will take it,&#8221; he said.</p>
+<p>He stooped, took up the bundle, and carried
+it outside. She followed to the doorway.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will look, Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She nodded, and knelt by the bundle, while
+the two men waited.</p>
+<p>&#8220;There is little here, M&#8217;sieu. I brought only
+what was necessary. Here is a comb. Would
+that please them?&#8221;</p>
+<p>She reached back to them, holding out a high
+tortoise-shell comb. They took it and examined
+it.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is beautiful,&#8221; said Menard.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_210' name='page_210'></a>210</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes; my mother gave it to me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Perhaps, Mademoiselle,&ndash;&ndash;perhaps there is
+something else, something that would do as well.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How many should you have, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Five, I had planned. There will be five
+words in the speech.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Words?&#8221; she repeated.</p>
+<p>&#8220;To the Iroquois each argument is a &#8216;word.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have almost nothing else, not even clothing
+of value. Wait&ndash;&ndash;here is a small coat of seal.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And you, Father?&#8221; asked Menard.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have a book with highly coloured pictures,
+M&#8217;sieu,&ndash;&ndash;&#8216;The Ceremonies of the Mass applied
+to the Passion of Our Lord.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Splendid! Have you nothing else?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I fear not.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard turned to the maid, who was still on
+her knees by the open bundle, looking up at them.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I am afraid that we must take your coat and
+the comb,&#8221; he said. &#8220;I am sorry.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She answered in a low tone, but firmly: &#8220;You
+know, M&#8217;sieu, that it would hurt me to do nothing.
+It hurts me to do so little.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Thank you, Mademoiselle. Well, Father,
+we must use our wits. It may be that four
+words will be enough, but I cannot use fewer.
+We have but three presents.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_211' name='page_211'></a>211</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; replied the priest, &#8220;yes.&#8221; He walked
+slowly by them, and about in a circle, repeating
+the word. The maid leaned back and watched
+him, wondering. He paused before the Captain
+and seemed about to speak. Then abruptly he
+went into the hut, and they could hear him
+moving within. Menard and the maid looked
+at each other, the soldier smiling quietly. He
+understood.</p>
+<p>Father Claude came out holding the portrait
+of Catharine, the Lily of the Onondagas, in his
+hands.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It may be that this could be used for the
+fourth present,&#8221; he said.</p>
+<p>Menard took it without a word, and laid it
+on the ground by the fur coat. The maid
+looked at it curiously.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, it is a picture,&#8221; she said.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, Mademoiselle,&#8221; the Captain replied.
+&#8220;It is the portrait of an Onondaga maiden
+who is to them, and to the French, almost a
+saint. They will prize this above all else.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid raised it, and looked at the
+strangely clad figure. Father Claude quietly
+walked away, but Menard went after and gripped
+his hand.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_212' name='page_212'></a>212</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_XI_THE_BIG_THROAT_SPEAKS' id='CHAPTER_XI_THE_BIG_THROAT_SPEAKS'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER XI.</h2>
+<h3>THE BIG THROAT SPEAKS.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>The light of the rising sun struggled through
+the mist that lay on the Onondaga Valley.
+The trees came slowly out of the gray air, like
+ships approaching through a fog. As the sun
+rose higher, each leaf glistened with dew. The
+grass was wet and shining.</p>
+<p>Menard had seized a few hours of sleep. He
+awoke with the first beam of yellow light, and
+rose from his bed on the packed, beaten ground
+before the door. Father Claude was sitting on
+a log, at a short distance, with bowed head.
+The Captain stretched his stiff limbs, and
+walked slowly about until the priest looked
+up.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good morning, Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good morning, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It was a selfish thought that led me to
+choose the earlier watch. These last hours
+are the best for sleeping.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_213' name='page_213'></a>213</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;No, I have rested well.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And Mademoiselle?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have heard no sound. I think that she
+still sleeps.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Softly, then. There has been no disturbance?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;None. The singing has died down during
+the last hour. There, you can hear it,
+M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. But it is only a few voices. It must
+be that the others are sleeping off the liquor.
+They will soon awaken.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Listen.&#8221;</p>
+<p>A musket was fired, and another.</p>
+<p>&#8220;That is the signal.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The song, which one group after another had
+taken up all through the night, rose again and
+grew in volume as one at a time the sleepers
+aroused and joined the dance. The only sign
+of the fire was a pillar of thin smoke that rolled
+straight upward in the still air.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father,&#8221; said Menard, &#8220;are the guards
+about?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have not seen them. I suppose they are
+wandering within call.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Then, quickly, before we are seen, help me
+with this log.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_214' name='page_214'></a>214</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;I do not understand, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Into the hut with it, and the others, there.
+If a chance does come,&ndash;&ndash;well, it may be that
+we shall yet be reduced to holding the hut.
+These will serve to barricade the door.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They were not disturbed while they rolled
+the short logs within and piled them at one
+side of the door, where they could not be seen
+from the path.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Quietly, Father,&#8221; whispered the Captain.
+He knew that the maid lay sleeping, back
+among the shadows. &#8220;And the presents,&ndash;&ndash;you
+have packed them away?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;In my bundle, M&#8217;sieu. They will not be
+harmed.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They returned to the open air, and looked
+about anxiously for signs of a movement toward
+the hut; but the irregular street was silent.
+Here and there, from the opening in the roof
+of some low building of bark and logs, rose a
+light smoke.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They are all at the dance,&#8221; said Menard.
+His memory supplied the picture: the great
+fire, now sunk to heaps of gray ashes, spread
+over the ground by the feet of those younger
+braves who had wished to show their hardihood
+by treading barefoot on the embers; the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_215' name='page_215'></a>215</span>
+circle of grunting figures, leaning forward,
+hatchet and musket in hand, moving slowly
+around the fire with a shuffling, hopping step;
+the outer circle of sitting or lying figures, men,
+women, and children, drunken, wanton, quarrelsome,
+dreaming of the blood that should be let
+before the sun had gone; and at one side the
+little group of old men, beating their drums of
+wood and skin with a rhythm that never slackened.</p>
+<p>The song grew louder, and broke at short
+intervals into shouts and cries, punctuated with
+musket-shots.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They are coming, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The head of the line, still stepping in the
+slow movement of the dance, appeared at some
+distance up the path. The Long Arrow was
+in front, in full war-paint, and wearing the collar
+of wampum beads. Beside him was the
+Beaver. The line advanced, two and two,
+steadily toward the lodge of the white men.</p>
+<p>Menard leaned against the door-post and
+watched them. His figure was relaxed, his
+face composed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Here are the doctors, Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>A group of medicine men, wildly clad in
+skins of beasts and reptiles, with the heads of
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_216' name='page_216'></a>216</span>
+animals on their shoulders, came running along
+beside the line, leaping high in the air, and
+howling.</p>
+<p>Menard turned to the priest. &#8220;Father, which
+shall it be,&ndash;&ndash;shall we fight?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I do not know, M&#8217;sieu. We have no
+weapons, and it may be, yet, that the Big
+Throat&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, I know.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And there is the maid, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>For the first time since the sunrise the quiet
+expression left the Captain&#8217;s face. He was
+silent for a moment. Then he said:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will go, Father. You must protect her.
+If anything&ndash;&ndash;if they should dare to touch her,
+you will&ndash;&ndash;?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will fight them, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Thank you.&#8221; Menard held out his hand.
+They gripped in silence, and turned again
+toward the Indians, who were now but a hundred
+yards away.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They will stop in a moment,&#8221; said Menard,
+&#8220;and form for the gantlet. Yes,&ndash;&ndash;see, the
+Long Arrow holds up his hands.&#8221; He stood
+irresolute, looking at the fantastic picture; then
+he stepped back into the hut.</p>
+<p>The maid lay in her blanket on the bench.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_217' name='page_217'></a>217</span>
+He stood over her, looking at the peaceful face
+that rested on her outstretched arm. He took
+her hand, and said gently:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She stirred, and slowly opened her eyes; she
+did not seem surprised that he should be there
+clasping tightly her slender hand. He wondered
+if he had been in her dreams.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-bye, Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You&ndash;&ndash;you are going, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She looked up at him with half-dazed eyes.
+She was not yet fully awake.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You must not fear,&#8221; he said. &#8220;They cannot
+hurt you. You will soon be safe at&ndash;&ndash;at
+Frontenac.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She was beginning to understand. Then all
+at once the light came into her eyes, and she
+clung to his arm, which was still wet with the
+dew.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are not going? They will not take
+you? Oh, M&#8217;sieu, I cannot&ndash;&ndash;you must not!&#8221;</p>
+<p>She would have said more, but he bent down
+and kissed her forehead. Then, with his free
+hand he unclasped her fingers and went away.
+At the door he turned. She was sitting on the
+bench, gazing after him with a look that he
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_218' name='page_218'></a>218</span>
+never forgot. For all of the unhappiness, the
+agony, that came to him from those eyes, it
+was with a lighter heart that he faced the
+warriors who rushed to seize him.</p>
+<p>Every brave, woman, and child that the village
+could supply was in the double line that
+stretched away from a point on the path not
+a hundred yards distant to the long council
+house, which stood on a slight rise of ground.
+They were armed with muskets, clubs, knives,&ndash;&ndash;with
+any instrument which could bruise or,
+mutilate the soldier as he passed, and yet leave
+life in him for the harder trials to follow. Five
+warriors, muskets in hand, had come to the hut.
+They sprang at Menard as he stepped out
+through the doorway, striking him roughly and
+holding his elbows behind his back.</p>
+<p>A shout went up from the waiting lines, and
+muskets and clubs were waved in the air. The
+Captain stepped forward briskly with head erect,
+scorning to glance at the braves who walked on
+either side. He knew that they would not kill
+him in the gantlet; they would save him for
+the fire. He had passed through this once, he
+could do it again, conscious that every moment
+brought nearer the chance of a rescue by the
+Big Throat. Perhaps twenty paces had been
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_219' name='page_219'></a>219</span>
+covered, and his guardians were prodding him
+and trying to force him into a run, when he
+heard a shout from the priest, and then the
+sounds of a struggle at the hut. He turned his
+head, but a rude hand knocked it back. Again
+he heard the priest&#8217;s voice, and this time, with
+it, a woman&#8217;s scream.</p>
+<p>The Captain hesitated for a second. The
+warriors prodded him again, and before they
+could raise their arms he had jerked loose,
+snatched a musket from one, and swinging it
+around his head, sent the two to the ground,
+one with a cracked skull. Before those in the
+lines could fairly see what had happened, he
+was running toward the hut with two captured
+muskets and a knife. In front of the hut the
+three other Indians were struggling with Father
+Claude, who was fighting in a frenzy, and the
+maid. She was hanging back, and one redskin
+had crushed her two wrists together in his hand
+and was dragging her.</p>
+<p>Menard was on them with a leap. They did
+not see him until a musket whirled about their
+ears, and one man fell, rolling, at the maid&#8217;s feet.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Back into the hut!&#8221; he said roughly, and
+she obeyed. As he turned to aid the priest
+he called after her, &#8220;Pile up the logs, quick!&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_220' name='page_220'></a>220</span></p>
+<p>She understood, and with the strength that
+came with the moment, she dragged the logs
+to the door.</p>
+<p>Menard crushed down the two remaining
+Indians as he would have crushed wild beasts,
+without a glance toward the mob that was running
+at him, without a thought for the gash in
+his arm, made first by an arrow at La Gallette
+and now reopened by a knife thrust. The
+Father, too, was wounded, but still he could
+fight. There was but a second more. The
+Captain threw the four muskets into the hut,
+and after them the powder-horns and bullet-pouches
+which he had barely time to strip from
+the dead men. Then he crowded the priest
+through the opening above the logs, and came
+tumbling after. Another second saw the logs
+piled close against the door, while a shower of
+bullets and arrows rattled against them.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Take a musket, Father. Now, fire together!
+Quick, the others! Can you load
+these, Mademoiselle?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221; She reached for them, and poured
+the powder down the barrels.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Not too much, Mademoiselle. We may
+run short.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_221' name='page_221'></a>221</span></p>
+<p>To miss a mark in that solid mob would have
+been difficult. The first four shots brought
+down three men, and sent another limping away
+with a bleeding foot.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Keep it up, Father! Don&#8217;t wait an instant.
+Fast, Mademoiselle, fast! Ah, there&#8217;s one more.
+See, they are falling back. Take the other wall,
+Father. See that they do not come from the
+rear.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest ran about the hut, peering through
+the chinks.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I see nothing,&#8221; he called.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You had better stay there, then. Keep a
+close watch.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid laid two loaded muskets at the
+Captain&#8217;s side.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Can we hold them off, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>His eye was pressed to an opening, and he
+did not turn.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I fear not, Mademoiselle. A few minutes
+more may settle it. But we can give them a
+fight.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If they come again, will you let me shoot,
+M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>He turned in surprise, and looked at her
+slight figure.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You, Mademoiselle?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_222' name='page_222'></a>222</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes; I can help. I have shot before.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He laughed, with the excitement of the moment,
+and nodded. Then they were silent. She
+knelt by his side and looked through another
+opening. The women and children had retreated
+well up the path. The warriors were
+crowded together, just out of range, talking and
+shouting excitedly. A moment later a number
+of these slipped to the rear and ran off between
+the huts.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What does that mean, M&#8217;sieu? Will they
+come around behind?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. Watch out, Father. You will hear
+from them soon.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well, M&#8217;sieu. It will be hard. There
+are trees and bushes here for cover.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard shrugged his shoulders, and made no
+reply. Time was all he wished.</p>
+<p>&#8220;If the Big Throat started with the first light,
+he should be here before another hour,&#8221; he said
+to the maid, who was watching the Indians.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; she replied.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is there any corn in the basket, Mademoiselle?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think so. I had forgotten.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We shall need it. Wait; I will look.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He got the basket, and brought it to her.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_223' name='page_223'></a>223</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;There is no time for cooking, but you had better
+eat what you can. And keep a close watch.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Here, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221; She spread her skirt, and
+he poured out half of the corn.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You give me too much. You must not.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He laughed, and crossed to the priest, saying
+over his shoulder:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle is our new recruit. And the
+recruit must not complain of her food. I cannot
+allow it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The moments passed with no sign of action
+along the line of redskins on the path. They
+were quieter since the flanking party had started.
+To Menard it was evident that a plan had been
+settled upon. In a like position, a dozen Frenchmen
+would have stormed the hut, knowing that
+only two or three could fall before they were
+under the shelter of the walls; but even a large
+force of Indians was unwilling to take the
+chance.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father,&#8221; called the Captain, &#8220;it may be better
+for you to take the doorway. Mademoiselle
+and I will watch the forest.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The exchange was made rapidly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will you look out at the sides, as well?&#8221;
+Menard said to her. &#8220;Keep moving about, and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_224' name='page_224'></a>224</span>
+using all the openings. There are too many
+chances for approach here.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If I see one, shall I shoot, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>He smiled. &#8220;You had better tell me first.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She stepped briskly about, peering through
+the chinks with an alert eye. Menard found it
+hard to keep his own watch, so eager were his
+eyes to watch her. But he turned resolutely
+toward the woods.</p>
+<p>&#8220;M&#8217;sieu!&#8221; she whispered. They had been
+silent for a long time. &#8220;To the left in the
+bushes! It looks like a head.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Can you make sure?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. It is a head. May I shoot?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard nodded without looking. She rested
+her musket in the opening between two logs,
+and fired quickly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Did you hit him?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, I think so.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She was breathless with excitement, but she
+reloaded at once. A moment later Menard
+fired, and then the priest.</p>
+<p>&#8220;On all sides, eh?&#8221; the Captain muttered.
+He called to the others: &#8220;Waste no powder.
+Shoot only when you are sure of hitting. They
+will fall back again. Two dead Indians will
+discourage the wildest charge.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_225' name='page_225'></a>225</span></p>
+<p>The firing went on at intervals, but still the
+warriors kept at it, creeping up from bush to
+bush and tree to tree. Menard&#8217;s face grew more
+serious as the time went by. He began to
+realize that the Long Arrow was desperate, that
+he was determined on vengeance before the
+other chiefs could come. It had been a typical
+savage thought that had led him to bring Menard
+to this village, where he had once lived,
+rather than to the one in which the chief held
+greater permanent authority; the scheme was
+too complete and too near its end for delay or
+failure to be considered. Still the attacking
+party drew nearer, swelled every moment by a
+new group. Then Menard saw their object.
+They would soon be near enough to dash in
+close to the wall, where their very nearness
+would disable the white men&#8217;s muskets.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Work fast!&#8221; he said suddenly. &#8220;They
+must not get nearer!&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; panted the maid. Her shoulder was
+bruised by the heavy musket, her arms ached
+with the quick ramming and lifting, but she
+loaded and fired as rapidly as she could.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father,&#8221; called the Captain. &#8220;Quick! come
+here. They are too many for me!&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest ran across the floor, half blinded
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_226' name='page_226'></a>226</span>
+by the smoke, cocking his musket as he came.
+&#8220;Where, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There&ndash;&ndash;at the oak! They are preparing
+for a rush!&#8221;</p>
+<p>He fired, at the last word, and one warrior
+sprawled on his face. The priest followed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;That will check them. Now back to the
+door!&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude turned. The light was dim
+and the smoke heavy. His eyes smarted and
+blurred, so that he heard, rather than saw, the logs
+come crashing back into the hut. Menard heard
+it also; and together the two men dashed forward.
+They met the rush of Indians with
+blows that could not be stayed, but there was a
+score pushing behind the few who had entered.
+Slowly, the two backed across the hut. The
+stock of Menard&#8217;s musket broke short off against
+the head of the Beaver. His foot struck another,
+and he snatched it up and fought on.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle,&#8221; he called, &#8220;where are you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Here, M&#8217;sieu!&#8221;</p>
+<p>The voice was behind him. Then he felt a
+weight on his shoulder. The wearied maid, for
+want of another rest for her musket, fired past
+his face straight into the dark mass of Indians.
+She tried to reload, but Menard was swept back
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_227' name='page_227'></a>227</span>
+against her. With one arm he caught and held
+her tight against him, swinging the musket with
+his free hand. She clung to him, hardly breathing.
+They reached the rear wall. One tall
+warrior bounded forward and struck the musket
+from his hand. That was the end of the struggle.
+They were torn apart, and dragged roughly
+out into the blinding sunlight.</p>
+<p>Among the Iroquois, the torture was a religious
+rite, which nothing, once it was begun,
+could hasten. It may have been that the
+younger warriors would have rushed upon the
+captives to kill them; but if so, their elders held
+them back. The long lines formed again, and
+the doctors ran about the little group before the
+hut door, leaping and singing. Menard lay on
+his face, held down by three warriors. He tried
+to turn his head to see what had been done with
+the maid, but could not. He would have called
+to her, but to make a sound now would be to
+his captors an admission of weakness.</p>
+<p>A great clamour came from the lines. Menard
+wondered at the delay. He heard a movement
+a few yards away. Warriors were grunting,
+and feet shuffled on the ground. He heard the
+priest say, in a calm voice, &#8220;Courage, Mademoiselle&#8221;;
+and for a moment he struggled desperately.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_228' name='page_228'></a>228</span>
+Then, realizing his mistake, he lay quiet.
+When at last he was jerked to his feet, he saw
+that the priest and the maid had been forced to
+take the two first places in the line. The maid
+was struggling in the grasp of two braves, one
+of whom made her hold a war club by closing
+his own hand over hers. Menard understood;
+his friends were to strike the first blows.</p>
+<p>The guards tried to drag him forward, but
+he went firmly with them, smiling scornfully.
+There was a delay, as the line was reached, for
+the maid could not be made to hold the club.
+Another man dropped out of the line to aid
+the two who held her.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Strike me, Mademoiselle,&#8221; said Menard.
+&#8220;It is best.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She shook her head. Father Claude spoke:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;M&#8217;sieu is right.&#8221;</p>
+<p>It was then that she first looked at the Captain.
+When she saw the straight figure and
+the set face, a sense of her own weakness came
+to her, and she, too, straightened. Menard
+stepped forward; and raising the club she let
+it fall lightly on his shoulders. A shout went
+up.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Hard, Mademoiselle, hard,&#8221; he said. &#8220;You
+must.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_229' name='page_229'></a>229</span></p>
+<p>She pressed her lips together, closed her
+eyes, and swung the club with all her strength.
+Then her muscles gave way, and she sank to
+the ground, not daring to look after the Captain
+as he passed on between the two rows of
+savages. She heard the shouts and the wild
+cries, but dimly, as if they came from far away.
+The confusion grew worse, and then died
+down. From screaming the voices dropped
+into excited argument. She did not know
+what it meant,&ndash;&ndash;not until Father Claude bent
+over her and spoke gently.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is it?&#8221; she whispered, not looking
+up. &#8220;What have they done?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Nothing. The Big Throat has come.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She raised her eyes helplessly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;He has come?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. I must go back. Take heart, Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He hurried away and slipped through the
+crowd that had gathered about Menard and
+the chief. She sat in a little heap on the
+ground, not daring to feel relieved, wondering
+what would come next. She could not see the
+Captain, but as the other voices dropped lower
+and lower, she could catch now and then a
+note of his voice. In a few moments, the warriors
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_230' name='page_230'></a>230</span>
+who were pressing close on the outskirts
+of the crowd were pushed aside, and he came
+out. She looked at him, then at the ground,
+shuddering, for there was blood on his forehead.
+Even when he stood over her she could
+not look up or speak.</p>
+<p>&#8220;There is hope now, Mademoiselle. He is
+here.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes&ndash;&ndash;Father Claude told me. Is&ndash;&ndash;are
+you to be released?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Hardly that, but we shall at least have a
+little time. And I hope to get a hearing at
+the council.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He will let you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have not asked him yet.&#8221; He sat beside
+her, wearily. &#8220;There will be time for that. He
+is talking now with the Long Arrow and the
+old warriors. He is not fond of the Long
+Arrow.&#8221; In the excitement he had not seen
+that she was limp and exhausted, but now he
+spoke quickly, &#8220;They have hurt you, Mademoiselle?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, I am not hurt. But you&ndash;&ndash;your
+head&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Only a bruise.&#8221; He drew his sleeve across
+his forehead. &#8220;I had rather a bad one in the
+arm.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_231' name='page_231'></a>231</span></p>
+<p>He rolled up his sleeve in a matter-of-fact
+way. Her eyes filled.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, M&#8217;sieu, you did not tell me. I can
+help you. Wait, I will be back.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She rose, and started toward the spring, but
+he sprang to her side.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You must not trouble. It is not bad.
+There will be time for this.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. Come with me if you will.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She ran with nervous steps; and he strode
+after. At the side of the bubbling pool she
+knelt, and looked up impatiently.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It will not do to let this go, M&#8217;sieu. Can
+you roll your sleeve higher?&#8221;</p>
+<p>He tried, but the heavy cloth was stiff.</p>
+<p>&#8220;If you will take off the coat&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>He unlaced it at the breast, and drew it off.
+She took his wrist, and plunged his arm into
+the pool, washing it with quick, gentle fingers,
+drying it on his coat. Then she leaned back,
+half perplexed, and looked around.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is it?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;A cloth. No,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;as he reached for his
+coat;&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;that is too rough. Here, M&#8217;sieu,&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;
+she tore a strip from her skirt, and wrapped it
+around the forearm. &#8220;Hold it with your other
+hand, just a moment.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_232' name='page_232'></a>232</span></p>
+<p>She hurried to the hut, and returning with
+needle and thread, stitched the bandage. Then
+she helped him on with his coat, and they
+walked slowly to the hut.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Where is Father Claude?&#8221; she asked.</p>
+<p>He pointed to a thicket beyond the hut.
+There, kneeling by the body of a dying Indian,
+was the priest, praying silently. He had
+baptized the warrior with dew from the leaves
+at his side, and now was claiming his soul for
+the greater King in whose service his own life
+had been spent.</p>
+<p>The Captain sat beside the maid, their backs
+to the logs, and watched the shifting groups
+of warriors. He told her of the arrival of the
+Big Throat, and of the confusion that resulted.
+Then for a time they were silent, waiting for
+the impromptu council to reach a conclusion.
+The warriors finally began to drift away,
+though the younger and more curious ones
+still hung about. A group of braves came
+slowly toward the hut.</p>
+<p>&#8220;That is the Big Throat in front,&#8221; said Menard.
+&#8220;The broad-shouldered warrior beside
+him is the Talking Eagle, the best-known chief
+of the clan of the Bear. They are almost here.
+We had better stand. Are you too tired?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_233' name='page_233'></a>233</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;No, indeed.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude had seen the group approaching,
+and he joined Menard. The Big Throat
+stood motionless and looked at the Captain.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brother, the Big Buffalo, has asked
+to speak with the Big Throat,&#8221; he said at
+length.</p>
+<p>Menard bowed, but did not reply.</p>
+<p>&#8220;He asks for his release,&ndash;&ndash;and for the
+holy man and the squaw?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo asks nothing save what
+the chiefs of the Onondagas would give to a
+chief taken in battle. The Long Arrow has lied
+to the Big Buffalo. He has soiled his hands
+with the blood of women and holy Fathers.
+The Big Buffalo was told by Onontio, whom
+all must obey, to come to the Onondagas and
+give them his word. The Long Arrow was
+impatient. He would not let him journey in
+peace. He wished to injure him; to let his
+blood. Now the Big Buffalo is here. He asks
+that he may be heard at the council, to give
+the chief the word of Onontio. That is all.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Big Throat&#8217;s face was inscrutable. He
+looked at Menard without a word until the
+silence grew tense, and the maid caught her
+breath. Then he said, with the cool, diplomatic
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_234' name='page_234'></a>234</span>
+tone that concealed whatever kindness
+or justice may have prompted the words:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo shall be heard at the
+council to-night. The chiefs of the Onondagas
+never are deaf to the words of Onontio.&#8221;</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_235' name='page_235'></a>235</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_XII_THE_LONG_HOUSE' id='CHAPTER_XII_THE_LONG_HOUSE'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER XII.</h2>
+<h3>THE LONG HOUSE.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>The council-house was a hundred paces or
+more in length. The frame was of tall
+hickory saplings planted in the ground in two
+rows, with the tops bent over and lashed together
+in the form of an arch. The building
+was not more than fifteen yards wide. The
+lower part of the outer wall was of logs, the
+upper part and the roof of bark. Instead of a
+chimney there was a narrow opening in the
+roof, extending the length of the building.</p>
+<p>A row of smouldering fires reached nearly
+from end to end of the house. The smoke
+struggled upward, but failing, for the greater
+part, to find the outlet overhead, remained inside
+to clog the air and dim the eyes. The
+chiefs sat in a long ellipse in the central part of
+the house, some sitting erect with legs crossed,
+others half reclining, while a few lay sprawling,
+their chins resting on their hands. The Big
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_236' name='page_236'></a>236</span>
+Throat sat with the powerful chiefs of the nation
+at one end. The lesser sachems, including the
+Long Arrow, sat each before his own band of
+followers. The second circle was made up of
+the older and better-known warriors. Behind
+these, pressing close to catch every word of the
+argument, were braves, youths, women, and
+children, mixed together indiscriminately. A
+low platform extended the length of the building
+against the wall on each side, and this held
+another crowding, elbowing, whispering mass
+of redskins. Every chief and warrior, as well
+as most of the women, held each a pipe between
+his teeth, and puffed out clouds of smoke into
+the thick air.</p>
+<p>The maid&#8217;s eyes smarted and blurred in
+the smoke. It reached her throat, and she
+coughed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Lie down, Mademoiselle,&#8221; said Menard.
+&#8220;Breathe close to the ground and it will not be
+so bad.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She hesitated, looking at the Big Throat,
+who sat with arms folded, proud and dignified.
+Then she smiled, and lay almost flat on the
+ground, breathing in the current of less impure
+air that passed beneath the smoke. They had
+been placed in the inner circle, next to the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_237' name='page_237'></a>237</span>
+chiefs of the nations, where Menard&#8217;s words
+would have the weight that, to the mind of the
+Big Throat, was due to a representative of the
+French Governor, even in time of war. Father
+Claude, sitting on the left of the maid, was
+looking quietly into the fire. He had committed
+the case into the hands of Providence,
+and he was certain that the right words would
+be given to the Captain.</p>
+<p>It was nearing the close of the afternoon. A
+beam of sunlight slipped in at one end of the
+roof-opening, and slanted downward, clearing a
+shining way through the smoke. A Cayuga
+chief was speaking.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The corn is ripening in the fields about the
+Onondaga village. As I came down the hills
+of the west to-day I saw the green tops waving
+in the wind, and I was glad, for I knew that
+my brothers would feast in plenty, that their
+Manitous have been kind. The Cayugas, too,
+have great fields of corn, and the Senecas.
+Their women have worked faithfully that the
+land might be plentiful.</p>
+<p>&#8220;But a storm is breaking over the cornfields
+of the Senecas. It is a great cloud that has
+come down from the north, with the flash of
+fire and the roar of thunder, and with hailstones
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_238' name='page_238'></a>238</span>
+of lead that will leave no stalk standing. My
+brothers know the strength of the north wind.
+They have not forgotten other storms that
+would have laid waste the villages of the Senecas
+and the Mohawks. And they have not
+forgotten their Manitous, who have whispered
+to them when the clouds appeared in the northern
+sky, &#8216;Rise up, Mohawks and Oneidas and
+Onondagas and Cayugas and Senecas, and
+stand firmly against this storm, and your
+homes and your fields shall not be destroyed.&#8217;&#8221;</p>
+<p>The house was silent with interest. The
+maid raised her head and watched the stolid
+faces of the chiefs in the inner circle. Not an
+expression changed from beginning to end of
+the speech. Beyond, she could see other,
+younger faces, some eager, some bitter, some
+defiant, some smiling, and all showing the
+flush of excitement,&ndash;&ndash;but these grim old chiefs
+had long schooled their faces to hide their
+thoughts. They held their blankets close, and
+puffed deliberately at their pipes with hardly a
+movement of the lips.</p>
+<p>The Cayuga went on:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Messengers have come to the Cayugas from
+their brothers, the Senecas, telling of the storm
+that is rushing on them. The Cayugas know
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_239' name='page_239'></a>239</span>
+the hearts of the Five Nations. When the Mohawks
+have risen to defend their homes, the
+hearts of the Cayugas have been warm, and
+they have taken up the hatchet with their
+brothers. When the Onondagas have gone on
+the war-path, Senecas and Cayugas have gone
+with them, and the trouble of one has been the
+trouble of all.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The good White Father is no longer the
+war chief of the white men. The Great Mountain,
+who knew the voice of the forest, who
+spoke with the tongue of the redman, has
+been called back to his Great-Chief-Across-the-Water.
+His word was the word of kindness,
+and when he spoke our hearts were warm. But
+another mountain is now the war chief, a mountain
+that spits fire and lead, that speaks with
+a double tongue. The Five Nations have
+never turned from a foe. The enemy of the
+Senecas has been the enemy of the Mohawks.
+If the storm strikes the fields of the Senecas,
+their brothers will not turn away and stop their
+ears and say they do not hear the thunder, for
+they remember the storms of other seasons,
+and they know that the hail that destroys one
+field will destroy other fields. And so this is
+the word of the Cayugas:&ndash;&ndash;Let all the warriors
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_240' name='page_240'></a>240</span>
+of the Five Nations take up the hatchet; let
+them go on the war-path to tell this white chief
+with the double tongue that the Five Nations
+are one nation; that they are bolder than
+thunder, swifter than fire, stronger than lead.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid found it hard, with her imperfect
+knowledge of the language, to follow his metaphors.
+She had partly risen, heedless of the
+smoke, and was leaning forward with her
+eyes fixed on the stern face of the speaker.
+Menard bent down, and half smiled at her
+excitement.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is it?&#8221; she whispered. &#8220;He is for
+war?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes; he naturally would be.&#8221; There was a
+stir about the house, as the speech ended, and
+they could speak softly without drawing notice.
+&#8220;The Cayugas are nearer to the Senecas than
+the other nations, and they fear that they too
+may suffer.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Then you do not think they all feel with
+him?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No; the Oneidas and Mohawks, and even
+the Onondagas, are too far to the east to feel
+in danger. They know how hard it would be
+for the Governor to move far from his base in
+this country. It may be that the younger warriors
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_241' name='page_241'></a>241</span>
+will be for fighting, but the older heads
+will think of the corn.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will the Big Throat speak?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes; but not like these others. He talks
+simply and forcibly. That is the way when a
+chief&#8217;s reputation is made. The Big Throat
+won his name, as a younger brave, by his wonderful
+oratory.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And you, M&#8217;sieu,&ndash;&ndash;you will be heard?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes; I think so. We must not talk any
+more now. They will not like it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Cayuga was followed by a wrinkled old
+chief of the Oneidas, called the Hundred Skins.
+He stepped forward and stood near the fire, his
+blanket drawn close about his shoulders, where
+the red light could play on his face. A whisper
+ran around the outer circle, for it was known
+that he stood for peace.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My Cayuga brother has spoken wisely,&#8221; he
+began, in a low but distinct voice. He looked
+slowly about the house to command attention.
+&#8220;The Oneidas have not forgotten the storms
+of other seasons; they have not forgotten the
+times of starving, when neither the Manitous
+of the redman nor the God of the white man
+came to help. The grain stood brown in the
+fields; the leaves hung dead from the trees;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_242' name='page_242'></a>242</span>
+there was no wind to cool the fever that carried
+away old men and young men, squaws and
+children. And when the wind came, and the
+cold and snow of the winter, there was no food
+in the lodges of the Five Nations. My brothers
+have heard that the corn is rising to a man&#8217;s
+height&ndash;&ndash;they have seen it to-day in the fields
+of the Onondagas. They know that this corn
+must be cared for like the children of their
+lodges, if they wish food to eat when the winter
+comes and the fields are dead. They know
+what it will cost them to take the war-path.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Twelve moons have not gone since the
+chiefs of the Senecas rose in this house and
+called on the warriors of the Five Nations to
+take up the hatchet against the white men of the
+north. The skins of the beaver were talking in
+their ears. They saw great canoes on the white
+man&#8217;s rivers loaded with skins, and their hands
+itched and their hearts turned inward. Then
+the wise chiefs of the Oneidas and Cayugas and
+Onondagas and Mohawks spoke well. They
+were not on the war-path; the hatchet was deep
+in the ground, and young trees were growing
+over it. Then the Oneidas said that the White
+Chief would not forget if the Senecas heeded
+their itching hands and listened to the bad
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_243' name='page_243'></a>243</span>
+medicine of the beaver skins in their ears. But
+the Senecas were not wise, and they took up
+the hatchet.</p>
+<p>&#8220;This is the word of the Oneidas to the
+chiefs of the Long House:&ndash;&ndash;The Seneca has
+put his foot in the trap. Then shall the Oneida
+and Onondaga and Cayuga and Mohawk rush
+after, that they too may put in their feet where
+they can get away only by gnawing off the
+bone? Shall the wise chiefs of the Long
+House run into fight like the dogs of their
+village? The Oneidas say no! The Senecas
+took up the hatchet; let them bury it where
+they can. And when the winter comes, the
+Oneidas will send them corn that they may not
+have another time of starving.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard was watching the Oneida with eyes
+that fairly snapped. The low voice stopped,
+and another murmur ran around the outer circles.
+The Hundred Skins had spoken boldly,
+and the Cayuga young men looked stern. The
+chief stepped slowly back and resumed his seat,
+and then, not before, did Menard&#8217;s face relax.
+He looked about cautiously to see if he was
+observed, then settled back and gazed stolidly
+into the fire. The old Oneida had played
+directly into his hand; by letting slip the motive
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_244' name='page_244'></a>244</span>
+for the Seneca raid of the winter before, he
+had strengthened the one weak point in the
+speech Menard meant to make.</p>
+<p>The next speaker was one of the younger war
+chiefs of the Onondagas. He made an effort
+to speak with the calmness of the older men,
+but there was now and then a flash in his eye
+and an ill-controlled vigour in his voice that told
+Menard and the priest how strong was the war
+party of this village. The Onondaga plunged
+into his speech without the customary deliberation.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Our brothers, the Senecas, have sent to us
+for aid. We have been called to the Long
+House to hear the voice of the Senecas,&ndash;&ndash;not
+from the lips of their chiefs, for they have fields
+and villages to guard against the white man,
+and they are not here to stand before the council
+and ask what an Iroquois never refuses.
+The Cayuga has spoken with the voice of the
+Seneca. Shall the chiefs and warriors of the
+Long House say to the Cayuga, &#8216;Go back to
+your village and send messengers to the Senecas
+to tell them that their brothers of the Long
+House have corn and squaws and children that
+are more to them than the battles of their
+brothers&ndash;&ndash;tell the Senecas that the Oneidas
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_245' name='page_245'></a>245</span>
+must eat and cannot fight&#8217;? There is corn in
+the fields of the Oneidas. But there is food for
+all the Five Nations in the great house on the
+Lake.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The speaker paused to let his words sink in.
+Menard whispered to the maid, in reply to an
+inquiring look. &#8220;He means the Governor&#8217;s
+base of supplies at La Famine.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Onondaga&#8217;s voice began to rise.</p>
+<p>&#8220;When the Oneida thinks of his corn, is he
+afraid to leave it to his squaws? Does he hesitate
+because he thinks the white warriors are
+strong enough to turn on him and drive him
+from his villages? This is not the speech that
+young warriors are taught to expect from the
+Long House. When has the Long House been
+guided by fear? No. If the Oneida is hungry,
+let him eat from the stores of the white
+man, at the house on the Lake. The Cayugas
+and Onondagas will draw their belts tighter,
+that the Oneida may be filled.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The young chief looked defiantly around.
+There was a murmur from the outer circle, but
+the chiefs were grave and silent. The Hundred
+Skins gazed meditatively into the fire as
+if he had not heard, slowly puffing at his pipe.
+The taunt of cowardice had sprung out in the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_246' name='page_246'></a>246</span>
+heat of youth; his dignity demanded that he
+ignore it. The speech had its effect on the
+Cayugas and the young men, but the older
+heads were steady.</p>
+<p>Other chiefs rose, talked, and resumed their
+places, giving all views of the situation and of
+the relations between the Iroquois and the
+French,&ndash;&ndash;but still little expression showed on
+the inner circle of faces. The maid after a
+time grew more accustomed to the smoke, and
+sat up. She was puzzled by the conflicting
+arguments and the lack of enthusiasm. Fully
+two hours had passed, and there was no sign
+of an agreement. The eager spectators, in the
+outer rows, gradually settled down.</p>
+<p>During a lull between two speeches, Menard
+spoke to the maid, who was beginning to show
+traces of weariness.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It may be a long sitting, Mademoiselle.
+We must make the best of it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221; She smiled. &#8220;I am a little tired.
+It has been a hard day.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Too hard, poor child. But I hope to see
+you safe very soon now. I am relying on the
+Big Throat. He, with a few of the older
+chiefs, sees farther than these hot-heads. He
+knows that France must conquer in the end,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_247' name='page_247'></a>247</span>
+and is wise enough to make terms whenever
+he can.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But can he, M&#8217;sieu? Will they obey him?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Not obey, exactly; he will not command
+them. Indians have no discipline such as ours.
+The chiefs rely on their judgment and influence.
+But they have followed the guidance of the Big
+Throat for too many years to leave it now.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Another chief rose to speak. The sun had
+gone, and the long building was growing dark
+rapidly. A number of squaws came through
+the circle, throwing wood on the fires. The
+new flames shot up, and threw a flickering
+light on the copper faces, many of which still
+wore the paint of the morning. The smoke
+lay over them in wavering films, now and again
+half hiding some sullen face until it seemed to
+fade away into the darkness.</p>
+<p>At last the whole situation lay clear before
+the council. Some speakers were for war, some
+for peace, others for aiding the Senecas as a
+matter of principle. The house was divided.</p>
+<p>There was a silence, and the pipes glowed in
+the dusk; then the Long Arrow rose. The
+listless spectators stirred and leaned forward.
+The maid, too, was moved, feeling that at last
+the moment of decision was near. She was
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_248' name='page_248'></a>248</span>
+surprised to see that he had none of the savage
+excitement of the morning. He was as quiet
+and tactful in speech as the Big Throat himself.</p>
+<p>Slowly the Long Arrow drew his blanket
+close about him and began to speak. The
+house grew very still, for the whole tribe knew
+that he had, in his anger of the morning, disputed
+the authority of the Big Throat. There
+had been hot words, and the great chief had
+rebuked him contemptuously within the hearing
+of half a hundred warriors. Now he was
+to stand before the council, and not a man in
+that wide circle but wondered how much he
+would dare to say.</p>
+<p>He seemed not to observe the curious
+glances. Simply and quietly he began the
+narrative of the capture of the hunting party
+at Fort Frontenac. At the first words Menard
+turned to Father Claude with a meaning look.
+The maid saw it, and her lips framed a question.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is better than I hoped,&#8221; Menard whispered.
+&#8220;He is bringing it up himself.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Not two moons have waned,&#8221; the Long
+Arrow was saying, &#8220;since five score brave
+young warriors left our village for the hunt.
+They left the hatchet buried under the trees.
+They took no war-paint. The Great Mountain
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_249' name='page_249'></a>249</span>
+had said that there was peace between
+the redman and the white man; he had asked
+the Onondagas to hunt on the banks of the
+Great River; he had told them that his white
+sons at the Stone House would take them as
+brothers into their lodges. When the Great
+Mountain said this, through the mouths of the
+holy Fathers, he lied.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The words came out in the same low, even
+tone in which he had begun speaking, but
+they sank deep. The house was hushed; even
+the stirring of the children on the benches
+died away.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Great Mountain has lied to his children,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;Menard&#8217;s
+keen ears caught the bitter,
+if covered, sarcasm in the last two words; they
+had been Governor Frontenac&#8217;s favourite term
+in addressing the Iroquois&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;and his children
+know his voice no longer. There is corn in the
+fields? Let it grow or rot. There are squaws
+and children in our lodges? Let them live or
+die. It is not the Senecas who ask our aid; it
+is the voice of a hundred sons and brothers and
+youths and squaws calling from far beyond the
+great water,&ndash;&ndash;calling from chains, calling from
+fever, calling from the Happy Hunting Ground,
+where they have gone without guns or corn or
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_250' name='page_250'></a>250</span>
+blankets, where they lie with nothing to comfort
+them.&#8221; The Long Arrow stood erect, with
+head thrown back and eyes fixed on the opposite
+wall. &#8220;Our sons and brothers went like
+children to the Stone House of the white man.
+Their hands were stretched before them, their
+muskets hung empty from their shoulders, their
+bowstrings were loosened; the calumet was in
+their hands. But the sons of Onontio lied as
+their fathers had taught them. They took the
+calumet; they called the Onondagas into their
+great lodge; and in the sleep of the white man&#8217;s
+fire-water they chained them. Five score Onondagas
+have gone to be slaves to the Great-Chief-Across-the-Water,
+who loves his children
+and is kind to them, and would take them all
+under his arm where no storm can harm them.
+My brothers of the Long House have heard
+the promises of Onontio, and they have seen the
+fork in his tongue. And so they choose this
+time to speak of corn and squaws and children.&#8221;
+The keen, closely set eyes slowly lowered and
+swept around the circle. &#8220;Is this the time to
+speak of corn? Our Manitou has sent this
+Great Mountain into our country. He has
+placed him in our hands so that we may strike,
+so that we may tell the white man with our
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_251' name='page_251'></a>251</span>
+muskets that our Manitou is stern and just, and
+that no Iroquois will listen to the idle words of
+a double tongue.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He paused, readjusted his blanket, and then
+stood motionless, that all might digest his
+words. Then, after a long wait, he went on:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There are children to-day in our lodges who
+can remember the Big Buffalo, who can remember
+our adopted son who shared our fires and
+food, who shared our hunts, who lived with us
+as freely as an Onondaga. We saw him every
+day, and we forgot that his heart was as white
+as his skin, for his tongue was the tongue of an
+Onondaga. We forgot that the white man has
+two tongues. It has not been long, my brothers,&ndash;&ndash;not
+long enough for an Onondaga to forget.
+But the Big Buffalo is a mangy dog. He forgot
+the brothers of his lodge. He it was who
+took the Onondaga hunters and carried them
+away to be slaves. But the Manitou did not
+forget. He has put this Big Buffalo into our
+hands, that we may give him what should be
+given to the dog who forgets his master.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Again the Long Arrow paused.</p>
+<p>&#8220;No; this is not the time to speak of corn.
+It is not the Senecas who call us, it is our
+brothers and their squaws and children. The
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_252' name='page_252'></a>252</span>
+Iroquois have been the greatest warriors of
+the world. They have driven the Hurons to
+the far northern forests; the Illinois to the
+Father of Waters, two moons&#8217; travel to the
+west; the Delawares to the waters of the south.
+They have told the white man to stay within
+his boundaries, and he has stayed. They have
+been kind to the white man; they have welcomed
+the holy Fathers into their villages. But
+now the Great Mountain makes slaves of the
+Onondagas. He brings his warriors across the
+Great Lake to punish the Senecas and destroy
+their lodges. Shall the Long House of the
+Five Nations turn a white face to this Great
+Mountain? Shall the Long House call out in
+a shaking voice, &#8216;See, Onontio, there are no
+heads on our arrows, no flints in our muskets!
+our hatchets are dull, our knives nicked and
+rusted! come, Onontio, and strike us, that
+we may know you are our master and our
+father&#8217;?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Long Arrow&#8217;s voice had risen only
+slightly, but now it dropped; he went on, in
+a tone that was keen as a knife, but so low
+that those at the farther end of the house
+leaned forward and sat motionless.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It has been said to-day to the Long House
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_253' name='page_253'></a>253</span>
+that we shall close our ears to the thunder of
+the Great Mountain, that we should think of
+our corn and our squaws, and leave the Senecas
+to fight their own battles. But the Long House
+will not do this. The Long House will not
+give up the liberty that has been the pride of
+the Iroquois since first the rivers ran to the
+lake, and the moss grew on the trees, and the
+wind waved the tops of the long grass. The
+Great Mountain has come to take this liberty.
+He shall not have it. No; he shall lose his
+own&ndash;&ndash;we will leave his bones to dry where
+the Seneca dogs run loose. The Big Buffalo
+shall die to tell the white man that the Iroquois
+never forgets; the Great Mountain shall
+die to tell the white man that the Iroquois is
+free.&#8221;</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_254' name='page_254'></a>254</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_XIII_THE_VOICE_OF_THE_GREAT_MOUNTAIN' id='CHAPTER_XIII_THE_VOICE_OF_THE_GREAT_MOUNTAIN'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER XIII.</h2>
+<h3>THE VOICE OF THE GREAT MOUNTAIN.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>There was no lack of interest now in the
+council. The weariness left the maid&#8217;s
+eyes as she followed the speeches that came in
+rapid succession. There was still the disagreement,
+the confusion of a dozen different views
+and demands; but the speech of the Long
+Arrow had pointed the discussion, it had set
+up an opinion to be either defended or attacked.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will the Big Throat speak now?&#8221; asked
+Mademoiselle, leaning close to Menard.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I hardly think so. I don&#8217;t know what will
+come next.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;When will you speak, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Not until word from the Big Throat. It
+would be a breach of courtesy.&#8221;</p>
+<p>One warrior, a member of the Beaver family,
+and probably a blood relative of the Beaver who
+had been killed in the fight of the morning, took
+advantage of the pause to speak savagely for
+war and vengeance. He counted those who
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_255' name='page_255'></a>255</span>
+had fallen since the sun rose, and appealed to
+their families to destroy the man who had killed
+them. He was not a chief, but his fiery speech
+aroused a murmur of approval from scattered
+groups of the spectators. This sympathy from
+those about him, with the anger which was
+steadily fed by his own hot words, gradually
+drove from his mind the observance of etiquette
+which was so large a part of an important council.
+Still speaking, he left his place, and walking
+slowly between two of the fires and across
+the circle, paused before Menard.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The dog whom we fed and grew has turned
+against its masters, as the dogs of your own
+lodges, my brothers, will bite the hand that pats
+their heads. It has hung about outside of the
+Great Lodge to kill the hunter who sees no
+danger ahead. And now, when this dog is
+caught, and tied at your door, would not my
+brothers bring him to the end of all evil
+beasts?&#8221; As he finished, he made a gesture
+of bitter contempt and kicked Menard.</p>
+<p>A shout went up, and voices clamoured, protesting,
+denouncing, exulting. The Captain&#8217;s
+eyes flashed fire. It was not for a second that
+he hesitated. Weakness, to an Indian, is the
+last, the greatest fault. If he should take this
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_256' name='page_256'></a>256</span>
+insult, it would end forever not only his own
+chance of escape, with the maid and the priest,
+but all hope of safety for the Governor&#8217;s column.
+He sprang to his feet before the Indian, whose
+arm was still stretched out in the gesture, and
+with two quick blows knocked him clear of his
+feet, and then kicked him into the fire.</p>
+<p>A dozen hands dragged the warrior from the
+fire and stamped out a blaze that had started in
+the fringe of one legging. Every man in the
+house was on his feet, shouting and screaming.
+Menard stood with his hands at his side, smiling,
+with the same look of scorn he had worn in
+the morning when they led him to the torture.
+Father Claude drew closer to the maid, and
+the two sat without moving. Then above the
+uproar rose the voice of the Big Throat; and
+slowly the noise died away. The chief stepped
+to the centre of the circle, but before he could
+speak Menard had reached his side, and motioned
+to him to be silent.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brothers,&#8221; he said, looking straight at
+the fallen warrior, who was scrambling to his
+feet,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;my brothers, the Big Buffalo is sorry
+that the Onondagas have among them a fool
+who thinks himself a warrior. The Big Buffalo
+is not here to fight fools. He is here to talk to
+chiefs. He is glad that the fool speaks only for
+himself and not for the brave men of the Long
+House.&#8221; He walked deliberately back and
+resumed his seat by the maid.</p>
+<div class='figcenter'>
+<a name='linki_4' id='linki_4'></a>
+<img src='images/illus-256.jpg' alt='' title='' style='width: 614px; height: 366px;' /><br />
+<p class='caption' style='margin: 0 auto; text-align:center; width: 614px;'>
+&#8220;Menard stood ... smiling with the same look of scorn he had worn ... when they led him to the torture.&#8221;<br />
+</p>
+</div>
+<div><span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_257' name='page_257'></a>257</span></div>
+<p>&#8220;Courage, Mademoiselle,&#8221; he said close to
+her ear. &#8220;It is all right.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What will they do, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Nothing. I have won. Wait&ndash;&ndash;the Big
+Throat is speaking.&#8221;</p>
+<p>One by one the warriors fell back to their
+seats. Some were muttering, some were smiling;
+but all were subdued. The Big Throat&#8217;s
+voice was calm and firm.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo has spoken well. The
+word of a fool is not the word of the Long
+House. The White Chief comes to give us
+the voice of Onontio, and we will listen.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He turned toward Menard, and then resumed
+his seat.</p>
+<p>The Captain rose, and looked about the circle.
+The chiefs were motionless. Even the
+Long Arrow, now that his outburst was past,
+closed his lips over the stem of his pipe and
+gazed at the smoke. Father Claude drew forward
+the bundle and opened it, the maid helping.
+Some of the boys behind them crowded
+closer to see the presents.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_258' name='page_258'></a>258</span></p>
+<p>Menard spoke slowly and quietly. The rustling
+and whispering in the outer circle died
+away, so that every word was distinct.</p>
+<p>&#8220;When the Five Nations have given their
+word to another nation, it has not been necessary
+to sign a paper; it has not been necessary
+to keep a record. The Long Arrow has said
+that the Iroquois do not forget. He is right.
+The words that have gone out from the councils
+have never been forgotten. I see here, in this
+council, the faces of warriors who have grown
+old in serving their people, of chiefs who are
+bent and wrinkled with the cares of many generations.
+I see in the eyes of my brothers that
+they have not forgotten the Onontio, who went
+away to his greater chief only five seasons ago.
+They have seen this Onontio in war and peace.
+They have listened to his silver tongue in the
+council. They have called themselves his children,
+and have known that he was a wise and
+kind father. They remember the promises they
+made him. But the Senecas did not remember.
+The Seneca has no ears; he has a hole in his
+head, and the words of his father have passed
+through. The Senecas promised Onontio that
+they would not take the white man&#8217;s beaver.
+But when the English came to their lodges and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_259' name='page_259'></a>259</span>
+whispered in their ears, the hole was stopped.
+The English whispered of brandy and guns and
+powder and hatchets and knives. They told
+the Senecas that these things should be given
+to them if they would steal the beaver. The
+English are cowards&ndash;&ndash;they sent the Senecas
+to do what they were afraid to do. And then
+the hole in the Seneca&#8217;s head was stopped&ndash;&ndash;the
+Seneca who had forgotten the words of
+Onontio remembered the words of the English.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brothers of the Long House had not
+forgotten the promises they had given Onontio.
+When the Seneca chiefs called for aid in stealing
+the beaver, my brothers were wise and said
+no. The Onondagas and Cayugas and Oneidas
+and Mohawks were loyal&ndash;&ndash;they kept their
+promise, and Onontio has not forgotten; he
+will not forget.</p>
+<p>&#8220;This is what the Great Mountain would say
+to you, my brothers: You have been faithful to
+your word, and he is pleased. He knows that
+the Onondagas are his children. And he
+knows why the Senecas left their villages and
+fields to plunder his white children. It was
+for the skins of the beaver, which the white
+braves had taken from their own forests and
+would bring in their canoes down the Ottawa
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_260' name='page_260'></a>260</span>
+to trade at the white man&#8217;s villages. He
+knows, my brothers, that the Senecas had
+tired of their promises, and now would steal
+the beaver and sell it to the English. What
+comes to the boy when he climbs the tree to
+steal the honey which the bees have gathered
+and taken to their home? Is he not stung
+and bitten until he cries that he will not disturb
+the bees again? The Senecas have tried
+to take that which is to the white man as the
+honey is to the bee; and they too must be
+stung and bitten until they have learned that
+the Great Mountain will always protect those
+who deserve his aid. He has sent you a comb
+from the shell of the great sea-tortoise, more
+precious than a thousand wampum shells, to tell
+you that as the sea-monster pursues its enemies,
+so will he pursue those who cannot keep their
+promises&ndash;&ndash;who lie to him.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Father Claude handed him the comb, and he
+laid it before the Big Throat. It was evident
+that he had been closely followed, and he
+started on his second word with more vigour.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Your chiefs have spoken to-day of the
+storm cloud that has swept down from the
+north; your runners have told you that it is
+not a cloud, but an army, that has come up
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_261' name='page_261'></a>261</span>
+the great river and across the lake of Frontenac
+to the country of the Senecas. Do my
+brothers know what a great army follows their
+White Father when he sets out to punish his
+children? More than twenty score of trained
+warriors are in this war party, and every warrior
+carries a musket; to-night they are marching
+on the Seneca villages. They will destroy
+those villages as a brave would destroy a nest
+of hornets in his lodge. Not one lodge will be
+left standing, not one stalk of corn.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Oneidas and Onondagas and Cayugas
+talk of their cornfields. But even the Cayugas
+need have no fear. For Onontio is a wise and
+just father; he punishes only those that offend
+him. The Senecas have broken their promises,
+and the Senecas must be punished, but the
+other nations are still the children of the Great
+Mountain, and his hand is over them. The
+Big Buffalo has come from the Great Mountain
+to tell you that he will not harm the Cayugas;
+their fields and lodges are safe.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There was a stir at this, and then quiet, as
+the spectators settled back to hear the rest of
+Menard&#8217;s speech. Here was a captive who
+spoke as boldly as their own chiefs, who commanded
+their attention as a present bearer from
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_262' name='page_262'></a>262</span>
+the White Chief. And they knew, all of them,
+from the way in which he was choosing his
+words, coolly ignoring the more important
+subjects until he should be ready to deal with
+them, that he spoke with authority. He knew
+his auditors, and he let them see that he knew
+them.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Senecas have listened to the English.
+What do they expect from them? Do they
+think that the English wish to help them?
+Do they look for wealth and support from the
+English? My brothers of the Long House
+know better. They have seen the English
+hide from the anger of the Great Mountain.
+They have seen the iron hand of New France
+reach out across the northern country, and
+along the shores of the great lakes, and down
+the Father of Waters in the far west, while the
+English were clinging to their little strip of
+land on the edge of the sea. My brothers
+know who is strong and who is weak. Never
+have the fields of the Five Nations been so rich
+and so large. No wars have disturbed them.
+They have grown and prospered. Do the
+Senecas think it is the English who have
+made them great? No&ndash;&ndash;the Senecas are not
+fools. They know that the Great Mountain
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_263' name='page_263'></a>263</span>
+has driven away their enemies and given them
+peace and plenty. My brothers of the Long
+House remembered this when the Senecas
+came to them and asked for aid in stealing
+the beaver. They stopped their ears; they
+knew that Onontio was their father, and that
+they must be faithful to him if they wished to
+have plenty in their lodges.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Onontio is a patient father. Let the Senecas
+repent, and he will forgive them. Let
+them bury the hatchet, and he will forgive
+them. Let them be satisfied with peace and
+honest trade, and he will buy their furs, and
+give them fair payment. And then their cornfields
+shall grow so large that a fleet runner
+cannot pass around them in half a moon. They
+shall have no more famine. Their pouches
+shall be full of powder, their muskets new and
+bright. Their women shall have warm clothing
+and many beads. Nowhere shall there be
+such prosperous nations as here among the
+Iroquois. If the Senecas have broken their
+pledges and have not repented, they must be
+punished. But the Cayugas and Onondagas
+and Oneidas and Mohawks have not broken
+their pledges. The Great Mountain has sent
+the Big Buffalo to tell them that he has seen
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_264' name='page_264'></a>264</span>
+that they are loyal, and he is pleased. He
+knows that they are wise. If the Onondagas
+have a grievance, he will not forget it, and if
+they ask for vengeance he will hear them.
+The Great Mountain knows that the Onondagas
+are his children, that they will not make
+war upon their father. He sends this coat of
+seal fur that the hearts of the Cayugas and
+Onondagas and Oneidas and Mohawks may
+be kept warm, and to tell them that he loves
+them and will protect them.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid&#8217;s eyes sparkled with excitement.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I wish they would speak, or laugh, or do
+something,&#8221; she whispered to Father Claude,
+&#8220;Are they not interested? They hardly seem
+to hear him.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest looked at her gravely.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; he replied, &#8220;they are listening.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The time had come to speak of La Grange.
+The Captain had been steadily leading up to
+this moment. He had tried to show the Indians
+that they had no complaint, no cause for
+war, unless it was the one incident at Fort
+Frontenac. He knew that the chiefs not only
+understood his argument, but that they were
+quietly waiting for him to approach this real
+cause of trouble, and were probably curious to
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_265' name='page_265'></a>265</span>
+see how he would meet it. The mind of the
+Iroquois, when in the council, separated
+from the heat and emotion of the dance, the
+hunt, the war-path, was remarkably keen.
+Menard felt sure that if he could present his
+case logically and firmly, it would appeal to
+most of the chief and older warriors. Then
+the maid came into his thoughts, and he knew,
+though he did not look down, that she was
+gazing up at him and waiting. He hesitated
+for a moment longer. The chiefs, too, were
+waiting. The Long House was hushed:&ndash;&ndash;three
+hundred faces were looking at him
+through the twisting, curling smoke that
+blurred the scene into an unreal picture. Yes,
+the time had come to speak of La Grange; and
+he spoke the first words hurriedly, stepping
+half-unconsciously farther from the maid.</p>
+<p>There was a part of the true story of the
+capture which he did not tell,&ndash;&ndash;the Governor&#8217;s
+part. For the rest, it was all there, every word
+about La Grange and his treacherous act coming
+out almost brutally.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Your speakers have told you of the hunting
+party that was taken into the stone house,
+and put into chains, and sent away to be slaves
+to the Chief-Across-the-Water. There is a chief
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_266' name='page_266'></a>266</span>
+at the stone house whom you have seen fighting
+bravely in many a battle. He is a bold
+warrior; none is so quick or so tireless as Captain
+la Grange. But he has a devil in his
+heart. The bad medicine of white man and
+redman, the fire-water, is always close to him,
+ready to whisper to him and guide him. It
+was not the father at Quebec that broke the
+faith with the Onondagas. It was not the Big
+Buffalo. If the Big Buffalo could so forget
+his brothers of the Onondaga lodges, he would
+not have come back to the Long House to tell
+them of the sorrow of the Great Mountain.
+My brothers have seen the Big Buffalo in war
+and peace&ndash;&ndash;they know that he would not do
+this.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The devil was in Captain la Grange&#8217;s
+heart. He captured my brothers. He told
+the Great Mountain that it was a war party,
+that he had taken them prisoners fairly. He
+lied to the Great Mountain. When the Great
+Mountain asked the Big Buffalo to bring the
+prisoners to his great village on the river, the
+Big Buffalo could not say, &#8216;No, I am no longer
+your son!&#8217; When the Great Mountain commands,
+the Big Buffalo obeys. With sorrow
+in his heart he did as his father told him.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_267' name='page_267'></a>267</span></p>
+<p>Menard was struggling to put the maid out
+of his thoughts, to keep in view only the safety
+of the column and the welfare of New France.
+And as the words came rapidly to his lips and
+fell upon the ears of that silent audience, he
+began to feel that they believed him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brothers,&#8221; he said, with more feeling
+than they knew, &#8220;it is five seasons since I left
+your village for the land of the white man. In
+that time you have had no thought that I was
+not indeed your brother, the son of your chief.
+You have known other Frenchmen. Father
+Claude, who sits by my side; Father Jean de
+Lamberville, who has given his many years to
+save you for the great white man&#8217;s Manitou;
+Major d&#8217;Orvilliers, who has never failed to give
+food and shelter to the starving hunter at his
+great stone house,&ndash;&ndash;I could name a hundred
+others. You know that these are honest, that
+what they promise will be done. But in every
+village is a fool, in every family is one who is
+weak and cannot earn a name on the hunt.
+You have a warrior in this house who to-day
+raised his hand against a visitor in the great
+council. My brothers,&ndash;&ndash;it is with sadness
+that I say it,&ndash;&ndash;not all the white men are true
+warriors. You are wise chiefs and brave warriors;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_268' name='page_268'></a>268</span>
+you know that because one man is a dog,
+it is not so with all his nation. The Great
+Mountain sends me to you, and I speak in his
+voice. I tell you that Captain la Grange is
+a dog, that he has broken the faith of the
+white man and the redman, that the father at
+Quebec and the Great-Chief-Across-the-Water,
+who are so quick to punish their red children,
+will also punish the white. The white men
+are good. They love the Onondagas. And
+if any white man breaks the faith, he shall be
+punished.&#8221;</p>
+<p>His voice had risen, and he was speaking in
+a glow that seemed to drop a spark into each
+listening heart. He knew now that they believed.
+He turned abruptly for the present.
+Father Claude was so absorbed in following
+the speech, and in watching the maid, who
+sat with flushed cheeks and lowered eyes, that
+he was not ready, and Menard stooped and
+took the book. He could not avoid seeing
+the maid, when he looked down; and the
+priest felt a sudden pain in his own heart to
+see the look of utter weariness that came into
+the Captain&#8217;s eyes.</p>
+<p>Menard turned the leaves of the book for a
+moment, as if to collect himself, and then held
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_269' name='page_269'></a>269</span>
+it open so that the Indians could see the bright
+pictures. There was a craning of necks in the
+outer circles.</p>
+<p>&#8220;In these picture writings is told the story
+of the &#8216;Ceremonies of the Mass applied to the
+Passion of Our Lord,&#8217;&#8221; he said slowly. &#8220;And
+our Lord is your Great Spirit. It brings you
+a message; it tells you that the white man is
+a good man, who punishes his own son as
+sternly as his red child.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The present pleased the Big Throat. He
+would not let his curiosity appear in the council,
+but he dropped the book so that it fell
+open, seemingly by accident, and his eyes
+strayed to it now and then during the last
+word of the speech. Menard did not hesitate
+again.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have told my Onondaga brothers that
+this white dog shall be punished,&#8221; he said.
+&#8220;When this word is given in your council in
+the voice of Onontio, it is a word that cannot
+be broken. Wind is not strong enough, thunder
+is not loud enough, waves are not fierce
+enough, snows are not cold enough, powder is
+not swift enough to break it.&#8221; The words
+came swiftly from his lips. Calm old chiefs
+leaned forward that they might catch every
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_270' name='page_270'></a>270</span>
+syllable. Eyes were brighter with interest.
+The Long Arrow, thinking of his son and
+fearing lest the man who killed him should
+slip from his grasp, grew troubled and more
+stern. At last Menard turned, and taking the
+portrait from the priest&#8217;s hands held it up,
+slowly turning it so that all could see it in
+the uncertain firelight. At first they were puzzled
+and surprised; then a murmur of recognition
+ran from lip to lip.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You know this maid,&#8221; Menard was saying,
+&#8220;this maid who to all who love the Iroquois, to
+all who love the church, the Great Spirit, is a
+saint. Her spirit has been for many moons
+in the happy hunting ground. The snow has
+lain cold and heavy on her grave. The night
+bird has sung her beauty in the empty forest.
+Catherine Outasoren has come back from the
+land where the corn is always growing, where
+the snows can never fall; she has come back to
+bear you the word of the Great Mountain. She
+has come to tell you that the dog who broke
+the oath of the white man to the Onondagas
+must suffer. This is the pledge of the Great
+Mountain.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He stopped abruptly, and stood looking with
+flashing eyes at the circle of chiefs. There was
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_271' name='page_271'></a>271</span>
+silence for a moment, then a murmur that rapidly
+rose and swelled into the loud chatter of
+many voices. Menard laid the portrait at the
+feet of the Big Throat, and took his seat at the
+side of the maid,&ndash;&ndash;but he did not look at her
+nor she at him. Father Claude sat patiently
+waiting.</p>
+<p>There was low talk among the chiefs. Then
+a warrior came and led the captives out of
+doors, through a long passage that opened
+between two rows of crowding Indians. The
+night was clear, and the air was sweet to their
+nostrils. They walked slowly down the path.
+A group of young braves kept within a few rods.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It must be late,&#8221; said Menard, in a weak
+effort to break the silence.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; replied Father Claude.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I suppose we had better go back to our
+hut?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; said the priest again. But the maid
+was silent.</p>
+<p>They sat on the grass plot before the door,
+none of them having any words that fitted the
+moment. Menard brought out a blanket and
+spread it on the ground, that the maid need not
+touch the dew-laden grass.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_272' name='page_272'></a>272</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_XIV_WHERE_THE_DEAD_SIT' id='CHAPTER_XIV_WHERE_THE_DEAD_SIT'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER XIV.</h2>
+<h3>WHERE THE DEAD SIT.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>&#8220;They need not starve us,&#8221; said Menard,
+trying to speak lightly. &#8220;I am hungry.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The others made no reply.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will see what chance we have for a supper.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He got up and walked along the path looking
+for the guards. In a short time he returned.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They will bring us something. The sentiment
+is not so strong against us now, I think.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They change quickly,&#8221; said Father Claude.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. It is the Big Throat.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And yourself, M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; the maid said impulsively.
+&#8220;You have done it, too.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I cannot tell. We do not know what the
+council may decide. It may be morning before
+they will come to an agreement. The Long
+Arrow will fight to the last.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And the other, M&#8217;sieu,&ndash;&ndash;the one who
+attacked you,&ndash;&ndash;he too will fight?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_273' name='page_273'></a>273</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;He is nothing. When an Iroquois shows
+himself a coward his influence is gone forever.
+It may be even that they will give him a new
+name because of this.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There are times when a small accident or
+a careless word will change the mind of a
+nation,&#8221; said Father Claude. &#8220;When we left
+the council they were not unfriendly to us.
+But in an hour it may be that they will renew
+the torture. Until their hearts have been
+touched by the Faith there are but two motives
+behind the most of their actions, expediency
+and revenge. But I think we may hope.
+Brother de Lamberville has told of many
+cases of torture where the right appeal has
+brought a complete change.&#8221;</p>
+<p>So they talked on, none having anything to
+say, and yet each dreading the silences that
+came so easily and hung over them so heavily.
+They could see the council-house some distance
+up the path. Its outlines were lost in
+the shadows of the trees, but through the crevices
+in the bark and logs came thin lines of
+light, and a glow shone through the long roof
+opening upon the smoke that hung in the still
+air above it. Sometimes they could hear indistinctly
+the voice of a speaker; but the words
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_274' name='page_274'></a>274</span>
+could not be distinguished. At other times
+there was a low buzz of voices. The children
+and women who had not been able to get into
+the building could be seen moving about outside
+shutting off a strip of light here and there.</p>
+<p>Two braves came with some corn and smoked
+meat. Menard set it down on a corner of the
+blanket.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will eat, Mademoiselle?&#8221;</p>
+<p>She shook her head. &#8220;I am not hungry.
+Thank you, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If I may ask it,&ndash;&ndash;if I may insist,&ndash;&ndash;it is
+really necessary, Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She reached out, with a weary little gesture,
+and took some of the corn.</p>
+<p>&#8220;And you too, Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They ate in silence, and later went together
+to the spring for a cool drink.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We ought to make an effort to sleep,&#8221;
+Menard said; and added, &#8220;if we can. Father,
+you had better lie down. In a few hours, if
+there is no word, I will wake you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will not forget, M&#8217;sieu? You will not
+let me sleep too long.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No.&#8221; The Captain smiled. &#8220;No, Father;
+you shall take your turn at guard duty.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest said good-night, and went to a
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_275' name='page_275'></a>275</span>
+knoll not far from the door. The maid had
+settled back against the logs of the hut, and
+was gazing at the trees. Menard sat in silence
+for a few moments.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Mademoiselle,&#8221; he said at length, &#8220;I know
+that it will be hard for you to rest until we have
+heard; but&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; he hesitated, but she did not
+help him, and he had to go on,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;I wish you
+would try.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It would be of no use, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I know,&ndash;&ndash;I know. But we have much to
+keep in mind. It has been very hard. Any
+one of us is likely to break. And you have not
+been so used to this life as the Father and I.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I know it,&#8221; she said, still looking at the elm
+branches that bent almost to the ground before
+them, &#8220;but when I lie down, and close my eyes,
+and let my mind go, it seems as if I could not
+stand it. It is not bad now; I can be very
+cool now. You see, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221; She turned
+toward him with the trace of a smile. &#8220;But
+when I let go&ndash;&ndash;perhaps you do not know how
+it is; the thoughts that come, and the dreams,&ndash;&ndash;when
+I am awake and yet not awake,&ndash;&ndash;and
+the feeling that it is not worth while, this struggle,
+even to what it may bring if we succeed.
+It makes the night a torture, and the dread of
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_276' name='page_276'></a>276</span>
+another day is even worse. It is better to stay
+awake; it is better even to break. Anything
+is better.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard looked down between his knees at
+the ground. He did not understand what it
+was that lay behind her words. He started to
+speak, then stopped. After a little he found himself
+saying words that came to his lips with no
+effort; in fact, he did not seem able to check
+them.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is not right that I should be here near
+you. I gave up that right to-night. I gave it
+up yesterday. I have been proud, during these
+years of fighting, that I was a soldier. I had
+thought, too, that I was a man. It was hardly
+a week ago that I rebuked that poor boy for
+what I have since done myself. I promised
+Major Provost that I would take you safely to
+Frontenac. That I have failed is only a little
+thing. I have said to you&ndash;&ndash;no, you must not
+stop me. We have gone already beyond that
+point. We understand now. I have tried to
+be to you more than&ndash;&ndash;than I had a right to
+be while you were in my care. Danton did
+not know; Father Claude does not know. You
+know, because I have told you. I have shown
+you in a hundred ways.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_277' name='page_277'></a>277</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; she said, in a choking voice. &#8220;It is
+my fault. I allowed you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He shook his head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;That is nothing. It is not what you have
+done. It is not even what you think. It is
+what I shall think and know all my life,&ndash;&ndash;that
+I have done the wrong thing. There are some
+of us, Mademoiselle, who have no home, no ties
+of family, no love, except for the work in which
+we are slowly building up a good name and a
+firm place. That is what I was. Do you know
+what it is that makes up the life of such a
+man? It is the little things, the acts of every
+day and every week; and they must be honest
+and loyal, or he will fail. I might have stayed
+in Paris, I might even have found a place in
+Quebec where I could wear a bright uniform,
+and be close in the Governor&#8217;s favour. I chose
+the other course. I have given a dozen years
+to the harder work, only to fall within the week
+from all that I had hoped,&ndash;&ndash;had thought myself
+to be. And now, as I speak to you, I know
+that I have lost; that if you should smile at me,
+should put your hand in mine, everything that
+I have been working for would be nothing to
+me. You would be the only thing in the world.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She sat motionless. He did not go on, and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_278' name='page_278'></a>278</span>
+yet each moment seemed to bring them closer
+in understanding. After a little while she said
+huskily:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You cared&ndash;&ndash;you cared like that?&#8221;</p>
+<p>She was not looking toward him, and she
+could not see him slowly bow his head; but
+there was an answer in his silence.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You cared&ndash;&ndash;when you made the speech&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She looked at the stalwart, bowed figure.
+She was beginning to understand what he
+had done, that in his pledge to the chiefs he
+had triumphed over a love greater than she had
+supposed a man could bear for a woman.</p>
+<p>&#8220;A soldier cannot always choose his way,&#8221;
+he was saying. &#8220;I have never chosen mine.
+It was the orders of my superior that brought
+us here, that brought this suffering to you. If
+it were not for these orders, the Onondagas
+would be my friends, and because of that, your
+friends. It has always been like this; I have
+built up that others might tear down. I thought
+for a few hours that something else was to come
+to me. I should have known better. It was
+when you took the daisy&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; she raised her hand
+and touched the withered flower. &#8220;I did not
+reason. I knew I was breaking my trust, and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_279' name='page_279'></a>279</span>
+I did not care. After all, perhaps even that
+was the best thing. It gave me strength and
+hope to carry on the fight. It was you, then,&ndash;&ndash;not
+New France. Now the dream is over,
+and again it is New France. It must be that.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; she said, &#8220;it must be.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have had wild thoughts. I have meant
+to ask you to let me hope, once this is over
+and you safe at Frontenac. I could not believe
+that what comes so easily to other men
+is never to come to me. I cannot ask that
+now.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She looked at him, and a sudden glow came
+into her eyes.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why not?&#8221; she whispered, as if frightened.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why not,&#8221; he repeated, for an instant meeting
+her gaze. Then he rose and stood before
+her. &#8220;Because I have given an oath to bring
+Captain la Grange to punishment. You heard
+me. But you did not hear what I promised to
+Father Claude. I have sworn that what the
+Governor may refuse to do, I shall do myself.
+I have set my hand against your family.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You could not help it, M&#8217;sieu,&ndash;&ndash;you could
+not help it,&#8221; she said. But the light was going
+out of her eyes. It had been a moment of
+weakness for both of them. She looked up at
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_280' name='page_280'></a>280</span>
+him, standing erect in the faint light, and the
+sight of his square, broad shoulders seemed to
+give her strength. He was the strong one; he
+had always been the strong one. She rose and
+leaned back against the logs. She found that
+she could face him bravely.</p>
+<p>&#8220;He is your cousin,&#8221; he had just said in a
+dry voice.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, he is my cousin.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard was steadily recovering himself.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We will not give all up. You know that I
+love you,&ndash;&ndash;I hope that you love me.&#8221; He
+hesitated for an instant, but she gave no sign.
+&#8220;We will keep the two flowers. We will always
+think of this day, and yesterday. I have
+no duty now but to get you safe to Frontenac;
+until you are there I must not speak again.
+As for the rest of it, we can only wait, and
+trust that some day there may be some light.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She looked at him sadly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You do not know? Father Claude has not
+told you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Something in her voice brought him a step
+nearer.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You know that Captain la Grange is my
+cousin?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_281' name='page_281'></a>281</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;You did not know that I am to be his
+wife?&#8221;</p>
+<p>They stood face to face, looking deep into
+each other&#8217;s eyes, while a long minute dragged
+by, and the rustling night sounds and the call
+of the crickets came to their ears.</p>
+<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; he said, &#8220;I did not know. May I
+keep the flower, Mademoiselle?&#8221;</p>
+<p>She bowed her head. She could not speak.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He walked away. She saw him stop at the
+knoll where the priest lay asleep on a bed of
+boughs, and stand for a moment gazing down
+at him. Then he went into the shadows.
+From the crackling of the twigs she knew that
+he was walking about among the trees. She
+sank to the ground and listened to the crickets.
+A frog bellowed in the valley; perhaps he had
+been calling before&ndash;&ndash;she did not know.</p>
+<p>She fell asleep, with her cheek resting against
+a mossy log. She did not know when Menard
+came back and stood for a long time looking at
+her. He did not awaken Father Claude until
+long after the time for changing the watch.</p>
+<p>When he did, he walked up and down on the
+path, holding the priest&#8217;s arm, and trying to
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_282' name='page_282'></a>282</span>
+speak. They had rounded the large maple
+three times before he said:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You did not tell me, Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What, my son?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Captain stopped, and drawing the priest
+around, pointed toward the maid as she slept.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You did not tell me&ndash;&ndash;why we are taking
+her to Frontenac.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. She asked it. We spoke of it only
+once, that night on the river. She was confused,
+and she asked me not to speak. She
+does not know him. She has not seen him
+since she was a child.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard said nothing. He was gripping
+the priest&#8217;s arm, and gazing at the sleeping
+maid.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It was her father,&#8221; added Father Claude.</p>
+<p>Menard&#8217;s hand relaxed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-night, Father.&#8221; He walked slowly
+toward the bed on the knoll. And Father
+Claude called softly after him:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-night, M&#8217;sieu. Good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard lay awake. He could see the priest
+sitting by the door. He wondered if the maid
+were sleeping. A late breeze came across the
+valley, arousing the leaves and carrying a soft
+whisper from tree to tree, until all the forest
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_283' name='page_283'></a>283</span>
+voices were joined. Lying on his side he
+could see indistinctly the council-house. There
+were still the lighted cracks; the Long House
+was still in session. Their decision did not
+now seem so vital a matter. The thought of
+the maid&ndash;&ndash;that he was taking her to be the
+wife of another, and that other La Grange&ndash;&ndash;had
+taken the place of all other thoughts.</p>
+<p>Later still came the buzz of many voices.
+Dark forms were moving about the council-house.
+Menard raised himself to his elbow,
+and waited until he saw a group approaching
+on the path, then he joined Father Claude.</p>
+<p>The Big Throat led the little band of chiefs
+to the hut. They stood, half a score of them,
+in a semicircle, their blankets drawn close,
+their faces, so far as could be seen in the dim
+light, stern and impassive. Menard and the
+priest stood erect and waited.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It has pleased the Great Mountain that his
+voice should be heard in the Long House of
+the Iroquois,&#8221; said the Big Throat, in a low,
+calm voice. &#8220;His voice is gentle as the breeze
+and yet as strong as the wind. The Great
+Mountain has before promised many things to
+the Iroquois. Some of the promises he has
+broken, some he has kept. But the Onondagas
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_284' name='page_284'></a>284</span>
+know that there is no man who keeps all his
+promises. They once thought they knew such
+a man, but they were mistaken. White men,
+Indians,&ndash;&ndash;all speak at night with a strong voice,
+in the morning with a weak voice. Each draws
+his words sometimes off the top of his mind,
+where the truth and the strong words do not lie.
+The Onondagas are not children. They know
+the friend from the enemy. And they know,
+though he may sometimes fail them, that the
+Great Mountain is their friend, their father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard bowed slowly, facing the chief with
+self-control as firm as his own.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They know,&#8221; the Big Throat continued,
+&#8220;that the Indian has not always kept the faith
+with the white man. And then it is that the
+Great Mountain has been a kind father. If he
+thinks it right that our brothers, the Senecas,
+should meet with punishment for breaking the
+peace promised to the white man by the Long
+House, the Onondagas are not the children to
+say to their father, &#8216;We care not if our brother
+has done wrong; we will cut off the hand that
+holds the whip of punishment.&#8217; The Onondagas
+are men. They say to the father, &#8216;We care
+not who it is that has done wrong. Though he
+be our next of blood, let him be punished.&#8217; This
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_285' name='page_285'></a>285</span>
+is the word of the council to the Big Buffalo
+who speaks with his father&#8217;s voice.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Well as he knew the Iroquois temperament,
+Menard could not keep an expression of admiration
+from his eyes. He knew what this speech
+meant,&ndash;&ndash;that the Big Throat alone saw far into
+the future, saw that in the conflict between red
+and white, the redman must inevitably lose
+unless he crept close under the arm that was
+raised to strike him. It was no sense of justice
+that prompted the Big Throat&#8217;s words; it was
+the vision of one of the shrewdest statesmen,
+white or red, who had yet played a part in the
+struggles for possession of the New World.
+Greatest of all, only a master could have convinced
+that hot-blooded council that peace was
+the safest course. The chief went on:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo has spoken well to the
+council. He has told the chiefs that he has not
+been a traitor to the brothers who have for so
+long believed that his words were true words.
+The Big Buffalo is a pine tree that took root in
+the lands of the Onondagas many winters ago.
+From these lands and these waters, and the sun
+and winds that give life to the corn and the
+trees of the Onondagas, he drew his sap and his
+strength. Can we then believe that this pine
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_286' name='page_286'></a>286</span>
+tree which we planted and which has grown
+tall and mighty before our eyes, is not a pine
+tree at all? When a quick-tongued young
+brave, who has not known the young tree as we
+have, comes to the council and says that this
+Big Buffalo, this pine tree, is not a pine but an
+elm with slippery bark, are we to believe him?
+Are we to drop from our minds what our hearts
+and eyes have long known, to forget what we
+have believed? My brothers of the Long House
+say no. They know that the pine tree is a pine
+tree. It may be that in the haze of the distance
+pine and elm look alike to young eyes; but
+what a chief has seen, he has seen; what he
+has known, he has known. The Big Buffalo
+speaks the truth to his Onondaga brothers, and
+with another sun he shall be free to go to his
+white brothers.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Throat has a faithful heart,&#8221; said
+Menard, quietly. &#8220;He knows that the voice of
+Onontio is the voice of right and strength.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The chiefs of the Onondagas and Cayugas
+will sit quietly before their houses with their
+eyes turned toward the lands beyond the great
+lake, waiting for the whisper that shall come
+with the speed of the winds over forests and
+waters to tell them that the white man has kept
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_287' name='page_287'></a>287</span>
+his promise. When the dog who robbed our
+villages of a hundred brave warriors has been
+slain, then shall they know that the Big Buffalo
+is what they have believed him to be, their
+brother.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And the maid and the holy Father?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They are free. The chiefs are sorry that
+a foolish brave has captured the white man&#8217;s
+squaw.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard and Father Claude bowed again, and
+the chiefs turned and strode away. The priest
+smiled gently after them.</p>
+<p>&#8220;And now, M&#8217;sieu, we may rest quietly.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. You lie down, Father; it will not be
+necessary to watch now, and anyway I am not
+likely to sleep much.&#8221; He walked back to the
+bed on the knoll, leaving the priest to stretch
+out across the doorway.</p>
+<p>The elder bushes and briers crowded close to
+the little clearing behind the hut, and Menard,
+lying on his side with his face close to the
+ground, watched the clusters of leaves as they
+gently rustled. He rolled half over and stared
+up at the bits of sky that showed through the
+trees. It seemed as if the great world were a
+new thing, as if these trees and bushes and
+reaches of tufted grass were a part of a new life.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_288' name='page_288'></a>288</span>
+Before, they had played their part in his rugged
+life without asking for recognition; but to-night
+they came into his thoughts with their sympathy,
+and he wondered that all this great
+world of summer green and winter white, and
+of blue and green and lead-coloured water could
+for so long have influenced him without consciousness
+on his part. But his life had left
+little time for such thoughts; to-night he was
+unstrung.</p>
+<p>Over the noise of the leaves and the trickle
+of the spring sounded a rustle. It was not loud,
+but it was a new sound, and his eyes sought the
+bushes. The noise came, and stopped; came,
+and stopped. Evidently someone was creeping
+slowly toward the hut; but the sound was
+on the farther side of him, so that he could
+reach the maid&#8217;s side before whoever was
+approaching could cross the clearing.</p>
+<p>For a time the noise died altogether. Then,
+after a space, his eyes, sweeping back and forth
+along the edge of the brush, rested on a bright
+bit of metal that for an instant caught the light
+of the sky, probably a weapon or a head ornament.
+Menard was motionless. Finally an
+Indian stepped softly out and stood beside a
+tree. When he began to move forward the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_289' name='page_289'></a>289</span>
+Captain recognized Tegakwita, and he spoke his
+name.</p>
+<p>The Indian came rapidly over the grass with
+his finger at his lips.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Do not speak loud,&#8221; he whispered. &#8220;Do
+not wake the holy Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why do you come creeping upon my house
+at night, like a robber?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita is sad for his sister. His heart
+will not let him go among men about the village;
+it will not let his feet walk on the common
+path.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why do you come?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita seeks the Big Buffalo.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It cannot be for an honest reason. You
+lay behind the bush. You saw me here and
+thought me asleep, but you did not approach
+honestly. You crept through the shadows like
+a Huron.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita&#8217;s night eyes are not his day
+eyes. He could not see who the sleeping
+man was. When he heard the voice, he came
+quickly.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard looked at the musket that rested in
+the Indian&#8217;s hand, at the hatchet and knife that
+hung from his belt.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are heavily armed, Tegakwita. Is it
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_290' name='page_290'></a>290</span>
+for the war-path or the hunt? Do Onondaga
+warriors carry their weapons from house to
+house in their own village?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian made a little gesture of impatience.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita has no house. His house has
+been dishonoured. He lives under the trees,
+and carries his house with him. All that he
+has is in his hand or his belt. The Big Buffalo
+speaks strangely.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard said nothing for a moment. He
+looked up, with a keen gaze, at the erect figure
+of the Indian. Finally he said:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Sit down, Tegakwita. Tell me why you
+came.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. Tegakwita cannot rest himself until
+his sister has reached the Happy Hunting-Ground.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well, do as you like. But waste no
+more time. What is it?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo has been an Onondaga.
+He knows the city in the valley where the
+dead sit in their graves. It is there that my
+sister lies, by an open grave, waiting for the
+farewell word of him who alone is left to
+say farewell to her. Tegakwita&#8217;s Onondaga
+brothers will not gather at the grave of a girl
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_291' name='page_291'></a>291</span>
+who has given up her nation for a white dog.
+But he can ask the Big Buffalo, who brought
+the white dog to our village, to come to the
+side of the grave.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Your memory is bad, Tegakwita. It was
+not I who brought the white brave. It was
+you who brought him, his two hands tied with
+thongs.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian stood, without replying, looking
+down at him with brilliant, staring eyes.</p>
+<p>Menard spoke again.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You want me to go with you. You slip
+through the bushes like a snake, with your
+musket and your knife and your hatchet, to
+ask me to go with you to the grave of your
+sister. Do I speak rightly, Tegakwita?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo has understood.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard slowly rose and looked into the
+Indian&#8217;s eyes.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have no weapons, Tegakwita. The chiefs
+who have set me free have not yet returned the
+musket which was taken from me. It is dangerous
+to go at night through the forest without
+a weapon. Give me your hatchet and I will
+go with you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Tegakwita&#8217;s lip curled almost imperceptibly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The White Chief is afraid of the night?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_292' name='page_292'></a>292</span></p>
+<p>Menard, too, looked scornful. He coolly
+waited.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo cannot face the dead without
+a hatchet in his hand?&#8221; said Tegakwita.</p>
+<p>Menard suddenly sprang forward and
+snatched the hatchet from the Indian&#8217;s belt.
+It was a surprise, and the struggle was brief.
+Tegakwita was thrown a step backward. He
+hesitated between struggling for the hatchet
+and striking with the musket; before he had
+fully recovered and dropped the musket,
+Menard had leaped back and stood facing
+him with the hatchet in his right hand.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Now I will go with you to the city of the
+dead, Tegakwita.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian&#8217;s breath was coming quickly, and
+he stood with clenched fists, taken aback by the
+Captain&#8217;s quickness.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come, I am ready. Pick up your musket.&#8221;</p>
+<p>As Tegakwita stooped, Menard glanced
+toward the hut. The priest lay asleep before
+the door. It was better to get this madman
+away than to leave him free to prowl about the
+hut.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_293' name='page_293'></a>293</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_XV_THE_BAD_DOCTOR' id='CHAPTER_XV_THE_BAD_DOCTOR'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER XV.</h2>
+<h3>THE BAD DOCTOR.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>At the edge of the thicket they stopped and
+stood face to face, each waiting for the
+other to pass ahead. Tegakwita slightly bowed,
+with an unconscious imitation of the Frenchmen
+he had seen at Fort Frontenac and Montreal.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Pass on,&#8221; said Menard, sternly. &#8220;You
+know the trail, Tegakwita; I do not. It is you
+who must lead the way.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian was sullen, but he yielded,
+plunging forward between the bushes, and
+now and then, in the shadow of some tree,
+glancing furtively over his shoulder. His
+manner, the suspicion that showed plainly in
+the nervous movements of his head, in every
+motion as he glided through thicket, glade, or
+strip of forest, told Menard that he had chosen
+well to take the second place. His fingers
+closed firmly about the handle of the hatchet.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_294' name='page_294'></a>294</span>
+That he could throw at twenty paces to the
+centre of a sapling, no one knew better than
+Tegakwita.</p>
+<p>The city of the dead lay in a hollow at ten
+minutes&#8217; walk from the village. Generations
+ago the trees had been cleared, and no bush or
+sapling had been allowed a foothold on this
+ground. The elms and oaks and maples threw
+their shadows across the broad circle, and each
+breath of wind set them dancing over the
+mounds where many an hundred skeletons
+crouched side by side, under the grass-grown
+heaps of earth, their rusted knives and hatchets
+and their mouldy blankets by their sides. No
+man came here, save when a new heap of yellow
+earth lay fresh-turned in the sun, and a
+long line of dancing, wailing redmen, led by
+their howling doctors, followed some body that
+had come to claim its seat among the skeletons.</p>
+<p>Tegakwita paused at the edge of the clearing,
+and looked around with that furtive quickness.
+Menard came slowly to his side.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will take your weapons to the grave?&#8221;
+asked Menard, very quietly, but with a suggestion
+that the other understood.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. Tegakwita has no place for his weapons.
+He must carry them where he goes.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_295' name='page_295'></a>295</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;We can leave them here. The leaves will
+hide them. I will put the hatchet under this
+log.&#8221; He made a motion of dropping the
+hatchet, closely watching the Indian; then he
+straightened, for Tegakwita&#8217;s right hand held
+the musket, and his left rested lightly on his
+belt, not a span from his long knife.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The White Chief knows the danger of leaving
+weapons to tempt the young braves. He
+finds it easy to take the chance with Tegakwita&#8217;s
+hatchet.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well,&#8221; said Menard, sternly. &#8220;Lead
+the way.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They walked slowly between the mounds.
+Menard looked carefully about, but in the
+uncertain light he could see no sign of a
+new opening in any of them. When they
+had passed the centre he stopped, and said
+quietly:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian turned.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Where is the grave?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is beyond, close to the great oak.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah!&#8221;</p>
+<p>They went on. The great oak was in a
+dense, deep-shadowed place, at the edge of the
+circle. A little to one side, close to the crowding
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_296' name='page_296'></a>296</span>
+thicket, was a small, new mound. Looking
+now at Tegakwita, Menard could see that his
+front was stained with the soil. Probably he
+had spent the day working on the mound for
+his sister. While Menard stood at one side, he
+went to a bush that encroached a yard on the
+sacred ground and drew out a number of presents,
+with necessary articles and provisions to
+stay the soul on its long journey to the Happy
+Hunting-Ground. It was at the end of Menard&#8217;s
+tongue to repeat Tegakwita&#8217;s remark about
+hiding the weapons, but he held back and
+stood silently waiting.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come,&#8221; said the Indian.</p>
+<p>He parted the bushes, drew away a heavy covering
+of boughs, and there, wrapped in Tegakwita&#8217;s
+finest blanket, lay the body of the Indian
+girl. Menard stood over it, looking down with
+a sense of pity he had never before felt for an
+Indian. He could not see her face, for it was
+pressed to the ground, but the clotted scalp
+showed indistinctly in the shadow. He suddenly
+raised, his eyes to Tegakwita, who stood
+opposite.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What have you done with the white brave?&#8221;
+he said in fierce, low tones. &#8220;What have you
+done with him?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_297' name='page_297'></a>297</span></p>
+<p>Tegakwita raised one arm and swept it about
+in a quarter circle.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ask the vultures that come when a man
+falls, ask the beasts that wait for everyone, ask
+the dogs of the village. They can tell you,
+not I.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard&#8217;s hands closed tightly, and a wild
+desire came to him to step across the body and
+choke the man who had killed Danton; but in
+a moment he was himself. He had nothing to
+gain by violence. And after all, the Indian
+had done no more than was, in his eyes, right.
+He bent down; and together they carried the
+body to the grave, close at hand. Tegakwita
+placed her sitting upright in the hole he had
+dug. By her side he placed the pots and dishes
+and knives which she had used in preparing the
+food they two had eaten. He set the provisions
+before her and in her lap; and drawing a twist
+of tobacco from his bosom, he laid it at her feet
+to win her the favour and kindness of his own
+Manitou on her journey. After each gift he
+stood erect, looking up at the sky with his arms
+stretched out above his head; and at these
+moments his simple dignity impressed Menard.
+But there were other moments, when, in stooping,
+Tegakwita would glance about with nervous,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_298' name='page_298'></a>298</span>
+shifting eyes, as if fearing some interruption.
+His musket was always in his hand or
+by his side. Menard took it that he still feared
+the hatchet.</p>
+<p>Then at last the ceremony was done, and
+the Indian with his bare hands threw the earth
+over the hole in the mound. Still looking nervously
+from bush to bush, his hands began to
+move more slowly; then he paused, and sat by
+the mound, looking up with a hesitancy that
+recognized the need of an explanation for the
+delay.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita&#8217;s arms are weary.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Are they?&#8221; said Menard, dryly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita has not slept for many suns.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Neither have I.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian started as a rustle came from the
+forest. Menard watched him curiously. The
+whole proceeding was too unusual to be easily
+understood. Tegakwita&#8217;s nervous manner, his
+request that the Captain accompany him to the
+mound, the weapons that never left his side,&ndash;&ndash;these
+might be the signs of a mind driven to
+madness by his sister&#8217;s act; but Menard did not
+recollect, from his own observation of the Iroquois
+character, that love for a sister was a
+marked trait among the able-bodied braves.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_299' name='page_299'></a>299</span>
+Perhaps it was delay that he sought. At this
+thought Menard quietly moved farther from the
+undergrowth. Tegakwita&#8217;s quick eyes followed
+the movement.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come,&#8221; said the Captain, &#8220;the night is nearly
+gone. I cannot wait longer.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita has worked hard. His heart is
+sick, his body lame. Will the Big Buffalo
+help his Onondaga brother?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian rose with too prompt relief.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Your muscles need only the promise of
+help to give them back their spring, Tegakwita.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The White Chief speaks with a biting
+tongue.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You have been speaking with a lying
+tongue. You think I do not know why you have
+brought me here; you think I do not understand
+the evil thoughts that fill your mind.
+You are a coward, Tegakwita. But you will
+not succeed to-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The ill-concealed fright that came into the
+Indian&#8217;s face and manner told Menard that he
+was not wide of the mark. He began to understand.
+Tegakwita wished to get him at work
+and off his guard,&ndash;&ndash;the rest would be simple.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_300' name='page_300'></a>300</span>
+And as Menard well knew, more than one
+brave of the Onondagas, who had known him
+both as friend and enemy, would shrink when
+the moment came to attack the Big Buffalo
+single-handed, even though taking him at a
+disadvantage. Now Tegakwita was hesitating,
+and struggling to keep his eyes from the
+thicket.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, I will help you. We will close this
+matter now, and go back to the village where
+your cowardly hands will be tied by fear of
+your chiefs. Drop your musket.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo speaks in anger. Does he
+think to disarm Tegakwita that he may kill
+him?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Lay your musket on the ground before us.
+Then I will drop the hatchet.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Tegakwita stepped around the grave, and
+leaning the musket across a stone stood by it.
+Menard&#8217;s voice was full of contempt.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You need not fear. The Big Buffalo keeps
+his word.&#8221; He tossed the hatchet over the
+grave, and stood unarmed. &#8220;Drop your
+knife.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Tegakwita hesitated. Menard took a step
+forward, and the knife fell to the ground.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come. We will work side by side.&#8221; He
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_301' name='page_301'></a>301</span>
+was surprised at Tegakwita&#8217;s slinking manner.
+He wondered if this Indian could by
+some strange accident have been given a temperament
+so fine that sorrow could unman him.
+To the Iroquois, gifted as they were with reasoning
+power, life held little sentiment. Curiously
+enough, as Menard stood in the light of
+the young moon watching the warrior come
+slowly around the grave, which still showed
+above the earth the head and shoulders of the
+dead girl, he found himself calling up the rare
+instances he had known of a real affection between
+Indians.</p>
+<p>Tegakwita stood by him, and without a word
+they stooped and set to work, side by side,
+scraping the earth with their fingers over the
+body. Tegakwita found a dozen little ways to
+delay. Menard steadily lost patience.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tegakwita has forgotten,&#8221; said the Indian,
+standing up; &#8220;he has not offered the present
+to his sister&#8217;s Oki.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well?&#8221; said Menard, roughly.</p>
+<p>Tegakwita&#8217;s voice trembled, as if he knew
+that he was pressing the white man too far.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The grave must be opened. It will not
+take long.&#8221;</p>
+<p>It came to Menard in a flash. The many delays,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_302' name='page_302'></a>302</span>
+the anxious glances toward the thicket,&ndash;&ndash;these
+meant that others were coming. Something
+delayed them; Tegakwita must hold the
+Big Buffalo till they arrived. With never a
+word Menard sprang over the grave; but the
+Indian was quicker, and his hand was the first
+on the musket. Then they fought, each struggling
+to free his hands from the other&#8217;s grasp,
+rolling over and over,&ndash;&ndash;now half erect, tramping
+on the soft mound, now wrestling on the
+harder ground below. At last Menard, as they
+whirled and tumbled past the weapons, snatched
+the knife. Tegakwita caught his wrist, and
+then it was nigh to stabbing his own thigh as
+they fought for it. Once he twisted his hand
+and savagely buried the blade in the Indian&#8217;s
+side. Tegakwita caught his breath and rallied,
+and the blood of the one was on them both.
+At last a quick wrench bent the Indian&#8217;s wrist
+back until it almost snapped,&ndash;&ndash;Menard thought
+that it had,&ndash;&ndash;and the stained blade went home
+once, and again, and again, until the arms that
+had clung madly about the white man slipped
+off, and lay weakly on the ground.</p>
+<p>Menard was exhausted. The dirt and blood
+were in his hair and eyes and ears. He was
+rising stiffly to his knees when the rush of
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_303' name='page_303'></a>303</span>
+Indians came from the bushes. He could not
+see them clearly,&ndash;&ndash;could hardly hear them,&ndash;&ndash;though
+he fought until a musket-stock swung
+against his head and stretched him on the
+ground.</p>
+<p>When he recovered they were standing
+about him, half a score of them, waiting to
+see if he still had life. He raised a bruised
+arm to wipe his eyes, but a rough hand caught
+it and drew a thong tightly about his wrists.
+Slowly his senses awakened, and he could see
+indistinctly the silent forms,&ndash;&ndash;some standing
+motionless, others walking slowly about. It
+was strange. His aching head had not the
+wit to meet with the situation. Then they
+jerked him to his feet, and with a stout brave
+at each elbow and others crowding about on
+every side, he was dragged off through the
+bushes.</p>
+<p>For a long time the silent party pushed forward.
+They were soon clear of the forest,
+passing through rich wild meadows that lifted
+the scent of clover, the fresher for the dew that
+lay wet underfoot. There were other thickets
+and other forests, and many a reach of meadow,
+all rolling up and down over the gentle hills.
+Menard tried to gather his wits, but his head
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_304' name='page_304'></a>304</span>
+reeled; and the struggle to keep his feet moving
+steadily onward was enough to hold his
+mind. He knew that he should watch the
+trail closely, to know where they were taking
+him, but he was not equal to the effort. At
+last the dawn came, gray and depressing, creeping
+with deadly slowness on the trail of the retreating
+night. The sky was dull and heavy,
+and a mist clung about the party, leaving little
+beads of moisture on deerskin coats and
+fringed leggings and long, brown musket barrels.
+The branches drooped from the trees,
+blurred by the mist and the half dark into
+strange shapes along the trail.</p>
+<p>The day was broad awake when Menard
+gave way. His muscles had been tried to the
+limit of his endurance during these many desperate
+days and sleepless nights that he had
+thought to be over. He fell loosely forward.
+For a space they dragged him, but the burden
+was heavy, and the chief ordered a rest. The
+band of warriors scattered about to sleep under
+the trees, leaving a young brave to watch the
+Big Buffalo, who slept motionless where they
+had dropped him in the long grass close at
+hand. On every side were hills, shielding
+them from the view of any chance straggler
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_305' name='page_305'></a>305</span>
+from the Onondaga villages, unless he should
+clamber down the short slopes and search for
+them in the mist. A stream tumbled by, not
+a dozen yards from Menard and his yawning
+guardian.</p>
+<p>When he awoke, the mist had thinned, but
+the sky showed no blue. Beneath the gray
+stretch that reached from hill crest to hill crest,
+light foaming clouds scudded across from east
+to west, though there was little wind near the
+ground. The Captain listened for a time to
+the noise of the stream before looking about.
+He changed his position, and rheumatic pains
+shot through his joints. For the second time
+in his life he realized that he was growing old;
+and with this thought came another. What
+sort of a soldier was he if he could not pass
+through such an experience without paying
+the old man&#8217;s penalty. To be sure his head
+was battered and bruised, and scattered over
+his shoulders and arms and hips were a dozen
+small wounds to draw in the damp from the
+grass, but he did not think of these. In his
+weak, half-awake state, he was discouraged,
+with the feeling that the best of his life was
+past. And the thought that he, a worn old
+soldier, could have dreamed what he had
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_306' name='page_306'></a>306</span>
+dreamed of the maid and her love sank down
+on his heart like a weight. But this thought
+served another purpose: to think of the maid
+was to think of her danger; and this was to be
+the alert soldier again, with a plan for every
+difficulty as long as he had life in his body.
+And so, before the mood could drag him down,
+he was himself again.</p>
+<p>Most of the Indians were asleep, sprawling
+about under the trees near the water. The
+warrior guarding Menard appeared to be little
+more than a youth. He sat with his knees
+drawn up and his head bowed, his blanket
+pulled close around him, and his oily black
+hair tangled about his eyes. Menard lay on
+his back looking at the Indian through half-closed
+eyes.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well,&#8221; he said in a low, distinct voice,
+&#8220;you have me now, haven&#8217;t you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian gave him a quick glance, but
+made no reply.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is all right, my brother. Do not turn your
+eyes to me, and nothing will be seen. I can
+speak quietly. A nod of your head will tell me
+if anyone comes near. Do you understand?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Again the little eyes squinted through the
+hanging locks of hair.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_307' name='page_307'></a>307</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;You do understand? Very well. You
+know who I am? I am the Big Buffalo. I
+killed half a score of your bravest warriors in
+their own village. Do you think these thongs
+can hold the Big Buffalo, who never has been
+held by thongs, who is the hardest fighter
+and the boldest hunter of all the lands from
+the Mohawk to the Great River of the Illinois?
+Listen, I will tell you how many
+canoes of furs the Big Buffalo has in the
+north country; I will tell you&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian&#8217;s head nodded almost imperceptibly.
+A yawning brave was walking slowly
+along the bank of the stream, gathering wood
+for a fire. He passed to a point a few rods
+below the prisoner, then came back and disappeared
+among the trees.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will tell you,&#8221; said Menard, keeping his
+voice at such a low pitch that the guard had to
+bend his head slightly toward him, &#8220;of the
+great bales of beaver that are held safe in the
+stores of the Big Buffalo. Does my brother
+understand? Does he see that these bales are
+for him, that he will be as rich as the greatest
+chief among all the chiefs of the Long House?
+No brave shall have such a musket,&ndash;&ndash;with a
+long, straight barrel that will send a ball to
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_308' name='page_308'></a>308</span>
+the shoulder of a buffalo farther than the
+flight of three arrows. His blanket shall be
+the brightest in Onondaga; his many clothes,
+his knives, his hatchets, his collars of wampum
+shall have no equal. He can buy the
+prettiest wives in the nation. Does my brother
+understand?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The fire had been lighted, and a row of wild
+hens turned slowly on wooden spits over the
+flames. One by one the warriors were rousing
+and stirring about among the trees. There
+were shouts and calls, and the grumbling talk
+of the cooks as they held the long spits and
+turned their faces away from the smoke, which
+rose but slowly in the damp, heavy air. Menard
+lay with his eyes closed, as if asleep; even
+his lips hardly moved as he talked.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brother must think quickly, for the time
+is short. All that I promise he will have, if he
+will be a friend to the Big Buffalo. And every
+Onondaga knows that the word of the Big
+Buffalo is a word that has never been broken.
+My brother will be a friend. He will watch
+close, and to-night, when the dark has come,
+he will let his knife touch the thongs that
+hold the White Chief captive.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian&#8217;s face was without expression.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_309' name='page_309'></a>309</span>
+Menard watched him closely, but could not
+tell whether his offer was taking effect. What
+he had no means of knowing was that since the
+battle at the hut, and the short fight in the
+council-house, the younger braves had centred
+their superstitions on him. It was thought
+that his body was occupied by some bad spirit
+that gave him the strength of five men, and that
+he had been sent to their village by a devil to
+lure the warriors into the hands of the French.
+These were not the open views that would have
+been heard at a council; they were the fears of
+the untried warriors, who had not the vision
+to understand the diplomacy of the chiefs, nor
+the position in the village to give them a public
+hearing. They had talked together in low
+tones, feeding the common fear, until a few
+words from the Long Arrow had aroused them
+into action. And so this guard was between
+two emotions: the one a lust for wealth and
+position in the tribe, common to every Indian
+and in most cases a stronger motive than any
+of the nobler sentiments; the other an unreasoning
+fear of this &#8220;bad doctor,&#8221; the fear
+that to aid him or to accept furs from him
+would poison the ears of his own Oki, and
+destroy his chance of a name and wealth during
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_310' name='page_310'></a>310</span>
+his life, and of a long, glorious hunt after
+death.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brother shall come with me to the land
+of the white men, where there is no trouble,&ndash;&ndash;where
+he shall have a great lodge like the white
+chiefs, with coloured pictures in gold frames, and
+slaves to prepare his food. He shall be a great
+chief among white men and redmen, and his
+stores shall be filled to the doors with furs of
+beaver and seal.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard&#8217;s voice was so low and deliberate
+that the Indian did not question his statements.
+He was tempted more strongly than he had
+ever been tempted before, but with the desire
+grew the fear of the consequences. As for the
+Captain, he was clutching desperately at this
+slender chance that lay to his hand.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have given my brother his choice of
+greater power than was ever before offered to
+a youth who has yet to win his name. The
+stroke of a knife will do it. No one shall
+know, for the Big Buffalo can be trusted. My
+brother has it before him to be a red chief or
+a white chief, as he may wish. The warriors
+are near,&ndash;&ndash;the day grows bright; he must
+speak quickly.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There was a call from the group by the fire,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_311' name='page_311'></a>311</span>
+and the young Indian gave a little start, and
+slowly rising, walked away, yielding his place
+as guard to an older man. Menard rolled over
+and pressed his face to the ground as if weary;
+he could then watch the youth through the
+grass as he moved to the fire, but in a moment
+he lost sight of him. The new guard was a
+stern-faced brave, and his appearance promised
+no help; so the Captain, having done all that
+could be done at the moment, tried to get
+another sleep, struggling to put thoughts of
+the maid from his mind. Perhaps, after all,
+she was safe at the village.</p>
+<p>Meantime the youth, after a long struggle
+with the temptings of the bad doctor, yielded
+to his superstition, and sought the Long Arrow,
+who lay on the green bank of the stream. In
+a few moments the story was told, and the
+chief, with a calm face but with twinkling eyes,
+came to the prisoner and stood looking down
+at him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The White Chief is glad to be with his
+Onondaga brothers?&#8221; he said in his quiet
+voice.</p>
+<p>Menard slowly raised his eyes, and looked
+coolly at the chief without replying.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The tongue of the Big Buffalo is weary perhaps?
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_312' name='page_312'></a>312</span>
+It has moved so many times to tell the
+Onondaga what is not true, that now it asks
+for rest. The Long Arrow is kind. He will
+not seek to move it again. For another sleep
+it shall lie at rest; then it may be that our
+braves shall find a way to stir it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard rolled over, with an expression of
+contempt, and closed his eyes.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Long Arrow was sorry that his white
+brother was disappointed at the torture. Perhaps
+he will have better fortune after he has
+slept again. Already have the fires been lighted
+that shall warm the heart of the White Chief.
+And he shall have friends to brighten him.
+His squaw, too, shall feel the glow of the roaring
+fire, and the gentle hands of the Onondaga
+warriors, who do not forget the deaths of their
+own blood.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard lay still.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Another sleep, my brother, and the great
+White Chief who speaks with the voice of
+Onontio shall be with his friends. He shall
+hear the sweet voice of his young squaw
+through the smoke that shall be her garment.
+He shall hear the prayers of his holy Father
+by his side, and shall know that his spirit is
+safe with the Great Spirit who is not strong
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_313' name='page_313'></a>313</span>
+enough to give him his life when the Long
+Arrow takes it away.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There was still a mad hope that the chief
+spoke lies, that the maid and Father Claude
+were safe. True or false, the Long Arrow
+would surely talk thus; for the Iroquois were
+as skilled in the torments of the mind as of
+the body. He was conscious that the keen
+voice was going on, but he did not follow
+what it said. Again he was going over and
+over in his mind all the chances of escape.
+It might be that the youth had been moved
+by his offer. But at that moment he heard
+the Long Arrow saying:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220; ... Even before his death the Big Buffalo
+must lie as he has always lied. His tongue
+knows not the truth. He thinks to deceive
+our young braves with talk of his furs and
+his lodges and his power in the land of the
+white men. But our warriors know the truth.
+They know that the Big Buffalo has no store
+of furs, no great lodges,&ndash;&ndash;that he lives in
+the woods with only a stolen musket, where he
+can by his lies capture the peaceful hunters of
+the Onondagas to make them the slaves of his
+Chief-Across-the-Water.&#8221;</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_314' name='page_314'></a>314</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_XVI_AT_THE_LONG_LAKE' id='CHAPTER_XVI_AT_THE_LONG_LAKE'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER XVI.</h2>
+<h3>AT THE LONG LAKE.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>Menard again dropped to sleep. When
+the day had nearly reached its middle, he
+was aroused by two warriors, who pulled him
+roughly to his feet. The band had evidently
+been astir for some moments. A few braves
+were extinguishing the fire with clumps of sod,
+while the others packed in their blankets what
+had been left from the morning meal, or looked
+to the spots of rust which the damp had
+brought to knives and muskets. The Long
+Arrow came over to inspect the thongs that
+held Menard&#8217;s wrists; he had not forgotten
+his attack on his guards on the morning of the
+torture. And with a precaution that brought
+a half smile to the prisoner&#8217;s face, he posted
+a stout warrior on each side, in addition to
+those before and behind. Then they set out
+over the hills, wading through a great tumbling
+meadow where their feet sank deep into
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_315' name='page_315'></a>315</span>
+the green and yellow and white that June had
+spread over the open lands of the Iroquois.
+Overhead the sky, though still clouded, was
+breaking, giving little glimpses of clear blue.</p>
+<p>As they neared the crest of the first hill, the
+Captain looked back over his shoulder. The
+sun had at last broken through to the earth,
+and a great band of yellow light was moving
+swiftly across the valley. Before it, all the
+ground was sombre in its dark green and its
+heavy moisture; behind lay a stretch of golden
+sunshine, rounding over the farther hills in
+great billows of grass and flowers and clustering
+trees, glistening with dew and glowing with
+the young health of the summer. Up the hillside
+came the sunlight; and then in a moment
+it had passed them, and the air was warm and
+sweet.</p>
+<p>Menard looked at the sun and then back
+across the valley to get his direction. He
+saw that the party was moving a little to the
+south of west. This line of march should take
+them through the Cayuga country,&ndash;&ndash;a natural
+move on the part of the Long Arrow, for the
+Cayugas were closer to the scene of the fighting
+than the Onondagas, and therefore would
+be less likely to interfere with the persecution
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_316' name='page_316'></a>316</span>
+of a Frenchman, particularly before their chiefs
+should return from the council.</p>
+<p>Late in the afternoon they came to a slow-moving
+stream, the outlet of an inland lake.
+By the basin-shape of the end of the lake, he
+recognized it as one that lay directly between
+Onondaga and the Long Lake of the Cayugas.
+On the bank of the little river, under the
+matted foliage, the chief signalled a halt, and
+the warriors threw themselves on the ground.
+Menard lay at the foot of a beech whose roots
+dipped in the water, and for the hundredth
+time since the sun had risen he cast about for
+some chance at escape. The thongs about his
+wrists were tied by skilful hands. He tried to
+reach the knot with his fingers, but could not.
+His guards were alert to every motion; they
+lay on either side, and he could not lift his
+eyes without meeting the sullen glance of one
+or the other. He was about ready to submit,
+trusting to his wits to seize the first opportunity
+that should come; for after all, to worry
+would strain his nerves, and now, if at any
+time, his nerves and his strength were needed.
+When at last he reached this point of view, he
+lay back on the weed-grown earth and went to
+sleep.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_317' name='page_317'></a>317</span></p>
+<p>An hour later he was aroused for another
+start. Night came while they were on the
+way, but they pushed steadily forward, and
+within a few hours they reached the Long
+Lake. Instead of stopping, however, the Long
+Arrow headed to the south along the bank of
+the lake. For a space it was hard going
+through the interwoven bushes and briers that
+tore even Menard&#8217;s tough skin. The moon
+was in the sky, and here and there he caught
+glimpses of the lake lying still and bright.
+They saw no signs of life save for the flitting
+bats, and the owls that called weirdly through
+the reaches of the forest. After another hour
+they found a trail which led them down close
+to the water, and at last to a half-cleared space,
+rank and wild with weed and thistle, and with
+rotting heaps where lay the trunks of trees,
+felled a generation earlier. Scattered about
+the outer edge of the clearing, close to the
+circle of trees, were a few bark huts, with
+roofs sagging and doors agape. One or two
+were rivalled in height by the weeds that
+choked their windows. As Menard stood
+between his guards under the last tree on the
+trail, looking at the deserted village where the
+frightened bats rose and wheeled, and the moonlight
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_318' name='page_318'></a>318</span>
+streamed on broken roofs, he began to
+understand. The Long Arrow had found a
+place where he could carry out his vengeance
+undisturbed.</p>
+<p>Other forms had risen from the weeds to
+greet the party. Looking more closely, Menard
+saw that a group of Indians were dragging logs
+for a fire. Evidently this was a rendezvous for
+two or more bands. He tried to count the dim
+forms, and found them somewhat less than a
+score in all. Perhaps the Long Arrow had
+found it not easy to raise a large party to
+defy the will of the council concerning the
+White Chief; but he had enough, and already
+the brandy was beginning to flow,&ndash;&ndash;the first
+stage of the orgie which should take up the
+rest of the night, and perhaps the day to follow.
+The Long Arrow and his party at once joined
+in the drinking. Confident that they would
+not this time be interrupted, they would probably
+use all deliberation in preparing for the
+torture.</p>
+<p>A rough meal was soon ready, and all fell to.
+Nothing was set apart for the prisoner; though
+had he been weak they would have fed him to
+stay him for the torture. One of his guardians,
+in mock pity, threw him a bone to which a little
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_319' name='page_319'></a>319</span>
+meat clung. He asked that his hands be loosed,
+or at least tied in front of his body, but his
+request brought jeers from the little group about
+him. Seeing that there was no hope of aid, he
+rolled over and gnawed the bone where it lay
+on the ground. The warriors laughed again,
+and one kicked it away; but Menard crawled
+after it, and this time was not disturbed. A
+little later, two other Indians came from the
+fire, and after a talk with his guards, ordered
+him to his feet and led him to one of the
+huts. The door was of rude boards, hung
+on wooden hinges, and now held in place by a
+short log. One brave kicked away the log, and
+Menard was thrown inside with such force that
+he fell headlong.</p>
+<p>Through an opening in the roof came a wide
+beam of moonlight. He looked up, and at
+first thought he was alone; then he saw two
+figures crouching against the rear wall. His
+own face and head were so covered with dust
+and blood that he could not have been recognized
+for a white man.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Who are you?&#8221; he said in Iroquois.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Captain!&#8221; came in a startled voice that he
+knew for Father Claude&#8217;s; and a little gasp of
+relief from the other figure brought a thrill of
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_320' name='page_320'></a>320</span>
+joy. He tried to raise himself, but in an instant
+they had come to him and were laughing and
+sobbing and speaking his name. While Father
+Claude seized his shoulders to lift him, the maid
+fell on her knees, and with her teeth tried to cut
+the thongs.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Wait, Father,&#8221; she said in a mumbled voice,
+without pausing in her work; &#8220;wait a moment.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard could feel her warm tears dropping
+on his hands.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You must not, Mademoiselle,&#8221; said the
+priest. &#8220;You must let me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She shook her head, and worked faster, until
+the thongs fell away and she could rub with her
+own torn hands the Captain&#8217;s wrists.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Now he may arise, Father. See&ndash;&ndash;see what
+they have done to him.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard laughed. All the weight that had
+pressed on his heart had lifted at the sound of
+her voice and the touch of her hands. The
+laugh lingered until he was on his feet, and the
+three stood close together in the patch of moonlight
+and looked each into the other&#8217;s eyes&ndash;&ndash;not
+speaking, because there was no word so
+complete as the relief that had come to them
+all; a relief so great, and a bond so strong that
+during all the time they should live thereafter,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_321' name='page_321'></a>321</span>
+through other days and other times, even across
+the seas in lands where much should be about
+them to draw a mist over the past, the moment
+would always be close in their memories,&ndash;&ndash;it
+would stand out above all other deeds and other
+moments. Then the Captain held out his hands,
+and they each took one in a long clasp that told
+them all to hope, that stirred a new, daring
+thought in each heart. Father Claude at last
+turned away with shining eyes. The maid stood
+looking up at this soldier whom she trusted, and
+a little sigh passed her lips. Then she too
+turned, and to cover her thoughts she hummed
+a gay air that Menard had heard the trumpeters
+play at Quebec.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tell us, M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; she said abruptly, &#8220;what is
+it? How did it happen?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is the Long Arrow.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;So we thought,&#8221; said Father Claude; &#8220;but
+he was not with the party that brought us
+here, and we could not know. They came
+while we were sleeping, and bound our mouths
+so that we could not scream. I was at
+fault, I&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, Father. You cannot say that. I left
+you. I should have been at your side.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will you tell us about it, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221; asked
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_322' name='page_322'></a>322</span>
+the maid. She was leaning against the bark
+wall, looking at the two men.</p>
+<p>Menard dropped to the ground, and in a quiet
+voice gave them the story of his capture. The
+priest rested near him on the broken-down bench
+that slanted against one wall. As the story
+grew, the maid came over and sat at the Captain&#8217;s
+feet where she could watch his face as he
+talked. When he reached the account of the
+fight at the grave, he paused and looked at her
+upturned face. Then he went on, but he did
+not take up the tale where he had dropped it.
+He could not tell her of Tegakwita&#8217;s end. As
+he went on to the fight with the Long Arrow&#8217;s
+band and the flight through the hill country, he
+thought that she had missed nothing; but when
+he had finished she said:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And Tegakwita, M&#8217;sieu? Did he come
+with them?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; Menard replied; &#8220;he did not come. I
+killed him.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He had not meant to let the words come out
+so brutally. And now, as he saw the frightened
+look, almost of horror, come into her eyes, he
+suffered in a way that would not have been possible
+before he had known this maid. He read
+her thoughts,&ndash;&ndash;that she herself was the cause
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_323' name='page_323'></a>323</span>
+of a double tragedy,&ndash;&ndash;and it for the moment
+unmanned him. When he could look at her
+again, she was more nearly herself.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Go on, M&#8217;sieu. There is more?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. There is no more, except that I am
+here with you. But of yourselves? You have
+told me nothing.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We have told you all there is to tell,&#8221; said
+Father Claude. &#8220;We were taken while we
+slept. They have come rapidly, but otherwise
+they have not been unkind.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You have had food?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We must think now,&#8221; Menard said abruptly;
+&#8220;we must put our wits together. It is late in
+the night, and we should be free before dawn.
+Have you thought of any way?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; replied the priest, slowly, &#8220;we have
+thought of one. Teganouan is with our party.
+At the first he tried to keep out of sight, but
+of course he could not, once we were on the
+way. He was a long time at the Mission of
+St. Francis, and I at one time hoped that he
+would prove a true believer. It was drink that
+led him away from us,&ndash;&ndash;an old weakness with
+him. This morning, when he passed me, I
+knew that he was ashamed. I dared not speak
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_324' name='page_324'></a>324</span>
+to him; but since then, whenever my eyes
+have met his, I have seen that look of understanding.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I fear you will not see it to-night,&#8221; said the
+Captain. &#8220;They are drinking.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah, but he is not. He is guarding the hut.
+Come, M&#8217;sieu, it may be that we can see him
+now.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard rose, and with the priest peered
+through the cracks at the rear of the hut.
+After a moment they saw him, standing in the
+shadow of a tree.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are sure it is he, Father?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah, M&#8217;sieu, I should know him.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard rested his hand on a strip of rotting
+bark in the wall. The priest saw the movement.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; he said cautiously, &#8220;it would be very
+simple. But you will be cautious, M&#8217;sieu. Of
+course, I do not know&ndash;&ndash;I cannot tell surely&ndash;&ndash;and
+yet it must be that Teganouan still has a
+warm heart. It cannot be that he has forgotten
+the many months of my kindness.&#8221;</p>
+<p>While they stood there, hesitating between a
+dozen hasty plans, a light step sounded, and in
+an instant their eyes were at the opening. A
+second Indian had joined the guard, and was
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_325' name='page_325'></a>325</span>
+talking with him in a low voice. Father Claude
+gripped the Captain&#8217;s arm.</p>
+<p>&#8220;See, M&#8217;sieu,&ndash;&ndash;the wampum collar,&ndash;&ndash;it is
+the Long Arrow.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard laid his finger on his lips. The two
+Indians were not a dozen yards away. The
+chief swayed unsteadily as he talked, and once
+his voice rose. He carried a bottle, and paused
+now and then to drink from it.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan is holding back,&#8221; whispered
+Menard. &#8220;See, the Long Arrow has taken his
+arm&ndash;&ndash;they are coming&ndash;&ndash;is the door fast?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We cannot make it fast, M&#8217;sieu. It opens
+outward.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard sprang across to the door and ran
+his hands over it, but found no projection that
+could be used to hold it closed. He stood for
+a moment, puzzling; then his face hardened,
+and he fell back to where the priest and the
+maid stood side by side.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They will get in, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. It is better.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They did not speak again. The moccasined
+feet made no noise on the cleared ground, and
+it seemed a long time before they could hear
+the log fall from the door. There were voices
+outside. At last the door swung open, and the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_326' name='page_326'></a>326</span>
+Long Arrow, bottle in hand, came clumsily into
+the hut and stood unsteadily in the square of
+moonlight. He looked about as if he could not
+see them. Teganouan had come in behind
+him; and the door swung to, creaking.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The White Chief is the brother of the
+Long Arrow,&#8221; said the chief, speaking slowly
+and with an effort to make his words distinct.
+&#8220;He loves the Onondagas. Deep in his mind
+are the thoughts of the young white brave who
+lived in our villages and hunted with our braves
+and called the mighty Big Throat his father.
+He never forgets what the Onondagas have
+done for him. He has a grateful heart.&#8221; The
+effort of speaking was confusing to the chief.
+He paused, as if to collect his ideas, and looked
+stupidly at the three silent figures before him.
+&#8220; ... grateful heart,&#8221; he repeated. &#8220;The Long
+Arrow has a grateful heart, too. He remembers
+the kind words of the white men who come to
+his village and tell him of the love of the Great
+Mountain. He never forgets that the Big Buffalo
+is his brother&ndash;&ndash;he never forgets. When
+the Big Buffalo took his son from the hunting
+party of the Onondagas he did not forget.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard did not listen further. He was looking
+about the hut with quick, shifting eyes, now
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_327' name='page_327'></a>327</span>
+at the chief in the moonlight, now at Teganouan,
+who stood at one side in the shadow,
+now at the door. Could Teganouan be trusted
+to help them? He glanced sharply at the warrior,
+who was looking at his chief with an alert,
+cunning expression. His musket lay carelessly
+in the hollow of his arm, his knife and hatchet
+hung at his waist. The chief had only his
+knife; in his hand was the bottle, which he
+held loosely, now and then spilling a few drops
+of the liquor.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Long Arrow nev&#8217;r f&#8217;rgets,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;the chief&#8217;s
+tongue was getting the better of him. &#8220;His
+house is lonely, where the fire burns alone and
+the young warr&#8217;r who once laid &#8217;s blanket,&ndash;&ndash;laid
+&#8217;s blanket by the fire, no long&#8217;r &#8217;s there to
+warm the heart of the Long Arrow. But now
+his loneliness is gone. Now when he comes
+from the hunt to &#8217;s house he&#8217;ll find a new fire,
+a bright fire, and a new squaw to warm &#8217;s heart&ndash;&ndash;warm
+&#8217;s heart.&#8221; He swayed a little as he
+spoke, and Teganouan took a short step forward;
+but the chief drew himself up and came
+slowly across the patch of moonlight. His eyes
+were unnaturally bright, and they rolled uncertainly
+from one to another of the little group
+before him. His coarse black hair was matted
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_328' name='page_328'></a>328</span>
+and tangled, and the eagle feathers that at the
+council had stood erect from his head now
+drooped, straggling, to one side.</p>
+<p>The maid had understood. The two men
+drew close to her on each side, and her hand
+rested, trembling, on Menard&#8217;s arm. All three
+were thinking fast. One scream, the sound of
+a struggle or even of loud voices, would bring
+upon them the whole drunken band. As the
+chief approached, the maid could feel the muscles
+harden on the Captain&#8217;s arm.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Long Arrow&#8217;s lonely&ndash;&ndash;his fire&#8217;s not bright
+when he comes from hunt&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; Here and there
+in his talk a few words were distinguishable as
+he stood lurching before them. He reached
+out in a maudlin effort to touch the maid&#8217;s
+white face. She drew in her breath quickly
+and stepped back; then Menard had sprung
+forward, and she covered her eyes with her
+hands.</p>
+<p>There was a light scuffle, but no other sound.
+A strong smell of brandy filled the hut. Slowly
+she lifted her head, and let her hands drop to
+her sides. The Long Arrow lay sprawling at
+her feet, his head gashed and bleeding, and
+covered with broken glass and dripping liquor.
+The priest had kneeled beside him, and over
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_329' name='page_329'></a>329</span>
+his bowed head she saw Teganouan, startled,
+defiant, his musket halfway to his shoulder,
+his eyes fixed on the door. Her eyes followed
+his gaze. There stood the Captain, his back
+to the door, the broken neck of the bottle firmly
+gripped in his hand.</p>
+<p>She stepped forward, too struck with horror
+to remain silent.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, M&#8217;sieu!&#8221; she said brokenly, stretching
+out her hands.</p>
+<p>He motioned to her to be quiet, and she
+sank down on the bench.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father,&#8221; he said.</p>
+<p>The priest looked up questioningly. There
+was a long moment of silence, and the shouts
+and calls of the half-drunken revellers without
+sounded strangely loud. Then, as the priest
+gazed at the set, hard face of the Captain, and
+at the motionless Indian, he understood of a
+sudden all the wild plan that was forming in
+the Captain&#8217;s mind. He rose slowly to his
+feet, and stood facing Teganouan, with the
+light streaming down upon his gentle face.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The sun has gone to sleep many times,
+Teganouan, since you left the great white
+house of the church at St. Francis. You
+have heard the counsel of evil men, who think
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_330' name='page_330'></a>330</span>
+only of the knife and the hatchet and the
+musket, who have no dream but to slay their
+brothers.&#8221; He was speaking slowly and in a
+kindly voice, as a father might speak to a son
+who has wandered from the right. &#8220;Have
+you forgotten the talk of the holy Fathers,
+when they told you the words of the Book of the
+Great Spirit, who is to all your Manitous and
+Okis as the sun is to the stars. Have you forgotten
+the many moons that passed while you
+lived in the great white house,&ndash;&ndash;when you
+gave your promise, the promise of an Onondaga,
+that you would be a friend to the white
+man, that you would believe the words of the
+Great Spirit and live a peaceful life? Have you
+forgotten, Teganouan, the evil days when your
+enemy, the fire-water, took possession of your
+heart and led you away from the white house
+into the lodges of them that do wrong,&ndash;&ndash;how
+when the good spirit returned to you and you
+came back to the arms of the Faith, you were
+received as a son and a brother? The holy
+Fathers did not say, &#8216;This warrior has done
+that which he should not do. Let him be
+punished. We have no place for the wrongdoer.&#8217;
+No; they did not say this. They said,
+&#8216;The lost is found. He that wandered from
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_331' name='page_331'></a>331</span>
+the fold has returned.&#8217; And they welcomed
+the lost one, and bade him repent and lead a
+right life. Have you forgotten, Teganouan?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian had slowly lowered his musket.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan has not forgotten,&#8221; he replied.
+&#8220;He has a grateful heart toward the holy
+Fathers of the great white house. When he
+was sick, they brought him their good doctor
+and told him to live. He believed that the
+white men were his brothers, that they would
+do to him as the Fathers had promised. But
+when Teganouan came to the white men, and
+asked to be made like they were, he left behind
+in his village a brother and a sister and a father
+who said that he was a traitor, who said that
+he was false to the trust of his blood and his
+nation, that he was not of their blood.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And did he believe them? Did he not
+know, better than they could, that the faith of
+the white man is also the faith of the redman;
+that the love of the white man includes all who
+breathe and speak and hunt and trade and
+move upon the earth?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan has not forgotten. He heard
+the words of the Fathers, and he believed that
+they were true; but when the white Captain
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_332' name='page_332'></a>332</span>
+took from the Onondagas five score of their
+bravest warriors and called them slaves, when
+he took the brother of Teganouan, borne by
+the same mother and fed by the same hand, to
+be a slave of the mighty Chief-Across-the-Water,
+could he remember what the holy
+Fathers had said,&ndash;&ndash;that all men were
+brothers?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan has heard what the White
+Chief, the Big Buffalo, has said, that the evil
+man who was treacherous to the Onondagas
+shall be punished?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan understands. But the evil man
+is far from the vengeance of the white man.
+The White Chief is here in our lodges.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard left the door and came to the
+priest&#8217;s side. The jagged piece of glass, his
+only weapon, he threw to the ground.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan,&#8221; he said slowly and firmly, looking
+into the Indian&#8217;s eyes, &#8220;you heard the
+great council at the Long House of the Five
+Nations. You heard the decision of the chiefs
+and warriors, that they whom Onontio had
+sent to bring a message of peace should be
+set free. You have broken the pledge made
+by your council. You have attacked us and
+made us prisoners, and brought us here where
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_333' name='page_333'></a>333</span>
+we may be tortured and killed and none may
+know. But when the Great Mountain finds
+that the Big Buffalo has not come back, when
+he sends his white soldier to the villages of the
+Onondagas and asks what they have done to
+him who brought his voice, what will you say?
+When the chiefs say, &#8216;We set him free,&#8217; and look
+about to find the warrior who has dared to
+disobey the Long House, what will you say?
+When the young boys and the drunkards with
+loose tongues have told the story of the death
+of the Long Arrow, what will you say? Then
+you will be glad to flee to the white house of
+the holy Fathers, knowing that they will protect
+you and save you when the braves of your
+own blood shall pursue you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Teganouan&#8217;s eyelids had drooped, and now he
+was looking at the ground, where the chief lay.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will come with me, Teganouan. You
+will fly with us over the Long Lake, and
+through the forests and down the mighty rivers
+and over the inland sea, and there you shall
+be safe; and you shall see with your own eyes
+the punishment that the Great Mountain will
+give to the evil man who has been false to the
+Onondagas.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He held out his hand, and silently waited.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_334' name='page_334'></a>334</span>
+The priest&#8217;s head was raised, and his lips moved
+slowly in prayer. The maid sat rigid, her
+hands tightly gripping the edge of the bench.
+Though he knew that every moment brought
+nearer the chance of discovery, that the lives
+of them all hung on a thread as slender as a
+hair, the Captain stood without the twitching
+of a muscle, without a sign of fear or haste in
+his grave, worn face.</p>
+<p>The Indian&#8217;s eyes wavered. He looked at the
+fallen chief, at the priest, at Menard; then he
+took the offered hand. No further word was
+needed. Menard did not know the thought
+that lay behind the cunning face; it was
+enough that the Indian had given his word.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Quick, we must hide him,&#8221; said the Captain,
+looking swiftly about the hut. &#8220;We must disturb
+you, Mademoiselle&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>In a moment the three men had lifted the
+body of the Long Arrow and laid it away under
+the low bench. Teganouan scraped a few
+handfuls of earth from a corner and spread it
+over the spot where the chief had been.</p>
+<p>&#8220;How far is it to the lake, Teganouan?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But a few rods.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And the forest is thick?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_335' name='page_335'></a>335</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;We must cross the lake. Is there a canoe
+here?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian shook his head. Menard stood
+thinking for an instant.</p>
+<p>&#8220;If you are thinking of me, M&#8217;sieu, I think I
+can swim with you,&#8221; said the maid, timidly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;There is no other way, Mademoiselle. I
+am sorry. But we will make it as easy as we
+can.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He stepped to the rear wall, and with a blow
+of his fist would have broken an opening
+through the rotted bank, but the Indian caught
+his arm.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is not necessary. See.&#8221; He set rapidly
+to work, and in a few silent moments he had
+unlaced the thread-like root that held the sheet
+of bark in place, and lowered it to the ground.
+He raised himself by the cross-pole that marked
+the top of the wall, and slipped through the
+opening. A few quick glances through the
+trees, and he turned and beckoned. Menard followed,
+with the knife of the Long Arrow between
+his teeth; and with Father Claude&#8217;s help
+the maid got through to where he could catch
+her and lower her to the ground.</p>
+<p>The Indian made a cautious gesture and
+crept slowly through the yielding bushes. One
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_336' name='page_336'></a>336</span>
+by one they followed, the Captain lingering
+until the maid was close to him and he could
+whisper to her to keep her courage. They
+paused at the bank of the lake. The water
+lay sparkling in the moonlight. Menard looked
+grimly out; this light added to the danger.
+He found a short log close at hand and carried
+it to the water.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come, Mademoiselle,&#8221; he whispered, &#8220;and
+Father Claude. This will support you. Teganouan
+and I will swim. Keep low in the
+water, and do not splash or speak. The slightest
+noise will travel far across the lake.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Slowly they waded out, dropping into the
+water before it was waist deep. Teganouan&#8217;s
+powder-horn and musket lay on the log, and
+the maid herself steadied it so that they should
+not be lost.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_337' name='page_337'></a>337</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_XVII_NORTHWARD' id='CHAPTER_XVII_NORTHWARD'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER XVII.</h2>
+<h3>NORTHWARD.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>Weak and chilled from the long swim
+through the cold water they dragged
+themselves across the narrow beach to the bushes
+that hung over the bank. Menard and Father
+Claude supported the maid, who was trembling
+and clinging to them. At the bank she sank
+to the ground.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is hard, Mademoiselle, but we must not
+stop. It is better to be weary than to rest in
+this condition. It would mean sickness.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; she said; &#8220;I know. In a moment I
+can go on.&#8221; She looked up and tried to smile.
+&#8220;It is so cold, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard turned to Teganouan.</p>
+<p>&#8220;How far is it to the villages of the Cayugas?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Not far. Half a sleep.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is there a trail?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The trail is far. It passes the end of the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_338' name='page_338'></a>338</span>
+Long Lake.&#8221; He raised his head and looked
+at the stars, then pointed to the southwest.
+&#8220;The nearest village lies there. If we go
+through the forest toward the setting sun, we
+shall meet the trail.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You think it will be wise to go to the Cayugas,
+M&#8217;sieu?&#8221; asked Father Claude.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think so. The chiefs must have returned
+before this time, or at least by the morrow.&#8221;
+He dropped into the Iroquois tongue. &#8220;Is not
+this so, Teganouan? Would the chiefs of
+the Cayugas linger among the Onondagas
+after the close of the council?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Cayuga warriors await the word of the
+Long House. They know that their chiefs
+would hasten to bring it back to them.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. It must be so, Father. And we can
+trust them to aid us. Perhaps they will give
+us a canoe. Teganouan must tell them he is our
+guide, sent by the Big Throat and the chiefs of
+the Onondagas to take us safely to Frontenac.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The maid was struggling to keep awake, but
+her lids were heavy. Menard came to her and
+stood, hesitating. She knew that he was
+there; she could hear the rustle of his wet
+clothes, and his heavy breathing, but she did
+not look up.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_339' name='page_339'></a>339</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Come,&#8221; he said, lightly touching her shoulder,
+&#8220;we cannot wait here. We must go.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She did not reply, and he hesitated again.
+Then he stooped and lifted her in his arms.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will go ahead, Teganouan,&#8221; he said,
+&#8220;and you, too, if you will, Father Claude.
+Choose an easy trail if you can, and be careful
+that no twig flies back.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They set out slowly through the forest. The
+priest and the Indian laboriously broke a way,
+and Menard followed, holding the maid tenderly,
+and now and then, in some lighter spot
+where a beam of moonlight fell through the
+foliage, looking down at her gentle, weary face.
+She was sleeping; and he prayed that no sad
+dreams might come to steal her rest. His arms
+ached and his knees gave under him, but he
+had hardly a thought for himself. At last, after
+a long, silent march, the priest stopped, and said,
+supporting himself with one thin hand against a
+tree:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You are weary, M&#8217;sieu. You must let me
+take Mademoiselle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, Father, no. I have been thinking. I
+am afraid it is not right that she should sleep
+now. Even though she fail in the effort, exercise
+of her muscles is all that will prevent sickness.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_340' name='page_340'></a>340</span>
+And yet I cannot,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;he looked again
+at her face as it rested against his shoulder,&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;I
+cannot awaken her now.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Father saw the sorrow in the Captain&#8217;s
+eyes, and understood.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will take her, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Carefully Menard placed her in Father
+Claude&#8217;s arms and turned away.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan,&#8221; he said, trying to recover his
+self-possession, &#8220;should we not be near the
+trail?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, more than half the way.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Can we reach it more quickly by heading a
+little to the north?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We would reach the trail, yes; but the way
+would be longer.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Never mind; once on the trail it will be
+easier than in this forest. Turn to the north,
+Teganouan.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He could hear the maid&#8217;s voice, protesting
+sleepily, and Father Claude talking quietly to
+her. He looked around. The priest said in a
+low tone:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come, M&#8217;sieu, it is hard to awaken her.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We must frighten her, then.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He caught her shoulders and shook her
+roughly. Slowly her eyes opened, and then the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_341' name='page_341'></a>341</span>
+two men dragged her forward. At first she
+thought herself back among the Onondagas,
+and she begged them not to take her away,
+hanging back and forcing them almost to carry
+her. It cut Menard to the heart, but he pushed
+steadily forward. Later she yielded, and with a
+dazed expression obeyed. Once or twice she
+stumbled, and would have fallen but for the
+strong hands that held her. Father Claude
+rested his hand on her forehead as they walked,
+and Menard gave him an anxious, questioning
+glance. The priest shook his head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; he said, &#8220;there is no fever. I trust
+that it is nothing worse than exhaustion.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard went on with relief in his eyes.</p>
+<p>In less than half an hour after reaching the
+trail, they came upon the outlying huts of the
+village. Over the hills to the east the dawn
+was breaking, and all the sleeping birds and
+beasts and creeping things of the forest were
+stirring into life and movement. Teganouan
+went ahead of the party and soon roused a member
+of the Cayuga branch of his clan, the family
+of the Bear. Through the yawning services of
+this warrior they were guided to an unused hut.
+Teganouan searched farther, and returned with
+a heap of blankets for the maid, who had dropped
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_342' name='page_342'></a>342</span>
+to the ground before the hut. Menard carried
+her within and made her as comfortable as possible,
+then withdrew and closed the door.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Have the chiefs returned from the council
+at the village of the Onondagas?&#8221; he asked of
+the warrior, who stood at one side watching
+them with curiosity in his gaze.</p>
+<p>The Cayuga bowed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Will my brother carry a message from the
+White Chief, the Big Buffalo, to his chiefs?
+Will he tell them, as soon as the sun has risen,
+that the Big Buffalo has come to talk with
+them?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The warrior bowed and walked away.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We are safe now, I think, Father. We
+must get what little sleep we can between now
+and sunrise.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Should not one of us watch, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;We are not fit for it. We have hard work
+before us, and many a chance yet to run.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan will watch,&#8221; said the Indian.</p>
+<p>Menard&#8217;s face showed surprise, but Father
+Claude whispered, &#8220;He has learned at the mission
+to understand our language.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They lay on the ground before the hut, in
+their wet clothes, and in a moment were asleep.
+Teganouan built a fire close at hand, and sat
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_343' name='page_343'></a>343</span>
+by it without a motion, excepting the alert shifting
+glances of his bead-like eyes, until, when the
+colours in the east had faded into blue and the
+sun was well above the trees, he saw the chiefs
+of the village coming slowly toward him between
+the huts, a crowd of young men following behind
+them, and a snarling pack of dogs running before.
+He aroused Menard and Father Claude.</p>
+<p>The chiefs sat in a circle about the fire, the
+two white men among them. The other Indians
+sat and stood in a wider circle, just within earshot,
+and waited inquisitively for the White
+Chief to state his errand.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My brothers, the white men, have asked to
+speak with the chiefs of the Cayugas,&#8221; said the
+spokesman, a wrinkled old warrior, whom Menard
+recognized as one of the speakers at the
+Long House.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo is on his way to the stone
+house of Onontio. He is far from the trail.
+His muskets and his knives and hatchets were
+taken from him by the Onondagas and were not
+returned to him. He asks that the chiefs of
+the Cayugas permit him to use one of their
+many canoes, that he may hasten to carry to
+Onontio the word of the Long House.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The White Chief comes to the Cayugas, who
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_344' name='page_344'></a>344</span>
+live two sleeps away from their brothers, the
+Onondagas, to ask for aid. Have the Onondagas
+then refused him? Why is my brother
+so far from the trail?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The chiefs of the Cayugas sat in the Long
+House; they heard the words of the great council,
+that the Big Buffalo and the holy Father
+and the white maiden should be set free. They
+know that what is decided in the council is the
+law of the nation, that no warrior shall break
+it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The little circle was silent with attention, but
+none of the chiefs replied.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It was still in the dark of the night when
+the Big Throat came to the lodge of the Big
+Buffalo, and gave him the pledge of the council
+that he should be free with the next sun. The
+Big Buffalo once learned to believe the pledge
+of the Iroquois. When the mighty Big Throat
+said that he was free, he believed. He did not
+set a guard to sit with wakeful eyes through the
+night in fear that the pledge was not true. No,
+the Big Buffalo is a warrior and a chief; he is
+not a woman. He trusted his red brothers, and
+rested his head to sleep. Then in the dark
+came a chief, a dog of a traitor, and took away
+his white brother and his white sister while their
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_345' name='page_345'></a>345</span>
+eyes were still heavy with sleep, and carried
+them far over the hills to the lake of the Cayugas.
+Here they hid like serpents in the long
+grass, and thought that they would kill them.
+But the Big Buffalo is a warrior. Without a
+knife or a musket or a hatchet he killed the
+Long Arrow and came across the Long Lake.
+He knew that the Cayugas were his brothers,
+that they would not break the pledge of the
+Long House.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The grave faces of the Indians showed no
+surprise, save for a slight movement of the
+eyes on the part of one or two of the younger
+men, when the Long Arrow was mentioned.
+Most of them had lighted their pipes before
+sitting down, and now they puffed in silence.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The White Chief speaks strangely,&#8221; the
+spokesman said at last. &#8220;He tells the Cayugas
+that their brothers, the Onondagas, have
+broken the pledge of the council.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He asks for aid?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; said Menard, &#8220;he does not ask for aid.
+He asks that the Iroquois nation restore to him
+what the dogs of the Long Arrow have taken
+away. He has spoken to the Long House in
+the voice of the Great Mountain. He has the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_346' name='page_346'></a>346</span>
+right of a free man, of a chief honoured by the
+council, to go freely and in peace. What if
+those who do not respect the law of the council
+shall rob him of his rights? Must he go on his
+knees to the chiefs? Must he ask that he be
+allowed to live? Must he go far back on his
+trail to seek aid of the Onondagas, because the
+Cayugas will not hold to the law?&#8221;</p>
+<p>One of the great lessons learned during Menard&#8217;s
+work under Governor Frontenac had been
+that the man who once permits himself to be
+lowered in the eyes of the Indians has forever
+lost his prestige. Now he sat before the chiefs
+of a great village, weak from the strain of the
+long days and nights of distress and wakefulness
+and hunger, his clothing still wet and bedraggled,
+with no weapon but a knife, no canoe,
+not to speak of presents,&ndash;&ndash;with none of the
+equipment which to the Indian mind suggested
+authority,&ndash;&ndash;and yet made his demands in the
+stern voice of a conqueror. He knew that these
+Indians cared not at all whether the word of
+the council to him had been broken or kept,
+unless he could so impress them with his
+authority that they would fear punishment for
+the offence.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo is a mighty warrior,&#8221; said
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_347' name='page_347'></a>347</span>
+the spokesman. &#8220;His hard hands are greater
+than the muskets and hatchets of the Cayugas.
+He fights with the strength of the winter wind;
+no man can stand where his hand falls. He
+speaks wisely to the Cayugas. They are sorry
+that their brothers, the Onondagas, have so
+soon forgotten the word of the great council,
+Let the Big Buffalo rest his arms. The warriors
+of the Cayugas shall be proud to offer
+him food.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They all rose, and after a few grunted words
+of friendship, filed away to go over the matter
+in private council. Menard saw that they were
+puzzled; perhaps they did not believe that he
+had killed the Long Arrow. He turned to
+Teganouan, who had been sitting a few yards
+away.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan, will you go among the braves
+of the village and tell them that the Big
+Buffalo is a strong fighter, that he killed the
+Long Arrow with his hands? It may be that
+they have not believed.&#8221;</p>
+<p>This was the kind of strategy Teganouan
+understood. He walked slowly away, puffing
+at his pipe, to mingle among the people of the
+village and boast in bold metaphors the prowess
+of his White Chief.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_348' name='page_348'></a>348</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;They will give us a canoe,&#8221; said Father
+Claude.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, they must. Now, let us sleep again.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They dropped to the ground, and Menard
+looked warningly at the circle of young boys
+who came as close as they dared to see this
+strange white man, and to hear him talk in the
+unpronounceable language. Father Claude&#8217;s
+eyes were first to close. The Captain was
+about to join him in slumber when a low voice
+came from the door.</p>
+<p>&#8220;M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He started up and saw the maid holding
+the door ajar and leaning against it, her pale
+face, framed in a tangle of soft hair, showing
+traces of the wearing troubles of the days just
+passed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah, Mademoiselle, you must not waken.
+You must sleep long, and rest, and grow bright
+and young again.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She smiled, and looked at him timidly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I have been dreaming, M&#8217;sieu,&#8221; she said, and
+her eyes dropped, &#8220;such an unpleasant dream.
+It was after we had crossed the lake&ndash;&ndash;We
+did cross it, M&#8217;sieu, did we not? That, too, was
+not a dream? No&ndash;&ndash;see, my hair is wet.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; he said, &#8220;that was not a dream.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_349' name='page_349'></a>349</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;We were on the land, and I was so tired,
+and you talked to me&ndash;&ndash;something good&ndash;&ndash;I
+cannot remember what it was, but I know that
+you were good. And I thought that I&ndash;&ndash;that
+I said words that hurt you, unkind words. And
+when I wished and tried to speak as I felt, only
+the other words would come. That was a
+dream, M&#8217;sieu, was it not? It has been troubling
+me. You have been so kind, and I could
+not sleep thinking that&ndash;&ndash;that&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; he said, &#8220;that was a dream.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She looked at him with relief, but as she
+looked she seemed to become more fully awake
+to what they were saying. Her eyes lowered
+again, and the red came over her face.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I am glad,&#8221; she said, so low that he hardly
+heard.</p>
+<p>&#8220;And now you will rest, Mademoiselle?&#8221;</p>
+<p>She smiled softly, and drew back within the
+hut, closing the heavy door. And Menard
+turned away, unmindful of the wide-eyed boys
+who were staring from a safe distance at him
+and at the door where the strange woman had
+appeared. He sat with his back against the
+logs of the hut, and looked at the ants that
+hurried about over the trampled ground.</p>
+<p>The sun was high when he was aroused by
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_350' name='page_350'></a>350</span>
+Teganouan, who had spent the greater part
+of the morning among the people of the village.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Have you any word, Teganouan?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. The warriors have learned of the
+strength of the Big Buffalo, and his name
+frightens them. They bow to the great chief
+who has killed the Long Arrow without a
+hatchet. They say that the Onondagas should
+be punished for their treachery.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan has been talking long with a
+runner of the Seneca nation.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah, he brings word of the fight?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. The Senecas have suffered under the
+iron hand of the Great Mountain. A great
+army takes up the hatchet when he goes on
+the war-path, more than all the Senecas and
+Cayugas and Onondagas together when every
+brave who can hold in his hand a bow or a
+musket has come to fight with his brothers.
+There were white warriors so many that the
+runner could not have counted them with all
+the sticks in the Long House. There were
+men of the woods in the skins and beads of
+the redmen; there were Hurons and Ottawas
+and Nipissings, and even the cowardly Illinois
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_351' name='page_351'></a>351</span>
+and the Kaskaskias and the Miamis from
+the land where the Great River flows past the
+Rock Demons. The Senecas fought with the
+strength of the she-bear, but their warriors were
+killed, their corn was trampled and cut, their
+lodges were burned.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Did the Great Mountain pursue them?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He has gone back to his stone house
+across the great lake, leaving the land black
+and smoking. The Senecas have come to
+the western villages of the Cayugas.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;There are none in this village?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. But the chiefs have sent blankets to
+their brothers, and as much corn as a hundred
+braves could carry over the trail. They have
+taken from their own houses to give to the
+Senecas.&#8221;</p>
+<p>A few moments later two young men came
+with baskets of sagamity and smoked meat.
+Menard received it, and rising, knocked gently
+at the door.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, M&#8217;sieu,&ndash;&ndash;I am not sleeping.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He hesitated, and she came to the door and
+opened it.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Ah, you have food, M&#8217;sieu! I am glad. I
+have been so hungry.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come, Father,&#8221; said the Captain, and they
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_352' name='page_352'></a>352</span>
+entered and sat on the long bench, eating the
+smoky, greasy meat as eagerly as if it had been
+cooked for the Governor&#8217;s table. Their spirits
+rose as the baskets emptied, and they found
+that they could laugh and joke about their
+ravenous hunger.</p>
+<p>The chiefs returned shortly after, and came
+stooping into the hut in the free Indian fashion.
+The old chief spoke:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo has honoured the lodges of
+the Cayugas; he has made the village proud to
+offer him their corn and meat. It would make
+their hearts glad if he would linger about their
+fires, with the holy Father and the squaw, that
+they might tell their brothers of the great warrior
+who dwelt in their village. But the White
+Chief bears the word of the Long House.
+He goes to the stone house to tell his white
+brothers, who fight with the thunder, that the
+Cayugas and the Onondagas are friends of the
+white men, that they have given a pledge
+which binds them as close as could the stoutest
+ropes of deerskin. And so with sad hearts
+they come to say farewell to the Big Buffalo,
+and to wish that no dog may howl while he
+sleeps, that no wind may blow against his
+canoe, that no rains may fall until he rests
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_353' name='page_353'></a>353</span>
+with his brothers at the great stone house
+beyond the lake.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo thanks the mighty chiefs
+of the Cayugas,&#8221; replied Menard. &#8220;He is glad
+that they are his friends. And when his mouth
+is close to the ear of the Great Mountain, he
+will tell him that his Cayuga sons are loyal to
+their Father.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The chief had lighted a long pipe. After
+two deliberate puffs, the first upward toward
+the roof of the hut, the second toward the
+ground, he handed it to Menard, who followed
+his example, and passed it to the chief next in
+importance. As it went slowly from hand to
+hand about the circle, the Captain turned to
+the maid, who sat at his side.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Do they mean it, M&#8217;sieu?&#8221; she whispered.</p>
+<p>For an instant a twinkle came into his eye;
+she saw it, and smiled.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Careful,&#8221; he whispered.</p>
+<p>Before she could check the smile, a bronze
+hand reached across to her with the pipe. She
+started back and looked down at it.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You must smoke it,&#8221; Menard whispered.
+&#8220;It is a great honour. They have admitted
+you to their council.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, M&#8217;sieu&ndash;&ndash;I can&#8217;t&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; she took the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_354' name='page_354'></a>354</span>
+pipe and held it awkwardly; then, with an
+effort, raised it to her mouth. It made her
+cough, and she gave it quickly to the Captain.</p>
+<p>The Indians rose gravely and filed out of
+the hut.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come, Mademoiselle, we are to go.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The smoke had brought tears to her eyes, and
+she was hesitating, laughing in spite of herself.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, M&#8217;sieu, will&ndash;&ndash;will it make me sick?&#8221;</p>
+<p>He smiled, with a touch of the old light
+humour.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think not. We must go, or they will
+wonder.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They found the chiefs waiting before the hut,
+Father Claude and Teganouan among them.
+As soon as they had appeared, the whole party
+set out through the village and over a trail
+through the woods to the eastward. The ill-kept
+dogs played about them, and plunged,
+barking, through the brush on either side.
+Behind, at a little distance, came the children
+and hangers-on of the village, jostling one
+another to keep at the head where they could
+see the white strangers.</p>
+<p>When they reached the bank of the lake, they
+found two canoes drawn up on the narrow strip
+of gravel, and a half-dozen well-armed braves
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_355' name='page_355'></a>355</span>
+waiting close at hand. The chief paused and
+pointed toward the canoes.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Cayugas are proud that the White
+Chief will sail in their canoes to the land of the
+white men. The bravest warriors of a mighty
+village will go with them to see that no Onondaga
+arrow flies into their camp by night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He signalled to a brave, who brought forward
+a musket and laid it, with powder-horn
+and bullet-pouch, at the Captain&#8217;s feet.</p>
+<p>&#8220;This musket is to tell the Big Buffalo that
+no wild beast shall disturb his feast, and that
+meat in plenty shall hang from the smoking-pole
+in his lodge.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The canoes were carried into the water and
+they embarked,&ndash;&ndash;Menard, the maid, and two
+braves in one, Father Claude and four braves
+in the other. They swung out into the lake,
+the wiry arms and shoulders of the canoemen
+knotting with each stroke of the paddles; and
+the crowd of Indians stood on the shore gazing
+after until they had passed from view beyond
+a wooded point.</p>
+<p>A few hours should take them to the head
+of the lake. They had reached perhaps half
+the distance, when Menard saw that two of his
+canoemen had exchanged glances and were
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_356' name='page_356'></a>356</span>
+looking toward the shore. He glanced along
+the fringe of trees and bushes, a few hundred
+yards distant, until his eyes rested on three
+empty canoes. He called to Father Claude&#8217;s
+canoe, and both, at his order, headed for the
+shore. As they drew near, half a score of
+Indians came from the brush.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why,&#8221; said the maid, &#8220;there are some of the
+men who brought us to the lake.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; replied Menard, &#8220;it is the Long
+Arrow&#8217;s band.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He leaped out of the canoe before it touched
+the beach, and walked sternly up to the
+group of warriors. He knew why they were
+there. It was what he had expected. When
+they had discovered the death of the Long
+Arrow there had been rage and consternation.
+Disputes had followed, the band had divided,
+and a part had crossed the lake to hunt the
+trail of the Big Buffalo. He folded his arms
+and gave them a long, contemptuous look.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why do the Onondagas seek the trail of the
+Big Buffalo? Do they think to overtake him?
+Do they think that all their hands together are
+strong enough to hold him? Did they think
+that they could lie to the White Chief, could
+play the traitor, and go unpunished?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_357' name='page_357'></a>357</span></p>
+<p>Only one or two of the Onondagas had their
+muskets in their hands. They all showed
+fright, and one was edging toward the wood.
+The Cayugas in the canoes, at a word from
+Father Claude, had raised their muskets.
+Menard saw the movement from the corner
+of his eye, and for the moment doubted the
+wisdom of the action. It was a question whether
+the Cayugas could actually be brought to fire
+on their Onondaga brothers. Still, this band
+had defied the law of the council, and might, in
+the eyes of the Indians, bring down another
+war upon the nation by their act. While he
+spoke, the Captain had been deciding on a
+course. He now walked boldly up to the man
+who was nearest the bushes, and snatched
+away his musket. There was a stir and
+a murmur, but without heeding, he took
+also the only other musket in the party,
+and stepped between the Indians and the
+forest.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Stand where you are, or I will kill you.
+One man&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;he pointed to a youth&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;will
+go into the forest and bring your muskets to
+the canoes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They hesitated, but Menard held his piece
+ready to fire, and the Cayugas did the same.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_358' name='page_358'></a>358</span>
+At last the youth went sullenly into the bushes
+and brought out an armful of muskets.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Count them, Father,&#8221; Menard called in
+French.</p>
+<p>The priest did so, and then ran his eye over
+the party on the beach.</p>
+<p>&#8220;There are two missing, M&#8217;sieu.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard turned to the youth, who, though
+he had not understood the words, caught their
+spirit and hurried back for the missing weapons.
+Then the Captain walked coolly past
+them, and took his place in the canoe. For a
+long time, as they paddled up the lake, they
+could see the Onondagas moving about the
+beach, and could hear their angry voices.</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_359' name='page_359'></a>359</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_XVIII_THE_ONLY_WAY' id='CHAPTER_XVIII_THE_ONLY_WAY'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER XVIII.</h2>
+<h3>THE ONLY WAY.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>When at last the canoe slipped from the
+confines of river and hills and forest out
+upon the great Lake Ontario, where the green
+water stretched flat, east and north and west to
+the horizon, the Cayuga warriors said farewell
+and turned again to their own lands. It was at
+noon of a bright day. The water lay close to
+the white beach, with hardly a ripple to mar the
+long black scallops of weed and drift which the
+last storm had left on the sand. The sky was
+fair and the air sweet.</p>
+<p>In the one canoe which the Cayugas had left
+to them, the little party headed to the east, now
+skimming close to the silent beach, now cutting
+a straight path across some bay from point
+to point, out over the depths where lay the
+sturgeon and the pickerel and trout and whitefish.
+The gulls swooped at them; then, frightened,
+soared away in wide, rushing circles,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_360' name='page_360'></a>360</span>
+dropping here and there for an overbold minnow.
+The afternoon went by with hardly the passing
+of a word. Each of them, the Captain, the
+maid, the priest, looked over the burnished water,
+now a fair green or blue sheet, now a space
+of striped yellow and green and purple, newly
+marked by every phase of sun and cloud; and
+to each it meant that the journey was done.
+Here was solitude, with none of the stir of the
+forest to bring companionship; but as they
+looked out to the cloud-puffs that dipped behind
+the water at the world&#8217;s end, they knew
+that far yonder were other men whose skins
+were white, for all of beard and tan, whose
+tongue was the tongue of Montreal, of Quebec,
+of Paris,&ndash;&ndash;and neither tree nor rock nor mountain
+lay between. The water that bore them
+onward was the water that washed the beach
+at Frontenac. Days might pass and find them
+still on the road; but they would be glorious
+days, with the sun overhead and the breeze
+at their backs, and at evening the wonder of the
+western sky to make the water golden with
+promise. As they swung their paddles, the
+maid with them, their eyes were full of dreams,&ndash;&ndash;all
+save Teganouan. His eyes were keen
+and cunning, and when they looked to the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_361' name='page_361'></a>361</span>
+north it was not with thoughts of home. It may
+be that he was dreaming of the deed which
+might yet win back his lost name as an Onondaga
+warrior.</p>
+<p>The sun hung over the lake when at last
+the canoe touched the beach. They ate their
+simple meal almost in silence, and then sat near
+the fire watching the afterglow that did not
+fade from the west until the night was dark
+and the moon high over the dim line that
+marked the eastern end of the lake. The
+sense of relief that had come to them with the
+first sight of the lake was fading now. They
+were thinking of Frontenac, and of what might
+await them there,&ndash;&ndash;the priest soberly, the
+maid bravely, the Captain grimly. Later,
+when the maid had said good-night, and Father
+Claude had wandered down the beach to the
+water&#8217;s edge, Menard dragged a new log to the
+fire and threw it on, sending up the flame and
+sparks high above the willows of the bank. He
+stretched out and looked into the flames.</p>
+<p>Teganouan, who had been lying on the sand,
+heard a rustle far off in the forest and raised
+his head. He heard it again, and rose, standing
+motionless; then he took his musket and
+came toward the fire. The Captain lay at full
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_362' name='page_362'></a>362</span>
+length, his chin on his hands. He was awake,
+for his eyes were open, but he did not look up.
+The Indian hesitated, and stood a few yards
+away looking at the silent figure, as if uncertain
+whether to speak. Finally he stepped
+back and disappeared among the willows.</p>
+<p>Half an hour went by. Father Claude came
+up the beach, walking slowly.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is growing late, M&#8217;sieu, for travellers.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard glanced up, but did not reply. The
+priest was looking about the camp.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Where is Teganouan, M&#8217;sieu? Did you
+give him permission to go away?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No; he is here,&ndash;&ndash;he was here.&#8221; Menard
+rose. &#8220;You are right, he has gone. Has he
+taken his musket?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think so. I do not see it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He left it leaning against the log. No; it
+is not there. Wait,&ndash;&ndash;do you hear?&#8221;</p>
+<p>They stood listening; and both caught the
+faint sound of a body moving between the
+bushes that grew on the higher ground, close
+to the line of willows. Menard took up his
+musket and held it ready, for they had not left
+the country of the Iroquois.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Here he comes,&#8221; whispered Father Claude.
+&#8220;Yes, it is Teganouan.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_363' name='page_363'></a>363</span></p>
+<p>The Indian was running toward them. He
+dropped his musket, and began rapidly to throw
+great handfuls of sand upon the fire. The two
+white men sprang to aid him, without asking
+an explanation. In a moment the beach was
+lighted only by the moon. Then Menard
+said:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is it, Teganouan?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan heard a step in the forest. He
+went nearer, and there were more. They are
+on the war-path, for they come cautiously and
+slowly.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Father, will you keep by the maid? We
+must not disturb her now. You had better heap
+up the sand about the canoe so that no stray
+ball can reach her.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The priest hurried down the beach, and
+Menard and the Indian slipped into the willows,
+Menard toward the east, Teganouan toward the
+west, where they could watch the forest and
+the beach on all sides. The sound of an approaching
+party was now more distinct. There
+would be a long silence, then the crackle of a
+twig or the rustle of dead leaves; and Menard
+knew that the sound was made by moccasined
+feet. He was surprised that the invaders took
+so little caution; either they were confident of
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_364' name='page_364'></a>364</span>
+finding the camp asleep, or they were in such
+force as to have no fear. While he lay behind
+a scrub willow conjecturing, Father Claude
+came creeping up behind him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will watch with you, M&#8217;sieu. It will make
+our line longer.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Is she safe?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. I have heaped the sand high around
+the canoe, even on the side toward the water.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good. You had better move off a little
+nearer the lake, and keep a sharp eye out. It
+may be that they are coming by water as well,
+though I doubt it. The lake is very light. I
+will take the centre. You have no musket?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No; but my eyes are good.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If you need me, I shall be close to the
+bushes, a dozen yards farther inland.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They separated, and Menard took up his
+new position. Apparently the movement had
+stopped. For a long time no sound came, and
+then, as Menard was on the point of moving
+forward, a branch cracked sharply not twenty
+rods away. He called in French:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Who are you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>For a moment there was silence, then a rush
+of feet in his direction. He could hear a number
+of men bounding through the bushes. He
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_365' name='page_365'></a>365</span>
+cocked his gun and levelled it, shouting this
+time in Iroquois:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Stand, or I will fire!&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I know that voice! Drop your musket!&#8221;
+came in a merry French voice, and in another
+moment a sturdy figure, half in uniform and
+half in buckskin, bearded beyond recognition,
+had come crashing down the slope, throwing
+his arms around the Captain&#8217;s neck so wildly
+that the two went down and rolled on the sand.
+Before Menard could struggle to his feet, three
+soldiers had followed, and stood laughing, forgetting
+all discipline, and one was saying over
+and over to the other:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is Captain Menard! Don&#8217;t you know
+him? It is Captain Menard!&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You don&#8217;t know me, Menard, I can see that.
+I wish I could take the beard off, but I can&#8217;t.
+What have you done with my men?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Now Menard knew; it was Du Peron.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I left them at La Gallette,&#8221; he said.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I haven&#8217;t seen them&ndash;&ndash;oh, killed?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard nodded.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come down the beach and tell me about it.
+What condition are you in? Have you anybody
+with you?&#8221; Before Menard could answer,
+he said to one of the soldiers:&ndash;&ndash;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_366' name='page_366'></a>366</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Go back and tell the sergeant to bring up
+the canoes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They walked down the beach, and the other
+soldiers set about building a new fire.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Perhaps I&#8217;d better begin on you,&#8221; Menard
+said. &#8220;What are you doing here? And what
+in the devil do you mean by coming up through
+the woods like a Mohawk on the war-path?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Lieutenant laughed.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My story isn&#8217;t a long one. I&#8217;m cleaning
+up our base of supplies at La Famine. We&#8217;ve
+got a small guard there. The main part of the
+rear-guard is back at Frontenac.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Where is the column?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Gone to Niagara, Denonville and all, to
+build a fort. They&#8217;ll give it to De Troyes, I
+imagine. It&#8217;s a sort of triumphal procession
+through the enemy&#8217;s country, after rooting up
+the Seneca villages and fields and stockades
+until you can&#8217;t find an able-bodied redskin this
+side of the Cayugas. Oh, I didn&#8217;t answer your
+other question. What do you think of these?&#8221;
+He held out a foot, shod in a moccasin. &#8220;You&#8217;d
+never know the King&#8217;s troops now, Menard.
+We&#8217;re wearing anything we can pick up. I&#8217;ve
+got a dozen canoes a quarter of a league down
+the lake. I saw your fire, and thought it best
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_367' name='page_367'></a>367</span>
+to reconnoitre before bringing the canoes past.&#8221;
+He read the question in Menard&#8217;s glance. &#8220;We
+are not taking out much time for sleep, I can
+tell you. It&#8217;s all day and all night until we get
+La Famine cleared up. There is only a handful
+of men there, and we&#8217;re expecting every day
+that the Cayugas and Onondagas will sweep
+down on them.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They won&#8217;t bother you,&#8221; said Menard.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Maybe not, but we must be careful. For
+my part, I look for trouble. The nations stand
+pretty closely by each other, you know.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They won&#8217;t bother you now.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How do you know?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What did I come down here for?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;They didn&#8217;t tell me. Oh, you had a mission
+to the other nations? But that can&#8217;t be,&ndash;&ndash;you
+were captured.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard lay on his side, and watched the
+flames go roaring upward as the soldiers piled
+up the logs.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I could tell you some things, Du Peron,&#8221;
+he said slowly. &#8220;I suppose you didn&#8217;t know,&ndash;&ndash;for
+that matter you couldn&#8217;t know,&ndash;&ndash;but when
+the column was marching on the Senecas, and
+our rear-guard of four hundred men&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Four hundred and forty.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_368' name='page_368'></a>368</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;The same thing. You can&#8217;t expect the
+Cayugas to count so sharply as that. At that
+time the Cayugas and Onondagas held a council
+to discuss the question of sending a thousand
+warriors to cut off the rear-guard and the
+Governor&#8217;s communications.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Lieutenant slowly whistled.</p>
+<p>&#8220;How did they know so much about it,
+Menard?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How could they help it? Our good Governor
+had posted his plans on every tree. You
+can see what would have happened.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why, with the Senecas on his front it
+would have been&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; He paused, and whistled
+again.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well,&ndash;&ndash;you see. But they didn&#8217;t do it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why not?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Because I spoke at that council.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You spoke&ndash;&ndash;but you were a prisoner,
+weren&#8217;t you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Lieutenant sat staring into the fire.
+Slowly it came to him what it was that the
+Captain had accomplished.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why, Menard,&#8221; he said, &#8220;New France
+won&#8217;t be able to hold you, when this gets out.
+How you must have gone at them. You&#8217;ll be
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_369' name='page_369'></a>369</span>
+a major in a week. You&#8217;re the luckiest man
+this side of Versailles.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No, I&#8217;m not. And I won&#8217;t be a major.
+I&#8217;m not on the Governor&#8217;s pocket list. But I
+don&#8217;t care about that. That isn&#8217;t the reason I
+did it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why did you do it then?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I&ndash;&ndash;That&#8217;s the question I&#8217;ve been asking
+myself for several days, Du Peron.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Lieutenant was too thoroughly aroused
+to note the change in the Captain&#8217;s tone.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You don&#8217;t see it right now, Menard. Wait
+till you&#8217;ve reached the city, and got into some
+clothes and a good bed, and can shake hands
+with d&#8217;Orvilliers and Provost and the general
+staff,&ndash;&ndash;maybe with the Governor himself.
+Then you&#8217;ll feel different. You&#8217;re down now.
+I know how it feels. You&#8217;re all tired out, and
+you&#8217;ve got the Onondaga dirt rubbed on so
+thick that you&#8217;re lost in it. You wait a few
+weeks.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Did the Governor have much trouble with
+the Senecas?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, he had to fight for it. He was&ndash;&ndash;My
+God, Menard, what about the girl? I was
+so shaken up at meeting you like this that it
+got away from me. The column had hardly
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_370' name='page_370'></a>370</span>
+got to the fort on their way up from Montreal
+before everyone was asking for you. La
+Grange had a letter from her father saying that
+she was with you, and he&#8217;s been in a bad way.
+He says that he was to have married her, and
+that you&#8217;ve got away with her. It serves him
+right, the beast. One night, at La Famine, he
+was drunk, and he came around to all of us
+reading that letter at the top of his voice and
+swearing to kill you the moment he sees you.
+He&#8217;s been talking a good deal about that.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;She is here, asleep.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Thank God.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Where is La Grange now?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He&#8217;s over at Frontenac. He got into trouble
+before we left La Famine. He&#8217;s drinking
+hard now, you know. He had command of a
+company that was working on the stockades,
+and he made such a muss of it that his sergeant
+had to take hold and handle it to get
+the work done at all. You can imagine what
+bad feeling that made in his company. Played
+the devil with his discipline. Well, he took
+it like a child. But that night, when he
+got a little loose on his legs, he hunted up the
+sergeant and made him fight. The fellow
+wouldn&#8217;t until La Grange came at him with
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_371' name='page_371'></a>371</span>
+his sword, but then he cracked his head with
+a musket.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Hurt him?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. They took him up to Frontenac.
+He&#8217;s in the hospital now, but it&#8217;s pretty generally
+understood that d&#8217;Orvilliers won&#8217;t let
+him go out until the Governor gets back from
+Niagara. He&#8217;s well enough already, they say.
+It&#8217;s hard on the sergeant, too; no one blames
+him.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Du Peron looked around and saw Teganouan
+lying near.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Who&#8217;s this Indian?&#8221; he asked in a low
+tone.</p>
+<p>&#8220;He is with me. A mission Indian.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Does he know French? Has he understood
+us?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I don&#8217;t know. I suppose so. Here is
+Father Claude de Casson. You remember
+him, don&#8217;t you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes, indeed.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Lieutenant rose to greet the priest, and
+then the three sat together.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You asked me about the fight, didn&#8217;t you,
+Menard? I don&#8217;t seem able to hold to a subject
+very long to-night. We struck out from
+La Famine on the morning of the twelfth of
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_372' name='page_372'></a>372</span>
+July. You know the trail that leads south
+from La Famine? We followed that.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard smiled at the leaping fire.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Don&#8217;t laugh, Menard; that was no worse
+than what we&#8217;ve done from the start. The
+Governor never thought but what we&#8217;d surprise
+them as much on that road as on another.
+And after all, we won, though it did look bad
+for a while. There was a time, at the beginning
+of the fight,&ndash;&ndash;well, I&#8217;m getting ahead of
+myself again. We were in fairly good order.
+Calli&egrave;res had the advance with the Montreal
+troops. He threw out La Durantaye, with
+Tonty and Du Luth,&ndash;&ndash;the <i>coureurs de bois</i>,
+you know,&ndash;&ndash;to feel the way. La Durantaye
+had the mission Indians, from Sault St. Louis
+and the Montreal Mountain, on his left, and
+the Ottawas and Mackinac tribes on his right.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;How did the Ottawas behave?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Wretchedly. They ran at the first fire. I&#8217;ll
+come to that. The others weren&#8217;t so bad, but
+there was no holding them. They spread
+through the forest, away out of reach. Perrot
+had the command, but he could only follow
+after and knock one down now and then.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Governor took command of the main
+force?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_373' name='page_373'></a>373</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. And he carried his bale like the
+worst of us; I&#8217;ll say that for him. It was hot,
+and we all drooped a bit before night. And
+he made a good fight, too, if you can forgive
+him that bungling march. When we bivouacked,
+some of Du Luth&#8217;s boys scouted ahead.
+They got in by sunrise. They&#8217;d been to the
+main village of the Senecas on the hill beyond
+the marsh,&ndash;&ndash;you know it, don&#8217;t you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;And they saw nothing but a few women
+and a pack of dogs. The Governor was up
+early,&ndash;&ndash;he&#8217;s not used to sleeping out doors in
+the mosquito country,&ndash;&ndash;sitting on a log at the
+side of the trail, talking with Granville and
+Berthier. I wasn&#8217;t five yards behind them,
+trying to scrape the mud off my boots&ndash;&ndash;you
+know how that mud sticks, Menard. Well,
+when the scouts came in with their story, the
+Governor stood up. &#8216;Take my order to La
+Durantaye,&#8217; he said, &#8216;that he is to move on
+with all caution, that the surprise may be complete.
+He will push forward, following the
+trail. You,&#8217; he said, to a few aides who stood
+by, &#8216;will see that the command is aroused as
+silently as possible.&#8217; Well, I didn&#8217;t know
+whether to laugh at the Governor or pity myself
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_374' name='page_374'></a>374</span>
+and the boys. Any man but the crowd
+of seigniors that he had about him would have
+foreseen what was coming. I knew that the
+devils were waiting for us, probably at one of
+the ravines where the trail runs through that
+group of hills just this side of the marsh. You
+know the place,&ndash;&ndash;every one of us knows it.
+But what could we say? I&#8217;d have given a
+month&#8217;s pay to have been within ear-shot of La
+Durantaye when he got the order. La Valterie
+told me about it afterward. &#8216;What&#8217;s this?&#8217; he
+says, &#8216;follow the trail? I&#8217;ll go to the devil first.
+There&#8217;s a better place for my bones than this
+pest-ridden country.&#8217; He calls to Du Luth:
+&#8216;Hear this, Du Luth. We&#8217;re to &#8220;push forward,
+following the trail.&#8221;&#8217; I can fairly hear
+him say it, with his eyes looking right through
+the young aide. &#8216;Not I,&#8217; says Du Luth, &#8216;I&#8217;m
+going around the hills and come into the village
+over the long oak ridge!&#8217; &#8216;You can&#8217;t do
+it. I have the Governor&#8217;s order.&#8217; And then
+Du Luth drew himself up, La Valterie says,
+and looked the aide (who wasn&#8217;t used to this
+kind of a soldier, and wished himself back
+under the Governor&#8217;s petticoats) up and down
+till the fellow got red as a Lower Town girl.
+&#8216;Tell your commanding officer,&#8217; says Du Luth,
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_375' name='page_375'></a>375</span>
+in his big voice, &#8216;that the advance will &#8220;push
+forward, following the trail,&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;and may God
+have mercy on our poor souls!&#8217;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Well, Menard, they did it, nine hundred
+of them. And we came on, a quarter of a
+league after, with sixteen hundred more. We
+got into the first defile, and through it, with
+never a sound. Then I was sure of trouble
+in the second, but long after the advance had
+had time to get through, everything was still.
+There was still the third defile, just before you
+reach the marsh, and my head was spinning,
+waiting for the first shot and wondering where
+we were to catch it and how many of us were
+to get out alive. And then, all at once it
+came. You see the Senecas, three hundred
+of them at least, were in the brush up on the
+right slope of the third defile; and as many
+more were in the elder thickets and swamp
+grass ahead and to the left. They let the
+whole advance get through,&ndash;&ndash;fooled every
+man of Du Luth&#8217;s scouts,&ndash;&ndash;and then came
+at them from all sides. We heard the noise&ndash;&ndash;I
+never heard a worse&ndash;&ndash;and started up on
+the run; and then there was the strangest
+mess I ever got into. They had surprised the
+advance, right enough,&ndash;&ndash;we could see Du
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_376' name='page_376'></a>376</span>
+Luth and Tonty running about knocking men
+down and bellowing out orders to hold their
+force together,&ndash;&ndash;but you see the Senecas
+never dreamed that a larger force was coming
+on behind, and we struck them like a whirlwind.
+Well, for nearly an hour we didn&#8217;t
+know what was going on. Our Indians and
+the Senecas were so mixed together that we
+dared not shoot to kill. Our own boys, even
+the regulars, lost their heads and fell into the
+tangle. It was all yelling and whooping and
+banging and running around, with the smoke so
+thick that you couldn&#8217;t find the trail or the hills
+or the swamp. I was crowded up to my arms
+in water and mud for the last part of the time.
+Once the smoke lifted a little, and I saw what
+I thought to be a mission Indian, not five
+yards away, in the same fix. I called to him
+to help me, and he turned out to be a Seneca
+chief. Our muskets were wet,&ndash;&ndash;at least mine
+was, and I saw that he dropped his when he
+started for me,&ndash;&ndash;so we had it out with
+knives.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Did he get at you?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Once. A rib stopped it&ndash;&ndash;no harm done.
+Well, I was tired, but I got out and dodged
+around through the smoke to find out where
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_377' name='page_377'></a>377</span>
+our boys were, but they were mixed up worse
+than ever. I was just in time to save a <i>coureur</i>
+from killing one of our Indians with his own
+hatchet. Most of the regulars scattered as
+soon as they lost sight of their officers. And
+Berthier,&ndash;&ndash;I found him lying under a log all
+gone to pieces with fright.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I didn&#8217;t know how it was to come out
+until at last the firing eased a little, and the
+smoke thinned out. Then we found that the
+devils had slipped away, all but a few who had
+wandered so far into our lines&ndash;&ndash;if you could
+call them lines&ndash;&ndash;that they couldn&#8217;t get out.
+They carried most of their killed, though we
+picked up a few on the edge of the marsh.
+It took all the rest of the day to pull things
+together and find out how we stood.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Heavy loss?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No. I don&#8217;t know how many, but beyond
+a hundred or so of cuts and flesh-wounds like
+mine we seemed to have a full force. We
+went on in the morning, after a puffed-out
+speech by the Governor, and before night
+reached the village. The Senecas had already
+burned a part of it, but we finished it, and
+spent close to ten days cutting their corn and
+destroying the fort on the big hill, a league
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_378' name='page_378'></a>378</span>
+or more to the east. Then we came back to
+La Famine, and the Governor took the whole
+column to Niagara,&ndash;&ndash;to complete the parade,
+I suppose.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The story told, they sat by the fire, silent
+at first, then talking as the mood prompted,
+until the flames had died and the red embers
+were fading to gray. Father Claude had
+stretched out and was sleeping.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I must look about my camp,&#8221; Du Peron
+said at length. &#8220;Good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-night,&#8221; said Menard; and alone he
+sat there until the last spark had left the scattered
+heap of charred wood.</p>
+<p>The night was cold and clear. The lake
+stretched out to a misty somewhere, touching
+the edge of the sky. He rose and walked
+toward the water. A figure, muffled in a
+blanket stood on the dark, firm sand close to
+the breaking ripples. He thought it was one
+of Du Peron&#8217;s sentries, but a doubt drew
+him nearer. Then the blanket was thrown
+aside, and he recognized, in the moonlight, the
+slender figure of the maid. She was gazing
+out toward the pole-star and the dim clouds
+that lay motionless beneath it. The splash of
+the lake and the call of the locusts and tree-toads
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_379' name='page_379'></a>379</span>
+on the bank behind them were the only
+sounds. He went slowly forward and stood
+by her side. She looked up into his eyes,
+then turned to the lake. She had dropped
+the blanket to the sand, and he placed it again
+about her shoulders.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I am not cold,&#8221; she said.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I am afraid, Mademoiselle. The air is chill.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They stood for a long time without speaking,
+while the northern clouds sank slowly beneath
+the horizon, their tops gleaming white in the
+moonlight. Once a sharp command rang
+through the night, and muskets rattled.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is that?&#8221; she whispered, touching his
+arm.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They are changing the guard.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will not need to watch to-night,
+M&#8217;sieu?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No; not again. We shall have an escort to
+Frontenac.&#8221; He paused; then added in uncertain
+voice, &#8220;but perhaps&ndash;&ndash;if Mademoiselle&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>She looked up at him. He went on:</p>
+<p>&#8220;I will watch to-night, and to-morrow night,
+and once again&ndash;&ndash;then there will be no need:
+we shall be at Frontenac. Yes, I will watch; I
+will myself keep guard, that Mademoiselle may
+sleep safely and deep, as she slept at the Long
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_380' name='page_380'></a>380</span>
+Lake and in the forests of the Cayugas. And
+perhaps, while she is sleeping, and the lake lies
+still, I may dream again as I did then&ndash;&ndash;I will
+carry on our story to the end, and then&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>He could not say more; he could not look at
+her. Even at the rustle of her skirt, as she
+sank to the beach and sat gazing up at him, he
+did not turn. He was looking dully at the last
+bright cloud tip, sinking slowly from his sight.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Frontenac lies there,&#8221; he said. &#8220;I told them
+I should bring you there. It has been a longer
+road than we thought,&ndash;&ndash;it has been a harder
+road,&ndash;&ndash;and they have said that I broke my
+trust. Perhaps they were not wrong&ndash;&ndash;I would
+have broken it&ndash;&ndash;once. But we shall be there
+in three days. I will keep my promise to the
+chiefs; and we&ndash;&ndash;we shall not meet again. It
+will be better. But I shall keep watch, to-night
+and twice again. That will be all.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He looked down, and at sight of the mute
+figure his face softened.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Forgive me&ndash;&ndash;I should not have spoken.
+It has been a mad dream&ndash;&ndash;the waking is hard.
+When I saw you standing here to-night, I knew
+that I had no right to come&ndash;&ndash;and still I came.
+I have called myself a soldier&#8221;&ndash;&ndash;his voice
+was weary&ndash;&ndash;&#8220;see, this is what is done to soldiers
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_381' name='page_381'></a>381</span>
+such as I.&#8221; One frayed strip of an epaulet
+yet hung from his shoulder. He tore it
+off and threw it out into the lake. A little
+splash, and it was gone. &#8220;Good-night, Mademoiselle,&ndash;&ndash;good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He turned away. The maid leaned forward
+and called. Her voice would not come. She
+called again and again. Then he heard, for he
+stood motionless.</p>
+<p>&#8220;M&#8217;sieu!&#8221;</p>
+<p>He came back slowly, and stood waiting.
+She was leaning back on her hands. Her hair
+had fallen over her face, and she shook it back,
+gazing up and trying to speak.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You said&ndash;&ndash;you said, the end&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>He hesitated, as if he dared not meet his
+thoughts.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You said&ndash;&ndash;See,&#8221; she fumbled hastily at
+her bosom, &#8220;see, I have kept it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>She was holding something up to him. In
+the dim light he could not make it out. He
+took it and held it up. It was the dried stem
+and the crumbling blossom of a daisy. For a moment
+he kept it there, then, while he looked, he
+reached into his pocket and drew out the other.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; he said, &#8220;yes&ndash;&ndash;&#8221; His voice trembled;
+his hand shook. Her hair had fallen again, and
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_382' name='page_382'></a>382</span>
+she was trying to fasten it back. He looked at
+her, almost fiercely, but now her eyes were hidden.
+&#8220;We will go to Frontenac;&#8221; he said; &#8220;we
+will go to Frontenac, you and I. But they
+shall not get you.&#8221; He caught the hands that
+were braiding her hair, and held them in his
+rough grip. &#8220;It is too late. Let them break my
+sword, if they will, still they shall not get you.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Her head dropped upon his hands, and for
+the second time since those days at Onondaga,
+he felt her tears. For a moment they were
+motionless; he erect, looking out to the pole-star
+and over the water that stretched far away to
+the stone fort, she sobbing and clinging to his
+scarred hands. Then a desperate look came
+into his eyes, and he dropped on one knee and
+caught her shoulders and held her tightly, close
+against him.</p>
+<p>&#8220;See,&#8221; he said, with the old mad ring in his
+voice, &#8220;see what a soldier I am! See how I keep
+my trust! But now&ndash;&ndash;but now it is too late
+for them all. I am still a soldier, and I can
+fight, Valerie. And God will be good to us.
+God grant that we are doing right. There is
+no other way.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No,&#8221; she whispered after him; &#8220;there is no
+other way.&#8221;</p>
+<hr class='major' />
+<div style='margin: auto; text-align: center; padding-top: 2em; padding-bottom: 1em'>
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_383' name='page_383'></a>383</span>
+<a name='CHAPTER_XIX_FRONTENAC' id='CHAPTER_XIX_FRONTENAC'></a>
+<h2>CHAPTER XIX.</h2>
+<h3>FRONTENAC.</h3>
+</div>
+<p>The sun was dropping behind the western
+forests. From the lodges and cabins of
+the friendly Indians about the fort rose a hundred
+thin columns of smoke. Long rows of
+bateaux and canoes lined the beach below the
+log palisade; and others drew near the shore,
+laden with fish. There was a stir and bustle
+about the square within the stone bastions;
+orderlies hurried from quarters to barracks,
+bugles sounded, and groups of ragged soldiers
+sat about, polishing muskets and belts, and
+setting new flints. Men of the commissary
+department were carrying boxes and bales from
+the fort to a cleared space on the beach.</p>
+<p>Menard walked across the square and
+knocked at the door of Major d&#8217;Orvilliers&#8217;s
+little house. Many an eye had followed him
+as he hurried by, aroused to curiosity by his
+tattered uniform, rusted musket, and boot-tops
+rudely stitched to deerskin moccasins.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_384' name='page_384'></a>384</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Major d&#8217;Orvilliers is busy,&#8221; said the orderly
+at the door.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Tell him it is Captain Menard.&#8221;</p>
+<p>In a moment the Major himself appeared in
+the doorway.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Come in, Menard. I am to start in an
+hour or so to meet Governor Denonville, but
+there is always time for you. I&#8217;ll start a little
+late, if necessary.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Governor comes from Niagara?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. He is two or three days&#8217; journey up
+the lake. I am to escort him back.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They had reached the office in the rear of
+the house, and the Major brushed a heap of
+documents and drawings from a chair.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Sit down, Menard. You have a long story,
+I take it. You look as if you&#8217;d been to the
+Illinois and back.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You knew of my capture?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes. We had about given you up. And
+the girl,&ndash;&ndash;Mademoiselle St. Denis&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;She is here.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Here&ndash;&ndash;at Frontenac?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes; in Father de Casson&#8217;s care.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Thank God! But how did you do it?
+How did you get her here, and yourself?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard rose and paced up and down the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_385' name='page_385'></a>385</span>
+room. As he walked, he told the story of the
+capture at La Gallette, of the days in the Onondaga
+village, of the council and the escape.
+When he had finished, there was a long silence,
+while the Major sat with contracted brows.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You&#8217;ve done a big thing, Menard,&#8221; he said
+at last, &#8220;one of the biggest things that has
+been done in New France. But have you
+thought of the Governor&ndash;&ndash;of how he will
+take it?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It may not be easy. Denonville doesn&#8217;t
+know the Iroquois as you and I do. He is
+elated now about his victory,&ndash;&ndash;he thinks he
+has settled the question of white supremacy.
+If I were to tell him to-morrow that he has
+only made a bitter enemy of the Senecas, and
+that they will not rest until they wipe out this
+defeat, do you suppose he would believe it?
+You have given a pledge to the Iroquois that
+is entirely outside of the Governor&#8217;s view of
+military precedent. To tell the truth, Menard,
+I don&#8217;t believe he will like it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why not?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;He doesn&#8217;t know the strength of the Five
+Nations. He thinks they would all flee before
+our regulars just as the Senecas did. Worse
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_386' name='page_386'></a>386</span>
+than that, he doesn&#8217;t know the Indian temperament.
+I&#8217;m afraid you can&#8217;t make him understand
+that to satisfy their hunger for revenge
+will serve better than a score of orations and
+treaties.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You think he won&#8217;t touch La Grange?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I am almost certain of it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Then it rests with me.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;What do you mean?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I gave another pledge, d&#8217;Orvilliers. If the
+Governor won&#8217;t do this&ndash;&ndash;I shall have to do it
+myself.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Save for a moment&#8217;s hesitation Menard&#8217;s
+voice was cool and even; but he had stopped
+walking and was looking closely at the commandant.</p>
+<p>D&#8217;Orvilliers was gazing at the floor.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What do you mean by that?&#8221; he said
+slowly, and then suddenly he got up. &#8220;My
+God, Menard, you don&#8217;t mean that you
+would&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;That can&#8217;t be! I can&#8217;t allow it.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;It may not be necessary. I hope you are
+mistaken about the Governor.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I hope I am&ndash;&ndash;but no; he won&#8217;t help you.
+He&#8217;s not in the mood for paying debts to a
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_387' name='page_387'></a>387</span>
+weakened enemy. And&ndash;&ndash;Menard, sit down.
+I must talk plainly to you. I can&#8217;t go on
+covering things up now. I don&#8217;t believe you
+see the matter clearly. If it were a plain question
+of your mission to the Onondagas&ndash;&ndash;if it
+were&ndash;&ndash;Well, I want you to tell me in what
+relation you stand to Mademoiselle St. Denis.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Captain was standing by the chair. He
+rested his arms on the high back, and looked
+over them at d&#8217;Orvilliers.</p>
+<p>&#8220;She is to be my wife,&#8221; he said.</p>
+<p>D&#8217;Orvilliers leaned back and slowly shook
+his head.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My dear fellow,&#8221; he said, &#8220;when your story
+goes to Quebec, when the Ch&acirc;teau learns that
+you have promised the punishment of La
+Grange in the name of France, and then of
+this,&ndash;&ndash;of Mademoiselle and her relations to
+yourself and to La Grange,&ndash;&ndash;do you know
+what they will do?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard was silent.</p>
+<p>&#8220;They will laugh&ndash;&ndash;first, and then&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I know,&#8221; said the Captain, &#8220;I have thought
+of all that.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You have told all this in your report?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;So you would go on with it?&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_388' name='page_388'></a>388</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes; I am going on with it. There is
+nothing else I can do. I couldn&#8217;t have offered
+to give myself up; they already had me. The
+fault was La Grange&#8217;s. What I did was the
+only thing that could have been done to save
+the column; if you will think it over, you will
+see that. I know what I did,&ndash;&ndash;I know I was
+right; and if my superiors, when I have given
+my report, choose to see it in another way, I
+have nothing to say. If they give me my
+liberty, in the army or out of it, I will find La
+Grange. If not, I will wait.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why not give that up, at least, Menard?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If I give that up, we shall have a war with
+the Iroquois that will shake New France as she
+has never been shaken before.&#8221;</p>
+<p>D&#8217;Orvilliers started to speak, but checked the
+words. Menard slung his musket behind his
+shoulders.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Wait, Menard. I don&#8217;t know what to say.
+I must have time to think. If you wish, I will
+not give notice of your arrival to the Governor.
+I will leave the matter of reporting in your
+hands.&#8221; He rose, and fingered the papers on
+the table. &#8220;You see how it will look&ndash;&ndash;there
+is the maid&ndash;&ndash;La Grange seeks your life, you
+seek his&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_389' name='page_389'></a>389</span></p>
+<p>Menard drew himself up, his hat in his hand.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It shall be pushed to the end, Major. You
+know me; you know Captain la Grange.
+There will be excitement, perhaps,&ndash;&ndash;you may
+find it hard to avoid taking one side or the
+other. I must ask which side is to be yours.&#8221;</p>
+<p>D&#8217;Orvilliers winced, and for a moment stood
+biting his lip; then he stepped forward and
+took both Menard&#8217;s hands.</p>
+<p>&#8220;You shouldn&#8217;t have asked that,&#8221; he said.
+&#8220;God bless you, Menard! God bless you!&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard paused in the door, and turned.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Shall I need a pass to enter the hospital?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh, you can&#8217;t go there. La Grange is
+there.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes; I will report to him. He shall not say
+that I have left it to hearsay.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;But he will attack you!&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;No; I will not fight him until I have an
+answer from the Governor.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You can&#8217;t get in now until morning.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well, good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You will be careful, Menard?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Captain nodded and left the room.
+Wishing to settle his thoughts, he passed
+through the palisade gate and walked down
+the beach. The commissary men were loading
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_390' name='page_390'></a>390</span>
+the canoes, threescore of them, that were
+to carry the garrison on its westward journey.
+Already the twilight was deepening, and the
+lanterns of the officers were dimmed by the
+glow from a hundred Indian camp-fires.</p>
+<p>From within the fort came a long bugle-call.
+There was a distant rattling of arms and shouting
+of commands, then the tramp of feet, and
+the indistinct line came swinging through the
+sally-port. They halted at the water&#8217;s edge,
+broke ranks, and took to the canoes, paddling
+easily away along the shore until they had
+faded into shadows. A score of Indians stood
+watching them, stolidly smoking stone pipes
+and holding their blankets close around them.</p>
+<p>It was an hour later when the Captain returned
+to the fort and started across the enclosure
+toward the hut which had been assigned to
+him. Save for a few Indians and a sentry who
+paced before the barracks, the fort seemed
+deserted. It was nearly dark now, and the
+lanterns at the sally-port and in front of barrack
+and hospital glimmered faintly. Menard
+had reached his own door, when he heard a
+voice calling, and turned. A dim figure was
+running across the square toward the sentry.
+There was a moment of breathless talk,&ndash;&ndash;Menard
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_391' name='page_391'></a>391</span>
+could not catch the words,&ndash;&ndash;then the
+sentry shouted. It occurred to Menard that
+he was now the senior officer at the fort, and
+he waited. A corporal led up his guard, halted,
+and again there was hurried talking. Menard
+started back toward them, but before he reached
+the spot all were running toward the hospital,
+and a dozen others of the home guard had
+gathered before the barracks and were talking
+and asking excited questions.</p>
+<p>Menard crossed to the hospital. Two privates
+barred the door, and he was forced to
+wait until a young Lieutenant of the regulars
+appeared. The lanterns over the door threw a
+dim light on the Captain as he stood on the
+low step.</p>
+<p>&#8220;What is it?&#8221; asked the Lieutenant. &#8220;You
+wished to see me?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I am Captain Menard. What is the trouble?&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Lieutenant looked doubtfully at the
+dingy, bearded figure, then he motioned the
+soldiers aside.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is Captain la Grange,&#8221; he said, when
+Menard had entered; &#8220;he has been killed.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Lieutenant spoke in a matter-of-fact
+tone, but his eyes were shining and he was
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_392' name='page_392'></a>392</span>
+breathing rapidly. Menard looked at him for
+a moment without a word, then he stepped to
+the door of a back room and looked in. Three
+flickering candles stood on a low table, and
+another on a chair at the head of the narrow
+bed. The light wavered over the log and plaster
+walls. A surgeon was bending over the bed,
+his assistant waiting at his elbow with instruments;
+the two shut off the upper part of the
+bed from Menard&#8217;s view. The Lieutenant
+stood behind the Captain, looking over his
+shoulder; both were motionless. There was
+no sound save a low word at intervals between
+the two surgeons, and the creak of a bore-worm
+that sounded distinctly from a log in the
+wall.</p>
+<p>Menard turned away and walked back to the
+outer door, the Lieutenant with him. There
+they stood, silent, as men are who have been
+brought suddenly face to face with death. At
+last the Lieutenant began to speak in a subdued
+voice.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We only know that it was an Indian. He
+has been scalped.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Oh!&#8221; muttered Menard.</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think he is still breathing,&ndash;&ndash;he was just
+before you came,&ndash;&ndash;but there is no hope for
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_393' name='page_393'></a>393</span>
+him. He was stabbed in a dozen places. It
+was some time before we knew&ndash;&ndash;the Indian
+came in by the window, and must have found
+him asleep. There was no struggle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>They stood again without speaking, and
+again the Lieutenant broke the silence.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It is too bad. He was a good fellow.&#8221; He
+paused, as if searching for a kind word for Captain
+la Grange. &#8220;He was the best shot at the
+fort when he&ndash;&ndash;when&ndash;&ndash;&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes,&#8221; said Menard. He too wished to speak
+no harsh word. &#8220;Is there anything I can do?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;I think not. There is a strong guard about
+the fort, but I think the Indian had escaped
+before we learned of it. I will see you before
+we take further steps.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well. I shall be at my quarters.
+Good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Good-night.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard walked slowly back across the enclosure.
+At the door of his hut he paused,
+and for a long time he stood there, looking up
+at the quiet sky. His mind was scattered for
+the moment; he could not think clearly.</p>
+<p>He opened his door and stepped over the log
+threshold, letting the door close after him of its
+own weight. The hut was dark, with but a square
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_394' name='page_394'></a>394</span>
+of dim light at the window. He fumbled for
+the candle and struck a light.</p>
+<p>There was a low rustle from the corner.
+Menard whirled around and peered into the
+shadows. The candle was blowing; he caught
+it up and shielded it with his hand. A figure
+was crouching in the corner, half hidden behind
+a cloak that hung there. The Captain
+sprang forward holding the candle high, tore
+down the cloak, and discovered Teganouan, the
+Onondaga, bending over feeling for his hatchet
+which lay on the floor at his feet. Menard
+caught his shoulders, and dragging him out of
+reach of the hatchet, threw him full length on
+the floor. The candle dropped and rolled on
+the floor, but before it could go out, Menard
+snatched it up.</p>
+<p>Slowly Teganouan rose to his feet.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan comes in a strange manner to
+the lodge of the white warrior,&#8221; said Menard,
+scornfully. &#8220;He steals in like a Huron thief,
+and hides in dark corners.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Indian looked at him defiantly, but did
+not answer.</p>
+<p>&#8220;My Onondaga brother does not wish to
+show himself in the light. Perhaps there is
+some trouble on his mind. Perhaps he is governed
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_395' name='page_395'></a>395</span>
+by an evil Oki who loves the darkness.&#8221;
+While Menard was speaking he was moving
+quietly toward the door. The Indian saw, but
+beyond turning slowly so as always to face his
+captor, made no movement. His face, except
+for the blazing eyes, was inscrutable. In a moment
+Menard stood between him and the door.
+&#8220;Perhaps it is best that I should call for the
+warriors of the fort. They will be glad to find
+here the slayer of their brother.&#8221; His hand was
+on the latch.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo will not call to his brothers.&#8221;
+The Indian&#8217;s voice was calm. Menard
+looked closely at him. &#8220;He has not thought
+yet. When he has thought, he will understand.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan speaks like a child.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;If Teganouan is a child, can the Big Buffalo
+tell why he came to the white man&#8217;s
+lodge?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Because he has slain a great white warrior,
+he must hide his face like the outcast dog.&#8221;
+Menard pointed to the scalp that hung at his
+waist. &#8220;He has slain a great warrior while the
+hatchet lies buried in the ground. He has
+broken the law of the white man and the redman.
+And so he must hide his face.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Why did not Teganouan run to the woods?
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_396' name='page_396'></a>396</span>
+Why did he come to the lodge of the Big Buffalo?&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard looked steadily at him. He began
+to understand. The shrewd old warrior had
+chosen the one hiding-place where no searching
+party would look. Perhaps he had hoped for
+aid from the Captain, remembering his pledge
+to bring punishment on La Grange. If so, he
+should learn his mistake.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan&#8217;s words are idle.&#8221; Menard
+moved the latch.</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Big Buffalo will not open the door.
+Teganouan has not delivered his message. He
+is not an enemy to the Big Buffalo. He is
+his friend. He has come to this lodge, caring
+nothing for the safety of his life, that he might
+give his message. The Big Buffalo will not
+open the door. He will wait to hear the
+words of Teganouan; and then he may call
+to his brother warriors if he still thinks it
+would be wise.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard waited.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Speak quickly, Teganouan.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan&#8217;s words are like the wind. He
+has brought them many leagues,&ndash;&ndash;from the
+lodges of the Onondagas,&ndash;&ndash;that he may speak
+them now. He has brought them from the
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_397' name='page_397'></a>397</span>
+Long House of the Five Nations, where the
+fires burn brightly by day and by night, where
+the greatest chiefs of many thousand warriors
+are met to hear the Voice of the Great Mountain,
+the father of white men and redmen.
+The Great Mountain has a strong voice. It
+is louder than cannon; it wounds deeper than
+the musket of the white brave. It tells the
+Onondagas and Cayugas and Oneidas and
+Mohawks that they must not give aid to their
+brothers, the Senecas, who have fallen, whose
+corn and forts and lodges are burned to ashes
+and scattered on the winds. It tells the Onondagas
+that the Great Mountain is a kind
+father, that he loves them like his own children,
+and will punish the man who wrongs
+them, let him be white or red. It tells the
+Onondagas that the white captain, who has
+robbed a hundred Onondaga lodges of their
+bravest hunters, shall be struck by the strong
+arm of the Great Mountain, shall be blown to
+pieces by the Voice that thunders from the
+great water where the seal are found to the
+farthest village of the Five Nations. And
+the chiefs hear the Voice; they listen with
+ears that are always open to the counsel of
+Onontio. They take his promises into their
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_398' name='page_398'></a>398</span>
+hearts and believe them. They know that he
+will strike down the dog of a white captain.
+They refuse aid to their dying brothers, the
+Senecas, because they know that the strong
+arm of Onontio is over them, that it will give
+them peace.&#8221;</p>
+<p>He paused, gazing with bright eyes at Menard.
+There was no reply, and he continued:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;The Great Mountain has kept his word.
+The Onondagas shall know, in their council,
+that Onontio&#8217;s promise has been kept, that
+the white brave, who lied to their hunters and
+sent them in chains across the big water, has
+gone to a hunting-ground where his musket
+will not help him, where the buffalo shall
+trample him and tear his flesh with their
+horns. Then the Onondagas shall know that
+the Big Buffalo spoke the truth to the Long
+House. And this word shall be carried to the
+Onondagas by Teganouan. He will go to the
+council with the scalp in his hand telling them
+that the white children of Onontio are their
+brothers. Teganouan sees the Big Buffalo
+stand with his strong hand at the door. He
+knows that the Big Buffalo could call his warriors
+to seize Teganouan, and bind him, and
+bid him stand before the white men&#8217;s muskets.
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_399' name='page_399'></a>399</span>
+But Teganouan is not a child. He sees with
+the eye of the old warrior who has fought a
+battle for every sun in the year, who has
+known the white man as well as the redman.
+When the Big Buffalo stood in the Long
+House, Teganouan believed him; Teganouan
+knew that his words were true. And now the
+heart of Teganouan is warm with trust. He
+knows that the Big Buffalo is a wise warrior
+and that he has an honest heart.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There was a pause, and Menard, his hand
+still on the latch, stood motionless. He knew
+what the Indian meant. He had done no
+more than Menard himself had promised the
+council, in the name of Governor Denonville,
+should be done. The lodges of the allies near
+the fort sheltered many an Iroquois spy;
+whatever might follow would be known in
+every Iroquois village before the week had
+passed. To hold Teganouan for trial would
+mean war.</p>
+<p>There was the tramp of feet on the beaten
+ground without, and a clear voice said:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Wait a moment, I must report to Captain
+Menard.&#8221;</p>
+<p>Menard raised the latch an inch, then looked
+sharply at Teganouan. The Indian stood
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_400' name='page_400'></a>400</span>
+quietly, leaning a little forward, waiting for
+the decision. The Captain was on the point
+of speaking, but no word came from his parted
+lips. The voices were now just outside the
+door. With a long breath Menard&#8217;s fingers
+relaxed, and the latch slipped back into
+place. Then he motioned toward the wall
+ladder that reached up into the darkness of
+the loft.</p>
+<p>Teganouan turned, picked up the hatchet
+and thrust it into his belt, took one quick
+glance about the room to make sure that no
+telltale article remained, and slipped up the
+ladder. There was a loud knock on the
+door, and Menard opened it. The Lieutenant
+came in.</p>
+<p>&#8220;We have no word yet, Captain,&#8221; he said.
+&#8220;Every building in the fort has been searched.
+I have so few men that I could not divide them
+until this was done, but I am just now sending
+out searching parties through the Indian village
+and the forest. None of the canoes are
+missing. Have I your approval?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;You&ndash;&ndash;you have been here since you left
+the hospital?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Yes.&#8221;
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_401' name='page_401'></a>401</span></p>
+<p>&#8220;I think, then, that he must have had time to
+slip out before we knew of it. There are many
+Indians here who would help him; but a few
+of them can be trusted, I think, to join the
+search. Major d&#8217;Orvilliers left me with only
+a handful of men. It will be difficult to accomplish
+much until he returns. I will post a
+sentry at the sally-port; we shall have to leave
+the bastions without a guard. I think it will be
+safe, for the time.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well, Lieutenant.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The Lieutenant saluted and hurried away.
+Menard closed the door, and turned to the
+table, where were scattered the sheets on
+which he had been writing his report. He
+collected them and read the report carefully.
+He removed one leaf, and rolling it up, lighted
+it at the candle, and held it until it was burned
+to a cinder. Then he read the other sheets
+again. The report now told of his capture, of
+a part of the council at the Long House, and
+of the escape; but no word was there concerning
+Captain la Grange. Another hand had
+disposed of that question. Menard sighed as
+he laid it down, but soon the lines on his face
+relaxed. It was not the first time in the history
+of New France that a report had told but
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_402' name='page_402'></a>402</span>
+half the truth; and, after all, the column had
+been saved.</p>
+<p>He sharpened a quill with his sheath-knife,
+and began to copy the report, making further
+corrections here and there. Something more
+than an hour had passed before the work was
+finished. He rolled up the document and tied
+it with a thong of deerskin.</p>
+<p>It was still early in the evening, but the
+fort was as silent as at midnight. Menard
+opened the door and walked out a little way.
+The lamps were all burning, but no soldiers
+were to be seen. The barrack windows were
+dark. He stepped back into the house, closed
+the door, and said in a low voice:&ndash;&ndash;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan.&#8221;</p>
+<p>There was a stir in the loft. In a moment
+the Indian came down the ladder and stood
+waiting.</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan, you heard what the Lieutenant
+said?&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Teganouan has ears.&#8221;</p>
+<p>&#8220;Very well. I am going to blow out the
+candle.&#8221;</p>
+<p>The room was dark. The door creaked
+softly, and a breath of air blew in upon the
+Captain as he stood by the table. He felt
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_403' name='page_403'></a>403</span>
+over the table for his tinder-box and struck a
+light. The door was slowly closing; Teganouan
+had gone.</p>
+<hr class='tb' />
+<p>Another sun was setting. A single drum
+was beating loudly as the little garrison drew
+up outside the sally-port and presented arms.
+The allies and the mission Indians were crowding
+down upon the beach, silent, inquisitive,&ndash;&ndash;puffing
+at their short pipes. For half a league,
+from the flat, white beach out over the rose-tinted
+water stretched an irregular black line of
+canoes and bateaux, all bristling with muskets.
+The Governor had come. He could be seen
+kneeling, all sunburned and ragged but with
+erect head, in the first canoe. His canoemen
+checked their swing, for the beach was close
+at hand, and then backed water. The bow
+scraped, and a dozen hands were outstretched
+in aid, but Governor Denonville stepped briskly
+out into the ankle-deep water and carried his
+own pack ashore. A cheer went up from the
+little line at the sally-port. Du Luth&#8217;s <i>voyageurs</i>
+and <i>coureur de bois</i> caught it up, and
+then it swept far out over the water and was
+echoed back from the forest.</p>
+<p>In the doorway of a hut near the Recollet
+<span class='pagenum pncolor'><a id='page_404' name='page_404'></a>404</span>
+Chapel stood Menard and Val&eacute;rie. They
+watched canoe after canoe glide up and
+empty its load of soldiers, not speaking as
+they watched, but thinking each the same
+thought. At last, when the straggling line
+was pouring into the fort, and the bugles were
+screaming, and the drum rolling, Val&eacute;rie slipped
+her hand through the Captain&#8217;s arm and
+looked up into his face.</p>
+<p>&#8220;It was you who brought them here,&#8221; she
+said; and then, after a pause, she laughed a
+breathless little laugh. &#8220;It was you,&#8221; she
+repeated.</p>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<hr class="full" />
+<p>***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC***</p>
+<p>******* This file should be named 28958-h.txt or 28958-h.zip *******</p>
+<p>This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:<br />
+<a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/2/8/9/5/28958">http://www.gutenberg.org/2/8/9/5/28958</a></p>
+<p>Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.</p>
+
+<p>Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.</p>
+
+
+
+<pre>
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+<a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/license">http://www.gutenberg.org/license)</a>.
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS,' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Each eBook is in a subdirectory of the same number as the eBook's
+eBook number, often in several formats including plain vanilla ASCII,
+compressed (zipped), HTML and others.
+
+Corrected EDITIONS of our eBooks replace the old file and take over
+the old filename and etext number. The replaced older file is renamed.
+VERSIONS based on separate sources are treated as new eBooks receiving
+new filenames and etext numbers.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+<a href="http://www.gutenberg.org">http://www.gutenberg.org</a>
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+EBooks posted prior to November 2003, with eBook numbers BELOW #10000,
+are filed in directories based on their release date. If you want to
+download any of these eBooks directly, rather than using the regular
+search system you may utilize the following addresses and just
+download by the etext year.
+
+<a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/etext06/">http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/etext06/</a>
+
+ (Or /etext 05, 04, 03, 02, 01, 00, 99,
+ 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92, 91 or 90)
+
+EBooks posted since November 2003, with etext numbers OVER #10000, are
+filed in a different way. The year of a release date is no longer part
+of the directory path. The path is based on the etext number (which is
+identical to the filename). The path to the file is made up of single
+digits corresponding to all but the last digit in the filename. For
+example an eBook of filename 10234 would be found at:
+
+http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/1/0/2/3/10234
+
+or filename 24689 would be found at:
+http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/2/4/6/8/24689
+
+An alternative method of locating eBooks:
+<a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/GUTINDEX.ALL">http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/GUTINDEX.ALL</a>
+
+*** END: FULL LICENSE ***
+</pre>
+</body>
+</html>
diff --git a/28958-h/images/illus-036.jpg b/28958-h/images/illus-036.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4133f00
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958-h/images/illus-036.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/28958-h/images/illus-064.jpg b/28958-h/images/illus-064.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fa1a1e3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958-h/images/illus-064.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/28958-h/images/illus-256.jpg b/28958-h/images/illus-256.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..93f422b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958-h/images/illus-256.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/28958-h/images/illus-emb.png b/28958-h/images/illus-emb.png
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d978f6c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958-h/images/illus-emb.png
Binary files differ
diff --git a/28958-h/images/illus-fpc.jpg b/28958-h/images/illus-fpc.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5c64761
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958-h/images/illus-fpc.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/28958-h/images/illus-map.png b/28958-h/images/illus-map.png
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8a56aff
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958-h/images/illus-map.png
Binary files differ
diff --git a/28958.txt b/28958.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..71052a9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,10065 @@
+The Project Gutenberg eBook, The Road to Frontenac, by Samuel Merwin
+
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+
+
+
+Title: The Road to Frontenac
+
+
+Author: Samuel Merwin
+
+
+
+Release Date: May 24, 2009 [eBook #28958]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-646-US (US-ASCII)
+
+
+***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC***
+
+
+E-text prepared by Roger Frank and the Project Gutenberg Online
+Distributed Proofreading Team (http://www.pgdp.net)
+
+
+
+Note: Project Gutenberg also has an HTML version of this
+ file which includes the original illustrations.
+ See 28958-h.htm or 28958-h.zip:
+ (http://www.gutenberg.org/files/28958/28958-h/28958-h.htm)
+ or
+ (http://www.gutenberg.org/files/28958/28958-h.zip)
+
+
+
+
+
+THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC
+
+
+[Illustration: "Half way down the steps was a double file of Indians
+chained two and two."]
+
+
+THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC
+
+by
+
+SAMUEL MERWIN
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+New York
+Doubleday, Page & Co.
+1901
+
+Copyright, 1901, by Frank Leslie Publishing House.
+Copyright, 1901, by Doubleday, Page & Company.
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+ CHAPTER PAGE
+ I. Captain Menard Has a Lazy Day. 1
+ II. The Maid. 19
+ III. Mademoiselle Eats Her Breakfast. 38
+ IV. The Long Arrow. 61
+ V. Danton Breaks Out. 83
+ VI. The Fight at La Gallette. 103
+ VII. A Compliment for Menard. 127
+ VIII. The Maid Makes New Friends. 147
+ IX. The Word of an Onondaga. 169
+ X. A Night Council. 191
+ XI. The Big Throat Speaks. 212
+ XII. The Long House. 235
+ XIII. The Voice of the Great Mountain. 254
+ XIV. Where the Dead Sit. 272
+ XV. The Bad Doctor. 293
+ XVI. At the Long Lake. 314
+ XVII. Northward. 337
+ XVIII. The Only Way. 359
+ XIX. Frontenac. 383
+
+
+
+
+LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
+
+ PAGE
+
+ "Half way down the steps was a double file of Indians
+ chained two and two." _Frontispiece_
+
+ "Sitting on a bundle was, a girl, perhaps eighteen or
+ nineteen years old." 36
+
+ "The Indians walked silently to the fire." 64
+
+ "Menard stood ... smiling with the same look of scorn
+ he had worn ... when they led him to the torture." 256
+
+
+
+
+THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC.
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+CAPTAIN MENARD HAS A LAZY DAY.
+
+
+Captain Daniel Menard leaned against the parapet at the outer edge of
+the citadel balcony. The sun was high, the air clear and still.
+Beneath him, at the foot of the cliff, nestled the Lower Town, a strip
+of shops and houses, hemmed in by the palisades and the lower battery.
+The St. Lawrence flowed by, hardly stirred by the light breeze. Out in
+the channel, beyond the merchantmen, lay three ships of war, _Le
+Fourgon_, _Le Profond_, and _La Perle_, each with a cluster of supply
+boats at her side; and the stir and rattle of tackle and chain coming
+faintly over the water from _Le Fourgon_ told that she would sail for
+France on the morrow, if God should choose to send the wind.
+
+Looking almost straight down, Menard could see the long flight of
+steps that climbed from the settlement on the water front to the
+nobler city on the heights. Halfway down the steps was a double file
+of Indians, chained two and two, and guarded by a dozen regulars from
+his own company. He watched them until they reached the bottom and
+disappeared behind the row of buildings that ended on the wharf in
+Patron's trading store. In a moment they reappeared, and marched
+across the wharf, toward the two boats from _Le Fourgon_ that awaited
+them. Even from the height, Menard could see that the soldiers had a
+stiff task to control their prisoners. After one of the boats, laden
+deep, had shoved off, there was a struggle, and the crowd of idlers
+that had gathered scattered suddenly. Two Indians had broken away, and
+were running across the wharf, with a little knot of soldiers close on
+their heels. One of the soldiers, leaping forward, brought the stock
+of his musket down on the head of the nearer Indian. The fugitive went
+down, dragging with him his companion, who tugged desperately at the
+chain. A soldier drew his knife, and cut off the dead Indian's arm
+close to the iron wristlet, breaking the bone with his foot. Then they
+led back the captive and tumbled him into the boat, with the hand of
+his comrade dangling at the end of the chain. The incident had excited
+the soldiers, and they kicked and pounded the prisoners. A crowd
+gathered about the body on the wharf, the bolder ones snatching at his
+beads and wampum belt.
+
+Menard raised his eyes to the lands across the river and to the white
+cloud-puffs above. After months of camp and canoe, sleeping in snow
+and rain, and by day paddling, poling, and wading,--never a new face
+among the grumbling soldiers or the stolid prisoners,--after this,
+Quebec stood for luxury and the pleasant demoralization of good
+living. He liked the noise of passing feet, the hail of goodwill from
+door to door, the plodding shopkeepers and artisans, the comfortable
+priests in brown and gray.
+
+The sound of oars brought his eyes again to the river. The two boats
+with their loads of redskins were passing the merchantmen that lay
+between the men-of-war and the city. On the wharf, awaiting a second
+trip, was a huddled group of prisoners. Menard's face clouded as he
+watched them. Men of his experience were wondering what effect this
+new plan of the Governor's would have upon the Iroquois. Capturing a
+hunting party by treachery and shipping them off to the King's galleys
+was a bold stroke,--too bold, perhaps. Governor Frontenac would never
+have done this; he knew the Iroquois temper too well. Governor la
+Barre, for all his bluster, would not have dared. It was certain that
+this new governor, Denonville, was not a coward; but as Menard
+reflected, going back over his own fifteen years of frontier life, he
+knew that this policy of brute force would be sorely tested by the
+tact and intrigue of the Five Nations. His own part in the capture
+little disturbed him. He had obeyed orders. He had brought the band to
+the citadel at Quebec without losing a man (saving the poor devil who
+had strangled himself with his own thongs at La Gallette).
+
+To such men as Menard, whose lives were woven closely into the fabric
+of New France, the present condition was clear. Many an evening he had
+spent with Major d'Orvilliers, at Fort Frontenac, in talking over the
+recent years of history into which their two names and their two lives
+had gone so deeply. Until his recall to France in 1682, Governor
+Frontenac had been for ten years building up in the Iroquois heart a
+fear and awe of Onontio, the Great Father, at Quebec. D'Orvilliers
+knew that period the better, for Menard had not come over (from the
+little town of his birth, in Picardy) until Frontenac's policy was
+well established. But Menard had lived hard and rapidly during his
+first years in the province, and he was a stern-faced young soldier
+when he stood on the wharf, hat in hand and sword to chin, watching
+New France's greatest governor sitting erect in the boat that bore him
+away from his own. Menard had been initiated by a long captivity among
+the Onondagas, and had won his first commission by gallant action
+under the Governor's eye.
+
+In those days no insult went unpunished; no tribe failed twice in its
+obligations. The circle of French influence was firmly extended around
+the haunts of the Iroquois in New York and along the Ohio. From
+Frontenac, on Lake Ontario, north to Hudson's Bay, was French land. To
+the westward, along the Ottawa River, and skirting the north shore of
+Lake Huron to Michillimackinac and Green Bay, were the strong French
+allies, the Hurons, Ottawas, Nipissings, Kiskagons, Sacs, Foxes, and
+Mascoutins. Down at the lower end of Lake Michigan, at the Chicagou
+and St. Joseph portages, were the Miamis; and farther still, the
+Illinois, whom the Sieur de la Salle and Henri de Tonty had drawn
+close under the arm of New France.
+
+This chain of allies, with Du Luth's fort at Detroit and a partial
+control over Niagara, had given New France nearly all the fur trade of
+the Great Lakes. The English Governor Dongan, of New York, dared not
+to fight openly for it, but he armed the Iroquois and set them against
+the French. Menard had laughed when the word came, in 1684, from
+Father de Lamberville, whose influence worked so far toward keeping
+the Iroquois quiet, that Dongan had pompously set up the arms of his
+king in each Iroquois village, even dating them back a year to make
+his claim the more secure. Every old soldier knew that more than
+decrees and coats of arms were needed to win the Five Nations.
+
+When La Barre succeeded Frontenac, lacking the tact and firmness which
+had established Frontenac's name among foes and allies alike, he fell
+back upon bluster (to say nothing of the common talk in Quebec that he
+had set out to build up his private fortune by the fur trade).
+Learning that, by his grant of Fort Frontenac, La Salle was entitled
+to a third of the trade that passed through it, he seized the fort. He
+weakened La Salle's communications so greatly that La Salle and Tonty
+could not make good their promises of French protection to the
+Illinois. This made it possible for the Iroquois, unhindered, to lay
+waste the Illinois country. By equally shortsighted methods, La Barre
+so weakened the ties that bound the northern allies, and so increased
+the arrogance of the Iroquois, that when Governor Denonville took up
+the task, most of the allies, always looking to the stronger party,
+were on the point of going over to the Iroquois. This would give the
+fur trade to the English, and ruin New France. Governor Dongan seized
+the moment to promise better bargains for the peltry than the French
+could offer. It remained for the new governor to make a demonstration
+which would establish firmly the drooping prestige of New France.
+
+Now the spring of 1687 was just ending. Since February it had been
+spread abroad, from the gulf seignories to Fort Frontenac, that
+preparations were making for a great campaign against the Iroquois.
+Champigny, the new Intendant, had scoured the country for supplies,
+and now was building bateaux and buying canoes. Regulars and militia
+were drilling into the semblance of an army, and palisades and
+defences were everywhere built or strengthened, that the home guard
+might keep the province secure during the long absence of the troops.
+Menard wondered, as he snapped bits of stone off the parapet, and
+watched the last boatload of galley slaves embarking at the wharf,
+whether the Governor's plans would carry. He would undoubtedly act
+with precision, he would follow every detail of campaigning to the
+delight of the tacticians, he would make a great splash,--and then?
+How about the wily chiefs of the Senecas and Onondagas and Mohawks?
+They had hoodwinked La Barre into signing the meanest treaty that ever
+disgraced New France. Would Denonville, too, blind himself to the
+truth that shrewd minds may work behind painted faces?
+
+But above all else, Menard was a soldier. He snapped another bit of
+stone, and gave up the problem. He would fight at the Governor's
+orders, retreat at the Governor's command,--to the Governor would
+belong the credit or the blame. Of only one thing was he sure,--his
+own half hundred men should fight as they had always fought, and
+should hold their posts to the end. There ended his responsibility.
+And did not the good Fathers say that God was watching over New
+France?
+
+Meantime the breath of summer was in the air. The spring campaign was
+over for Menard. So he rested both elbows on the parapet, and wondered
+how long the leaves had been out in Picardy. Over beyond the ships and
+the river were waves of the newest green, instead of the deep, rich
+colour and the bloom of full life he had left behind at Fort Frontenac
+but two weeks back. The long journey down the St. Lawrence had seemed
+almost a descent into winter. On the way to Quebec every day and every
+league had brought fewer blossoms. Even Montreal, sixty leagues to the
+south, had her summer before Quebec.
+
+On the wharf below him the crowd were still plucking the dead Indian.
+Menard could hear their laughter and shouts. Their figures were small
+in the distance, their actions grotesque. One man was dancing,
+brandishing some part of the Indian's costume. Menard could not
+distinguish the object in his hand. A priest crossed the wharf and
+elbowed into the crowd. For the moment he was lost in the rabble, but
+shortly the shouting quieted and the lightheaded fellows crowded into
+a close group. Probably the priest was addressing them. Soon the
+fringe of the crowd thinned, then the others walked quietly away. When
+at last the priest was left alone by the mutilated Indian, he knelt,
+and for a space was motionless.
+
+The idleness of reaction was on Menard. He leaned on the parapet,
+hardly stirring, while the priest went on his way across the square
+and began toiling up the steps. When he was halfway up, Menard
+recognized him for Claude de Casson, an old Jesuit of the Iroquois
+mission at Sault St. Francis Xavier, near Montreal. Menard strolled
+through the citadel to the square, and, meeting the Father, walked
+with him.
+
+"Well, Father Claude, you are a long way from your flock."
+
+"Yes, Captain Menard, I came with the relations. I have been"--Father
+Claude was blown from his climb, and he paused, wiping the sweat from
+his lean face--"I have been grieved by a spectacle in the Lower Town.
+Some wretches had killed an Onondaga with the brutality of his own
+tribe, and were robbing him. Are such acts permitted to-day in Quebec,
+M'sieu?"
+
+"He was a prisoner escaping from the soldiers. It must be a full year
+since I last saw you, Father. I hope you bring a good record to the
+College."
+
+"The best since our founding, M'sieu."
+
+"Is there no word in the relations from the New York missions?"
+
+"Yes, M'sieu. Brother de Lamberville brings glorious word from the
+Mohawks. Twenty-three complete conversions."
+
+"You say he brings this word?" Menard's brows came together. "Then he
+has come up to Montreal?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"It is true, then, that the Iroquois have word of our plans?"
+
+"It would seem so. He said that a war party which started weeks ago
+for the Illinois country had been recalled. A messenger was sent out
+but a few days before he came away."
+
+Menard slowly shook his head.
+
+"This word should go to the Commandant," he said. "How about your
+Indians at the Mission, Father Claude? They have not French hearts."
+
+"Ah, but I am certain, M'sieu, they would not break faith with us."
+
+"You can trust them?"
+
+"They are Christians, M'sieu."
+
+"Yes, but they are Iroquois. Have none of them gone away since this
+news reached Quebec?"
+
+"None, save one poor wretch whose drunkenness long ago caused us to
+give up hope, though I--"
+
+"What became of him? Where did he go?"
+
+"He wandered away in a drunken fit."
+
+"And you have not heard from him since?"
+
+"No, M'sieu. He was Teganouan, an Onondaga."
+
+"You would do well, Father, if I may suggest, to take what news you
+may have to the Commandant. You and I know the importance of trifles
+at such a time as this. How long do you remain in Quebec?"
+
+"A few days only, unless there should be work for me here."
+
+"Do you return then to Montreal?"
+
+"I cannot say until I have made my report and delivered the relations.
+Brother de Lamberville thinks it important that word should go to all
+those who are now labouring in the Iroquois villages. If they remain
+after the campaign is fairly started, their lives may be in danger."
+
+"You think it necessary to go yourself?"
+
+"What else, M'sieu? This is not the time to trust too freely an Indian
+runner. And a layman might never get through alive. My habit would be
+the best safeguard."
+
+"I suppose you are right. If I should not see you again, I must ask
+you to convey my respect to your colleagues at the Mission. I shall
+probably be here until the campaign is fairly started; perhaps longer.
+Already I am tasting the luxury of idleness."
+
+"A dangerous luxury, M'sieu. If I might be permitted to advise--"
+
+"Yes, yes, Father,--I know, I know. But what is the use? You are a
+priest, I am a soldier. Yours is penance, mine is fighting; yours is
+praying, mine is singing,--every man to his own. And when you priests
+have got your pagans converted, we soldiers will clean up the mess
+with our muskets. And now, Father, good day, and may God be with
+you."
+
+The priest's face was unmoved as he looked after the retreating
+figure. He had watched Menard grow from a roistering lieutenant into a
+rigid captain, and he knew his temper too well to mind the flicks of
+banter. But before the soldier had passed from earshot, he called
+after him.
+
+Menard turned back. "What now, good Father? A mass for my soul, or a
+last absolution before I plunge into my term of dissolute idleness?"
+
+"Neither, my son," replied the priest, smiling. "Is any of your
+idleness to be shared with another?"
+
+"Certainly, Father."
+
+"I am bringing a picture to the College."
+
+"I have no money, Father. I should be a sorry patron."
+
+"No, no, M'sieu; it is not a patron I seek. It is the advice of one
+who has seen and judged the master work of Paris. The painting has
+been shown to none as yet."
+
+"But you have seen it?"
+
+"Yes, yes, I have seen it. Come with me, M'sieu; it is at my room."
+
+They walked together to the cell, six feet long by five wide, where
+Father Claude slept when in Quebec. It was bare of all save a hard
+cot. A bale, packed in rough cloth and tied with rope, lay on the bed.
+Father Claude opened the bundle, while Menard leaned against the wall,
+and drew out his few personal belongings and his portable altar before
+he reached the flat, square package at the bottom. There was a touch
+of colour in his cheeks and a nervousness in the movement of his hands
+as he untied the flaxen strings, stripped off the cloth, and held the
+picture up to Menard's view.
+
+It was a full-length portrait in oil of a young Indian woman, holding
+a small cross in her right hand, and gazing at it with bent head. Her
+left hand was spread upon her breast. She wore a calico chemise
+reaching below her knees, and leggings, and moccasins. A heavy robe
+was thrown over the top of her head, falling on the sides and back to
+within a foot of the ground. In the middle background was a stream,
+with four Indians in a canoe. A tiny stone chapel stood on the bank at
+the extreme right.
+
+Father Claude's hand trembled as he supported the canvas upon the cot,
+and his eyes wavered from Menard to the picture, and back again.
+
+"It is not altogether completed," he said, nervously. "Of course the
+detail will be worked out more fully, and the cross should be given a
+warmer radiance. Perhaps a light showing through the windows of the
+chapel--"
+
+"Who is it?" asked Menard.
+
+"It is Catherine Outasoren, the Lily of the Onondagas," replied the
+priest; "the noblest woman that ever rose from the depths of Indian
+superstition."
+
+Menard's eyes rested on an obscure signature in a lower corner, "C. de
+C."
+
+"You certainly have reason to be proud of the work. But may I ask
+about the perspective? Should the maiden appear larger than the
+chapel?"
+
+The priest gazed at the painting with an unsettled expression.
+
+"Yes," he said, "perhaps you are right, M'sieu. At any rate I will
+give the matter thought and prayer."
+
+"And the Indians," Menard questioned, "in the canoe; are they coming
+toward the chapel or going away from it? It seems to me that any doubt
+on that point should be removed."
+
+"Ah," said the priest; "that very doubt is allegorical. It typifies
+the workings of the human mind when first confronted by the truth.
+When the seeker first beholds the light, as shown through the devotion
+of such a woman as Catherine Outasoren, there arises in his mind--"
+
+"Very true, very true! But I never yet have seen a canoe-load of
+Indians in doubt whether they were moving forward or backward."
+
+Father Claude held the canvas at arm's length and gazed long at it.
+
+"Tell me, M'sieu," he said at last, "do you think it deserving of a
+place in the College?"
+
+"I do not see why not."
+
+"And you think I would be justified in laying a request before the
+Superior?"
+
+Menard shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"That is your decision, Father."
+
+"I never can fully thank you, my son, for your kindness in looking on
+my humble work. I will not decide to-day. First I must add foliage in
+the foreground. And I will give it my earnest prayer."
+
+Menard said farewell and went out, leaving the priest gazing at the
+picture. He strolled back toward the citadel, stopping now and then to
+greet an old friend or a chance acquaintance. When he arrived at the
+headquarters in the citadel he found Danton, a brown-haired young
+lieutenant of engineers, gazing at a heap of plans and other papers on
+the table.
+
+"Well, Captain Menard," was his greeting, "I'd give half of last
+year's pay, if I ever get it, to feel as lazy as you look."
+
+"You are lazy enough," growled Menard.
+
+"That begs the question. It is not how lazy a man is, but how lazy he
+gets a chance to be."
+
+"If you'd been through what I have this spring, you'd deserve a
+rest."
+
+"You must have had a stirring time," said the Lieutenant. "Major
+Provost has promised to let me go out with the line when the campaign
+starts. I've not had a brush since I came over."
+
+Menard gave him a quizzical smile before he replied, "You'll get
+brushes enough."
+
+"By the way, the Major wants to see you."
+
+"Does he?" said Menard.
+
+He lighted his short pipe with a coal from the fire and walked out.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II.
+
+THE MAID.
+
+
+Menard did not go at once to see Major Provost, the Commandant. He had
+already handed in his report at the citadel. It was probable that this
+was some new work for him. He had just settled his mind to the
+prospect of a rest, the first since that mad holiday, seven years
+before, when word had come that his lieutenant's commission was on the
+way. That was at Three Rivers. He wanted to idle, to waste a few weeks
+for the sheer delight of extravagance, but his blood did not flow more
+quickly at the wish. He was an older man by a score of years--or was
+it only seven?
+
+He lingered on the square. The black-eyed children, mostly dirty and
+ragged (for the maids whom the King had sent over by shiploads to his
+colonists had not developed into the most diligent and neat
+housewives) tumbled about his feet. He allowed himself to be drawn
+into their play. They had no awe of his uniform, for it was worn and
+frayed. He had not yet taken the trouble to get out his fresher coat
+and breeches and boots. He thought of this, and was again amused. It
+was another sign of age. The time had been when his first care after
+arriving in Quebec was to don his rich house uniform and polished
+scabbard, and step gaily to the Major's house to sun himself in the
+welcome of the Major's pretty wife, who had known his uncle, the Sieur
+de Vauban, at La Rochelle. Now he was back in Quebec from months on
+the frontier, he was summoned to the Major's house, and yet he stayed
+and laughed at the children. For the Major's wife was older, too, and
+the vivacity of her youth was thinning out and uncovering the
+needle-like tongue beneath. A slim little urchin was squirming between
+his boots, with a pursuing rabble close behind, and the Captain had to
+take hold of a young tree to keep his feet. He turned and started in
+pursuit of the children, but caught sight of two Ursuline sisters
+entering the square, and straightened himself. After all, a captain is
+a captain, even though the intoxication of spring be in him, and his
+heart struggling to clamber back into the land of youth. He walked on
+across the square and down the street to the Major's house.
+
+Major Provost welcomed Menard heartily, and led him to his office.
+"We'll have our business first," he said, "and get it done with."
+
+Menard settled back in the carved oak chair which had for generations
+been a member of the Major's family. The light mood had left him. Now
+he was the soldier, brusque in manner, with lines about his mouth
+which, to certain men, gave his face a hard expression.
+
+"First let me ask you, Menard, what are your plans?"
+
+"For the present?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"I have none."
+
+"Your personal affairs, I mean. Have you any matters to hold your
+attention here for the next few weeks?"
+
+"None."
+
+Major Provost fingered his quill.
+
+"I don't know, of course, how your own feelings stand, Menard. You've
+been worked hard for three years, and I suppose you want rest. But
+somebody must go to Fort Frontenac, and the Governor thinks you are
+the man."
+
+Menard made a gesture of impatience.
+
+"There are a dozen men here with little to do."
+
+"I know it. But this matter is of some importance, and it may call for
+delicate work before you are through with it. It isn't much in
+itself,--merely to bear orders to d'Orvilliers,--but the Governor
+thinks that the right man may be able to do strong work before the
+campaign opens. You probably know that we are to move against the
+Senecas alone, and that we must treat with the other nations to keep
+them from aiding the Senecas. No one can say just how this can be
+done. Even Father de Lamberville has come back, you know, from the
+Mohawks; but the Governor thinks that if we send a good man, he may be
+able to see a way, once he gets on the ground, and can advise with
+d'Orvilliers. Now, you are a good man, Menard; and you can influence
+the Indians if anyone can."
+
+"You are a little vague, Major."
+
+"You will go to Frontenac in advance of the army to prepare the way.
+La Durantaye and Du Luth are already at Detroit, awaiting orders, with
+close to two hundred Frenchmen and four hundred Indians. And Tonty
+should have joined them before now with several hundred Illinois."
+
+"I don't believe he'll bring many Illinois. They must have known of
+the Iroquois war party that started toward their villages. They will
+stay to defend their own country. They may not know that the Iroquois
+party was recalled."
+
+"Recalled?" said the Major.
+
+"Yes. Father de Casson has the news from Father de Lamberville. You
+see what that means. The Iroquois have been warned."
+
+"I was afraid of it. These new governors, Menard--each has to learn
+his lesson from the beginning of the book. Why will they not take
+counsel from the men who know the Indians? This campaign has been
+heralded as broadly as a trading fair."
+
+"When should I start?" asked Menard, abruptly.
+
+"At once--within a few days." Major Provost looked at the other's set
+face. "I am sorry about this, Menard. But you understand, I am sure.
+Perhaps I had better give you an idea of our plans. You know, of
+course, that we have three ships fitting out at Frontenac. Already our
+force is being got together at St. Helen's Island, by Montreal.
+Champigny is engaging canoemen and working out a transport and supply
+system between Montreal and Frontenac. The force will proceed to
+Frontenac, and embark from there in the ships, bateaux, and canoes."
+
+"Is the rendezvous at Niagara?"
+
+"No, at La Famine, on the southern shore of Lake Ontario."
+
+Menard nodded. He knew the place; for by nearly starving there, years
+before, with the others of Governor la Barre's ill-starred expedition,
+he had contributed to giving the spot a name.
+
+"La Durantaye and Du Luth, with Tonty, are to meet us there. You will
+instruct them to move on to Niagara, and there await further orders.
+We shall sail around the east end of the lake and along the south
+shore."
+
+"The Iroquois will follow your movements."
+
+"We intend that they shall. They will not know where our final landing
+place will be, and will have to keep their forces well in hand. And it
+will prevent them from uniting to attack Niagara."
+
+"What then?"
+
+"We will leave a strong guard at La Famine with the stores, and strike
+inland for the Seneca villages."
+
+"And now what part am I to play in this?"
+
+Major Provost leaned back in his chair.
+
+"You, Menard, are to represent the Governor. You will move in advance
+of the troops. At Frontenac it will be your duty to see first that the
+way is clear to getting the two divisions to the meeting place at La
+Famine, and to see that d'Orvilliers has the fort ready for the
+troops, with extra cabins and stockades. Then the Governor wishes you
+and d'Orvilliers to go over all the information the scouts bring in.
+If you can decide upon any course which will hold back the other
+tribes from aiding the Senecas, act upon it at once, without orders.
+In other words, you have full liberty to follow your judgment. That
+ought to be responsibility enough."
+
+Menard stretched his arms. "All right, Major. But when my day comes to
+taste the delights of Quebec, I hope I may not be too old to enjoy
+it."
+
+"The Governor honours you, Menard, with this undertaking."
+
+"He honoured De Sevigne with a majority and turned him loose in
+Quebec."
+
+"Too bad, Menard, too bad," the Major laughed. "Now I, who ask nothing
+better than a brisk campaign, must rot here in Quebec until I die."
+
+"Are you not to go?"
+
+"No. I am to stay behind and brighten my lonely moments drilling the
+rabble of a home guard. Do you think you will need an escort?"
+
+"No; the river from here to Frontenac is in use every day. I shall
+want canoemen. Two will be enough."
+
+"Very well. Let me know what supplies you need. You mistake, man, in
+grumbling at the work. You are building up a reputation that never
+could live at short range. Stay away long enough and you will be a
+more popular man than the Governor. I envy you, on my honour, I do."
+
+"One thing more, Major. This galley affair; what do you think of it?"
+
+"You mean the capture at Frontenac? You should know better than I,
+Menard. You brought the prisoners down."
+
+"There is no doubt in my mind, Major, nor in d'Orvilliers's! We obeyed
+orders." Menard looked up expressively. "You know the Iroquois. You
+know how they will take it. The worst fault was La Grange's. He
+captured the party--and it was not a war party--by deliberate
+treachery. D'Orvilliers had intrusted to him the Governor's orders
+that Indians must be got for the King's galleys. As you know,
+d'Orvilliers and I both protested. I did not bring them here until the
+Governor commanded it."
+
+"Well, we can't help that now, Menard."
+
+"That is not the question. You ask me to keep the Onondagas out of
+this fight, after we have taken a hundred of their warriors in this
+way."
+
+"I know it, Menard; I know it. But the Governor's orders--Well, I have
+nothing to say. You can only do your best."
+
+They went to the reception room, where Madame de Provost awaited them.
+Menard was made to stay and dine, in order that Madame could draw from
+him a long account of his latest adventures on the frontier. Madame de
+Provost, though she had lived a dozen years in the province, had never
+been farther from Quebec than the Seignory of the Marquis de St.
+Denis, half a dozen leagues below the city. The stories that came to
+her ears of massacres and battles, of settlers butchered in the
+fields, and of the dashing adventures of La Salle and Du Luth, were to
+her no more than wild tales from a far-away land. So she chattered
+through the long dinner; and for the first time since he had reached
+the city, Menard wished himself back on Lake Ontario, where there were
+no women.
+
+Menard returned to the citadel early in the evening. Lieutenant Danton
+was drawing plans for a redoubt, but he leaned back as Menard
+entered.
+
+"I began to think you were not coming back, Captain," he said. "I'm
+told the Major says that you are the only man in New France who could
+have got that trading agreement from the Onondagas last year. How did
+you do it?"
+
+"How does a man usually do what he is told to do?" Menard sat on a
+corner of the long table and looked lazily at the boy.
+
+"That wasn't the kind of treaty our Governors make; you know it
+wasn't."
+
+"You were not here under Frontenac."
+
+"No. I wish I had been. He must have been a great orator. My father
+has told me about the long council at Montreal. He said that Frontenac
+out-talked the greatest of the Mohawk orators. Did you learn it from
+him?"
+
+"My boy, when you are through with your pretty pictures," Menard
+motioned toward the plans, "and have got out into the real work; when
+you've spent months in Iroquois lodges; when you've been burned and
+shot and starved,--then it will be a pity if you haven't learned to be
+a soldier. What is this little thing you are drawing?"
+
+Danton flushed. "You may laugh at the engineers," he said, "but where
+would King Louis be now if--"
+
+"Tut, my boy, tut!"
+
+"That is very well--"
+
+Menard laughed. "How old are you, Danton?" he asked.
+
+"Twenty-two."
+
+"Very good. You have got on well. I dare say you've learned a deal out
+of your books. Now we have you out here in the provinces, where the
+hard work is done. Well send you back in a few years a real man. And
+then you'll step smartly among the pretty officers of the King, and
+when one speaks of New France you'll lift your brows and say: 'New
+France? Ah, yes. That is in America. I was there once. Rather a
+primitive life--no court, no army.' Ah, ha, my boy--no, never mind.
+Come up to my quarters and have a sip of real old Burgundy."
+
+"Are you ever serious, Menard?" asked Danton, sitting on the Captain's
+cot and smacking his lips over the liquor.
+
+Menard smiled. "I'm afraid I shall have to play at composure for an
+hour," he said. "I must see Father Claude. Settle yourself here, if
+you like."
+
+Menard hurried away, for it was growing late. He found the Jesuit
+meditating in his cell.
+
+"Ah, Captain Menard, I am glad to see you so soon again."
+
+Menard sat on the narrow bed and stretched out his legs as far as he
+could in the cramped space.
+
+"How soon will your duties be over here, Father?"
+
+"There seems to be no reason for me to stay. I have delivered the
+relations, and no further work has come to hand."
+
+"Then it may be that you can help me, Father."
+
+"You know, my son, that I will."
+
+"Very well. I have been ordered to Fort Frontenac in advance of the
+troops. I am to bear orders to d'Orvilliers and to Du Luth and La
+Durantaye. It is possible that there may be some delicate work to be
+done among the Indians. You know the Iroquois, Father, and our two
+heads together should be stronger than mine alone. I want you to go
+with me."
+
+The priest's eyes lighted.
+
+"It may be that I can get permission at Montreal."
+
+"You will go, then?"
+
+"Gladly. It is to be no one else--we two--"
+
+"We shall have canoemen. To my mind, the fewer the better."
+
+"Still, Captain, you cannot depend on the canoemen. Would it not be
+well to have one other man? You might need a messenger."
+
+Menard thought for a moment.
+
+"True, Father. And if I am to have a man, he had best be an officer;
+yes, a man who could execute orders. I'll take Danton. You will be
+ready for a start, Father, probably to-morrow?"
+
+"At any time, my son."
+
+"Good night."
+
+There was little work to be done in preparing for the journey (Major
+Provost would attend to the supplies and to engaging the canoemen),
+and Menard still was in the lazy mood. He stood for a while at the
+edge of the cliff and looked down at the wharf. It was dark, and he
+could not see whether the body of the Indian had been removed. The
+incident of the afternoon had been gathering importance to his mind
+the longer he thought of it. Five years earlier Menard had been
+captured by the Onondagas during a fight near Fort Frontenac. They had
+taken him to one of their villages, south of Lake Ontario, and for
+days had tortured him and starved him. They had drawn out cords from
+his arms and legs and thrust sticks between them and the flesh. His
+back was still covered with scars from the burning slivers which they
+had stuck through the skin. They had torn the nails from his left hand
+with their teeth. Then Otreouati, the Big Throat, the chief who had
+led his followers to believe in Frontenac, came back from a parley
+with another tribe, and taking a liking to the tall young soldier who
+bore the torture without flinching, he adopted him into his own
+family. Menard had lived with the Indians, a captive only in name, and
+had earned the name of the Big Buffalo by his skill in the hunt. At
+last, when they had released him, it was under a compact of
+friendship, that had never since been broken. It had stood many tests.
+Even during open campaigns they had singled him out from the other
+Frenchmen as their brother. He wondered whether they knew of his part
+in stocking the King's galleys. Probably they did.
+
+It was late when Menard took a last sweeping look at the river and
+walked up to the citadel. His day of idleness was over. After all, it
+had not been altogether a wasted day. But it was the longest holiday
+he was likely to have for months to come. Having made up his mind to
+accept the facts, he stretched out on his bed and went to sleep.
+
+Danton took the news that he was to be a member of the party with
+enthusiasm. Menard had hardly finished telling him when he swept the
+tiresome plans and specifications into a heap at the end of the table,
+and rushed out to get a musket (for a sword would have no place in the
+work before them). The start was to be made at noon, but Danton was on
+the ground so early as almost to lower his dignity in the eyes of the
+bronzed canoemen. He wore his bravest uniform, with polished belt and
+buttons and new lace at the neck. His broad hat had a long curling
+feather. He wore the new musket slung rakishly over his shoulder.
+
+About the middle of the forenoon, as Menard was looking over his
+orders, memorizing them in case of accident to the papers, he was
+found by Major Provost's orderly, who said that the Commandant wished
+to see him at once.
+
+The Major was busy with the engineers in another room, but he left
+them.
+
+"Menard," he said abruptly, "I've got to ask you to do me a favour. If
+I could see any way out of it--"
+
+"I will do anything I can."
+
+"Thank you. I suppose you know the Marquis de St. Denis?"
+
+"Slightly."
+
+"Well, I shan't take time to give you the whole story. St. Denis has
+the seignory six leagues to the east. You may know that he went into
+debt to invest in La Salle's colonizing scheme in Louisiana. St. Denis
+was in France at the time, and had great faith in La Salle. Of course,
+now that La Salle has not been heard from, and the debts are all past
+due without even a rumour of success to make them good--you can
+imagine the rest. The seignory has been seized. St. Denis has
+nothing."
+
+"Has he a family?" asked Menard.
+
+"A daughter. His wife is dead. He came here after you left last night,
+and again this morning. We are old friends, and I have been trying to
+help him. He is going to sail to-day on _Le Fourgon_ for Paris to see
+what he can save from the wreck. My house is crowded with the officers
+who are here planning the campaign; but St. Denis has a cousin living
+at Frontenac, Captain la Grange, and we've got to get Valerie there
+somehow. Do you think it will be safe?"
+
+"It's a hard trip, you know; but it's safe enough."
+
+"I shan't forget your kindness, Menard. The girl is a spirited little
+thing, and she takes it hard. Madame has set her heart on getting her
+to La Grange. I don't know all the details myself."
+
+"I think we can arrange it, Major. We start in an hour."
+
+"She will be there. You are a splendid fellow, Menard. Good-bye."
+
+Menard's face was less amiable once he was away from the house. He
+knew from experience the disagreeable task that lay before him. But
+there was nothing to be said, so he went to his quarters and took a
+last look at the orders. Then taking off his coat and his rough shirt,
+he placed the papers carefully in a buckskin bag, which he hung about
+his neck.
+
+Everything was ready at the wharf. The long canoe lay waiting, a
+_voyageur_ at each end. The bales were stowed carefully in the centre.
+Father de Casson met Menard at the upper end of the dock. He had come
+down by way of the winding road, for his bundle was heavy, and he knew
+no way but to carry it himself. Menard good-naturedly gave him a hand
+as they crossed the dock. When they had set it down, and Menard
+straightened up, his eyes twinkled, for young Danton, in his finery,
+was nervously walking back and forth at the edge of the dock, looking
+fixedly into the canoe, apparently inspecting the bales. His shoulders
+were unused to the musket, and by a quick turn he had brought the
+muzzle under the rim of his hat, setting it on the side of his head.
+His face was red.
+
+Sitting on a bundle, a rod away, was a girl, perhaps eighteen or
+nineteen years old, wearing a simple travelling dress. Her hands were
+clasped tightly in her lap, and she gazed steadily out over the water
+with an air that would have been haughty save for the slight upward
+tip of her nose.
+
+[Illustration: "Sitting on a bundle was, a girl, perhaps eighteen or
+nineteen years old."]
+
+Menard's eyes sobered, and he handed his musket to one of the
+canoemen. Then he crossed over to where the maiden was sitting.
+
+"Mademoiselle St. Denis?"
+
+The girl looked up at him. Her eyes seemed to take in the dinginess of
+his uniform. She inclined her head.
+
+"I am Captain Menard. Major Provost tells me that I am to have the
+honour of escorting you to Fort Frontenac. With your permission we
+will start. Father Claude de Casson is to go with us, and Lieutenant
+Danton."
+
+The bundle was placed in the canoe. Menard helped the girl to a seat
+near the middle: from the way she stepped in and took her seat he saw
+that she had been on the river before. Danton, with his Parisian airs,
+had to be helped in carefully. Then they were off, each of the four
+men swinging a paddle, though Danton managed his awkwardly at first.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III.
+
+MADEMOISELLE EATS HER BREAKFAST.
+
+
+The sun hung low over the western woods when Menard, at the close of
+the second day, headed the canoe shoreward. The great river swept by
+with hardly a surface motion, dimpling and rippling under the last
+touch of the day breeze. Menard's eyes rested on Father Claude, as the
+canoe drew into the shadow of the trees. The priest, stiff from the
+hours of sitting and kneeling, had taken up a paddle and was handling
+it deftly. He had rolled his sleeves up to the elbow, showing a thin
+forearm with wire-like muscles. The two _voyageurs_, at bow and stern,
+were proving to be quiet enough fellows. Guerin, the younger, wore a
+boyish, half-confiding look. His fellow, Perrot, was an older man.
+
+Menard felt, when he thought of Danton, a sense of pride in his own
+right judgment. The boy was taking hold with a strong, if unguided,
+hand. Already the feather was gone from his hat, the lace from his
+throat. Two days in the canoe and a night on the ground had stained
+and wrinkled his uniform,--a condition of which, with his quick
+adaptability, he was already beginning to feel proud. He had flushed
+often, during the first day, under the shrewd glances of the
+_voyageurs_, who read the inexperience in his bright clothes and white
+hands. Menard knew, from the way his shoulders followed the swing of
+his arms, that the steady paddling was laming him sadly. He would
+allow Danton five days more; at the week's end he must be a man, else
+the experiment had failed.
+
+The canoe scraped bottom under a wild growth of brush and outreaching
+trees. The forest was stirring with the rustle and call of birds, with
+the breath of the leaves and the far-away crackle and plunge of larger
+animals through the undergrowth. A chipmunk, with inquisitive eyes,
+sat on the root of a knotted oak, but he whisked away when Menard and
+the canoemen stepped into the shallow water. Overhead, showing little
+fear of the canoe and of the strangely clad animals within it,
+scampered a family of red squirrels, now nibbling a nut from the
+winter's store, now running and jumping from tree to tree, until only
+by the shaking of the twigs and the leaf-clusters could one follow
+their movements.
+
+The maid leaned an elbow on the bale which Danton had placed at her
+back, and rested her cheek on her hand. They were under the drooping
+branches of an elm that stood holding to the edge of the bank. Well
+out over the water sat one of the squirrels, his tail sweeping above
+his head, nibbling an acorn, and looking with hasty little glances at
+the canoe. She watched him, and memories came into her eyes. There had
+been squirrels on her father's seignory who would take nuts from her
+hand, burying them slyly under the bushes, and hurrying back for
+more.
+
+Danton came wading to the side of the canoe to help her to the bank,
+but she took his hand only to steady herself while rising. Stepping
+over the bracing-strips between the gunwales, she caught a swaying
+branch, and swung herself lightly ashore. Back from the water the
+ground rose into a low hill, covered with oak and elm and ragged
+hickory trees. Here, for a space, there was little undergrowth, and
+save under the heaviest of the trees the ground was green with short,
+coarse grass. Danton took a hatchet from the canoe, and trimmed a fir
+tree, heaping armfuls of green boughs at the foot of an oak near the
+top of the slope. Over these he threw a blanket. The maid came slowly
+up the hill, in response to his call, and with a weary little smile of
+thanks she sank upon the fragrant couch. She rested against the tree
+trunk, gazing through the nearer foliage at the rushing river.
+
+For the two days she had been like this,--silent, shy, with sad eyes.
+And Danton,--who could no more have avoided the company of such a maid
+than he could have left off eating or breathing or laughing,--Danton,
+for all his short Paris life (which should, Heaven knows, have given
+him a front with the maids), could do nothing but hang about, eager
+for a smile or a word, yet too young to know that he could better
+serve his case by leaving her with her thoughts, and with the
+boundless woods and the great lonely spaces of the river. Menard saw
+the comedy--as indeed, who of the party did not--and was amused. A few
+moments later he glanced again toward the oak. He was sharpening a
+knife, and could seem not to be observing. Danton was sitting a few
+yards from the maid, with the awkward air of a youth who doubts his
+welcome. She still looked out over the water. Menard saw that her face
+was white and drooping. He knew that she had not slept; for twice
+during the preceding night, as he lay in his blanket, he had heard
+from under the overturned canoe, where she lay, the low sound of her
+sobbing.
+
+Menard walked slowly down the slope, testing the knife-edge with his
+thumb, his short pipe between his teeth. He sheathed his knife,
+lowered his pipe, and called:--
+
+"Guerin." The two men, who were bringing wood to the fire, looked up.
+"Where has the Father gone?"
+
+Guerin pointed around the base of the hill. "He went to the woods,
+M'sieu."
+
+"With a bundle," added Perrot.
+
+Menard walked around the hill, and after a little searching found the
+priest, kneeling, in a clearing, before the portrait of Catharine
+Outasoren, which he had set against a tree. His brushes and paints
+were spread on the ground before him. He did not hear Menard
+approach.
+
+"Oh," said the captain, "you brought the picture!"
+
+The priest looked up over his shoulder, with a startled manner.
+
+"I myself have stripped down to the lightest necessaries," said
+Menard, with a significant glance at the portrait.
+
+The priest lowered his brush, and sat looking at the picture
+with troubled eyes. "I had no place for it," he said at last,
+hesitatingly.
+
+"They didn't take it at the College, eh?"
+
+Father Claude flushed.
+
+"They were very kind. They felt that perhaps it was not entirely
+completed, and that--"
+
+"You will leave it at Montreal, then, at the Mission?"
+
+"Yes,--I suppose so. Yes, I shall plan to leave it there."
+
+Menard leaned against a tree, and pressed the tobacco down in his
+pipe.
+
+"I have been doing some thinking in the last few minutes, Father. I've
+decided to make my first call on you for assistance."
+
+"Very well, Captain."
+
+"It is about the maid. Have you noticed?"
+
+"She seems of a sober mind."
+
+"Don't you see why? It is her father's losses, and this journey. She
+is taking it very hard. She is afraid, Father, all the time; and she
+neither sleeps nor eats."
+
+"It is naturally hard for such a child as she is to take this journey.
+She has had no experience,--she does not comprehend the easy customs
+and the hard travelling of the frontier. I think that in time--"
+
+Menard was puffing impatiently.
+
+"Father," he said, "do you remember when Major Gordeau was killed, and
+I was detailed to bring his wife and daughter down to Three Rivers? It
+was much like this. They fretted and could not sleep, and the coarse
+fare of the road was beneath their appetites. Do you remember? And
+when it came to taking the rapids, with the same days of hard work
+that lie before us now, they were too weak, and they sickened, the
+mother first, then the daughter. When I think of that, Father, of the
+last week of that journey, and of how I swore never again to take a
+woman in my care on the river, I--well, there is no use in going over
+it. If this goes on, we shall not get to Frontenac in time, that is
+all. And I cannot afford to take such a chance."
+
+The priest looked grave. The long struggle against the rapids from
+Montreal to La Gallette had tried the hardihood of more than one
+strong man.
+
+"It is probable, my son, that the sense of your responsibility makes
+you a little over-cautious. She is a strong enough child, I should
+say. Still, perhaps the food is not what she has been accustomed to. I
+have noticed that she eats little."
+
+"Perrot is too fond of grease," Menard said. "I must tell him to use
+less grease."
+
+"If she should be taken sick, we could leave her with someone at
+Montreal."
+
+"Leave her at Montreal!" exclaimed Menard. "When she breaks down, it
+will be in the rapids. And then I must either go on alone, or wait
+with you until she is strong enough to be carried. In any case it
+means confusion and delay. And I must not be delayed."
+
+"What have you in mind to do?"
+
+"We must find a way to brighten her spirits. It is homesickness that
+worries her, and sorrow for her father, and dread of what is before
+and around her. I'll warrant she has never been away from her home
+before. We must get her confidence,--devise ways to cheer her,
+brighten her."
+
+"I can reason with her, and--"
+
+"This is not the time for reasoning, Father. What we must do is to
+make her stop thinking, stop looking backward and forward. And there
+is Danton; he can help. He is of an age with her, and should succeed
+where you and I might fail."
+
+"He has not awaited the suggestion, Captain."
+
+"Yes, I know. But he must,--well, Father, it has all been said. The
+maid is on our hands, and must be got to Frontenac. That is all. And
+there is nothing for it but to rely on Danton to help."
+
+The priest looked at his brushes, and hesitated. "I am not certain,"
+he said, "she is very young. And Lieutenant Danton,--I have heard,
+while at Quebec,--"
+
+Menard laughed.
+
+"He is a boy, Father. These tales may be true enough. Why not? They
+would fit as well any idle lieutenant in Quebec, who is lucky
+enough to have an eye, and a pair of shoulders, and a bit of the
+King's gold in his purse. This maid is the daughter of a gentleman,
+Father; she is none of your Lower Town jades. And Danton may be young
+and foolish,--as may we all have been,--but he is a gentleman born."
+
+"Very well," replied the priest, looking with regret at the failing
+light, and beginning to gather his brushes. "I will counsel her, but I
+fear it will do little good. If the maid is sick at heart, and we
+attempt to guide her thoughts, we may but drive the trouble deeper in.
+It is the same with some of the Indian maidens, when they have left
+the tribe for the Mission. Now and again there comes a time, even with
+piety to strengthen them,--and this maid has little,--when the
+yearning seems to grow too strong to be cured. Sometimes they go back.
+One died. It was at Sault St. Francis in the year of the--"
+
+"Yes, yes," Menard broke in. "We have only one fact to remember; there
+must be no delay in carrying out the Governor's orders. We cannot
+change our plans because of this maid."
+
+"We must not let her understand, M'sieu."
+
+Menard had been standing, with a shoulder against the tree,
+alternately puffing at his pipe and lowering it, scowling meanwhile at
+the ground. Now he suddenly raised his head and chuckled.
+
+"It will be many a year since I have played the beau, Father. It may
+be that I have forgotten the role." He spread out his hands and looked
+at the twisted fingers. "But I can try, like a soldier. And there are
+three of us, Father Claude, there are three of us."
+
+He turned to go back to the camp, but the priest touched him.
+
+"My son,--perhaps, before you return, you would look again at my
+unworthy portrait. I--about the matter of the canoe--"
+
+"Oh," said Menard, "you've taken it out."
+
+"Yes; it seemed best, considering the danger that others might feel
+the same doubts which troubled you."
+
+"I wouldn't do that. The canoe was all right, once the direction were
+decided on."
+
+"Above all else, the true portrait should convey to the mind of the
+observer the impression that a single, an unmistakable purpose
+underlies the work. When one considers--"
+
+"Very true, Father, very true," said Menard abruptly, looking about at
+the beginning of the twilight. "And now we had better get back. The
+supper will be ready."
+
+Menard strode away toward the camp. Father Claude watched him for a
+time through the trees, then turned again to the picture. Finally he
+got together his materials, and carrying them in a fold of his gown,
+with the picture in his left hand, he followed Menard.
+
+The maid was leaning back against the tree, looking up at the sky,
+where the first red of the afterglow was spreading. She did not hear
+Menard; and he paused, a few yards away, to look at the clear
+whiteness of her skin and the full curve of her throat. Her figure and
+air, her habits of gesture and step, and carriage of the head, were
+those of the free-hearted maid of the seignory. They told of an
+outdoor life, of a good horse, and a light canoe, and the inbred love
+of trees and sky and running water. Here was none of the stiffness,
+the more than Parisian manner, of the maidens of Quebec. To stand
+there and look at her, unconscious as she was, pleased Menard.
+
+"Mademoiselle," he said, coming nearer, "will you join us at supper?"
+
+The maid looked at him with a slow blush (she was not yet accustomed
+to the right of these men to enter into the routine of her life).
+Menard reached to help her, but she rose easily.
+
+"Lieutenant Danton is not here?"
+
+"No, M'sieu, he walked away."
+
+They sat about a log. Danton had not strayed far, for he joined them
+shortly, wearing a sulky expression. Menard looked about the group.
+The maid was silent. Father Claude was beginning at once on the food
+before him. The twilight was growing deeper, and Guerin dragged a log
+to the fire, throwing it on the pile with a shower of sparks, and half
+a hundred shooting tongues of flame. The Captain looked again at
+Danton, and saw that the boy's glance shifted uneasily about the
+group. Altogether it was an unfortunate start for his plan. But it was
+clear that no other would break the ice, so he drew a long breath, and
+plunged doggedly into the story of his first fight on the St.
+Lawrence.
+
+It was a brave story of ambuscade and battle; and it was full of the
+dark of night and the red flash of muskets and the stealth and
+treachery of the Iroquois soul. When he reached the tale of the
+captured Mohawk, who sat against a tree with a ball in his lungs, to
+the last refusing the sacrament, and dying like a chief with the death
+song on his lips, Danton was leaning forward, breathless and eager,
+hanging on his words. The maid's eyes, too, were moist. Then they
+talked on, Danton asking boyish questions, and Father Claude starting
+over and again on a narrative of the wonderful conversion of the Huron
+drunkard, Heroukiki, who, in his zeal,--and here Menard always swept
+in with a new story, which left the priest adrift in the eddies of the
+conversation. At last, when they rose, and the dusk was settling over
+the trees, the maid was laughing with gentle good fellowship.
+
+While they were eating, the _voyageurs_ had brought the canoe a short
+way up the bank, resting it, bottom up, on large stones brought from
+the shore. Underneath was a soft cot of balsam; over the canoe were
+blankets, hanging on both sides to the ground. Then Mademoiselle said
+good-night, with a moment's lingering on the word, and a wistful note
+in her voice that brought perhaps more sympathy than had the sad eyes
+of the morning. For after all she was only a girl, and hers was a
+brave little heart.
+
+The three men lay on the slope with hardly a word, looking at the
+river, now shining like silver through the trees. This new turn in the
+life of the party was not as yet to be taken familiarly. Father Claude
+withdrew early to his meditations. Menard stretched out on his back,
+his hands behind his head, gazing lazily at the leaves overhead, now
+hanging motionless from the twigs.
+
+Danton was sitting up, looking about, and running the young reeds
+through his fingers.
+
+"Danton," Menard said, after a long silence, "I suppose you know that
+we have something of a problem on our hands."
+
+Danton looked over the river.
+
+"What have you thought about Mademoiselle?"
+
+"I don't understand."
+
+"Father Claude and I have been talking this evening about her. I have
+thought that she does not look any too strong for a hard journey of a
+hundred and more leagues."
+
+"She has little colour," said Danton, cautiously.
+
+"It seems to me, Danton, that you can help us."
+
+"How?"
+
+"What seems to you the cause of the trouble?"
+
+"With Mademoiselle? She takes little impression from the kindness of
+those about her."
+
+"Oh, come, Danton. You know better. Even a boy of your age should see
+deeper than that. You think she slights you; very likely she does.
+What of that? You are not here to be drawn into a boy-and-girl quarrel
+with a maid who chances to share our canoe. You are here as my aid, to
+make the shortest time possible between Quebec and Frontenac. If she
+were to fall sick, we should be delayed. Therefore she must not fall
+sick."
+
+Danton had plucked a weed, and now was pulling it to pieces, bit by
+bit.
+
+"What do you want me to do?"
+
+"Stop this moping, this hanging about. Take hold of the matter. Devise
+talks, diversions; fill her idle moments; I care not what you
+do,--within limits, my boy, within limits."
+
+"Oh," said Danton, "then you really want me to?"
+
+"Certainly. I am too old myself."
+
+Danton rose, and walked a few steps away and back.
+
+"But she will have none of me, Menard. It is, 'No, with thanks,' or,
+worse, a shake of the head. If I offer to help, if I try to talk, if
+I--oh, it is always the same. I am tired of it."
+
+Menard smiled in the dark.
+
+"Is that your reply to an order from your superior officer, Danton?"
+
+The boy stood silent for a moment, then he said, "I beg your pardon,
+Captain." And with a curious effort at stiffness he wandered off among
+the trees, and was soon out of Menard's sight.
+
+Menard walked slowly down to the fire, opened his pack, and spreading
+out his blanket, rolled himself in it with his feet close to the red
+embers. For a long time he lay awake. This episode took him back
+nearly a decade, to a time when he, like Danton, would have lost his
+poise at a glance from the nearest pair of eyes. That the maid should
+so interest him was in itself amusing. Had she been older or younger,
+had she been any but the timid, honest little woman that she was, he
+would have left her, without a second thought, in the care of the
+Commandant at Montreal, to be escorted through the rapids by some
+later party. But he had fixed his mind on getting her to Frontenac,
+and the question was settled. His last thought that night was of her
+quiet laughter and her friendly, hesitating "good-night."
+
+He was awakened in the half light before the sunrise by a step on the
+twigs. At a little distance through the trees was the maid, walking
+down toward the water. She slipped easily between the briers, holding
+her skirt close. From a spring, not a hundred yards up the hillside, a
+brook came tumbling to the river, picking its way under and over the
+stones and the fallen trees, and trickling over the bank with a low
+murmur. The maid stopped by a pool, and kneeling on a flat rock,
+dipped her hands.
+
+The others were asleep. A rod away lay Danton, a sprawling heap in his
+blanket. Menard rose, tossed his blanket upon his bundle, and walked
+slowly down toward the maid.
+
+"Mademoiselle, you rise with the birds."
+
+She looked around, and laughed gently. He saw that she had frankly
+accepted the first little change in their relations.
+
+"I like to be with the birds, M'sieu."
+
+Menard had no small talk. He was thinking of her evident lack of
+sleep.
+
+"It is the best hour for the river, Mademoiselle." The colours of the
+dawn were beginning to creep up beyond the eastern bank, sending a
+lance of red and gold into a low cloud bank, and a spread of soft
+crimson close after. "Perhaps you are fond of the fish?"
+
+The maid was kneeling to pick a cluster of yellow flower cups. She
+looked up and nodded, with a smile.
+
+"We fished at home, M'sieu."
+
+"We will go," said Menard, abruptly. "I will bring down the canoe."
+
+He threw the blankets to one side, and stooping under the long canoe,
+carried it on his shoulders to the water. A line and hook were in his
+bundle; the bait was ready at a turn of the grass and weeds.
+
+"We are two adventurers," he said lightly, as he tossed the line into
+the canoe, and held out one of the paddles. "You should do your share
+of the morning's work, Mademoiselle."
+
+She laughed again, and took the paddle. They pushed off; the maid
+kneeling at the bow, Menard in the stern. He guided the canoe against
+the current. The water lay flat under the still air, reflecting the
+gloomy trees on the banks, and the deepening colours of the sky. He
+fell into a lazy, swinging stroke, watching the maid. Her arms and
+shoulders moved easily, with the grace of one who had tumbled about a
+canoe from early childhood.
+
+"Ready, Mademoiselle?" He was heading for a deep pool near a line of
+rushes. The maid, laying down her paddle, reached back for the line,
+and put on the bait with her own fingers.
+
+Menard held the canoe steady against the current, which was there but
+a slow movement, while she lowered the hook over the bow. They sat
+without a word for some minutes. Once he spoke, in a bantering voice,
+and she motioned to him to be quiet. Her brows were drawn down close
+together.
+
+It was but a short time before she felt a jerk at the line. Her arms
+straightened out, and she pressed her lips tightly together. "Quick!"
+she said. "Go ahead!"
+
+"Can you hold it?" he asked, as he dipped his paddle.
+
+She nodded. "I wish the line were longer. It will be hard to give him
+any room." She wound the cord around her wrist. "Will the line hold,
+M'sieu?"
+
+"I think so. See if you can pull in."
+
+She leaned back, and pulled steadily, then shook her head. "Not very
+much. Perhaps, if you can get into the shallow water--"
+
+Menard slowly worked the canoe through an opening in the rushes. There
+was a thrashing about and plunging not two rods away. Once the fish
+leaped clear of the water in a curve of clashing silver.
+
+"It's a salmon," he said. "A small one."
+
+The maid held hard, but the colour had gone from her face. The canoe
+drew nearer to the shore.
+
+"Hold fast," said Menard. He gave a last sweep of the paddle, and
+crept forward to the bow. Kneeling behind the maid, he reached over
+her shoulder, and took the line below her hand.
+
+"Careful, M'sieu; it may break."
+
+"We must risk it." He pulled slowly in until the fish was close under
+the gunwale. "Now can you hold?"
+
+"Yes." She shook a straying lock of hair from her eyes, and took
+another turn of the cord around her wrist.
+
+"Steady," he said. He drew his knife, leaned over the gunwale, and
+stabbed at the fighting fish until his blade sank in just below the
+gills, and he could lift it aboard.
+
+The maid laughed nervously, and rested her hands upon the two
+gunwales. Her breath was gone, and there was a red mark around her
+wrist where the cord had been. The canoe had drifted into the rushes,
+and Menard went back to his paddle, and worked out again into the
+channel.
+
+"And now, Mademoiselle," he said, "we shall have a breakfast of our
+own. You need not paddle. I will take her down."
+
+Her breath was coming back. She laughed, and sat comfortably in the
+bow, facing Menard, and letting her eyes follow the steady swing and
+catch of his paddle. When they reached the camp, the _voyageurs_ were
+astir, but Danton and the priest still slept. The first red glare of
+the sun was levelled at them over the eastern trees.
+
+Menard made a fire under an arch of flat stones, and trimming a strip
+of oak wood with his hatchet, he laid the cleaned fish upon it and
+kept it on the fire until it was brown and crisp. The maid sat by, her
+eyes alert and her cheeks flushed.
+
+Danton was awake before the fish was cooked, and he stood about with a
+pretence of not observing them. The maid was fairly aroused. She drew
+him into the talk, and laughed and bantered with the two men as
+prettily as they could have wished from a Quebec belle.
+
+All during the morning Danton was silent. At noon, when the halt was
+made for the midday lunch, he was still puzzling over the apparent
+understanding between Mademoiselle and the Captain. Before the journey
+was taken up, he stood for a moment near Menard, on the river bank.
+
+"Captain," he said, "you asked me last night to--"
+
+"Well?"
+
+"It may be that I have misunderstood you. Of course, if Mademoiselle--if
+you--" He caught himself.
+
+Menard smiled; then he read the earnestness beneath the boy's
+confusion, and sobered.
+
+"Mademoiselle and I went fishing, Danton. Result,--Mademoiselle eats
+her first meal. If you can do as much you shall have my thanks. And
+now remember that you are a lieutenant in the King's service."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV.
+
+THE LONG ARROW.
+
+
+Menard allowed a halt of but a few hours at Three Rivers. The
+settlement held little of interest, for all the resident troops and
+most of the farmers and _engages_ had gone up the river to join the
+army which was assembling at Montreal. The close of the first week out
+of Quebec saw the party well on the second half of the journey to
+Montreal. As they went on, Menard's thoughts were drawn more deeply
+into the work that lay ahead, and in spite of his efforts at
+lightness, the work of keeping up the maid's spirits fell mostly to
+Danton (though Father Claude did what he could). As matters gradually
+became adjusted, Danton's cheery, hearty manner began to tell; and now
+that there was little choice of company, the maid turned to him for
+her diversion.
+
+On the morning of the second day after leaving Three Rivers, the two
+_voyageurs_ were carrying the canoe to the water when Guerin slipped
+on a wet log, throwing the canoe to the ground, and tearing a wide
+rent in the bark. Menard was impatient at this carelessness. The
+knowledge that the Three Rivers detachment had already gone on to
+Montreal had decided him to move more rapidly, and he had given orders
+that they should start each day in the first light of the dawn. This
+was a chill morning. A low, heavy fog lay on the river, thinning, at a
+yard above the water, into a light mist which veiled what colour may
+have been in the east.
+
+While Guerin and Perrot were patching the canoe under Menard's eye,
+Danton found some dry logs under the brush, and built up the dying
+fire, which was in a rocky hollow, not visible from the river. Then he
+and the maid sat on the rocks above it, where they could get the
+warmth, and yet could see the river. Menard and his men, though only a
+few rods away, were but blurred forms as they moved about the canoe,
+gumming the new seams.
+
+The maid, save for an occasional heavy hour in the late evenings, had
+settled into a cheerful frame of mind. The novelty, and the many
+exciting moments of the journey, as well as the kindness of the three
+men, kept her thoughts occupied. Danton, once he had shaken off his
+sulky fits, was good company. They sat side by side on the rock,
+looking down at the struggling fire, or at the figures moving about
+the canoe, or out into the white mystery of the river, talking easily
+in low tones of themselves and their lives and hopes.
+
+The mist, instead of rising, seemed to settle closer to the water, as
+the broad daylight came across the upper air. The maid and Danton fell
+into silence as the picture brightened. Danton was less sensitive than
+she to the whims of nature, and tiring of the scene, he was gazing
+down into the fire when the maid, without a word, touched his arm. He
+looked up at her; then, seeing that her eyes were fixed on the river,
+followed her gaze. Not more than a score of yards from the shore,
+moving silently through the mist, were the heads of three Indians.
+Their profiles stood out clearly against the white background; their
+shoulders seemed to dissolve into the fog. They passed slowly on up
+the stream, looking straight ahead, without a twitch of the eyelids,
+like a vision from the happy hunting-ground.
+
+Danton slipped down from the rock, and stepped lightly to Menard,
+pointing out the three heads just as they were fading into the
+whiteness about them. Menard motioned to Guerin and Perrot to get the
+newly patched canoe into the water, took three muskets, and in a
+moment pushed off, leaving Danton with the maid and the priest, who
+had retired a short distance for his morning prayers. For a minute the
+heads of the three white men were in sight above the fog, then they
+too were swallowed up.
+
+"I wonder what Menard thinks about them?" said Danton, going back
+toward the maid.
+
+She was still looking at the mist, and did not hear him, so he took a
+seat at the foot of the rock and rubbed the hammer of his musket,
+which had been rusted by the damp. After a time the maid looked toward
+him.
+
+"What does it mean?" she asked.
+
+"I don't know," Danton replied. "They were going up-stream in a canoe,
+I suppose. Probably he thinks they can give us some information."
+
+In a few minutes, during which the mist was clearing under the rays of
+the sun, the two canoes together came around a wooded point and
+beached. The Indians walked silently to the fire. They appeared not to
+see Danton and the maid. Menard paused to look over his canoe. It was
+leaking badly, and before joining the group at the fire, he set the
+canoemen at work making a new patch.
+
+[Illustration: "The Indians walked silently to the fire."]
+
+"Danton," he said, in a low tone, when he reached the fire, "find the
+Father."
+
+Danton hurried away, and Menard turned to the largest of the three
+Indians, who wore the brightest blanket, and had a peculiar wampum
+collar, decorated in mosaic-like beadwork.
+
+"You are travellers, like ourselves," he said, in the Iroquois tongue.
+"We cannot let you pass without a word of greeting. I see that you are
+of the Onondagas, my brothers. It may be that you are from the Mission
+at the Sault St. Francis Xavier?"
+
+The Indian bowed. "We go from Three Rivers to Montreal."
+
+"I, too, am taking my party to Montreal." Menard thought it wise to
+withhold the further facts of his journey. "Have you brothers at Three
+Rivers?"
+
+"No," replied the Indian. "We have been sent with a paper from the
+Superior at Sault St. Francis Xavier to the good fathers at Three
+Rivers. Now we are on our return to the Mission."
+
+"Have my brothers eaten?" Menard motioned toward the fire. "It is
+still early in the day."
+
+The three bowed. "We are travelling fast," said the spokesman, "for
+the Superior awaits our return. We ate before the light. It will soon
+be time for us to go on our journey."
+
+Menard saw Father Claude and Danton approaching, and waited for them.
+The face of the large Indian seemed like some other face that had had
+a place in his memory. It was not unlikely that he had known this
+warrior during his captivity, when half a thousand braves had been to
+him as brothers. The Indian was apparently of middle age, and had
+lines of dignity and authority in his face that made it hard to accept
+him as a subdued resident at the Mission. But Menard knew that no sign
+of doubt or suspicion must appear in his face, so he waited for the
+priest. The Indians sat with their knees drawn up and their blankets
+wrapped about them, looking stolidly at the fire.
+
+Father Claude came quietly into the group, and with a smile extended
+his hand to the smallest of the three, an older man, with a wrinkled
+face. "I did not look for you here, Teganouan. Have you gone back to
+the Mission?"
+
+Teganouan returned the smile, and bowed.
+
+"My brother has told the white man of our errand?"
+
+"Yes," said Menard, "they have been sent to Three Rivers by the
+Superior, and are now returning. I have told them that we, too, are
+going to Montreal."
+
+The priest took the hint. "We shall meet you and your brothers again,
+Teganouan. They are newcomers at the Mission, I believe. They had not
+come when I left."
+
+"No, Father. They have but last week become Christians. The Long
+Arrow" (inclining his head toward the large Indian) "has lost a son,
+and through his suffering was led to take the faith."
+
+The Long Arrow, who had seemed to lose interest in the conversation as
+soon as he had finished speaking, here rose.
+
+"My brothers and the good Father will give us their blessing? The end
+of the journey is yet three days away. I had hoped that we might be
+permitted to accept the protection of the son of Onontio,"--he looked
+at Menard,--"but I see that his canoe will not be ready for the
+journey before the sun is high." He looked gravely from Menard to the
+priest, then walked to the shore, followed by the others. They pushed
+off, and shortly disappeared around the point of land.
+
+Menard gave them no attention, but as soon as they were gone from
+sight, he turned to the priest.
+
+"Well, Father, what do you make of that?"
+
+Father Claude shook his head.
+
+"Nothing, as yet, M'sieu. Do you know who the large man is?"
+
+"No; but I seem to remember him. And what is more to the point, he
+certainly remembers me."
+
+"Are you sure?"
+
+"He recognized me on the river. He came back with me so willingly
+because he wanted to know more about us. That was plain. It would be
+well, Father, to enquire at the Mission. We should know more of them
+and their errand at Three Rivers."
+
+Menard called Danton, and walked with him a little way into the wood.
+
+"Danton," he said, "you are going through this journey with us, and I
+intend that you shall know about such matters as this meeting with the
+Onondagas."
+
+"Oh, they were Onondagas?"
+
+"Yes. They claim to be Mission Indians, but neither the Father nor I
+altogether believe them." In a few sentences Menard outlined the
+conversation. "Now, Danton, this may or may not be an important
+incident. I want you to know the necessity for keeping our own counsel
+in all such matters, dropping no careless words, and letting no
+emotions show. I wish you would make a point of learning the Iroquois
+language. Father Claude will help you. You are to act as my right-hand
+man, and you may as well begin now to learn to draw your own
+conclusions from an Indian's words."
+
+Danton took eagerly to the lessons with Father Claude, for they seemed
+another definite step toward the excitement that surely, to his mind,
+lay in wait ahead. The studying began on that afternoon, while they
+were toiling up against the stream.
+
+In the evening, when the dusk was coming down, and the little camp was
+ready for the night, Menard came up from the heap of stores, where the
+_voyageurs_ had already stretched out, and found the maid sitting
+alone by the fire. Danton, in his rush of interest in the new study,
+had drawn Father Claude aside for another lesson.
+
+"Mademoiselle is lonely?" asked Menard, sitting beside her.
+
+"No, no, M'sieu. I have too many thoughts for that."
+
+"What interesting thoughts they must be."
+
+"They are, M'sieu. They are all about the Indians this morning. Tell
+me, M'sieu,--they called you Onontio. What does it mean?"
+
+"They called me the son of Onontio, because of my uniform. Onontio,
+the Great Mountain, is their name for the Governor; and the Governor's
+soldiers are to them his sons."
+
+"They speak a strange language. It is not the same as that of the
+Ottawas, who once worked for my father."
+
+"Did you know their tongue?"
+
+"A few words, and some of the signs. This,"--raising her hand, with
+the first finger extended, and slowly moving her arm in a half circle
+from horizon to horizon,--"this meant a sun,--one day."
+
+Menard looked at her for a moment in silence. He enjoyed her
+enthusiasm.
+
+"Why don't you learn Iroquois? You would enjoy it. It is a beautiful
+tongue,--the language of metaphor and poetry."
+
+"I should like to," she replied, looking with a faint smile at Danton
+and the priest, who were sitting under a beech tree, mumbling in low
+tones.
+
+"You shall join the class, Mademoiselle. You shall begin to-morrow. It
+was thoughtless of Danton to take the Father's instruction to himself
+alone."
+
+"And then, M'sieu, I will know what the Indians say when they sit up
+stiffly in their blankets, and talk down in their throats. They have
+such dignity. It is hard not to believe them when they look straight
+at one."
+
+"Don't you believe them?"
+
+"The three this morning,--they did not tell the truth."
+
+"Didn't they?"
+
+"Why, I understood that you did not believe them."
+
+"And where did Mademoiselle learn that? Did she follow the conversation?"
+
+"No; but Lieutenant Danton--"
+
+"He told you?"
+
+She nodded. Menard frowned.
+
+"He shouldn't have done that."
+
+The maid looked surprised at his remark, and the smile left her face.
+"Of course, M'sieu," she said, a little stiffly, "whatever is not
+meant for my ears--"
+
+Menard was still frowning, and he failed to notice her change in
+manner. He abruptly gave the conversation a new turn, but seeing after
+a short time that the maid had lost interest in his sallies, he rose,
+and called to the priest.
+
+"Father, you are to have a new pupil. Mademoiselle also will study the
+language of the Iroquois. If you are quick enough with your pupils, we
+shall soon be able to hold a conversation each night about the fire.
+Perhaps, if you would forego your exclusive air, Mademoiselle would
+begin at once."
+
+Danton, without waiting for the priest to start, came hurriedly over
+and sat by the maid.
+
+"You must pardon me," he said, "I did not think,--I did not know that
+you would be interested. It is so dry."
+
+The maid smiled at the fire.
+
+"You did not ask," she replied, "and I could not offer myself to the
+class."
+
+"It will be splendid," said Danton. "We shall learn the language of
+the trees and the grass and the rivers and the birds. And the message
+of the wampum belt, too, we shall know. You see,"--looking up at
+Menard,--"already I am catching the meanings."
+
+Menard smiled, and then went down the bank, leaving the three to bend
+their heads together over the mysteries of the Iroquois rules of
+gender, written out by Father Claude on a strip of bark. It was nearly
+an hour later, after the maid had crept to her couch beneath the
+canoe, and Perrot and Guerin had sprawled upon the bales and were
+snoring in rival keys, that Danton came lightly down the slope humming
+a drinking song. He saw Menard, and dropped to the ground beside him,
+with a low laugh.
+
+"Mademoiselle will lead my wits a chase, Menard. Already she is deep
+in the spirit of the new work."
+
+"Be careful, my boy, that she leads no more than your wits a chase."
+
+Danton laughed again.
+
+"I don't believe there is great danger. What a voice she has! I did
+not know it at first, when she was frightened and spoke only in the
+lower tones. Now when she speaks or laughs it is like--"
+
+"Like what?"
+
+"There is no fit simile in our tongue, light as it is. It may be that
+in the Iroquois I shall find the words. It should be something about
+the singing brooks or the voice of the leaves at night."
+
+The lad was in such buoyant spirits that Menard had to harden himself
+for the rebuke which he must give. With the Indian tribes Menard had
+the tact, the control of a situation, that would have graced a council
+of great chiefs; but in matters of discipline, the blunter faculties
+and language of the white men seemed to give his wit no play. Now, as
+nearly always, he spoke abruptly.
+
+"Have you forgotten our talk of this morning, Danton?"
+
+"No," replied the boy, looking up in surprise.
+
+The night had none of the dampness that had left a white veil over the
+morning just gone. The moon was half hidden behind the western trees.
+The sky, for all the dark, was blue and deep, set with thousands of
+stars, each looking down at its mate in the shining water.
+
+"I spoke of the importance of keeping our own counsel."
+
+Danton began to feel what was coming. He looked down at the ground
+without replying.
+
+"To-night Mademoiselle has repeated a part of our conversation."
+
+"Mademoiselle,--why, she is one of our party. She knows about us,--who
+we are, what we are going for--"
+
+"Then you have told her, Danton?"
+
+"How could she help knowing? We are taking her to Frontenac."
+
+"Father Claude has not told her why we go to Frontenac--nor have I."
+
+"But Major Provost is her friend--"
+
+"He would never have told her."
+
+"But she seemed to know about it."
+
+"Then you have talked it over with her?"
+
+"Why, no,--that is, in speaking of our journey we said something of
+the meaning of the expedition. It could hardly be expected that we,--I
+fail to see, Captain, what it is you are accusing me of."
+
+"You have not been accused yet, Danton. Let me ask you a question. Why
+did you enter the King's army?"
+
+Danton hesitated, and started once or twice to frame answer, but made
+no reply.
+
+"Did you wish a gay uniform, to please the maids, to--"
+
+"You are unfair, M'sieu."
+
+"No, I wish to know. We will say, if you like, that you have hoped to
+be a soldier,--a soldier of whom the King may one day have cause to be
+proud."
+
+Danton flushed, and bowed his head.
+
+"I offered you the chance to go on this mission, Danton, because I
+believed in you. I believed that you had the making of a soldier. This
+is not a child's errand, this of ours. It is the work of strong men.
+This morning I told you of my talk with the three Onondagas because I
+have planned to take you into my confidence, and to give you the
+chance to make a name for yourself. I made a point of the importance
+of keeping such things to yourself."
+
+"But Mademoiselle, M'sieu, she is different--"
+
+"Look at the facts, Danton. I told you this morning: within twelve
+hours you have passed on your information. How do I know that you
+would not have let it slip to others if you had had the chance? You
+forget that Mademoiselle is a woman, and the first and last duty of a
+soldier is to tell no secrets to a woman."
+
+"You speak wrongly of Mademoiselle. It is cowardly to talk thus."
+
+Menard paused to get control of his temper.
+
+"Cowardly, Danton? Is that the word you apply to your commander?"
+
+"Your pardon, M'sieu! A thousand pardons! It escaped me--"
+
+"We will pass it by. I want you to understand this matter. Mademoiselle
+will spend a night in Montreal. We shall leave her with other women. A
+stray word, which to her might mean nothing, might be enough to give
+the wrong persons a hint of the meaning of our journey. A moment's
+nervousness might slip the bridle from her tongue. All New France is
+not so loyal that we can afford to drop a chance secret here and
+there. As to this maid, she is only a child, and by giving her our
+secrets, you are forcing her to bear a burden which we should bear
+alone. These Indians this morning were spies, I am inclined to
+believe, scouting along the river for information of the coming
+campaign. The only way that we can feel secure is by letting no word
+escape our lips, no matter how trivial. I tell you this, not so much
+for this occasion as for a suggestion for the future."
+
+"Very well, M'sieu. You will please accept my complete apologies."
+
+"I shall have to add, Danton, that if any further mistake of this kind
+occurs I shall be forced to dismiss you from my service. Now that I
+have said this, I want you to understand that I don't expect it to
+happen. I have believed in you, Danton, and I stand ready to be a
+friend to you."
+
+Menard held out his hand. Danton clasped it nervously, mumbling a
+second apology. For a few moments longer they sat there, Menard trying
+to set Danton at ease, but the boy was flushed, and he spoke only half
+coherently. He soon excused himself and wandered off among the trees
+and the thick bushes.
+
+During the next day Danton was in one of his sullen moods. He worked
+feverishly, and, with the maid, kept Father Claude occupied for the
+greater part of the time, as they paddled on, with conversation, and
+with discussion of the Iroquois words. The maid felt the change from
+the easy relations in the party, and seemed a little depressed, but
+she threw herself into the studying. Often during the day she would
+take up a paddle, and join in the stroke. At first Menard protested,
+but she laughed, and said that it was a "rest" after sitting so long.
+
+They were delayed on the following day by a second accident to the
+canoe, so that they were a full day late in reaching Montreal. They
+moved slowly up the channel, past the islands and the green banks with
+their little log-houses or, occasionally, larger dwellings built after
+the French manner. St. Helen's Island, nearly opposite the city, had a
+straggling cluster of hastily built bark houses, and a larger group of
+tents where the regulars were encamped, awaiting the arrival of
+Governor Denonville with the troops from Quebec.
+
+Menard stopped at the island, guiding the canoe to the bank where a
+long row of canoes and bateaux lay close to the water.
+
+"You might get out and walk around," he said to the others. "I shall
+be gone only a few moments."
+
+Father Claude sat on the bank, lost in meditation. Danton and the maid
+walked together slowly up and down, beyond earshot from the priest.
+Since Menard's rebuke, both the lad and the maid had shown a slight
+trace of resentment. It did not come out in their conversation, but
+rather in their silences, and in the occasions which they took to sit
+and walk apart from the others. It was as if a certain common ground
+of interest had come to them. The maid, for all her shyness and even
+temper, was not accustomed to such cool authority as Menard was
+developing. The priest was keeping an eye on the fast-growing
+acquaintanceship, and already had it vaguely in mind to call it to the
+attention of Menard, who was getting too deeply into the spirit and
+the details of his work to give much heed.
+
+Menard was soon back.
+
+"Push off," he said. "The Major is not here. We shall have to look for
+him in the city."
+
+They headed across the stream. The city lay before them, on its gentle
+slope, with the mountain rising behind like an untiring sentry. It was
+early in the afternoon, and on the river were many canoes and small
+boats, filled with soldiers, friendly Indians, or _voyageurs_, moving
+back and forth between the island and the city. They passed close to
+many of the bateaux, heaped high with provision and ammunition bales,
+and more than once the lounging soldiers rose and saluted Menard.
+
+At the city wharf he turned to Danton.
+
+"We shall have to get a larger canoe, Danton, and a stronger. Will you
+see to it, please? We shall have two more in our party from now on.
+Make sure that the canoe is in the best of condition. Also I wish you
+would see to getting the rope and the other things we may need in
+working through the rapids. Then spend your time as you like. We shall
+start early in the morning."
+
+Menard and Father Claude together went with the maid to the Superior,
+who arranged for her to pass the night with the sisters. Then Menard
+left the priest to make his final arrangements at the Mission, and
+went himself to see the Commandant, to whom he outlined the bare facts
+of his journey to Frontenac.
+
+"The thing that most concerns you," he said finally, "is a meeting I
+had a few days ago with three Indians down the river. One called
+himself the Long Arrow, and another was Teganouan, who, Father de
+Casson tells me, recently left the Mission at the Sault St. Francis
+Xavier. They claim to be Mission Indians. It will be well to watch
+out for them, and to have an eye on the Richelieu, and the other
+routes, to make sure that they don't slip away to the south with
+information."
+
+"Very well," replied the Commandant. "I imagine that we can stop them.
+Do you feel safe about taking this maid up the river just now?"
+
+"Oh, yes. Our men are scattered along the route, are they not?" Menard
+asked.
+
+"Quite a number are out establishing Champigny's transport system."
+
+"I don't look for any trouble. But I should like authority for one or
+two extra men."
+
+"Take anything you wish, Menard. I will get word over to the island at
+once, giving you all the authority you need."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V.
+
+DANTON BREAKS OUT.
+
+
+When Menard reached the wharf, early on the following morning, he
+found Father Claude waiting for him. The new canoe lay on the wharf,
+and beside it was a heap of stores. Perrot and the two new _engages_
+sat on the edge of the wharf. The sun had just risen over the trees on
+St. Helen's Island, and the air was clear and cool.
+
+"Well, Perrot," said Menard, as he unslung his musket and horn, "is
+everything ready?"
+
+"Everything, M'sieu."
+
+"Where is Guerin?"
+
+"I have not seen him, M'sieu."
+
+Menard turned to the priest.
+
+"Good-morning, Father. You are on time, I see; and that is more than
+we can say for Danton. Where is the boy?"
+
+"He has gone for Mademoiselle St. Denis, Captain. He was here before
+the sunrise, checking up the stores."
+
+"Learning to work, is he? That is a good sign. And how about yourself?
+Did you pick up anything yesterday?"
+
+"Yes," replied the priest. "I enquired at the Mission about Teganouan
+and his companions."
+
+"Well?"
+
+"Nothing is known of them. Teganouan had been one of the worst
+drunkards among the Onondagas, and his conversion, a year ago, was
+thought to be one of our greatest victories for the faith. His
+penances were among the most complete and purging ever--"
+
+"And the others?"
+
+"Just before I left the Mission for Quebec, Teganouan went on an
+errand to the city and fell among some of our fellow-countrymen who
+were having a drinking bout. For a few days after that he wavered, and
+fell again. Once afterward he was seen in company with two low
+fellows, _coureurs de bois_, who have since been confined under
+suspicion of communicating with the enemy."
+
+"He has returned to the Mission, then?"
+
+"No, he disappeared some time ago. They do not know the Long Arrow. I
+described him to Brother de Lamberville--"
+
+"Oh, he is here now?"
+
+"Yes. It seems, further, that all the other workers among the Iroquois
+have had word and are returning. That much of my labour is removed."
+
+"How do they get this word?" said Menard, impatiently. "That is the
+old question. It is enough to make one wonder if there are any secrets
+kept from the enemy's country."
+
+"No one seems to know, M'sieu. The Superior told me last night that
+they had not been sent for, so it would seem that the information must
+have reached them through the Indians."
+
+"The folly of these new governors!" Menard strode back and forth. "Oh,
+it makes one sigh for old Frontenac. He never walked blindfolded into
+such a trap as this. But go on. You were speaking of Father de
+Lamberville."
+
+"It was only that I described the Long Arrow to Brother de Lamberville.
+He seemed to remember such a wampum collar as the Long Arrow wore. He
+could not recall exactly."
+
+"Then we may as well forget the incident. It seems that we are to know
+nothing of it. Here is Danton."
+
+The lieutenant and the maid were walking rapidly down to the wharf.
+Mademoiselle was in a gay mood after her few hours of enjoyment among
+the comforts of a city.
+
+"Good-morning," she called, waving her hand.
+
+"Good-morning," said Menard, shortly. He did not look a second time,
+to see her smile fade, for Guerin had not appeared, and he was rapidly
+losing patience. He walked up and down the wharf for a few moments,
+while Danton found a seat for the maid and the two talked together.
+
+"Perrot," he said, "do you know where Guerin was last evening?"
+
+"Yes, M'sieu. He was at the inn."
+
+"What was he doing? Drinking?"
+
+"A little, M'sieu."
+
+"Go up there, on the run. If you don't find him there, come right
+back, for we can't wait much longer for anyone."
+
+Perrot ran up the street and disappeared. In a few moments he came in
+sight, striding down between the row of houses, holding Guerin firmly
+by one arm. The young fellow was hanging back, and stumbling in limp
+fashion. He was evidently drunk. Danton, who had joined Menard when
+the two men appeared, said, "Heavens, he must have started early!"
+
+Some distance behind Perrot and Guerin came a ragged crowd of
+woodsmen, singing, jeering, and shouting, and bearing broad traces of
+a sleepless night.
+
+Menard stood waiting with a look of disgust. When they came upon the
+wharf Guerin laughed, and tried to get out a flippant apology for his
+tardiness; but Menard seized him before the words were off his lips,
+and dragging him across the wharf threw him into the water. Then he
+turned to Perrot, and said, "Pull him out."
+
+The two new men stood uneasily near, with startled faces. Behind them
+the maid was sitting, a frightened look in her eyes. Danton had
+risen.
+
+"Clear away from here!" Menard called to the drunken rabble, who had
+collected a few rods away, and were now hesitating between laughter
+and fright. They stood looking at each other and at Menard, then they
+slunk away.
+
+In all an hour had gone before they were ready to start. Guerin was
+weak and shivering from his plunge, but Menard ordered him into the
+canoe. The incident drew a cloud over the maid's spirits, and
+altogether depressed the party, so that not until afternoon did they
+get into conversation. By that time they were past the Lachine Rapids
+and the Sault St. Louis, where the men made a portage, and Danton led
+the maid along the bank through the tangled brush and briers. When at
+last they were ready to push on across Lake St. Louis the maid's skirt
+was torn in a dozen places, and a thorn had got into her hand, which
+Danton carefully removed with the point of his knife, wincing and
+flushing with her at each twinge of pain. During the rest of the day,
+they had an Iroquois lesson, and by the end of the afternoon when the
+sun was low, and Menard headed for the shore of Isle Perrot, the maid
+was bright again, laughing over Danton's blunders in the new
+language.
+
+They spent the next day on the island, for what with wind and rain
+the lake was impassable for their canoe. The men built a hut of brush
+and bark which sheltered the party from the driving rain. Menard's
+mood lightened at the prospect of a rest, and he started a long
+conversation in Iroquois which soon had even Father Claude laughing
+in his silent way. The rain lessened in the afternoon, but the wind
+was still running high. Menard and the _engages_ went out early in
+the afternoon and repacked all the supplies, in order that the
+weight might be distributed more evenly in the canoe. With this and
+other work he was occupied until late in the afternoon. Father Claude
+took the occasion for a solitary walk, and for meditation. When Menard
+entered the hut he found the maid sitting with her head resting
+against one of the supporting trees. She wore a disturbed, unsettled
+expression. Danton evidently had been sitting or standing near her,
+for when Menard entered, stooping, he was moving across the hut in a
+hesitating, conscious manner. The Captain looked at them curiously.
+
+"I'm afraid we'll have to take away a part of your house to pay for
+your supper," he said. "Everything is wet outside that might do for
+firewood. Lend a hand, Danton." He gathered logs and sticks from the
+floor and walls, and carried them out. Danton, after a quick look
+toward the maid (which, of course, Menard saw), did the same.
+
+The Captain was the first to reenter the hut. The maid had not moved,
+and her eyes were puzzled and wearied, but she tried to smile.
+
+"Has it stopped raining?" she asked.
+
+Menard gave her an amused glance, and pointed to a sparkling beam of
+sunlight that came slanting in through an opening in the wall, and
+buried itself in a little pool of light on the trampled ground. She
+looked at it, flushed, and turned her eyes away. He stood for a
+moment, half minded to ask the question that was on his tongue, but
+finally held it back. In a moment Danton came back, looking
+suspiciously at each of them as he stooped to gather another armful of
+wood.
+
+Menard was thoughtful during the evening meal. Afterward he slipped
+his arm through Father Claude's, and led him for a short walk, giving
+him an account of the incident. "I didn't say anything at the time,"
+he concluded, "partly because I thought I might be mistaken, and
+partly because it would have been the worst thing I could do. I begin
+to see--I should have foreseen it before I spoke to him about the
+girl--that we have trouble ahead, Father, with these precious
+children. I confess I don't know just what to do about it. We must
+think it over. Anyway, you had better talk to her. She would tell you
+what she wouldn't tell me. If he's annoying her, we must know it."
+
+Father Claude was troubled.
+
+"The maid is in our care," he said, "and also in that of Lieutenant
+Danton. It would seem that he--"
+
+"There's no use in expecting him to take any responsibility, Father."
+
+"Yes, I suppose you are right. He is a child."
+
+"Will you go to the maid, Father, and get straight at the truth? You
+see that I cannot meddle with her thoughts without danger of being
+misinterpreted. It is you who must be her adviser."
+
+The priest acquiesced, and they returned to the camp, to find the maid
+still sitting alone, with a troubled face, and Danton puttering about
+the fire with a show of keeping himself occupied. They ate in silence,
+in spite of Menard's efforts to arouse them. After the meal they hung
+about, each hesitating to wander away, and yet seeing no pleasure in
+gathering about the fire. Menard saw that Father Claude had it in mind
+to speak to the maid, so he got Danton away on a pretext of looking
+over the stores. But he said nothing of the episode that was in all
+their minds, preferring to await the priest's report.
+
+After the maid had gone to her couch beneath the canoe, and Danton had
+wandered into the wilderness that was all about them, Father Claude
+joined Menard at the fire.
+
+"Well, Father, what word?"
+
+"Softly, M'sieu. It is not likely that she sleeps as yet."
+
+"Well?"
+
+"I have talked long with her, but she is of a stubborn mind."
+
+"How is that?"
+
+"She was angry at first. She spoke hastily, and asked me in short
+terms to leave her in solitude. And then, after a time, when she began
+to see that it was her welfare and our duty which I had in mind, and
+not an idle curiosity, she was moved."
+
+"Did she speak then?"
+
+"No, M'sieu, she wept, and insisted that there was no trouble on her
+mind,--it was merely the thought of her home and her father that had
+cast her down."
+
+"And so she has pride," mused Menard. "Could you gather any new
+opinions, Father? Do you think that they may already have come to some
+understanding?"
+
+"I hardly think so, M'sieu. But may I suggest that it would be well to
+be firm with Lieutenant Danton? He is young, and the maid is in our
+trust,"
+
+"True, Father. I will account for him."
+
+There seemed to be nothing further to do at the moment, so the priest
+went to his blanket, and Menard drew a bundle under his head and went
+to sleep, after a glance about the camp to see that the sentry was on
+watch. Now that Montreal lay behind, and the unsettled forest before,
+with only a thin line of Frenchmen stretched along the river between
+them and Fort Frontenac, he had divided the night into watches, and
+each of the four _engages_ stood his turn.
+
+The following day was all but half gone before the wind had dropped to
+a rate that made the passage of the lake advisable. Menard ordered the
+noon meal for an hour earlier than usual, and shortly afterward they
+set out across the upper end of Lake St. Louis to the foot of the
+cascades. Before the last bundle had been carried up the portage to
+Buisson Pointe, the dusk was settling over the woods across the river,
+and over the rising ground on Isle Perrot at the mouth of the Ottawa.
+
+During the next day they passed on up the stream to the Coteau des
+Cedres. Menard and Father Claude were both accustomed to take the
+rapid without carrying, or even unloading, but Danton looked at the
+swirling water with doubt in his eyes. When the maid, leaning back in
+the canoe while the men halted at the bank to make fast for the
+passage, saw the torrent that tumbled and pitched merrily down toward
+them, she laughed. To hold a sober mood for long was not in her
+buoyant nature, and she welcomed a dash of excitement as a relief from
+the strained relations of the two days just gone.
+
+"M'sieu," she called to Menard, with a sparkle in her eyes. "Oh,
+M'sieu, may I stay in the canoe?"
+
+Danton turned quickly at the sound of her voice, and a look, half of
+pain, half of surprise, came over his face as he saw her eagerness.
+Menard looked at her in doubt.
+
+"It may be a wet passage, Mademoiselle."
+
+"And why not, M'sieu? Have I not been wet before? See, I will protect
+myself." She drew the bundles closely about her feet, and threw a
+blanket across her knees. "Now I can brave the stream, Captain.
+Or,"--her gay tone dropped, and she looked demurely at him,--"perhaps
+it is that I am too heavy, that I should carry myself up the bank. I
+will obey my orders, Captain." But as she spoke she tucked the blanket
+closer about her, and stole another glance at Menard.
+
+He smiled. He was thinking of Madame Gordeau and her fragile daughter,
+who had shuddered with fear at a mere glimpse of the first rapid.
+"Very well," he said, "Mademoiselle shall stay in the canoe."
+
+"But it is not safe"--broke in Danton, stepping forward. Then,
+conscious of the blunder, he turned away, and took up the rope.
+
+"Lay hold, boys," said Menard.
+
+Perrot and one of the new men waded into the water, and laid hold of
+the gunwales on each side of the bow. Menard himself took the stern.
+He called to Danton, who stood awkwardly upon the bank, "Take the rope
+with the men."
+
+Guerin made the rope fast and set out ahead, with the other men and
+Danton close behind. Father Claude rolled up his robe and joined
+them.
+
+"Wait," called Menard, as the rope straightened. "Mademoiselle, I am
+sorry to disturb you, but if you will sit farther back you will have
+less trouble from the spray." He waded along the side, and helped her
+to move nearer the stern, placing the bundles and the blanket about
+her as before. Then he shouted, "All right," and they started into the
+foaming water.
+
+They toiled slowly up the incline, catching at rocks to steady their
+course, and often struggling for a foothold. Once Menard ordered a
+halt at a large rock, and all rested for a moment.
+
+When they started again, the men at the bow of the canoe had some
+trouble in holding it steady, for their feet were on a stretch of
+smooth rock, and Menard called Danton back to help them. The boy
+worked his way along the rope, and reached the bow.
+
+"Come around behind Perrot," said Menard.
+
+Danton reached around Perrot's body, and caught hold of the gunwale.
+At that moment his foot slipped, and he fell, dragging the side of the
+canoe down with him. The men at the bow did their best to prevent a
+capsize, but succeeded only in keeping half the bundles in the canoe.
+The others, the muskets, and the maid went into the river.
+
+Menard moved forward as rapidly as he could against the current. The
+maid was unable at once to get her feet, used as she was to the water,
+and was swept down against him. He caught her, and, steadying himself
+with one hand, by the water-logged canoe, raised her head and held her
+while she struggled for a footing and shook the water from her eyes.
+Before she was wholly herself, Danton came plunging toward them.
+
+"Give her to me!" he said huskily. "I've drowned her! My God, let me
+have her!"
+
+"Stop," said Menard, sternly. "Take the men, and go after those
+bales--quick!"
+
+Danton looked stupidly at him and at the maid, who was wiping the
+water from her face with one hand, and holding tightly to the Captain.
+Then he followed Perrot, who had already, with the two new men and
+Father Claude, commenced to get together the bales, most of which had
+sunk, and were moving slowly along the bottom. Menard still had his
+arm about the girl's shoulders. He helped her to the shore.
+
+"Keep moving, Mademoiselle,--don't sit down. In a moment we shall have
+a fire. Father Claude," he called, "bring the canoe ashore." Then to
+the maid, "There are yet some dry blankets, thank God."
+
+Mademoiselle was herself now, and she protested. "But it is only
+water, M'sieu. Let me go on with you, beyond the rapids."
+
+Menard merely shook his head. The canoe was soon on the bank, and
+emptied of water. The other men were beginning to come in with soaked
+bundles and dripping muskets. Each bale was opened, and the contents
+spread out to dry, while Guerin was set to work at drying the muskets
+with a cloth. Perrot and Danton built a rough shelter for the maid,
+enclosing a small fire, and gave her some dry blankets. Then each man
+dried himself as best he could.
+
+This accident threw Danton into a fit of gloominess from which nothing
+seemed to arouse him. He was careless of his duty, and equally
+careless to the reprimands that followed. This went on for two days,
+during which the maid seemed at one moment to avoid him, and at
+another to watch for his coming. In the evening of the second day
+following, the party camped at Pointe a Baudet, on Lake St. Francis.
+The supper was eaten in a silence more oppressive than usual, for
+neither Menard nor Father Claude could overcome the influence of
+Danton's heavy face and the maid's troubled eyes. After the supper the
+two strolled away, and sat just out of earshot on a mossy knoll. For
+hours they talked there, their voices low, save once or twice when
+Danton's rose. They seemed to have lost all count of time, all heed of
+appearances. Menard and the priest made an effort at first to appear
+unobservant, but later, seeing that their movements were beyond the
+sight of those unheeding eyes, they took to watching and speculating
+on the course of the conversation. The night came on, and the dark
+closed over them. Still the murmur of those low voices floated across
+the camp.
+
+Father Claude, with a troubled mind, went down to the water, and
+walked slowly up and down. Menard saw to the final preparations for
+the night, and posted the first sentry. Then he joined the priest.
+
+"Father?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"I think it is time to speak."
+
+"I fear it is, M'sieu."
+
+"I must leave it in your hands."
+
+"Shall I go now?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+Without further words, Father Claude walked up the bank, crackling
+through the bushes. From this spot the voices were inaudible, and for
+a few moments there was no sound. Then Menard could hear some one
+moving heavily through the undergrowth, going farther and farther into
+the stillness, and he knew that it was Danton. He sat on the bank with
+his back against a tree, and waited for a long hour. At last he
+dropped asleep.
+
+He was awakened by Father Claude. The priest dropped to the ground
+beside him. His training had given Menard the faculty of awaking
+instantly into full grasp of a situation.
+
+"Well," he said. "Where is the maid?"
+
+"She has gone to her couch, but not to sleep, I fear. It has come,
+M'sieu."
+
+"What has come?"
+
+"Danton has lost his senses. He asks her to marry him, to flee with
+him. It is a difficult case. She has had no such experience before,
+and knows not how to receive him. She seems to have no love for him,
+beyond the pleasure his flattery has given her. She believes all he
+says. One thing I know, aside from all questions of expediency, of
+care for our trust, this must not go on."
+
+"Not for the present, at least. She may do what she will, once we have
+taken her safely to Frontenac."
+
+"No, M'sieu; not even then. We must stop it at once."
+
+"Oh, of course," said Menard; "so far as we are concerned, we have no
+choice. You need not bother longer to-night. I will wait for the boy.
+I am sorry for him."
+
+"I should have more pity, if I knew less of his past."
+
+"Tush, Father! He is not a bad fellow, as they go. To be sure he does
+not rise any too well to new responsibilities, but he will grow into
+it. It is better an honest infatuation with the daughter of a
+gentleman than a dishonest one with an Indian maid. And you know our
+officers, Father. God knows, they are all bad enough; and yet they are
+loyal fellows."
+
+"Ah, M'sieu, I fear you will be too lenient with him. Believe me, we
+have not a minute to waste in stopping the affair."
+
+"Have no fear, Father. Good-night."
+
+"Good-night."
+
+Menard lay on the bank, gazing at the sparkling water, and listening
+to the slow step of the sentry and to the deeper sounds of the forest.
+Another hour crept by, and still Danton had not returned. Menard
+walked about the camp to make sure that he was not already rolled in
+his blanket; then he went to the sentry, who was leaning against a
+tree a few rods away.
+
+"Colin," he said, "have you seen Lieutenant Danton?"
+
+"Yes, M'sieu. He is up there." Colin pointed through the trees that
+fringed the river. "I heard a noise some time ago, and went up to see.
+He is lying under a beech tree, if he has not moved,--and I should
+have heard him if he had. It may be that he is asleep."
+
+Menard nodded, and walked slowly along the bank, bending aside the
+briers that caught at his clothes and his hands.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI.
+
+THE FIGHT AT LA GALLETTE.
+
+
+Danton was lying on the ground, but he was not asleep. He looked up,
+at the sound of Menard's footsteps, and then, recognizing him, lowered
+his eyes again. The Captain hesitated, standing over the prostrate
+figure.
+
+"Danton," he said finally, "I want you to tell me the truth."
+
+The boy made no reply, and Menard, after waiting for a moment, sat
+upon a log.
+
+"I have decided to do rather an unusual thing, Danton," he said
+slowly, "in offering to talk it over with you as a friend, and not as
+an officer. In one thing you must understand me: Mademoiselle St.
+Denis has been intrusted to my care, and until she has safely reached
+those who have a right to share the direction of her actions, I can
+allow nothing of this sort to go on. You must understand that. If you
+will talk with me frankly, and try to control yourself for the
+present, it may be that I can be of service to you later on."
+
+There was a long silence. Finally, Danton spoke, without raising his
+head.
+
+"Is there need of this, M'sieu? Is it not enough that she--that
+Mademoiselle dismisses me?"
+
+"Oh," said Menard, "that is it?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"You are sure of yourself, Danton? sure that you have not made a
+mistake?"
+
+"A mistake?" The boy looked up wildly. "I was--shall I tell you,
+M'sieu?--I left the camp to-night with the thought that I should never
+go back."
+
+Menard looked at him curiously.
+
+"What did you plan to do?"
+
+"I didn't know,--I don't know now. Back to Montreal, perhaps to the
+Iroquois. I don't care where."
+
+"You did not bring your musket. It would hardly be safe."
+
+"Safe!" There was weary contempt in the boy's voice. He sat up, and
+made an effort to steady himself, leaning back upon his hands. "I
+should not say this. It was what I thought at first. I am past it now;
+I can think better. It was only your coming,--when I first saw you, it
+came rushing back, and I wanted to--oh, what is the use? You do not
+know. You cannot understand."
+
+"And now?"
+
+"Now, Captain, I ask for a release. Let me go back to Montreal."
+
+"How would you go? You have no canoe."
+
+"I will walk."
+
+Menard shook his head.
+
+"I am sorry," he said, "but it is too late. In the first place, you
+would never reach the city. There are scouting bands of Iroquois all
+along the river."
+
+"So much the better, M'sieu, so--"
+
+"Wait. That is only one reason. I cannot spare you. I have realized
+within the last day that I should have brought more men. The Iroquois
+know of our campaign; they are watching us. A small party like this is
+to their liking. I will tell you, Danton, we may have a close rub
+before we get to Frontenac. I wish I could help you, but I cannot.
+What reason could I give for sending you alone down the river to
+Montreal? You forget, boy, that we are not on our own pleasure; we are
+on the King's errand. For you to go now would be to take away one of
+our six fighting men,--to imperil Mademoiselle. And that, I think," he
+looked keenly at Danton, "is not what you would wish to do."
+
+The boy's face was by turns set and working. He looked at Menard as if
+to speak, but got nothing out. At last he sprang to his feet, and
+paced back and forth between the trees.
+
+"What can I do?" he said half to himself. "I can't stay! I can't see
+her every day, and hear her voice, and sit with her at every meal. Why
+do you call yourself my friend, Menard? Why don't you help? Why don't
+you say something--?"
+
+"There are some things, Danton, that a man must fight out alone."
+
+Danton turned away, and stood looking over the river. Menard sat on
+the log and waited. The moments slipped by, and still they said
+nothing. They could hear the stirring of Colin, back at the camp, and
+the rustle of the low night breeze. They could almost hear the great
+silent rush of the river.
+
+"Danton."
+
+The boy half turned his head.
+
+"You will stay here and play the man. You will go on with your duties;
+though, if the old arrangement be too hard, I will be your master in
+the Iroquois study, leaving Mademoiselle to Father Claude. And now you
+must return to the camp and get what sleep you can. Heaven knows we
+may have little enough between here and Frontenac. Come."
+
+He got up, and walked to the camp, without looking around. Danton
+lingered until the Captain's tall figure was blending with the shadows
+of the forest, then he went after.
+
+During the following day they got as far as the group of islands at
+the head of Lake St. Francis. Wherever possible Menard was now
+selecting islands or narrow points for the camp, where, in case of a
+night attack, defence would be a simple problem for his few men. Also,
+each night, he had the men spread a circle of cut boughs around the
+camp at a little distance, so that none could approach without some
+slight noise. Another night saw the party at the foot of Petit
+Chesneaux, just above Pointe Maligne.
+
+While Perrot was preparing the supper, and Danton, with the
+_voyageurs_, was unpacking the bales, Menard took his musket and
+strode off into the forest. There was seldom a morning now that the
+maid did not have for her breakfast a morsel of game which the
+Captain's musket had brought down.
+
+In half an hour he returned, and sought Father Claude; and after a few
+low words the two set off. Menard led the way through thicket and
+timber growth, over a low hill, and down into a hollow, where a
+well-defined Indian trail crossed a brook. Here was a large sugar
+maple tree standing in a narrow opening in the thicket. Menard struck
+a light, and held up a torch so that the priest could make out a
+blaze-mark on the tree.
+
+"See," said Menard. "It is on the old trail. I saw it by the merest
+chance."
+
+Father Claude bent forward, with his eyes close to the inscription
+that had been painted on the white inner bark, with charcoal and
+bear's grease.
+
+"Can you read it?" asked Menard, holding the torch high.
+
+The priest nodded. Both of these men knew the Indian writing nearly as
+well as their own French.
+
+ [Transcriber's Note: An illustration of picture-writing appears
+ here in the text with the following caption:
+
+ NOTE.--By this picture-writing the Long Arrow (of the clan of the
+ Beaver) tells the Beaver (of the same clan) that he has taken up
+ the hatchet against the party in the canoe, and he asks the Beaver
+ to assist him. The parallel zigzag lines under the long arrow tell
+ that he is travelling by the river, and the two straight lines
+ under these that he has two warriors with him. The attack is to be
+ made in either three or four sleeps, or days, as indicated by the
+ three finished huts and one unfinished.
+
+ The Beaver has seen this sign, as shown by his signature at the
+ bottom. The seventeen slanting lines under the foot mean that he
+ has seventeen warriors and they are travelling on foot, southward,
+ as shown by the fact that the lines slope toward the sun.
+
+ That the figures in the canoe are French is shown by their hats.
+ The priest has no paddle, the maid is represented with long
+ hair.]
+
+"He does not know of the two men you got at Montreal, M'sieu. He tells
+of only six in our canoe."
+
+"No? But that matters little. The Beaver has hurried after him with
+nearly a score. They can give us trouble enough. What do you make of
+the huts? Do they mean three days or four?"
+
+"It looks to me," said the priest slowly, "that he was interrupted in
+drawing the fourth."
+
+"Well,"--Menard threw his torch into the brook, and turned away into
+the dusk of the thicket,--"we know enough. The fight will be somewhere
+near the head of the rapids. Perhaps they will wait until we get on
+into the islands."
+
+"And meantime," said the priest, as they crackled through the
+undergrowth, "we shall say nothing of this to Lieutenant Danton or the
+maid?"
+
+"Nothing," Menard replied.
+
+In three days more they had passed Rapide Flat, after toiling
+laboriously by the Long Sault. They were a sober enough party now,
+oppressed with Danton's dogged attention to duty and with the maid's
+listless manner.
+
+They were passing a small island the next morning, when Perrot gave a
+shout and stopped paddling.
+
+"What is it?" asked Menard, sharply.
+
+Perrot pointed across a spit of land. In the other channel they could
+see a bateau just disappearing behind a clump of trees. It was headed
+down-stream. Menard swung the canoe about, and they skirted the foot
+of the island. Instead of a single bateau there were some half dozen,
+drifting light down the river, with a score of _coureurs de bois_ and
+_voyageurs_ under the command of a bronzed lieutenant, Du Peron, a
+sergeant, and a corporal. The lieutenant recognized Menard, and both
+parties landed while the two officers exchanged news.
+
+"Can you spare me a few men?" Menard asked, when they had drawn apart
+from the others.
+
+The lieutenant's eye roamed over the group on the beach, where the men
+of both parties were mingling.
+
+"How many do you want? I'm running shorthanded. We have all we can
+manage with these bateaux."
+
+"There's a war party of twenty on my trail," said Menard. "If I had my
+own men with me I should feel safe, but I have my doubts about these
+fellows. I haven't room for more than two."
+
+"What's the trouble?--that La Grange affair?"
+
+Menard nodded.
+
+"I heard that they had a price on your head. There's been a good deal
+of talk about it at Frontenac. A converted Mohawk has been scouting
+for us, and he says that the Onondagas blame you for that whole galley
+business."
+
+"I know," said Menard, grimly. "You could hardly expect them to get
+the truth of it."
+
+"It was bad work, Menard, bad work. The worst thing La Grange did was
+to butcher the women and children. He was drunk at the time, and the
+worst of it was over before d'Orvilliers got wind of it. Do you know
+who is leading this war party?"
+
+"The Long Arrow."
+
+"Oh, yes. A big fellow, with a rather noticeable wampum collar. He
+came to Frontenac as a Mission Indian, but got away before we
+suspected anything. Our scout told me that his son was in the party
+that was taken to the galleys. He's been scouting along the river ever
+since. Likely as not he followed you down to Quebec. How many men have
+you now?"
+
+"Five, and Father Claude."
+
+"He could shoot at a pinch, I suppose. I'll let you have the best two
+I have, but--" Du Peron shrugged his shoulders--"you know the sort
+that are assigned for this transport work. They're a bad lot at best.
+But they can shoot, and they hate the Iroquois, so you're all right if
+you can keep them sober. That will make nine, with yourself,--it
+should be enough."
+
+"It will be enough. How is the transport moving?"
+
+"Splendidly. Whatever we may say about the new Governor, our Intendant
+knows his business. I judge from the way he is stocking up Frontenac,
+that we are to use it as the base for a big campaign."
+
+"I suppose so. You will report, will you, at Montreal, that we were
+safe at Rapide Flat? And if you find a _coureur_ going down to Quebec,
+I wish you would send word to Provost that Mademoiselle St. Denis is
+well and in good spirits."
+
+The lieutenant looked curiously at the maid, who was walking with
+Father Claude near the canoe. Then the two officers shook hands, and
+in a few moments were going their ways, Menard with two villainous
+_voyageurs_ added to his crew. That afternoon he passed the last
+rapid, and beached the canoe at La Gallette, thankful that nothing
+intervened between them and Fort Frontenac but a reach of still water
+and the twining channels of the Thousand Islands, where it would call
+for the sharpest eyes ever set in an Iroquois head to follow his
+movements.
+
+They ate an early supper, and immediately afterward Father Claude
+slipped away. The maid looked after him a little wistfully, then she
+wandered to the bank, and found a mossy seat where she could watch the
+long rapid, with its driving, foaming current that dashed over the
+ledges and leaped madly around the jagged rocks. Menard set his men at
+work preparing the camp against attack. When this was well under way
+he called Danton, who was lying by the fire, and spent an hour with
+him conversing in Iroquois. By that time the twilight was creeping
+down the river. Menard left the boy to form a speech in accord with
+Iroquois tradition, and went on a tour of inspection about the camp.
+The new men had swung thoroughly into the spirit of their work; one of
+them was already on guard a short way back in the woods. The other men
+were grouped in a cleared place, telling stories and singing.
+
+Father Claude came hurriedly toward the fire, looking for Menard. His
+eyes glowed with enthusiasm.
+
+"M'sieu," he said, in an eager voice, "come. I have found it."
+
+"What?"
+
+"It has come to me,--about the canoe."
+
+Menard looked puzzled, but the priest caught his arm, and led him
+away.
+
+"It came while we ate supper. The whole truth, the secret of the
+allegory, flashed upon me. I have worked hard, and now it is done.
+Instead of leaving out the canoe, I have put it back, and have placed
+in it six warriors, three paddling toward the chapel, and three away
+from it. Over them hovers an angel,--a mere suggestion, a faint,
+shining face, a diaphanous form, and outspread hands. Thus we
+symbolize the conflict in the savage mind at the first entrance of the
+Holy Word into their lives, with the blessed assurance over all that
+the Faith must triumph in the end."
+
+At the last words, he stopped and drew Menard around to face the
+portrait of the Lily of the Onondagas, which was leaning against a
+stump.
+
+"Is it too dark, M'sieu? See, I will bring it closer." He lifted the
+picture, and held it close to Menard's eyes. He was trembling with the
+excitement of his inspiration.
+
+The Captain stepped back.
+
+"I should like to know, Father, where you have had this picture."
+
+"It was in my bundle. I have"--for the first time he saw the sternness
+in Menard's face, and his voice faltered.
+
+"You did not leave it at Montreal?"
+
+Father Claude slowly lowered the canvas to the ground. The light had
+gone out of his eyes, and his face was white. Then suddenly his thin
+form straightened. "I had forgotten. It was M'sieu's order. See,"--he
+suddenly lifted the picture over his head and whirled to the
+stump,--"it shall go no farther. We will leave it here for the wolves
+and the crows and the pagan redmen."
+
+He dashed it down with all his strength, but Menard sprang forward,
+and caught it on his outstretched arm. "No, Father," he said; "we will
+take it with us."
+
+The priest smiled wearily, and lowered the picture to the ground; but
+when Menard said, "You have broken it," he raised it hastily, and
+examined it. One corner of the wooden frame was loosened, but the
+canvas was not injured.
+
+"I can mend it," he said.
+
+Then they walked to the camp together, without talking; and Menard
+helped him repair the frame, and pack the picture carefully.
+
+"How is it that it was not ruined in the capsize at Coteau des
+Cedres?" Menard asked.
+
+"It was preserved by a miracle, M'sieu. This bundle did not leave the
+canoe."
+
+The _voyageurs_, still lounging in the clearing, were laughing and
+talking noisily. The Captain, after he had prepared the maid's couch,
+and bade her good-night, called to them to be quiet. For a time the
+noise ceased, but a little later, as he was spreading his blanket on
+the ground, it began again, and one of the transport men sang the
+opening strain of a ribald song. Menard strode over to the group so
+quickly that he took them by surprise. Colin was slipping something
+behind him, but he could not escape Menard's eye. In a moment he was
+sprawling on his face, and a brandy flask was brought to light. Menard
+dashed it against a tree, and turned to the frightened men.
+
+"Go to your blankets, every man of you. There are Iroquois on this
+river. You have already made enough noise to draw them from half a
+league away. The next man that is caught drinking will be flogged." He
+thought of the maid lying under her frail shelter, for whose life he
+was responsible. "If it occurs twice, he will be shot. Perrot, I want
+you to join the sentry. From now on we shall have two men on guard all
+night. See that there is no mistake about this. At the slightest
+noise, you will call me."
+
+The men slunk to their blankets, and soon the camp was still.
+
+The river sang as it rushed down its zigzag channel through the
+rocks,--a song that seemed a part of the night, and yet was distinct
+from the creeping, rustling, dropping, all-pervading life and stir of
+the forest. Every leaf, every twig and root, every lump of sod and
+rock-held pool of stagnant water, had its own miniature world, where
+living things were fighting the battle of life. In the far distance,
+perhaps, an owl hooted; or near at hand a flying squirrel alighted on
+a bending elm-twig. Deer and moose followed their beaten tracks to the
+streams that had been theirs before ever Frenchman pierced the forest;
+beaver dove into their huts above the dams their own sharp teeth had
+made; moles nosed under the rich soil, and left a winding track
+behind; frogs croaked and bellowed from some backset of the
+river,--and all blended, not, perhaps, so much into a sound, as into a
+sense of movement,--an even murmur in a low key, to which the lighter
+note of the water was apart and distinct.
+
+To a man trained as Menard had been, this was companionship. He was
+never alone in the forest, never without his millions of friends, who,
+though they seldom came into his thoughts, were yet a part of him, of
+his sense of life and strength. And through all these noises, even to
+the roar of Niagara itself, he could sleep like a child, when the
+slightest sound of a moccasined foot on a dry leaf would have aroused
+him at the instant to full activity. To-night he lay awake for a long
+time. With every day that he drew nearer the frontier came graver
+doubts of the feasibility of the plan which had been intrusted to him.
+The wretched business of La Grange's treachery and the stocking of the
+King's galleys had probably alienated the Onondagas for all time.
+Their presence on the St. Lawrence pointed to this. He felt safe
+enough, personally, for the very imprudence of the Governor's
+campaign, which had made it known so early to all the Iroquois, was an
+element in his favour. The Iroquois, unlike many of the roaming
+western tribes, had their settled villages, with lodges and fields of
+grain to defend from invasion. One secret of the campaign had been
+well kept; no one save the Governor's staff and Menard knew that the
+blow was to fall on the Senecas alone. And Menard was certain enough
+in his knowledge of Iroquois character to believe that each tribe,
+from the Mohawks on the east to the Senecas on the west, would call in
+its warriors, and concentrate to defend its villages. Therefore there
+could be no strong force on the St. Lawrence, where the French could
+so easily cut it off. As for the Long Arrow and his band, eight good
+fighting men and a stout-hearted priest could attend to them.
+
+No, the danger would begin after the maid was safe at Frontenac, and
+he and Danton and Father Claude must set out to win the confidence of
+the Onondagas. The Oneidas and Mohawks must not be slighted; but the
+Onondagas and Cayugas, being the nearest to the Senecas, and between
+them and the other nations, would likely prove to be the key to the
+situation.
+
+The night was black when he awoke. Clouds had spread over the sky,
+hiding all but a strip in the west where a low line of stars peeped
+out. This strip was widening rapidly as the night breeze carried the
+clouds eastward. At a little distance some of the men were whispering
+together and laughing softly. A hand was feeling his arm, and a voice
+whispered,--
+
+"Quick, M'sieu; something has happened!"
+
+"Is that you, Colin?"
+
+"Yes. Guerin was on guard with me, and he fell. I thought I heard an
+arrow, but could not be sure. I looked for him after I heard him fall,
+but could not find him in the dark."
+
+Menard sprang to his feet, with his musket, which had lain at his side
+every night since leaving Montreal.
+
+"Where was Guerin, Colin?"
+
+"Straight back from the river, a few rods. He had spoken but a moment
+before. It must have told them where to shoot."
+
+"Call the men, and draw them close in a circle." Menard felt his way
+toward the fire, where a few red embers showed dimly, and roused
+Danton with a light touch and a whispered caution to be silent.
+Already he could hear the low stir of the _engages_ as they slipped
+nearer the fire. He walked slowly toward the river, with one hand
+stretched out in front, to find the canoe. It was closer than he
+supposed, and he stumbled over it, knocking one end off its support.
+The maid awoke with a gasp.
+
+"Mademoiselle, silence!" he whispered, kneeling beside her. "I fear we
+are attacked. You must come with me." He had to say it twice before
+she could fully understand, and just then an arrow sang over them, and
+struck a tree with a low _thut_. He suddenly rose and shouted,
+"Together, boys! They will be on us in a moment. Close in at the bank,
+and save your powder. Perrot, come here and help me with the canoe."
+
+There was a burst of yells from the dark in answer to his call, and a
+few shots flashed. Danton was rallying the men, and calling to them to
+fall back, where they could take cover among the rocks and trees of
+the bank.
+
+The maid was silent, but she reached out her hand, and Menard,
+catching her wrist, helped her to her feet, and fairly carried her
+down the slope of the bank, laying her behind the tangled roots of a
+great oak. Already the sky was clearer, and the trees and men were
+beginning to take dim shape. The river rushed by, a deeper black than
+sky and woods, with a few ghostly bits of white where the foam of the
+rapids began.
+
+"Stay here," he whispered. "Don't move or speak. I shall not be far."
+
+She clung to his hand in a dazed manner, but he gently drew his away,
+and left her crouching on the ground.
+
+The men were calling to one another as they dodged back from tree to
+tree toward the river, shooting only when a flash from the woods
+showed the position of an Indian. Some of them were laughing, and as
+Menard reached the canoe Perrot broke into a jeering song. It was
+clear that the attacking party was not strong. Probably they had not
+taken into account the double guard, relying on the death of the
+sentry to clear the way for a surprise.
+
+"Perrot!" called the Captain. "Why don't you come here?"
+
+The song stopped. There was a heavy noise as the _voyageur_ came
+plunging through the bushes, drawing a shower of arrows and musket
+balls.
+
+"Careful, Perrot, careful."
+
+"They can't hit me," said Perrot, laughing. He stumbled against the
+Captain, stepped back, and fell over the canoe, rolling and kicking.
+Menard sprang toward him and jerked him up. He smelled strongly of
+brandy.
+
+Menard swore under his breath.
+
+"Pick up your musket. Take hold of that canoe,--quick!"
+
+Perrot was frightened by his stern words, and he succeeded in holding
+up an end of the canoe, while Menard pushed him down the slope to
+the water's edge. They rushed back, and in a few trips got down
+most of the stores. By this time Perrot was sobering somewhat, and
+with the Captain he took his place in the line. The men were
+shooting more frequently now, and by their loose talk showed
+increasing recklessness. Calling to Danton, Menard finally made
+them understand his order to fall back. Before they reached the
+bank, Colin dropped, with a ball through the head, and was dragged
+back by Danton.
+
+They dropped behind logs and trees at the top of the slope. It began
+to look as if the redmen were to get no closer, in spite of the
+drunken condition of all but one or two of the men. Though the night
+was now much brighter, they were in the shadow, and neither the
+Captain nor Danton observed that the brandy which the transport men
+had supplied was passing steadily from hand to hand. They could not
+know that the boy Guerin lay on his back amid the attacking Onondagas,
+an arrow sticking upright in his breast, one hand lying across his
+musket, the other clasping a flask.
+
+The maid had not moved. She could be easily seen now in the clearer
+light, and Menard went to her, feeling the need of giving her some
+work to occupy her mind during the strain of the fight.
+
+"Mademoiselle," he whispered.
+
+She looked up. He could see that she was shivering.
+
+"I must ask you to help me. We must get the canoe into the water. They
+will soon tire of the assault and withdraw; then it will be safe to
+take to the canoe. They cannot hurt you. We are protected by the
+bank."
+
+He helped her to rise, and she bravely threw her weight on the canoe,
+which Menard could so easily have lifted alone, and stood at the edge
+of the beach, passing him the bundles, which he, wading out, placed
+aboard. But suddenly he stopped, with an exclamation, peering into the
+canoe.
+
+The maid, dreading each moment some new danger, asked in a dry voice,
+"What is it, M'sieu?"
+
+For reply he seized the bundles, one at a time, and tossed them
+ashore, hauling the canoe after, and running his hand along the bark.
+
+The maid stepped to his side. There was a gaping hole in the side of
+the canoe. She drew her breath in quickly, and looked up at him.
+
+"It was Perrot," he muttered, "that fool Perrot." He stood looking at
+it, as if in doubt what to do. Up on the bank the men, Danton and
+Father Claude among them, were popping away at the rustling bushes.
+Suddenly he turned and gazed down at the maid's upturned face.
+"Mademoiselle," he said, "I do not think there is danger, but whatever
+happens you must keep close to me, or to Danton and Father Claude. It
+may be that there will be moments when we cannot stop and explain to
+you as I am doing now, but you must trust us, and believe that all
+will come out well. The other men are not themselves to-night--"
+
+He stopped. It was odd that he should so talk to a maid while his men
+were fighting for their lives; but the Menard who had the safety of
+this slender girl in his hands was not the Menard of a hundred battles
+gone by. So he lingered, not knowing why, save that he hoped for some
+word from her lips of confidence in those who wished to protect her.
+And, as he waited, she smiled with trembling lips, and said:--
+
+"It will come out well, M'sieu. I--I am not afraid."
+
+Then Menard went up the bank with a bound, and finding one man already
+in a stupor, and another struggling for a flask, which Father Claude
+was trying to take away from him, he laid about him with his hard
+fists, and shortly had the drunkards as near to their senses as they
+were destined to be during the short space they had yet to live.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII.
+
+A COMPLIMENT FOR MENARD.
+
+
+Colin and Guerin were dead, and one of the transport men lay in a
+drunken sleep, so that including Menard, Danton, and Father Claude
+there were six men in the little half circle that clung to the edge of
+the bank, shooting into the brush wherever a twig stirred or a musket
+flashed. "There are not many of them," said Menard to Danton, as they
+lay on their sides reloading. He listened to the whoops and barks in
+an interval between shots. "Not a score, all told."
+
+"Will they come closer?"
+
+"No. You won't catch an Iroquois risking his neck in an assault.
+They'll try to pick us off; but if we continue as strong as we are
+now, they are likely to draw off and try some other devilment, or wait
+for a better chance."
+
+Danton crept back to his log for another shot. Now that the sky was
+nearly free of clouds, and the river was sparkling in the starlight,
+the Frenchmen could not raise their heads to shoot without exposing a
+dim silhouette to the aim of an Indian musket. Father Claude, who was
+loading and firing a long _arquebuse a croc_, had risen above this
+difficulty by heaping a pile of stones. Kneeling on the slope, a pace
+below the others, and resting the crutch of his piece in a hollow
+close to the stones, he could shoot through a crevice with little
+chance of harm, beyond a bruised shoulder.
+
+The maid came timidly up the bank, and touched Menard's arm.
+
+"What is it, Mademoiselle? You must not come here. It is not safe."
+
+"I want to speak to you, M'sieu. If I could have your knife--for one
+moment--"
+
+"What do you want of a knife, child? It is best that you--" There was
+a fusillade from the brush, and his voice was lost in the uproar. "You
+must wait below, on the beach. They cannot get to you."
+
+"It is the canoe, M'sieu. The cloth about the bales is stout,--I can
+sew it over the hole."
+
+Menard looked at her as she crouched by his side; her hair fallen
+about her face and shoulders; her hands, grimy with the clay of the
+bank, clinging to a wandering root. She was still trembling with
+excitement, but her eyes were bright and eager. Without a word he drew
+his knife from its sheath, and held it out. She took it, and was down
+the slope with a light spring, while the Captain poked the muzzle of
+his musket through the leaves. As he drew it back, after firing, he
+caught a glimpse of Danton's face, turned toward him with a curious
+expression. The boy laughed nervously, and wiped the sweat from his
+blackened forehead. "They don't give us much rest, Captain, do they?"
+Menard's reply was jerked out with the strokes of his ramrod: "They
+will--before long--and we can--take to the canoe. We're letting them
+have all they want." He peered through the leaves, and fired quickly.
+A long shriek came from the darkness. Menard laughed. "There's one
+more gone, Danton."
+
+The fight went on slowly, wretchedly, shot for shot, Danton himself
+dragging up a bale of ammunition and serving it to the men. The maid,
+unaided, had overturned the canoe where it lay, and with quickened
+breath was pressing her needle through the tough bark. Danton lost the
+flint from his musket, and crept down the bank to set a new one.
+Suddenly he exclaimed, "There goes Perrot!"
+
+The old _voyageur_ had, in a fit of recklessness, raised his head for
+a long look about the woods. Now he was rolling slowly down the slope
+toward the canoe and the maid, clutching weakly at roots and bushes as
+he passed. There was a dark spot on his forehead. Menard sprang after,
+and felt of his wrists; the pulse was fluttering out. He looked up, to
+see the maid dipping up water with her hollowed hands, and waved her
+back.
+
+"It is no use, Mademoiselle. Is the canoe ready? We may need it
+soon."
+
+She stood motionless, slowly shaking her head, and letting the water
+spill from her hands a drop at a time.
+
+"Go back there. Do what you can with it." He hurried up the bank and
+fell into his place.
+
+"Do you see what they are doing?" asked Danton.
+
+"Playing the devil. Anything else?"
+
+The lieutenant pointed to an arrow that was sticking in a tree beside
+him, slanting downward. "They are climbing trees. Listen. You can hear
+them talking, and calling down. I've fired, but I don't get them."
+
+Menard listened closely, and shot for the sound, but with no result.
+
+"We've got to stop this, Danton. I don't understand it. It isn't like
+the Iroquois to keep at it after a repulse. Tell Father Claude; he is
+shooting too low." Menard glanced along the line at his men. The
+drunken transport man lay silent at his post; beyond him were his mate
+and one of the Montreal men, both of them reckless and frightened by
+turns, shooting aimlessly into the dark. The arrows were rattling down
+about them now. One grazed Father Claude's back as he stooped to take
+aim, and straightened him up with a jerk. A moment later a bullet sang
+close past Menard's head. He looked for the maid; she was sitting by
+the canoe, sewing, giving no heed to the arrows.
+
+The Montreal man groaned softly, and flattened out, with an arrow
+slanting into the small of his back; which so unmanned the only other
+conscious _engage_ that he sank by him, sobbing, and trying to pull
+out the arrow with his hands. Menard sprang up.
+
+"My God, Danton! Father Claude! This is massacre. Run for the canoe.
+My turn, eh?"
+
+"What is it?" asked Danton. "Did they get you?"
+
+For reply, Menard tore an arrow from the flesh of his forearm and
+dashed down the bank, musket in hand. The maid was tugging at the
+canoe, struggling to move it toward the water. She did not look up to
+see the yellow, crimson, and green painted figures rise from the reeds
+that fringed the water but a few yards away; she did not hear the rush
+of moccasined feet on the gravel. Before she could turn, she was
+seized and thrown to the ground, surrounded by the Indians, who were
+facing about hastily to meet Menard. The Captain came among them with
+a whirl of his musket that sent one warrior to the ground and dropped
+another, half stunned, across the canoe. Danton was at his heels, and
+Father Claude, fighting like demons with muskets and knives.
+
+"Quick, Mademoiselle!" Menard lifted her as he spoke, and swung her
+behind him; and then the three were facing the group of howling,
+jumping figures, which was increased rapidly by those who had followed
+the Frenchmen down the bank. "Come back here, Father. Protect the
+maid! They dare not attack you, if you drop your musket! Loose your
+hold, Mademoiselle." He caught roughly at the slender arms that held
+about his waist, parrying a knife stroke with his other hand. "They
+will kill you if you cling to me. Now, Danton! Never mind your arm. I
+have one in the hand. Fight for the maid and France!" Menard was
+shouting for sheer lust and frenzy of battle, "What is the matter with
+the devils? Why don't they shoot? God, Danton, they're coming at us
+with clubs!" He called out in the Iroquois tongue: "Come at us,
+cowards! Make an end of it! Where are your bows? your muskets? Where
+is the valour of the Onondagas--of my brothers?"
+
+The last words brought forth a chorus of jeers and yells. The two
+officers stood side by side at the water's edge. Behind them,
+knee-deep in the water, was Father Claude, holding the maid in his
+arms. The Indians seemed to draw together, still with that evident
+effort to take their game alive, for two tall chiefs were rushing
+about, cautioning the warriors. Then, of a sudden, the whole body came
+forward with a rush, and Menard, Danton, Father Claude, and the maid
+went down; the three men fighting and splashing until they lay, bound
+with thongs, on the beach.
+
+Menard turned his head and saw that Danton lay close to him.
+
+"Mademoiselle?" he said. "What have they done with her?"
+
+"She is here." The reply was in Father Claude's voice. It came from
+the farther side of Danton.
+
+"Is she hurt?"
+
+"No. But they have bound her and me."
+
+"Bound you!" The Captain tried to sit up, but could not. "They would
+not do that, Father. It is a mistake."
+
+A warrior, carrying a musket under his arm, walked slowly around the
+prisoners, making signs to them to be silent. The others had withdrawn
+to the shadow of the bank; the sound of their voices came indistinctly
+across the strip of shore. Indifferent to the pain in his arm, Menard
+struggled at his thongs, and called to them in Iroquois: "Who of my
+brothers has bound the holy Father? What new fear strikes the breasts
+of the sons of the night-wind that they must subdue with force the
+gentle spirit of their Father, who has given his years for his
+children? Is it not enough that you have broken the faith with your
+brother, the child of your own village, the son of your bravest chief?
+Need you other prey than myself?"
+
+The guard stood over Menard, and lifted his musket. Menard laughed.
+
+"Strike me, brave warrior. Show that your heart is still as fond as on
+the day I carried your torn body on my shoulder to the safety of your
+lodge. Ah, you remember? You have not forgotten the Big Buffalo? Then,
+why do you hesitate? The man who has courage to seize a Father of the
+Church, surely can strike his brother. This is not the brave Tegakwita
+I have known."
+
+Father Claude broke in on Menard, whose voice was savage in its
+defiance.
+
+"Have patience, M'sieu. I will speak." He lifted his voice.
+"Teganouan! Father Claude awaits you." There was no reply from the
+knot of warriors at the bank, and the priest called again. Finally a
+chief came across and looked stolidly at the prisoners.
+
+"My Father called?" he said.
+
+"Your Father is grieved, Long Arrow, that you would bind him like a
+soldier taken in war." The priest's voice was gentle. "Is this the
+custom of the Onondagas? It was not so when I served you with Father
+de Lamberville."
+
+"My Father fought against his children."
+
+"You would have slain me, Long Arrow, had I not."
+
+The Indian walked slowly back to his braves, and for some moments
+there was a consultation. Then the other chief came to them, and,
+without a word, himself cut the thongs that bound the priest's wrists
+and ankles. There was no look of recognition in his eyes as he passed
+Menard, though they had been together on many a long hunt. He was the
+Beaver.
+
+As the Captain lay on his back, looking first at the kneeling Indian,
+then at the sky overhead, he was thinking of the Long Arrow, again
+with a half-memory of some other occasion when they had met. Then,
+slowly, it came to him. It was at the last council to decide on his
+release from captivity, five years before. The Long Arrow had come
+from a distant village to urge the death of the prisoner. He had
+argued eloquently that to release Menard would be to send forth an
+ungrateful son who would one day strike at the hand that had
+befriended him.
+
+Father Claude was on his feet, chafing his wrists and talking with the
+Beaver. The Long Arrow joined them, and for a few moments the chiefs
+reasoned together in low, dignified tones. Then, at a word from the
+Beaver, and a grunt of disgust from the Long Arrow, Father Claude,
+with quick fingers, set the maid free, and took her head upon his
+knee.
+
+"Have they hurt her, Father?" asked Menard, in French.
+
+"No, M'sieu, I think not. It is the excitement. The child sadly needs
+rest."
+
+"Will they release you? It is not far to Frontenac. It may be that you
+can reach there with Mademoiselle."
+
+"No, my son." The priest paused to dip up some water, and to stroke
+the maid's forehead and wrists. "They have some design which has not
+been made clear to me. They have promised not to bind me or to injure
+what belongs to me among the supplies. But the Beaver threatens to
+kill us if we try to escape, Mademoiselle and I."
+
+"Why do they hold you?"
+
+"To let no word go out concerning your capture. I fear, M'sieu--"
+
+"Well?"
+
+The priest lowered his eyes to the maid, who still lay fainting, and
+said no more. A long hour went by, with only a commonplace word now
+and then between the prisoners. The maid revived, and sat against the
+canoe, gazing over the water that swept softly by. Danton lay silent,
+saying nothing. Once a groan slipped past the Captain's lips at a
+twitch of his wounded arm, and Father Claude, immediately cheered by
+the prospect of a moment's occupation, cleaned the wound with cool
+water, and bandaged it with a strip from his robe.
+
+Preparations were making for a start. A half-dozen braves set out,
+running down the beach; and shortly returned by way of the river with
+two canoes. The others had opened the bales of supplies (excepting
+Father Claude's bundle, which he kept by him), and divided the food
+and ammunition among themselves. The two chiefs came to the prisoners,
+and seated themselves on the gravel. The Long Arrow began talking.
+
+"My brother, the Big Buffalo, is surprised that he should be taken a
+prisoner to the villages of the Onondagas. He thinks of the days when
+he shared with us our hunts, our lodges, our food, our trophies; when
+he lived a free life with his brothers, and parted from them with
+sadness in his voice. He had a grateful heart for the Onondagas then.
+When he left our lodges he placed his hand upon the hearts of our
+chiefs, he swore by his strange gods to keep the pledge of friendship
+to his brothers of the forest. Moons have come and gone many times
+since he left our villages. The snow has fallen for five seasons
+between him and us, to chill his heart against those who have
+befriended him. Twice has he been in battle when we might have taken
+him a prisoner, but the hearts of our braves were warm toward him, and
+they could not lift their arms. When there have been those who have
+urged that the hatchet be taken up against him, many others have come
+forward to say, 'No; he will yet prove our friend and our brother.'"
+
+Menard lay without moving, looking up at the stars. Danton, by his
+side, and the maid, sitting beyond, were watching him anxiously.
+Father Claude stood erect, with folded arms.
+
+"And now," continued the chief, "now that Onontio, the greatest of war
+chiefs, thinks that he is strong, and can with a blow destroy our
+villages and drive us from the lands our gods and your gods have said
+to be ours by right, as it was our fathers',--now there is no longer
+need for the friendship of the Onondagas, whose whole nation is fewer
+than the fighting braves of the great Onontio. The war-song is sung in
+every white village. The great canoes take food and powder up our
+river, for those who would destroy us."
+
+Menard was still looking upward. "My brother," he said, speaking
+slowly, "was once a young brave. When he was called before his great
+chief, and commanded to go out and fight to save his village and his
+brothers and sisters, did he say to his chief: 'No, my father, I will
+no longer obey your commands. I will no longer strive to become a
+famous warrior of your nation. I will go away into the deep
+forest,--alone, without a lodge, without a nation, to be despised
+alike by my brothers and my foes?' Or did he go as he was bid,
+obeying, like a brave warrior, the commands of those who have a right
+to command? Does not the Long Arrow know that Onontio is the greatest
+of chiefs, second only to the Great-Chief-Across-the-Water, the father
+of red men and white men? If Onontio's red sons are disobedient, and
+he commands me to chastise them, shall I say to my father, 'I cannot
+obey your will, I will become an outcast, without a village or a
+nation?' The Long Arrow is a wise man. He knows that the duty of all
+is to obey the father at Quebec."
+
+"The Big Buffalo speaks with wisdom. But it may be he forgets that our
+braves have passed him by in the battles of every season since he left
+our villages. He forgets that he met a band of peaceful hunters from
+our nation, who went into his great stone house because they believed
+that his white brothers, if not himself, would keep the word of
+friendship. He forgets that they were made to drink of the white man's
+fire water, and were chained together to become slaves of the great
+kind Chief-Across-the-Water, who loves his children, and would make
+them mighty in his land. Is this the father he would have us obey?
+Truly, he speaks with an idle tongue."
+
+Menard lay silent. His part in La Grange's treachery, and in carrying
+out later the Governor's orders, would be hard to explain. To lay the
+blame on La Grange would not help his case, at least until he could
+consult with Father Claude, and be prepared to speak deliberately.
+
+"My brother does not reply?"
+
+"He will ask a question," replied Menard. "What is the will of the
+chiefs to do with the sons of Onontio?"
+
+"The Big Buffalo has seen the punishment given by the Onondagas to
+those who have broken their faith."
+
+"I understand. And of course we shall be taken to your villages before
+this death shall come?"
+
+The Long Arrow bowed.
+
+"Very well," said Menard, in his slow voice. "As the Long Arrow, brave
+as he is, is but a messenger, obeying the will of the nation, I will
+withhold my word until I shall be brought before your chiefs in
+council. I shall have much to say to them; it need be said only once.
+I shall be pleased to tell my truths to the Big Throat, whose eyes can
+see beyond the limits of his lodge; who knows that the hand of Onontio
+is a firm and strong hand. He shall know from my lips how kind Onontio
+wishes to be to his ungrateful children--" He paused. The Indians must
+not know yet that the Governor's campaign was to be directed only
+against the Senecas. The mention of the Big Throat would, he knew, be
+a shaft tipped with jealousy in the breast of the Long Arrow. The Big
+Throat, Otreouati, was the widest famed orator and chief of the
+Onondagas; and it was he who had adopted Menard as his son. Above all,
+the Long Arrow would not dare to do away with so important a prisoner
+before he could be brought before the council.
+
+The maid was leaning forward, following their words intently. "Oh,
+M'sieu," she said, "I cannot understand it all. What will they do with
+you?"
+
+Menard hesitated, and replied in French without turning his head:
+"They will take us to their villages below Lake Ontario. They will not
+harm you, under Father Claude's protection. And then it is likely that
+we may be rescued before they can get off the river."
+
+"But yourself, M'sieu? They are angry with you. What will they do?"
+
+"Lieutenant Danton and I must look out for ourselves. I shall hope
+that we may find a way out."
+
+The Long Arrow was looking closely at them, evidently resenting a
+woman's voice in the talk. At the silence, he spoke in the same low
+voice, but Menard and Father Claude read the emotion underneath.
+
+"It may be that the Big Buffalo has never had a son to brighten his
+days as his life reaches the downward years. It may be that he has not
+watched the papoose become a fleet youth, and the youth a tireless
+hunter. He may not have waited for the day when the young hunter
+should take his seat at the council and speak with those who will hear
+none but wise men. I had such a son. He went on the hunt with a band
+that never returned to the village." His voice rose above the pitch
+customary to a chief. It was almost cold in its intensity. "I found
+his body, my brother, the body of my son, at this place, killed by the
+white men, who talked to us of the love of their gods and their
+Chief-Across-the-Water. Here it was I found him, who died before he
+would become the slave of a white man; and here I have captured the
+man who killed him. It is well that we have not killed my brother
+to-night. It is better that we should take him alive before the
+council of the Onondagas, who once were proud in their hearts that he
+was of their own nation."
+
+The maid's eyes, shining with tears, were fixed on the Indian's face.
+She had caught up with her hand the flying masses of her hair and
+braided them hastily; but still there were locks astray, touched by
+the light of the starlit sky. Menard turned his head, and watched her
+during the long silence. Danton was watching her too. He had not
+understood the chief's story, but it was clear from her face that she
+had caught it all. It was Father Claude who finally spoke. His voice
+was gentle, but it had the air of authority which his long experience
+had taught him was necessary in dealing with the Indians.
+
+"The Big Buffalo has said wisely. He will speak only to the great
+chiefs of the nation, who will understand what may be beyond the minds
+of others. The heart of the Long Arrow is sad, his spirit cast down,
+and he does not see now what to-morrow he may,--that the hand of the
+Big Buffalo is not stained with the blood of his son. We will go to
+your village, and tell your chiefs many things they cannot yet know.
+For the Big Buffalo and his young brother, I shall ask only the
+justice which the Onondagas know best how to give. For myself and my
+sister, I am not afraid. We will follow your course, to come back when
+the chiefs shall order it."
+
+The two Indians exchanged a few signs, rose, and went to the scattered
+group of braves, who were feasting on the white men's stores. In a
+moment these had thrown the bundles together, and were getting the
+canoes into the water. Two warriors cut Danton's thongs and raised him
+to his feet. He rubbed his wrists, where the thongs had broken the
+skin, and stepped about to get the stiffness from his ankles. Then he
+bent down to set Menard loose, but was thrown roughly back.
+
+"What's this? What's the matter? Do you understand this, Menard?"
+
+"I think so," replied the Captain, quietly.
+
+"What is it?"
+
+"A little compliment to me, that is all."
+
+Danton stood looking at him in surprise, until he was hustled to
+the nearest canoe and ordered to take a paddle. He looked back and
+saw four warriors lift Menard, still bound hand and foot, and
+carry him to the other canoe, laying him in the bottom beneath the
+bracing-strips. Father Claude, too, was given a paddle. Then they
+glided away over the still water, into a mysterious channel that
+wound from one shadow-bound stretch to another, past islands that
+developed faintly from the blackness ahead and faded into the
+blackness behind. The lean arms of the Indians swung with a
+tireless rhythm, and their paddles slipped to and fro in the water
+with never a sound, save now and then a low splash.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII.
+
+THE MAID MAKES NEW FRIENDS.
+
+
+The prisoners were allowed some freedom in the Onondaga village. They
+were not bound, and they could wander about within call of the low hut
+which had been assigned to them. This laxity misled Danton into
+supposing that escape was practicable.
+
+"See," he said to Menard, "no one is watching. Once the dark has come
+we can slip away, all of us."
+
+Menard shook his head.
+
+"Do you see the two warriors sitting by the hut yonder,--and the group
+playing platter among the trees behind us? Did you suppose they were
+idling?"
+
+"They seem to sleep often."
+
+"You could not do it. We shall hope to get away safely; but it will
+not be like that."
+
+Danton was not convinced. He said nothing further, but late on that
+first night he made the attempt alone. The others were asleep, and
+suspected nothing until the morning. Then Father Claude, who came and
+went freely among the Indians, brought word that he had been caught a
+league to the north. The Indians bound him, and tied him to stakes in
+a strongly guarded hut. This much the priest learned from Tegakwita,
+the warrior who had guarded them on the night of their capture. After
+Menard's appeal to his gratitude he had shown a willingness to be
+friendly, and, though he dared do little openly, he had given the
+captives many a comfort on the hard journey southward.
+
+Later in the morning Menard and Mademoiselle St. Denis were sitting at
+the door of their hut. The irregular street was quiet, excepting for
+here and there a group of naked children playing, or a squaw passing
+with a load of firewood on her back. An Indian girl came in from the
+woods toward them. She was of light, strong figure, with a full face
+and long hair, which was held back from her face by bright ribbons.
+Her dress showed more than one sign of Mission life. She was cleaner
+than most of the Indians, and was not unattractive. She came to them
+without hesitation.
+
+"I am Tegakwita's sister. My name is Mary; the Fathers at the Mission
+gave it to me."
+
+Menard hardly gave her a glance, but Mademoiselle was interested.
+
+"That is not your Indian name?" she asked.
+
+"Yes,--Mary."
+
+"Did you never have another?"
+
+"My other name is forgotten."
+
+"These Mission girls like to ape our ways," said Menard, in French.
+
+The girl looked curiously at them, then she untied a fold of her
+skirt, and showed a heap of strawberries. "For the white man's squaw,"
+she said.
+
+Mademoiselle blushed and laughed. "Thank you," she replied, holding
+out her hands. The girl gave her the berries, and turned away. Menard
+looked up as a thought came to him.
+
+"Wait, Mary. Do you know where the young white chief is?"
+
+"Yes. He tried to run away. He cannot run away from our warriors."
+
+"Are you afraid to go to him?"
+
+"My brother, Tegakwita, is guarding him. I am not afraid."
+
+Menard went to a young birch tree that stood near the hut, peeled off
+a strip of bark, and wrote on it:--
+
+"If you try to escape again you will endanger my plans. Keep your
+patience, and I can save you."
+
+"Will you take him some berries, and give him this charm with them?"
+
+She took the note, rolled it up with a nod, and went away. Menard saw
+the question in Mademoiselle's eyes, and said: "It was a warning to be
+cool. Our hope is in getting the good-will of the chiefs."
+
+"Will they--will they hurt him, M'sieu?"
+
+"I hope not. At least we are still alive and safe; and years ago,
+Mademoiselle, I learned how much that means."
+
+The maid looked into the trees without replying. Her face had lost
+much of its fulness, and only the heavy tan concealed the worn
+outlines. But her eyes were still bright, and her spirit, now that the
+first shock had passed, was firm.
+
+Father Claude returned, after a time, with a heavy face. He drew
+Menard into the hut, and told him what he had gathered: that the Long
+Arrow and his followers were planning a final vengeance against
+Captain Menard. All the braves knew of it; everywhere they were
+talking of it, and preparing for the feasting and dancing.
+
+"They will wait until after the fighting, won't they?"
+
+"No, M'sieu. It is planned to begin soon, within a day or two."
+
+"Have you inquired for the Big Throat?"
+
+"He is five leagues away, at the next village. We can hardly hope for
+help from him, I fear. All the tribes are preparing to join in
+fighting our troops."
+
+Menard paused to think.
+
+"It looks bad, Father." He walked up and down the hut. "The Governor's
+column must have followed up the river within a few days of us. Then
+much time was lost in getting us down here." He turned almost fiercely
+to the priest. "Why, the campaign may have opened already. Word may
+come to-morrow from the Senecas calling out the Onondagas and Cayugas.
+Do you know what that means? It means that I have failed,--for the
+first time in my life, Father,--miserably failed. There must be some
+way out. If I could only get word to the Big Throat. I'm certain I
+could talk him over. I have done it before."
+
+Father Claude had never before seen despair in Menard's eyes.
+
+"You speak well, M'sieu. There must be some way. God is with us."
+
+The Captain was again pacing the beaten floor. Finally he came to the
+priest, and took his arm. "I don't know what it is that gives me
+courage, Father, but at my age a man isn't ready to give up. They may
+kill me, if they like, but not before I've carried out my orders. The
+Onondagas must not join the Senecas."
+
+"How"--began the priest.
+
+Menard shook his head. "I don't know yet,--but we can do it." He went
+out of doors, as if the sunlight could help him, and during the rest
+of the day and evening he roamed about or lay motionless under the
+trees. The maid watched him until dark, but kept silent; for Father
+Claude had told her, and she, too, believed that he would find a way.
+
+Late in the evening Father Claude began to feel disturbed. Menard was
+still somewhere off among the trees. He had come in for his handful of
+grain, at the supper hour, but with hardly a word. The Father had
+never succeeded, save on that one occasion when Danton was the
+subject, in carrying on a long conversation with the maid; and now
+after a few sorry attempts he went out of doors. He thought of going
+to the Captain, to cheer his soul and prepare his mind for whatever
+fate awaited him, but his better judgment held him back.
+
+The village had no surface excitement to suggest coming butchery and
+war. The children were either asleep or playing in the open. Warriors
+walked slowly about, wrapped closely in blankets, though the night was
+warm. The gnats and mosquitoes were humming lazily, the trees barely
+stirring, and the voices of gossiping squaws or merry youths blended
+into a low drone. There was the smell in the air of wood and leaves
+burning, from a hundred smouldering fires. Father Claude stood for a
+long time gazing at the row of huts, and wondering that such an air of
+peace and happiness could hover over a den of brute savages, who were
+even at the moment planning to torture to his death one of the bravest
+sons of New France.
+
+While he meditated, he was half conscious of voices near at hand. He
+gave it no attention until his quick ear caught a French word. He
+started, and hurried to the hut, pausing in the door. By the dim light
+of the fire, that burned each night in the centre of the floor, he
+could see Mademoiselle standing against the wall, with hands clasped
+and lips parted. Nearer, with his back to the door, stood an Indian.
+
+The maid saw the Father, but did not speak. He came forward into the
+hut, and gently touched the Indian's arm.
+
+"What is it?" he asked in Iroquois.
+
+The Indian stood, without a reply, until the silence grew heavy.
+Mademoiselle had straightened up, and was watching with fascinated
+eyes. Then, slowly, the warrior turned, and beneath buckskin and
+feathers, dirt and smeared colours, the priest recognized Danton. He
+turned sadly to the maid.
+
+"I do not understand," he said.
+
+She put her hands before her eyes. "I cannot talk to him," she said,
+in a broken voice. "Why does he come? Why must I--" Then she collected
+herself, and came forward. Pity and dignity were in her voice. "I am
+sorry, Lieutenant Danton. I am very sorry."
+
+The boy choked, and Father Claude drew him, unresisting, outside the
+hut.
+
+"How did you come here, Danton? Tell me."
+
+Danton looked at him defiantly.
+
+"What does this mean? Where did you get these clothes?"
+
+"It matters not where I got them. It is my affair."
+
+"Who gave you these clothes?"
+
+"It is enough that I have friends, if those whom I thought friends
+will not aid me."
+
+The priest was pained by the boy's rough words.
+
+"I am sorry for this, my son,--for this strange disorder. Did you not
+receive a message from your Captain?"
+
+Danton hesitated. "Yes," he said at last. "I received a message,--an
+order to lie quiet, and let these red beasts burn me to death. Menard
+is a fool. Does he not know that they will kill him? Does he not know
+that this is his only chance to escape? He is a fool, I say."
+
+"You forget, my son."
+
+"Well, if I do? Must I stay here for the torture because my Captain
+commands? Why do you hold me here? Let me go. They will be after me."
+
+"Wait, Danton. What have you said to Mademoiselle?"
+
+The boy looked at him, and for a moment could not speak.
+
+"Do you, too, throw that at me, Father? It was all I could do. I
+thought she cared for her life more than for--for Menard. No, let me
+go on. I have risked everything to come for her, and she--she--I did
+not know it would be like this."
+
+"But what do you plan?" The priest's voice was more gentle. "Where are
+you going? You cannot get to Frontenac alone."
+
+"I don't know," replied Danton wearily, turning away. "I don't care
+now. I may as well go to the devil."
+
+Without a word of farewell he walked boldly off through the trees,
+drawing his blanket about his shoulders. Father Claude stood watching
+him, half in mind to call Menard, then hesitating. Already the boy was
+committed: he had broken his bonds, and to make any effort to hold him
+meant certain death for him. Perhaps it was better that he should take
+the only chance left to him. The hut was silent. He looked within, and
+saw the maid still standing by the wall. Her eyes were on him, but she
+said nothing, and he turned away. He walked slowly up and down under
+the great elms that arched far up over his head. At last he looked
+about for the Captain, and finding him some little way back in the
+woods, told him the story.
+
+Menard's face had aged during the day. His eyes had a dull firmness in
+place of the old flash. He heard the account without a word, and, at
+the close, when the priest looked at him questioningly for a reply, he
+shook his head sadly. His experiment with Danton had failed.
+
+"He didn't tell you who had helped him?"
+
+"No, M'sieu. It is very strange."
+
+"Yes," said Menard, "it is."
+
+The night passed without further incident. Early in the morning,
+Father Claude went out to find Tegakwita, and learn what news had come
+in during the night of the French column. Runners were employed in
+passing daily between the different villages, keeping each tribe fully
+informed.
+
+Menard sat before the hut. The clearing showed more life than on the
+preceding day. Bands of warriors, hunting and scouting parties, were
+coming in at short intervals, scattering to their shelters or hurrying
+to the long building in the centre of the village. The growing boys
+and younger warriors ran about, calling to one another in eager,
+excited voices. As the morning wore along, grave chiefs and braves,
+wrapped in their blankets, walked by on their way to the council
+house.
+
+The maid, after Father Claude had gone, watched the Captain for a long
+time through the open door. The conversation with the Long Arrow, on
+the night of their capture, had been burned into her memory; and now,
+as she looked at Menard's drawn face and weary eyes, the picture came
+to her again of the Long Arrow sitting by the river in the dim light
+of the stars,--and of the white man who had fought for her, lying
+before him, gazing upward and speaking with a calm voice to the stern
+chief who wished to kill him. Then, in spite of the excitement, the
+danger, and exhaustion of the fight, it had seemed that the Captain
+could not long be held by this savage. His stern manner, his command,
+had given her a confidence which had, until this moment, strengthened
+her. But now, of a sudden, she saw in his eyes the look of a man who
+sees no way ahead. This quarrel with the Long Arrow was no matter of
+open warfare, even of race against race; it was an eye for an eye, the
+demand of a crazed father for the life of the slayer of his son. That
+she could do nothing, that she must sit feebly while he went to his
+death, came to her with a dead sense of pain.
+
+With a restless spirit she went out of doors, passing him with a
+little smile; but he did not look up. A group of passing youths
+stopped and jeered at him, but he did not give them a glance. She
+shrank back against the building until they had gone on.
+
+"Do not mind them, Mademoiselle," said Menard, quietly. "They will not
+harm you."
+
+She hesitated by his side, half in mind to speak to him, to tell him
+that she knew his trouble, and had faith in him, but his bowed head
+was forbidding in its solitude. All about the hut, under the spreading
+trees, was a stretch of coarse green sod, dotted with tiny yellow
+flowers and black-centred daisies. She wandered over the grass,
+gathering them until her hands were full. Two red boys came by, and
+paused to cry at her, taunting her as if she, too, were to meet the
+fate of a war captive. The thought made her shudder, but then, on an
+impulse, she called to them in their own language. They looked at each
+other in surprise. She walked toward them, laying down the flowers,
+and holding out her hand. A little later, when Menard looked up, he
+saw her sitting beneath a gnarled oak, a boy on either side eagerly
+watching her. She was talking and laughing with them, and teaching
+them to make a screeching pipe with grass-blades held between the
+thumbs. He envied her her elastic spirits.
+
+"You have made two friends," he called in French.
+
+She looked up and nodded, laughing. "They are learning to make the
+music of the white brothers."
+
+The boys' faces had sobered at the sound of his voice. They looked at
+him doubtfully, and then at each other. He got up and walked slowly
+toward them.
+
+"I will make friends, too, Mademoiselle," he said, smiling. "We have
+none too many here."
+
+Before he had taken a dozen steps, the boys arose. He held out his
+hands, saying, "Your father would be friends with his children." But
+they began to retreat, a step at a time.
+
+"Come, my children," said the maid, smiling at the words as she
+uttered them. "The white father is good. He will not hurt you."
+
+They kept stepping backward until he had reached the maid's side;
+then, with a shout of defiance, they scampered away. In the distance
+they stopped, and soon were the centre of a group of children whom
+they taught to blow on the grass-blades, with many a half-frightened
+glance toward Menard and the maid.
+
+"There," he said, at length, "you may see the advantage of a
+reputation."
+
+She looked at him, and, moved by the pathos underlying the words,
+could not, for the moment, reply.
+
+"I once had a home in this village," he added. "It stood over there,
+in the bare spot near the beech tree." His eyes rested on the spot for
+a moment, then he turned back to the hut.
+
+"M'sieu," she said shyly.
+
+The little heap of flowers lay where she had dropped them; and, taking
+them up, she arranged them hastily and held them out. "Won't you take
+them?"
+
+He looked at her, a little surprised, then held out his hand.
+
+"Why,--thank you. I don't know what I can do with them."
+
+They walked back together.
+
+"You must wear some of the daisies, Mademoiselle. They will look
+well."
+
+She looked down at her torn, stained dress, and laughed softly; but
+took the white cluster he gave her, and thrust the stems through a
+tattered bit of lace on her breast.
+
+Menard was plainly relieved by the incident. He had been worn near to
+despair, facing a difficulty which seemed every moment farther from a
+solution; and now he turned to her fresh, light mood as to a refuge.
+
+"We must put these in water, Mademoiselle, or they will soon lose
+their bloom."
+
+"If we had a cup--?"
+
+"A cup? A woodsman would laugh at your question. There is the spring,
+here is the birch; what more could you have?"
+
+"You mean--?"
+
+"We will make a cup,--if you will hold the flowers. They are
+beautiful, Mademoiselle. No nation has such hills and lakes and
+flowers as the Iroquois. The Hurons boast of their lake country,--and
+the Sacs and Foxes, too, though they have a duller eye for the
+picturesque. See--the valley yonder--" He pointed through a rift in
+the foliage to the league-long glimpse of green, bound in by the
+gentle hills that rose beyond--"even to the tired old soldier there is
+nothing more beautiful, more peaceful."
+
+He peeled a long strip of bark from the birch tree, and rolled it into
+a cup. "Your needle and thread, Mademoiselle,--if they have not taken
+them."
+
+"No; I have everything here."
+
+She got her needle, and under his direction stitched the edges of the
+bark.
+
+"But it will leak, M'sieu."
+
+He laughed. "The tree is the Indian's friend, Mademoiselle. Now it is
+a pine tree that we need. The guards will tell me of one."
+
+He walked over to the little group of warriors still at their game of
+platter,--the one never-ceasing recreation of the Onondagas, at which
+they would one day gamble away blankets, furs, homes, even squaws,
+only to win them back on the next. They looked at him suspiciously
+when he questioned them; but he was now as light of heart as on the
+day, a few weeks earlier, when he had leaned on the balcony of the
+citadel at Quebec, idly watching the river. He smiled at them, and
+after a parley the maid saw one tall brave point to a tree a few yards
+farther in the wood. They followed him closely with their eyes until
+he was back within the space allowed him.
+
+"Now, Mademoiselle, we can gum the seams,--see? It is so easy. The
+cold water will harden it."
+
+They went together to the spring and filled the cup, first drinking
+each a draught. He rolled a large stone to the hut door, and set the
+cup on it.
+
+"Oh, Mademoiselle, it will not stand. I am not a good workman, I fear.
+But then, it is not often in a woodsman's life that he keeps flowers
+at his door. We must have some smaller stones to prop it up."
+
+"I will get them, M'sieu." In spite of his protests she ran out to the
+path and brought some pebbles. "Now we have decorated our home." She
+sat upon the ground, leaning against the log wall, and smiling up at
+him. "Sit down, M'sieu. I am tired of being solemn, we have been
+solemn so long."
+
+Already the heaviness was coming back on the Captain. He wondered, as
+he looked at her, if she knew how serious their situation was. It
+hardly seemed that she could understand it, her gay mood was so
+genuine. She glanced up again, and at the sight of the settling lines
+about his mouth and the fading sparkle in his eyes, her own eyes,
+while the smile still hovered, grew moist.
+
+"I am sorry," she said softly,--"very, very sorry."
+
+He sat near by, and fingered the flowers in the birch cup. They were
+both silent. Finally she spoke.
+
+"M'sieu."
+
+He looked down.
+
+"It may be that you think that--that I do not understand. It is not
+that, M'sieu. But when I think about it, and the sadness comes, I
+know, some way, that it is going to come out all right. We are
+prisoners, but other people have been prisoners, too. I have heard of
+many of them from Father Dumont. He himself has suffered among the
+Oneidas. I--I cannot believe it, even when it seems the darkest."
+
+"I hope you are right, Mademoiselle. I, too, have felt that there must
+be a way. And at the worst, they will not dare to hurt Father Claude
+and--you." And under his breath he added, "Thank God."
+
+"They will not dare to hurt you, M'sieu. They must not do it." She
+rose and stood before him. "When I think of that,--that you, who have
+done so much that I might be safe, are in danger, I feel that it would
+be cowardly for me to go away without you. You would not have left me,
+on the river. I know you would have died without a thought. And I--if
+anything should happen, M'sieu; if Father Claude and I should be set
+free, and--without you--I could never put it from my thoughts. I
+should always feel that I--that you--no no, M'sieu. They cannot do
+it."
+
+She shook away a tear, and looked at him with an honest, fearless
+gaze. It was the outpouring of a grateful heart, true because she
+herself was true, because she could not accept his care and sacrifice
+without a thought of what she owed him.
+
+"You forget," he said gently, "that it was not your fault. They could
+have caught me as easily if you had not been there. It is a soldier's
+chance, Mademoiselle. He must take what life brings, with no
+complaint. It is the young man's mistake to be restless, impatient.
+For the rest of us, why, it is our life."
+
+"But, M'sieu, you are not discouraged? You have not given up?"
+
+"No, I have not given up." He rose and looked into her eyes. "I have
+come through before; I may again. If I am not to get through, I shall
+fight them till I drop. And then, I pray God, I may die like a
+soldier."
+
+He turned away and went into the hut. He was in the hardest moment of
+his trial. It was the inability to fight, the lack of freedom, of
+weapons, the sense of helplessness, that had come nearer to
+demoralizing Menard than a hundred battles. He had been trusted with
+the life of a maid, and, more important still, with the Governor's
+orders. He was, it seemed, to fail.
+
+The maid stood looking after him. She heard him drop to the ground
+within. Then she roamed aimlessly about, near the building.
+
+Father Claude came up the path, walking slowly and wearily, and
+entered the hut. A moment later Menard appeared in the doorway and
+called:--
+
+"Mademoiselle." As she approached, he said gravely, "I should like it
+if you will come in with us. It is right that you should have a voice
+in our councils."
+
+She followed him in, wondering.
+
+"Father Claude has news," Menard said.
+
+The priest told them all that he had been able to learn. Runners had
+been coming in during the night at intervals of a few hours. They
+brought word of the landing of the French column at La Famine. The
+troops had started inland toward the Seneca villages. The Senecas were
+planning an ambush, and meanwhile had sent frantic messages to the
+other tribes for aid. The Cayuga chiefs were already on the way to
+meet in council with the Onondagas. The chance that the attack might
+be aimed only at the Senecas, to punish them for their depredations of
+the year before, had given rise to a peace sentiment among the more
+prudent Onondagas and Cayugas, who feared the destruction of their
+fields and villages. Up to the present, none had known where the
+French would strike. But, nevertheless, said the priest, the general
+opinion was favourable to taking up the quarrel with the Senecas.
+
+Further, the French were leaving a rearguard of four hundred men in a
+hastily built stockade at La Famine, and the more loose-tongued
+warriors were already talking of an attack on this force, cutting the
+Governor's communications, and then turning on him from the rear,
+leaving it to the Senecas to engage him in front.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX.
+
+THE WORD OF AN ONONDAGA.
+
+
+For a long time after Father Claude had finished speaking, the three
+sat talking over the situation. Even the maid had suggestions. But
+when all had been said, when the chances of a rescue by the French, or
+of getting a hearing before the council, even of a wild dash for
+liberty, had been gone over and over, their voices died away, and the
+silence was eloquent. D'Orvilliers would know that only capture could
+have prevented them from reaching the fort; but even supposing him to
+believe that they were held by the Onondagas, he had neither the men
+nor the authority to fight through the Cayuga lakes and hills to reach
+them. As for the Governor's column, it would have its hands full
+before marching ten leagues from La Famine. Had Menard been alone, he
+would have made the attempt to escape, knowing from the start that the
+chance was near to nothing, but glad of the opportunity at least to
+die fighting. But with Mademoiselle to delay their progress, and to
+suffer his fate if captured, it was different. As matters stood, she
+was likely to be released with Father Claude, as soon as he should be
+disposed of. And so his mind had settled on staying, and dying, if he
+must, alone.
+
+"I have not known whether to tell all," said Father Claude, after the
+silence. "And yet it would seem that Mademoiselle may as well know the
+truth now as later."
+
+"You have not told me?" she said, with reproach in her voice. "Must I
+always be a child to you, Father? If God has seen it best to place me
+here, am I not to help bear the burden?"
+
+"Mademoiselle is right, Father. Hold nothing back. Three stout hearts
+are better than two."
+
+The priest looked gravely at the fire.
+
+"The word has gone out," he said. "The Long Arrow, by his energy and
+his eloquence, but most of all because he had the courage to capture
+the Big Buffalo in the enemy's country with but a score of braves, now
+controls the village. To-morrow night the great council will begin.
+The war chiefs of all the Cayuga and Onondaga and Oneida and Mohawk
+villages will meet here and decide whether to take up the hatchet
+against the white men. The Long Arrow well knows that his power will
+last only until the greater chiefs come, and he will have his revenge
+before his day wanes."
+
+"When?" asked the Captain.
+
+"To-morrow morning, M'sieu. The feasting and dancing will begin
+to-night."
+
+The maid was looking at the priest. "I do not understand," she said.
+"What will he do?"
+
+"He means me, Mademoiselle," said the Captain, quietly.
+
+"Not--" she said, "not--"
+
+"Yes," he replied. "They will bring us no food to-night. In the
+morning they will come for me."
+
+"Oh, M'sieu, they cannot! They--" She gazed at him, not heeding the
+tears that suddenly came to her eyes and fell down upon her cheeks;
+and, as she looked, she understood what was in his mind. "Why do you
+not escape, M'sieu? There is yet time,--to-night! You are thinking of
+me, and I--I--Oh, I have been selfish--I did not know! We will stay
+here, Father Claude and I. You need not think of us; they will not
+harm us--you told me that yourself, M'sieu. I should be in your way,
+but alone--it is so easy." She would have gone on, but Menard held up
+his hand.
+
+"No," he said, shaking his head, "no."
+
+Her lips moved, but she saw the expression in his eyes, and the words
+died. She turned to Father Claude, but he did not look up.
+
+"I do not know," said Menard, slowly, "whether the heart of the Big
+Throat is still warm toward me. He was once as my father."
+
+"He will not be here in time," Father Claude said. "He does not start
+from his village until the sun is dropping on the morrow."
+
+The maid could not take her eyes from Menard's face. Now that the
+final word had come, now that all the doubts of the unsettled day, now
+only half gone, had settled into a fact to be faced, he was himself
+again, the quiet, resolute soldier. Only the set, almost hard lines
+about the mouth told of his suffering.
+
+"If we had a friend here," he was saying, quietly enough, "it may be
+that Tegakwita--But no, of course not. I had forgotten about
+Danton--"
+
+"Tegakwita has lost standing in the tribe for allowing Lieutenant
+Danton to escape. He is very bitter, We can ask nothing from him."
+
+"No, I suppose not."
+
+The cool air of these two men, the manner in which they could face the
+prospect, coupled with her own sense of weakness, weighed hard upon
+the maid's heart. She felt that she must cry out, must in some manner
+give way to her feelings. She rose and hurried into the open air. The
+broad sunlight was still sifting down through the leaves and lying
+upon the green earth in bright patches. The robins were singing, and
+many strange birds, whose calls she did not know, but who piped
+gently, musically, so in harmony with the soft landscape that their
+notes seemed a part of it. It was all unreal, this quiet, sunlit
+world, where the birds were free as the air which bore their songs,
+while the brave Captain--she could not face the thought.
+
+The birch cup was still on the stone by the door. She lifted out the
+flowers with their dripping stems, and rearranged them carefully,
+placing a large yellow daisy in the centre.
+
+An Indian was approaching up the path. He had thrown aside his
+blanket, and he strode rapidly, clad in close-fitting jacket and
+leggings of deerskin, with knife and hatchet slung at his waist. He
+came straight to the hut and entered, brushing by her without a
+glance. Just as he passed she recognized him. He was Tegakwita. Her
+fear of these stern warriors had suddenly gone, and she followed him
+into the doorway to hear his errand. Menard greeted him with a nod;
+Father Claude, too, was silent.
+
+"The White Chief, the Big Buffalo, has a grateful heart," said the
+Indian, in cutting tones. She was glad that she could understand him.
+She took a flower from the bunch at her breast, and stood motionless
+in the low doorway, pulling the petals apart, one by one and watching
+the little group within. The priest and the Captain were sitting on
+the ground, Menard with his hands clasped easily about his knees.
+Tegakwita stood erect, with his back to the door. "He feels the love
+of a brother for those who would make sacrifices for him," he went on.
+"It was many years ago that he saved Tegakwita from the perils of the
+hunt. Tegakwita has not forgotten. When the White Chief became a
+captive, he had not forgotten. He has lost his brave name as a warrior
+because he believed in the White Chief. He has lost--" his voice grew
+tremulous with the emotion that lay underneath the words--"He has lost
+his sister, whom he sent to be a sister to the white man and his
+squaw."
+
+"My brother speaks strangely," said Menard, looking up at him half
+suspiciously.
+
+"Yes, it is strange." His voice was louder, and in his excitement he
+dropped the indirect form of speech that, in the case of an older
+warrior, would have concealed his feelings. "It is strange that you
+should send my sister, who came to you in trust, to release the white
+brave. It is strange you should rob me of her whom my father placed by
+my side."
+
+Menard and Father Claude looked at each other. The Indian watched them
+narrowly.
+
+"My son is mistaken," said Father Claude, quietly. "His sister has
+wandered away. It may be that she has even now returned."
+
+"No, my Father. The white brave has stolen her."
+
+Menard got up, and spoke with feeling.
+
+"Tegakwita does not understand. The white brave was foolish. He is a
+young warrior. He does not know the use of patience. He first escaped
+against my orders. The word I sent by your sister was a command to be
+patient. He went alone, my brother. He has gone forever from my camp.
+It cannot be that she--"
+
+"The Big Buffalo speaks lies. Who came to cut the white brave's bonds?
+Who stole the hunting coat, the leggings of Tegakwita, that her lover
+might go free? Who has dishonoured herself, her brother, the father
+that--" Words failed him, and he stood facing them with blazing eyes.
+
+Menard glanced at the maid, but she had passed the point where a shock
+could sway her, and now stood quietly at the door, waiting to hear
+what more the warrior would say. But he stood motionless. Father
+Claude touched his arm.
+
+"If this is true, Tegakwita, the Big Buffalo must not be held to
+blame. He has spoken truly. To talk in these words to the man who has
+been your brother, is the act of a dog. You have forgotten that the
+Big Buffalo never speaks lies."
+
+The Indian gave no heed to his words. He took a step forward, and
+raised his hand to his knife. Menard smiled contemptuously, and spread
+out his hands; he had no weapon. But Tegakwita had a second thought,
+and dropped his hand.
+
+"Tegakwita, too, never speaks lies," he said. "He will come back
+before the sun has come again."
+
+He walked rapidly out, crowding roughly past the maid.
+
+Menajd leaned against the wall. "Poor boy!" he said, "poor boy!"
+
+The maid came slowly in, and sat on the rude bench which leaned
+against the logs near the door. The strain of the day was drawing out
+all the strength, the womanhood, that lay behind her buoyant youth.
+Already the tan was fading from her face, here in the hut and under
+the protecting elms; and the whiteness of her skin gave her, instead
+of a worn appearance, the look of an older woman,--firmer, with
+greater dignity. Her eyes had a deeper, fuller understanding.
+
+"I suppose that there is nothing, M'sieu--nothing that we can do?"
+
+Menard shook his head. "No; nothing."
+
+"And the Indian,--he says that he will come back?"
+
+"Yes. I don't know what he means. It doesn't matter."
+
+"No, I suppose it doesn't."
+
+They were silent for a moment. The maid leaned forward. "What was
+that, M'sieu?"
+
+"Loungers, on the path."
+
+"No, they are coming here."
+
+Menard rose, but she stepped to the door. "Let me go, M'sieu. Ah, I
+see them. It is my little friends." She went out, and they could hear
+her laughing with the two children, and trying to coax them toward the
+door.
+
+"Danton will never get away," said the Captain, in a low tone to the
+priest.
+
+"I fear not, M'sieu."
+
+"He has lost his head, poor boy. I thought him of better stuff. And
+the girl--Ah, if he had only gone alone! I could forgive his rashness,
+Father, his disobedience, if only he could go down with a clear
+name."
+
+"There is still doubt," said the priest, cautiously. "We know only
+what Tegakwita said."
+
+"I'm afraid," Menard replied, shaking his head, "I'm afraid it's true.
+You said he wore the hunting clothes. Some one freed him. And the girl
+is gone. I wish--Well, there is no use. I hoped for something better,
+that is all."
+
+Just outside the door the maid was talking gaily with the two
+children, who now and then raised their piping voices. Then it was
+evident that they were going away, for she was calling after them. She
+came into the hut, smiling, and carrying a small willow basket full of
+corn.
+
+"See," she said, "even now it is something to have made a friend. We
+shall not go hungry to-day, after all. Will you partake, Father? And
+M'sieu?"
+
+She paused before the Captain. He had stepped forward, and was staring
+at her.
+
+"Where are they?" he asked.
+
+"The children? They are wandering along the path."
+
+"Quick, Mademoiselle! Call them back."
+
+She hesitated, in surprise; then set the basket on the ground and
+obeyed. Menard paced the floor until she returned.
+
+"They are outside, M'sieu, too frightened to come near."
+
+"Give me that birch cup, outside the door." He was speaking in quick,
+low tones. "They must not see me. It would frighten them."
+
+She brought him the cup, and he emptied the flowers on the floor,
+tearing open the seams, and drying the wet white bark on his sleeve.
+He snatched a charred coal from the heap of ashes in the centre of the
+floor, and wrote rapidly in a strange mixture of words and signs, "A
+piece of thread, Mademoiselle. And look again--see that they have not
+gone."
+
+"They are waiting, M'sieu."
+
+He rolled the bark tightly, and tied it with the thread which she
+brought from her bundle.
+
+"We must have a present. Father Claude, you have your bale.
+Find something quickly,--something that will please them. No,
+wait--Mademoiselle, have you a mirror? They would run fifty
+leagues for a mirror."
+
+She nodded, rummaged through her bundle, and brought out a small
+glass.
+
+"Take this, Mademoiselle. Tell them to give this letter to the Big
+Throat, at the next village. They will know the way. He must have it
+before the day is over. No harm can come to them. If anyone would
+punish them, the Big Throat will protect them. You must make them do
+it. They cannot fail."
+
+Her face flushed, and her eyes snapped as she caught his nervous
+eagerness. Even Father Claude had risen, and was watching him with
+kindling eyes. She took the roll and the mirror, and ran out the door.
+In a moment, Menard, pacing the floor, could hear her merry laugh, and
+the shrill-voiced delight of the children over their new toy. He
+caught the priest's hand.
+
+"Father, we shall yet be free. Who could fail with such a lieutenant
+as that maid. How she laughs. One would think she had never a care."
+
+At last she came back, and sank, with a nervous, irresponsible little
+laugh, on the bench. And then, for the moment, they all three laughed
+together.
+
+In the silence that followed, Father Claude moved toward the door.
+
+"I must go out again, M'sieu. It may be that there is further word."
+
+"Very well, Father. And open your ears for news of the poor boy."
+
+The priest bowed, and went out. Menard stood in the door watching him,
+as he walked boldly along the path. After a little he turned. The maid
+was looking at him, still flushed and smiling.
+
+"Well, Mademoiselle, we can take hope again."
+
+"You are so brave, M'sieu."
+
+He smiled at her impulsiveness, and looked at her, hardly conscious
+that he was causing her to blush and lower her eyes.
+
+"And so I am brave, Mademoiselle? It may be that Major Provost and
+Major d'Orvilliers will not feel so."
+
+"But they must, M'sieu."
+
+"Do you know what they will say? They will speak with sorrow of
+Captain Menard, the trusted, in whose hands Governor Denonville placed
+the most important commission ever given to a captain in New France.
+They will regret that their old friend was not equal to the test; that
+he--ah, do not interrupt, Mademoiselle; it is true--that his failure
+lost a campaign for New France. You heard Father Claude; you know what
+these Indians plan to do."
+
+"You must not speak so, M'sieu. It is wicked. He would be a coward who
+could blame you. It was not your fault that you were captured. When I
+return I shall go to them and tell them how you fought, and how you
+faced them like--like a hero. When I return--" She stopped, as if the
+word were strange.
+
+"Aye, Mademoiselle, and God grant that you may return soon. But your
+good heart leads you wrong. It was my fault that I did not bring a
+force strong enough to protect myself,--and you. To fight is not a
+soldier's first duty. It is to be discreet; he must know when not to
+fight as well as when to draw his sword; he must know how many men are
+needed to defend his cause. No; I was overconfident, and I lost. And
+there we must leave it. Nothing more can be said."
+
+He stood moodily over the heap of ashes. When he looked at her again,
+she had risen.
+
+"The flowers, M'sieu," she said, "you--you threw them away."
+
+He glanced down. They lay at his feet. Silently he knelt and gathered
+them.
+
+"Will you help me, Mademoiselle? We will make another cup. And these
+two large daisies,--did you see how they rested side by side on the
+ground when I would have trampled on them? You will take one and I the
+other; and when this day shall be far in the past, it may be that you
+will remember it, and how we two were here together, waiting for the
+stroke that should change life for us."
+
+He held it out, and she, with lowered eyes, reached to take it from
+his hand, but suddenly checked the motion and turned to the door.
+
+"Will you take it, Mademoiselle?"
+
+She did not move; and he stood, the soldier, helpless, waiting for a
+word. He had forgotten everything,--the low, smoke-blackened hut, the
+responsibility that lay on his shoulders, the danger of the
+moment,--everything but the slender maid who stood before him, who
+would not take the flower from his hand. Then he stepped to her side,
+and, taking away the other flowers from the lace beneath her throat,
+he placed the single daisy in their stead. Her eyes were nearly
+closed, and she seemed hardly to know that he was there.
+
+"And it may be," he whispered softly, "that we, like the flowers,
+shall be spared."
+
+She turned slowly away, and sank upon the bench. Menard, with a
+strange, new lightness in his heart, went out into the sunlight.
+
+The day wore on. The warm sunbeams, that slipped down through the
+foliage, lengthened and reached farther and farther to the east. The
+bright spots of light crept across the grass, climbed the side of the
+hut and the tree-trunks, lingered on the upreaching twigs, and died
+away in the blue sky. The evening star shot out its white spears,
+glowing and radiant, long before the light had gone, or the purple and
+golden afterglow had faded into twilight. Menard's mind went back to
+another day, just such a glorious, shining June day as this had been,
+when he had sat not a hundred yards from this spot, waiting, as now,
+for the end. He looked at his fingers. They were scarred and knotted;
+one drunken, frenzied squaw had mangled them with her teeth. He had
+wondered then how a man could endure such torture as had come to him,
+and still could live and think, could even struggle back to health.
+The depression had gone from him now; his mind was more alert than
+since the night of the capture. Whether it was the bare chance of help
+from the Big Throat, or the gentle sadness in the face of the maid as
+she bowed her head to the single daisy on her breast,--something had
+entered into his nerves and heart, something hopeful and strong, He
+wondered, as Father Claude came up the path, slowly, laboriously, why
+the priest should be so saddened. After all, the world was green and
+bright, and life, even a few hours of it, was sweet.
+
+"What news, Father?"
+
+The priest shook his head. "Little, M'sieu."
+
+"Has the feast begun?"
+
+"Not yet. They are assembling before the Long House."
+
+"Are they drinking?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+There was no need for talk, and so the two men sat before the hut,
+with only an idle word now and then, until the dark came down. The
+quiet of the village was broken now by the shouts of drinking
+warriors, with a chanting undertone that rose and swelled slowly into
+the song that would continue, both men knew, until the break of day,
+or until none was left with sober tongue to carry the wavering air. A
+great fire had been lighted, and they could see the glare and the
+sparks beyond a cluster of trees and huts. Later, straggling braves
+appeared, wandering about, bottle or flask in hand, crazed by the raw
+brandy with which the English and Dutch of New York and Orange and the
+French of the province alike saw fit to keep the Indians supplied.
+
+A group of the warriors came from the dance, and staggered toward the
+hut of the captives. They were armed with knives and hatchets. One had
+an arquebuse, which he fired at the trees as often as the uncertain
+hands of all of them could load it. He caught sight of the white men
+sitting in the shadow, and came toward them, his fellows at his
+heels.
+
+"Move nearer the door," whispered Menard. "They must not get in."
+
+The two edged along the ground without rising, until they sat with
+their backs in the open doorway. The Indians hung about, a few yards
+away, jeering and shouting. The one with the arquebuse evidently
+wished to shoot, but the others were holding his arms, and reasoning
+in thick voices. No construction of the Iroquois traditions could make
+it right to kill a prisoner who was held for the torture.
+
+The white men watched them quietly. Menard heard a rustle, and the
+sound of a quick breath behind him, and he said, without taking his
+eyes from the Indians:--
+
+"Step back, Mademoiselle, behind the wall. You must not stand here."
+
+The warrior broke away from the hands that held him, staggering a rod
+across the grass before he could recover his balance. The others went
+after him, but he quickly rested the piece and fired. The ball went
+over their heads through the doorway, striking with a low noise
+against the rear wall. Menard rose, jerking away from the priest's
+restraining hand.
+
+"Mademoiselle," he said, "you are not hurt?"
+
+"No, M'sieu."
+
+"Thank God!" He stood glaring at the huddled band of warriors, who
+were trying to reload the arquebuse; then he bounded forward, broke
+into the group with a force that sent two to the ground, snatched the
+weapon, and, with a quick motion, drew out the flint. He threw the gun
+on the ground, and walked back to his seat.
+
+Two of the guards came running forward. They had not been drinking,
+and one of them ordered the loafers away. This did not strike them
+amiss. They started off, trying to reload as they walked, evidently
+not missing the flint.
+
+The maid came again to the doorway, and asked timidly:--
+
+"Is there danger for you, M'sieu? Will they come back?"
+
+"No. It is merely a lot of drunken youths. They have probably
+forgotten by now. Can you sleep, Mademoiselle?--have you tried?"
+
+"No, I--I fear that I could not."
+
+"It would be well to make the effort," he said gently, looking over
+his shoulder at her as she leaned against the doorpost. "We do not
+know what may happen. At any rate, even if you escape, you will need
+all your strength on the morrow. A fallen captain may not command,
+Mademoiselle, but--"
+
+"If it is your command, M'sieu, I will try. Good night."
+
+There was a long stillness, broken only by the distant noises of the
+dance.
+
+"You, too, will sleep, M'sieu?" said Father Claude. "I will watch."
+
+"No, no, Father."
+
+"I beg it of you. At the least you will let me divide the night with
+you?"
+
+"We shall see, we shall see. There is much to be said before either of
+us closes his eyes. Hello, here is a runner."
+
+An Indian was loping up the path. He turned in toward the hut.
+
+"Quiet," said the priest. "It is Tegakwita."
+
+The warrior had run a long way. He was breathing deeply, and the sweat
+stood out on his face and caught the shine of the firelight.
+
+"My brother has been far," said Menard, rising.
+
+"The White Chief is not surprised? He heard the word of Tegakwita,
+that he would return before another sun. He has indeed been far. He
+has followed the track of the forest wolf that stole the child of the
+Onondagas. He has found the bold, the brave white warrior, who stole
+away in the night, robbing Tegakwita of what is dearer to him than the
+beating of his heart."
+
+The maid stood again in the doorway, resting a hand on the post, and
+leaning forward with startled eyes.
+
+"He has found--he has found him--" she faltered.
+
+The Indian did not look at her. He drew something from the breast of
+his shirt, and threw it on the ground at Menard's feet. Then, with
+broken-hearted dignity, he strode away and disappeared in the night.
+
+Father Claude stooped, and picked up the object. Dimly in the
+firelight they could see it,--two warm human scalps, the one of brown
+hair knotted to the other of black. Menard took them in his hand.
+
+"Poor boy!" he said, over and over. "Poor boy!"
+
+He looked toward the door, but the maid had gone inside.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X.
+
+A NIGHT COUNCIL.
+
+
+The night crept by, as had the day, wearily.
+
+The two men sat in the doorway or walked slowly back and forth across
+the front of the hut, saying little. The Captain was calling to mind
+every incident of their capture, and of the original trouble between
+La Grange and the hunting party. He went over the conversation with
+Major Provost at Quebec word by word, until he felt sure in his
+authority as the Governor's representative; although the written
+orders in the leather bag that hung from his neck were concerned only
+with his duties in preparing Fort Frontenac for the advancing
+column,--duties that he had not fulfilled.
+
+A plan was forming in his mind which would make strong demands on the
+good faith of Major Provost and the Governor. He knew, as every old
+soldier knows, that governments and rulers are thankless, that even
+written authority is none too binding, if to make it good should
+inconvenience those who so easily give it. He knew further that if he
+should succeed now in staying the Onondagas and Cayugas by pledges
+which, perchance, it might not please Governor Denonville to observe,
+the last frail ties that held the Iroquois to the French would be
+broken, and England would reign from the Hudson to the river of the
+Illinois. And he sighed, as he had sighed many times before, for the
+old days under Frontenac, under the only Governor of New France who
+could hold these slippery redskins to their obligations.
+
+"Father," he said finally, "I begin to see a way."
+
+"The Big Throat?"
+
+"He must help, though to tell the truth I fear that he will be of
+little service. He may come in time to give us a stay; but, chief
+though he is, he will hardly dare overrule the Long Arrow on a matter
+so personal as this."
+
+"What is the Long Arrow's family--the Beaver?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"But, M'sieu, that is the least of the eight families. If it were the
+Tortoise or the Bear against us, we should have greater cause for
+fear."
+
+"True, Father, but to each family belongs its own quarrels, its own
+revenge. If the Big Throat should interfere too deeply, it would anger
+the other small families, who might fear the same treatment at some
+other time. And with Beaver, Snipe, Deer, and Potato united against
+us,--well, it is a simple enough problem."
+
+They were walking by the door, and Menard, as he spoke, sat on the
+stone which he had rolled there in the afternoon. The priest stood
+before him.
+
+"I hope we may succeed, my son. I have seen this anger before, and it
+has always ended in the one way."
+
+"Of course," the Captain replied, "it does depend on the Big Throat.
+He must reach here in time."
+
+"God grant that he may!"
+
+"In that case, Father, I look for a delay. Unless his heart has
+hardened rapidly, he still thinks of me. Together we will go to him,
+and ask a hearing in the war council."
+
+"Oratory will not release us, I fear, M'sieu."
+
+"We shall not ask to be released, Father. Don't you understand? It is
+more than that we shall demand,--it is peace with New France, the
+safety of the column--"
+
+The priest's eyes lighted. "Do you think, M'sieu--"
+
+"We can do it. They have not heard all the truth. They do not want a
+long war which will kill their braves and destroy their homes and
+their corn. It is this attack on the Senecas that has drawn them
+out."
+
+"You will tell them that the Governor fights only the Senecas?"
+
+"More than that. The La Grange affair has stirred them up. It has
+weakened their faith in the Governor,--it has as good as undone all
+the work of twenty years past. Our only hope is to reestablish that
+faith."
+
+"I hope that we may," said the priest, slowly. "But they have reached
+a state now where words alone will hardly suffice. I have tried it,
+M'sieu. Since we came, I have talked and reasoned with them."
+
+"Well, Father, I am going to try it. The question is, will the
+Governor make good what I shall have to promise? It may be that he
+will. If not,--then my life will not be worth a box of tinder if I
+stray a league from Quebec without a guard." He looked down at the
+daisy on his coat. "But the maid will be safe, Father. She will be
+safe."
+
+"I do not believe that they would harm her, even as it is."
+
+"No, I trust not--I trust not. But we are here, and she is here; and
+not until I know that her journey is over will my eyes close easily at
+night."
+
+"But your plan, M'sieu,--you have not told me."
+
+"Ah, I thought you understood. Did you know about the capture at
+Frontenac when it happened? No? It was like this. The Governor sent
+word, with the orders that came up to the fort in May, that at the
+first sign of trouble or disturbance with the Indians there,
+d'Orvilliers should seize a few score of them and send them down
+the river in chains. It would be an example, he said. I was
+awaiting orders,--I had just returned from the Huron Country and
+Michillimackinac,--and d'Orvilliers called me to his rooms and
+showed me the order. 'Now,' he said, 'who in the devil is meddling
+at Quebec?' I did not know; I do not know yet. But there was the
+order. He turned it over to La Grange, with instructions to wait until
+some offence should give him an excuse."
+
+"I know the rest, M'sieu."
+
+"Yes, yes. You have heard a dozen times,--how La Grange was drinking,
+and how he lied to a peaceful hunting party, and drugged them, and
+brained one poor devil with his own sword. And what could we do,
+Father? Right or wrong, the capture was made. It was too late to
+release them, for the harm was done. If d'Orvilliers had refused to
+carry out his orders and send them to Quebec, it would have cost him
+his commission."
+
+"And you, M'sieu?"
+
+"I was the only officer on detached service at the Fort. D'Orvilliers
+could not look me in the face when he ordered me to take them."
+
+"You will tell them this?"
+
+"This? Yes, and more. I will pledge the honour of New France that La
+Grange shall suffer. The man who has betrayed the Onondagas must be
+punished before we can have their good faith. Don't you understand?"
+
+Father Claude walked away a few steps, and then back, his hands
+clasped before him.
+
+"Don't you understand, Father? If a wrong has been done an Iroquois,
+it is revenge that will appease him. Very well. Captain la Grange has
+wronged them; let them have their revenge."
+
+"Is that the right view, M'sieu?"
+
+"Not for us, Father,--for you and me. To us it is simple justice. But
+justice,--that is not the word with which to reach an Indian."
+
+"But it may be that Captain la Grange is in favour at Quebec. What
+then?"
+
+"You do not seem to understand me yet, Father." Menard spoke slowly
+and calmly. "This is not my quarrel. I can take what my life brings,
+and thank your God, the while, that I have life at all. But if by one
+foolish act the Iroquois are to be lost to France, while I have the
+word on my tongue that will set all right, am I,--well, would you have
+me such a soldier?"
+
+The priest was looking through the leaves at the firelight. For once
+he seemed to have nothing to offer.
+
+"It will not be easy, Father; but when was a soldier's work easy?
+First I must make these Indians believe me,--and you know how hard
+that will be. Then I must convince Governor Denonville that this is
+his only course; and that will be still harder. Or, if they will not
+release me, you will be my messenger, Father, and take the word. I
+will stay here until La Grange has got his dues."
+
+"Let us suppose," said the priest,--"let us suppose that you did not
+do this, that you did not take this course against Captain la Grange
+which will leave him a marked man to the Iroquois, even if the
+Governor should do nothing."
+
+"Then," said Menard, "the rear-guard at La Famine will be butchered,
+and the army of New France will be cut to pieces. That is all."
+
+"You are sure of this?"
+
+"It points that way, Father."
+
+"Then let us take another case. Suppose that you succeed at the
+council, that you are released. Then if the Governor should disclaim
+responsibility, should--"
+
+"Then, Father, I will go to La Grange and make him fight me. I mean to
+pledge my word to these chiefs. You know what that means."
+
+"Yes," replied the priest, "yes." He seemed puzzled and unsettled by
+some thought that held his mind. He walked slowly about, looking at
+the ground. Menard, too, was restless. He rose from the stone and
+tossed away the pebbles that had supported the cup, one at a time.
+
+"They are singing again," he said, listening to the droning chant that
+came indistinctly through the dark. "One would think they would long
+ago have been too drunk to stand. How some of these recruits the King
+sends over to us would envy them their stomachs."
+
+The priest made no reply. He did not understand the impulse that led
+the Captain to speak irrelevantly at such a moment.
+
+"I suppose the doctors are dancing now," Menard continued. "It may be
+that they will come here. If they do, we shall have a night of it."
+
+"We will hope not, M'sieu."
+
+"If they should, Father,--well, it is hard to know just what to do."
+
+"You were thinking--?"
+
+"Oh, I was wondering. If they come here, and let their wild talk run
+away with them, it might be well to fight them off until morning.
+Maybe we could do it."
+
+"Yes, it might seem best."
+
+"But if--if the Big Throat should not come, or should have changed,
+then it would have been better that I had submitted."
+
+"You are thinking of me, my son. You must not. I will not leave you to
+go without a struggle. I can fight, if needs be, as well as you. I
+will do my part."
+
+"It is not that, Father. But if we fight, and the Big Throat does not
+come,--there is the maid. They would not spare her then."
+
+The priest looked at the Captain, and in the dim, uncertain light he
+saw something of the thought that lay behind those wearied eyes.
+
+"True," he said; "true."
+
+Menard walked up and down, a half-dozen steps forward, a half-dozen
+back, without a glance at the priest, who watched him closely.
+Suddenly he turned, and the words that were in his mind slipped
+unguarded from his tongue, low and stern:--
+
+"If they come, Father,--if they harm her,--God! if they even wake her,
+I will kill them."
+
+Father Claude looked at him, but said nothing. They walked together up
+and down; then, as if weary, they sat again by the door.
+
+"There are some things which I could not talk over with you," said the
+priest, finally. "It was best that I should not. And now I hardly know
+what is the right thing for me to do, or to say."
+
+"What troubles you?"
+
+"When you are cooler, it will come to you. For to-night,--until our
+last moment of choice,--I must ask one favour, M'sieu. You will not
+decide on this course until it comes to the end. You will think of
+other ways; you will--"
+
+"What else have I been doing, Father? There is no other way."
+
+"But you will not decide yet?"
+
+"No. We need not, to-night."
+
+The priest seemed relieved.
+
+"M'sieu," came in a low voice from the darkness within the hut, "may I
+not sit with you?"
+
+"You are awake, Mademoiselle? You have not been sleeping?"
+
+"No, I could not. I--I have not heard you, M'sieu,--I have not
+listened. But I wanted to very much. I have only my thoughts, and they
+are not the best of company to-night."
+
+"Come." Menard rose and got one of the priest's blankets, folding it
+and laying it on the ground against the wall. "I fear that we may be
+no better than the thoughts; but such as we are, we are at the service
+of Mademoiselle."
+
+She sat by them, and leaned back, letting her hands fall into her lap.
+Menard was half in the shadow, and he could let his eyes linger on her
+face. It was a sad face now, worn by the haunting fears that the night
+had brought,--fears that had not held their substance in the sunlight;
+but the eyes were still bright. Even at this moment she had not
+forgotten to catch up the masses of hair that were struggling to be
+free; and there was a touch of neatness about her torn dress that the
+hardships of the journey and the dirt and discomforts of an Indian
+shelter had not been able to take away. They all three sat without
+talking, watching the sparks from the fire and the tips of flame that
+now and then reached above the huts.
+
+"How strange their song is, M'sieu."
+
+"Yes. They will keep it up all night. If we were nearer, you would see
+that as soon as a brave is exhausted with the dancing and singing,
+another will rush in to take his place. Sometimes they fall fainting,
+and do not recover for hours."
+
+"I saw a dance once, at home. The Ottawas--there were but a few of
+them--had a war-dance. It seemed to be just for amusement."
+
+"They enjoy it. It is not uncommon for them to dance for a day when
+there is no hunt to occupy them."
+
+Father Claude had been silent. Now he rose and walked slowly away,
+leaving them to talk together. They could see him moving about with
+bowed head.
+
+"The Father is sad, M'sieu."
+
+"Yes. But it is not for himself."
+
+"Does he fear now? Does he not think that the Big Throat will come?"
+
+"I think he will come."
+
+The maid looked down at her clasped hands. Menard watched her,--the
+firelight was dancing on her face and hair,--and again the danger
+seemed to slip away, the chant and the fire to be a part of some
+mad dream that had carried him in a second from Quebec to this
+deep-shadowed spot, and had set this maid before him.
+
+"You are wearing the daisy, Mademoiselle."
+
+She looked up, half-startled at the change in his voice. Then her eyes
+dropped again.
+
+"See," he continued, "so am I. Is it not strange that we should be
+here, you and I. And yet, when I first saw you, I thought--"
+
+"You thought, M'sieu?"
+
+Menard laughed gently. "I could not tell you, without telling you what
+I think now, and that would--be--"
+
+He spoke half playfully, and waited; but she did not reply.
+
+"I do not know what it is that has come to me. It is not like me. Or
+it may be that the soldier, all these years, has not been me. Would it
+not be strange if I were but now to find myself,--or if you were to
+find me, Mademoiselle? If it is true, if this is what I have waited so
+long to find, it would be many years before I could repay you for
+bringing it to me,--it would be a long lifetime."
+
+Again he waited, and still she was silent. Then he talked on, as madly
+now as on the night of their capture, when he had fought, shouting,
+musket and knife in hand, at the water's edge. But this was another
+madness.
+
+"It is such a simple thing. Until you came out here under the trees my
+mind was racked with the troubles about us. But now you are here, and
+I do not care,--no, not if this were to be my last night, if to-morrow
+they should--" She made a nervous gesture, but he went on.
+
+"You see it is you, Mademoiselle, who come into my life, and then all
+the rest goes out."
+
+"Don't," she said brokenly. "Don't."
+
+Father Claude came slowly toward them.
+
+"My child," he said, "if you are not too wearied, I wish to talk with
+you."
+
+She rose with an air of relief and joined him. Menard watched them,
+puzzled. He could hear the priest speaking in low, even tones; and
+then the maid's voice, deep with emotion. Finally they came back, and
+she went hurriedly into the hut without a glance at the soldier, who
+had risen and stood by the door.
+
+"Come, M'sieu, let us walk."
+
+Menard looked at him in surprise, but walked with him.
+
+"It is about the speech to the council--and Captain la Grange. It may
+be that you are right, M'sieu."
+
+"Right? I do not understand."
+
+"It was but a moment ago that we talked of it."
+
+"Yes, I have not forgotten. But what do you mean now?"
+
+"You promised me to wait before deciding. It may be that I was wrong.
+If you are to make the speech, you will need to prepare it carefully.
+There is none too much time."
+
+"Yes," said Menard. Then suddenly he stopped and took the priest's
+arm. "I did not think, Father; I did not understand. What a fool I
+am!"
+
+"No, no, M'sieu."
+
+"You have talked with her. He is her cousin, and yet it did not come
+to me. It will pain her."
+
+"Yes," said Father Claude, slowly, "it will pain her. But I have been
+thinking. I fear that you are right. It has passed beyond the simple
+matter of our own lives; now it is New France that must be thought of.
+You have said that it was Captain la Grange's treachery that first
+angered the Onondagas. We must lay this before them. If his punishment
+will satisfy them, will save the rear-guard, why then, my son, it is
+our duty."
+
+They paced back and forth in silence. Menard's heavy breathing and his
+quick glances toward the hut told the priest something of the struggle
+that was going on in his mind. Suddenly he said:--
+
+"I will go to her, Father. I will tell her. I cannot pledge myself to
+this act if--if she--"
+
+"No, M'sieu, you must not; I have told her. She understands. And she
+has begged me to ask you not to speak with her. She has a brave heart,
+but she cannot see you now."
+
+"She asked you,--" said the Captain, slowly. "She asked you--I cannot
+think. I do not know what to say."
+
+The priest quietly walked back to the stone by the door, and left the
+soldier to fight out the battle alone. It was half an hour before he
+came back and stood before Father Claude.
+
+"Well, M'sieu?"
+
+Menard spoke shortly, "Yes, Father, you are right."
+
+That was all, but it told the priest that the matter had been finally
+settled. He had seen the look in the Captain's eyes when the truth had
+come to him; and he knew now what he had not dreamed before, that the
+soldier's heart had gone out to this maid, and now he must set his
+hand against one of her own blood. The Father knew that he would do
+it, would fight La Grange to the end. A word was trembling on his
+tongue, but as he looked at the seamed face before him, he could not
+bring himself to add a deeper sorrow to that already stamped there.
+
+"You must help me with the speech, Father. My wits are not at their
+best, I fear."
+
+"Willingly, M'sieu. And the presents,--we must think of that."
+
+"True. We have not the wampum collars. It must be something of great
+value that will take their place. You know how much tradition means to
+these people. Of course I have nothing. But you--you have your bale.
+And Mademoiselle--together you should find something."
+
+"I fear that I have little. My blankets and my altar they would not
+value. One moment--" He stepped to the door, and spoke softly,
+"Mademoiselle."
+
+"Yes, Father." She stood in the doorway, wearily. It was plain that
+she had been weeping, but she was not ashamed.
+
+"We shall need your help, Mademoiselle. Anything in your bale that
+would please the chiefs must be used."
+
+She was puzzled.
+
+"It is the custom," continued the priest, "at every council. To the
+Indians a promise is not given, a statement is not true, a treaty is
+not binding, unless there is a present for each clause. We have much
+at stake, and we must give what we have."
+
+"Certainly, Father."
+
+She stepped back into the darkness, and they could hear her dragging
+the bundle. Menard sprang to help.
+
+"Mademoiselle, where are you?"
+
+"Here, M'sieu."
+
+He walked toward the sound with his hands spread before him. One hand
+rested on her shoulder, where she stooped over the bale. She did not
+shrink from his touch. For a moment he stood, struggling with a mad
+impulse to take her slender figure in his arms, to hold her where a
+thousand Indians could not harm her save by taking his own strong
+life; to tell her what made this moment more to him than all the stern
+years of the past. It may be that she understood, for she was
+motionless, almost breathless. But in a moment he was himself.
+
+"I will take it," he said.
+
+He stooped, took up the bundle, and carried it outside. She followed
+to the doorway.
+
+"You will look, Mademoiselle."
+
+She nodded, and knelt by the bundle, while the two men waited.
+
+"There is little here, M'sieu. I brought only what was necessary. Here
+is a comb. Would that please them?"
+
+She reached back to them, holding out a high tortoise-shell comb. They
+took it and examined it.
+
+"It is beautiful," said Menard.
+
+"Yes; my mother gave it to me."
+
+"Perhaps, Mademoiselle,--perhaps there is something else, something
+that would do as well."
+
+"How many should you have, M'sieu?"
+
+"Five, I had planned. There will be five words in the speech."
+
+"Words?" she repeated.
+
+"To the Iroquois each argument is a 'word.'"
+
+"I have almost nothing else, not even clothing of value. Wait--here is
+a small coat of seal."
+
+"And you, Father?" asked Menard.
+
+"I have a book with highly coloured pictures, M'sieu,--'The Ceremonies
+of the Mass applied to the Passion of Our Lord.'"
+
+"Splendid! Have you nothing else?"
+
+"I fear not."
+
+Menard turned to the maid, who was still on her knees by the open
+bundle, looking up at them.
+
+"I am afraid that we must take your coat and the comb," he said. "I am
+sorry."
+
+She answered in a low tone, but firmly: "You know, M'sieu, that it
+would hurt me to do nothing. It hurts me to do so little."
+
+"Thank you, Mademoiselle. Well, Father, we must use our wits. It may
+be that four words will be enough, but I cannot use fewer. We have but
+three presents."
+
+"Yes," replied the priest, "yes." He walked slowly by them, and about
+in a circle, repeating the word. The maid leaned back and watched him,
+wondering. He paused before the Captain and seemed about to speak.
+Then abruptly he went into the hut, and they could hear him moving
+within. Menard and the maid looked at each other, the soldier smiling
+quietly. He understood.
+
+Father Claude came out holding the portrait of Catharine, the Lily of
+the Onondagas, in his hands.
+
+"It may be that this could be used for the fourth present," he said.
+
+Menard took it without a word, and laid it on the ground by the fur
+coat. The maid looked at it curiously.
+
+"Oh, it is a picture," she said.
+
+"Yes, Mademoiselle," the Captain replied. "It is the portrait of an
+Onondaga maiden who is to them, and to the French, almost a saint.
+They will prize this above all else."
+
+The maid raised it, and looked at the strangely clad figure. Father
+Claude quietly walked away, but Menard went after and gripped his
+hand.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI.
+
+THE BIG THROAT SPEAKS.
+
+
+The light of the rising sun struggled through the mist that lay on the
+Onondaga Valley. The trees came slowly out of the gray air, like ships
+approaching through a fog. As the sun rose higher, each leaf glistened
+with dew. The grass was wet and shining.
+
+Menard had seized a few hours of sleep. He awoke with the first beam
+of yellow light, and rose from his bed on the packed, beaten ground
+before the door. Father Claude was sitting on a log, at a short
+distance, with bowed head. The Captain stretched his stiff limbs, and
+walked slowly about until the priest looked up.
+
+"Good morning, Father."
+
+"Good morning, M'sieu."
+
+"It was a selfish thought that led me to choose the earlier watch.
+These last hours are the best for sleeping."
+
+"No, I have rested well."
+
+"And Mademoiselle?"
+
+"I have heard no sound. I think that she still sleeps."
+
+"Softly, then. There has been no disturbance?"
+
+"None. The singing has died down during the last hour. There, you can
+hear it, M'sieu."
+
+"Yes. But it is only a few voices. It must be that the others are
+sleeping off the liquor. They will soon awaken."
+
+"Listen."
+
+A musket was fired, and another.
+
+"That is the signal."
+
+The song, which one group after another had taken up all through the
+night, rose again and grew in volume as one at a time the sleepers
+aroused and joined the dance. The only sign of the fire was a pillar
+of thin smoke that rolled straight upward in the still air.
+
+"Father," said Menard, "are the guards about?"
+
+"I have not seen them. I suppose they are wandering within call."
+
+"Then, quickly, before we are seen, help me with this log."
+
+"I do not understand, M'sieu."
+
+"Into the hut with it, and the others, there. If a chance does
+come,--well, it may be that we shall yet be reduced to holding the
+hut. These will serve to barricade the door."
+
+They were not disturbed while they rolled the short logs within and
+piled them at one side of the door, where they could not be seen from
+the path.
+
+"Quietly, Father," whispered the Captain. He knew that the maid lay
+sleeping, back among the shadows. "And the presents,--you have packed
+them away?"
+
+"In my bundle, M'sieu. They will not be harmed."
+
+They returned to the open air, and looked about anxiously for signs of
+a movement toward the hut; but the irregular street was silent. Here
+and there, from the opening in the roof of some low building of bark
+and logs, rose a light smoke.
+
+"They are all at the dance," said Menard. His memory supplied the
+picture: the great fire, now sunk to heaps of gray ashes, spread over
+the ground by the feet of those younger braves who had wished to show
+their hardihood by treading barefoot on the embers; the circle of
+grunting figures, leaning forward, hatchet and musket in hand, moving
+slowly around the fire with a shuffling, hopping step; the outer
+circle of sitting or lying figures, men, women, and children, drunken,
+wanton, quarrelsome, dreaming of the blood that should be let before
+the sun had gone; and at one side the little group of old men, beating
+their drums of wood and skin with a rhythm that never slackened.
+
+The song grew louder, and broke at short intervals into shouts and
+cries, punctuated with musket-shots.
+
+"They are coming, M'sieu."
+
+The head of the line, still stepping in the slow movement of the
+dance, appeared at some distance up the path. The Long Arrow was in
+front, in full war-paint, and wearing the collar of wampum beads.
+Beside him was the Beaver. The line advanced, two and two, steadily
+toward the lodge of the white men.
+
+Menard leaned against the door-post and watched them. His figure was
+relaxed, his face composed.
+
+"Here are the doctors, Father."
+
+A group of medicine men, wildly clad in skins of beasts and reptiles,
+with the heads of animals on their shoulders, came running along
+beside the line, leaping high in the air, and howling.
+
+Menard turned to the priest. "Father, which shall it be,--shall we
+fight?"
+
+"I do not know, M'sieu. We have no weapons, and it may be, yet, that
+the Big Throat--"
+
+"Yes, I know."
+
+"And there is the maid, M'sieu."
+
+For the first time since the sunrise the quiet expression left the
+Captain's face. He was silent for a moment. Then he said:--
+
+"I will go, Father. You must protect her. If anything--if they should
+dare to touch her, you will--?"
+
+"I will fight them, M'sieu."
+
+"Thank you." Menard held out his hand. They gripped in silence, and
+turned again toward the Indians, who were now but a hundred yards
+away.
+
+"They will stop in a moment," said Menard, "and form for the gantlet.
+Yes,--see, the Long Arrow holds up his hands." He stood irresolute,
+looking at the fantastic picture; then he stepped back into the hut.
+
+The maid lay in her blanket on the bench. He stood over her, looking
+at the peaceful face that rested on her outstretched arm. He took her
+hand, and said gently:--
+
+"Mademoiselle."
+
+She stirred, and slowly opened her eyes; she did not seem surprised
+that he should be there clasping tightly her slender hand. He wondered
+if he had been in her dreams.
+
+"Good-bye, Mademoiselle."
+
+"You--you are going, M'sieu?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+She looked up at him with half-dazed eyes. She was not yet fully
+awake.
+
+"You must not fear," he said. "They cannot hurt you. You will soon be
+safe at--at Frontenac."
+
+She was beginning to understand. Then all at once the light came into
+her eyes, and she clung to his arm, which was still wet with the dew.
+
+"You are not going? They will not take you? Oh, M'sieu, I cannot--you
+must not!"
+
+She would have said more, but he bent down and kissed her forehead.
+Then, with his free hand he unclasped her fingers and went away. At
+the door he turned. She was sitting on the bench, gazing after him
+with a look that he never forgot. For all of the unhappiness, the
+agony, that came to him from those eyes, it was with a lighter heart
+that he faced the warriors who rushed to seize him.
+
+Every brave, woman, and child that the village could supply was in the
+double line that stretched away from a point on the path not a hundred
+yards distant to the long council house, which stood on a slight rise
+of ground. They were armed with muskets, clubs, knives,--with any
+instrument which could bruise or, mutilate the soldier as he passed,
+and yet leave life in him for the harder trials to follow. Five
+warriors, muskets in hand, had come to the hut. They sprang at Menard
+as he stepped out through the doorway, striking him roughly and
+holding his elbows behind his back.
+
+A shout went up from the waiting lines, and muskets and clubs were
+waved in the air. The Captain stepped forward briskly with head erect,
+scorning to glance at the braves who walked on either side. He knew
+that they would not kill him in the gantlet; they would save him for
+the fire. He had passed through this once, he could do it again,
+conscious that every moment brought nearer the chance of a rescue by
+the Big Throat. Perhaps twenty paces had been covered, and his
+guardians were prodding him and trying to force him into a run, when
+he heard a shout from the priest, and then the sounds of a struggle at
+the hut. He turned his head, but a rude hand knocked it back. Again he
+heard the priest's voice, and this time, with it, a woman's scream.
+
+The Captain hesitated for a second. The warriors prodded him again,
+and before they could raise their arms he had jerked loose, snatched a
+musket from one, and swinging it around his head, sent the two to the
+ground, one with a cracked skull. Before those in the lines could
+fairly see what had happened, he was running toward the hut with two
+captured muskets and a knife. In front of the hut the three other
+Indians were struggling with Father Claude, who was fighting in a
+frenzy, and the maid. She was hanging back, and one redskin had
+crushed her two wrists together in his hand and was dragging her.
+
+Menard was on them with a leap. They did not see him until a musket
+whirled about their ears, and one man fell, rolling, at the maid's
+feet.
+
+"Back into the hut!" he said roughly, and she obeyed. As he turned to
+aid the priest he called after her, "Pile up the logs, quick!"
+
+She understood, and with the strength that came with the moment, she
+dragged the logs to the door.
+
+Menard crushed down the two remaining Indians as he would have crushed
+wild beasts, without a glance toward the mob that was running at him,
+without a thought for the gash in his arm, made first by an arrow at
+La Gallette and now reopened by a knife thrust. The Father, too, was
+wounded, but still he could fight. There was but a second more. The
+Captain threw the four muskets into the hut, and after them the
+powder-horns and bullet-pouches which he had barely time to strip from
+the dead men. Then he crowded the priest through the opening above the
+logs, and came tumbling after. Another second saw the logs piled close
+against the door, while a shower of bullets and arrows rattled against
+them.
+
+"Take a musket, Father. Now, fire together! Quick, the others! Can you
+load these, Mademoiselle?"
+
+"Yes." She reached for them, and poured the powder down the barrels.
+
+"Not too much, Mademoiselle. We may run short."
+
+"Yes, M'sieu."
+
+To miss a mark in that solid mob would have been difficult. The first
+four shots brought down three men, and sent another limping away with
+a bleeding foot.
+
+"Keep it up, Father! Don't wait an instant. Fast, Mademoiselle, fast!
+Ah, there's one more. See, they are falling back. Take the other wall,
+Father. See that they do not come from the rear."
+
+The priest ran about the hut, peering through the chinks.
+
+"I see nothing," he called.
+
+"You had better stay there, then. Keep a close watch."
+
+The maid laid two loaded muskets at the Captain's side.
+
+"Can we hold them off, M'sieu?"
+
+His eye was pressed to an opening, and he did not turn.
+
+"I fear not, Mademoiselle. A few minutes more may settle it. But we
+can give them a fight."
+
+"If they come again, will you let me shoot, M'sieu?"
+
+He turned in surprise, and looked at her slight figure.
+
+"You, Mademoiselle?"
+
+"Yes; I can help. I have shot before."
+
+He laughed, with the excitement of the moment, and nodded. Then they
+were silent. She knelt by his side and looked through another opening.
+The women and children had retreated well up the path. The warriors
+were crowded together, just out of range, talking and shouting
+excitedly. A moment later a number of these slipped to the rear and
+ran off between the huts.
+
+"What does that mean, M'sieu? Will they come around behind?"
+
+"Yes. Watch out, Father. You will hear from them soon."
+
+"Very well, M'sieu. It will be hard. There are trees and bushes here
+for cover."
+
+Menard shrugged his shoulders, and made no reply. Time was all he
+wished.
+
+"If the Big Throat started with the first light, he should be here
+before another hour," he said to the maid, who was watching the
+Indians.
+
+"Yes," she replied.
+
+"Is there any corn in the basket, Mademoiselle?"
+
+"I think so. I had forgotten."
+
+"We shall need it. Wait; I will look."
+
+He got the basket, and brought it to her.
+
+"There is no time for cooking, but you had better eat what you can.
+And keep a close watch."
+
+"Here, M'sieu." She spread her skirt, and he poured out half of the
+corn.
+
+"You give me too much. You must not."
+
+He laughed, and crossed to the priest, saying over his shoulder:--
+
+"Mademoiselle is our new recruit. And the recruit must not complain of
+her food. I cannot allow it."
+
+The moments passed with no sign of action along the line of redskins
+on the path. They were quieter since the flanking party had started.
+To Menard it was evident that a plan had been settled upon. In a like
+position, a dozen Frenchmen would have stormed the hut, knowing that
+only two or three could fall before they were under the shelter of the
+walls; but even a large force of Indians was unwilling to take the
+chance.
+
+"Father," called the Captain, "it may be better for you to take the
+doorway. Mademoiselle and I will watch the forest."
+
+"Very well, M'sieu."
+
+The exchange was made rapidly.
+
+"Will you look out at the sides, as well?" Menard said to her. "Keep
+moving about, and using all the openings. There are too many chances
+for approach here."
+
+"If I see one, shall I shoot, M'sieu?"
+
+He smiled. "You had better tell me first."
+
+She stepped briskly about, peering through the chinks with an alert
+eye. Menard found it hard to keep his own watch, so eager were his
+eyes to watch her. But he turned resolutely toward the woods.
+
+"M'sieu!" she whispered. They had been silent for a long time. "To the
+left in the bushes! It looks like a head."
+
+"Can you make sure?"
+
+"Yes. It is a head. May I shoot?"
+
+Menard nodded without looking. She rested her musket in the opening
+between two logs, and fired quickly.
+
+"Did you hit him?"
+
+"Yes, I think so."
+
+She was breathless with excitement, but she reloaded at once. A moment
+later Menard fired, and then the priest.
+
+"On all sides, eh?" the Captain muttered. He called to the others:
+"Waste no powder. Shoot only when you are sure of hitting. They will
+fall back again. Two dead Indians will discourage the wildest
+charge."
+
+The firing went on at intervals, but still the warriors kept at it,
+creeping up from bush to bush and tree to tree. Menard's face grew
+more serious as the time went by. He began to realize that the Long
+Arrow was desperate, that he was determined on vengeance before the
+other chiefs could come. It had been a typical savage thought that had
+led him to bring Menard to this village, where he had once lived,
+rather than to the one in which the chief held greater permanent
+authority; the scheme was too complete and too near its end for delay
+or failure to be considered. Still the attacking party drew nearer,
+swelled every moment by a new group. Then Menard saw their object.
+They would soon be near enough to dash in close to the wall, where
+their very nearness would disable the white men's muskets.
+
+"Work fast!" he said suddenly. "They must not get nearer!"
+
+"Yes," panted the maid. Her shoulder was bruised by the heavy musket,
+her arms ached with the quick ramming and lifting, but she loaded and
+fired as rapidly as she could.
+
+"Father," called the Captain. "Quick! come here. They are too many for
+me!"
+
+The priest ran across the floor, half blinded by the smoke, cocking
+his musket as he came. "Where, M'sieu?"
+
+"There--at the oak! They are preparing for a rush!"
+
+He fired, at the last word, and one warrior sprawled on his face. The
+priest followed.
+
+"That will check them. Now back to the door!"
+
+Father Claude turned. The light was dim and the smoke heavy. His eyes
+smarted and blurred, so that he heard, rather than saw, the logs come
+crashing back into the hut. Menard heard it also; and together the two
+men dashed forward. They met the rush of Indians with blows that could
+not be stayed, but there was a score pushing behind the few who had
+entered. Slowly, the two backed across the hut. The stock of Menard's
+musket broke short off against the head of the Beaver. His foot struck
+another, and he snatched it up and fought on.
+
+"Mademoiselle," he called, "where are you?"
+
+"Here, M'sieu!"
+
+The voice was behind him. Then he felt a weight on his shoulder. The
+wearied maid, for want of another rest for her musket, fired past his
+face straight into the dark mass of Indians. She tried to reload, but
+Menard was swept back against her. With one arm he caught and held her
+tight against him, swinging the musket with his free hand. She clung
+to him, hardly breathing. They reached the rear wall. One tall warrior
+bounded forward and struck the musket from his hand. That was the end
+of the struggle. They were torn apart, and dragged roughly out into
+the blinding sunlight.
+
+Among the Iroquois, the torture was a religious rite, which nothing,
+once it was begun, could hasten. It may have been that the younger
+warriors would have rushed upon the captives to kill them; but if so,
+their elders held them back. The long lines formed again, and the
+doctors ran about the little group before the hut door, leaping and
+singing. Menard lay on his face, held down by three warriors. He tried
+to turn his head to see what had been done with the maid, but could
+not. He would have called to her, but to make a sound now would be to
+his captors an admission of weakness.
+
+A great clamour came from the lines. Menard wondered at the delay. He
+heard a movement a few yards away. Warriors were grunting, and feet
+shuffled on the ground. He heard the priest say, in a calm voice,
+"Courage, Mademoiselle"; and for a moment he struggled desperately.
+Then, realizing his mistake, he lay quiet. When at last he was jerked
+to his feet, he saw that the priest and the maid had been forced to
+take the two first places in the line. The maid was struggling in the
+grasp of two braves, one of whom made her hold a war club by closing
+his own hand over hers. Menard understood; his friends were to strike
+the first blows.
+
+The guards tried to drag him forward, but he went firmly with them,
+smiling scornfully. There was a delay, as the line was reached, for
+the maid could not be made to hold the club. Another man dropped out
+of the line to aid the two who held her.
+
+"Strike me, Mademoiselle," said Menard. "It is best."
+
+She shook her head. Father Claude spoke:--
+
+"M'sieu is right."
+
+It was then that she first looked at the Captain. When she saw the
+straight figure and the set face, a sense of her own weakness came to
+her, and she, too, straightened. Menard stepped forward; and raising
+the club she let it fall lightly on his shoulders. A shout went up.
+
+"Hard, Mademoiselle, hard," he said. "You must."
+
+She pressed her lips together, closed her eyes, and swung the club
+with all her strength. Then her muscles gave way, and she sank to the
+ground, not daring to look after the Captain as he passed on between
+the two rows of savages. She heard the shouts and the wild cries, but
+dimly, as if they came from far away. The confusion grew worse, and
+then died down. From screaming the voices dropped into excited
+argument. She did not know what it meant,--not until Father Claude
+bent over her and spoke gently.
+
+"What is it?" she whispered, not looking up. "What have they done?"
+
+"Nothing. The Big Throat has come."
+
+She raised her eyes helplessly.
+
+"He has come?"
+
+"Yes. I must go back. Take heart, Mademoiselle."
+
+He hurried away and slipped through the crowd that had gathered about
+Menard and the chief. She sat in a little heap on the ground, not
+daring to feel relieved, wondering what would come next. She could not
+see the Captain, but as the other voices dropped lower and lower, she
+could catch now and then a note of his voice. In a few moments, the
+warriors who were pressing close on the outskirts of the crowd were
+pushed aside, and he came out. She looked at him, then at the ground,
+shuddering, for there was blood on his forehead. Even when he stood
+over her she could not look up or speak.
+
+"There is hope now, Mademoiselle. He is here."
+
+"Yes--Father Claude told me. Is--are you to be released?"
+
+"Hardly that, but we shall at least have a little time. And I hope to
+get a hearing at the council."
+
+"He will let you?"
+
+"I have not asked him yet." He sat beside her, wearily. "There will be
+time for that. He is talking now with the Long Arrow and the old
+warriors. He is not fond of the Long Arrow." In the excitement he had
+not seen that she was limp and exhausted, but now he spoke quickly,
+"They have hurt you, Mademoiselle?"
+
+"No, I am not hurt. But you--your head--"
+
+"Only a bruise." He drew his sleeve across his forehead. "I had rather
+a bad one in the arm."
+
+He rolled up his sleeve in a matter-of-fact way. Her eyes filled.
+
+"Oh, M'sieu, you did not tell me. I can help you. Wait, I will be
+back."
+
+She rose, and started toward the spring, but he sprang to her side.
+
+"You must not trouble. It is not bad. There will be time for this."
+
+"No. Come with me if you will."
+
+She ran with nervous steps; and he strode after. At the side of the
+bubbling pool she knelt, and looked up impatiently.
+
+"It will not do to let this go, M'sieu. Can you roll your sleeve
+higher?"
+
+He tried, but the heavy cloth was stiff.
+
+"If you will take off the coat--"
+
+He unlaced it at the breast, and drew it off. She took his wrist, and
+plunged his arm into the pool, washing it with quick, gentle fingers,
+drying it on his coat. Then she leaned back, half perplexed, and
+looked around.
+
+"What is it?"
+
+"A cloth. No,"--as he reached for his coat;--"that is too rough. Here,
+M'sieu,--" she tore a strip from her skirt, and wrapped it around the
+forearm. "Hold it with your other hand, just a moment."
+
+She hurried to the hut, and returning with needle and thread, stitched
+the bandage. Then she helped him on with his coat, and they walked
+slowly to the hut.
+
+"Where is Father Claude?" she asked.
+
+He pointed to a thicket beyond the hut. There, kneeling by the body of
+a dying Indian, was the priest, praying silently. He had baptized the
+warrior with dew from the leaves at his side, and now was claiming his
+soul for the greater King in whose service his own life had been
+spent.
+
+The Captain sat beside the maid, their backs to the logs, and watched
+the shifting groups of warriors. He told her of the arrival of the Big
+Throat, and of the confusion that resulted. Then for a time they were
+silent, waiting for the impromptu council to reach a conclusion. The
+warriors finally began to drift away, though the younger and more
+curious ones still hung about. A group of braves came slowly toward
+the hut.
+
+"That is the Big Throat in front," said Menard. "The broad-shouldered
+warrior beside him is the Talking Eagle, the best-known chief of the
+clan of the Bear. They are almost here. We had better stand. Are you
+too tired?"
+
+"No, indeed."
+
+Father Claude had seen the group approaching, and he joined Menard.
+The Big Throat stood motionless and looked at the Captain.
+
+"My brother, the Big Buffalo, has asked to speak with the Big Throat,"
+he said at length.
+
+Menard bowed, but did not reply.
+
+"He asks for his release,--and for the holy man and the squaw?"
+
+"The Big Buffalo asks nothing save what the chiefs of the Onondagas
+would give to a chief taken in battle. The Long Arrow has lied to the
+Big Buffalo. He has soiled his hands with the blood of women and holy
+Fathers. The Big Buffalo was told by Onontio, whom all must obey, to
+come to the Onondagas and give them his word. The Long Arrow was
+impatient. He would not let him journey in peace. He wished to injure
+him; to let his blood. Now the Big Buffalo is here. He asks that he
+may be heard at the council, to give the chief the word of Onontio.
+That is all."
+
+The Big Throat's face was inscrutable. He looked at Menard without a
+word until the silence grew tense, and the maid caught her breath.
+Then he said, with the cool, diplomatic tone that concealed whatever
+kindness or justice may have prompted the words:--
+
+"The Big Buffalo shall be heard at the council to-night. The chiefs of
+the Onondagas never are deaf to the words of Onontio."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII.
+
+THE LONG HOUSE.
+
+
+The council-house was a hundred paces or more in length. The frame was
+of tall hickory saplings planted in the ground in two rows, with the
+tops bent over and lashed together in the form of an arch. The
+building was not more than fifteen yards wide. The lower part of the
+outer wall was of logs, the upper part and the roof of bark. Instead
+of a chimney there was a narrow opening in the roof, extending the
+length of the building.
+
+A row of smouldering fires reached nearly from end to end of the
+house. The smoke struggled upward, but failing, for the greater part,
+to find the outlet overhead, remained inside to clog the air and dim
+the eyes. The chiefs sat in a long ellipse in the central part of the
+house, some sitting erect with legs crossed, others half reclining,
+while a few lay sprawling, their chins resting on their hands. The Big
+Throat sat with the powerful chiefs of the nation at one end. The
+lesser sachems, including the Long Arrow, sat each before his own band
+of followers. The second circle was made up of the older and
+better-known warriors. Behind these, pressing close to catch every
+word of the argument, were braves, youths, women, and children, mixed
+together indiscriminately. A low platform extended the length of the
+building against the wall on each side, and this held another
+crowding, elbowing, whispering mass of redskins. Every chief and
+warrior, as well as most of the women, held each a pipe between his
+teeth, and puffed out clouds of smoke into the thick air.
+
+The maid's eyes smarted and blurred in the smoke. It reached her
+throat, and she coughed.
+
+"Lie down, Mademoiselle," said Menard. "Breathe close to the ground
+and it will not be so bad."
+
+She hesitated, looking at the Big Throat, who sat with arms folded,
+proud and dignified. Then she smiled, and lay almost flat on the
+ground, breathing in the current of less impure air that passed
+beneath the smoke. They had been placed in the inner circle, next to
+the chiefs of the nations, where Menard's words would have the weight
+that, to the mind of the Big Throat, was due to a representative of
+the French Governor, even in time of war. Father Claude, sitting on
+the left of the maid, was looking quietly into the fire. He had
+committed the case into the hands of Providence, and he was certain
+that the right words would be given to the Captain.
+
+It was nearing the close of the afternoon. A beam of sunlight slipped
+in at one end of the roof-opening, and slanted downward, clearing a
+shining way through the smoke. A Cayuga chief was speaking.
+
+"The corn is ripening in the fields about the Onondaga village. As I
+came down the hills of the west to-day I saw the green tops waving in
+the wind, and I was glad, for I knew that my brothers would feast in
+plenty, that their Manitous have been kind. The Cayugas, too, have
+great fields of corn, and the Senecas. Their women have worked
+faithfully that the land might be plentiful.
+
+"But a storm is breaking over the cornfields of the Senecas. It is a
+great cloud that has come down from the north, with the flash of fire
+and the roar of thunder, and with hailstones of lead that will leave
+no stalk standing. My brothers know the strength of the north wind.
+They have not forgotten other storms that would have laid waste the
+villages of the Senecas and the Mohawks. And they have not forgotten
+their Manitous, who have whispered to them when the clouds appeared in
+the northern sky, 'Rise up, Mohawks and Oneidas and Onondagas and
+Cayugas and Senecas, and stand firmly against this storm, and your
+homes and your fields shall not be destroyed.'"
+
+The house was silent with interest. The maid raised her head and
+watched the stolid faces of the chiefs in the inner circle. Not an
+expression changed from beginning to end of the speech. Beyond, she
+could see other, younger faces, some eager, some bitter, some defiant,
+some smiling, and all showing the flush of excitement,--but these grim
+old chiefs had long schooled their faces to hide their thoughts. They
+held their blankets close, and puffed deliberately at their pipes with
+hardly a movement of the lips.
+
+The Cayuga went on:--
+
+"Messengers have come to the Cayugas from their brothers, the Senecas,
+telling of the storm that is rushing on them. The Cayugas know the
+hearts of the Five Nations. When the Mohawks have risen to defend
+their homes, the hearts of the Cayugas have been warm, and they have
+taken up the hatchet with their brothers. When the Onondagas have gone
+on the war-path, Senecas and Cayugas have gone with them, and the
+trouble of one has been the trouble of all."
+
+"The good White Father is no longer the war chief of the white men.
+The Great Mountain, who knew the voice of the forest, who spoke
+with the tongue of the redman, has been called back to his
+Great-Chief-Across-the-Water. His word was the word of kindness, and
+when he spoke our hearts were warm. But another mountain is now the
+war chief, a mountain that spits fire and lead, that speaks with a
+double tongue. The Five Nations have never turned from a foe. The
+enemy of the Senecas has been the enemy of the Mohawks. If the storm
+strikes the fields of the Senecas, their brothers will not turn
+away and stop their ears and say they do not hear the thunder, for
+they remember the storms of other seasons, and they know that the
+hail that destroys one field will destroy other fields. And so this is
+the word of the Cayugas:--Let all the warriors of the Five Nations
+take up the hatchet; let them go on the war-path to tell this
+white chief with the double tongue that the Five Nations are one
+nation; that they are bolder than thunder, swifter than fire,
+stronger than lead."
+
+The maid found it hard, with her imperfect knowledge of the language,
+to follow his metaphors. She had partly risen, heedless of the smoke,
+and was leaning forward with her eyes fixed on the stern face of the
+speaker. Menard bent down, and half smiled at her excitement.
+
+"What is it?" she whispered. "He is for war?"
+
+"Yes; he naturally would be." There was a stir about the house, as the
+speech ended, and they could speak softly without drawing notice. "The
+Cayugas are nearer to the Senecas than the other nations, and they
+fear that they too may suffer."
+
+"Then you do not think they all feel with him?"
+
+"No; the Oneidas and Mohawks, and even the Onondagas, are too far to
+the east to feel in danger. They know how hard it would be for the
+Governor to move far from his base in this country. It may be that the
+younger warriors will be for fighting, but the older heads will think
+of the corn."
+
+"Will the Big Throat speak?"
+
+"Yes; but not like these others. He talks simply and forcibly. That is
+the way when a chief's reputation is made. The Big Throat won his
+name, as a younger brave, by his wonderful oratory."
+
+"And you, M'sieu,--you will be heard?"
+
+"Yes; I think so. We must not talk any more now. They will not like
+it."
+
+The Cayuga was followed by a wrinkled old chief of the Oneidas, called
+the Hundred Skins. He stepped forward and stood near the fire, his
+blanket drawn close about his shoulders, where the red light could
+play on his face. A whisper ran around the outer circle, for it was
+known that he stood for peace.
+
+"My Cayuga brother has spoken wisely," he began, in a low but distinct
+voice. He looked slowly about the house to command attention. "The
+Oneidas have not forgotten the storms of other seasons; they have not
+forgotten the times of starving, when neither the Manitous of the
+redman nor the God of the white man came to help. The grain stood
+brown in the fields; the leaves hung dead from the trees; there was no
+wind to cool the fever that carried away old men and young men, squaws
+and children. And when the wind came, and the cold and snow of the
+winter, there was no food in the lodges of the Five Nations. My
+brothers have heard that the corn is rising to a man's height--they
+have seen it to-day in the fields of the Onondagas. They know that
+this corn must be cared for like the children of their lodges, if they
+wish food to eat when the winter comes and the fields are dead. They
+know what it will cost them to take the war-path.
+
+"Twelve moons have not gone since the chiefs of the Senecas rose in
+this house and called on the warriors of the Five Nations to take up
+the hatchet against the white men of the north. The skins of the
+beaver were talking in their ears. They saw great canoes on the white
+man's rivers loaded with skins, and their hands itched and their
+hearts turned inward. Then the wise chiefs of the Oneidas and Cayugas
+and Onondagas and Mohawks spoke well. They were not on the war-path;
+the hatchet was deep in the ground, and young trees were growing over
+it. Then the Oneidas said that the White Chief would not forget if the
+Senecas heeded their itching hands and listened to the bad medicine of
+the beaver skins in their ears. But the Senecas were not wise, and
+they took up the hatchet.
+
+"This is the word of the Oneidas to the chiefs of the Long House:--The
+Seneca has put his foot in the trap. Then shall the Oneida and
+Onondaga and Cayuga and Mohawk rush after, that they too may put in
+their feet where they can get away only by gnawing off the bone? Shall
+the wise chiefs of the Long House run into fight like the dogs of
+their village? The Oneidas say no! The Senecas took up the hatchet;
+let them bury it where they can. And when the winter comes, the
+Oneidas will send them corn that they may not have another time of
+starving."
+
+Menard was watching the Oneida with eyes that fairly snapped. The low
+voice stopped, and another murmur ran around the outer circles. The
+Hundred Skins had spoken boldly, and the Cayuga young men looked
+stern. The chief stepped slowly back and resumed his seat, and then,
+not before, did Menard's face relax. He looked about cautiously to see
+if he was observed, then settled back and gazed stolidly into the
+fire. The old Oneida had played directly into his hand; by letting
+slip the motive for the Seneca raid of the winter before, he had
+strengthened the one weak point in the speech Menard meant to make.
+
+The next speaker was one of the younger war chiefs of the Onondagas.
+He made an effort to speak with the calmness of the older men, but
+there was now and then a flash in his eye and an ill-controlled vigour
+in his voice that told Menard and the priest how strong was the war
+party of this village. The Onondaga plunged into his speech without
+the customary deliberation.
+
+"Our brothers, the Senecas, have sent to us for aid. We have been
+called to the Long House to hear the voice of the Senecas,--not from
+the lips of their chiefs, for they have fields and villages to guard
+against the white man, and they are not here to stand before the
+council and ask what an Iroquois never refuses. The Cayuga has spoken
+with the voice of the Seneca. Shall the chiefs and warriors of the
+Long House say to the Cayuga, 'Go back to your village and send
+messengers to the Senecas to tell them that their brothers of the Long
+House have corn and squaws and children that are more to them than the
+battles of their brothers--tell the Senecas that the Oneidas must eat
+and cannot fight'? There is corn in the fields of the Oneidas. But
+there is food for all the Five Nations in the great house on the
+Lake."
+
+The speaker paused to let his words sink in. Menard whispered to the
+maid, in reply to an inquiring look. "He means the Governor's base of
+supplies at La Famine."
+
+The Onondaga's voice began to rise.
+
+"When the Oneida thinks of his corn, is he afraid to leave it to his
+squaws? Does he hesitate because he thinks the white warriors are
+strong enough to turn on him and drive him from his villages? This is
+not the speech that young warriors are taught to expect from the Long
+House. When has the Long House been guided by fear? No. If the Oneida
+is hungry, let him eat from the stores of the white man, at the house
+on the Lake. The Cayugas and Onondagas will draw their belts tighter,
+that the Oneida may be filled."
+
+The young chief looked defiantly around. There was a murmur from the
+outer circle, but the chiefs were grave and silent. The Hundred Skins
+gazed meditatively into the fire as if he had not heard, slowly
+puffing at his pipe. The taunt of cowardice had sprung out in the heat
+of youth; his dignity demanded that he ignore it. The speech had its
+effect on the Cayugas and the young men, but the older heads were
+steady.
+
+Other chiefs rose, talked, and resumed their places, giving all views
+of the situation and of the relations between the Iroquois and the
+French,--but still little expression showed on the inner circle of
+faces. The maid after a time grew more accustomed to the smoke, and
+sat up. She was puzzled by the conflicting arguments and the lack of
+enthusiasm. Fully two hours had passed, and there was no sign of an
+agreement. The eager spectators, in the outer rows, gradually settled
+down.
+
+During a lull between two speeches, Menard spoke to the maid, who was
+beginning to show traces of weariness.
+
+"It may be a long sitting, Mademoiselle. We must make the best of
+it."
+
+"Yes." She smiled. "I am a little tired. It has been a hard day."
+
+"Too hard, poor child. But I hope to see you safe very soon now. I am
+relying on the Big Throat. He, with a few of the older chiefs, sees
+farther than these hot-heads. He knows that France must conquer in the
+end, and is wise enough to make terms whenever he can."
+
+"But can he, M'sieu? Will they obey him?"
+
+"Not obey, exactly; he will not command them. Indians have no
+discipline such as ours. The chiefs rely on their judgment and
+influence. But they have followed the guidance of the Big Throat for
+too many years to leave it now."
+
+Another chief rose to speak. The sun had gone, and the long building
+was growing dark rapidly. A number of squaws came through the circle,
+throwing wood on the fires. The new flames shot up, and threw a
+flickering light on the copper faces, many of which still wore the
+paint of the morning. The smoke lay over them in wavering films, now
+and again half hiding some sullen face until it seemed to fade away
+into the darkness.
+
+At last the whole situation lay clear before the council. Some
+speakers were for war, some for peace, others for aiding the Senecas
+as a matter of principle. The house was divided.
+
+There was a silence, and the pipes glowed in the dusk; then the Long
+Arrow rose. The listless spectators stirred and leaned forward. The
+maid, too, was moved, feeling that at last the moment of decision was
+near. She was surprised to see that he had none of the savage
+excitement of the morning. He was as quiet and tactful in speech as
+the Big Throat himself.
+
+Slowly the Long Arrow drew his blanket close about him and began to
+speak. The house grew very still, for the whole tribe knew that he
+had, in his anger of the morning, disputed the authority of the Big
+Throat. There had been hot words, and the great chief had rebuked him
+contemptuously within the hearing of half a hundred warriors. Now he
+was to stand before the council, and not a man in that wide circle but
+wondered how much he would dare to say.
+
+He seemed not to observe the curious glances. Simply and quietly he
+began the narrative of the capture of the hunting party at Fort
+Frontenac. At the first words Menard turned to Father Claude with a
+meaning look. The maid saw it, and her lips framed a question.
+
+"It is better than I hoped," Menard whispered. "He is bringing it up
+himself."
+
+"Not two moons have waned," the Long Arrow was saying, "since five
+score brave young warriors left our village for the hunt. They left
+the hatchet buried under the trees. They took no war-paint. The Great
+Mountain had said that there was peace between the redman and the
+white man; he had asked the Onondagas to hunt on the banks of the
+Great River; he had told them that his white sons at the Stone House
+would take them as brothers into their lodges. When the Great Mountain
+said this, through the mouths of the holy Fathers, he lied."
+
+The words came out in the same low, even tone in which he had begun
+speaking, but they sank deep. The house was hushed; even the stirring
+of the children on the benches died away.
+
+"The Great Mountain has lied to his children,"--Menard's keen ears
+caught the bitter, if covered, sarcasm in the last two words; they
+had been Governor Frontenac's favourite term in addressing the
+Iroquois--"and his children know his voice no longer. There is corn
+in the fields? Let it grow or rot. There are squaws and children
+in our lodges? Let them live or die. It is not the Senecas who ask
+our aid; it is the voice of a hundred sons and brothers and youths
+and squaws calling from far beyond the great water,--calling from
+chains, calling from fever, calling from the Happy Hunting Ground,
+where they have gone without guns or corn or blankets, where they
+lie with nothing to comfort them." The Long Arrow stood erect, with
+head thrown back and eyes fixed on the opposite wall. "Our sons and
+brothers went like children to the Stone House of the white man.
+Their hands were stretched before them, their muskets hung empty
+from their shoulders, their bowstrings were loosened; the calumet was
+in their hands. But the sons of Onontio lied as their fathers had
+taught them. They took the calumet; they called the Onondagas into
+their great lodge; and in the sleep of the white man's fire-water
+they chained them. Five score Onondagas have gone to be slaves to
+the Great-Chief-Across-the-Water, who loves his children and is kind
+to them, and would take them all under his arm where no storm can
+harm them. My brothers of the Long House have heard the promises of
+Onontio, and they have seen the fork in his tongue. And so they
+choose this time to speak of corn and squaws and children." The
+keen, closely set eyes slowly lowered and swept around the circle.
+"Is this the time to speak of corn? Our Manitou has sent this
+Great Mountain into our country. He has placed him in our hands so
+that we may strike, so that we may tell the white man with our
+muskets that our Manitou is stern and just, and that no Iroquois
+will listen to the idle words of a double tongue."
+
+He paused, readjusted his blanket, and then stood motionless, that all
+might digest his words. Then, after a long wait, he went on:--
+
+"There are children to-day in our lodges who can remember the Big
+Buffalo, who can remember our adopted son who shared our fires and
+food, who shared our hunts, who lived with us as freely as an
+Onondaga. We saw him every day, and we forgot that his heart was as
+white as his skin, for his tongue was the tongue of an Onondaga. We
+forgot that the white man has two tongues. It has not been long, my
+brothers,--not long enough for an Onondaga to forget. But the Big
+Buffalo is a mangy dog. He forgot the brothers of his lodge. He it was
+who took the Onondaga hunters and carried them away to be slaves. But
+the Manitou did not forget. He has put this Big Buffalo into our
+hands, that we may give him what should be given to the dog who
+forgets his master."
+
+Again the Long Arrow paused.
+
+"No; this is not the time to speak of corn. It is not the Senecas who
+call us, it is our brothers and their squaws and children. The
+Iroquois have been the greatest warriors of the world. They have
+driven the Hurons to the far northern forests; the Illinois to the
+Father of Waters, two moons' travel to the west; the Delawares to the
+waters of the south. They have told the white man to stay within his
+boundaries, and he has stayed. They have been kind to the white man;
+they have welcomed the holy Fathers into their villages. But now the
+Great Mountain makes slaves of the Onondagas. He brings his warriors
+across the Great Lake to punish the Senecas and destroy their lodges.
+Shall the Long House of the Five Nations turn a white face to this
+Great Mountain? Shall the Long House call out in a shaking voice,
+'See, Onontio, there are no heads on our arrows, no flints in our
+muskets! our hatchets are dull, our knives nicked and rusted! come,
+Onontio, and strike us, that we may know you are our master and our
+father'?"
+
+The Long Arrow's voice had risen only slightly, but now it dropped; he
+went on, in a tone that was keen as a knife, but so low that those at
+the farther end of the house leaned forward and sat motionless.
+
+"It has been said to-day to the Long House that we shall close our
+ears to the thunder of the Great Mountain, that we should think of our
+corn and our squaws, and leave the Senecas to fight their own battles.
+But the Long House will not do this. The Long House will not give up
+the liberty that has been the pride of the Iroquois since first the
+rivers ran to the lake, and the moss grew on the trees, and the wind
+waved the tops of the long grass. The Great Mountain has come to take
+this liberty. He shall not have it. No; he shall lose his own--we will
+leave his bones to dry where the Seneca dogs run loose. The Big
+Buffalo shall die to tell the white man that the Iroquois never
+forgets; the Great Mountain shall die to tell the white man that the
+Iroquois is free."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII.
+
+THE VOICE OF THE GREAT MOUNTAIN.
+
+
+There was no lack of interest now in the council. The weariness left
+the maid's eyes as she followed the speeches that came in rapid
+succession. There was still the disagreement, the confusion of a dozen
+different views and demands; but the speech of the Long Arrow had
+pointed the discussion, it had set up an opinion to be either defended
+or attacked.
+
+"Will the Big Throat speak now?" asked Mademoiselle, leaning close to
+Menard.
+
+"I hardly think so. I don't know what will come next."
+
+"When will you speak, M'sieu?"
+
+"Not until word from the Big Throat. It would be a breach of
+courtesy."
+
+One warrior, a member of the Beaver family, and probably a blood
+relative of the Beaver who had been killed in the fight of the
+morning, took advantage of the pause to speak savagely for war and
+vengeance. He counted those who had fallen since the sun rose, and
+appealed to their families to destroy the man who had killed them. He
+was not a chief, but his fiery speech aroused a murmur of approval
+from scattered groups of the spectators. This sympathy from those
+about him, with the anger which was steadily fed by his own hot words,
+gradually drove from his mind the observance of etiquette which was so
+large a part of an important council. Still speaking, he left his
+place, and walking slowly between two of the fires and across the
+circle, paused before Menard.
+
+"The dog whom we fed and grew has turned against its masters, as the
+dogs of your own lodges, my brothers, will bite the hand that pats
+their heads. It has hung about outside of the Great Lodge to kill the
+hunter who sees no danger ahead. And now, when this dog is caught, and
+tied at your door, would not my brothers bring him to the end of all
+evil beasts?" As he finished, he made a gesture of bitter contempt and
+kicked Menard.
+
+A shout went up, and voices clamoured, protesting, denouncing,
+exulting. The Captain's eyes flashed fire. It was not for a second
+that he hesitated. Weakness, to an Indian, is the last, the greatest
+fault. If he should take this insult, it would end forever not only
+his own chance of escape, with the maid and the priest, but all hope
+of safety for the Governor's column. He sprang to his feet before the
+Indian, whose arm was still stretched out in the gesture, and with two
+quick blows knocked him clear of his feet, and then kicked him into
+the fire.
+
+A dozen hands dragged the warrior from the fire and stamped out a
+blaze that had started in the fringe of one legging. Every man in the
+house was on his feet, shouting and screaming. Menard stood with his
+hands at his side, smiling, with the same look of scorn he had worn in
+the morning when they led him to the torture. Father Claude drew
+closer to the maid, and the two sat without moving. Then above the
+uproar rose the voice of the Big Throat; and slowly the noise died
+away. The chief stepped to the centre of the circle, but before he
+could speak Menard had reached his side, and motioned to him to be
+silent.
+
+"My brothers," he said, looking straight at the fallen warrior, who
+was scrambling to his feet,--"my brothers, the Big Buffalo is sorry
+that the Onondagas have among them a fool who thinks himself a
+warrior. The Big Buffalo is not here to fight fools. He is here to
+talk to chiefs. He is glad that the fool speaks only for himself and
+not for the brave men of the Long House." He walked deliberately back
+and resumed his seat by the maid.
+
+[Illustration: "Menard stood ... smiling with the same look of scorn he
+had worn ... when they led him to the torture."]
+
+"Courage, Mademoiselle," he said close to her ear. "It is all right."
+
+"What will they do, M'sieu?"
+
+"Nothing. I have won. Wait--the Big Throat is speaking."
+
+One by one the warriors fell back to their seats. Some were muttering,
+some were smiling; but all were subdued. The Big Throat's voice was
+calm and firm.
+
+"The Big Buffalo has spoken well. The word of a fool is not the word
+of the Long House. The White Chief comes to give us the voice of
+Onontio, and we will listen."
+
+He turned toward Menard, and then resumed his seat.
+
+The Captain rose, and looked about the circle. The chiefs were
+motionless. Even the Long Arrow, now that his outburst was past,
+closed his lips over the stem of his pipe and gazed at the smoke.
+Father Claude drew forward the bundle and opened it, the maid helping.
+Some of the boys behind them crowded closer to see the presents.
+
+Menard spoke slowly and quietly. The rustling and whispering in the
+outer circle died away, so that every word was distinct.
+
+"When the Five Nations have given their word to another nation, it has
+not been necessary to sign a paper; it has not been necessary to keep
+a record. The Long Arrow has said that the Iroquois do not forget. He
+is right. The words that have gone out from the councils have never
+been forgotten. I see here, in this council, the faces of warriors who
+have grown old in serving their people, of chiefs who are bent and
+wrinkled with the cares of many generations. I see in the eyes of my
+brothers that they have not forgotten the Onontio, who went away to
+his greater chief only five seasons ago. They have seen this Onontio
+in war and peace. They have listened to his silver tongue in the
+council. They have called themselves his children, and have known that
+he was a wise and kind father. They remember the promises they made
+him. But the Senecas did not remember. The Seneca has no ears; he has
+a hole in his head, and the words of his father have passed through.
+The Senecas promised Onontio that they would not take the white man's
+beaver. But when the English came to their lodges and whispered in
+their ears, the hole was stopped. The English whispered of brandy and
+guns and powder and hatchets and knives. They told the Senecas that
+these things should be given to them if they would steal the beaver.
+The English are cowards--they sent the Senecas to do what they were
+afraid to do. And then the hole in the Seneca's head was stopped--the
+Seneca who had forgotten the words of Onontio remembered the words of
+the English.
+
+"My brothers of the Long House had not forgotten the promises they had
+given Onontio. When the Seneca chiefs called for aid in stealing the
+beaver, my brothers were wise and said no. The Onondagas and Cayugas
+and Oneidas and Mohawks were loyal--they kept their promise, and
+Onontio has not forgotten; he will not forget.
+
+"This is what the Great Mountain would say to you, my brothers: You
+have been faithful to your word, and he is pleased. He knows that the
+Onondagas are his children. And he knows why the Senecas left their
+villages and fields to plunder his white children. It was for the
+skins of the beaver, which the white braves had taken from their own
+forests and would bring in their canoes down the Ottawa to trade at
+the white man's villages. He knows, my brothers, that the Senecas had
+tired of their promises, and now would steal the beaver and sell it to
+the English. What comes to the boy when he climbs the tree to steal
+the honey which the bees have gathered and taken to their home? Is he
+not stung and bitten until he cries that he will not disturb the bees
+again? The Senecas have tried to take that which is to the white man
+as the honey is to the bee; and they too must be stung and bitten
+until they have learned that the Great Mountain will always protect
+those who deserve his aid. He has sent you a comb from the shell of
+the great sea-tortoise, more precious than a thousand wampum shells,
+to tell you that as the sea-monster pursues its enemies, so will he
+pursue those who cannot keep their promises--who lie to him."
+
+Father Claude handed him the comb, and he laid it before the Big
+Throat. It was evident that he had been closely followed, and he
+started on his second word with more vigour.
+
+"Your chiefs have spoken to-day of the storm cloud that has swept down
+from the north; your runners have told you that it is not a cloud, but
+an army, that has come up the great river and across the lake of
+Frontenac to the country of the Senecas. Do my brothers know what a
+great army follows their White Father when he sets out to punish his
+children? More than twenty score of trained warriors are in this war
+party, and every warrior carries a musket; to-night they are marching
+on the Seneca villages. They will destroy those villages as a brave
+would destroy a nest of hornets in his lodge. Not one lodge will be
+left standing, not one stalk of corn.
+
+"The Oneidas and Onondagas and Cayugas talk of their cornfields. But
+even the Cayugas need have no fear. For Onontio is a wise and just
+father; he punishes only those that offend him. The Senecas have
+broken their promises, and the Senecas must be punished, but the other
+nations are still the children of the Great Mountain, and his hand is
+over them. The Big Buffalo has come from the Great Mountain to tell
+you that he will not harm the Cayugas; their fields and lodges are
+safe."
+
+There was a stir at this, and then quiet, as the spectators settled
+back to hear the rest of Menard's speech. Here was a captive who spoke
+as boldly as their own chiefs, who commanded their attention as a
+present bearer from the White Chief. And they knew, all of them, from
+the way in which he was choosing his words, coolly ignoring the more
+important subjects until he should be ready to deal with them, that he
+spoke with authority. He knew his auditors, and he let them see that
+he knew them.
+
+"The Senecas have listened to the English. What do they expect from
+them? Do they think that the English wish to help them? Do they look
+for wealth and support from the English? My brothers of the Long House
+know better. They have seen the English hide from the anger of the
+Great Mountain. They have seen the iron hand of New France reach out
+across the northern country, and along the shores of the great lakes,
+and down the Father of Waters in the far west, while the English were
+clinging to their little strip of land on the edge of the sea. My
+brothers know who is strong and who is weak. Never have the fields of
+the Five Nations been so rich and so large. No wars have disturbed
+them. They have grown and prospered. Do the Senecas think it is the
+English who have made them great? No--the Senecas are not fools. They
+know that the Great Mountain has driven away their enemies and given
+them peace and plenty. My brothers of the Long House remembered this
+when the Senecas came to them and asked for aid in stealing the
+beaver. They stopped their ears; they knew that Onontio was their
+father, and that they must be faithful to him if they wished to have
+plenty in their lodges.
+
+"Onontio is a patient father. Let the Senecas repent, and he will
+forgive them. Let them bury the hatchet, and he will forgive them. Let
+them be satisfied with peace and honest trade, and he will buy their
+furs, and give them fair payment. And then their cornfields shall grow
+so large that a fleet runner cannot pass around them in half a moon.
+They shall have no more famine. Their pouches shall be full of powder,
+their muskets new and bright. Their women shall have warm clothing and
+many beads. Nowhere shall there be such prosperous nations as here
+among the Iroquois. If the Senecas have broken their pledges and have
+not repented, they must be punished. But the Cayugas and Onondagas and
+Oneidas and Mohawks have not broken their pledges. The Great Mountain
+has sent the Big Buffalo to tell them that he has seen that they are
+loyal, and he is pleased. He knows that they are wise. If the
+Onondagas have a grievance, he will not forget it, and if they ask for
+vengeance he will hear them. The Great Mountain knows that the
+Onondagas are his children, that they will not make war upon their
+father. He sends this coat of seal fur that the hearts of the Cayugas
+and Onondagas and Oneidas and Mohawks may be kept warm, and to tell
+them that he loves them and will protect them."
+
+The maid's eyes sparkled with excitement.
+
+"I wish they would speak, or laugh, or do something," she whispered to
+Father Claude, "Are they not interested? They hardly seem to hear
+him."
+
+The priest looked at her gravely.
+
+"Yes," he replied, "they are listening."
+
+The time had come to speak of La Grange. The Captain had been steadily
+leading up to this moment. He had tried to show the Indians that they
+had no complaint, no cause for war, unless it was the one incident at
+Fort Frontenac. He knew that the chiefs not only understood his
+argument, but that they were quietly waiting for him to approach this
+real cause of trouble, and were probably curious to see how he would
+meet it. The mind of the Iroquois, when in the council, separated from
+the heat and emotion of the dance, the hunt, the war-path, was
+remarkably keen. Menard felt sure that if he could present his case
+logically and firmly, it would appeal to most of the chief and older
+warriors. Then the maid came into his thoughts, and he knew, though he
+did not look down, that she was gazing up at him and waiting. He
+hesitated for a moment longer. The chiefs, too, were waiting. The Long
+House was hushed:--three hundred faces were looking at him through the
+twisting, curling smoke that blurred the scene into an unreal picture.
+Yes, the time had come to speak of La Grange; and he spoke the first
+words hurriedly, stepping half-unconsciously farther from the maid.
+
+There was a part of the true story of the capture which he did not
+tell,--the Governor's part. For the rest, it was all there, every word
+about La Grange and his treacherous act coming out almost brutally.
+
+"Your speakers have told you of the hunting party that was taken into
+the stone house, and put into chains, and sent away to be slaves to
+the Chief-Across-the-Water. There is a chief at the stone house whom
+you have seen fighting bravely in many a battle. He is a bold warrior;
+none is so quick or so tireless as Captain la Grange. But he has a
+devil in his heart. The bad medicine of white man and redman, the
+fire-water, is always close to him, ready to whisper to him and guide
+him. It was not the father at Quebec that broke the faith with the
+Onondagas. It was not the Big Buffalo. If the Big Buffalo could so
+forget his brothers of the Onondaga lodges, he would not have come
+back to the Long House to tell them of the sorrow of the Great
+Mountain. My brothers have seen the Big Buffalo in war and peace--they
+know that he would not do this.
+
+"The devil was in Captain la Grange's heart. He captured my brothers.
+He told the Great Mountain that it was a war party, that he had taken
+them prisoners fairly. He lied to the Great Mountain. When the Great
+Mountain asked the Big Buffalo to bring the prisoners to his great
+village on the river, the Big Buffalo could not say, 'No, I am no
+longer your son!' When the Great Mountain commands, the Big Buffalo
+obeys. With sorrow in his heart he did as his father told him."
+
+Menard was struggling to put the maid out of his thoughts, to keep in
+view only the safety of the column and the welfare of New France. And
+as the words came rapidly to his lips and fell upon the ears of that
+silent audience, he began to feel that they believed him.
+
+"My brothers," he said, with more feeling than they knew, "it is five
+seasons since I left your village for the land of the white man. In
+that time you have had no thought that I was not indeed your brother,
+the son of your chief. You have known other Frenchmen. Father Claude,
+who sits by my side; Father Jean de Lamberville, who has given his
+many years to save you for the great white man's Manitou; Major
+d'Orvilliers, who has never failed to give food and shelter to the
+starving hunter at his great stone house,--I could name a hundred
+others. You know that these are honest, that what they promise will be
+done. But in every village is a fool, in every family is one who is
+weak and cannot earn a name on the hunt. You have a warrior in this
+house who to-day raised his hand against a visitor in the great
+council. My brothers,--it is with sadness that I say it,--not all the
+white men are true warriors. You are wise chiefs and brave warriors;
+you know that because one man is a dog, it is not so with all his
+nation. The Great Mountain sends me to you, and I speak in his voice.
+I tell you that Captain la Grange is a dog, that he has broken the
+faith of the white man and the redman, that the father at Quebec and
+the Great-Chief-Across-the-Water, who are so quick to punish their red
+children, will also punish the white. The white men are good. They
+love the Onondagas. And if any white man breaks the faith, he shall be
+punished."
+
+His voice had risen, and he was speaking in a glow that seemed to drop
+a spark into each listening heart. He knew now that they believed. He
+turned abruptly for the present. Father Claude was so absorbed in
+following the speech, and in watching the maid, who sat with flushed
+cheeks and lowered eyes, that he was not ready, and Menard stooped and
+took the book. He could not avoid seeing the maid, when he looked
+down; and the priest felt a sudden pain in his own heart to see the
+look of utter weariness that came into the Captain's eyes.
+
+Menard turned the leaves of the book for a moment, as if to collect
+himself, and then held it open so that the Indians could see the
+bright pictures. There was a craning of necks in the outer circles.
+
+"In these picture writings is told the story of the 'Ceremonies of the
+Mass applied to the Passion of Our Lord,'" he said slowly. "And our
+Lord is your Great Spirit. It brings you a message; it tells you that
+the white man is a good man, who punishes his own son as sternly as
+his red child."
+
+The present pleased the Big Throat. He would not let his curiosity
+appear in the council, but he dropped the book so that it fell open,
+seemingly by accident, and his eyes strayed to it now and then during
+the last word of the speech. Menard did not hesitate again.
+
+"I have told my Onondaga brothers that this white dog shall be
+punished," he said. "When this word is given in your council in the
+voice of Onontio, it is a word that cannot be broken. Wind is not
+strong enough, thunder is not loud enough, waves are not fierce
+enough, snows are not cold enough, powder is not swift enough to break
+it." The words came swiftly from his lips. Calm old chiefs leaned
+forward that they might catch every syllable. Eyes were brighter with
+interest. The Long Arrow, thinking of his son and fearing lest the man
+who killed him should slip from his grasp, grew troubled and more
+stern. At last Menard turned, and taking the portrait from the
+priest's hands held it up, slowly turning it so that all could see it
+in the uncertain firelight. At first they were puzzled and surprised;
+then a murmur of recognition ran from lip to lip.
+
+"You know this maid," Menard was saying, "this maid who to all who
+love the Iroquois, to all who love the church, the Great Spirit, is a
+saint. Her spirit has been for many moons in the happy hunting ground.
+The snow has lain cold and heavy on her grave. The night bird has sung
+her beauty in the empty forest. Catherine Outasoren has come back from
+the land where the corn is always growing, where the snows can never
+fall; she has come back to bear you the word of the Great Mountain.
+She has come to tell you that the dog who broke the oath of the white
+man to the Onondagas must suffer. This is the pledge of the Great
+Mountain."
+
+He stopped abruptly, and stood looking with flashing eyes at the
+circle of chiefs. There was silence for a moment, then a murmur that
+rapidly rose and swelled into the loud chatter of many voices. Menard
+laid the portrait at the feet of the Big Throat, and took his seat at
+the side of the maid,--but he did not look at her nor she at him.
+Father Claude sat patiently waiting.
+
+There was low talk among the chiefs. Then a warrior came and led the
+captives out of doors, through a long passage that opened between two
+rows of crowding Indians. The night was clear, and the air was sweet
+to their nostrils. They walked slowly down the path. A group of young
+braves kept within a few rods.
+
+"It must be late," said Menard, in a weak effort to break the
+silence.
+
+"Yes," replied Father Claude.
+
+"I suppose we had better go back to our hut?"
+
+"Yes," said the priest again. But the maid was silent.
+
+They sat on the grass plot before the door, none of them having any
+words that fitted the moment. Menard brought out a blanket and spread
+it on the ground, that the maid need not touch the dew-laden grass.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV.
+
+WHERE THE DEAD SIT.
+
+
+"They need not starve us," said Menard, trying to speak lightly. "I am
+hungry."
+
+The others made no reply.
+
+"I will see what chance we have for a supper."
+
+He got up and walked along the path looking for the guards. In a short
+time he returned.
+
+"They will bring us something. The sentiment is not so strong against
+us now, I think."
+
+"They change quickly," said Father Claude.
+
+"Yes. It is the Big Throat."
+
+"And yourself, M'sieu," the maid said impulsively. "You have done it,
+too."
+
+"I cannot tell. We do not know what the council may decide. It may be
+morning before they will come to an agreement. The Long Arrow will
+fight to the last."
+
+"And the other, M'sieu,--the one who attacked you,--he too will
+fight?"
+
+"He is nothing. When an Iroquois shows himself a coward his influence
+is gone forever. It may be even that they will give him a new name
+because of this."
+
+"There are times when a small accident or a careless word will change
+the mind of a nation," said Father Claude. "When we left the council
+they were not unfriendly to us. But in an hour it may be that they
+will renew the torture. Until their hearts have been touched by the
+Faith there are but two motives behind the most of their actions,
+expediency and revenge. But I think we may hope. Brother de
+Lamberville has told of many cases of torture where the right appeal
+has brought a complete change."
+
+So they talked on, none having anything to say, and yet each dreading
+the silences that came so easily and hung over them so heavily. They
+could see the council-house some distance up the path. Its outlines
+were lost in the shadows of the trees, but through the crevices in the
+bark and logs came thin lines of light, and a glow shone through the
+long roof opening upon the smoke that hung in the still air above it.
+Sometimes they could hear indistinctly the voice of a speaker; but the
+words could not be distinguished. At other times there was a low buzz
+of voices. The children and women who had not been able to get into
+the building could be seen moving about outside shutting off a strip
+of light here and there.
+
+Two braves came with some corn and smoked meat. Menard set it down on
+a corner of the blanket.
+
+"You will eat, Mademoiselle?"
+
+She shook her head. "I am not hungry. Thank you, M'sieu."
+
+"If I may ask it,--if I may insist,--it is really necessary,
+Mademoiselle."
+
+She reached out, with a weary little gesture, and took some of the
+corn.
+
+"And you too, Father."
+
+They ate in silence, and later went together to the spring for a cool
+drink.
+
+"We ought to make an effort to sleep," Menard said; and added, "if we
+can. Father, you had better lie down. In a few hours, if there is no
+word, I will wake you."
+
+"You will not forget, M'sieu? You will not let me sleep too long."
+
+"No." The Captain smiled. "No, Father; you shall take your turn at
+guard duty."
+
+The priest said good-night, and went to a knoll not far from the door.
+The maid had settled back against the logs of the hut, and was gazing
+at the trees. Menard sat in silence for a few moments.
+
+"Mademoiselle," he said at length, "I know that it will be hard for
+you to rest until we have heard; but--" he hesitated, but she did not
+help him, and he had to go on,--"I wish you would try."
+
+"It would be of no use, M'sieu."
+
+"I know,--I know. But we have much to keep in mind. It has been very
+hard. Any one of us is likely to break. And you have not been so used
+to this life as the Father and I."
+
+"I know it," she said, still looking at the elm branches that bent
+almost to the ground before them, "but when I lie down, and close my
+eyes, and let my mind go, it seems as if I could not stand it. It is
+not bad now; I can be very cool now. You see, M'sieu?" She turned
+toward him with the trace of a smile. "But when I let go--perhaps you
+do not know how it is; the thoughts that come, and the dreams,--when I
+am awake and yet not awake,--and the feeling that it is not worth
+while, this struggle, even to what it may bring if we succeed. It
+makes the night a torture, and the dread of another day is even worse.
+It is better to stay awake; it is better even to break. Anything is
+better."
+
+Menard looked down between his knees at the ground. He did not
+understand what it was that lay behind her words. He started to speak,
+then stopped. After a little he found himself saying words that came
+to his lips with no effort; in fact, he did not seem able to check
+them.
+
+"It is not right that I should be here near you. I gave up that right
+to-night. I gave it up yesterday. I have been proud, during these
+years of fighting, that I was a soldier. I had thought, too, that I
+was a man. It was hardly a week ago that I rebuked that poor boy for
+what I have since done myself. I promised Major Provost that I would
+take you safely to Frontenac. That I have failed is only a little
+thing. I have said to you--no, you must not stop me. We have gone
+already beyond that point. We understand now. I have tried to be to
+you more than--than I had a right to be while you were in my care.
+Danton did not know; Father Claude does not know. You know, because I
+have told you. I have shown you in a hundred ways."
+
+"No," she said, in a choking voice. "It is my fault. I allowed you."
+
+He shook his head.
+
+"That is nothing. It is not what you have done. It is not even what
+you think. It is what I shall think and know all my life,--that I have
+done the wrong thing. There are some of us, Mademoiselle, who have no
+home, no ties of family, no love, except for the work in which we are
+slowly building up a good name and a firm place. That is what I was.
+Do you know what it is that makes up the life of such a man? It is the
+little things, the acts of every day and every week; and they must be
+honest and loyal, or he will fail. I might have stayed in Paris, I
+might even have found a place in Quebec where I could wear a bright
+uniform, and be close in the Governor's favour. I chose the other
+course. I have given a dozen years to the harder work, only to fall
+within the week from all that I had hoped,--had thought myself to be.
+And now, as I speak to you, I know that I have lost; that if you
+should smile at me, should put your hand in mine, everything that I
+have been working for would be nothing to me. You would be the only
+thing in the world."
+
+She sat motionless. He did not go on, and yet each moment seemed to
+bring them closer in understanding. After a little while she said
+huskily:--
+
+"You cared--you cared like that?"
+
+She was not looking toward him, and she could not see him slowly bow
+his head; but there was an answer in his silence.
+
+"You cared--when you made the speech--"
+
+"Yes."
+
+She looked at the stalwart, bowed figure. She was beginning to
+understand what he had done, that in his pledge to the chiefs he had
+triumphed over a love greater than she had supposed a man could bear
+for a woman.
+
+"A soldier cannot always choose his way," he was saying. "I have never
+chosen mine. It was the orders of my superior that brought us here,
+that brought this suffering to you. If it were not for these orders,
+the Onondagas would be my friends, and because of that, your friends.
+It has always been like this; I have built up that others might tear
+down. I thought for a few hours that something else was to come to me.
+I should have known better. It was when you took the daisy--" she
+raised her hand and touched the withered flower. "I did not reason. I
+knew I was breaking my trust, and I did not care. After all, perhaps
+even that was the best thing. It gave me strength and hope to carry on
+the fight. It was you, then,--not New France. Now the dream is over,
+and again it is New France. It must be that."
+
+"Yes," she said, "it must be."
+
+"I have had wild thoughts. I have meant to ask you to let me hope,
+once this is over and you safe at Frontenac. I could not believe that
+what comes so easily to other men is never to come to me. I cannot ask
+that now."
+
+She looked at him, and a sudden glow came into her eyes.
+
+"Why not?" she whispered, as if frightened.
+
+"Why not," he repeated, for an instant meeting her gaze. Then he rose
+and stood before her. "Because I have given an oath to bring Captain
+la Grange to punishment. You heard me. But you did not hear what I
+promised to Father Claude. I have sworn that what the Governor may
+refuse to do, I shall do myself. I have set my hand against your
+family."
+
+"You could not help it, M'sieu,--you could not help it," she said. But
+the light was going out of her eyes. It had been a moment of weakness
+for both of them. She looked up at him, standing erect in the faint
+light, and the sight of his square, broad shoulders seemed to give her
+strength. He was the strong one; he had always been the strong one.
+She rose and leaned back against the logs. She found that she could
+face him bravely.
+
+"He is your cousin," he had just said in a dry voice.
+
+"Yes, he is my cousin."
+
+Menard was steadily recovering himself.
+
+"We will not give all up. You know that I love you,--I hope that you
+love me." He hesitated for an instant, but she gave no sign. "We will
+keep the two flowers. We will always think of this day, and yesterday.
+I have no duty now but to get you safe to Frontenac; until you are
+there I must not speak again. As for the rest of it, we can only wait,
+and trust that some day there may be some light."
+
+She looked at him sadly.
+
+"You do not know? Father Claude has not told you?"
+
+Something in her voice brought him a step nearer.
+
+"You know that Captain la Grange is my cousin?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"You did not know that I am to be his wife?"
+
+They stood face to face, looking deep into each other's eyes, while a
+long minute dragged by, and the rustling night sounds and the call of
+the crickets came to their ears.
+
+"No," he said, "I did not know. May I keep the flower, Mademoiselle?"
+
+She bowed her head. She could not speak.
+
+"Good-night."
+
+"Good-night."
+
+He walked away. She saw him stop at the knoll where the priest lay
+asleep on a bed of boughs, and stand for a moment gazing down at him.
+Then he went into the shadows. From the crackling of the twigs she
+knew that he was walking about among the trees. She sank to the ground
+and listened to the crickets. A frog bellowed in the valley; perhaps
+he had been calling before--she did not know.
+
+She fell asleep, with her cheek resting against a mossy log. She did
+not know when Menard came back and stood for a long time looking at
+her. He did not awaken Father Claude until long after the time for
+changing the watch.
+
+When he did, he walked up and down on the path, holding the priest's
+arm, and trying to speak. They had rounded the large maple three times
+before he said:--
+
+"You did not tell me, Father."
+
+"What, my son?"
+
+The Captain stopped, and drawing the priest around, pointed toward the
+maid as she slept.
+
+"You did not tell me--why we are taking her to Frontenac."
+
+"No. She asked it. We spoke of it only once, that night on the river.
+She was confused, and she asked me not to speak. She does not know
+him. She has not seen him since she was a child."
+
+Menard said nothing. He was gripping the priest's arm, and gazing at
+the sleeping maid.
+
+"It was her father," added Father Claude.
+
+Menard's hand relaxed.
+
+"Good-night, Father." He walked slowly toward the bed on the knoll.
+And Father Claude called softly after him:--
+
+"Good-night, M'sieu. Good-night."
+
+Menard lay awake. He could see the priest sitting by the door. He
+wondered if the maid were sleeping. A late breeze came across the
+valley, arousing the leaves and carrying a soft whisper from tree to
+tree, until all the forest voices were joined. Lying on his side he
+could see indistinctly the council-house. There were still the lighted
+cracks; the Long House was still in session. Their decision did not
+now seem so vital a matter. The thought of the maid--that he was
+taking her to be the wife of another, and that other La Grange--had
+taken the place of all other thoughts.
+
+Later still came the buzz of many voices. Dark forms were moving about
+the council-house. Menard raised himself to his elbow, and waited
+until he saw a group approaching on the path, then he joined Father
+Claude.
+
+The Big Throat led the little band of chiefs to the hut. They stood,
+half a score of them, in a semicircle, their blankets drawn close,
+their faces, so far as could be seen in the dim light, stern and
+impassive. Menard and the priest stood erect and waited.
+
+"It has pleased the Great Mountain that his voice should be heard in
+the Long House of the Iroquois," said the Big Throat, in a low, calm
+voice. "His voice is gentle as the breeze and yet as strong as the
+wind. The Great Mountain has before promised many things to the
+Iroquois. Some of the promises he has broken, some he has kept. But
+the Onondagas know that there is no man who keeps all his promises.
+They once thought they knew such a man, but they were mistaken. White
+men, Indians,--all speak at night with a strong voice, in the morning
+with a weak voice. Each draws his words sometimes off the top of his
+mind, where the truth and the strong words do not lie. The Onondagas
+are not children. They know the friend from the enemy. And they know,
+though he may sometimes fail them, that the Great Mountain is their
+friend, their father."
+
+Menard bowed slowly, facing the chief with self-control as firm as his
+own.
+
+"They know," the Big Throat continued, "that the Indian has not always
+kept the faith with the white man. And then it is that the Great
+Mountain has been a kind father. If he thinks it right that our
+brothers, the Senecas, should meet with punishment for breaking the
+peace promised to the white man by the Long House, the Onondagas are
+not the children to say to their father, 'We care not if our brother
+has done wrong; we will cut off the hand that holds the whip of
+punishment.' The Onondagas are men. They say to the father, 'We care
+not who it is that has done wrong. Though he be our next of blood, let
+him be punished.' This is the word of the council to the Big Buffalo
+who speaks with his father's voice."
+
+Well as he knew the Iroquois temperament, Menard could not keep an
+expression of admiration from his eyes. He knew what this speech
+meant,--that the Big Throat alone saw far into the future, saw that in
+the conflict between red and white, the redman must inevitably lose
+unless he crept close under the arm that was raised to strike him. It
+was no sense of justice that prompted the Big Throat's words; it was
+the vision of one of the shrewdest statesmen, white or red, who had
+yet played a part in the struggles for possession of the New World.
+Greatest of all, only a master could have convinced that hot-blooded
+council that peace was the safest course. The chief went on:--
+
+"The Big Buffalo has spoken well to the council. He has told the
+chiefs that he has not been a traitor to the brothers who have for so
+long believed that his words were true words. The Big Buffalo is a
+pine tree that took root in the lands of the Onondagas many winters
+ago. From these lands and these waters, and the sun and winds that
+give life to the corn and the trees of the Onondagas, he drew his sap
+and his strength. Can we then believe that this pine tree which we
+planted and which has grown tall and mighty before our eyes, is not a
+pine tree at all? When a quick-tongued young brave, who has not known
+the young tree as we have, comes to the council and says that this Big
+Buffalo, this pine tree, is not a pine but an elm with slippery bark,
+are we to believe him? Are we to drop from our minds what our hearts
+and eyes have long known, to forget what we have believed? My brothers
+of the Long House say no. They know that the pine tree is a pine tree.
+It may be that in the haze of the distance pine and elm look alike to
+young eyes; but what a chief has seen, he has seen; what he has known,
+he has known. The Big Buffalo speaks the truth to his Onondaga
+brothers, and with another sun he shall be free to go to his white
+brothers."
+
+"The Big Throat has a faithful heart," said Menard, quietly. "He knows
+that the voice of Onontio is the voice of right and strength."
+
+"The chiefs of the Onondagas and Cayugas will sit quietly before their
+houses with their eyes turned toward the lands beyond the great lake,
+waiting for the whisper that shall come with the speed of the winds
+over forests and waters to tell them that the white man has kept his
+promise. When the dog who robbed our villages of a hundred brave
+warriors has been slain, then shall they know that the Big Buffalo is
+what they have believed him to be, their brother."
+
+"And the maid and the holy Father?"
+
+"They are free. The chiefs are sorry that a foolish brave has captured
+the white man's squaw."
+
+Menard and Father Claude bowed again, and the chiefs turned and strode
+away. The priest smiled gently after them.
+
+"And now, M'sieu, we may rest quietly."
+
+"Yes. You lie down, Father; it will not be necessary to watch now, and
+anyway I am not likely to sleep much." He walked back to the bed on
+the knoll, leaving the priest to stretch out across the doorway.
+
+The elder bushes and briers crowded close to the little clearing
+behind the hut, and Menard, lying on his side with his face close to
+the ground, watched the clusters of leaves as they gently rustled. He
+rolled half over and stared up at the bits of sky that showed through
+the trees. It seemed as if the great world were a new thing, as if
+these trees and bushes and reaches of tufted grass were a part of a
+new life. Before, they had played their part in his rugged life
+without asking for recognition; but to-night they came into his
+thoughts with their sympathy, and he wondered that all this great
+world of summer green and winter white, and of blue and green and
+lead-coloured water could for so long have influenced him without
+consciousness on his part. But his life had left little time for such
+thoughts; to-night he was unstrung.
+
+Over the noise of the leaves and the trickle of the spring sounded a
+rustle. It was not loud, but it was a new sound, and his eyes sought
+the bushes. The noise came, and stopped; came, and stopped. Evidently
+someone was creeping slowly toward the hut; but the sound was on the
+farther side of him, so that he could reach the maid's side before
+whoever was approaching could cross the clearing.
+
+For a time the noise died altogether. Then, after a space, his eyes,
+sweeping back and forth along the edge of the brush, rested on a
+bright bit of metal that for an instant caught the light of the sky,
+probably a weapon or a head ornament. Menard was motionless. Finally
+an Indian stepped softly out and stood beside a tree. When he began to
+move forward the Captain recognized Tegakwita, and he spoke his name.
+
+The Indian came rapidly over the grass with his finger at his lips.
+
+"Do not speak loud," he whispered. "Do not wake the holy Father."
+
+"Why do you come creeping upon my house at night, like a robber?"
+
+"Tegakwita is sad for his sister. His heart will not let him go among
+men about the village; it will not let his feet walk on the common
+path."
+
+"Why do you come?"
+
+"Tegakwita seeks the Big Buffalo."
+
+"It cannot be for an honest reason. You lay behind the bush. You saw
+me here and thought me asleep, but you did not approach honestly. You
+crept through the shadows like a Huron."
+
+"Tegakwita's night eyes are not his day eyes. He could not see who the
+sleeping man was. When he heard the voice, he came quickly."
+
+Menard looked at the musket that rested in the Indian's hand, at the
+hatchet and knife that hung from his belt.
+
+"You are heavily armed, Tegakwita. Is it for the war-path or the hunt?
+Do Onondaga warriors carry their weapons from house to house in their
+own village?"
+
+The Indian made a little gesture of impatience.
+
+"Tegakwita has no house. His house has been dishonoured. He lives
+under the trees, and carries his house with him. All that he has is in
+his hand or his belt. The Big Buffalo speaks strangely."
+
+Menard said nothing for a moment. He looked up, with a keen gaze, at
+the erect figure of the Indian. Finally he said:--
+
+"Sit down, Tegakwita. Tell me why you came."
+
+"No. Tegakwita cannot rest himself until his sister has reached the
+Happy Hunting-Ground."
+
+"Very well, do as you like. But waste no more time. What is it?"
+
+"The Big Buffalo has been an Onondaga. He knows the city in the valley
+where the dead sit in their graves. It is there that my sister lies,
+by an open grave, waiting for the farewell word of him who alone is
+left to say farewell to her. Tegakwita's Onondaga brothers will not
+gather at the grave of a girl who has given up her nation for a white
+dog. But he can ask the Big Buffalo, who brought the white dog to our
+village, to come to the side of the grave."
+
+"Your memory is bad, Tegakwita. It was not I who brought the white
+brave. It was you who brought him, his two hands tied with thongs."
+
+The Indian stood, without replying, looking down at him with
+brilliant, staring eyes.
+
+Menard spoke again.
+
+"You want me to go with you. You slip through the bushes like a snake,
+with your musket and your knife and your hatchet, to ask me to go with
+you to the grave of your sister. Do I speak rightly, Tegakwita?"
+
+"The Big Buffalo has understood."
+
+Menard slowly rose and looked into the Indian's eyes.
+
+"I have no weapons, Tegakwita. The chiefs who have set me free have
+not yet returned the musket which was taken from me. It is dangerous
+to go at night through the forest without a weapon. Give me your
+hatchet and I will go with you."
+
+Tegakwita's lip curled almost imperceptibly.
+
+"The White Chief is afraid of the night?"
+
+Menard, too, looked scornful. He coolly waited.
+
+"The Big Buffalo cannot face the dead without a hatchet in his hand?"
+said Tegakwita.
+
+Menard suddenly sprang forward and snatched the hatchet from the
+Indian's belt. It was a surprise, and the struggle was brief.
+Tegakwita was thrown a step backward. He hesitated between struggling
+for the hatchet and striking with the musket; before he had fully
+recovered and dropped the musket, Menard had leaped back and stood
+facing him with the hatchet in his right hand.
+
+"Now I will go with you to the city of the dead, Tegakwita."
+
+The Indian's breath was coming quickly, and he stood with clenched
+fists, taken aback by the Captain's quickness.
+
+"Come, I am ready. Pick up your musket."
+
+As Tegakwita stooped, Menard glanced toward the hut. The priest lay
+asleep before the door. It was better to get this madman away than to
+leave him free to prowl about the hut.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV.
+
+THE BAD DOCTOR.
+
+
+At the edge of the thicket they stopped and stood face to face, each
+waiting for the other to pass ahead. Tegakwita slightly bowed, with an
+unconscious imitation of the Frenchmen he had seen at Fort Frontenac
+and Montreal.
+
+"Pass on," said Menard, sternly. "You know the trail, Tegakwita; I do
+not. It is you who must lead the way."
+
+The Indian was sullen, but he yielded, plunging forward between the
+bushes, and now and then, in the shadow of some tree, glancing
+furtively over his shoulder. His manner, the suspicion that showed
+plainly in the nervous movements of his head, in every motion as he
+glided through thicket, glade, or strip of forest, told Menard that he
+had chosen well to take the second place. His fingers closed firmly
+about the handle of the hatchet. That he could throw at twenty paces
+to the centre of a sapling, no one knew better than Tegakwita.
+
+The city of the dead lay in a hollow at ten minutes' walk from the
+village. Generations ago the trees had been cleared, and no bush or
+sapling had been allowed a foothold on this ground. The elms and oaks
+and maples threw their shadows across the broad circle, and each
+breath of wind set them dancing over the mounds where many an hundred
+skeletons crouched side by side, under the grass-grown heaps of earth,
+their rusted knives and hatchets and their mouldy blankets by their
+sides. No man came here, save when a new heap of yellow earth lay
+fresh-turned in the sun, and a long line of dancing, wailing redmen,
+led by their howling doctors, followed some body that had come to
+claim its seat among the skeletons.
+
+Tegakwita paused at the edge of the clearing, and looked around with
+that furtive quickness. Menard came slowly to his side.
+
+"You will take your weapons to the grave?" asked Menard, very quietly,
+but with a suggestion that the other understood.
+
+"Yes. Tegakwita has no place for his weapons. He must carry them where
+he goes."
+
+"We can leave them here. The leaves will hide them. I will put the
+hatchet under this log." He made a motion of dropping the hatchet,
+closely watching the Indian; then he straightened, for Tegakwita's
+right hand held the musket, and his left rested lightly on his belt,
+not a span from his long knife.
+
+"The White Chief knows the danger of leaving weapons to tempt the
+young braves. He finds it easy to take the chance with Tegakwita's
+hatchet."
+
+"Very well," said Menard, sternly. "Lead the way."
+
+They walked slowly between the mounds. Menard looked carefully about,
+but in the uncertain light he could see no sign of a new opening in
+any of them. When they had passed the centre he stopped, and said
+quietly:--
+
+"Tegakwita."
+
+The Indian turned.
+
+"Where is the grave?"
+
+"It is beyond, close to the great oak."
+
+"Ah!"
+
+They went on. The great oak was in a dense, deep-shadowed place, at
+the edge of the circle. A little to one side, close to the crowding
+thicket, was a small, new mound. Looking now at Tegakwita, Menard
+could see that his front was stained with the soil. Probably he had
+spent the day working on the mound for his sister. While Menard stood
+at one side, he went to a bush that encroached a yard on the sacred
+ground and drew out a number of presents, with necessary articles and
+provisions to stay the soul on its long journey to the Happy
+Hunting-Ground. It was at the end of Menard's tongue to repeat
+Tegakwita's remark about hiding the weapons, but he held back and
+stood silently waiting.
+
+"Come," said the Indian.
+
+He parted the bushes, drew away a heavy covering of boughs, and there,
+wrapped in Tegakwita's finest blanket, lay the body of the Indian
+girl. Menard stood over it, looking down with a sense of pity he had
+never before felt for an Indian. He could not see her face, for it was
+pressed to the ground, but the clotted scalp showed indistinctly in
+the shadow. He suddenly raised, his eyes to Tegakwita, who stood
+opposite.
+
+"What have you done with the white brave?" he said in fierce, low
+tones. "What have you done with him?"
+
+Tegakwita raised one arm and swept it about in a quarter circle.
+
+"Ask the vultures that come when a man falls, ask the beasts that wait
+for everyone, ask the dogs of the village. They can tell you, not I."
+
+Menard's hands closed tightly, and a wild desire came to him to step
+across the body and choke the man who had killed Danton; but in a
+moment he was himself. He had nothing to gain by violence. And after
+all, the Indian had done no more than was, in his eyes, right. He bent
+down; and together they carried the body to the grave, close at hand.
+Tegakwita placed her sitting upright in the hole he had dug. By her
+side he placed the pots and dishes and knives which she had used in
+preparing the food they two had eaten. He set the provisions before
+her and in her lap; and drawing a twist of tobacco from his bosom, he
+laid it at her feet to win her the favour and kindness of his own
+Manitou on her journey. After each gift he stood erect, looking up at
+the sky with his arms stretched out above his head; and at these
+moments his simple dignity impressed Menard. But there were other
+moments, when, in stooping, Tegakwita would glance about with nervous,
+shifting eyes, as if fearing some interruption. His musket was always
+in his hand or by his side. Menard took it that he still feared the
+hatchet.
+
+Then at last the ceremony was done, and the Indian with his bare hands
+threw the earth over the hole in the mound. Still looking nervously
+from bush to bush, his hands began to move more slowly; then he
+paused, and sat by the mound, looking up with a hesitancy that
+recognized the need of an explanation for the delay.
+
+"Tegakwita's arms are weary."
+
+"Are they?" said Menard, dryly.
+
+"Tegakwita has not slept for many suns."
+
+"Neither have I."
+
+The Indian started as a rustle came from the forest. Menard watched
+him curiously. The whole proceeding was too unusual to be easily
+understood. Tegakwita's nervous manner, his request that the Captain
+accompany him to the mound, the weapons that never left his
+side,--these might be the signs of a mind driven to madness by his
+sister's act; but Menard did not recollect, from his own observation
+of the Iroquois character, that love for a sister was a marked trait
+among the able-bodied braves. Perhaps it was delay that he sought. At
+this thought Menard quietly moved farther from the undergrowth.
+Tegakwita's quick eyes followed the movement.
+
+"Come," said the Captain, "the night is nearly gone. I cannot wait
+longer."
+
+"Tegakwita has worked hard. His heart is sick, his body lame. Will the
+Big Buffalo help his Onondaga brother?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+The Indian rose with too prompt relief.
+
+"Your muscles need only the promise of help to give them back their
+spring, Tegakwita."
+
+"The White Chief speaks with a biting tongue."
+
+"You have been speaking with a lying tongue. You think I do not know
+why you have brought me here; you think I do not understand the evil
+thoughts that fill your mind. You are a coward, Tegakwita. But you
+will not succeed to-night."
+
+The ill-concealed fright that came into the Indian's face and manner
+told Menard that he was not wide of the mark. He began to understand.
+Tegakwita wished to get him at work and off his guard,--the rest would
+be simple. And as Menard well knew, more than one brave of the
+Onondagas, who had known him both as friend and enemy, would shrink
+when the moment came to attack the Big Buffalo single-handed, even
+though taking him at a disadvantage. Now Tegakwita was hesitating, and
+struggling to keep his eyes from the thicket.
+
+"Yes, I will help you. We will close this matter now, and go back to
+the village where your cowardly hands will be tied by fear of your
+chiefs. Drop your musket."
+
+"The Big Buffalo speaks in anger. Does he think to disarm Tegakwita
+that he may kill him?"
+
+"Lay your musket on the ground before us. Then I will drop the
+hatchet."
+
+Tegakwita stepped around the grave, and leaning the musket across a
+stone stood by it. Menard's voice was full of contempt.
+
+"You need not fear. The Big Buffalo keeps his word." He tossed the
+hatchet over the grave, and stood unarmed. "Drop your knife."
+
+Tegakwita hesitated. Menard took a step forward, and the knife fell to
+the ground.
+
+"Come. We will work side by side." He was surprised at Tegakwita's
+slinking manner. He wondered if this Indian could by some strange
+accident have been given a temperament so fine that sorrow could unman
+him. To the Iroquois, gifted as they were with reasoning power, life
+held little sentiment. Curiously enough, as Menard stood in the light
+of the young moon watching the warrior come slowly around the grave,
+which still showed above the earth the head and shoulders of the dead
+girl, he found himself calling up the rare instances he had known of a
+real affection between Indians.
+
+Tegakwita stood by him, and without a word they stooped and set to
+work, side by side, scraping the earth with their fingers over the
+body. Tegakwita found a dozen little ways to delay. Menard steadily
+lost patience.
+
+"Tegakwita has forgotten," said the Indian, standing up; "he has not
+offered the present to his sister's Oki."
+
+"Well?" said Menard, roughly.
+
+Tegakwita's voice trembled, as if he knew that he was pressing the
+white man too far.
+
+"The grave must be opened. It will not take long."
+
+It came to Menard in a flash. The many delays, the anxious glances
+toward the thicket,--these meant that others were coming. Something
+delayed them; Tegakwita must hold the Big Buffalo till they arrived.
+With never a word Menard sprang over the grave; but the Indian was
+quicker, and his hand was the first on the musket. Then they fought,
+each struggling to free his hands from the other's grasp, rolling over
+and over,--now half erect, tramping on the soft mound, now wrestling
+on the harder ground below. At last Menard, as they whirled and
+tumbled past the weapons, snatched the knife. Tegakwita caught his
+wrist, and then it was nigh to stabbing his own thigh as they fought
+for it. Once he twisted his hand and savagely buried the blade in the
+Indian's side. Tegakwita caught his breath and rallied, and the blood
+of the one was on them both. At last a quick wrench bent the Indian's
+wrist back until it almost snapped,--Menard thought that it had,--and
+the stained blade went home once, and again, and again, until the arms
+that had clung madly about the white man slipped off, and lay weakly
+on the ground.
+
+Menard was exhausted. The dirt and blood were in his hair and eyes and
+ears. He was rising stiffly to his knees when the rush of Indians came
+from the bushes. He could not see them clearly,--could hardly hear
+them,--though he fought until a musket-stock swung against his head
+and stretched him on the ground.
+
+When he recovered they were standing about him, half a score of them,
+waiting to see if he still had life. He raised a bruised arm to wipe
+his eyes, but a rough hand caught it and drew a thong tightly about
+his wrists. Slowly his senses awakened, and he could see indistinctly
+the silent forms,--some standing motionless, others walking slowly
+about. It was strange. His aching head had not the wit to meet with
+the situation. Then they jerked him to his feet, and with a stout
+brave at each elbow and others crowding about on every side, he was
+dragged off through the bushes.
+
+For a long time the silent party pushed forward. They were soon clear
+of the forest, passing through rich wild meadows that lifted the scent
+of clover, the fresher for the dew that lay wet underfoot. There were
+other thickets and other forests, and many a reach of meadow, all
+rolling up and down over the gentle hills. Menard tried to gather his
+wits, but his head reeled; and the struggle to keep his feet moving
+steadily onward was enough to hold his mind. He knew that he should
+watch the trail closely, to know where they were taking him, but he
+was not equal to the effort. At last the dawn came, gray and
+depressing, creeping with deadly slowness on the trail of the
+retreating night. The sky was dull and heavy, and a mist clung about
+the party, leaving little beads of moisture on deerskin coats and
+fringed leggings and long, brown musket barrels. The branches drooped
+from the trees, blurred by the mist and the half dark into strange
+shapes along the trail.
+
+The day was broad awake when Menard gave way. His muscles had been
+tried to the limit of his endurance during these many desperate days
+and sleepless nights that he had thought to be over. He fell loosely
+forward. For a space they dragged him, but the burden was heavy, and
+the chief ordered a rest. The band of warriors scattered about to
+sleep under the trees, leaving a young brave to watch the Big Buffalo,
+who slept motionless where they had dropped him in the long grass
+close at hand. On every side were hills, shielding them from the view
+of any chance straggler from the Onondaga villages, unless he should
+clamber down the short slopes and search for them in the mist. A
+stream tumbled by, not a dozen yards from Menard and his yawning
+guardian.
+
+When he awoke, the mist had thinned, but the sky showed no blue.
+Beneath the gray stretch that reached from hill crest to hill crest,
+light foaming clouds scudded across from east to west, though there
+was little wind near the ground. The Captain listened for a time to
+the noise of the stream before looking about. He changed his position,
+and rheumatic pains shot through his joints. For the second time in
+his life he realized that he was growing old; and with this thought
+came another. What sort of a soldier was he if he could not pass
+through such an experience without paying the old man's penalty. To be
+sure his head was battered and bruised, and scattered over his
+shoulders and arms and hips were a dozen small wounds to draw in the
+damp from the grass, but he did not think of these. In his weak,
+half-awake state, he was discouraged, with the feeling that the best
+of his life was past. And the thought that he, a worn old soldier,
+could have dreamed what he had dreamed of the maid and her love sank
+down on his heart like a weight. But this thought served another
+purpose: to think of the maid was to think of her danger; and this was
+to be the alert soldier again, with a plan for every difficulty as
+long as he had life in his body. And so, before the mood could drag
+him down, he was himself again.
+
+Most of the Indians were asleep, sprawling about under the trees near
+the water. The warrior guarding Menard appeared to be little more than
+a youth. He sat with his knees drawn up and his head bowed, his
+blanket pulled close around him, and his oily black hair tangled about
+his eyes. Menard lay on his back looking at the Indian through
+half-closed eyes.
+
+"Well," he said in a low, distinct voice, "you have me now, haven't
+you?"
+
+The Indian gave him a quick glance, but made no reply.
+
+"It is all right, my brother. Do not turn your eyes to me, and nothing
+will be seen. I can speak quietly. A nod of your head will tell me if
+anyone comes near. Do you understand?"
+
+Again the little eyes squinted through the hanging locks of hair.
+
+"You do understand? Very well. You know who I am? I am the Big
+Buffalo. I killed half a score of your bravest warriors in their own
+village. Do you think these thongs can hold the Big Buffalo, who never
+has been held by thongs, who is the hardest fighter and the boldest
+hunter of all the lands from the Mohawk to the Great River of the
+Illinois? Listen, I will tell you how many canoes of furs the Big
+Buffalo has in the north country; I will tell you--"
+
+The Indian's head nodded almost imperceptibly. A yawning brave was
+walking slowly along the bank of the stream, gathering wood for a
+fire. He passed to a point a few rods below the prisoner, then came
+back and disappeared among the trees.
+
+"I will tell you," said Menard, keeping his voice at such a low pitch
+that the guard had to bend his head slightly toward him, "of the great
+bales of beaver that are held safe in the stores of the Big Buffalo.
+Does my brother understand? Does he see that these bales are for him,
+that he will be as rich as the greatest chief among all the chiefs of
+the Long House? No brave shall have such a musket,--with a long,
+straight barrel that will send a ball to the shoulder of a buffalo
+farther than the flight of three arrows. His blanket shall be the
+brightest in Onondaga; his many clothes, his knives, his hatchets, his
+collars of wampum shall have no equal. He can buy the prettiest wives
+in the nation. Does my brother understand?"
+
+The fire had been lighted, and a row of wild hens turned slowly on
+wooden spits over the flames. One by one the warriors were rousing and
+stirring about among the trees. There were shouts and calls, and the
+grumbling talk of the cooks as they held the long spits and turned
+their faces away from the smoke, which rose but slowly in the damp,
+heavy air. Menard lay with his eyes closed, as if asleep; even his
+lips hardly moved as he talked.
+
+"My brother must think quickly, for the time is short. All that I
+promise he will have, if he will be a friend to the Big Buffalo. And
+every Onondaga knows that the word of the Big Buffalo is a word that
+has never been broken. My brother will be a friend. He will watch
+close, and to-night, when the dark has come, he will let his knife
+touch the thongs that hold the White Chief captive."
+
+The Indian's face was without expression. Menard watched him closely,
+but could not tell whether his offer was taking effect. What he had no
+means of knowing was that since the battle at the hut, and the short
+fight in the council-house, the younger braves had centred their
+superstitions on him. It was thought that his body was occupied by
+some bad spirit that gave him the strength of five men, and that he
+had been sent to their village by a devil to lure the warriors into
+the hands of the French. These were not the open views that would have
+been heard at a council; they were the fears of the untried warriors,
+who had not the vision to understand the diplomacy of the chiefs, nor
+the position in the village to give them a public hearing. They had
+talked together in low tones, feeding the common fear, until a few
+words from the Long Arrow had aroused them into action. And so this
+guard was between two emotions: the one a lust for wealth and position
+in the tribe, common to every Indian and in most cases a stronger
+motive than any of the nobler sentiments; the other an unreasoning
+fear of this "bad doctor," the fear that to aid him or to accept furs
+from him would poison the ears of his own Oki, and destroy his chance
+of a name and wealth during his life, and of a long, glorious hunt
+after death.
+
+"My brother shall come with me to the land of the white men, where
+there is no trouble,--where he shall have a great lodge like the white
+chiefs, with coloured pictures in gold frames, and slaves to prepare
+his food. He shall be a great chief among white men and redmen, and
+his stores shall be filled to the doors with furs of beaver and
+seal."
+
+Menard's voice was so low and deliberate that the Indian did not
+question his statements. He was tempted more strongly than he had ever
+been tempted before, but with the desire grew the fear of the
+consequences. As for the Captain, he was clutching desperately at this
+slender chance that lay to his hand.
+
+"I have given my brother his choice of greater power than was ever
+before offered to a youth who has yet to win his name. The stroke of a
+knife will do it. No one shall know, for the Big Buffalo can be
+trusted. My brother has it before him to be a red chief or a white
+chief, as he may wish. The warriors are near,--the day grows bright;
+he must speak quickly."
+
+There was a call from the group by the fire, and the young Indian gave
+a little start, and slowly rising, walked away, yielding his place as
+guard to an older man. Menard rolled over and pressed his face to the
+ground as if weary; he could then watch the youth through the grass as
+he moved to the fire, but in a moment he lost sight of him. The new
+guard was a stern-faced brave, and his appearance promised no help; so
+the Captain, having done all that could be done at the moment, tried
+to get another sleep, struggling to put thoughts of the maid from his
+mind. Perhaps, after all, she was safe at the village.
+
+Meantime the youth, after a long struggle with the temptings of the
+bad doctor, yielded to his superstition, and sought the Long Arrow,
+who lay on the green bank of the stream. In a few moments the story
+was told, and the chief, with a calm face but with twinkling eyes,
+came to the prisoner and stood looking down at him.
+
+"The White Chief is glad to be with his Onondaga brothers?" he said in
+his quiet voice.
+
+Menard slowly raised his eyes, and looked coolly at the chief without
+replying.
+
+"The tongue of the Big Buffalo is weary perhaps? It has moved so many
+times to tell the Onondaga what is not true, that now it asks for
+rest. The Long Arrow is kind. He will not seek to move it again. For
+another sleep it shall lie at rest; then it may be that our braves
+shall find a way to stir it."
+
+Menard rolled over, with an expression of contempt, and closed his
+eyes.
+
+"The Long Arrow was sorry that his white brother was disappointed at
+the torture. Perhaps he will have better fortune after he has slept
+again. Already have the fires been lighted that shall warm the heart
+of the White Chief. And he shall have friends to brighten him. His
+squaw, too, shall feel the glow of the roaring fire, and the gentle
+hands of the Onondaga warriors, who do not forget the deaths of their
+own blood."
+
+Menard lay still.
+
+"Another sleep, my brother, and the great White Chief who speaks with
+the voice of Onontio shall be with his friends. He shall hear the
+sweet voice of his young squaw through the smoke that shall be her
+garment. He shall hear the prayers of his holy Father by his side, and
+shall know that his spirit is safe with the Great Spirit who is not
+strong enough to give him his life when the Long Arrow takes it
+away."
+
+There was still a mad hope that the chief spoke lies, that the maid
+and Father Claude were safe. True or false, the Long Arrow would
+surely talk thus; for the Iroquois were as skilled in the torments of
+the mind as of the body. He was conscious that the keen voice was
+going on, but he did not follow what it said. Again he was going over
+and over in his mind all the chances of escape. It might be that the
+youth had been moved by his offer. But at that moment he heard the
+Long Arrow saying:--
+
+" ... Even before his death the Big Buffalo must lie as he has always
+lied. His tongue knows not the truth. He thinks to deceive our young
+braves with talk of his furs and his lodges and his power in the land
+of the white men. But our warriors know the truth. They know that the
+Big Buffalo has no store of furs, no great lodges,--that he lives in
+the woods with only a stolen musket, where he can by his lies capture
+the peaceful hunters of the Onondagas to make them the slaves of his
+Chief-Across-the-Water."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI.
+
+AT THE LONG LAKE.
+
+
+Menard again dropped to sleep. When the day had nearly reached its
+middle, he was aroused by two warriors, who pulled him roughly to his
+feet. The band had evidently been astir for some moments. A few braves
+were extinguishing the fire with clumps of sod, while the others
+packed in their blankets what had been left from the morning meal, or
+looked to the spots of rust which the damp had brought to knives and
+muskets. The Long Arrow came over to inspect the thongs that held
+Menard's wrists; he had not forgotten his attack on his guards on the
+morning of the torture. And with a precaution that brought a half
+smile to the prisoner's face, he posted a stout warrior on each side,
+in addition to those before and behind. Then they set out over the
+hills, wading through a great tumbling meadow where their feet sank
+deep into the green and yellow and white that June had spread over the
+open lands of the Iroquois. Overhead the sky, though still clouded,
+was breaking, giving little glimpses of clear blue.
+
+As they neared the crest of the first hill, the Captain looked back
+over his shoulder. The sun had at last broken through to the earth,
+and a great band of yellow light was moving swiftly across the valley.
+Before it, all the ground was sombre in its dark green and its heavy
+moisture; behind lay a stretch of golden sunshine, rounding over the
+farther hills in great billows of grass and flowers and clustering
+trees, glistening with dew and glowing with the young health of the
+summer. Up the hillside came the sunlight; and then in a moment it had
+passed them, and the air was warm and sweet.
+
+Menard looked at the sun and then back across the valley to get his
+direction. He saw that the party was moving a little to the south of
+west. This line of march should take them through the Cayuga
+country,--a natural move on the part of the Long Arrow, for the
+Cayugas were closer to the scene of the fighting than the Onondagas,
+and therefore would be less likely to interfere with the persecution
+of a Frenchman, particularly before their chiefs should return from
+the council.
+
+Late in the afternoon they came to a slow-moving stream, the outlet of
+an inland lake. By the basin-shape of the end of the lake, he
+recognized it as one that lay directly between Onondaga and the Long
+Lake of the Cayugas. On the bank of the little river, under the matted
+foliage, the chief signalled a halt, and the warriors threw themselves
+on the ground. Menard lay at the foot of a beech whose roots dipped in
+the water, and for the hundredth time since the sun had risen he cast
+about for some chance at escape. The thongs about his wrists were tied
+by skilful hands. He tried to reach the knot with his fingers, but
+could not. His guards were alert to every motion; they lay on either
+side, and he could not lift his eyes without meeting the sullen glance
+of one or the other. He was about ready to submit, trusting to his
+wits to seize the first opportunity that should come; for after all,
+to worry would strain his nerves, and now, if at any time, his nerves
+and his strength were needed. When at last he reached this point of
+view, he lay back on the weed-grown earth and went to sleep.
+
+An hour later he was aroused for another start. Night came while they
+were on the way, but they pushed steadily forward, and within a few
+hours they reached the Long Lake. Instead of stopping, however, the
+Long Arrow headed to the south along the bank of the lake. For a space
+it was hard going through the interwoven bushes and briers that tore
+even Menard's tough skin. The moon was in the sky, and here and there
+he caught glimpses of the lake lying still and bright. They saw no
+signs of life save for the flitting bats, and the owls that called
+weirdly through the reaches of the forest. After another hour they
+found a trail which led them down close to the water, and at last to a
+half-cleared space, rank and wild with weed and thistle, and with
+rotting heaps where lay the trunks of trees, felled a generation
+earlier. Scattered about the outer edge of the clearing, close to the
+circle of trees, were a few bark huts, with roofs sagging and doors
+agape. One or two were rivalled in height by the weeds that choked
+their windows. As Menard stood between his guards under the last tree
+on the trail, looking at the deserted village where the frightened
+bats rose and wheeled, and the moonlight streamed on broken roofs, he
+began to understand. The Long Arrow had found a place where he could
+carry out his vengeance undisturbed.
+
+Other forms had risen from the weeds to greet the party. Looking more
+closely, Menard saw that a group of Indians were dragging logs for a
+fire. Evidently this was a rendezvous for two or more bands. He tried
+to count the dim forms, and found them somewhat less than a score in
+all. Perhaps the Long Arrow had found it not easy to raise a large
+party to defy the will of the council concerning the White Chief; but
+he had enough, and already the brandy was beginning to flow,--the
+first stage of the orgie which should take up the rest of the night,
+and perhaps the day to follow. The Long Arrow and his party at once
+joined in the drinking. Confident that they would not this time be
+interrupted, they would probably use all deliberation in preparing for
+the torture.
+
+A rough meal was soon ready, and all fell to. Nothing was set apart
+for the prisoner; though had he been weak they would have fed him to
+stay him for the torture. One of his guardians, in mock pity, threw
+him a bone to which a little meat clung. He asked that his hands be
+loosed, or at least tied in front of his body, but his request brought
+jeers from the little group about him. Seeing that there was no hope
+of aid, he rolled over and gnawed the bone where it lay on the ground.
+The warriors laughed again, and one kicked it away; but Menard crawled
+after it, and this time was not disturbed. A little later, two other
+Indians came from the fire, and after a talk with his guards, ordered
+him to his feet and led him to one of the huts. The door was of rude
+boards, hung on wooden hinges, and now held in place by a short log.
+One brave kicked away the log, and Menard was thrown inside with such
+force that he fell headlong.
+
+Through an opening in the roof came a wide beam of moonlight. He
+looked up, and at first thought he was alone; then he saw two figures
+crouching against the rear wall. His own face and head were so covered
+with dust and blood that he could not have been recognized for a white
+man.
+
+"Who are you?" he said in Iroquois.
+
+"Captain!" came in a startled voice that he knew for Father Claude's;
+and a little gasp of relief from the other figure brought a thrill of
+joy. He tried to raise himself, but in an instant they had come to him
+and were laughing and sobbing and speaking his name. While Father
+Claude seized his shoulders to lift him, the maid fell on her knees,
+and with her teeth tried to cut the thongs.
+
+"Wait, Father," she said in a mumbled voice, without pausing in her
+work; "wait a moment."
+
+Menard could feel her warm tears dropping on his hands.
+
+"You must not, Mademoiselle," said the priest. "You must let me."
+
+She shook her head, and worked faster, until the thongs fell away and
+she could rub with her own torn hands the Captain's wrists.
+
+"Now he may arise, Father. See--see what they have done to him."
+
+Menard laughed. All the weight that had pressed on his heart had
+lifted at the sound of her voice and the touch of her hands. The laugh
+lingered until he was on his feet, and the three stood close together
+in the patch of moonlight and looked each into the other's eyes--not
+speaking, because there was no word so complete as the relief that had
+come to them all; a relief so great, and a bond so strong that during
+all the time they should live thereafter, through other days and other
+times, even across the seas in lands where much should be about them
+to draw a mist over the past, the moment would always be close in
+their memories,--it would stand out above all other deeds and other
+moments. Then the Captain held out his hands, and they each took one
+in a long clasp that told them all to hope, that stirred a new, daring
+thought in each heart. Father Claude at last turned away with shining
+eyes. The maid stood looking up at this soldier whom she trusted, and
+a little sigh passed her lips. Then she too turned, and to cover her
+thoughts she hummed a gay air that Menard had heard the trumpeters
+play at Quebec.
+
+"Tell us, M'sieu," she said abruptly, "what is it? How did it
+happen?"
+
+"It is the Long Arrow."
+
+"So we thought," said Father Claude; "but he was not with the party
+that brought us here, and we could not know. They came while we were
+sleeping, and bound our mouths so that we could not scream. I was at
+fault, I--"
+
+"No, Father. You cannot say that. I left you. I should have been at
+your side."
+
+"Will you tell us about it, M'sieu?" asked the maid. She was leaning
+against the bark wall, looking at the two men.
+
+Menard dropped to the ground, and in a quiet voice gave them the story
+of his capture. The priest rested near him on the broken-down bench
+that slanted against one wall. As the story grew, the maid came over
+and sat at the Captain's feet where she could watch his face as he
+talked. When he reached the account of the fight at the grave, he
+paused and looked at her upturned face. Then he went on, but he did
+not take up the tale where he had dropped it. He could not tell her of
+Tegakwita's end. As he went on to the fight with the Long Arrow's band
+and the flight through the hill country, he thought that she had
+missed nothing; but when he had finished she said:--
+
+"And Tegakwita, M'sieu? Did he come with them?"
+
+"No," Menard replied; "he did not come. I killed him."
+
+He had not meant to let the words come out so brutally. And now, as he
+saw the frightened look, almost of horror, come into her eyes, he
+suffered in a way that would not have been possible before he had
+known this maid. He read her thoughts,--that she herself was the cause
+of a double tragedy,--and it for the moment unmanned him. When he
+could look at her again, she was more nearly herself.
+
+"Go on, M'sieu. There is more?"
+
+"No. There is no more, except that I am here with you. But of
+yourselves? You have told me nothing."
+
+"We have told you all there is to tell," said Father Claude. "We were
+taken while we slept. They have come rapidly, but otherwise they have
+not been unkind."
+
+"You have had food?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"We must think now," Menard said abruptly; "we must put our wits
+together. It is late in the night, and we should be free before dawn.
+Have you thought of any way?"
+
+"Yes," replied the priest, slowly, "we have thought of one. Teganouan
+is with our party. At the first he tried to keep out of sight, but of
+course he could not, once we were on the way. He was a long time at
+the Mission of St. Francis, and I at one time hoped that he would
+prove a true believer. It was drink that led him away from us,--an old
+weakness with him. This morning, when he passed me, I knew that he was
+ashamed. I dared not speak to him; but since then, whenever my eyes
+have met his, I have seen that look of understanding."
+
+"I fear you will not see it to-night," said the Captain. "They are
+drinking."
+
+"Ah, but he is not. He is guarding the hut. Come, M'sieu, it may be
+that we can see him now."
+
+Menard rose, and with the priest peered through the cracks at the rear
+of the hut. After a moment they saw him, standing in the shadow of a
+tree.
+
+"You are sure it is he, Father?"
+
+"Ah, M'sieu, I should know him."
+
+Menard rested his hand on a strip of rotting bark in the wall. The
+priest saw the movement.
+
+"Yes," he said cautiously, "it would be very simple. But you will be
+cautious, M'sieu. Of course, I do not know--I cannot tell surely--and
+yet it must be that Teganouan still has a warm heart. It cannot be
+that he has forgotten the many months of my kindness."
+
+While they stood there, hesitating between a dozen hasty plans, a
+light step sounded, and in an instant their eyes were at the opening.
+A second Indian had joined the guard, and was talking with him in a
+low voice. Father Claude gripped the Captain's arm.
+
+"See, M'sieu,--the wampum collar,--it is the Long Arrow."
+
+Menard laid his finger on his lips. The two Indians were not a dozen
+yards away. The chief swayed unsteadily as he talked, and once his
+voice rose. He carried a bottle, and paused now and then to drink from
+it.
+
+"Teganouan is holding back," whispered Menard. "See, the Long Arrow
+has taken his arm--they are coming--is the door fast?"
+
+"We cannot make it fast, M'sieu. It opens outward."
+
+Menard sprang across to the door and ran his hands over it, but found
+no projection that could be used to hold it closed. He stood for a
+moment, puzzling; then his face hardened, and he fell back to where
+the priest and the maid stood side by side.
+
+"They will get in, M'sieu?"
+
+"Yes. It is better."
+
+They did not speak again. The moccasined feet made no noise on the
+cleared ground, and it seemed a long time before they could hear the
+log fall from the door. There were voices outside. At last the door
+swung open, and the Long Arrow, bottle in hand, came clumsily into the
+hut and stood unsteadily in the square of moonlight. He looked about
+as if he could not see them. Teganouan had come in behind him; and the
+door swung to, creaking.
+
+"The White Chief is the brother of the Long Arrow," said the chief,
+speaking slowly and with an effort to make his words distinct. "He
+loves the Onondagas. Deep in his mind are the thoughts of the young
+white brave who lived in our villages and hunted with our braves and
+called the mighty Big Throat his father. He never forgets what the
+Onondagas have done for him. He has a grateful heart." The effort of
+speaking was confusing to the chief. He paused, as if to collect his
+ideas, and looked stupidly at the three silent figures before him.
+"... grateful heart," he repeated. "The Long Arrow has a grateful
+heart, too. He remembers the kind words of the white men who come to
+his village and tell him of the love of the Great Mountain. He never
+forgets that the Big Buffalo is his brother--he never forgets. When
+the Big Buffalo took his son from the hunting party of the Onondagas
+he did not forget."
+
+Menard did not listen further. He was looking about the hut with
+quick, shifting eyes, now at the chief in the moonlight, now at
+Teganouan, who stood at one side in the shadow, now at the door. Could
+Teganouan be trusted to help them? He glanced sharply at the warrior,
+who was looking at his chief with an alert, cunning expression. His
+musket lay carelessly in the hollow of his arm, his knife and hatchet
+hung at his waist. The chief had only his knife; in his hand was the
+bottle, which he held loosely, now and then spilling a few drops of
+the liquor.
+
+"The Long Arrow nev'r f'rgets,"--the chief's tongue was getting the
+better of him. "His house is lonely, where the fire burns alone and
+the young warr'r who once laid 's blanket,--laid 's blanket by the
+fire, no long'r 's there to warm the heart of the Long Arrow. But now
+his loneliness is gone. Now when he comes from the hunt to 's house
+he'll find a new fire, a bright fire, and a new squaw to warm 's
+heart--warm 's heart." He swayed a little as he spoke, and Teganouan
+took a short step forward; but the chief drew himself up and came
+slowly across the patch of moonlight. His eyes were unnaturally
+bright, and they rolled uncertainly from one to another of the little
+group before him. His coarse black hair was matted and tangled, and
+the eagle feathers that at the council had stood erect from his head
+now drooped, straggling, to one side.
+
+The maid had understood. The two men drew close to her on each side,
+and her hand rested, trembling, on Menard's arm. All three were
+thinking fast. One scream, the sound of a struggle or even of loud
+voices, would bring upon them the whole drunken band. As the chief
+approached, the maid could feel the muscles harden on the Captain's
+arm.
+
+"Long Arrow's lonely--his fire's not bright when he comes from hunt--"
+Here and there in his talk a few words were distinguishable as he
+stood lurching before them. He reached out in a maudlin effort to
+touch the maid's white face. She drew in her breath quickly and
+stepped back; then Menard had sprung forward, and she covered her eyes
+with her hands.
+
+There was a light scuffle, but no other sound. A strong smell of
+brandy filled the hut. Slowly she lifted her head, and let her hands
+drop to her sides. The Long Arrow lay sprawling at her feet, his head
+gashed and bleeding, and covered with broken glass and dripping
+liquor. The priest had kneeled beside him, and over his bowed head she
+saw Teganouan, startled, defiant, his musket halfway to his shoulder,
+his eyes fixed on the door. Her eyes followed his gaze. There stood
+the Captain, his back to the door, the broken neck of the bottle
+firmly gripped in his hand.
+
+She stepped forward, too struck with horror to remain silent.
+
+"Oh, M'sieu!" she said brokenly, stretching out her hands.
+
+He motioned to her to be quiet, and she sank down on the bench.
+
+"Father," he said.
+
+The priest looked up questioningly. There was a long moment of
+silence, and the shouts and calls of the half-drunken revellers
+without sounded strangely loud. Then, as the priest gazed at the set,
+hard face of the Captain, and at the motionless Indian, he understood
+of a sudden all the wild plan that was forming in the Captain's mind.
+He rose slowly to his feet, and stood facing Teganouan, with the light
+streaming down upon his gentle face.
+
+"The sun has gone to sleep many times, Teganouan, since you left the
+great white house of the church at St. Francis. You have heard the
+counsel of evil men, who think only of the knife and the hatchet and
+the musket, who have no dream but to slay their brothers." He was
+speaking slowly and in a kindly voice, as a father might speak to a
+son who has wandered from the right. "Have you forgotten the talk of
+the holy Fathers, when they told you the words of the Book of the
+Great Spirit, who is to all your Manitous and Okis as the sun is to
+the stars. Have you forgotten the many moons that passed while you
+lived in the great white house,--when you gave your promise, the
+promise of an Onondaga, that you would be a friend to the white man,
+that you would believe the words of the Great Spirit and live a
+peaceful life? Have you forgotten, Teganouan, the evil days when your
+enemy, the fire-water, took possession of your heart and led you away
+from the white house into the lodges of them that do wrong,--how when
+the good spirit returned to you and you came back to the arms of the
+Faith, you were received as a son and a brother? The holy Fathers did
+not say, 'This warrior has done that which he should not do. Let him
+be punished. We have no place for the wrongdoer.' No; they did not say
+this. They said, 'The lost is found. He that wandered from the fold
+has returned.' And they welcomed the lost one, and bade him repent and
+lead a right life. Have you forgotten, Teganouan?"
+
+The Indian had slowly lowered his musket.
+
+"Teganouan has not forgotten," he replied. "He has a grateful heart
+toward the holy Fathers of the great white house. When he was sick,
+they brought him their good doctor and told him to live. He believed
+that the white men were his brothers, that they would do to him as the
+Fathers had promised. But when Teganouan came to the white men, and
+asked to be made like they were, he left behind in his village a
+brother and a sister and a father who said that he was a traitor, who
+said that he was false to the trust of his blood and his nation, that
+he was not of their blood."
+
+"And did he believe them? Did he not know, better than they could,
+that the faith of the white man is also the faith of the redman; that
+the love of the white man includes all who breathe and speak and hunt
+and trade and move upon the earth?"
+
+"Teganouan has not forgotten. He heard the words of the Fathers, and
+he believed that they were true; but when the white Captain took from
+the Onondagas five score of their bravest warriors and called them
+slaves, when he took the brother of Teganouan, borne by the same
+mother and fed by the same hand, to be a slave of the mighty
+Chief-Across-the-Water, could he remember what the holy Fathers had
+said,--that all men were brothers?"
+
+"Teganouan has heard what the White Chief, the Big Buffalo, has said,
+that the evil man who was treacherous to the Onondagas shall be
+punished?"
+
+"Teganouan understands. But the evil man is far from the vengeance of
+the white man. The White Chief is here in our lodges."
+
+Menard left the door and came to the priest's side. The jagged piece
+of glass, his only weapon, he threw to the ground.
+
+"Teganouan," he said slowly and firmly, looking into the Indian's
+eyes, "you heard the great council at the Long House of the Five
+Nations. You heard the decision of the chiefs and warriors, that they
+whom Onontio had sent to bring a message of peace should be set free.
+You have broken the pledge made by your council. You have attacked us
+and made us prisoners, and brought us here where we may be tortured
+and killed and none may know. But when the Great Mountain finds that
+the Big Buffalo has not come back, when he sends his white soldier to
+the villages of the Onondagas and asks what they have done to him who
+brought his voice, what will you say? When the chiefs say, 'We set him
+free,' and look about to find the warrior who has dared to disobey the
+Long House, what will you say? When the young boys and the drunkards
+with loose tongues have told the story of the death of the Long Arrow,
+what will you say? Then you will be glad to flee to the white house of
+the holy Fathers, knowing that they will protect you and save you when
+the braves of your own blood shall pursue you."
+
+Teganouan's eyelids had drooped, and now he was looking at the ground,
+where the chief lay.
+
+"You will come with me, Teganouan. You will fly with us over the Long
+Lake, and through the forests and down the mighty rivers and over the
+inland sea, and there you shall be safe; and you shall see with your
+own eyes the punishment that the Great Mountain will give to the evil
+man who has been false to the Onondagas."
+
+He held out his hand, and silently waited. The priest's head was
+raised, and his lips moved slowly in prayer. The maid sat rigid, her
+hands tightly gripping the edge of the bench. Though he knew that
+every moment brought nearer the chance of discovery, that the lives of
+them all hung on a thread as slender as a hair, the Captain stood
+without the twitching of a muscle, without a sign of fear or haste in
+his grave, worn face.
+
+The Indian's eyes wavered. He looked at the fallen chief, at the
+priest, at Menard; then he took the offered hand. No further word was
+needed. Menard did not know the thought that lay behind the cunning
+face; it was enough that the Indian had given his word.
+
+"Quick, we must hide him," said the Captain, looking swiftly about the
+hut. "We must disturb you, Mademoiselle--"
+
+In a moment the three men had lifted the body of the Long Arrow and
+laid it away under the low bench. Teganouan scraped a few handfuls of
+earth from a corner and spread it over the spot where the chief had
+been.
+
+"How far is it to the lake, Teganouan?"
+
+"But a few rods."
+
+"And the forest is thick?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"We must cross the lake. Is there a canoe here?"
+
+The Indian shook his head. Menard stood thinking for an instant.
+
+"If you are thinking of me, M'sieu, I think I can swim with you," said
+the maid, timidly.
+
+"There is no other way, Mademoiselle. I am sorry. But we will make it
+as easy as we can."
+
+He stepped to the rear wall, and with a blow of his fist would have
+broken an opening through the rotted bank, but the Indian caught his
+arm.
+
+"It is not necessary. See." He set rapidly to work, and in a few
+silent moments he had unlaced the thread-like root that held the sheet
+of bark in place, and lowered it to the ground. He raised himself by
+the cross-pole that marked the top of the wall, and slipped through
+the opening. A few quick glances through the trees, and he turned and
+beckoned. Menard followed, with the knife of the Long Arrow between
+his teeth; and with Father Claude's help the maid got through to where
+he could catch her and lower her to the ground.
+
+The Indian made a cautious gesture and crept slowly through the
+yielding bushes. One by one they followed, the Captain lingering until
+the maid was close to him and he could whisper to her to keep her
+courage. They paused at the bank of the lake. The water lay sparkling
+in the moonlight. Menard looked grimly out; this light added to the
+danger. He found a short log close at hand and carried it to the
+water.
+
+"Come, Mademoiselle," he whispered, "and Father Claude. This will
+support you. Teganouan and I will swim. Keep low in the water, and do
+not splash or speak. The slightest noise will travel far across the
+lake."
+
+Slowly they waded out, dropping into the water before it was waist
+deep. Teganouan's powder-horn and musket lay on the log, and the maid
+herself steadied it so that they should not be lost.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII.
+
+NORTHWARD.
+
+
+Weak and chilled from the long swim through the cold water they
+dragged themselves across the narrow beach to the bushes that hung
+over the bank. Menard and Father Claude supported the maid, who was
+trembling and clinging to them. At the bank she sank to the ground.
+
+"It is hard, Mademoiselle, but we must not stop. It is better to be
+weary than to rest in this condition. It would mean sickness."
+
+"Yes," she said; "I know. In a moment I can go on." She looked up and
+tried to smile. "It is so cold, M'sieu."
+
+Menard turned to Teganouan.
+
+"How far is it to the villages of the Cayugas?"
+
+"Not far. Half a sleep."
+
+"Is there a trail?"
+
+"The trail is far. It passes the end of the Long Lake." He raised his
+head and looked at the stars, then pointed to the southwest. "The
+nearest village lies there. If we go through the forest toward the
+setting sun, we shall meet the trail."
+
+"You think it will be wise to go to the Cayugas, M'sieu?" asked Father
+Claude.
+
+"I think so. The chiefs must have returned before this time, or at
+least by the morrow." He dropped into the Iroquois tongue. "Is not
+this so, Teganouan? Would the chiefs of the Cayugas linger among the
+Onondagas after the close of the council?"
+
+"The Cayuga warriors await the word of the Long House. They know that
+their chiefs would hasten to bring it back to them."
+
+"Yes. It must be so, Father. And we can trust them to aid us. Perhaps
+they will give us a canoe. Teganouan must tell them he is our guide,
+sent by the Big Throat and the chiefs of the Onondagas to take us
+safely to Frontenac."
+
+The maid was struggling to keep awake, but her lids were heavy. Menard
+came to her and stood, hesitating. She knew that he was there; she
+could hear the rustle of his wet clothes, and his heavy breathing, but
+she did not look up.
+
+"Come," he said, lightly touching her shoulder, "we cannot wait here.
+We must go."
+
+She did not reply, and he hesitated again. Then he stooped and lifted
+her in his arms.
+
+"You will go ahead, Teganouan," he said, "and you, too, if you will,
+Father Claude. Choose an easy trail if you can, and be careful that no
+twig flies back."
+
+They set out slowly through the forest. The priest and the Indian
+laboriously broke a way, and Menard followed, holding the maid
+tenderly, and now and then, in some lighter spot where a beam of
+moonlight fell through the foliage, looking down at her gentle, weary
+face. She was sleeping; and he prayed that no sad dreams might come to
+steal her rest. His arms ached and his knees gave under him, but he
+had hardly a thought for himself. At last, after a long, silent march,
+the priest stopped, and said, supporting himself with one thin hand
+against a tree:--
+
+"You are weary, M'sieu. You must let me take Mademoiselle."
+
+"No, Father, no. I have been thinking. I am afraid it is not right
+that she should sleep now. Even though she fail in the effort,
+exercise of her muscles is all that will prevent sickness. And yet I
+cannot,"--he looked again at her face as it rested against his
+shoulder,--"I cannot awaken her now."
+
+The Father saw the sorrow in the Captain's eyes, and understood.
+
+"I will take her, M'sieu."
+
+Carefully Menard placed her in Father Claude's arms and turned away.
+
+"Teganouan," he said, trying to recover his self-possession, "should
+we not be near the trail?"
+
+"Yes, more than half the way."
+
+"Can we reach it more quickly by heading a little to the north?"
+
+"We would reach the trail, yes; but the way would be longer."
+
+"Never mind; once on the trail it will be easier than in this forest.
+Turn to the north, Teganouan."
+
+He could hear the maid's voice, protesting sleepily, and Father Claude
+talking quietly to her. He looked around. The priest said in a low
+tone:--
+
+"Come, M'sieu, it is hard to awaken her."
+
+"We must frighten her, then."
+
+He caught her shoulders and shook her roughly. Slowly her eyes opened,
+and then the two men dragged her forward. At first she thought herself
+back among the Onondagas, and she begged them not to take her away,
+hanging back and forcing them almost to carry her. It cut Menard to
+the heart, but he pushed steadily forward. Later she yielded, and with
+a dazed expression obeyed. Once or twice she stumbled, and would have
+fallen but for the strong hands that held her. Father Claude rested
+his hand on her forehead as they walked, and Menard gave him an
+anxious, questioning glance. The priest shook his head.
+
+"No," he said, "there is no fever. I trust that it is nothing worse
+than exhaustion."
+
+Menard went on with relief in his eyes.
+
+In less than half an hour after reaching the trail, they came upon the
+outlying huts of the village. Over the hills to the east the dawn was
+breaking, and all the sleeping birds and beasts and creeping things of
+the forest were stirring into life and movement. Teganouan went ahead
+of the party and soon roused a member of the Cayuga branch of his
+clan, the family of the Bear. Through the yawning services of this
+warrior they were guided to an unused hut. Teganouan searched farther,
+and returned with a heap of blankets for the maid, who had dropped to
+the ground before the hut. Menard carried her within and made her as
+comfortable as possible, then withdrew and closed the door.
+
+"Have the chiefs returned from the council at the village of the
+Onondagas?" he asked of the warrior, who stood at one side watching
+them with curiosity in his gaze.
+
+The Cayuga bowed.
+
+"Will my brother carry a message from the White Chief, the Big
+Buffalo, to his chiefs? Will he tell them, as soon as the sun has
+risen, that the Big Buffalo has come to talk with them?"
+
+The warrior bowed and walked away.
+
+"We are safe now, I think, Father. We must get what little sleep we
+can between now and sunrise."
+
+"Should not one of us watch, M'sieu?"
+
+"We are not fit for it. We have hard work before us, and many a chance
+yet to run."
+
+"Teganouan will watch," said the Indian.
+
+Menard's face showed surprise, but Father Claude whispered, "He has
+learned at the mission to understand our language."
+
+They lay on the ground before the hut, in their wet clothes, and in a
+moment were asleep. Teganouan built a fire close at hand, and sat by
+it without a motion, excepting the alert shifting glances of his
+bead-like eyes, until, when the colours in the east had faded into
+blue and the sun was well above the trees, he saw the chiefs of the
+village coming slowly toward him between the huts, a crowd of young
+men following behind them, and a snarling pack of dogs running before.
+He aroused Menard and Father Claude.
+
+The chiefs sat in a circle about the fire, the two white men among
+them. The other Indians sat and stood in a wider circle, just within
+earshot, and waited inquisitively for the White Chief to state his
+errand.
+
+"My brothers, the white men, have asked to speak with the chiefs of
+the Cayugas," said the spokesman, a wrinkled old warrior, whom Menard
+recognized as one of the speakers at the Long House.
+
+"The Big Buffalo is on his way to the stone house of Onontio. He is
+far from the trail. His muskets and his knives and hatchets were taken
+from him by the Onondagas and were not returned to him. He asks that
+the chiefs of the Cayugas permit him to use one of their many canoes,
+that he may hasten to carry to Onontio the word of the Long House."
+
+"The White Chief comes to the Cayugas, who live two sleeps away from
+their brothers, the Onondagas, to ask for aid. Have the Onondagas then
+refused him? Why is my brother so far from the trail?"
+
+"The chiefs of the Cayugas sat in the Long House; they heard the words
+of the great council, that the Big Buffalo and the holy Father and the
+white maiden should be set free. They know that what is decided in the
+council is the law of the nation, that no warrior shall break it."
+
+The little circle was silent with attention, but none of the chiefs
+replied.
+
+"It was still in the dark of the night when the Big Throat came to the
+lodge of the Big Buffalo, and gave him the pledge of the council that
+he should be free with the next sun. The Big Buffalo once learned to
+believe the pledge of the Iroquois. When the mighty Big Throat said
+that he was free, he believed. He did not set a guard to sit with
+wakeful eyes through the night in fear that the pledge was not true.
+No, the Big Buffalo is a warrior and a chief; he is not a woman. He
+trusted his red brothers, and rested his head to sleep. Then in the
+dark came a chief, a dog of a traitor, and took away his white brother
+and his white sister while their eyes were still heavy with sleep, and
+carried them far over the hills to the lake of the Cayugas. Here they
+hid like serpents in the long grass, and thought that they would kill
+them. But the Big Buffalo is a warrior. Without a knife or a musket or
+a hatchet he killed the Long Arrow and came across the Long Lake. He
+knew that the Cayugas were his brothers, that they would not break the
+pledge of the Long House."
+
+The grave faces of the Indians showed no surprise, save for a slight
+movement of the eyes on the part of one or two of the younger men,
+when the Long Arrow was mentioned. Most of them had lighted their
+pipes before sitting down, and now they puffed in silence.
+
+"The White Chief speaks strangely," the spokesman said at last. "He
+tells the Cayugas that their brothers, the Onondagas, have broken the
+pledge of the council."
+
+"Yes."
+
+"He asks for aid?"
+
+"No," said Menard, "he does not ask for aid. He asks that the Iroquois
+nation restore to him what the dogs of the Long Arrow have taken away.
+He has spoken to the Long House in the voice of the Great Mountain. He
+has the right of a free man, of a chief honoured by the council, to go
+freely and in peace. What if those who do not respect the law of the
+council shall rob him of his rights? Must he go on his knees to the
+chiefs? Must he ask that he be allowed to live? Must he go far back on
+his trail to seek aid of the Onondagas, because the Cayugas will not
+hold to the law?"
+
+One of the great lessons learned during Menard's work under Governor
+Frontenac had been that the man who once permits himself to be lowered
+in the eyes of the Indians has forever lost his prestige. Now he sat
+before the chiefs of a great village, weak from the strain of the long
+days and nights of distress and wakefulness and hunger, his clothing
+still wet and bedraggled, with no weapon but a knife, no canoe, not to
+speak of presents,--with none of the equipment which to the Indian
+mind suggested authority,--and yet made his demands in the stern voice
+of a conqueror. He knew that these Indians cared not at all whether
+the word of the council to him had been broken or kept, unless he
+could so impress them with his authority that they would fear
+punishment for the offence.
+
+"The Big Buffalo is a mighty warrior," said the spokesman. "His hard
+hands are greater than the muskets and hatchets of the Cayugas. He
+fights with the strength of the winter wind; no man can stand where
+his hand falls. He speaks wisely to the Cayugas. They are sorry that
+their brothers, the Onondagas, have so soon forgotten the word of the
+great council, Let the Big Buffalo rest his arms. The warriors of the
+Cayugas shall be proud to offer him food."
+
+They all rose, and after a few grunted words of friendship, filed away
+to go over the matter in private council. Menard saw that they were
+puzzled; perhaps they did not believe that he had killed the Long
+Arrow. He turned to Teganouan, who had been sitting a few yards away.
+
+"Teganouan, will you go among the braves of the village and tell them
+that the Big Buffalo is a strong fighter, that he killed the Long
+Arrow with his hands? It may be that they have not believed."
+
+This was the kind of strategy Teganouan understood. He walked slowly
+away, puffing at his pipe, to mingle among the people of the village
+and boast in bold metaphors the prowess of his White Chief.
+
+"They will give us a canoe," said Father Claude.
+
+"Yes, they must. Now, let us sleep again."
+
+They dropped to the ground, and Menard looked warningly at the circle
+of young boys who came as close as they dared to see this strange
+white man, and to hear him talk in the unpronounceable language.
+Father Claude's eyes were first to close. The Captain was about to
+join him in slumber when a low voice came from the door.
+
+"M'sieu."
+
+He started up and saw the maid holding the door ajar and leaning
+against it, her pale face, framed in a tangle of soft hair, showing
+traces of the wearing troubles of the days just passed.
+
+"Ah, Mademoiselle, you must not waken. You must sleep long, and rest,
+and grow bright and young again."
+
+She smiled, and looked at him timidly.
+
+"I have been dreaming, M'sieu," she said, and her eyes dropped, "such
+an unpleasant dream. It was after we had crossed the lake--We did
+cross it, M'sieu, did we not? That, too, was not a dream? No--see, my
+hair is wet."
+
+"No," he said, "that was not a dream."
+
+"We were on the land, and I was so tired, and you talked to
+me--something good--I cannot remember what it was, but I know that you
+were good. And I thought that I--that I said words that hurt you,
+unkind words. And when I wished and tried to speak as I felt, only the
+other words would come. That was a dream, M'sieu, was it not? It has
+been troubling me. You have been so kind, and I could not sleep
+thinking that--that--"
+
+"Yes," he said, "that was a dream."
+
+She looked at him with relief, but as she looked she seemed to become
+more fully awake to what they were saying. Her eyes lowered again, and
+the red came over her face.
+
+"I am glad," she said, so low that he hardly heard.
+
+"And now you will rest, Mademoiselle?"
+
+She smiled softly, and drew back within the hut, closing the heavy
+door. And Menard turned away, unmindful of the wide-eyed boys who were
+staring from a safe distance at him and at the door where the strange
+woman had appeared. He sat with his back against the logs of the hut,
+and looked at the ants that hurried about over the trampled ground.
+
+The sun was high when he was aroused by Teganouan, who had spent the
+greater part of the morning among the people of the village.
+
+"Have you any word, Teganouan?"
+
+"Yes. The warriors have learned of the strength of the Big Buffalo,
+and his name frightens them. They bow to the great chief who has
+killed the Long Arrow without a hatchet. They say that the Onondagas
+should be punished for their treachery."
+
+"Good."
+
+"Teganouan has been talking long with a runner of the Seneca nation."
+
+"Ah, he brings word of the fight?"
+
+"Yes. The Senecas have suffered under the iron hand of the Great
+Mountain. A great army takes up the hatchet when he goes on the
+war-path, more than all the Senecas and Cayugas and Onondagas together
+when every brave who can hold in his hand a bow or a musket has come
+to fight with his brothers. There were white warriors so many that the
+runner could not have counted them with all the sticks in the Long
+House. There were men of the woods in the skins and beads of the
+redmen; there were Hurons and Ottawas and Nipissings, and even the
+cowardly Illinois and the Kaskaskias and the Miamis from the land
+where the Great River flows past the Rock Demons. The Senecas fought
+with the strength of the she-bear, but their warriors were killed,
+their corn was trampled and cut, their lodges were burned."
+
+"Did the Great Mountain pursue them?"
+
+"He has gone back to his stone house across the great lake, leaving
+the land black and smoking. The Senecas have come to the western
+villages of the Cayugas."
+
+"There are none in this village?"
+
+"No. But the chiefs have sent blankets to their brothers, and as much
+corn as a hundred braves could carry over the trail. They have taken
+from their own houses to give to the Senecas."
+
+A few moments later two young men came with baskets of sagamity and
+smoked meat. Menard received it, and rising, knocked gently at the
+door.
+
+"Yes, M'sieu,--I am not sleeping."
+
+He hesitated, and she came to the door and opened it.
+
+"Ah, you have food, M'sieu! I am glad. I have been so hungry."
+
+"Come, Father," said the Captain, and they entered and sat on the long
+bench, eating the smoky, greasy meat as eagerly as if it had been
+cooked for the Governor's table. Their spirits rose as the baskets
+emptied, and they found that they could laugh and joke about their
+ravenous hunger.
+
+The chiefs returned shortly after, and came stooping into the hut in
+the free Indian fashion. The old chief spoke:--
+
+"The Big Buffalo has honoured the lodges of the Cayugas; he has made
+the village proud to offer him their corn and meat. It would make
+their hearts glad if he would linger about their fires, with the holy
+Father and the squaw, that they might tell their brothers of the great
+warrior who dwelt in their village. But the White Chief bears the word
+of the Long House. He goes to the stone house to tell his white
+brothers, who fight with the thunder, that the Cayugas and the
+Onondagas are friends of the white men, that they have given a pledge
+which binds them as close as could the stoutest ropes of deerskin. And
+so with sad hearts they come to say farewell to the Big Buffalo, and
+to wish that no dog may howl while he sleeps, that no wind may blow
+against his canoe, that no rains may fall until he rests with his
+brothers at the great stone house beyond the lake."
+
+"The Big Buffalo thanks the mighty chiefs of the Cayugas," replied
+Menard. "He is glad that they are his friends. And when his mouth is
+close to the ear of the Great Mountain, he will tell him that his
+Cayuga sons are loyal to their Father."
+
+The chief had lighted a long pipe. After two deliberate puffs, the
+first upward toward the roof of the hut, the second toward the ground,
+he handed it to Menard, who followed his example, and passed it to the
+chief next in importance. As it went slowly from hand to hand about
+the circle, the Captain turned to the maid, who sat at his side.
+
+"Do they mean it, M'sieu?" she whispered.
+
+For an instant a twinkle came into his eye; she saw it, and smiled.
+
+"Careful," he whispered.
+
+Before she could check the smile, a bronze hand reached across to her
+with the pipe. She started back and looked down at it.
+
+"You must smoke it," Menard whispered. "It is a great honour. They
+have admitted you to their council."
+
+"Oh, M'sieu--I can't--" she took the pipe and held it awkwardly; then,
+with an effort, raised it to her mouth. It made her cough, and she
+gave it quickly to the Captain.
+
+The Indians rose gravely and filed out of the hut.
+
+"Come, Mademoiselle, we are to go."
+
+The smoke had brought tears to her eyes, and she was hesitating,
+laughing in spite of herself.
+
+"Oh, M'sieu, will--will it make me sick?"
+
+He smiled, with a touch of the old light humour.
+
+"I think not. We must go, or they will wonder."
+
+They found the chiefs waiting before the hut, Father Claude and
+Teganouan among them. As soon as they had appeared, the whole party
+set out through the village and over a trail through the woods to the
+eastward. The ill-kept dogs played about them, and plunged, barking,
+through the brush on either side. Behind, at a little distance, came
+the children and hangers-on of the village, jostling one another to
+keep at the head where they could see the white strangers.
+
+When they reached the bank of the lake, they found two canoes drawn up
+on the narrow strip of gravel, and a half-dozen well-armed braves
+waiting close at hand. The chief paused and pointed toward the
+canoes.
+
+"The Cayugas are proud that the White Chief will sail in their canoes
+to the land of the white men. The bravest warriors of a mighty village
+will go with them to see that no Onondaga arrow flies into their camp
+by night."
+
+He signalled to a brave, who brought forward a musket and laid it,
+with powder-horn and bullet-pouch, at the Captain's feet.
+
+"This musket is to tell the Big Buffalo that no wild beast shall
+disturb his feast, and that meat in plenty shall hang from the
+smoking-pole in his lodge."
+
+The canoes were carried into the water and they embarked,--Menard, the
+maid, and two braves in one, Father Claude and four braves in the
+other. They swung out into the lake, the wiry arms and shoulders of
+the canoemen knotting with each stroke of the paddles; and the crowd
+of Indians stood on the shore gazing after until they had passed from
+view beyond a wooded point.
+
+A few hours should take them to the head of the lake. They had reached
+perhaps half the distance, when Menard saw that two of his canoemen
+had exchanged glances and were looking toward the shore. He glanced
+along the fringe of trees and bushes, a few hundred yards distant,
+until his eyes rested on three empty canoes. He called to Father
+Claude's canoe, and both, at his order, headed for the shore. As they
+drew near, half a score of Indians came from the brush.
+
+"Why," said the maid, "there are some of the men who brought us to the
+lake."
+
+"Yes," replied Menard, "it is the Long Arrow's band."
+
+He leaped out of the canoe before it touched the beach, and walked
+sternly up to the group of warriors. He knew why they were there. It
+was what he had expected. When they had discovered the death of the
+Long Arrow there had been rage and consternation. Disputes had
+followed, the band had divided, and a part had crossed the lake to
+hunt the trail of the Big Buffalo. He folded his arms and gave them a
+long, contemptuous look.
+
+"Why do the Onondagas seek the trail of the Big Buffalo? Do they think
+to overtake him? Do they think that all their hands together are
+strong enough to hold him? Did they think that they could lie to the
+White Chief, could play the traitor, and go unpunished?"
+
+Only one or two of the Onondagas had their muskets in their hands.
+They all showed fright, and one was edging toward the wood. The
+Cayugas in the canoes, at a word from Father Claude, had raised their
+muskets. Menard saw the movement from the corner of his eye, and for
+the moment doubted the wisdom of the action. It was a question whether
+the Cayugas could actually be brought to fire on their Onondaga
+brothers. Still, this band had defied the law of the council, and
+might, in the eyes of the Indians, bring down another war upon the
+nation by their act. While he spoke, the Captain had been deciding on
+a course. He now walked boldly up to the man who was nearest the
+bushes, and snatched away his musket. There was a stir and a murmur,
+but without heeding, he took also the only other musket in the party,
+and stepped between the Indians and the forest.
+
+"Stand where you are, or I will kill you. One man"--he pointed to a
+youth--"will go into the forest and bring your muskets to the
+canoes."
+
+They hesitated, but Menard held his piece ready to fire, and the
+Cayugas did the same. At last the youth went sullenly into the bushes
+and brought out an armful of muskets.
+
+"Count them, Father," Menard called in French.
+
+The priest did so, and then ran his eye over the party on the beach.
+
+"There are two missing, M'sieu."
+
+Menard turned to the youth, who, though he had not understood the
+words, caught their spirit and hurried back for the missing weapons.
+Then the Captain walked coolly past them, and took his place in the
+canoe. For a long time, as they paddled up the lake, they could see
+the Onondagas moving about the beach, and could hear their angry
+voices.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII.
+
+THE ONLY WAY.
+
+
+When at last the canoe slipped from the confines of river and hills
+and forest out upon the great Lake Ontario, where the green water
+stretched flat, east and north and west to the horizon, the Cayuga
+warriors said farewell and turned again to their own lands. It was at
+noon of a bright day. The water lay close to the white beach, with
+hardly a ripple to mar the long black scallops of weed and drift which
+the last storm had left on the sand. The sky was fair and the air
+sweet.
+
+In the one canoe which the Cayugas had left to them, the little party
+headed to the east, now skimming close to the silent beach, now
+cutting a straight path across some bay from point to point, out over
+the depths where lay the sturgeon and the pickerel and trout and
+whitefish. The gulls swooped at them; then, frightened, soared away in
+wide, rushing circles, dropping here and there for an overbold minnow.
+The afternoon went by with hardly the passing of a word. Each of them,
+the Captain, the maid, the priest, looked over the burnished water,
+now a fair green or blue sheet, now a space of striped yellow and
+green and purple, newly marked by every phase of sun and cloud; and to
+each it meant that the journey was done. Here was solitude, with none
+of the stir of the forest to bring companionship; but as they looked
+out to the cloud-puffs that dipped behind the water at the world's
+end, they knew that far yonder were other men whose skins were white,
+for all of beard and tan, whose tongue was the tongue of Montreal, of
+Quebec, of Paris,--and neither tree nor rock nor mountain lay between.
+The water that bore them onward was the water that washed the beach at
+Frontenac. Days might pass and find them still on the road; but they
+would be glorious days, with the sun overhead and the breeze at their
+backs, and at evening the wonder of the western sky to make the water
+golden with promise. As they swung their paddles, the maid with them,
+their eyes were full of dreams,--all save Teganouan. His eyes were
+keen and cunning, and when they looked to the north it was not with
+thoughts of home. It may be that he was dreaming of the deed which
+might yet win back his lost name as an Onondaga warrior.
+
+The sun hung over the lake when at last the canoe touched the beach.
+They ate their simple meal almost in silence, and then sat near the
+fire watching the afterglow that did not fade from the west until the
+night was dark and the moon high over the dim line that marked the
+eastern end of the lake. The sense of relief that had come to them
+with the first sight of the lake was fading now. They were thinking of
+Frontenac, and of what might await them there,--the priest soberly,
+the maid bravely, the Captain grimly. Later, when the maid had said
+good-night, and Father Claude had wandered down the beach to the
+water's edge, Menard dragged a new log to the fire and threw it on,
+sending up the flame and sparks high above the willows of the bank. He
+stretched out and looked into the flames.
+
+Teganouan, who had been lying on the sand, heard a rustle far off in
+the forest and raised his head. He heard it again, and rose, standing
+motionless; then he took his musket and came toward the fire. The
+Captain lay at full length, his chin on his hands. He was awake, for
+his eyes were open, but he did not look up. The Indian hesitated, and
+stood a few yards away looking at the silent figure, as if uncertain
+whether to speak. Finally he stepped back and disappeared among the
+willows.
+
+Half an hour went by. Father Claude came up the beach, walking
+slowly.
+
+"It is growing late, M'sieu, for travellers."
+
+Menard glanced up, but did not reply. The priest was looking about the
+camp.
+
+"Where is Teganouan, M'sieu? Did you give him permission to go away?"
+
+"No; he is here,--he was here." Menard rose. "You are right, he has
+gone. Has he taken his musket?"
+
+"I think so. I do not see it."
+
+"He left it leaning against the log. No; it is not there. Wait,--do
+you hear?"
+
+They stood listening; and both caught the faint sound of a body moving
+between the bushes that grew on the higher ground, close to the line
+of willows. Menard took up his musket and held it ready, for they had
+not left the country of the Iroquois.
+
+"Here he comes," whispered Father Claude. "Yes, it is Teganouan."
+
+The Indian was running toward them. He dropped his musket, and began
+rapidly to throw great handfuls of sand upon the fire. The two white
+men sprang to aid him, without asking an explanation. In a moment the
+beach was lighted only by the moon. Then Menard said:--
+
+"What is it, Teganouan?"
+
+"Teganouan heard a step in the forest. He went nearer, and there were
+more. They are on the war-path, for they come cautiously and slowly."
+
+"Father, will you keep by the maid? We must not disturb her now. You
+had better heap up the sand about the canoe so that no stray ball can
+reach her."
+
+The priest hurried down the beach, and Menard and the Indian slipped
+into the willows, Menard toward the east, Teganouan toward the west,
+where they could watch the forest and the beach on all sides. The
+sound of an approaching party was now more distinct. There would be a
+long silence, then the crackle of a twig or the rustle of dead leaves;
+and Menard knew that the sound was made by moccasined feet. He was
+surprised that the invaders took so little caution; either they were
+confident of finding the camp asleep, or they were in such force as to
+have no fear. While he lay behind a scrub willow conjecturing, Father
+Claude came creeping up behind him.
+
+"I will watch with you, M'sieu. It will make our line longer."
+
+"Is she safe?"
+
+"Yes. I have heaped the sand high around the canoe, even on the side
+toward the water."
+
+"Good. You had better move off a little nearer the lake, and keep a
+sharp eye out. It may be that they are coming by water as well, though
+I doubt it. The lake is very light. I will take the centre. You have
+no musket?"
+
+"No; but my eyes are good."
+
+"If you need me, I shall be close to the bushes, a dozen yards farther
+inland."
+
+They separated, and Menard took up his new position. Apparently the
+movement had stopped. For a long time no sound came, and then, as
+Menard was on the point of moving forward, a branch cracked sharply
+not twenty rods away. He called in French:--
+
+"Who are you?"
+
+For a moment there was silence, then a rush of feet in his direction.
+He could hear a number of men bounding through the bushes. He cocked
+his gun and levelled it, shouting this time in Iroquois:--
+
+"Stand, or I will fire!"
+
+"I know that voice! Drop your musket!" came in a merry French voice,
+and in another moment a sturdy figure, half in uniform and half in
+buckskin, bearded beyond recognition, had come crashing down the
+slope, throwing his arms around the Captain's neck so wildly that the
+two went down and rolled on the sand. Before Menard could struggle to
+his feet, three soldiers had followed, and stood laughing, forgetting
+all discipline, and one was saying over and over to the other:--
+
+"It is Captain Menard! Don't you know him? It is Captain Menard!"
+
+"You don't know me, Menard, I can see that. I wish I could take the
+beard off, but I can't. What have you done with my men?"
+
+Now Menard knew; it was Du Peron.
+
+"I left them at La Gallette," he said.
+
+"I haven't seen them--oh, killed?"
+
+Menard nodded.
+
+"Come down the beach and tell me about it. What condition are you in?
+Have you anybody with you?" Before Menard could answer, he said to one
+of the soldiers:--
+
+"Go back and tell the sergeant to bring up the canoes."
+
+They walked down the beach, and the other soldiers set about building
+a new fire.
+
+"Perhaps I'd better begin on you," Menard said. "What are you doing
+here? And what in the devil do you mean by coming up through the woods
+like a Mohawk on the war-path?"
+
+The Lieutenant laughed.
+
+"My story isn't a long one. I'm cleaning up our base of supplies at La
+Famine. We've got a small guard there. The main part of the rear-guard
+is back at Frontenac."
+
+"Where is the column?"
+
+"Gone to Niagara, Denonville and all, to build a fort. They'll give it
+to De Troyes, I imagine. It's a sort of triumphal procession through
+the enemy's country, after rooting up the Seneca villages and fields
+and stockades until you can't find an able-bodied redskin this side of
+the Cayugas. Oh, I didn't answer your other question. What do you
+think of these?" He held out a foot, shod in a moccasin. "You'd never
+know the King's troops now, Menard. We're wearing anything we can pick
+up. I've got a dozen canoes a quarter of a league down the lake. I saw
+your fire, and thought it best to reconnoitre before bringing the
+canoes past." He read the question in Menard's glance. "We are not
+taking out much time for sleep, I can tell you. It's all day and all
+night until we get La Famine cleared up. There is only a handful of
+men there, and we're expecting every day that the Cayugas and
+Onondagas will sweep down on them."
+
+"They won't bother you," said Menard.
+
+"Maybe not, but we must be careful. For my part, I look for trouble.
+The nations stand pretty closely by each other, you know."
+
+"They won't bother you now."
+
+"How do you know?"
+
+"What did I come down here for?"
+
+"They didn't tell me. Oh, you had a mission to the other nations? But
+that can't be,--you were captured."
+
+Menard lay on his side, and watched the flames go roaring upward as
+the soldiers piled up the logs.
+
+"I could tell you some things, Du Peron," he said slowly. "I suppose
+you didn't know,--for that matter you couldn't know,--but when the
+column was marching on the Senecas, and our rear-guard of four hundred
+men--"
+
+"Four hundred and forty."
+
+"The same thing. You can't expect the Cayugas to count so sharply as
+that. At that time the Cayugas and Onondagas held a council to discuss
+the question of sending a thousand warriors to cut off the rear-guard
+and the Governor's communications."
+
+The Lieutenant slowly whistled.
+
+"How did they know so much about it, Menard?"
+
+"How could they help it? Our good Governor had posted his plans on
+every tree. You can see what would have happened."
+
+"Why, with the Senecas on his front it would have been--" He paused,
+and whistled again.
+
+"Well,--you see. But they didn't do it."
+
+"Why not?"
+
+"Because I spoke at that council."
+
+"You spoke--but you were a prisoner, weren't you?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+The Lieutenant sat staring into the fire. Slowly it came to him what
+it was that the Captain had accomplished.
+
+"Why, Menard," he said, "New France won't be able to hold you, when
+this gets out. How you must have gone at them. You'll be a major in a
+week. You're the luckiest man this side of Versailles."
+
+"No, I'm not. And I won't be a major. I'm not on the Governor's pocket
+list. But I don't care about that. That isn't the reason I did it."
+
+"Why did you do it then?"
+
+"I--That's the question I've been asking myself for several days, Du
+Peron."
+
+The Lieutenant was too thoroughly aroused to note the change in the
+Captain's tone.
+
+"You don't see it right now, Menard. Wait till you've reached the
+city, and got into some clothes and a good bed, and can shake hands
+with d'Orvilliers and Provost and the general staff,--maybe with the
+Governor himself. Then you'll feel different. You're down now. I know
+how it feels. You're all tired out, and you've got the Onondaga dirt
+rubbed on so thick that you're lost in it. You wait a few weeks."
+
+"Did the Governor have much trouble with the Senecas?"
+
+"Oh, he had to fight for it. He was--My God, Menard, what about the
+girl? I was so shaken up at meeting you like this that it got away
+from me. The column had hardly got to the fort on their way up from
+Montreal before everyone was asking for you. La Grange had a letter
+from her father saying that she was with you, and he's been in a bad
+way. He says that he was to have married her, and that you've got away
+with her. It serves him right, the beast. One night, at La Famine, he
+was drunk, and he came around to all of us reading that letter at the
+top of his voice and swearing to kill you the moment he sees you. He's
+been talking a good deal about that."
+
+"She is here, asleep."
+
+"Thank God."
+
+"Where is La Grange now?"
+
+"He's over at Frontenac. He got into trouble before we left La Famine.
+He's drinking hard now, you know. He had command of a company that was
+working on the stockades, and he made such a muss of it that his
+sergeant had to take hold and handle it to get the work done at all.
+You can imagine what bad feeling that made in his company. Played the
+devil with his discipline. Well, he took it like a child. But that
+night, when he got a little loose on his legs, he hunted up the
+sergeant and made him fight. The fellow wouldn't until La Grange came
+at him with his sword, but then he cracked his head with a musket."
+
+"Hurt him?"
+
+"Yes. They took him up to Frontenac. He's in the hospital now, but
+it's pretty generally understood that d'Orvilliers won't let him go
+out until the Governor gets back from Niagara. He's well enough
+already, they say. It's hard on the sergeant, too; no one blames
+him."
+
+Du Peron looked around and saw Teganouan lying near.
+
+"Who's this Indian?" he asked in a low tone.
+
+"He is with me. A mission Indian."
+
+"Does he know French? Has he understood us?"
+
+"I don't know. I suppose so. Here is Father Claude de Casson. You
+remember him, don't you?"
+
+"Yes, indeed."
+
+The Lieutenant rose to greet the priest, and then the three sat
+together.
+
+"You asked me about the fight, didn't you, Menard? I don't seem able
+to hold to a subject very long to-night. We struck out from La Famine
+on the morning of the twelfth of July. You know the trail that leads
+south from La Famine? We followed that."
+
+Menard smiled at the leaping fire.
+
+"Don't laugh, Menard; that was no worse than what we've done from the
+start. The Governor never thought but what we'd surprise them as
+much on that road as on another. And after all, we won, though it did
+look bad for a while. There was a time, at the beginning of the
+fight,--well, I'm getting ahead of myself again. We were in fairly
+good order. Callieres had the advance with the Montreal troops. He
+threw out La Durantaye, with Tonty and Du Luth,--the _coureurs de
+bois_, you know,--to feel the way. La Durantaye had the mission
+Indians, from Sault St. Louis and the Montreal Mountain, on his left,
+and the Ottawas and Mackinac tribes on his right."
+
+"How did the Ottawas behave?"
+
+"Wretchedly. They ran at the first fire. I'll come to that. The others
+weren't so bad, but there was no holding them. They spread through the
+forest, away out of reach. Perrot had the command, but he could only
+follow after and knock one down now and then."
+
+"The Governor took command of the main force?"
+
+"Yes. And he carried his bale like the worst of us; I'll say that for
+him. It was hot, and we all drooped a bit before night. And he made a
+good fight, too, if you can forgive him that bungling march. When we
+bivouacked, some of Du Luth's boys scouted ahead. They got in by
+sunrise. They'd been to the main village of the Senecas on the hill
+beyond the marsh,--you know it, don't you?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"And they saw nothing but a few women and a pack of dogs. The Governor
+was up early,--he's not used to sleeping out doors in the mosquito
+country,--sitting on a log at the side of the trail, talking with
+Granville and Berthier. I wasn't five yards behind them, trying to
+scrape the mud off my boots--you know how that mud sticks, Menard.
+Well, when the scouts came in with their story, the Governor stood up.
+'Take my order to La Durantaye,' he said, 'that he is to move on with
+all caution, that the surprise may be complete. He will push forward,
+following the trail. You,' he said, to a few aides who stood by, 'will
+see that the command is aroused as silently as possible.' Well, I
+didn't know whether to laugh at the Governor or pity myself and the
+boys. Any man but the crowd of seigniors that he had about him would
+have foreseen what was coming. I knew that the devils were waiting for
+us, probably at one of the ravines where the trail runs through that
+group of hills just this side of the marsh. You know the place,--every
+one of us knows it. But what could we say? I'd have given a month's
+pay to have been within ear-shot of La Durantaye when he got the
+order. La Valterie told me about it afterward. 'What's this?' he says,
+'follow the trail? I'll go to the devil first. There's a better place
+for my bones than this pest-ridden country.' He calls to Du Luth:
+'Hear this, Du Luth. We're to "push forward, following the trail."' I
+can fairly hear him say it, with his eyes looking right through the
+young aide. 'Not I,' says Du Luth, 'I'm going around the hills and
+come into the village over the long oak ridge!' 'You can't do it. I
+have the Governor's order.' And then Du Luth drew himself up, La
+Valterie says, and looked the aide (who wasn't used to this kind of a
+soldier, and wished himself back under the Governor's petticoats) up
+and down till the fellow got red as a Lower Town girl. 'Tell your
+commanding officer,' says Du Luth, in his big voice, 'that the advance
+will "push forward, following the trail,"--and may God have mercy on
+our poor souls!'
+
+"Well, Menard, they did it, nine hundred of them. And we came on, a
+quarter of a league after, with sixteen hundred more. We got into the
+first defile, and through it, with never a sound. Then I was sure of
+trouble in the second, but long after the advance had had time to get
+through, everything was still. There was still the third defile, just
+before you reach the marsh, and my head was spinning, waiting for the
+first shot and wondering where we were to catch it and how many of us
+were to get out alive. And then, all at once it came. You see the
+Senecas, three hundred of them at least, were in the brush up on the
+right slope of the third defile; and as many more were in the elder
+thickets and swamp grass ahead and to the left. They let the whole
+advance get through,--fooled every man of Du Luth's scouts,--and then
+came at them from all sides. We heard the noise--I never heard a
+worse--and started up on the run; and then there was the strangest
+mess I ever got into. They had surprised the advance, right
+enough,--we could see Du Luth and Tonty running about knocking men
+down and bellowing out orders to hold their force together,--but you
+see the Senecas never dreamed that a larger force was coming on
+behind, and we struck them like a whirlwind. Well, for nearly an hour
+we didn't know what was going on. Our Indians and the Senecas were so
+mixed together that we dared not shoot to kill. Our own boys, even the
+regulars, lost their heads and fell into the tangle. It was all
+yelling and whooping and banging and running around, with the smoke so
+thick that you couldn't find the trail or the hills or the swamp. I
+was crowded up to my arms in water and mud for the last part of the
+time. Once the smoke lifted a little, and I saw what I thought to be a
+mission Indian, not five yards away, in the same fix. I called to him
+to help me, and he turned out to be a Seneca chief. Our muskets were
+wet,--at least mine was, and I saw that he dropped his when he started
+for me,--so we had it out with knives."
+
+"Did he get at you?"
+
+"Once. A rib stopped it--no harm done. Well, I was tired, but I got
+out and dodged around through the smoke to find out where our boys
+were, but they were mixed up worse than ever. I was just in time to
+save a _coureur_ from killing one of our Indians with his own hatchet.
+Most of the regulars scattered as soon as they lost sight of their
+officers. And Berthier,--I found him lying under a log all gone to
+pieces with fright.
+
+"I didn't know how it was to come out until at last the firing eased a
+little, and the smoke thinned out. Then we found that the devils had
+slipped away, all but a few who had wandered so far into our lines--if
+you could call them lines--that they couldn't get out. They carried
+most of their killed, though we picked up a few on the edge of the
+marsh. It took all the rest of the day to pull things together and
+find out how we stood."
+
+"Heavy loss?"
+
+"No. I don't know how many, but beyond a hundred or so of cuts and
+flesh-wounds like mine we seemed to have a full force. We went on in
+the morning, after a puffed-out speech by the Governor, and before
+night reached the village. The Senecas had already burned a part of
+it, but we finished it, and spent close to ten days cutting their corn
+and destroying the fort on the big hill, a league or more to the east.
+Then we came back to La Famine, and the Governor took the whole column
+to Niagara,--to complete the parade, I suppose."
+
+The story told, they sat by the fire, silent at first, then talking as
+the mood prompted, until the flames had died and the red embers were
+fading to gray. Father Claude had stretched out and was sleeping.
+
+"I must look about my camp," Du Peron said at length. "Good-night."
+
+"Good-night," said Menard; and alone he sat there until the last spark
+had left the scattered heap of charred wood.
+
+The night was cold and clear. The lake stretched out to a misty
+somewhere, touching the edge of the sky. He rose and walked toward the
+water. A figure, muffled in a blanket stood on the dark, firm sand
+close to the breaking ripples. He thought it was one of Du Peron's
+sentries, but a doubt drew him nearer. Then the blanket was thrown
+aside, and he recognized, in the moonlight, the slender figure of the
+maid. She was gazing out toward the pole-star and the dim clouds that
+lay motionless beneath it. The splash of the lake and the call of the
+locusts and tree-toads on the bank behind them were the only sounds.
+He went slowly forward and stood by her side. She looked up into his
+eyes, then turned to the lake. She had dropped the blanket to the
+sand, and he placed it again about her shoulders.
+
+"I am not cold," she said.
+
+"I am afraid, Mademoiselle. The air is chill."
+
+They stood for a long time without speaking, while the northern clouds
+sank slowly beneath the horizon, their tops gleaming white in the
+moonlight. Once a sharp command rang through the night, and muskets
+rattled.
+
+"What is that?" she whispered, touching his arm.
+
+"They are changing the guard."
+
+"You will not need to watch to-night, M'sieu?"
+
+"No; not again. We shall have an escort to Frontenac." He paused; then
+added in uncertain voice, "but perhaps--if Mademoiselle--"
+
+She looked up at him. He went on:
+
+"I will watch to-night, and to-morrow night, and once again--then
+there will be no need: we shall be at Frontenac. Yes, I will watch; I
+will myself keep guard, that Mademoiselle may sleep safely and deep,
+as she slept at the Long Lake and in the forests of the Cayugas. And
+perhaps, while she is sleeping, and the lake lies still, I may dream
+again as I did then--I will carry on our story to the end, and
+then--"
+
+He could not say more; he could not look at her. Even at the rustle of
+her skirt, as she sank to the beach and sat gazing up at him, he did
+not turn. He was looking dully at the last bright cloud tip, sinking
+slowly from his sight.
+
+"Frontenac lies there," he said. "I told them I should bring you
+there. It has been a longer road than we thought,--it has been a
+harder road,--and they have said that I broke my trust. Perhaps they
+were not wrong--I would have broken it--once. But we shall be there in
+three days. I will keep my promise to the chiefs; and we--we shall not
+meet again. It will be better. But I shall keep watch, to-night and
+twice again. That will be all."
+
+He looked down, and at sight of the mute figure his face softened.
+
+"Forgive me--I should not have spoken. It has been a mad dream--the
+waking is hard. When I saw you standing here to-night, I knew that I
+had no right to come--and still I came. I have called myself a
+soldier"--his voice was weary--"see, this is what is done to soldiers
+such as I." One frayed strip of an epaulet yet hung from his shoulder.
+He tore it off and threw it out into the lake. A little splash, and it
+was gone. "Good-night, Mademoiselle,--good-night."
+
+He turned away. The maid leaned forward and called. Her voice would
+not come. She called again and again. Then he heard, for he stood
+motionless.
+
+"M'sieu!"
+
+He came back slowly, and stood waiting. She was leaning back on her
+hands. Her hair had fallen over her face, and she shook it back,
+gazing up and trying to speak.
+
+"You said--you said, the end--"
+
+He hesitated, as if he dared not meet his thoughts.
+
+"You said--See," she fumbled hastily at her bosom, "see, I have kept
+it."
+
+She was holding something up to him. In the dim light he could not
+make it out. He took it and held it up. It was the dried stem and the
+crumbling blossom of a daisy. For a moment he kept it there, then,
+while he looked, he reached into his pocket and drew out the other.
+
+"Yes," he said, "yes--" His voice trembled; his hand shook. Her hair
+had fallen again, and she was trying to fasten it back. He looked at
+her, almost fiercely, but now her eyes were hidden. "We will go to
+Frontenac;" he said; "we will go to Frontenac, you and I. But they
+shall not get you." He caught the hands that were braiding her hair,
+and held them in his rough grip. "It is too late. Let them break my
+sword, if they will, still they shall not get you."
+
+Her head dropped upon his hands, and for the second time since those
+days at Onondaga, he felt her tears. For a moment they were
+motionless; he erect, looking out to the pole-star and over the water
+that stretched far away to the stone fort, she sobbing and clinging to
+his scarred hands. Then a desperate look came into his eyes, and he
+dropped on one knee and caught her shoulders and held her tightly,
+close against him.
+
+"See," he said, with the old mad ring in his voice, "see what a
+soldier I am! See how I keep my trust! But now--but now it is too late
+for them all. I am still a soldier, and I can fight, Valerie. And God
+will be good to us. God grant that we are doing right. There is no
+other way."
+
+"No," she whispered after him; "there is no other way."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX.
+
+FRONTENAC.
+
+
+The sun was dropping behind the western forests. From the lodges and
+cabins of the friendly Indians about the fort rose a hundred thin
+columns of smoke. Long rows of bateaux and canoes lined the beach
+below the log palisade; and others drew near the shore, laden with
+fish. There was a stir and bustle about the square within the stone
+bastions; orderlies hurried from quarters to barracks, bugles sounded,
+and groups of ragged soldiers sat about, polishing muskets and belts,
+and setting new flints. Men of the commissary department were carrying
+boxes and bales from the fort to a cleared space on the beach.
+
+Menard walked across the square and knocked at the door of Major
+d'Orvilliers's little house. Many an eye had followed him as he
+hurried by, aroused to curiosity by his tattered uniform, rusted
+musket, and boot-tops rudely stitched to deerskin moccasins.
+
+"Major d'Orvilliers is busy," said the orderly at the door.
+
+"Tell him it is Captain Menard."
+
+In a moment the Major himself appeared in the doorway.
+
+"Come in, Menard. I am to start in an hour or so to meet Governor
+Denonville, but there is always time for you. I'll start a little
+late, if necessary."
+
+"The Governor comes from Niagara?"
+
+"Yes. He is two or three days' journey up the lake. I am to escort him
+back."
+
+They had reached the office in the rear of the house, and the Major
+brushed a heap of documents and drawings from a chair.
+
+"Sit down, Menard. You have a long story, I take it. You look as if
+you'd been to the Illinois and back."
+
+"You knew of my capture?"
+
+"Yes. We had about given you up. And the girl,--Mademoiselle St.
+Denis--"
+
+"She is here."
+
+"Here--at Frontenac?"
+
+"Yes; in Father de Casson's care."
+
+"Thank God! But how did you do it? How did you get her here, and
+yourself?"
+
+Menard rose and paced up and down the room. As he walked, he told the
+story of the capture at La Gallette, of the days in the Onondaga
+village, of the council and the escape. When he had finished, there
+was a long silence, while the Major sat with contracted brows.
+
+"You've done a big thing, Menard," he said at last, "one of the
+biggest things that has been done in New France. But have you thought
+of the Governor--of how he will take it?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"It may not be easy. Denonville doesn't know the Iroquois as you and I
+do. He is elated now about his victory,--he thinks he has settled the
+question of white supremacy. If I were to tell him to-morrow that he
+has only made a bitter enemy of the Senecas, and that they will not
+rest until they wipe out this defeat, do you suppose he would believe
+it? You have given a pledge to the Iroquois that is entirely outside
+of the Governor's view of military precedent. To tell the truth,
+Menard, I don't believe he will like it."
+
+"Why not?"
+
+"He doesn't know the strength of the Five Nations. He thinks they
+would all flee before our regulars just as the Senecas did. Worse than
+that, he doesn't know the Indian temperament. I'm afraid you can't
+make him understand that to satisfy their hunger for revenge will
+serve better than a score of orations and treaties."
+
+"You think he won't touch La Grange?"
+
+"I am almost certain of it."
+
+"Then it rests with me."
+
+"What do you mean?"
+
+"I gave another pledge, d'Orvilliers. If the Governor won't do this--I
+shall have to do it myself."
+
+Save for a moment's hesitation Menard's voice was cool and even; but
+he had stopped walking and was looking closely at the commandant.
+
+D'Orvilliers was gazing at the floor.
+
+"What do you mean by that?" he said slowly, and then suddenly he got
+up. "My God, Menard, you don't mean that you would--"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"That can't be! I can't allow it."
+
+"It may not be necessary. I hope you are mistaken about the
+Governor."
+
+"I hope I am--but no; he won't help you. He's not in the mood for
+paying debts to a weakened enemy. And--Menard, sit down. I must talk
+plainly to you. I can't go on covering things up now. I don't believe
+you see the matter clearly. If it were a plain question of your
+mission to the Onondagas--if it were--Well, I want you to tell me in
+what relation you stand to Mademoiselle St. Denis."
+
+The Captain was standing by the chair. He rested his arms on the high
+back, and looked over them at d'Orvilliers.
+
+"She is to be my wife," he said.
+
+D'Orvilliers leaned back and slowly shook his head.
+
+"My dear fellow," he said, "when your story goes to Quebec, when the
+Chateau learns that you have promised the punishment of La Grange in
+the name of France, and then of this,--of Mademoiselle and her
+relations to yourself and to La Grange,--do you know what they will
+do?"
+
+Menard was silent.
+
+"They will laugh--first, and then--"
+
+"I know," said the Captain, "I have thought of all that."
+
+"You have told all this in your report?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"So you would go on with it?"
+
+"Yes; I am going on with it. There is nothing else I can do. I
+couldn't have offered to give myself up; they already had me. The
+fault was La Grange's. What I did was the only thing that could have
+been done to save the column; if you will think it over, you will see
+that. I know what I did,--I know I was right; and if my superiors,
+when I have given my report, choose to see it in another way, I have
+nothing to say. If they give me my liberty, in the army or out of it,
+I will find La Grange. If not, I will wait."
+
+"Why not give that up, at least, Menard?"
+
+"If I give that up, we shall have a war with the Iroquois that will
+shake New France as she has never been shaken before."
+
+D'Orvilliers started to speak, but checked the words. Menard slung his
+musket behind his shoulders.
+
+"Wait, Menard. I don't know what to say. I must have time to think. If
+you wish, I will not give notice of your arrival to the Governor. I
+will leave the matter of reporting in your hands." He rose, and
+fingered the papers on the table. "You see how it will look--there is
+the maid--La Grange seeks your life, you seek his--"
+
+Menard drew himself up, his hat in his hand.
+
+"It shall be pushed to the end, Major. You know me; you know Captain
+la Grange. There will be excitement, perhaps,--you may find it hard to
+avoid taking one side or the other. I must ask which side is to be
+yours."
+
+D'Orvilliers winced, and for a moment stood biting his lip; then he
+stepped forward and took both Menard's hands.
+
+"You shouldn't have asked that," he said. "God bless you, Menard! God
+bless you!"
+
+Menard paused in the door, and turned.
+
+"Shall I need a pass to enter the hospital?"
+
+"Oh, you can't go there. La Grange is there."
+
+"Yes; I will report to him. He shall not say that I have left it to
+hearsay."
+
+"But he will attack you!"
+
+"No; I will not fight him until I have an answer from the Governor."
+
+"You can't get in now until morning."
+
+"Very well, good-night."
+
+"You will be careful, Menard?"
+
+The Captain nodded and left the room. Wishing to settle his thoughts,
+he passed through the palisade gate and walked down the beach. The
+commissary men were loading the canoes, threescore of them, that were
+to carry the garrison on its westward journey. Already the twilight
+was deepening, and the lanterns of the officers were dimmed by the
+glow from a hundred Indian camp-fires.
+
+From within the fort came a long bugle-call. There was a distant
+rattling of arms and shouting of commands, then the tramp of feet, and
+the indistinct line came swinging through the sally-port. They halted
+at the water's edge, broke ranks, and took to the canoes, paddling
+easily away along the shore until they had faded into shadows. A score
+of Indians stood watching them, stolidly smoking stone pipes and
+holding their blankets close around them.
+
+It was an hour later when the Captain returned to the fort and started
+across the enclosure toward the hut which had been assigned to him.
+Save for a few Indians and a sentry who paced before the barracks, the
+fort seemed deserted. It was nearly dark now, and the lanterns at the
+sally-port and in front of barrack and hospital glimmered faintly.
+Menard had reached his own door, when he heard a voice calling, and
+turned. A dim figure was running across the square toward the sentry.
+There was a moment of breathless talk,--Menard could not catch the
+words,--then the sentry shouted. It occurred to Menard that he was now
+the senior officer at the fort, and he waited. A corporal led up his
+guard, halted, and again there was hurried talking. Menard started
+back toward them, but before he reached the spot all were running
+toward the hospital, and a dozen others of the home guard had gathered
+before the barracks and were talking and asking excited questions.
+
+Menard crossed to the hospital. Two privates barred the door, and he
+was forced to wait until a young Lieutenant of the regulars appeared.
+The lanterns over the door threw a dim light on the Captain as he
+stood on the low step.
+
+"What is it?" asked the Lieutenant. "You wished to see me?"
+
+"I am Captain Menard. What is the trouble?"
+
+The Lieutenant looked doubtfully at the dingy, bearded figure, then he
+motioned the soldiers aside.
+
+"It is Captain la Grange," he said, when Menard had entered; "he has
+been killed."
+
+The Lieutenant spoke in a matter-of-fact tone, but his eyes were
+shining and he was breathing rapidly. Menard looked at him for a
+moment without a word, then he stepped to the door of a back room and
+looked in. Three flickering candles stood on a low table, and another
+on a chair at the head of the narrow bed. The light wavered over the
+log and plaster walls. A surgeon was bending over the bed, his
+assistant waiting at his elbow with instruments; the two shut off the
+upper part of the bed from Menard's view. The Lieutenant stood behind
+the Captain, looking over his shoulder; both were motionless. There
+was no sound save a low word at intervals between the two surgeons,
+and the creak of a bore-worm that sounded distinctly from a log in the
+wall.
+
+Menard turned away and walked back to the outer door, the Lieutenant
+with him. There they stood, silent, as men are who have been brought
+suddenly face to face with death. At last the Lieutenant began to
+speak in a subdued voice.
+
+"We only know that it was an Indian. He has been scalped."
+
+"Oh!" muttered Menard.
+
+"I think he is still breathing,--he was just before you came,--but
+there is no hope for him. He was stabbed in a dozen places. It was
+some time before we knew--the Indian came in by the window, and must
+have found him asleep. There was no struggle."
+
+They stood again without speaking, and again the Lieutenant broke the
+silence.
+
+"It is too bad. He was a good fellow." He paused, as if searching for
+a kind word for Captain la Grange. "He was the best shot at the fort
+when he--when--"
+
+"Yes," said Menard. He too wished to speak no harsh word. "Is there
+anything I can do?"
+
+"I think not. There is a strong guard about the fort, but I think the
+Indian had escaped before we learned of it. I will see you before we
+take further steps."
+
+"Very well. I shall be at my quarters. Good-night."
+
+"Good-night."
+
+Menard walked slowly back across the enclosure. At the door of his hut
+he paused, and for a long time he stood there, looking up at the quiet
+sky. His mind was scattered for the moment; he could not think
+clearly.
+
+He opened his door and stepped over the log threshold, letting the
+door close after him of its own weight. The hut was dark, with but a
+square of dim light at the window. He fumbled for the candle and
+struck a light.
+
+There was a low rustle from the corner. Menard whirled around and
+peered into the shadows. The candle was blowing; he caught it up and
+shielded it with his hand. A figure was crouching in the corner, half
+hidden behind a cloak that hung there. The Captain sprang forward
+holding the candle high, tore down the cloak, and discovered
+Teganouan, the Onondaga, bending over feeling for his hatchet which
+lay on the floor at his feet. Menard caught his shoulders, and
+dragging him out of reach of the hatchet, threw him full length on the
+floor. The candle dropped and rolled on the floor, but before it could
+go out, Menard snatched it up.
+
+Slowly Teganouan rose to his feet.
+
+"Teganouan comes in a strange manner to the lodge of the white
+warrior," said Menard, scornfully. "He steals in like a Huron thief,
+and hides in dark corners."
+
+The Indian looked at him defiantly, but did not answer.
+
+"My Onondaga brother does not wish to show himself in the light.
+Perhaps there is some trouble on his mind. Perhaps he is governed by
+an evil Oki who loves the darkness." While Menard was speaking he was
+moving quietly toward the door. The Indian saw, but beyond turning
+slowly so as always to face his captor, made no movement. His face,
+except for the blazing eyes, was inscrutable. In a moment Menard stood
+between him and the door. "Perhaps it is best that I should call for
+the warriors of the fort. They will be glad to find here the slayer of
+their brother." His hand was on the latch.
+
+"The Big Buffalo will not call to his brothers." The Indian's voice
+was calm. Menard looked closely at him. "He has not thought yet. When
+he has thought, he will understand."
+
+"Teganouan speaks like a child."
+
+"If Teganouan is a child, can the Big Buffalo tell why he came to the
+white man's lodge?"
+
+"Because he has slain a great white warrior, he must hide his face
+like the outcast dog." Menard pointed to the scalp that hung at his
+waist. "He has slain a great warrior while the hatchet lies buried in
+the ground. He has broken the law of the white man and the redman. And
+so he must hide his face."
+
+"Why did not Teganouan run to the woods? Why did he come to the lodge
+of the Big Buffalo?"
+
+Menard looked steadily at him. He began to understand. The shrewd old
+warrior had chosen the one hiding-place where no searching party would
+look. Perhaps he had hoped for aid from the Captain, remembering his
+pledge to bring punishment on La Grange. If so, he should learn his
+mistake.
+
+"Teganouan's words are idle." Menard moved the latch.
+
+"The Big Buffalo will not open the door. Teganouan has not delivered
+his message. He is not an enemy to the Big Buffalo. He is his friend.
+He has come to this lodge, caring nothing for the safety of his life,
+that he might give his message. The Big Buffalo will not open the
+door. He will wait to hear the words of Teganouan; and then he may
+call to his brother warriors if he still thinks it would be wise."
+
+Menard waited.
+
+"Speak quickly, Teganouan."
+
+"Teganouan's words are like the wind. He has brought them many
+leagues,--from the lodges of the Onondagas,--that he may speak them
+now. He has brought them from the Long House of the Five Nations,
+where the fires burn brightly by day and by night, where the greatest
+chiefs of many thousand warriors are met to hear the Voice of the
+Great Mountain, the father of white men and redmen. The Great Mountain
+has a strong voice. It is louder than cannon; it wounds deeper than
+the musket of the white brave. It tells the Onondagas and Cayugas and
+Oneidas and Mohawks that they must not give aid to their brothers, the
+Senecas, who have fallen, whose corn and forts and lodges are burned
+to ashes and scattered on the winds. It tells the Onondagas that the
+Great Mountain is a kind father, that he loves them like his own
+children, and will punish the man who wrongs them, let him be white or
+red. It tells the Onondagas that the white captain, who has robbed a
+hundred Onondaga lodges of their bravest hunters, shall be struck by
+the strong arm of the Great Mountain, shall be blown to pieces by the
+Voice that thunders from the great water where the seal are found to
+the farthest village of the Five Nations. And the chiefs hear the
+Voice; they listen with ears that are always open to the counsel of
+Onontio. They take his promises into their hearts and believe them.
+They know that he will strike down the dog of a white captain. They
+refuse aid to their dying brothers, the Senecas, because they know
+that the strong arm of Onontio is over them, that it will give them
+peace."
+
+He paused, gazing with bright eyes at Menard. There was no reply, and
+he continued:--
+
+"The Great Mountain has kept his word. The Onondagas shall know, in
+their council, that Onontio's promise has been kept, that the white
+brave, who lied to their hunters and sent them in chains across the
+big water, has gone to a hunting-ground where his musket will not help
+him, where the buffalo shall trample him and tear his flesh with their
+horns. Then the Onondagas shall know that the Big Buffalo spoke the
+truth to the Long House. And this word shall be carried to the
+Onondagas by Teganouan. He will go to the council with the scalp in
+his hand telling them that the white children of Onontio are their
+brothers. Teganouan sees the Big Buffalo stand with his strong hand at
+the door. He knows that the Big Buffalo could call his warriors to
+seize Teganouan, and bind him, and bid him stand before the white
+men's muskets. But Teganouan is not a child. He sees with the eye of
+the old warrior who has fought a battle for every sun in the year, who
+has known the white man as well as the redman. When the Big Buffalo
+stood in the Long House, Teganouan believed him; Teganouan knew that
+his words were true. And now the heart of Teganouan is warm with
+trust. He knows that the Big Buffalo is a wise warrior and that he has
+an honest heart."
+
+There was a pause, and Menard, his hand still on the latch, stood
+motionless. He knew what the Indian meant. He had done no more than
+Menard himself had promised the council, in the name of Governor
+Denonville, should be done. The lodges of the allies near the fort
+sheltered many an Iroquois spy; whatever might follow would be known
+in every Iroquois village before the week had passed. To hold
+Teganouan for trial would mean war.
+
+There was the tramp of feet on the beaten ground without, and a clear
+voice said:--
+
+"Wait a moment, I must report to Captain Menard."
+
+Menard raised the latch an inch, then looked sharply at Teganouan. The
+Indian stood quietly, leaning a little forward, waiting for the
+decision. The Captain was on the point of speaking, but no word came
+from his parted lips. The voices were now just outside the door. With
+a long breath Menard's fingers relaxed, and the latch slipped back
+into place. Then he motioned toward the wall ladder that reached up
+into the darkness of the loft.
+
+Teganouan turned, picked up the hatchet and thrust it into his belt,
+took one quick glance about the room to make sure that no telltale
+article remained, and slipped up the ladder. There was a loud knock on
+the door, and Menard opened it. The Lieutenant came in.
+
+"We have no word yet, Captain," he said. "Every building in the fort
+has been searched. I have so few men that I could not divide them
+until this was done, but I am just now sending out searching parties
+through the Indian village and the forest. None of the canoes are
+missing. Have I your approval?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"You--you have been here since you left the hospital?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"I think, then, that he must have had time to slip out before we knew
+of it. There are many Indians here who would help him; but a few of
+them can be trusted, I think, to join the search. Major d'Orvilliers
+left me with only a handful of men. It will be difficult to accomplish
+much until he returns. I will post a sentry at the sally-port; we
+shall have to leave the bastions without a guard. I think it will be
+safe, for the time."
+
+"Very well, Lieutenant."
+
+The Lieutenant saluted and hurried away. Menard closed the door, and
+turned to the table, where were scattered the sheets on which he had
+been writing his report. He collected them and read the report
+carefully. He removed one leaf, and rolling it up, lighted it at the
+candle, and held it until it was burned to a cinder. Then he read the
+other sheets again. The report now told of his capture, of a part of
+the council at the Long House, and of the escape; but no word was
+there concerning Captain la Grange. Another hand had disposed of that
+question. Menard sighed as he laid it down, but soon the lines on his
+face relaxed. It was not the first time in the history of New France
+that a report had told but half the truth; and, after all, the column
+had been saved.
+
+He sharpened a quill with his sheath-knife, and began to copy the
+report, making further corrections here and there. Something more than
+an hour had passed before the work was finished. He rolled up the
+document and tied it with a thong of deerskin.
+
+It was still early in the evening, but the fort was as silent as at
+midnight. Menard opened the door and walked out a little way. The
+lamps were all burning, but no soldiers were to be seen. The barrack
+windows were dark. He stepped back into the house, closed the door,
+and said in a low voice:--
+
+"Teganouan."
+
+There was a stir in the loft. In a moment the Indian came down the
+ladder and stood waiting.
+
+"Teganouan, you heard what the Lieutenant said?"
+
+"Teganouan has ears."
+
+"Very well. I am going to blow out the candle."
+
+The room was dark. The door creaked softly, and a breath of air blew
+in upon the Captain as he stood by the table. He felt over the table
+for his tinder-box and struck a light. The door was slowly closing;
+Teganouan had gone.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+Another sun was setting. A single drum was beating loudly as the
+little garrison drew up outside the sally-port and presented arms. The
+allies and the mission Indians were crowding down upon the beach,
+silent, inquisitive,--puffing at their short pipes. For half a
+league, from the flat, white beach out over the rose-tinted water
+stretched an irregular black line of canoes and bateaux, all
+bristling with muskets. The Governor had come. He could be seen
+kneeling, all sunburned and ragged but with erect head, in the first
+canoe. His canoemen checked their swing, for the beach was close at
+hand, and then backed water. The bow scraped, and a dozen hands were
+outstretched in aid, but Governor Denonville stepped briskly out into
+the ankle-deep water and carried his own pack ashore. A cheer went up
+from the little line at the sally-port. Du Luth's _voyageurs_ and
+_coureur de bois_ caught it up, and then it swept far out over the
+water and was echoed back from the forest.
+
+In the doorway of a hut near the Recollet Chapel stood Menard and
+Valerie. They watched canoe after canoe glide up and empty its load of
+soldiers, not speaking as they watched, but thinking each the same
+thought. At last, when the straggling line was pouring into the fort,
+and the bugles were screaming, and the drum rolling, Valerie slipped
+her hand through the Captain's arm and looked up into his face.
+
+"It was you who brought them here," she said; and then, after a pause,
+she laughed a breathless little laugh. "It was you," she repeated.
+
+
+
+***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE ROAD TO FRONTENAC***
+
+
+******* This file should be named 28958.txt or 28958.zip *******
+
+
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/2/8/9/5/28958
+
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://www.gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit:
+http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
diff --git a/28958.zip b/28958.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..26aff0d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/28958.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e6a24fe
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #28958 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/28958)